Sunteți pe pagina 1din 629

CONTENTS

FOREWORD
Chapter 9

iii

Financial Statements - I

331

9.1

Stakeholders and Their Information Requirements

331

9.2

Distinction between Capital and Revenue

333

9.3

Financial Statements

335

9.4

Trading and Profit and Loss Account

337

9.5

Operating Profit (EBIT)

351

9.6

Balance Sheet

353

9.7

Opening Entry

362

Financial Statements

372

10.1

Need for Adjustments

372

10.2

Closing Stock

374

10.3

Outstanding Expenses

376

10.4

Prepaid Expenses

377

10.5

Accrued Income

379

10.6

Income Received in Advance

381

10.7

Depreciation

382

10.8

Bad Debts

383

10.9

Provision for Bad and Doubtful Debts

384

10.10

Provision for Discount on Debtors

387

10.11

Managers Commission

389

10.12

Interest on Capital

392

10.13

Methods of Presenting the Financial Statements

416

Accounts from Incomplete Records

437

11.1

Meaning of Incomplete Records

437

11.2

Reasons of Incompleteness and its Limitations

438

Chapter 10

Chapter 11

x
11.3

Ascertainment of Profit and Loss

439

11.4

Preparing Trading and Profit and Loss Account and


the Balance Sheet

444

Chapter 12

Applications of Computers in Accounting

475

12.1

Meaning and Elements of Computer System

475

12.2

Capabilities of Computer System

477

12.3

Limitations of a Computer System

478

12.4

Components of Computer

479

12.5

Evolution of Computerised Accounting

480

12.6

Features of Computerised Accounting System

483

12.7

Management Information System and Accounting


Information System

485

Computerised Accounting System

492

13.1

Concept of Computerised Accounting System

492

13.2

Comparison between Manual and Computerised Accounting494

13.3

Advantages of Computerised Accounting System

495

13.4

Limitations of Computerised Accounting System

497

13.5

Sourcing of Accounting Software

498

13.6

Generic Considerations before Sourcing an

Chapter 13

Accounting Software

501

Structuring Database for Accounting

504

14.1

Data Processing Cycle

506

14.2

Designing Database for Accounting

507

14.3

Entity Relationship (ER) Model

508

14.4

Database Technology

518

14.5

An Illustration of Accounting Database

520

14.6

Relational Data Model

523

14.7

Relational Databases and Schemas

524

14.8

Constraints and Database Schemas

525

14.9

Operations and Constraint Violations

527

Chapter 14

xi
14.10

Designing Relational Database Schema

14.11

llustrating the Database Structure for Example Realities 531

14.12

Interacting with Databases

539

Accounting System Using Database


Management System

555

15.1

MS Access and its Components

555

15.2

Creating Tables and Relationships for

Chapter 15

528

Accounting Database

560

15.3

Vouchers Using Forms

566

15.4

Information Using Queries

588

15.5

Generating Accounting Reports

622

Contents

Chapter 1
1.1
1.2
1.3
1.4
1.5

FOREWORD
Introduction to Accounting
Meaning of Accounting
Accounting as a Source of Information
Objectives of Accounting
Role of Accounting
Basic Terms in Accounting

iii
1
2
6
10
13
14

Chapter 2

Theory Base of Accounting

22

Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP)


Basic Accounting Concepts
Systems of Accounting
Basis of Accounting
Accounting Standards

23
24
33
34
35

Recording of Transactions - I

41

Business Transactions and Source Document


Accounting Equation
Using Debit and Credit
Books of Original Entry
The Ledger
Posting from Journal

41
45
47
56
64
67

Recording of Transactions - II

91

2.1
2.2
2.3
2.4
2.5
Chapter 3
3.1
3.2
3.3
3.4
3.5
3.6
Chapter 4
4.1
4.2
4.3
4.4
4.5
4.6
4.7

Cash Book
Purchases (Journal) Book
Purchases Return (Journal) Book
Sales (Journal) Book
Sales Return (Journal) Book
Journal Proper
Balancing the Accounts

92
117
119
121
123
129
131

Chapter 5
5.1
5.2
Chapter 6
6.1
6.2
6.3
6.4
6.5
6.6
Chapter 7
7.1
7.2
7.3
7.4
7.5
7.6
7.7
7.8
7.9
7.10
7.11
7.12
7.13
Chapter 8
8.1
8.2
8.3
8.4
8.5
8.6
8.7
8.8
8.9
8.10
8.11
8.12

Bank Reconciliation Statement

150

Need for Reconciliation


Preparation of Bank Reconciliation Statement

151
156

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors

181

Meaning of Trial Balance


Objectives of Preparing the Trial Balance
Preparation of Trial Balance
Significance of Agreement of Trial Balance
Searching of Errors
Rectification of Errors

181
182
185
190
192
193

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves

227

Depreciation
Depreciation and other Similar Terms
Causes of Depreciation
Need for Depreciation
Factors Affecting the Amount of Depreciation
Methods of calculating Depreciation Amount
Straight Line Method and Written Down Method
A Comparative Analysis
Methods of Recording Depreciation
Disposal of Asset
Effect of any Addition or Extension to the
Existing Asset
Provisions
Reserves
Secret Reserve

227
231
231
232
234
235
240

Bill of Exchange

279

Meaning of Bill of Exchange


Promissory Note
Advantages of Bill of Exchange
Maturity of Bill
Discounting of Bill
Endorsement of Bill
Accounting Treatment
Dishonour of a Bill
Renewal of the Bill
Retiring of the Bill
Bills Receivable and Bills Payable Books
Accommodation of Bills

280
282
284
285
285
286
286
293
298
301
303
317

242
251
261
264
266
270

Accountancy
Financial Accounting
Volume I
Textbook for Class XI

Introduction to Accounting

LEARNING OBJECTIVES
After studying this chapter
you will be able to:

state the meaning and


need of accounting;

discuss accounting as
a source of information ;

identify the internal


and external users of
accounting information;

explain the objectives


of accounting;

describe the role of


accounting;

explain the basic terms


used in accounting.

ver the centuries, accounting has remained


confined to the financial record-keeping
functions of the accountant. But, todays rapidly
changing business environment has forced the
accountants to reassess their roles and functions
both within the organisation and the society. The
role of an accountant has now shifted from that of
a mere recorder of transactions to that of the
member providing relevant information to the
decision-making team. Broadly speaking,
accounting today is much more than just bookkeeping and the preparation of financial reports.
Accountants are now capable of working in exciting
new growth areas such as: forensic accounting
(solving crimes such as computer hacking and the
theft of large amounts of money on the internet); ecommerce (designing web-based payment system);
financial planning, environmental accounting, etc.
This realisation came due to the fact that accounting
is capable of providing the kind of information that
managers and other interested persons need in
order to make better decisions. This aspect of
accounting gradually assumed so much importance
that it has now been raised to the level of an
information system. As an information system, it
collects data and communicates economic
information about the organisation to a wide variety
of users whose decisions and actions are related to
its per for mance. This introductory chapter
therefore, deals with the nature, need and scope of
accounting in this context.

1.1

Accountancy

Meaning of Accounting

In 1941, The American Institute of Certified Public Accountants (AICPA) had


defined accounting as the art of recording, classifying, and summarising in a
significant manner and in terms of money, transactions and events which
are, in part at least, of financial character, and interpreting the results thereof.
With greater economic development resulting in changing role of accounting,
its scope, became broader. In 1966, the American Accounting Association
(AAA) defined accounting as the process of identifying, measuring and
communicating economic information to permit informed judgments and
decisions by users of information.

Fig. 1.1 : Showing the process of accounting

In 1970, the Accounting Principles Board of AICPA also emphasised that


the function of accounting is to provide quantitative information, primarily
financial in nature, about economic entities, that is intended to be useful in
making economic decisions.
Accounting can therefore be defined as the process of identifying,
measuring, recording and communicating the required information relating
to the economic events of an organisation to the interested users of such

Introduction to Accounting

information. In order to appreciate the exact nature of accounting, we must


understand the following relevant aspects of the definition:
Economic Events
Identification, Measurement, Recording and Communication
Organisation
Interested Users of Information
Box 1
History and Development of Accounting
Accounting enjoys a remarkable heritage. The history of accounting is as old as
civilisation. The seeds of accounting were most likely first sown in Babylonia and
Egypt around 4000 B.C. who recorded transactions of payment of wages and taxes
on clay tablets. Historical evidences reveal that Egyptians used some form of
accounting for their treasuries where gold and other valuables were kept. The incharge
of treasuries had to send day wise reports to their superiors known as Wazirs (the
prime minister) and from there month wise reports were sent to kings. Babylonia,
known as the city of commerce, used accounting for business to uncover losses
taken place due to frauds and lack of efficiency. In Greece, accounting was used for
apportioning the revenues received among treasuries, maintaining total receipts,
total payments and balance of government financial transactions. Romans used
memorandum or daybook where in receipts and payments were recorded and
wherefrom they were posted to ledgers on monthly basis. (700 B.C to 400 A.D).
China used sophisticated form of government accounting as early as 2000 B.C.
Accounting practices in India could be traced back to a period when twenty three
centuries ago, Kautilya, a minister in Chandraguptas kingdom wrote a book named
Arthashasthra, which also described how accounting records had to be maintained.
Luca Paciolis, a Franciscan friar (merchant class), book Summa de
Arithmetica, Geometria, Proportion at Proportionality (Review of Arithmetic and Geometric
proportions) in Venice (1494) is considered as the first book on double entry bookkeeping. A portion of this book contains knowledge of business and book-keeping.
However, Pacioli did not claim that he was the inventor of double entry book-keeping
but spread the knowledge of it. It shows that he probably relied on thencurrent
book-keeping manuals as the basis for his masterpiece. In his book, he used the
present day popular terms of accounting Debit (Dr.) and Credit (Cr.). These were the
concepts used in Italian terminology. Debit comes from the Italian debito which comes
from the Latin debita and debeo which means owed to the proprietor. Credit comes
from the Italian credito which comes from the Latin credo which means trust or belief
(in the proprietor or owed by the proprietor. In explaining double entry system, Pacioli
wrote that All entries have to be double entries, that is if you make one creditor, you
must make some debtor. He also stated that a merchants responsibility include to
give glory to God in their enterprises, to be ethical in all business activities and to
earn a profit. He discussed the details of memorandum, journal, ledger and specialised
accounting procedures.

Accountancy

1.1.1 Economic Events


Business organisations involves economic events. An economic event is known
as a happening of consequence to a business organisation which consists of
transactions and which are measurable in monetary terms. For example,
purchase of machinery, installing and keeping it ready for manufacturing is
an event which comprises number of financial transactions such as buying a
machine, transportation of machine, site preparation for installation of a
machine, expenditure incurred on its installation and trial runs. Thus,
accounting identifies bunch of transactions relating to an economic event. If
an event involves transactions between an outsider and an organisation, these
are known as external events. The following are the examples of such
transactions:
Sale of Reebok shoes to the customers.
Rendering services to the customers by Videocon Limited.
Purchase of materials from suppliers.
Payment of monthly rent to the landlord.
An internal event is an economic event that occurs entirely between the
internal wings of an enterprise, e.g., supply of raw material or components by
the stores department to the manufacturing department, payment of wages
to the employees, etc.
1.1.2 Identification, Measurement, Recording and Communication
Identification : It means determining what transactions to record, i.e., to identity
events which are to be recorded. It involves observing activities and selecting
those events that are of considered financial character and relate to the
organisation. The business transactions and other economic events therefore
are evaluated for deciding whether it has to be recorded in books of account.
For example, the value of human resources, changes in managerial policies
or appointment of personnel are important but none of these are recorded in
books of account. However, when a company makes a sale or purchase, whether
on cash or credit, or pays salary it is recorded in the books of account.
Measurement : It means quantification (including estimates) of business
transactions into financial terms by using monetary unit, viz. rupees and
paise as a measuring unit. If an event cannot be quantified in monetary
terms, it is not considered for recording in financial accounts. That is why
important items like the appointment of a new managing director, signing of
contracts or changes in personnel are not shown in the books of accounts.
Recording : Once the economic events are identified and measured in financial
terms, these are recorded in books of account in monetary terms and in a
chronological order. Recording is done in a manner that the necessary financial

Introduction to Accounting

information is summarised as per well-established practice and is made


available as and when required.
Communication : The economic events are identified, measured and recorded
in order that the pertinent information is generated and communicated in a
certain form to management and other internal and external users. The
information is regularly communicated through accounting reports. These
reports provide information that are useful to a variety of users who have an
interest in assessing the financial performance and the position of an
enterprise, planning and controlling business activities and making necessary
decisions from time to time. The accounting information system should be
designed in such a way that the right information is communicated to the
right person at the right time. Reports can be daily, weekly, monthly, or
quarterly, depending upon the needs of the users. An important element in
the communication process is the accountants ability and efficiency in
presenting the relevant information.
1.1.3 Organisation
Organisation refers to a business enterprise, whether for profit or not-forprofit motive. Depending upon the size of activities and level of business
operation, it can be a sole-proprietory concern, partnership firm, cooperative
society, company, local authority, municipal corporation or any other
association of persons.
1.1.4 Interested Users of Information
Accounting is a means by which necessary financial information about
business enterprise is communicated and is also called the language of
business. Many users need financial information in order to make important
decisions. These users can be divided into two broad categories: internal users
and external users. Internal users include: Chief Executive, Financial Officer,
Vice President, Business Unit Managers, Plant Managers, Store Managers,
Line Supervisors, etc. External users include: present and potential Investors
(shareholders), Creditors (Banks and other Financial Institutions, Debentureholders and other Lenders), Tax Authorities, Regulatory Agencies (Department
of Company Affairs, Registrar of Companies, Securities Exchange Board of
India, Labour Unions, Trade Associations, Stock Exchange and Customers,
etc. Since the primary function of accounting is to provide useful information
for decision-making, it is a means to an end, with the end being the decision
that is helped by the availability of accounting information. You will study
about the types of accounting information and its users later in this chapter.

Accountancy
Box 2
Why do the Users Want Accounting Information?

The owners/shareholders use them to see if they are getting a satisfactory return
on their investment, and to assess the financial health of their company/business.

The directors/managers use them for making both internal and external
comparisons in their attempts to evaluate the performance. They may compare
the financial analysis of their company with the industry figures in order to
ascertain the companys strengths and weaknesses. Management is also
concerned with ensuring that the money invested in the company/organisation
is generating an adequate return and that the company/organisation is able to
pay its debts and remain solvent.

The creditors (lenders) want to know if they are likely to get paid and look
particularly at liquidity, which is the ability of the company/organisation to pay
its debts as they become due.

The prospective investors use them to assess whether or not to invest their
money in the company/organisation.

The government and regulatory agencies such as Registrar of companies, Custom


departments IRDA, RBI, etc. require information for the payment of various taxes
such as Value Added Tax (VAT), Income Tax (IT), Customs and Excise duties for
protecting the interests of investors, creditors(lenders), and also to satisfy the
legal obligations imposed by the Companies Act 1956 and SEBI from time-totime.

1.2

Accounting as a Source of Information

As discussed earlier, accounting is a definite processes of interlinked activities,


(refer figure 1.1) that begins with the identification of transactions and ends
with the preparation of financial statements. Every step in the process of
accounting generates information. Generation of information is not an end
in itself. It is a means to facilitate the dissemination of information among
different user groups. Such information enables the interested parties to
take appropriate decisions. Therefore, dissemination of information is an
essential
function of accounting. To be useful, the accounting information should
ensure to:
provide information for making economic decisions;
serve the users who rely on financial statements as their principal source
of information;
provide information useful for predicting and evaluating the amount,
timing and uncertainty of potential cash-flows;
provide information for judging managements ability to utilise resources
effectively in meeting goals;

Introduction to Accounting

provide factual and interpretative information by disclosing underlying


assumptions on matters subject to interpretation, evaluation, prediction,
or estimation; and
provide information on activities affecting the society.
Test Your Understanding - I
Complete the following sentences with appropriate words:
(a) Information in financial reports is based on ..................... transactions.
(b) Internal users are the ..................... of the business entity.
(c) A ..................... would most likely use an entities financial report to determine
whether or not the business entity is eligible for a loan.
(d) The Internet has assisted in decreasing the ..................... in issuing financial
reports to users.
(e) ..................... users are groups outside the business entity, who uses the
information to make decisions about the business entity.
(f)

Information is said to be relevent if it is ......................

(g) The process of accounting starts with ............ and ends with ............
(h) Accounting measures the business transactions in terms of ............ units.
(i)

Identified and measured economic events should be recording in ............ order.

The role of an accountant in generating accounting information is to observe,


screen and recognise events and transactions to measure and process them,
and thereby compile reports comprising accounting information that are
communicated to the users. These are then interpreted, decoded and used
by management and other user groups. It must be ensured that the information
provided is relevant, adequate and reliable for decision-making. The apparently
divergent needs of internal and external users of accounting information have
resulted in the development of sub-disciplines within the accounting discipline
namely, financial accounting, cost accounting and management accounting (refer
box 3).
Financial accounting assists keeping a systematic record of financial
transactions the preparation and presentation of financial reports in order to
arrive at a measure of organisational success and financial soundness. It
relates to the past period, serves the stewardship function and is monetary in
nature. It is primarily concerned with the provision of financial information to
all stakeholders.
Cost accounting assists in analysing the expenditure for ascertaining the
cost of various products manufactured or services provided by the firm and

Accountancy

fixation of prices thereof. It also helps in controlling the costs and providing
necessary costing information to management for decision-making.
Management accounting deals with the provision of necessary accounting
information to people within the organisation to enable them in decision-making,
planning and controlling business operations. Management accounting draws
the relevant information mainly from financial accounting and cost accounting
which helps the management in budgeting, assessing profitability, taking pricing
decisions, capital expenditure decisions and so on. Besides, it generates other
information (quantitative and qualitative, financial and non-financial) which
relates to the future and is relevant for decision-making in the organisation.
Such information includes: sales forecast, cash flows, purchase requirement,
manpower needs, environmental data about effects on air, water, land, natural
resources, flora, fauna, human health, social responsibilities, etc.
As a result, the scope of accounting has become so vast, that new areas
like human resource accounting, social accounting, responsibility accounting
have also gained prominance.
Lets Do It
Many People in todays society think of an accountant as simply a glorified bookkeeper. But the role of an accountant is continually changing. Discuss in the
classroom what really the role of accounting is?

1.2.1 Qualitative Characteristics of Accounting Information


Qualitative characteristics are the attributes of accounting information which
tend to enhance its understandability and usefulness. In order to assess
whether accounting information is decision useful, it must possess the
characteristics of reliability, relevance, understandability and comparability.
Reliability
Reliability means the users must be able to depend on the information. The
reliability of accounting information is determined by the degree of
correspondence between what the information conveys about the transactions
or events that have occurred, measured and displayed. A reliable information
should be free from error and bias and faithfully represents what it is meant
to represent. To ensure reliability, the information disclosed must be credible,
verifiable by independent parties use the same method of measuring, and be
neutral and faithful (refer figure 1.3).

Introduction to Accounting

9
Box 3
Branches of Accounting

The economic development and technological improvements have resulted in an


increase in the scale of operations and the advent of the company form of business
organisation. This has made the management function more and more complex and
increased the importance of accounting information. This gave rise to special branches
of accounting. These are briefly explained below :
Financial accounting : The purpose of this branch of accounting is to keep a record
of all financial transactions so that:
(a) the profit earned or loss sustained by the business during an accounting period
can be worked out,
(b) the financial position of the business as at the end of the accounting period
can be ascertained, and
(c)
the financial information required by the management and other interested
parties can be provided.
Cost Accounting : The purpose of cost accounting is to analyse the expenditure so
as to ascertain the cost of various products manufactured by the firm and fix the
prices. It also helps in controlling the costs and providing necessary costing
information to management for decision-making.
Management Accounting : The purpose of management accounting is to assist the
management in taking rational policy decisions and to evaluate the impact of its
decisons and actions.

Relevance
To be relevant, information must be available in time, must help in prediction
and feedback, and must influence the decisions of users by :
(a)
helping them form prediction about the outcomes of past, present or
future events; and/or
(b)
confirming or correcting their past evaluations.
Understandability
Understandability means decision-makers must interpret accounting
information in the same sense as it is prepared and conveyed to them. The
qualities that distinguish between good and bad communication in a message
are fundamental to the understandability of the message. A message is said
to be effectively communicated when it is interpreted by the receiver of the
message in the same sense in which the sender has sent. Accountants should
present the comparable information in the most intenlligible manner without
sacrificing relevance and reliability.

10

Accountancy

Comparability
It is not sufficient that the financial information is relevant and reliable at a
particular time, in a particular circumstance or for a particular reporting entity.
But it is equally important that the users of the general purpose financial reports
are able to compare various aspects of an entity over different time period and
with other entities. To be comparable, accounting reports must belong to a
common period and use common unit of measurement and format of reporting.
Test Your Understanding - II
You are a senior accountant of Ramona Enterprises Limited. What three steps would
you take to make your companys financial statements understandable and decision
useful?
1.
2.
3.
[Hint : Refer to qualitative characteristics of accounting information]

1.3

Objectives of Accounting

As an information system, the basic objective of accounting is to provide useful


information to the interested group of users, both external and internal. The
necessary information, particularly in case of external users, is provided in
the form of financial statements, viz., profit and loss account and balance
sheet. Besides these, the management is provided with additional information
from time to time from the accounting records of business. Thus, the primary
objectives of accounting include the following:
1.3.1 Maintenance of Records of Business Transactions
Accounting is used for the maintenance of a systematic record of all financial
transactions in book of accounts. Even the most brilliant executive or manager
cannot accurately remember the numerous amount of varied transactions
such as purchases, sales, receipts, payments, etc. that takes place in business
everyday. Hence, a proper and complete records of all business transactions
are kept regularly. Moreover, the recorded information enables verifiability
and acts as an evidence.
1.3.2 Calculation of Profit and Loss
The owners of business are keen to have an idea about the net results of their
business operations periodically, i.e. whether the business has earned profits

Introduction to Accounting

11

Qualitative Characteristic of Accounting Information

Decision Makers
(Users of Accounting Information)

Understandability

Decision Usefulness

Relevance

Relability

Timliness
Dedicative
Value

Feedback
Value

Verifiability

Faithfulness

Nutrality
Comparability
Fig. 1.3 : The qualitative characteristics of accounting information

or incurred losses. Thus, another objective of accounting is to ascertain the


profit earned or loss sustained by a business during an accounting period
which can be easily workout with help of record of incomes and expenses
relating to the business by preparing a profit or loss account for the period.
Profit represents excess of revenue (income), over expenses. If the total revenue
of a given period is Rs 6,00,000 and total expenses are Rs. 5,40,000 the profit
will be equal to Rs. 60,000(Rs. 6,00,000 Rs. 5,40,000). If however, the total
expenses exceed the total revenue, the difference reflects the loss.
1.3.3 Depiction of Financial Position
Accounting also aims at ascertaining the financial position of the business
concern in the form of its assets and liabilities at the end of every accounting
period. A proper record of resources owned by business organisation (Assets)

12

Accountancy

and claims against such resources (Liabilities) facilitates the preparation of a


statement known as balance sheet position statement.
1.3.4 Providing Accounting Information to its Users
The accounting information generated by the accounting process is
communicated in the form of reports, statements, graphs and charts to the
users who need it in different decision situations. As already stated, there are
two main user groups, viz. internal users, mainly management, who needs
timely information on cost of sales, profitability, etc. for planning, controlling
and decision-making and external users who have limited authority, ability
and resources to obtain the necessary information and have to rely on financial
statements (Balance Sheet, Profit and Loss account). Primarily, the external
users are interested in the following:

Investors and potential investors-information on the risks and returns


on investments;

Unions and employee groups-information on the stability, profitability


and distribution of wealth within the business;

Lenders and financial institutions-information on the creditworthiness of


the company and its ability to repay loans and pay interest;

Suppliers and creditors-information on whether amounts owed will be


repaid when due, and on the continued existence of the business;

Customers-information on the continued existence of the business and


thus the probability of a continued supply of products, parts and after
sales service;

Government and other regulators- information on the allocation of


resources and the compliance to regulations;

Social responsibility groups, such as environmental groups-information


on the impact on environment and its protection;

Competitors-information on the relative strengths and weaknesses of their


competition and for comparative and benchmarking purposes. Whereas
the above categories of users share in the wealth of the company,
competitors require the information mainly for strategic purposes.
Test Your Understanding - III
Which stakeholder g roup
_____________________________
_____________________________
_____________________________
_____________________________
_____________________________
_____________________________

Would be most interested in


(a) the VAT and other tax liabilities of the firm
(b) the potential for pay awards and bouns deals
(c) the ethical or environmental activities of the firm
(d) whether the firm has a long-term future
(e) profitability and share performance
(f) the ability of the firm to carry on providing a
service or producing a product.

Introduction to Accounting

1.4

13

Role of Accounting

For centuries, the role of accounting has been changing with the changes in
economic development and increasing societal demands. It describes and
analyses a mass of data of an enterprise through measurement, classification
and summarisation, and reduces those date into reports and statements,
which show the financial condition and results of operations of that enterprise.
Hence, it is regarded as a language of business. It also performs the service
activity by providing quantitative financial information that helps the users in
various ways. Accounting as an information system collects and communicates
economic information about an enterprise to a wide variety of interested parties.
However, accounting information relates to the past transactions and is
quantitative and financial in nature, it does not provide qualitative and nonfinancial information. These limitations of accounting must be kept in view
while making use of the accounting information.
Test Your Understanding - IV
Tick the Correct Answer
1. Which of the following is not a business transaction?
a. Bought furniture of Rs.10,000 for business
b. Paid for salaries of employees Rs.5,000
c. Paid sons fees from his personal bank account Rs.20,000
d. Paid sons fees from the business Rs.2,000
2. Deepti wants to buy a building for his business today. Which of the following is the
relevant data for his decision?
a. Similar business acquired the required building in 2000 for Rs. 10,00,000
b. Building cost details of 2003
c. Building cost details of 1998
d. Similar building cost in August, 2005 Rs. 25,00,000
3. Which is the last step of accounting as a process of information?
a. Recording of data in the books of accounts
b. Preparation of summaries in the form of financial statements
c. Communication of information
d. Analysis and interpretation of information
4. Which qualitative characteristics of accounting information is reflected when
accounting information is clearly presented?
a. Understandability
b. Relevance
c. Comparability
d. Reliability
5. Use of common unit of measurement and common format of reporting promotes;
a. Comparability
b. Understandability
c. Relevance
d. Reliability

14

Accountancy
Box 4
Different Roles of Accounting

9
9
9
9

1.5

As a language it is perceived as the language of business which is used to


communicate information on enterprises;
As a historical record- it is viewed as chronological record of financial transactions
of an organisation at actual amounts involved;
As current economic reality- it is viewed as the means of determining the true
income of an entity namely the change of wealth over time;
As an information system it is viewed as a process that links an information
source (the accountant) to a set of receivers (external users) by means of a channel
of communication;
As a commodity- specialised information is viewed as a service which is in demand
in society, with accountants being willing to and capable of providing it.

Basic Terms in Accounting

1.5.1 Entity
Entity means a thing that has a definite individual existence. Business entity
means a specifically identifiable business enterprise like Super Bazaar, Hire
Jewellers, ITC Limited, etc. An accounting system is always devised for a
specific business entity (also called accounting entity).
1.5.2 Transaction
A event involving some value between two or more entities. It can be a purchase
of goods, receipt of money, payment to a creditor, incurring expenses, etc. It
can be a cash transaction or a credit transaction.
1.5.3 Assets
Assets are economic resources of an enterprise that can be usefully expressed
in monetary terms. Assets are items of value used by the business in its
operations. For example, Super Bazar owns a fleet of trucks, which is used by
it for delivering foodstuffs; the trucks, thus, provide economic benefit to the
enterprise. This item will be shown on the asset side of the balance sheet of
Super Bazaar. Assets can be broadly classified into two types: Fixed Assets
and Current Assets.
Fixed Assets are assets held on a long-term basis, such as land, buildings,
machinery, plant, furniture and fixtures. These assets are used for the normal
operations of the business.

Introduction to Accounting

15

Current Assets are assets held on a short-ter m basis such as


debtors(accounts receivable), bills receivable (notes receivable), stock
(inventory), temporary marketable securities, cash and bank balances.
1.5.4 Liabilities
Liabilities are obligations or debts that an enterprise has to pay at some time
in the future. They represent creditors claims on the firms assets. Both small
and big businesses find it necessary to borrow money at one time or the other,
and to purchase goods on credit. Super Bazar, for example, purchases goods
for Rs. 10,000 on credit for a month from Fast Food Products on March 25,
2005. If the balance sheet of Super Bazaar is prepared as at March 31, 2005,
Fast Food Products will be shown as creditors on the liabilities side of the
balance sheet. If Super Bazaar takes a loan for a period of three years from
Delhi State Co-operative Bank, this will also be shown as a liability in the
balance sheet of Super Bazaar. Liabilities are classified as long-term liabilities
and short-term liabilities (also known as short-term liabilities).
Long-term liabilities are those that are usually payable after a period of
one year, for example, a term loan from a financial institution or debentures
(bonds) issued by a company.
Short-term liabilities are obligations that are payable within a period of one
year, for example, creditors, bills payable, bank overdraft.
1.5.5 Capital
Amount invested by the owner in the firm is known as capital. It may be
brought in the form of cash or assets by the owner for the business entity
capital is an obligation and a claim on the assets of business. It is, therefore,
shown as capital on the liabilities side of the balance sheet.
1.5.6 Sales
Sales are total revenues from goods or services sold or provided to customers.
Sales may be cash sales or credit sales.
1.5.7 Revenues
These are the amounts of the business earned by selling its products or
providing services to customers, called sales revenue. Other items of revenue
common to many businesses are: commission, interest, dividends, royalities,
rent received, etc. Revenue is also called income.

16

Accountancy

1.5.8 Expenses
Costs incurred by a business in the process of earning revenue are known as
expenses. Generally, expenses are measured by the cost of assets consumed
or services used during an accounting period. The usual items of expenses
are: depreciation, rent, wages, salaries, interest, cost of heater, light and water,
telephone, etc.
1.5.9 Expenditure
Spending money or incurring a liability for some benefit, service or property
received is called expenditure. Payment of rent, salary, purchase of goods,
purchase of machinery, purchase of furniture, etc. are examples of expenditure.
If the benefit of expenditure is exhausted within a year, it is treated as an
expense (also called revenue expenditure). On the other hand, the benefit of
an expenditure lasts for more than a year, it is treated as an asset (also called
capital expenditure) such as purchase of machinery, furniture, etc.
1.5.10 Profit
The excess of revenues of a period over its related expenses during an
accounting year profit. Profit increases the investment of the owners.
1.5.11 Gain
A profit that arises from events or transactions which are incidental to business
such as sale of fixed assets, winning a court case, appreciation in the value of
an asset.
1.5.12 Loss
The excess of expenses of a period over its related revenues its termed as loss.
It decreases in owners equity. It also refers to money or moneys worth lost
(or cost incurred) without receiving any benefit in return, e.g., cash or goods
lost by theft or a fire accident, etc. It also includes loss on sale of fixed assets.
1.5.13 Discount
Discount is the deduction in the price of the goods sold. It is offered in two
ways. Offering deduction of agreed percentage of list price at the time selling
goods is one way of giving discount. Such discount is called trade discount.
It is generally offered by manufactures to wholesellers and by wholesellers to
retailers. After selling the goods on credit basis the debtors may be given
certain deduction in amount due in case if they pay the amount within the
stipulated period or earlier. This deduction is given at the time of payment on

Introduction to Accounting

17

the amount payable. Hence, it is called as cash discount. Cash discount acts
as an incentive that encourages prompt payment by the debtors.
1.5.14 Voucher
The documentary evidence in support of a transaction is known as voucher.
For example, if we buy goods for cash, we get cash memo, if we buy on credit,
we get an invoice; when we make a payment we get a receipt and so on.
1.5.15 Goods
It refers to the products in which the business units is dealing, i.e. in terms of
which it is buying and selling or producting and selling. The items that are
purchased for use in the business are not called goods. For example, for a
furniture dealer purchase of chairs and tables is termed as goods, while for
other it is furniture and is treated as an asset. Similarly, for a stationery merchant,
stationery is goods, whereas for others it is an item of expense (not purchases)
1.5.16 Drawings
Withdrawal of money and/or goods by the owner from the business for personal
use is known as drawings. Drawings reduces the investment of the owners.
1.5.17 Purchases
Purchases are total amount of goods procured by a business on credit and on
cash, for use or sale. In a trading concern, purchases are made of merchandise
for resale with or without processing. In a manufacturing concern, raw
materials are purchased, processed further into finished goods and then sold.
Purchases may be cash purchases or credit purchases.
1.5.18 Stock
Stock (inventory) is a measure of something on hand-goods, spares and other
items in a business. It is called Stock in hand. In a trading concern, the stock
on hand is the amount of goods which are lying unsold as at the end of an
accounting period is called closing stock (ending inventory). In a manufacturing
company, closing stock comprises raw materials, semi-finished goods and
finished goods on hand on the closing date. Similarly, opening stock (beginning
inventory) is the amount of stock at the beginning of the accounting period.
1.5.19 Debtors
Debtors are persons and/or other entities who owe to an enterprise an amount
for buying goods and services on credit. The total amount standing against

18

Accountancy

such persons and/or entities on the closing date, is shown in the balance
sheet as sundry debtors on the asset side.
1.5.20 Creditors
Creditors are persons and/or other entities who have to be paid by an enterprise
an amount for providing the enterprise goods and services on credit. The total
amount standing to the favour of such persons and/or entities on the closing
date, is shown in the Balance Sheet as sundry creditors on the liabilities side.
Test Your Understanding - V
Mr. Sunrise started a business for buying and selling of stationery with Rs. 5,00,000
as an initial investment. Of which he paid Rs.1,00,000 for furniture, Rs. 2,00,000
for buying stationery items. He employed a sales person and clerk. At the end of the
month he paid Rs.5,000 as their salaries. Out of the stationery bought he sold some
stationery for Rs.1,50,000 for cash and some other stationery for Rs.1,00,000 on
credit basis to Mr.Ravi. Subsequently, he bought stationery items of Rs.1,50,000
from Mr. Peace. In the first week of next month there was a fire accident and he lost
Rs. 30,000 worth of stationery. A part of the machinery, which cost Rs. 40,000, was
sold for Rs. 45,000.
From the above, answer the following :
1. What is the amount of capital with which Mr. Sunrise started business.
2. What are the fixed assets he bought?
3. What is the value of the goods purchased?
4. Who is the creditor and state the amount payable to him?
5. What are the expenses?
6. What is the gain he earned?
7. What is the loss he incurred?
8. Who is the debtor? What is the amount receivable from him?
9. What is the total amount of expenses and losses incurred?
10. Determine if the following are assets, liabilities, revenues, expenses or none of
the these: sales, debtors, creditors, salary to manager, discount to debtors,
drawings by the owner.
Summary with Reference to Learning Objectives
1.

2.

Meaning of Accounting : Accounting is a process of identifying, measuring,


recording the business transactions and communicating thereof the required
information to the interested users.
Accounting as a source of information : Accounting as a source of information
system is the process of identifying, measuring, recording and communicating
the economic events of an organisation to interested users of the information.

Introduction to Accounting
3.

4.

5.

6.

19

Users of accounting information : Accounting plays a significant role in society


by providing information to management at all levels and to those having a
direct financial interest in the enterprise, such as present and potential
investors and creditors. Accounting information is also important to those
having indirect financial interest, such as regulatory agencies, tax authorities,
customers, labour unions, trade associations, stock exchanges and others.
Qualitative characteristics of Accounting : To make accounting information
decision useful, it should possess the following qualitative characteristics.
Reliability
Understandability
Relevance
Comparability
Objective of accounting : The primary objectives of accounting are to :

maintain records of business;

calculate profit or loss;

depict the financial position; and

make information available to various groups and users.


Role of accounting : Accounting is not an end in itself. It is a means to an end.
It plays the role of a :

Language of a business

Historical record

Current economic reality

Information system

Service to users
Questions for Practice

Short Answers
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.

14.

Define accounting.
State what is end product of financial accounting.
Enumerate main objectives of accounting.
List any five users who have indirect interest in accounting.
State the nature of accounting information required by long-term lenders.
Who are the external users of information?
Enumerate informational needs of management.
Give any three examples of revenues.
Distinguish between debtors and creditors.
Accounting information should be comparable. Do you agree with this
statement. Give two reasons.
If the accounting information is not clearly presented, which of the qualitative
characteristic of the accounting information is violated?
The role of accounting has changed over the period of time- Do you agree?
Explain.
Giving examples, explain each of the following accounting terms :
Fixed assets
Gain
Profit
Revenue
Expenses
Short-term liability
Capital
How will you define revenues and expenses?

20

Accountancy
15. What is the primiary reason for the business students and others to
familiarise themselves with the accounting discipline?
Long Answers
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.

Explain the factors, which necessitated systematic accounting.


Describe the brief history of accounting.
Explain the development of and role of accounting.
Define accounting and state its objectives.
Describe the informational needs of external users.
What do you mean by an asset and what are different types of assets?
Explain the meaning of gain and profit. Distinguish between these two terms.
Explain the qualitative characteristics of accounting information.
Describe the role of accounting in the modern world.
Checklist to Test Your Understanding

Test Your Understanding I


(a)
(d)
(g)
(h)

Economic
(b) Management/Employees (c) Creditor
Time-gap
(e) External
(f) Free from bias
Identifying the transactions and communicating information
Monetory
(i) Chronological

Test Your Understanding - II


1.
2.
3.

Reliability, i.e. Verifiability, Faithfulness, Nutrality


Relevance, i.e. Timeliness
Understandability and Comparibility

Test Your Understanding - III


(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)

Government and other regulators


Management
Social responsibility groups
Lenders
Suppliers and Creditors
Customers

Test Your Understanding - IV


1. (c)

2. (c)

3. (a)

4. (a)

5. (b)

6. (c)

7. (a)

8. (a)

9. (d)

Test Your Understanding - V


1.
4.
7.
10.

Rs. 5,00,000
2. Rs. 1,00,000,
3. Rs. 2,00,000
Mr. Reace, Rs. 1,50,000 5. Rs. 5,000
6. Rs. 5,000
Rs. 30,000
8. Mr. Ravi, Rs. 1,00,000 9. Rs. 35,000
Assets : debtors; Liabilities : creditors; drawings; Revenues : sales expenses,
discount, salary.

Introduction to Accounting

21
Lets Do It

Accountants today can work in exciting new growth areas such as forensic
accounting, budget accounting, cost accounting, environmental accounting,
e-commerce and the various agencies within the public sector.The advent of
information technology have resulted inthe development of necessary skills
for todays accountant include the ability to:
Develop competence in systems analysis and computer technology;
Develop facilitation skills, such as persuasion and communication
skills;
Acquire a broad business knowledge in strategy, operations, human
resources, marketing, finance and economics;
Develop analytical skills;
Develop a willingness to embrace change and assume risk;
Complete an internship in business and/or public accounting;
Develop proficiency in accounting and tax issues.

Theory Base of Accounting

LEARNING OBJECTIVES
After studying this chapter,
you will be able to:

identify the need for


theory base of accounting;

explain the nature of


Generally Accepted
Accounting Principles
(GAAP);

describe the meaning


and purpose of the basic
accounting concepts;

enumerate the accounting


standards issued by
Institute of Chartered
Accountants of India;

describe the systems


of accounting; and

describe various basis


of accounting.

s discussed in the previous chapter, accounting


is concerned with the recording, classifying and
summarising of financial transactions and events
and interpreting the results thereof. It aims at
providing information about the financial
performance of a firm to its various users such as
owners, managers employees, investors, creditors,
suppliers of goods and services and tax authorities
and help them in taking important decisions. The
investors, for example, may be interested in
knowing the extent of profit or loss earned by the
firm during a given period and compare it with the
performance of other similar enterprises. The
suppliers of credit, say a banker, may, in addition,
be interested in liquidity position of the enterprise.
All these people look forward to accounting for
appropriate, useful and reliable information.
For making the accounting information
meaningful to its internal and external users, it is
important that such information is reliable as well
as comparable. The comparability of information is
required both to make inter-firm comparisons, i.e.
to see how a firm has performed as compared to
the other firms, as well as to make inter-period
comparison, i.e. how it has performed as compared
to the previous years. This becomes possible only
if the information provided by the financial
statements is based on consistent accounting
policies, principles and practices. Such consistency
is required throughout the process of identifying

Theory base of Accounting

2 3

the events and transactions to be accounted for, measuring them,


communicating them in the book of accounts, summarising the results thereof
and reporting them to the interested parties. This calls for developing a proper
theory base of accounting.
The importance of accounting theory need not be over-emphasised as no
discipline can develop without a sound theoretical base. The theory base of
accounting consists of principles, concepts, rules and guidelines developed
over a period of time to bring uniformity and consistency to the process of
accounting and enhance its utility to different users of accounting information.
Apart from these, the Institute of Chartered Accountants of India, (ICAI), which
is the regulatory body for standardisation of accounting policies in the country
has issued Accounting Standards which are expected to be uniformly adhered
to, in order to bring consistency in the accounting practices. These are
discussed in the sections to follow.
2.1

Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP)

In order to maintain uniformity and consistency in accounting records, certain


rules or principles have been developed which are generally accepted by the
accounting profession. These rules are called by different names such as
principles, concepts, conventions, postulates, assumptions and modifying
principles.
The term principle has been defined by AICPA as A general law or rule
adopted or professed as a guide to action, a settled ground or basis of conduct
or practice. The word generally means in a general manner, i.e. pertaining
to many persons or cases or occasions. Thus, Generally Accepted Accounting
Principles (GAAP) refers to the rules or guidelines adopted for recording and
reporting of business transactions, in order to bring uniformity in the
preparation and the presentation of financial statements. For example, one of
the important rule is to record all transactions on the basis of historical cost,
which is verifiable from the documents such as cash receipt for the money
paid. This brings in objectivity in the process of recording and makes the
accounting statements more acceptable to various users.
The Generally Accepted Accounting Principles have evolved over a long
period of time on the basis of past experiences, usages or customs, statements
by individuals and professional bodies and regulations by government agencies
and have general acceptability among most accounting professionals. However,
the principles of accounting are not static in nature. These are constantly
influenced by changes in the legal, social and economic environment as well
as the needs of the users.

2 4

Accountancy

These principles are also referred as concepts and conventions. The term
concept refers to the necessary assumptions and ideas which are fundamental
to accounting practice, and the term convention connotes customs or traditions
as a guide to the preparation of accounting statements. In practice, the same
rules or guidelines have been described by one author as a concept, by another
as a postulate and still by another as convention. This at times becomes
confusing to the learners. Instead of going into the semantics of these terms,
it is important to concentrate on the practicability of their usage. From the
practicability view point, it is observed that the various terms such as
principles, postulates, conventions, modifying principles, assumptions, etc.
have been used inter-changeably and are referred to as Basic Accounting
Concepts in the present chapter.
2.2

Basic Accounting Concepts

The basic accounting concepts are referred to as the fundamental ideas or


basic assumptions underlying the theory and practice of financial accounting
and are broad working rules for all accounting activities and developed by the
accounting profession. The important concepts have been listed as below:

Business entity;
Money measurement;
Going concern;
Accounting period;
Cost
Dual aspect (or Duality);

Revenue recognition (Realisation);


Matching;
Full disclosure;
Consistency;
Conservatism (Prudence);
Materiality;
Objectivity.

2.2.1 Business Entity Concept


The concept of business entity assumes that business has a distinct and
separate entity from its owners. It means that for the purposes of accounting,
the business and its owners are to be treated as two separate entities. Keeping
this in view, when a person brings in some money as capital into his business,
in accounting records, it is treated as liability of the business to the owner.
Here, one separate entity (owner) is assumed to be giving money to another
distinct entity (business unit). Similarly, when the owner withdraws any money
from the business for his personal expenses(drawings), it is treated as reduction
of the owners capital and consequently a reduction in the liabilities of the
business.
The accounting records are made in the book of accounts from the point of
view of the business unit and not that of the owner. The personal assets and

Theory base of Accounting

2 5

liabilities of the owner are, therefore, not considered while recording and
reporting the assets and liabilities of the business. Similarly, personal
transactions of the owner are not recorded in the books of the business, unless
it involves inflow or outflow of business funds.
2.2.2 Money Measurement Concept
The concept of money measurement states that only those transactions and
happenings in an organisation which can be expressed in terms of money
such as sale of goods or payment of expenses or receipt of income, etc. are to
be recorded in the book of accounts. All such transactions or happenings
which can not be expressed in monetary terms, for example, the appointment
of a manager, capabilities of its human resources or creativity of its research
department or image of the organisation among people in general do not find
a place in the accounting records of a firm.
Another important aspect of the concept of money measurement is that
the records of the transactions are to be kept not in the physical units but in
the monetary unit. For example, an organisation may, on a particular day,
have a factory on a piece of land measuring 2 acres, office building containing
10 rooms, 30 personal computers, 30 office chairs and tables, a bank balance
of Rs.5 lakh, raw material weighing 20-tons, and 100 cartons of finished goods.
These assets are expressed in different units, so can not be added to give any
meaningful information about the total worth of business. For accounting
purposes, therefore, these are shown in money terms and recorded in rupees
and paise. In this case, the cost of factory land may be say Rs. 2 crore; office
building Rs. 1 crore; computers Rs.15 lakh; office chairs and tables Rs. 2
lakh; raw material Rs. 33 lakh and finished goods Rs. 4 lakh. Thus, the total
assets of the enterprise are valued at Rs. 3 crore and 59 lakh. Similarly, all
transactions are recorded in rupees and paise as and when they take place.
The money measurement assumption is not free from limitations. Due to
the changes in prices, the value of money does not remain the same over a
period of time. The value of rupee today on account of rise in prices is much
less than what it was, say ten years back. Therefore, in the balance sheet,
when we add different assets bought at different points of time, say building
purchased in 1995 for Rs. 2 crore, and plant purchased in 2005 for Rs. 1
crore, we are in fact adding heterogeneous values, which can not be clubbed
together. As the change in the value of money is not reflected in the book of
accounts, the accounting data does not reflect the true and fair view of the
affairs of an enterprise.

2 6

Accountancy

2.2.3 Going Concern Concept


The concept of going concern assumes that a business firm would continue to
carry out its operations indefinitely, i.e. for a fairly long period of time and
would not be liquidated in the foreseeable future. This is an important
assumption of accounting as it provides the very basis for showing the value
of assets in the balance sheet.
An asset may be defined as a bundle of services. When we purchase an
asset, for example, a personal computer, for a sum of Rs. 50,000, what we are
buying really is the services of the computer that we shall be getting over its
estimated life span, say 5 years. It will not be fair to charge the whole amount
of Rs. 50,000, from the revenue of the year in which the asset is purchased.
Instead, that part of the asset which has been consumed or used during a
period should be charged from the revenue of that period. The assumption
regarding continuity of business allows us to charge from the revenues of a
period only that part of the asset which has been consumed or used to earn
that revenue in that period and carry forward the remaining amount to the
next years, over the estimated life of the asset. Thus, we may charge
Rs. 10,000 every year for 5 years from the profit and loss account. In case the
continuity assumption is not there, the whole cost (Rs. 50,000 in the present
example) will need to be charged from the revenue of the year in which the
asset was purchased.
2.2.4 Accounting Period Concept
Accounting period refers to the span of time at the end of which the financial
statements of an enterprise are prepared, to know whether it has earned profits or
incurred losses during that period and what exactly is the position of its assets and
liabilities at the end of that period. Such information is required by different users
at regular interval for various purposes, as no firm can wait for long to know its
financial results as various decisions are to be taken at regular intervals on the
basis of such information. The financial statements are, therefore, prepared at
regular interval, normally after a period of one year, so that timely information is
made available to the users. This interval of time is called accounting period.
The Companies Act 1956 and the Income Tax Act require that the income
statements should be prepared annually. However, in case of certain
situations, preparation of interim financial statements become necessary.
For example, at the time of retirement of a partner, the accounting period
can be different from twelve months period. Apart from these companies
whose shares are listed on the stock exchange, are required to publish
quarterly results to ascertain the profitability and financial position at the
end of every three months period.

Theory base of Accounting

2 7
Test Your Understanding - I

Choose the Correct Answer


1. During the life-time of an entity accounting produce financial statements in
accordance with which basic accounting concept:
(a) Conservation
(b) Matching
(c)
Accounting period
(d) None of the above
2. When information about two different enterprises have been prepared presented
in a similar manner the information exhibits the characteristic of:
(a) Verifiability
(b) Relevance
(c)
Reliability
(d) None of the above
3. A concept that a business enterprise will not be sold or liquidated in the near
future is known as :
(a) Going concern
(b) Economic entity
(c)
Monetary unit
(d) None of the above
4. The primary qualities that make accounting information useful for decision-making
are :
(a) Relevance and freedom from bias
(b) Reliability and comparability
(c)
Comparability and consistency
(d) None of the above

2.2.5 Cost Concept


The cost concept requires that all assets are recorded in the book of accounts
at their purchase price, which includes cost of acquisition, transportation,
installation and making the asset ready to use. To illustrate, on June 2005,
an old plant was purchased for Rs. 50 lakh by Shiva Enterprise, which is into
the business of manufacturing detergent powder. An amount of
Rs. 10,000 was spent on transporting the plant to the factory site. In addition,
Rs. 15,000 was spent on repairs for bringing the plant into running position
and Rs. 25,000 on its installation. The total amount at which the plant will be
recorded in the books of account would be the sum of all these, i.e.
Rs. 50,50,000.
The concept of cost is historical in nature as it is something, which has
been paid on the date of acquisition and does not change year after year. For
example, if a building has been purchased by a firm for Rs. 2.5 crore, the

2 8

Accountancy

purchase price will remain the same for all years to come, though its market
value may change. Adoption of historical cost brings in objectivity in recording
as the cost of acquisition is easily verifiable from the purchase documents.
The market value basis, on the other hand, is not reliable as the value of an
asset may change from time to time, making the comparisons between one
period to another rather difficult.
However, an important limitation of the historical cost basis is that it does
not show the true worth of the business and may lead to hidden profits. During
the period of rising prices, the market value or the cost at (which the assets
can be replaced are higher than the value at which these are shown in the
book of accounts) leading to hidden profits.
2.2.6 Dual Aspect Concept
Dual aspect is the foundation or basic principle of accounting. It provides the
very basis for recording business transactions into the book of accounts. This
concept states that every transaction has a dual or two-fold effect and should
therefore be recorded at two places. In other words, at least two accounts will
be involved in recording a transaction. This can be explained with the help of
an example. Ram started business by investing in a sum of Rs. 50,00,000 The
amount of money brought in by Ram will result in an increase in the assets
(cash) of business by Rs. 50,00,000. At the same time, the owners equity or
capital will also increase by an equal amount. It may be seen that the two
items that got affected by this transaction are cash and capital account.
Let us take another example to understand this point further. Suppose
the firm purchase goods worth Rs. 10,00,000 on cash. This will increase an
asset (stock of goods) on the one hand and reduce another asset (cash) on the
other. Similarly, if the firm purchases a machine worth Rs. 30,00,000 on
credit from Reliable Industries. This will increase an asset (machinery) on the
one hand and a liability (creditor) on the other. This type of dual effect takes
place in case of all business transactions and is also known as duality principle.
The duality principle is commonly expressed in terms of fundamental
Accounting Equation, which is as follows :
Assets = Liabilities + Capital

In other words, the equation states that the assets of a business are always
equal to the claims of owners and the outsiders. The claims also called equity
of owners is termed as Capital(owners equity) and that of outsiders, as

Theory base of Accounting

2 9

Liabilities(creditors equity). The two-fold effect of each transaction affects in


such a manner that the equality of both sides of equation is maintained.
The two-fold effect in respect of all transactions must be duly recorded in
the book of accounts of the business. In fact, this concept forms the core of
Double Entry System of accounting, which has been dealt in detail, in
chapter 3.
2.2.7 Revenue Recognition (Realisation) Concept
The concept of revenue recognition requires that the revenue for a business
transaction should be included in the accounting records only when it is
realised. Here arises two questions in mind. First, is termed as revenue and
the other, when the revenue is realised. Let us take the first one first. Revenue
is the gross inflow of cash arising from (i) the sale of goods and services by an
enterprise; and (ii) use by others of the enterprises resources yielding interest,
royalties and dividends. Secondly, revenue is assumed to be realised when a
legal right to receive it arises, i.e. the point of time when goods have been sold
or service has been rendered. Thus, credit sales are treated as revenue on the
day sales are made and not when money is received from the buyer. As for the
income such as rent, commission, interest, etc. these are recongnised on a
time basis. For example, rent for the month of March 2005, even if received in
April 2005, will be taken into the profit and loss account of the financial year
ending March 31, 2005 and not into financial year beginning with April 2005.
Similarly, if interest for April 2005 is received in advance in March 2005, it
will be taken to the profit and loss account of the financial year ending
March 2006.
There are some exceptions to this general rule of revenue recognition. In
case of contracts like construction work, which take long time, say 2-3 years
to complete, proportionate amount of revenue, based on the part of contract
completed by the end of the period is treated as realised. Similarly, when
goods are sold on hire purchase, the amount collected in installments is treated
as realised.
2.2.8 Matching Concept
The process of ascertaining the amount of profit earned or the loss incurred
during a particular period involves deduction of related expenses from the
revenue earned during that period. The matching concept emphasises exactly
on this aspect. It states that expenses incurred in an accounting period should
be matched with revenues during that period. It follows from this that the

3 0

Accountancy

revenue and expenses incurred to earn these revenues must belong to the
same accounting period.
As already stated, revenue is recognised when a sale is complete or service
is rendered rather when cash is received. Similarly, an expense is recognised
not when cash is paid but when an asset or service has been used to generate
revenue. For example, expenses such as salaries, rent, insurance are
recognised on the basis of period to which they relate and not when these are
paid. Similarly, costs like depreciation of fixed asset is divided over the periods
during which the asset is used.
Let us also understand how cost of goods are matched with their sales
revenue. While ascertaining the profit or loss of an accounting year, we should
not take the cost of all the goods produced or purchased during that period
but consider only the cost of goods that have been sold during that year. For
this purpose, the cost of unsold goods should be deducted from the cost of
the goods produced or purchased. You will learn about this aspect in detail in
the chapter on financial statement.
The matching concept, thus, implies that all revenues earned during an
accounting year, whether received during that year, or not and all costs
incurred, whether paid during the year, or not should be taken into account
while ascertaining profit or loss for that year.
2.2.9 Full Disclosure Concept
Information provided by financial statements are used by different groups of
people such as investors, lenders, suppliers and others in taking various
financial decisions. In the corporate form of organisation, there is a distinction
between those managing the affairs of the enterprise and those owning it.
Financial statements, however, are the only or basic means of communicating
financial information to all interested parties. It becomes all the more important,
therefore, that the financial statements makes a full, fair and adequate
disclosure of all information which is relevant for taking financial decisions.
The principle of full disclosure requires that all material and relevant facts
concerning financial performance of an enterprise must be fully and completely
disclosed in the financial statements and their accompanying footnotes. This
is to enable the users to make correct assessment about the profitability and
financial soundness of the enterprise and help them to take informed decisions.
To ensure proper disclosure of material accounting information, the Indian
Companies Act 1956 has provided a format for the preparation of profit and
loss account and balance sheet of a company, which needs to be compulsorily
adhered to, for the preparation of these statements. The regulatory bodies

Theory base of Accounting

3 1

like SEBI, also mandates complete disclosures to be made by the companies,


to give a true and fair view of profitability and the state of affairs.
2.2.10 Consistency Concept
The accounting information provided by the financial statements would be
useful in drawing conclusions regarding the working of an enterprise only
when it allows comparisons over a period of time as well as with the working
of other enterprises. Thus, both inter-firm and inter-period comparisons are
required to be made. This can be possible only when accounting policies and
practices followed by enterprises are uniform and are consistent over the
period of time.
To illustrate, an investor wants to know the financial performance of an
enterprise in the current year as compared to that in the previous year. He
may compare this years net profit with that in the last year. But, if the
accounting policies adopted, say with respect to depreciation in the two years
are different, the profit figures will not be comparable. Because the method
adopted for the valuation of stock in the past two years is inconsistent. It is,
therefore, important that the concept of consistency is followed in preparation
of financial statements so that the results of two accounting periods are
comparable. Consistency eliminates personal bias and helps in achieving
results that are comparable.
Also the comparison between the financial results of two enterprises would
be meaningful only if same kind of accounting methods and policies are adopted
in the preparation of financial statements.
However, consistency does not prohibit change in accounting policies.
Necessary required changes are fully disclosed by presenting them in the
financial statements indicating their probable effects on the financial results
of business.
2.2.11 Conservatism Concept
The concept of conservatism (also called prudence) provides guidance for
recording transactions in the book of accounts and is based on the policy of
playing safe. The concept states that a conscious approach should be adopted
in ascertaining income so that profits of the enterprise are not overstated. If the
profits ascertained are more than the actual, it may lead to distribution of
dividend out of capital, which is not fair as it will lead to reduction in the capital
of the enterprise.
The concept of conservatism requires that profits should not to be recorded
until realised but all losses, even those which may have a remote possibility,

3 2

Accountancy

are to be provided for in the books of account. To illustrate, valuing closing


stock at cost or market value whichever is lower; creating provision for doubtful
debts, discount on debtors; writing of intangible assets like goodwill, patents,
etc. from the book of accounts are some of the examples of the application of
the principle of conservatism. Thus, if market value of the goods purchased
has fallen down, the stock will be shown at cost price in the books but if the
market value has gone up, the gain is not to be recorded until the stock is
sold. This approach of providing for the losses but not recognising the gains
until realised is called conservatism approach. This may be reflecting a
generally pessimist attitude adopted by the accountants but is an important
way of dealing with uncertainty and protecting the interests of creditors against
an unwanted distribution of firms assets. However, deliberate attempt to
underestimate the value of assets should be discouraged as it will lead to
hidden profits, called secret reserves.
2.2.12

Materiality Concept

The concept of materiality requires that accounting should focus on material


facts. Efforts should not be wasted in recording and presenting facts, which
are immaterial in the determination of income. The question that arises here
is what is a material fact. The materiality of a fact depends on its nature and
the amount involved. Any fact would be considered as material if it is reasonably
believed that its knowledge would influence the decision of informed user of
financial statements. For example, money spent on creation of additional
capacity of a theatre would be a material fact as it is going to increase the
future earning capacity of the enterprise. Similarly, information about any
change in the method of depreciation adopted or any liability which is likely to
arise in the near future would be significant information. All such information
about material facts should be disclosed through the financial statements
and the accompanying notes so that users can take informed decisions. In
certain cases, when the amount involved is very small, strict adherence to
accounting principles is not required. For example, stock of erasers, pencils,
scales, etc. are not shown as assets, whatever amount of stationery is bought
in an accounting period is treated as the expense of that period, whether
consumed or not. The amount spent is treated as revenue expenditure and
taken to the profit and loss account of the year in which the expenditure
is incurred.
2.2.13 Objectivity Concept
The concept of objectivity requires that accounting transaction should be
recorded in an objective manner, free from the bias of accountants and others.

Theory base of Accounting

3 3

This can be possible when each of the transaction is supported by verifiable


documents or vouchers. For example, the transaction for the purchase of
materials may be supported by the cash receipt for the money paid, if the
same is purchased on cash or copy of invoice and delivery challan, if the same
is purchased on credit. Similarly, receipt for the amount paid for purchase of
a machine becomes the documentary evidence for the cost of machine and
provides an objective basis for verifying this transaction. One of the reasons
for the adoption of Historical Cost as the basis of recording accounting
transaction is that adherence to the principle of objectivity is made possible
by it. As stated above, the cost actually paid for an asset can be verified from
the documents but it is very difficult to ascertain the market value of an asset
until it is actually sold. Not only that, the market value may vary from person
to person and from place to place, and so objectivity cannot be maintained if
such value is adopted for accounting purposes.
Test Your Understanding - II
Fill in the correct word:
1. Recognition of expenses in the same period as associated revenues is called
_______________concept.
2. The accounting concept that refers to the tendency of accountants to resolve
uncertainty and doubt in favour of understating assets and revenues and
overstating liabilities and expenses is known as _______________.
3. Revenue is generally recongnised at the point of sale denotes the concept
of _______________.
4. The _______________concept requires that the same accounting method should
be used from one accounting period to the next.
5. The_______________concept requires that accounting transaction should be free
from the bias of accountants and others.

2.3

Systems of Accounting

The systems of recording transactions in the book of accounts are generally


classified into two types, viz. Double entry system and Single entry system.
Double entry system is based on the principle of Dual Aspect which states
that every transaction has two effects, viz. receiving of a benefit and giving of
a benefit. Each transaction, therefore, involves two or more accounts and is
recorded at different places in the ledger. The basic principle followed is that
every debit must have a corresponding credit. Thus, one account is debited
and the other is credited.
Double entry system is a complete system as both the aspects of a transaction
are recorded in the book of accounts. The system is accurate and

3 4

Accountancy

more reliable as the possibilities of frauds and mis-appropriations are minimised.


The arithmetic inaccuracies in records can mostly be checked by preparing the
trial balance. The system of double entry can be implemented by big as well as
small organisations.
Single entry system is not a complete system of maintaining records of
financial transactions. It does not record two-fold effect of each and every
transaction. Instead of maintaining all the accounts, only personal accounts
and cash book are maintained under this system. In fact, this is not a system
but a lack of system as no uniformity is maintained in the recording of
transactions. For some transactions, only one aspect is recorded, for others,
both the aspects are recorded. The accounts maintained under this system
are incomplete and unsystematic and therefore, not reliable. The system is,
however, followed by small business firms as it is very simple and flexible (you
will study about them in detail later in this book).
2.4

Basis of Accounting

From the point of view the timing of recognition of revenue and costs, there
can be two broad approaches to accounting. These are:
(i) Cash basis; and
(ii) Accrual basis.
Under the cash basis, entries in the book of accounts are made when cash is
received or paid and not when the receipt or payment becomes due. Let us say,
for example, if office rent for the month of December 2005, is paid in January
2006, it would be recorded in the book of account only in January 2006.
Similarly sale of goods on credit in the month of January 2006 would not
be recorded in January but say in April, when the payment for the same is
received. Thus this system is incompatible with the matching principle, which
states that the revenue of a period is matched with the cost of the same period.
Though simple, this method is inappropriate for most organisations as profit
is calculated as a difference between the receipts and disbursement of money
for the given period rather than on happening of the transactions.
Under the accrual basis, however, revenues and costs are recognised in
the period in which they occur rather when they are paid. A distinction is
made between the receipt of cash and the right to receive cash and payment
of cash and legal obligation to pay cash. Thus, under this system, the monitory
effect of a transaction is taken into account in the period in which they are
earned rather than in the period in which cash is actually received or paid by
the enterprise. This is a more appropriate basis for the calculation of profits
as expenses are matched against revenue earned in relation thereto. For
example, raw material consumed are matched against the cost of goods sold.

Theory base of Accounting

2.5

3 5

Accounting Standards

As discussed in the preceding section, the Generally Accepted Accounting


Principles in the form of Basic Accounting Concept have been accepted by the
accounting profession to achieve uniformity and comparability in the financial
statement. This is aimed at increasing the utility of these statement to various
users of the accounting information. But the difficulty is that GAAP permit a
variety of alternative treatments for the same item. For example, various
methods of calculation of cost of inventory are permissible which may be
followed by different enterprises. This may cause problem to the external
users of information, which becomes inconsistent and incomparable. This
necessitates brining in uniformity and consistency in the reporting of
accounting information.
Recognising this need, the Institute of Charted Accountants of India (ICAI)
constituted an Accounting Standards Board (ASB) in April, 1977 for developing
Accounting Standards. The main function of ASB is to identify areas in which
uniformity in standards is required and develop draft standards after wide
discussion with representative of the Government, public sector undertakings,
industry and other organisations. ASB gives due consideration to the
International Accounting Standards as India is a member of International
Account Setting Body. ASB submits the draft of the standards to the Council
of the ICAI, which finalises them and notifies them for use in the presentation
of the financial statements. ASB also makes a periodic review of the accounting
standards.
Accounting standards are written statements of uniform accounting rules
and guidelines or practices for preparing the uniform and consistent financial
statements and for other disclosures affecting the user of accounting
information. However, the accounting standards cannot override the provision
of applicable laws, customs, usages and business environment in the country.
The Institute tries to persuade the accounting profession for adopting the
accounting standards, so that uniformity can be achieved in the presentation
of financial statements. In the initial years the standards are of recommendatory
in nature. Once an awareness is created about the requirements of a standard,
steps are taken to enforce its compliance by making them mandatory for all
companies to comply with. In case of non-compliance, the companies are
required to disclose the reasons for deviations and the financial effect, if any,
arising due to such deviation.
The list of accounting standards is given in the appendix to this chapter.

3 6

Accountancy
Key Terms Introduced in the Chapter

Cost
Matching
Materiality
Objectivity
Consistency
Dual aspect
Conservatism(Prudence)
Going concern
Comparibility

Full discloser
Generally accepted
Revenue Relisation
Operating guidelines
Accounting period
Money measurement
Accounting concept
Accounting Principles (GAAP)

Summary with Reference to Learning Objectives


1. Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (GAAP) : Generally Accepted
Accounting principles refer to the rules or guidelines adopted for recording
and reporting of business transactions in order to bring uniformity in the
preparation and presentation of financial statements. These principles are
also referred to as concepts and conventions. From the practicality view point,
the various terms such as principles, postulates, conventions modifying
principles, assumptions, etc. have been used interchangeably and are referred
to as basic accounting concepts, in the present book.
2. Basic Accounting Concepts : The basic accounting concepts are referred to as
the fundamental ideas or basic assumptions underlying the theory and practice
of financial accounting and are broad working rules of accounting activities.
3. Business Entity : This concept assumes that business has distinct and
separate entity from its owners. Thus, for the purpose of accounting, business
and its owners are to be treated as two separate entities.
4. Money Measurement : The concept of money measurement states that only those
transactions and happenings in an organisation, which can be expressed in terms
of money are to be recorded in the book of accounts. Also, the records of the
transactions are to be kept not in the physical units but in the monetary units.
5. Going Concern : The concept of going concern assumes that a business firm
would continue to carry out its operations indefinitely (for a fairly long period
of time) and would not be liquidated in the near future.
6. Accounting Period : Accounting period refers to the span of time at the end of
which the financial statements of an enterprise are prepared to know whether
it has earned profits or incurred losses during that period and what exactly
is the position of its assets and liabilities, at the end of that period.
7. Cost Concept : The cost concept requires that all assets are recorded in the
book of accounts at their cost price, which includes cost of acquisition,
transportation, installation and making the asset ready for the use.
8. Dual Aspect : This concept states that every transaction has a dual or twofold effect on various accounts and should therefore be recorded at two places.
The duality principle is commonly expressed in terms of fundamental
accounting equation, which is :
Assets = Liabilities + Capital

Theory base of Accounting

3 7

9. Revenue Recognition : Revenue is the gross in-flow of cash arising from the
sale of goods and services by an enterprise and use by others of the enterprise
resources yielding interest royalities and divididends. The concept of revenue
recognition requires that the revenue for a business transaction should be
considered realised when a legal right to receive it arises.
10. Matching : The concept of matching emphasises that expenses incurred in
an accounting period should be matched with revenues during that period.
It follows from this that the revenue and expenses incurred to earn these
revenue must belong to the same accounting period.
11. Full Disclosure : This concept requires that all material and relevant facts
concerning financial performance of an enterprise must be fully and completely
disclosed in the financial statements and their accompanying footnotes.
12. Consistency : This concepts states that accounting policies and practices
followed by enterprises should be uniform and consistent one the period of
time so that results are composable. Comparability results when the same
accounting principles are consistently being applied by different enterprises
for the period under comparison, or the same firm for a number of periods.
13. Conservatism : This concept requires that business transactions should be
recorded in such a manner that profits are not overstated. All anticipated
losses should be accounted for but all unrealised gains should be ignored.
14. Materiality : This concept states that accounting should focus on material
facts. If the item is likely to influence the decision of a reasonably prudent
investor or creditor, it should be regarded as material, and shown in the
financial statements.
15. Objectivity : According to this concept, accounting transactions should be
recorded in the manner so that it is free from the bias of accountants and
others.
16. Systems of Accounting : There are two systems of recording business
transactions, viz. double entry system and single entry system. Under double
entry system every transaction has two-fold effects where as single entry
system is known as incomplete records.
17. Basis of Accounting : The two broad approach of accounting are cash basis
and accrual basis. Under cash basis transactions are recorded only when
cash are received or paid. Whereas under accrual basis, revenues or costs
are recognises when they occur rather than when they are paid.
18. Accounting Standards : Accounting standards are written statements of
uniform accounting rules and guidelines in practice for preparing the uniform
and consistent financial statements. These standards cannot over ride the
provisions of applicable laws, customs, usages and business environment in
the country.
Questions for Practice
Short Answers
1.
2.

Why is it necessary for accountants to assume that business entity will remain
a going concern?
When should revenue be recognised? Are there exceptions to the general rule?

3 8

Accountancy
3.
4.

5.

What is the basic accounting equation?


The realisation concept determines when goods sent on credit to customers
are to be included in the sales figure for the purpose of computing the profit
or loss for the accounting period. Which of the following tends to be used in
practice to determine when to include a transaction in the sales figure for
the period. When the goods have been:
a. dispatched
b. invoiced
c. delivered
d. paid for
Give reasons for your answer.
Complete the following work sheet:
(i)
If a firm believes that some of its debtors may default, it should act on
this by making sure that all possible losses are recorded in the books.
This is an example of the ___________ concept.
(ii) The fact that a business is separate and distinguishable from its owner
is best exemplified by the ___________ concept.
(iii) Everything a firm owns, it also owns out to somebody. This co-incidence
is explained by the ___________ concept.
(iv) The ___________ concept states that if straight line method of depreciation
is used in one year, then it should also be used in the next year.
(v) A firm may hold stock which is heavily in demand. Consequently, the
market value of this stock may be increased. Normal accounting
procedure is to ignore this because of the ___________.
(vi) If a firm receives an order for goods, it would not be included in the
sales figure owing to the ___________.
(vii) The management of a firm is remarkably incompetent, but the firms
accountants can not take this into account while preparing book of
accounts because of ___________ concept.

Long Answers
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.

The accounting concepts and accounting standards are generally referred


to as the essence of financial accounting. Comment.
Why is it important to adopt a consistent basis for the preparation of financial
statements? Explain.
Discuss the concept-based on the premise do not anticipate profits but
provide for all losses.
What is matching concept? Why should a business concern follow this
concept? Discuss.
What is the money measurement concept? Which one factor can make it
difficult to compare the monetary values of one year with the monetary values
of another year?

Theory base of Accounting

3 9
Project Work

Activity 1
Ruchicas father is the sole proprietor of Friends Gifts, a firm engaged in the sale
of gift items. In the process of preparing financial statements, the accountant of
the firm Mr. Goyal fell ill and had to proceed on leave. Ruchicas father was urgently
in need of the statements as these had to be submitted to the bank, in pursuance
of a loan of Rs. 5 lakh applied for the expansion of the business of the firm.
Ruchica who is studying Accounting in her school, volunteered to complete the
work. On scrutinising the accounts, the banker found that the value of building
bought a few years back for Rs. 7 lakh has been shown in the books at Rs. 20
lakh, which is its present market value. Similarly, as compared to the last year,
the method of valuation of stock was changed, resulting in value of goods to be
about 15 per cent higher. Also, the whole amount of Rs. 70,000 spent on purchase
of personal computer (expected life 5 years) during the year had been charged to
the profits of the current year. The banker did not rely on the financial data
provided by Ruchica. Advise Ruchica for the mistakes committed by her in the
preparation of financial statements in the context of basic concepts in accounting.
Activity 2
A customer has filed a suit against a trader who has supplied poor quality goods
to him. It is known that the court judgment will be in favour of the customer and
the trader will be required to pay the damages. However, the amount of legal
damages is not known with certainity. The accounting year has already been
ended and the books are now finalised to ascertain true profit or loss. The
accountant of the trader has advised him not to consider the expected loss on
account of payment of legal damages because the amount is not certain and the
final judgment of the court is not yet out. Do you think the accountant is right in
his approach.
Checklist to Test Your Understanding
Test Your Understanding - I
1. (c)

2. (d)

3. (a)

4. (b)

Test Your Understanding - II


1.
3.
5.

Matching
Revenue Realisation
Objectivity

2. Conservatism
4. Consistency

APPENDIX

Accounting Standards (AS)


The ICAI has issued the following standards:
AS
AS
AS
AS
AS

1
2
3
4
5

AS
AS
AS
AS
AS
AS
AS
AS
AS
AS

6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15

AS
AS
AS
AS
AS
AS
AS
AS

16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23

AS
AS
AS
AS
AS
AS

24
25
26
27
28
29

Disclosure of Accounting Policies


Valuation of Inventories
Cash Flow Statements
Contingencies and Events Occurring after the Balance Sheet Date
Net Profit or Loss for the Period, Prior Period items and Changes in
Accounting Policies
Depreciation Accounting
Construction Contracts
Accounting for Research and Development
Revenue Recognition
Accounting for Fixed Assets
The Effects of Changes in Foreign Exchange Rates
Accounting for Government Grants
Accounting for Investments
Accounting for Amalgamations
Accounting for Retirement Benefits in the Financial Statements of
Employers (recently revised and titled as Employee Benefits)
Borrowing Costs
Segment Reporting
Related Party Disclosures
Leases
Earnings Per Share
Consolidated Financial Statements
Accounting for Taxes on Income
Accounting for Investments in associates in Consolidated Financial
Statements
Discontinuing Operations
Interim Financial Reporting
Intangible Assets
Financial Reporting of Interests in Join Ventures
Impairment of Assets
Provisions, Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets

Recording of Transactions-I

LEARNING OBJECTIVES
After studying this chapter,
you will be able to:
describe the nature of
transaction and source
documents;
explain the preparation of accounting
vouchers;
apply
accounting
equation to explain the
effect of transactions;
record transactions
using rules of debit
and credit;
explain the concept of
book of original entry
and recording of
transactions in journal;
explain the concept of
ledger and posting of
journal entries to the
ledger accounts.

n chapter 1 and 2, while explaining the


development and importance of accounting as a
source of disseminating the financial information
along with the discussion on basic accounting
concepts that guide the recording of business
transactions, it has been indicated that accounting
involves a process of identifying and analysing the
business transactions, recording them, classifying
and summarising their ef fects and finally
communicating it to the interested users of
accounting information.
In this chapter, we will discuss the details of each
step involved in the accounting process. The first
step involves identifying the transactions to be
recorded and preparing the source documents
which are in turn recorded in the basic book of
original entry called journal and are then posted to
individual accounts in the principal book called
ledger.
3.1 Business Transactions and Source Document
After securing good percentage in your previous
examination, as promised, your father wishes to
buy you a computer. You go to the market along
with your father to buy a computer. The dealer gives
a cash memo along with the computer and in
exchange your father makes cash payment of
Rs. 35,000. Purchase of computer for cash is an
example of a transaction, which involves reciprocal
exchange of two things: (i) payment of cash,
(ii) delivery of a computer. Hence, the transaction

42

Accountancy

involves this aspect, i.e. Give and Take. Payment of cash involves give aspect
and delivery of computer is a take aspect. Thus, business transactions are
exchanges of economic consideration between parties and have two-fold effects
that are recorded in at least two accounts.
Business transactions are usually evidenced by an appropriate documents
such as Cash memo, Invoice, Sales bill, Pay-in-slip, Cheque, Salary slip, etc. A
document which provides evidence of the transactions is called the Source
Document or a Voucher. At times, there may be no documentary for certain items
as in case of petty expenses. In such case voucher may be prepared showing the
necessary details and got approved by appropriate authority within the firm. All
such documents (vouchers) are arranged in chronological order and are serially
numbered and kept in a separate file. All recording in books of account is done
on the basis of vouchers.
Transaction Voucher
Name of Firm :
Voucher No
:
Date
:
Debit account :
Credit account:
Amount (Rs.) :
Narration
:

Authorised By :

Prepared By :

Fig. 3.1 : Showing specimen transaction voucher

3.1.1 Preparation of Accounting Vouchers


Accounting vouchers may be classified as cash vouchers, debit vouchers, credit
vouchers, journal vouchers, etc. There is no set format of accounting vouchers.
A specimen of a simple transaction voucher is used in practice is shown in
figure 3.1.
These must be preserved in any case till the audit of the accounts and tax
assessments for the relevant period are completed. Now a days, accounting is
computerised and the necessary accounting vouchers showing the code
number and name of the accounts to be debited and credited are prepared for
the purpose of necessary recording of transactions. A transaction with one
debit and one credit is a simple transaction and the accounting vouchers
prepared for such transaction is known as Transaction Voucher, the format of

Recording of Transactions - I

43

which is shown in figure 3.1. Voucher which records a transaction that entails
multiple debits/credits and one credit/debit is called compound voucher.
Compound voucher may be: (a) Debit Voucher or (b) Credit Voucher; the specimen
is shown in figure 3.2.
Debit Voucher
Name of Firm :
Voucher No
:
Credit Account :
Amount
:

Date :

Debit Accounts
S. No. Code Account Name

Amount
Rs.

Authorised By :

Narration (i.e. Explanation)

Prepared By :

CreditVoucher
Name of Firm :
Voucher No
:
Debit Account :
Amount
:

Date :

Credit Accounts
S. No. Code Account Name

Authorised By :

Amount
Rs.

Narration (i.e. Explanation)

Prepared By :

Fig. 3.2 : Showing debit and credit vouchers

44

Accountancy

Transactions with multiple debits and multiple credits are called complex
transactions and the accounting voucher prepared for such transaction is
known as Complex Voucher/ Journal Voucher. The format of a complex
transaction voucher is shown in figure 3.3.
Journal Voucher
Name of Firm :
Voucher No

Date :
Debit Entries

S. No. Code Account Name

Amount
Rs.

Narration (i.e. Explanation)

Credit Entries
S. No. Code Account Name

Authorised By :

Amount
Rs.

Narration (i.e. Explanation)

Prepared By :

Fig. 3.3 : Showing specimen of complex transaction voucher

The design of the accounting vouchers depends upon the nature, requirement
and convenience of the business. There is no set format of an accounting
voucher. To distinguish various vouchers, different colour papers and different
fonts of printing are used. Some of the specimen of the accounting vouchers
are given in the earlier pages. A accounting voucher must contain the following
essential elements :

It is written on a good quality paper;

Name of the firm must be printed on the top;


Date of transaction is filled up against the date and not the date of recording
of transaction is to be mentioned;
The number of the voucher is to be in a serial order;
Name of the account to be debited or credited is mentioned;

Recording of Transactions - I

45

Debit and credit amount is to be written in figures against the amount;


Description of the transaction is to be given account wise;
The person who prepares the voucher must mention his name along with
signature; and
The name and signature of the authorised person are mentioned on the
voucher.

3.2 Accounting Equation


Accounting equation signifies that the assets of a business are always equal
to the total of its liabilities and capital (owners equity). The equations reads
as follows:
A=L+C
Where,
A = Assets
L = Liabilities
C = Capital
The above equation can also be presented in the following forms as its
derivatives to enable the determination of missing figures of Capital(C) or
Liabilities(L).
(i) A L = C
(ii) A C = L
Since, the accounting equation depicts the fundamental relationship among
the components of the balance sheet, it is also called the Balance Sheet
Equation. As the name suggests, the balance sheet is a statement of assets,
liabilities and capital.
At any point of time resources of the business entity must be equal to the
claims of those who have financed these resources. The proprietors and
outsiders provide the resources of the business. The claim of the proprietors
is called capital and that of the outsides is known as liabilities. Each element
of the equation is the part of balance sheet, which states the financial position
of the business on a particular date. When we analyse the transactions, we
actually try to know that how balance sheet of a business entity gets affected.
Asset side of the balance sheet is the list of assets, which the business
entity owns. The liabilities side of the balance sheet is the list of owners
claims and outsiders claims, i.e., what the business entity owes. The equality
of the assets side and the liabilities side of the balance sheet is an undeniable
fact and this justifies the name of accounting equation as balance sheet
equation also.

46

Accountancy

For example, Rohit started business with a capital of Rs. 5,00,000. From
the accounting point of view, the resources of this business entity is in the
form of cash, i.e., Rs. 5,00,000. Sources of this business entity is the
contribution by Rohit (Proprietor) Rs. 5,00,000 as Capital .
(For the purpose of understanding we will refer this example as example 1,
throughout the chapter) .
If we put this information in the form of equality of resources and sources,
the picture would emerge somewhat as follows:
Books of Rohit
Balance Sheet as at ..........
Liabilities
Capital

Amount
Rs.
5,00,000
5,00,000

Assets
Cash in hand

Amount
Rs.
5,00,000
5,00,000

In the above balance sheet, the total assets are equal to the liabilities of
the business. Since, the business has not yet started its activities and has not
earned any profits; the amount invested in business is still Rs. 5,00,000. In
case any profits are earned, it will increase the invested amount in business.
On the other hand, if business suffers any losses, it will decrease the invested
amount in business.
We will now analyse the transactions listed in example 1 and its effect on
different elements and you will observe that the accounting equation always
remain balanced:
Example 1.
1.

Opened a bank account in State Bank of India with an amount of


Rs. 4,80,000.
Analysis of transaction: This transaction increases the cash in hand
(assets) and decreases cash (asset) by Rs. 4,80,000.

2.

Bought furniture for Rs. 60,000 and cheque was issued on the same day.
Analysis of transaction: This transaction increases furniture (assets) and
decreases bank (assets) by Rs. 60,000.

3.

Bought plant and machinery for the business for Rs. 1,25,000 and an
advance of Rs. 10,000 in cash is paid to M/s Ramjee Lal.
Analysis of transaction: This transaction increases plant and machinery
(assets) by Rs. 1,25,000, decreases cash by Rs. 10,000 and increases
liabilities (M/s Ramjee lal as creditor)by Rs. 1,15,000.

Recording of Transactions - I

4.

5.

47

Goods purchased from M/s Sumit Traders for Rs. 55,000.


Analysis of transaction: This transaction increases goods (assets) and
increases liabilities (M/s Sumit Traders as creditors) by Rs. 55,000.
Goods costing Rs. 25,000 sold to Rajani Enterprises for Rs. 35,000.
Analysis of transaction: This transaction decreases stock of goods (assets)
by Rs. 25,000 and increases assets (Rajani Enterprises as debtors
Rs. 35,000) and capital (with the profit of Rs. 10,000)

The final equation as per the above analysis table can be summarised in
the form of a balance sheet as under:
Balance Sheet as at.....2005
Liabilities
Outsiders Claims (Creditors)
Capital

Amount
Rs.
1,70,000
5,10,000

6,80,000

Assets
Cash
Bank
Debtors
Stock
Furniture
Plant & Machinery

Amount
Rs.
10,000
4,20,000
35,000
30,000
60,000
1,25,000
6,80,000

In terms of accounting equation


A=L+C
Rs. 6,80,000 = Rs. 1,70,000 + Rs. 5,10,000

3.3 Using Debit and Credit


As already stated every transaction involves give and take aspect. In double
entry accounting, every transaction affects and is recorded in at least two
accounts. When recording each transaction, the total amount debited must
equal to the total amount credited. In accounting, the terms debit and credit
indicate whether the transactions are to be recorded on the left hand side or
right hand side of the account. In its simplest form, an account looks like the
letter T. Because of its shape, this simple form called a T -account (refer
figure 3.4). Notice that the T format has a left side and a right side for recording
increases and decreases in the item. This helps in ascertaining the ultimate
position of each item at the end of an accounting period. For example, if it is
an account of a customer all goods sold shall appear on the left (debit) side of
customers account and all payments received on the right side. The difference
between the totals of the two sides called balance shall reflect the amount due
to the customer. In a T account, the left side is called debit (often abbreviated
as Dr.) and the right side is known as credit (often abbreviated as Cr.). To

Final
Equation

10,000

4,20,000

4,20,000
35,000
35,000

30,000

(25,000)

55,000
55,000

60,000

60,000

1,25,000

1,25,000

6,80,000

10,000

55,000
6,70,000

1,15,000
6,15,000

60,000

4,20,000

1,25,000
1,25,000

.......
5,00,000

Total
Assets

60,000
60,000

Plant and
Machinery

(60,000)
4,20,000

Furniture

.......
5,00,000

Goods
(Stock)

4,80,000
4,80,000

Assets
Debtors

1.
(4,80,000)
Post Trans.
20,000
Equation
2.
.......
Post Trans.
20,000
Equation
3.
(10,000)
Post Trans.
10,000
Equation
4.
Post Trans.
10,000
Equation
5.

Bank
5,00,000

Cash

5,00,000

Transaction
No.

1,70,000

55,000
1,70,000

1,15,000
1,15,000

.......

Liabilities

5,10,000

10,000

5,00,000

5,00,000

.......
5,00,,000

.......
5,00,000

5,00,000

Capital

6,80,000

10,000

55,000
6,70,000

1,15,000
6,15,000

.......
5,00,000

.......
5,00,000

5,00,000

Total

(Figures in rupees)

The summary of effects of transactions on accounting equation is in the following analysis table:

48
Accountancy

Recording of Transactions - I

49

enter amount on the left side of an account is to debit the account. To enter
amount on the right side is to credit the account.
Account Title
(Left Side)

(Right Side)
Fig. 3.4 : Showing T-account

3.3.1 Rules of Debit and Credit


All accounts are divided into five categories for the purposes of recording the
transactions: (a) Asset (b) Liability (c) Capital (d) Expenses/Losses, and (e)
Revenues/Gains.
Two fundamental rules are followed to record the changes in these accounts:
(1) For recording changes in Assets/Expenses (Losses):
(i) Increase in asset is debited, and decrease in asset is credited.
(ii) Increase in expenses/losses is debited, and decrease in expenses/
losses is credited.
(2) For recording changes in Liabilities and Capital/Revenues (Gains):
(i) Increase in liabilities is credited and decrease in liabilities is debited.
(ii) Increase in capital is credited and decrease in capital is debited.
(iii) Increase in revenue/gain is credited and decrease in revenue/gain
is debited.
The rules applicable to the different kinds of accounts have been
summarised in the following chart:
Rules of Debit and Credit
Asset
(Increase)
+
Debit

Liabilities
(Decrease)

Credit

(Decrease)

Debit

(Increase)
+
Credit

Capital
(Decrease)

Debit

(Increase)
+
Credit
Revenues/Gains

(Decrease)

Debit

(Increase)
+
Credit

Expenses/Losses
(Increase)
+
Debit

(Decrease)

Credit

50

Accountancy

The transactions in Example 1 on page 47 will help you to learn how to


apply these debit and credit rules. Observe the analysis table given on page
48 carefully to be sure that you understand before you go on to the next one.
To illustrate different kinds of events, three more transactions have been added
(transactions 7 to 9).
1.

Rohit started business with cash Rs. 5,00,000


Analysis of Transaction : The transaction increases cash on one hand and increases
capital on the other hand. Increases in assets are debited and increases in capital
are credited. Therefore record the transaction with debit to Cash and credit to Rohits
Capital.
Cash Account
Capital Account

(1) 5,00,000

(1) 5,00,000
(6) 10,000

2.

Opened a bank account with an amount of Rs. 4,80,000


Analysis of Transaction: The transaction increases the cash at bank on one hand
and decreases cash in hand on the other hand. Increases in assets are debited and
a decreases in assets are credited. Therefore, record the transactions with debit to
Bank account and credit to Cash account.
Cash Account

(1) 5,00,000

3.

Bank Account
(2) 4,80,000

(2) 4,80,000

Bought furniture for Rs. 60,000 and issued cheque for the same
Analysis of Transaction : This transaction increases furniture (assets) on one hand
and decreases bank (assets) on the other hand by Rs. 60,000. Increases in assets
are debited and decreases are credited. Therefore record the transactions with debit
to Furniture account and credit to Bank account.
Furniture Account

(1) 60,000

4.

Bank Account
(2) 4,80,000

(3) 60,000

Bought Plant and Machinery from Ramjee lal for the business for Rs. 1,25,000
and an advance of Rs. 10,000 in cash is given.
Analysis of Transaction : This transaction increases plant and machinery (assets) by
Rs. 1,25,000, decreases cash by Rs. 10,000 and increases liabilities (M/s Ramjee
Lal as creditor) by Rs. 1,15,000. Increases in assets are debited whereas decreases
in assets are credited. On the other hand increases in liabilities are credited. Therefore,
record the transaction with debit to furniture account and with credit to Cash and
Ramjee Lals account.

Recording of Transactions - I

51
Plant and Machinery Account

Cash Account
(1) 5,00,000

(2) 4,80,000
(4) 10,000

(4) 1,25,000

Ramjee Lals Account


(4) 1,15,000

5.

Goods purchased from Sumit Traders for Rs. 55,000


Analysis of transaction : This transaction increases purchases (expenses) and
increases liabilities (M/s Sumit Traders as creditors) by Rs. 55,000. Increases in
expenses are debited and increases in liabilities are credited. Therefore record the
transaction with debit to Purchases account and credit to Sumit Traders account.
Sumit Traders Account

Purchases Account

(5) 55,000

(5) 55,000

6. Goods costing Rs. 25,000 sold to Rajani Enterprises for Rs. 35,000
Analysis of transaction : This transaction increases sales (Revenue) and increases
assets (Rajani Enterprises as debtors). Increases in assets are debited and increases
in revenue are credited. Therefore record the entry with credit to Sales account and
debit to Rajani Enterprises account.
Sales Account

Rajani Enterprises Account


(6) 35,000

7.

(6) 35,000

Paid the monthly store rent Rs. 2,500 in cash


Analysis of transaction : The payment of rent is an expense which decreases capital
thus, are recorded as debits. Credit cash to record decrease in assets.
Rent Account

(7) 2,500

8.

Cash Account
(7) 5,00,000

(2) 4,80,000
(4) 10,000
(7) 2,500

Paid Rs. 5,000 as salary to the office employees

Analysis of transaction : The payment of salary is an expense which decreases capital


thus, are recorded as debits. Credit Cash to record decrease in assets.

52

Accountancy
Cash Account

Salary Account
(1) 5,00,000

(8) 5,000

9.

(2) 4,80,000
(4) 10,000
(7)
2,500
(8) 5,000

Received cheque as full payment from Rajani Enterprises and deposited same
day into bank
Analysis of transaction : This transaction increase assets( Bank) on the one hand
and decreases assets(Rajani Enterprises as debtors) on the other hand. Increase in
assets is debited whereas decrease in assets is credited. Therefore record the entry
with debit to Bank account and credit to Rajani Enterprises account.
Rajani Enterprises Account

(6) 35,000

Banks Account

(9) 35,000

(2) 4,80,000
(9) 35,000

(3) 60,000

Test Your Understanding - I


1. Double entry accounting requires that :
(i) All transactions that create debits to asset accounts must create credits to
liability or capital accounts;
(ii) A transaction that requires a debit to a liability account require a credit to an
asset account;
(iii)

Every transaction must be recorded with equal debits equal total credits.

2. State different kinds of transactions that increase and decrease capital.


3. Does debit always mean increase and credit always mean decrease?
4. Which of the following answers properly classifies these commonly used accounts:
(1) Building (2) Wages (3) Credit sales (4) Credit purchases (5) Electricity charges
due but not yet paid(outstanding electricity bills) (6) Godown rent paid in
advance(prepaid godown rent) (7) Sales (8) Fresh capital introduced (9) Drawings
(10) Discount paid
(i)
(ii)
(iii)

Assets

Liabilities

Capital

Revenue

Expense

5,4,
1, 6
2,10,4

3,
4, 5
4,6

9,6
8
8

2,10
7, 3
7,5

8,7
2,9,10
1,3,9

Illustration 1
Analyse the effect of each transaction on assets and liabilities and show that the both
sides of Accounting Equation (A = L + C) remains equal :
(i) Introduced Rs. 8,00,000 as cash and Rs. 50,000 by stock.

Recording of Transactions - I
(ii)
(iii)
(iv)
(v)
(vi)
(vii)
(viii)
(ix)
(x)

53

Purchased plant for Rs. 3,00,000 by paying Rs. 15,000 in cash and balance at a
later date.
Deposited Rs. 6,00,000 into the bank.
Purchased office furniture for Rs. 1,00,000 and made payment by cheque.
Purchased goods worth Rs. 80,000 for cash and for Rs. 35,000 in credit.
Goods amounting to Rs. 45,000 was sold for Rs. 60,000 on cash basis.
Goods costing to Rs. 80,000 was sold for Rs. 1,25,000 on credit.
Cheque issued to the supplier of goods worth Rs. 35,000.
Cheque received from customer amounting to Rs. 75,000.
Withdrawn by owner for personal use Rs. 25,000.

Solution
Transaction (i) It affects Cash and Inventory on the assets side and Capital on the other
hand. There is increase in cash by Rs. 8, 00,000 and Inventory of goods by Rs. 50,000 on
assets side of the equation. Capital is increased by Rs. 8, 50,000.
Rs.
Assets
Cash
+
8,00,000 +
Total

=
Inventory(Stock)
50,000
8,50,000

Liabilities + Capital

=
=

8,50,000
8,50,000

Transaction (ii) It affects Cash and Plant and Machinery on the assets side and liabilities
on the other side of the equation. There is an increase in plant and machinery by Rs. 3,
00,000 and decrease in cash by Rs. 15,000. Liability to pay to the supplier of plant and
machinery increases by Rs. 2,85,000.
Rs.
Assets
Cash
+Inventory + Plant and Machinery
8,00,000 + 50,000
(15,000)
3,00,000
7,85,000 + 50,000 +3,00,000

Liabilities + Capital

=
=
=

8,50,000
2,85,000
2,85,000 + 8,50,000

Total

11,35,000

11,35,000

Transaction (iii) It affects assets side only. The composition of the asset side changes.
Cash decreases by Rs. 6,00,000 and by the same amount bank increases.
Rs.
Assets
Cash

+ Inventory + Plant and +


Bank
Machinery
7,85,000 +
5,0000 + 3,00,000
(6,00,000)
+ 6,00,000
1,85,000 + 50,000 + 3,00,000 + 6,00,000
Total

11,35,000

=
=

Liabilities + Capital

2,85,000

2,85,000 + 8,50,000

11,35,000

+ 8,50,000

Transaction (iv) It affects assets side only. The composition of the asset side changes.
Furniture increases by Rs. 1,00,000 and by the same amount bank decreases.

54

Accountancy
Rs.

Assets
Cash

= Liabilities +

+ Inventory + Plant and +


Bank + Furniture
Machinery
1,85,000 +
50,000 + 3,00,000 + 6,00,000
(1,00,000) + 1,00,000
1,85,000 + 50,000 +3,00,000 +5,00,000 + 1,00,000

Total

= 11,35,000

11,35,000

Capital

2,85,000 + 8,50,000

= 2,85,000 + 8,50,000

Transaction (v) It affects Cash and Inventory on the assets side and liability on the other
side. There is decrease in cash by Rs. 80,000 and increase of inventory of goods by
Rs. 1,15,000 on the assts side of the equation. Liabilities increases by Rs. 35,000.
Rs.
Assets
Cash

= Liabilities +

Capital

+ Inventory +Plant and +


Bank + Furniture
Machinery
1,85,000 +
50,000 + 3,00,000 + 5,00,000 + 1,00,000
(80,000) + 1,15,000
1,05,000 + 1,65,000 +3,00,000 +5,00,000 + 1,00,000

= 2,85,000 + 8,50,000
=
35,000
= 3,20,000 + 8,50,000

Total

= 11,70,000

11,70,000

Transaction (vi) It affects Cash and Inventory on the assets side and capital on the other
side. There is an increase in cash by Rs. 60,000 and decrease in inventory of goods by
Rs. 45,000 on the assets side of the equation. Capital increases by Rs. 15,000.
Rs.
Assets
Cash

= Liabilitie +

Capital

+ Inventory + Plant and +


Bank + Furniture
Machinery
1,05,000 + 1,65,000 + 3,00,000 + 5,00,000 + 1,00,000
60,000 + (45,000)
1,65,000 + 1,20,000 +3,00,000 +5,00,000 + 1,00,000

3,20,000 + 8,50,000
+ 15,000
= 3,20,000 + 8,65,000

Total

= 11,85,000

11,85,000

Transaction (vii) It affects Debtors and Inventory on the assets side and capital on the
other side. There is increase in debtors by Rs. 1, 25,000 and decrease in Inventory of
goods by Rs. 80,000 on the assets side of the equation. Capital increases by Rs.45, 000.
Rs.
Assets
Cash

= Liabilities +

Capital

+ Inventory +Plant and +


Bank + Furniture + Debtors
Machinery
1,65,000 + 1,20,000 + 3,00,000 + 5,00,000 + 1,00,000
(80,000)
+ 1,25,000
1,65,000 + 40,000 +3,00,000 +5,00,000 + 1,00,000 + 1,25,000

= 3,20,000 + 8,65,000
=
+ 45,000
= 3,20,000 + 9,10,000

Total

= 12,30,000

12,30,000

Transaction (viii) It affects Bank on the assets side on one side and liability on the other
side. There is decrease in bank by Rs. 35,000 on the assets side and liability also decreases
by Rs. 35,000.

Recording of Transactions - I

55
Rs.

Assets
Cash

= Liabilities +

Capital

+ Inventory +Plant and +


Bank + Furniture + Debtors
Machinery
1,65,000 +
40,000 + 3,00,000 + 5,00,000 + 1,00,000 + 1,25,000 = 3,20,000 + 9,10,000
(35,000)
= (35,000)
1,65,000 + 40,000 + 3,00,000 +4,65,000 + 1,00,000 + 1,25,000= 2,85,000 + 9,10,000
Total

11,95,000

= 11,95,000

Transaction (ix) It affects assets side only. The composition of the assets side changes.
Bank increases by R. 75,000 and by the same amount Debtors decreases.
Rs.
Assets
Cash

= Liabilities +

+ Inventory +Plant and +


Bank + Furniture + Debtors
Machinary
1,65,000 +
40,000 + 3,00,000 + 4,65,000 + 1,00,000 + 1,25,000
+ 75,000
(75,000)
1,65,000 +
40,000 + 3,00,000 + 5,40,000 + 1,00,000 +
50,000

Total

= 11,95,000

11,95,000

Capital

2,85,000 + 9,10,000

= 2,85,000 + 9,10,000

Transaction (x) It affects Cash on the asset side and Capital on the other hand. There
is decrease in Cash by Rs. 25,000 on the assets side whereas capital decreases
by Rs. 25,000.
Rs.
Assets
Cash

= Liabilities +

+ Inventory +Plant and +


Bank + Furniture +
Machinery
1,65,000 +
40,000 + 3,00,000 + 5,40,000 + 1,00,000 +
(25,000)
1,40,000+ 40,000 +3,00,000 +5,40,000 + 1,00,000 +
Total

11,95,000

Capital

Debtors
50,000
50,000

2,85,000 + 9,10,000
+ (25,000)
= 2,85,000 + 8,85,000
= 11,95,000

3.4 Books of Original Entry


In the preceding pages, you learnt about debits and credits and observed how
transactions affect accounts. This process of analysing transactions and recording
their effects directly in the accounts is helpful as a learning exercise. However, real
accounting systems do not record transactions directly in the accounts. The book in
which the transaction is recorded for the first time is called journal or book of original
entry. The source document, as discussed earlier, is required to record the transaction
in the journal. This practice provides a complete record of each transaction in one
place and links the debits and credits for each transaction. After the debits and
credits for each transaction are entered in the journal, they are transferred to the
individual accounts. The process of recording transactions in journal is called
journalising. Once the journalising process is completed, the journal entry provides

56

Accountancy

a complete and useful description of the events effect on the organisation. The process
of transferring journal entry to individual accounts is called p o s t i n g .
This sequence causes the journal to be called the Book of Original Entry and
the ledger account as the Principal Book of entry. In this context, it should be
noted that on account of the number and commonality of most transactions,
the journal is subdivided into a number of books of original entry as follows:
(a) Journal Proper
(b) Cash book
(c) Other day books:
(i) Purchases (journal) book
(ii) Sales (journal) book
(iii) Purchase Returns (journal) book
(iv) Sale Returns (journal) book
(v) Bills Receivable (journal) book
(vi) Bills Payable (journal) book
In this chapter you will learn about the process of journalising and their
posting into ledger. The cash book and other day books are dealt in detail in
chapter 4.
3.4.1 Journal
This is the basic book of original entry. In this book, transactions are recorded
in the chronological order, as and when they take place. Afterwards,
transactions from this book are posted to the respective accounts. Each
transaction is separately recorded after determining the particular account to
be debited or credited. The format of Journal is shown is figure 3.5
Journal
Date

Particulars

L.F.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

Fig. 3.5 : Showing the format of journal

The first column in a journal is Date on which the transaction took place.
In the Particulars column, the account title to be debited is written on the first
line beginning from the left hand corner and the word Dr. is written at the
end of the column. The account title to be credited is written on the second
line leaving sufficient margin on the left side with a prefix To. Below the

Recording of Transactions - I

57

account titles, a brief description of the transaction is given which is called


Narration. Having written the Narration a line is drawn in the Particulars
column, which indicates the end of recording the specific journal entry. The
column relating to Ledger Folio records the page number of the ledger book on
which relevant account is appears. This column is filled up at the time of
posting and not at the time of making journal entry.
The Debit amount column records the amount against the account to be
debited and similarly the Credit Amount column records the amount against
the account to be credited. It may be noted that, the number of transactions
is very large and these are recorded in number of pages in the journal book.
Hence, at the end of each page of the journal book, the amount columns are
totaled and carried forward (c/f) to the next page where such amounts are
recorded as brought forward (b/f) balances.
The journal entry is the basic record of a business transaction. It may be
simple or compound. When only two accounts are involved to record a
transaction, it is called a simple journal entry.
For Example, Goods Purchased on credit for Rs.30,000 from M/s Govind
Traders on December 24, 2005, involves only two accounts: (a) Purchases A/c
(Goods), (b) Govind Traders A/c (Creditors). This transaction is recorded in
the journal as follows :
Journal
Date

Particulars

L.F.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

2005
Dec.24

Purchases A/c
To Govind Traders A/c
(Purchase of goods- in-trade from
Govind Traders)

Dr.

30,000
30,000

It will be noticed that although the transaction results in an increase in


stock of goods, the account debited is purchases, not goods. In fact, as
explained in chater 7 the goods account is divided into five accounts, viz.
purchases account, sales account, purchases returns account, sales returns
account, and stock account. When the number of accounts to be debited or
credited is more than one, entry made for recording the transaction is called
compound journal entry. That means compound journal entry involves multiple
accounts. For example, For Rs. 25,000 Office furniture is purchased from
Modern Furnitures on July 4, 2005 and Rs. 5,000 is paid by cash immediately
and balance of Rs. 20,000 is still payable. It increases furniture (assets) by
Rs. 25,000, decreases cash (assets) by Rs. 5,000 and increases liability by Rs.
20,000. The entry made in the journal on July 4, 2005 is :

58

Accountancy
Journal

Date

2005
July 4

Particulars

L.F.

Office Furniture A/c


To Cash A/c
To Modern Furniture A/c
(Purchase of office furniture from
Modern Furnitures)

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

25,000
5,000
20,000

Now refer to example 1(on page 47 again and observe how the transactions
listed are recorded in the journal:
Books of Rohit
Journal
Date

Particulars

L.F.

Cash A/c
To Capital A/c
(Business started with cash)

Dr.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

5,00,000
5,00,000

Bank A/c
Dr.
To Cash A/c
(Opened bank account with State
Bank of India)
Furniture A/c
To Bank A/c
( Purchased furniture and made
payment through bank))

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Dr.

4,80,000
4,80,000

60,000
60,000

Plant and Machinery A/c


Dr.
To Cash A/c
To Ramjee Lal
(Bought Plant and Machinery from
M/s Ramjee Lal, made an advance
payment by cash for Rs. 10,000 and
balance at the later date )
Purchases A/c
To M/s Sumit Traders A/c
(Goods bought on credit)

Dr.

Rajani Enterprises A/c


To Sales A/c
(Goods sold on profit)

Dr.

1,25,000
10,000
1,15,000

55,000
55,000
35,000
35,000

Total

12,55,000

12,55,000

Recording of Transactions - I

59

Illustration 2.
Soraj Mart furnishes the following information :
Transactions during the month of April, 2005 are as under :
Date

Details

1.4.2005
1.4.2005
1.4.2005
2.4.2005
2.4.2005
3.4.2005
5.4.2005
08.4.2005
10.4.2005
14.4.2005
18.4.2005
20.4.2005
24.4.2005
29.4.2005
30.4.2005
30.4.2005
30.4.2005
30.4.2005
30.4.2005

Business started with cash Rs. 1,50,000.


Goods purchased form Manisha Rs. 36,000.
Stationery purchased for cash Rs. 2,200.
Open a bank account with SBI for Rs. 35,000.
Goods sold to Priya for Rs. 16,000.
Received a cheque of Rs. 16,000 from Priya.
Sold goods to Nidhi Rs. 14,000.
Nidhi pays Rs. 14,000 cash.
Purchased goods for Rs. 20,000 on credit from Ritu.
Insurance paid by cheque Rs. 6,000.
Paid rent Rs. 2,000.
Goods costing Rs. 1,500 given as charity.
Purchased office furniture for Rs. 11,200.
Cash withdrawn for household purposes Rs. 5000.
Interest received cash Rs.1,200.
Cash sales Rs.2,300.
Commission paid Rs. 3,000 by cehque.
Telephone bill paid by cheque Rs. 2,000.
Payment of salaries in cash Rs. 12,000.

Journalise the transactions.


Solution
Books of Saroj Mart
Journal
Date

2005
Apr.01

Apr.01

Apr.01

Particulars

L.F.

Cash A/c
To Capital A/c
(Business started with cash)

Dr.

Purchases A/c
To Manisha A/c
(Goods purchase on credit)

Dr.

Stationery A/c
To Cash A/c
( Purchase of stationery for cash)

Dr.

Total c/f

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

1,50,000
1,50,000
36,000
36,000
2,200
2,200
1,88,200

1,88,200

60

Accountancy
Total b/f

Apr.02

Apr.02

Apr.03

Apr.05

Apr.08

Apr.10

Apr.14

Apr.18

Apr.20

Apr.24

1,88,200

Bank A/c
Dr.
To Cash A/c
(Opened a bank account with SBI)

35,000

Priya A/c
To Sales A/c
(Goods sold to Priya On Credit)

Dr.

16,000

Bank A/c
To Priya A/c
(Cheque Received from Priya)

Dr.

Nidhi A/c
To Sales A/c
(Sale of goods to Nidhi on credit)

Dr.

Cash A/c
To Nidhi A/c
(Cash received from Nidhi)

Dr.

Purchases A/c
To Ritu A/c
(Purchase of goods on credit)

Dr.

35,000

16,000
16,000
16,000
14,000
14,000
14,000
14,000
20,000
20,000

Insurance Premium A/c


Dr.
To Bank A/c
(Payment of Insurance premium by
cheque)

6,000

Rent A/c
To Cash A/c
(Rent paid)

Dr.

2,000

Charity A/c
To Purchases A/c
(Goods given as charity)

Dr.

Furniture A/c

Dr.

6,000

2,000
1,500
1,500
11,200

To Cash A/c
(Purchase of office furniture)
Apr.29

Apr.30

Apr.30

1,88,200

11,200

Drawings A/c
Dr.
To Cash A/c
(With drawl of cash from the business
for personal use of the proprietor)

5,000

Cash A/c
To Interest received A/c
(Interest received)
Cash A/c
To Sales A/c
(Sale of goods for cash)

1,200

Total c/f

Dr.

5,000

1,200
Dr.

2,300
2,300
3,32,400

3,32,400

Recording of Transactions - I

Apr.30

Apr.30

Apr.30

61

Total c/f
Commission A/c
To Bank A/c
(Commission paid by cheque)
Telephone expenses A/c
To Cash A/c
(Payment of telephone bill)

3,32,400
3,000

Dr.

3,32,400
3,000

Dr.

2,000
2,000

Salaries A/c
Dr.
To Cash A/c
(Payment of salary to the office persons)

12,000
12,000

Total

3,49,400

3,49,400

Illustration 3
Prove that the accounting equation is satisfied in all the following transactions of Sita
Ram house by preparing the analysis table. Also record the transactions in Journal.
(i)
(ii)
(iii)
(iv)
(v)
(vi)
(vii)
(viii)
(ix)
(x)

Business commenced with a capital of Rs. 6,00,000.


Rs. 4,50,000 deposited in a bank account.
Rs. 2,30,000 Plant and Machinery Purchased by paying Rs. 30,000 cash
immediately.
Purchased goods worth Rs. 40,000 for cash and Rs. 45,000 on account.
Paid a cheque of Rs. 2, 00,000 to the supplier for Plant and Machinery.
Rs. 70,000 cash sales (of goods costing Rs. 50,000).
Withdrawn by the proprietor Rs. 35,000 cash for personal use.
Insurance paid by cheque of Rs. 2,500.
Salary of Rs. 5,500 outstanding.
Furniture of Rs. 30,000 purchased in cash.

Solution
Journal
Date

Particulars

(i)

Cash A/c
To Capital A/c
(Business started with cash)

Dr.

Bank A/c
To Cash A/c
(Cash deposited into the bank)

Dr.

(ii)

L.F.

Total c/f

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

6,00,000
6,00,000
4,50,000
4,50,000
10,50,000

10,50,000

62

Accountancy

(iii)

(iv)

(v)

(vi)

(vii)

(viii)

(ix)

(x)

Total c/f
Plant and Machinery A/c
Dr.
To Cash A/c
To Creditors A/c
(Purchase of plant and machinery by
paying Rs. 30,000 cash and balance
on a later date)

10,50,000
2.30,000

Purchases A/c
Dr.
To Cash A/c
To Creditors A/c
(Bought goods for cash as well as on
credit)

85,000

Creditors A/c
Dr.
To Bank A/c
(Payment made to the supplier of plant
and machinery)

2,00,000

Cash A/c
To Sales A/c
(Sold goods on profit)

Dr.

Drawings A/c
To Cash A/c
(Withdrew cash for personal use)

Dr.

Insurance A/c
To Bank A/c
(Paid insurance by cheque)

Dr.

Outstanding salary A/c


To Salary A/c
(Salary outstanding )

Dr.

Furniture A/c
To Cash A/c
(Furniture purchased for cash)

Dr.

10,50,000
30,000
2,00,000

40,000
45,000

2,00,000

70,000
70,000
35,000
35,000
2,500
2,500
5,500
5,500
30,000
30,000

Total

17,08,000

17,08,000

Test Your Understanding - II


State the title of the accounts affected, type of account and the account to be debited
and account to be credited :
Rs
1.
Bhanu commenced business with cash
1,00,000
2.
Purchased goods on credit from Ramesh
40,000
3.
Sold goods for cash
30,000
4.
Paid salaries
3,000
5.
Furniture purchased for cash
10,000

2,47,500
-

2,47,500

1,15,000

1,15,000
(30,000)

85,000

10

Stock

35,000

35,000
-

4,50,000
4,50,000
-4,50,000
- 85,000
4,50,000 85,000
(2,00,000)
2,50,000 85,000
- (50,000)
2,50,000 35,000
2,50,000 35,000
(2,500)
2,47,500 35,000

Bank

6,00,000
6,00,000
(4,50,000)
1,50,000
(30,000)
1,20,000
(40,000)
80,000
80,000
70,000
1,50,000
(35,000)
1,15,000

Cash

1
2

No.

30,000

30,000

--

Furniture

2,30,000

2,30,000
-

2,30,000

2,30,000

2,30,000
2,30,000
2,30,000
2,30,000
2,30,000

Plant and
Machinery

6,27,500

6,27,500
-

6,00,000
2,00,000
8,00,000
45,000
8,45,000
(2,00,000)
6,45,000
20,000
6,65,000
(35,000)
6,30,000
(2,500)
6,27,500

6,00,000
6,00,000

Total

=
=

5,500

5,500
5,500
-

2,00,000
2,00,000
2,00,000
(2,00,000)
-

Non-trade
Creditors

45,000

45,000
45,000
-

45,000

45,000
45,000
45,000
45,000

Trade
Creditors

5,77,000

6,00,000
600,000
600,000
6,00,000
20,000
6,20,000
(35,000)
5,85,000
(2,500)
5,82,500
(5,500)
5,77,000
-

6,00,000
6,00,000

Capital

6,27,500

6,27,500

6,00,000
2,00,000
8,00,000
45,000
8,45,000
(2,00,000)
20,000
20,000
6,65,000
(35,000)
6,30,000
(2,500)
6,27,500

6,00,000
6,00,000

Total

Statement showing the effect of various transaction on accounting equation


(Figures in rupees)

Recording of Transactions - I
63

64

Accountancy
6.
7.
8.
9.

Borrowed from bank


Sold goods to Sarita
Cash paid to Ramesh on account
Rent paid

Transaction
No.

Name of Accounts
Affected
1

Type of Accounts
(Assets, Liabilities Capital,
Revenues and Expenses)
1
2

50,000
10,000
20,000
1,500
Affected Accounts
Increase/Decrease
1

1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.

3.5 The Ledger


The ledger is the principal book of accounting system. It contains different accounts
where transactions relating to that account are recorded. A ledger is the collection of
all the accounts, debited or credited, in the journal proper and various special
journal (about which you will learn in chapter 4). A ledger may be in the form of
bound register, or cards, or separate sheets may be maintained in a loose leaf binder.
In the ledger, each account is opened preferably on separate page or card.
Utility
A ledger is very useful and is of utmost importance in the organisation. The
net result of all transactions in respect of a particular account on a given date
can be ascertained only from the ledger. For example, the management on a
particular date wants to know the amount due from a certain customer or the
amount the firm has to pay to a particular supplier, such information can be
found only in the ledger. Such information is very difficult to ascertain from
the journal because the transactions are recorded in the chronological order
and defies classification. For easy posting and location, accounts are opened
in the ledger in some definite order. For example, they may be opened in the
same order as they appear in the profit and loss account and in balance
sheet. In the beginning, an index is also provided. For easy identification, in
big organisations, each account is also allotted a code number.
Format of the account is shown in figure 3.6.

Recording of Transactions - I

65
Name of the Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Fig. 3.6 : Showing format of a ledger

According to this format the columns will contain the information as given below:
An account is debited or credited according to the rules of debit and credit
already explained in respect of each category of account.
Title of the account : The Name of the item is written at the top of the format as
the title of the account. The title of the account ends with suffix Account.
Dr./Cr. : Dr. means Debit side of the account that is left side and Cr. means
Credit side of the account, i.e. right side.
Date : Year, Month and Date of transactions are posted in chronological order
in this column.
Particulars : Name of the item with reference to the original book of entry is
written on debit/credit side of the account.
Journal Folio : It records the page number of the original book of entry on
which relevant transaction is recorded. This column is filled up at the time of
posting.
Amount : This column records the amount in numerical figure, corresponding
to what has been entered in the amount column of the original book of entry.
Test Your Understanding - III
Choose the Correct Answer :
1.

The
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)

ledger folio column of journal is used to:


Record the date on which amount posted to a ledger account.
Record the number of ledger account to which information is posted.
Record the number of amounts posted to the ledger account.
Record the page number of the ledger account.

2.

The
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)

journal entry to record the sale of services on credit should include:


Debit to debtors and credit to capital.
Debit to cash and Credit to debtors.
Debit to fees income and Credit to debtors.
Debit to debtors and Credit to fees income.

3.

The journal entry to record purchase of equipment for Rs. 2,00,000 cash and a
balance of Rs. 8,00,000 due in 30 days include:
(a) Debit equipment for Rs. 2,00,000 and Credit cash 2,00,000.

66

Accountancy
(b)
(c)
(d)

Debit equipment for Rs. 10,00,000 and Credit cash Rs. 2,00,000 and creditors
Rs. 8,00,000.
Debit equipment Rs. 2,00,000 and Credit debtors Rs. 8,00,000.
Debit equipment Rs. 10,00,000 and Credit cash Rs. 10,00,000.

4.

When a entry is made in journal:


(a) Assets are listed first.
(b) Accounts to be debited listed first.
(c) Accounts to be credited listed first.
(d) Accounts may be listed in any order.

5.

If a
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)

transaction is properly analysed and recorded:


Only two accounts will be used to record the transaction.
One account will be used to record transaction.
One account balance will increase and another will decrease.
Total amount debited will equals total amount credited.

6.

The journal entry to record payment of monthly bill will include:


(a) Debit monthly bill and Credit capital.
(b) Debit capital and Credit cash.
(c) Debit monthly bill and Credit cash.
(d) Debit monthly bill and Credit creditors.
7. Journal entry to record salaries will include:
(a) Debit salaries Credit cash.
(b) Debit capital Credit cash.
(c) Debit cash Credit salary.
(d) Debit salary Credit creditors.

Distinction between Journal and Ledger


The Journal and the Ledger are the most important books of the double entry
mechanism of accounting and are indispensable for an accounting system.
Following points of comparison are worth noting :
1. The Journal is the book of first entry (original entry); the ledger is the
book of second entry.
2. The Journal is the book for chronological record; the ledger is the book
for analytical record.
3. The Journal, as a book of source entry, gets greater importance as
legal evidence than the ledger.
4. Transaction is the basis of classification of data within the Journal;
Account is the basis of classification of data within the ledger.
5. Process of recording in the Journal is called Journalising; the process
of recording in the ledger is known as Posting.

Recording of Transactions - I

67

3.5.1 Classification of Ledger Accounts


We have seen earlier that all ledger accounts are put into five categories namely,
assets, liabilities, capital, revenues/gains and expense losses. All these
accounts may further be put into two groups, i.e. permanent accounts and
temporary accounts. All permanent accounts are balanced and carried forward
to the next accounting period. The temporary accounts are closed at the end
of the accounting period by transferring them to the trading and profit and
loss account. All permanent accounts appears in the balance sheet. Thus, all
assets, liabilities and capital accounts are permanent accounts and all revenue
and expense accounts are temporary accounts. This classification is also
relevant for preparing the financial statements.
3.6 Posting from Journal
Posting is the process of transferring the entries from the books of original
entry (journal) to the ledger. In other words, posting means grouping of all the
transactions in respect to a particular account at one place for meaningful
conclusion and to further the accounting process. Posting from the journal is
done periodically, may be, weekly or fortnightly or monthly as per the
requirements and convenience of the business.
The complete process of posting from journal to ledger has been discussed below:
Step 1 : Locate in the ledger, the account to be debited as entered in the journal.
Step 2 : Enter the date of transaction in the date column on the debit side.
Step 3 : In the Particulars column write the name of the account through
which it has been debited in the journal. For example, furniture sold for cash
Rs. 34,000. Now, in cash account on the debit side in the particulars column
Furniture will be entered signifying that cash is received from the sale of
furniture. In Furniture account, in the ledger on the credit side is the
particulars column, the word, cash will be recorded. The same procedure is
followed in respect of all the entries recorded in the journal.
Step 4 : Enter the page number of the journal in the folio column and in the
journal write the page number of the ledger on which a particular account appears.
Step 5 : Enter the relevant amount in the amount column on the debit side.
It may be noted that the same procedure is followed for making the entry on
the credit side of that account to be credited. An account is opened only once
in the ledger and all entries relating to a particular account is posted on the
debit or credit side, as the case may be.
We will now see how the transactions listed in example on page 47 are
posted to different accounts from the journal.

68

Accountancy
Cash Account

Dr.
Date

Particulars

J.F.

Capital

Amount
Rs.

Date

5,00,000

Particulars

J.F.

Bank
Plant and
Machinery

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
4,80,000
10,000

Capital Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Cash

Amount
Rs.
5,00,000

Bank Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Cash

Amount
Rs.

Date

4,80,000

Particulars

J.F.

Furniture

Amount
Rs.
60,000

Furniture Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Bank

Amount
R s.
60,000

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Plant and Machinery Account


Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Cash
Ramjee lal

Amount
Rs.
10,000

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

1,15,000
Ramjee Lals Account

Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars
Plant and
Machinery

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
1,15,000

Recording of Transactions - I

69
Purchases Account

Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Sumit
Traders

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

55,000

Sumit Traders Account


Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars
Purchases

55,000

Rajani Enterprises Account


Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Sales

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

35,000

Sales Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars
Rajani Enter
prises

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
35,000

Test Your Understanding - IV


Fill in the blanks:
1. Issued a cheque for Rs.8,000 to pay rent. The account to be debited is ............
2. Collected Rs. 35,000 from debtors. The account to be credited is ............
3. Purchased office stationary for Rs. 18,000. The account to be credited is ...........
4. Purchased new machine for Rs. 1,70,000 and issued cheque for the same.
The account to be debited is ............
5. Issued cheque for Rs. 70,000 to pay off on of the creditors. The account to
be debited is ............
6. Returned damaged office stationary and received Rs. 50,000. The account
to be credited is ............
7. Provided services for Rs. 65,000 on credit. The account to be debited is ...........

70

Accountancy

Illustration 4
Journalise the following transactions of M/s Mallika Fashion House and post the entries
to the Ledger:
Date
2005
June
June
June
June
June
June
June
June
June
June

Details

05
08
12
12
18
20
22
25
28
30

Amount
Rs.
Business started with cash
2,00,000
Opened a bank account with Syndicate Bank
80,000
Goods purchased on credit from M/s Gulmohar Fashion House
30,000
Purchase office machines, paid by cheque
20,000
Rent paid by cheque
5,000
Sale of goods on credit to M/s Mohit Bros
10,000
Cash sales
15,000
Cash paid to M/s Gulmohar Fashion House
30,000
Received a cheque from M/s Mohit Bros
10,000
Salary paid in cash
6,000

Solution
(i)

Recording the transactions


Books of Mallika Fashion House
Journal

Date

Particulars

L.F.

2005
June 05 Cash A/c
To Capital A/c
(Business started with cash)

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

2,00,000
2,00,000

June 08 Bank A/c


Dr.
To Cash A/c
(Opened a current account with
syndicate bank)
June 12 Purchases A/c
Dr.
To Gulmohar Fashion House A/c
(Goods purchased on credit)

80,000

June 12 Office Machines A/c


To Bank A/c
(Office machine purchased)

Dr.

20,000

June 18 Rent A/c


To Bank A/c
(Rent paid)

Dr.

June 20 Mohit Bros A/c


To Sales A/c
(Goods sold on credit)

Dr.

80,000

30,000
30,000

20,000
5,000
5,000
10,000
10,000

Total c/f

3,45,000

3,45,000

Recording of Transactions - I

71
Total b/f

3,45,000

June 22 Cash A/c


To Sales A/c
(Goods sold for cash)

Dr.

June 25 Gulmohar Fashion House A/c

Dr.

3,45,000

15,000
15,000
30,000

To Cash A/c
(Cash paid to Gulmohar
Fashion House)

30,000

June 28 Bank A/c


To Mohit Bros A/c
(Payment received in full and
final settlement)

Dr.

June 30 Salary A/c


To Cash A/c
(Monthly salary paid)

Dr.

10,000

6,000
6,000

Total
(ii)

10,000

4,06,000

4,06,000

Posting in the Ledger Book


Cash Account

Dr.
Date
2005
June 5
June 22

Particulars

J.F.

Capital
Sales

Amount
Rs.
2,00,000
15,000

Date
2005
June 8
June 25
June 30

Particulars

J.F.

Bank
Gulmohar
Fashion House
Salary

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
80,000
30,000
6,000

Capital Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

2005
June 5

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
2,00,000

Bank Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2005
June 08
June 28

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2005
Cash
Mohit Bros.

80,000
10,000

June 12
June 18

Office Machines
Rent

30,000
5,000

72

Accountancy
Purchases Account

Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2005

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2005

June 12 Gulmohar
Fashion House

30,000

Gulmohar Fashion House Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
June 25

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
30,000

Date

Particulars

2005
June 12

Purchases

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
30,000

Office Machines Account


Dr.
Date
2005
June 12

Particulars

J.F.

Bank

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

Particulars

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

20,000
Rent Account

Dr.
Date
2005
June 18

Particulars

J.F.

Bank

Amount
Rs.

Date

5,000
Mohit Bros. Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
June 20

Sales

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
10,000

Date

Particulars

2005
June 28

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
10,000

Sales Account
Dr.
Date
2005
June 20

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

2005
June 20
June 22

Mohit Bros.
Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
10,000
15,000

Recording of Transactions - I

73
Salary Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
June 30

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

6,000

Illustrtion 5
Journalise the following transactions of M/s Time Zone and post them to the ledger accounts :
Date
2005

Details

Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.

01
02
04
10
12
14
16
18
19
20

Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.

22
24
26
28
29
30
31

Amount
Rs.

Business started with cash


Opened a bank account with ICICI
Goods purchased for cash
Paid cartage
Goods sold on credit to M/s Lara India
Cash received from M/s Lara India
Goods returned from Lara India
Paid trade expenses
Goods purchased on credit from Taranum
Cheque received from M/s Lara India for final settlement
and deposited sameday into bank
Goods returned to Taranum
Paid for stationery
Cheque given to Taranum on account
Paid rent by cheque
Drew cash for personal use
Cash sales
Goods sold to M/s Rupak Traders

1,20,000
4,00,00
12,000
500
25,000
10,000
3,000
700
32,000
11,500
1,500
1,200
20,000
4,000
10,000
12,000
11,000

Solution
Books of Time Zone
Journal
Date

2005
Dec. 01

02

04

Particulars

Cash A/c
To Capital A/c
( Business started with cash)
Bank A/c
To Cash A/c
(Opened a current account with
ICICI bank)
Purchases A/c
To Cash A/c
(Goods purchased for cash)
Total c/f

L.F.

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

1,20,000
1,20,000

Dr.

40,000
40,000

Dr.

12,000
12,000
1,72,000

1,72,000

74

Accountancy
Total b/f

10

12

14

16

18

19

20

22

24

26

28

29

30

31

1,72,000

Cartage A/c
To Cash A/c
(Cartage paid)

Dr.

Lara India A/c


To Sales A/c
(Goods sold on credit)
Cash A/c
To Lara India A/c
(Cash received from Lara India)
Sales Return A/c
To Lara India A/c
(Goods returned from Lara India)

Dr.

1,72,000

500
500
25,000
25,000

Dr.

10,000
10,000

Dr.

3,000
3,000

Trade Expenses A/c


To Cash A/c
(Trade expenses paid)

Dr.

Purchases A/c
To Tranums A/c
(Goods purchased on credit)

Dr.

700
700
32,000
32,000

Bank A/c
Dr.
Discount A/c
Dr.
To Lara India A/c
(Cheque received for final settlement)
Taranums A/c
Dr.
To Purchase Returns A/c
(Goods returned to Tranum)
Stationery A/c
Dr.
To Cash A/c
(Cash paid for stationery)

11,500
500

Taranums A/c
Dr.
To Bank A/c
(Cheque given to Tranum)
Rent A/c
Dr.
To Bank A/c
(Rent paid by cheque)
Drawings A/c
Dr.
To Cash A/c
(Cash withdrawn for personal use)
Cash A/c
Dr.
To Sales A/c
(Goods sold for cash)

20,000

Rupak Trader A/c


To Sales A/c
(Goods sold on credit)

Dr.

12,000
1,500
1,500
1,200
1,200

20,000
4,000
4,000
10,000
10,000
12,000
12,000
11,000
11,000

Total

3,14,900

3,14, 900

Recording of Transactions - I

75

Posting in the Ledger Book :


Cash Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec. 01
Dec. 14
Dec. 30

Capital
Lara India
Sales

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
1,20,000
10,000
12,000

Date
2005
Dec. 02
Dec. 04
Dec. 10
Dec. 18
Dec. 24.
Dec. 29

Particulars

J.F.

Bank
Purchase
Cartage
Trade
Expenses
Stationery
Drawings

Amount
Rs.
40,000
12,000
500
700
1,200
1,000

Capital Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date
2005
Dec.01

Particulars

J.F.

Cash

Amount
Rs.
1,20,000

Bank Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec.02
Dec.20

Cash
Lara India

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
40,000
11,500

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec.26
Dec.28

Taranums
Rent

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
20,000
4,000

Purchases Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec.04
Dec.19

Cash
Taranum

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

12,000
32,000
Cartage Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec.10

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
500

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

76

Accountancy
Lara India Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec.12

Sales

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
25,000

Date
2005
Dec. 14
Dec. 16
Dec. 20

Particulars

J.F.

Cash
Sales return
Bank
Discount

Amount
Rs.
10,000
3,000
11,500
500

Sales Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec.12
Dec.30
Dec.31

Lara India
Cash
Rupak Traders

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
25,000
12,000
11,000

Sales Return Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec.16

Lara India

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

3,000
Trade Expenses Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Dec.18

Particulars

J.F.

Cash

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

Particulars

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

700
Taranum Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Dec.22
Dec.26

Particulars

Purchase
Return
Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
1,500
20,000

Date
2005
Dec.19

Purchase

32,000

Recording of Transactions - I

77
Discount Received Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec.20

Lara India

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

500
Purchases Return Account

Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec.22

J.F.

Taranum

Amount
Rs.
1,500

Stationery Account
Dr.
Date
2005
Dec.

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Cash

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

1,200
Rent Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Dec. 28

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Bank

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

4,000
Drawings Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Dec. 29

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Cash

Amount
Rs.

Date

10,000
Rupak Traders Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Dec. 31

Cr.
Particulars

Sales

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
11,000

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

78

Accountancy
Test Your Understanding - V
Select Right Answer:
1. Voucher is prepared for:
(i)
Cash received and paid
(ii) Cash/Credit sales
(iii) Cash/Credit purchase
(iv) All of the above
2. Voucher is prepared from:
(i)
Documentary evidence
(ii) Journal entry
(iii) Ledger account
(iv) All of the above
3. How many sides does an account have?
(i)
Two
(ii) Three
(iii) one
(iv) None of These
4. A purchase of machine for cash should be debited to:
(i)
Cash account
(ii) Machine account
(iii) Purchase account
(iv) None of these
5. Which of the following is correct?
(i)
Liabilities = Assets
+ Capital
(ii) Assets
= Liabilities
Capital
(iii) Capital
= Assets

Liabilities
(iv) Capital
= Assets
+ Liabilities.
6. Cash withdrawn by the Proprietor should be credited to:
(i)
Drawings account
(ii) Capital account
(iii) Profit and loss account
(iv) Cash account
7. Find the correct statement:
(i)
Credit a decrease in assets
(ii) Credit the increase in expenses
(iii) Debit the increase in revenue
(iv) Credit the increase in capital
8. The book in which all accounts are maintained is known as:
(i)
Cash Book
(ii) Journal
(iii) Purchases Book
(iv) Ledger
9. Recording of transaction in the Journal is called:
(i)
Casting
(ii) Posting
(iii) Journalising
(iv) Recording

Recording of Transactions - I

79

Key Terms Introduced in the Chapter

Source Documents
Accounting Equation
Books of Original Entry
Journalising and Posting
Double Entry Book Keeping

Credit
Debit
Account
Ledger
Journal

Summary with Reference to Learning Objectives


1.

Meaning of source documents : Various business documents such as invoice,


bills, cash memos, vouchers, which form the basis and evidence of a business
transaction recorded in the books of account, are called source documents.

2.

Meaning of accounting equation : A statement of equality between debits and


credits signifying that the assets of a business are always equal to the total
liabilities and capital.

3.

Rules of debit and credit : An account is divided into two sides. The left side of
an account is known as debit and the credit. The rules of debit and credit
depend on the nature of an account. Debit and Credit both represent either
increase or decrease, depending on the nature of an account. These rules are
summarised as follows :
Name of an account
Assets
Liabilities
Capital
Revenues
Expenses

Debit
Increase
Decrease
Decrease
Decrease
increase

Credit
Decrease
Increase
Increase
Increase
Decrease

4.

Books of Original entry : The transactions are first recorded in these books in
a chronological order. Journal is one of the books of original entry. The process
of recording entries in the journal is called journalising.

5.

Ledger : A book containing all accounts to which entries are transferred from
the books of original entry. Posting is process of transferring entries from
books of original entry to the ledger.
Questions for Practice

Short Answers
1. States the three fundamental steps in the accounting process.
2. Why is the evidence provided by source documents important to accounting?
3. Should a transaction be first recorded in a journal or ledger? Why?
4. Are debits or credits listed first in journal entries? Are debits or credits
indented?
5. Why are some accounting systems called double accounting systems?
6. Give a specimen of an account.

80

Accountancy
7. Why are the rules of debit and credit same for both liability and capital?
8. What is the purpose of posting J.F numbers that are entered in the journal at
the time entries are posted to the accounts.
9. What entry (debit or credit) would you make to: (a) increase revenue (b) decrease
in expense, (c) record drawings (d) record the fresh capital introduced by the
owner.
10. If a transaction has the effect of decreasing an asset, is the decrease recorded
as a debit or as a credit? If the transaction has the effect of decreasing a
liability, is the decrease recorded as a debit or as a credit?
Long Answers
1. Describe the events recorded in accounting systems and the importance of
source documents in those systems?
2. Describe how debits and credits are used to analyse transactions.
3. Describe how accounts are used to record information about the effects of
transactions?
4. What is a journal? Give a specimen of journal showing at least five entries.
5. Differentiate between source documents and vouchers.
6. Accounting equation remains intact under all circumstances. Justify the
statement with the help of an example.
7. Explain the double entry mechanism with an illustrative example.
Numerical Questions
Analysis of Transactions
1. Prepare accounting equation on the basis of the following :
(a) Harsha started business with cash
Rs.2,00,000
(b) Purchased goods from Naman for cash
Rs. 40,000
(c) Sold goods to Bhanu costing Rs.10,000/Rs. 12,000
(d) Bought furniture on credit
Rs. 7,000
(Ans: Asset = cash Rs. 1,60,000 + Goods Rs. 30,000 + Debtors Rs. 12,000
+ Furniture Rs. 7,000 = Rs. 2,09,000; Liabilities = Creditors Rs. 7,000 +
Capital Rs. 2,02,000 = Rs. 2,09,000)
2. Prepare accounting equation from the following:
(a) Kunal started business with cash
Rs.2,50000
(b) He purchased furniture for cash
Rs. 35,000

Recording of Transactions - I
(c) He paid commission

81
Rs. 2,000

(d) He purchases goods on credit

Rs. 40,000

(e) He sold goods (Costing Rs.20,000) for cash

Rs. 26,000

(Ans: Asset = Cash Rs. 2,39,000 + Furniture Rs. 35,000 + Goods Rs. 20,000
= Rs. 2,94,000; Liabilities = Creditors Rs. 40,000 + Capital Rs. 2,54,000=
Rs. 2,94,000)
3.

Mohit has the following transactions, prepare accounting equation:


(a) Business started with cash

Rs. 1,75,000

(b) Purchased goods from Rohit

Rs. 50,000

(c) Sales goods on credit to Manish (Costing Rs. 17,500)

Rs. 20,000

(d) Purchased furniture for office use

Rs. 10,000

(e) Cash paid to Rohit in full settlement

Rs. 48,500

(f) Cash received from Manish

Rs. 20,000

(g) Rent paid

Rs. 1,000

(h) Cash withdrew for personal use

Rs. 3,000

(Ans: Cash Rs. 1,33,000 + Goods Rs. 32,500 + Furniture Rs. 10,000
= Rs. 1,75,500; Liabilition = Capital Rs. 1,77,500)
4.

Rohit has the following transactions :


(a) Commenced business with cash

Rs.1,50,000

(b) Purchased machinery on credit

Rs. 40,000

(c) Purchased goods for cash

Rs. 20,000

(d) Purchased car for personal use

Rs. 80,000

(e) Paid to creditors in full settlement

Rs. 38,000

(f) Sold goods for cash costing Rs. 5,000

Rs. 4,500

(g) Paid rent

Rs. 1,000

(h) Commission received in advance

Rs. 2,000

Prepare the Accounting Equation to show the effect of the above


transactions on the assets, liabilities and capital.
(Ans: Assets = Cash Rs. 17,500 + Machine Rs. 40,000 + Goods Rs. 15,000
= Rs. 72,500; Liabilities = Commission Rs. 2,000 + Capital Rs. 70,500
= Rs. 72,500)
5.

Use accounting equation to show the effect of the following transactions of


M/s Royal Traders:
(a) Started business with cash
(b) Purchased goods for cash

Rs.1,20,000
Rs. 10,000

(c) Rent received

Rs. 5,000

(d) Salary outstanding

Rs. 2,000

(e) Prepaid Insurance

Rs. 1,000

82

Accountancy
(f) Received interest
(g) Sold goods for cash (Costing Rs. 5,000)
(h) Goods destroyed by fire

Rs. 700
Rs. 7,000
Rs. 500

(Ans: Assets = Cash Rs. 1,22,700 + Goods Rs. 4,500 + Prepaid insurance
Rs. 1,000; Liabilities = Outstanding salary Rs. 2,000 + Capital Rs. 1,26,200)
6.

Show the accounting Equation on the basis of the following transaction:


(a)

Udit started business with:

(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)

(i) Cash
(ii) Goods
Purchased building for cash
Purchased goods from Himani
Sold goods to Ashu (Cost Rs. 25,000)
Paid insurance premium
Rent outstanding
Depreciation on building
Cash withdrawn for personal use
Rent received in advance
Cash paid to himani on account
Cash received from Ashu

Rs. 5,00,000
Rs. 1,00,000
Rs. 2, 00,000
Rs. 50,000
Rs. 36, 000
Rs. 3,000
Rs. 5,000
Rs. 8,000
Rs. 20,000
Rs. 5,000
Rs. 20,000
Rs. 30,000

(Ans : Assets = Cash Rs. 2,92,000 + Goods Rs. 1,25,000 + Building


Rs. 1,92,000 + Debitors Rs. 6,000 = 6,15,000: Laibilities = Creditors
Rs. 30,000 + Outstanding Rent Rs. 5,000 + Rent Rs. 5,000 + Capital
Rs. 5,75,000 = Rs. 6,15,000)
7.

Show the effect of the following transactions on Assets, Liabilities and


Capital through accounting equation:
(a) Started business with cash

Rs. 1,20,000

(b) Rent received

Rs. 10,000

(c) Invested in shares

Rs. 50,000

(d) Received dividend


(e) Purchase goods on credit from Ragani
(f) Paid cash for house hold Expenses

Rs. 5,000
Rs. 35,000
Rs. 7,000

(g) Sold goods for cash (costing Rs.10,000)

Rs. 14,000

(h) Cash paid to Ragani

Rs. 35,000

(i) Deposited into bank

Rs. 20,000

(Ans: Assets = Cash Rs. 37,000 + Shares Rs. 50,000 + Goods Rs. 25,000 +
Bank Rs. 20,000 = Rs. 1,32,000; Liabilities = Capital Rs. 1,32,000)
8.

Show the effect of following transaction on the accounting equation:


(a) Manoj started business with
(i)

Cash

Rs. 2,30,000

Recording of Transactions - I
(ii)

Goods

(iii) Building
(b) He purchased goods for cash

83
Rs. 1,00,000
Rs. 2,00,000
Rs. 50,000

(c) He sold goods(costing Rs.20,000)

Rs. 35,000

(d) He purchased goods from Rahul

Rs. 55,000

(e) He sold goods to Varun (Costing Rs. 52,000)

Rs. 60,000

(f) He paid cash to Rahul in full settlement

Rs. 53,000

(g) Salary paid by him

Rs. 20,000

(h) Received cash from Varun in full settlement

Rs. 59,000

(i) Rent outstanding


(j) Prepaid Insurance
(k) Commission received by him
(l) Amount withdrawn by him for personal use

Rs. 3,000
Rs. 2,000
Rs. 13, 000
Rs. 20,000

(m) Depreciation charge on building

Rs. 10,000

(n) Fresh capital invested

Rs. 50,000

(o) Purchased goods from Rakhi

Rs. 6,000

(Ans: Assets = Cash Rs. 2,42,000 + Goods Rs. 1,43,000 +Building Rs.1,90,000
+ Prepaid Insurouce Rs. 2,000 = Rs. 5,77,000; Liabilities = Outstanding Rent
Rs. 3,000 + Creditor Rs. 10,000 + Capital Rs. 5,64,000 = Rs. 5,77,000)
9.

Transactions of M/s Vipin Traders are given below.


Show the effects on Assets, Liabilities and Capital with the help of accounting
Equation.
(a) Business started with cash

Rs. 1,25,000

(b) Purchased goods for cash

Rs. 50,000

(c) Purchase furniture from R.K. Furniture

Rs. 10,000

(d) Sold goods to Parul Traders (Costing Rs. 7,000 vide


bill no. 5674)
(e) Paid cartage
(f) Cash Paid to R.K. furniture in full settlement
(g) Cash sales (costing Rs.10,000)
(h) Rent received
(i) Cash withdrew for personal use

Rs.9,000
Rs. 100
Rs. 9,700
Rs. 12,000
Rs. 4,000
Rs. 3,000

(Ans: Asset = cash Rs. 78,200 + Goods Rs. 33,000 + Furniture Rs. 10,000
Debtors Rs. 9,000= Rs. 1,30,200; Liabilities = Capital Rs. 1,30,200)
10.

Bobby opened a consulting firm and completed these transactions during


November, 2005:

84

Accountancy
(a) Invested Rs. 4,00,000 cash and office equipment with Rs. 1,50,000 in
a business called Bobbie Consulting.
(b) Purchased land and a small office building. The land was worth
Rs. 1,50,000 and the building worth Rs. 3, 50,000. The purchase price
was price was paid with Rs. 2,00,000 cash and a long term note payable
for Rs. 8,00,000.
(c) Purchased office supplies on credit for Rs. 12,000.
(d) Bobbie transferred title of motor car to the business. The motor car
was worth Rs. 90,000.
(e) Purchased for Rs. 30,000 additional office equipment on credit.
(f) Paid Rs. 75,00 salary to the office manager.
(g) Provided services to a client and collected Rs. 30,000
(h) Paid Rs. 4,000 for the months utilities.
(i) Paid supplier created in transaction c.
(j) Purchase new office equipment by paying Rs. 93,000 cash and trading
in old equipment with a recorded cost of Rs. 7,000.
(k) Completed services of a client for Rs. 26,000. This amount is to be
paid within 30 days.
(l) Received Rs. 19,000 payment from the client created in transaction k.
(m) Bobby withdrew Rs. 20,000 from the business.
Analyse the above stated transactions and open the following T-accounts:
Cash, client, office supplies, motor car, building, land, long term payables,
capital, withdrawals, salary, expense and utilities expense.
Journalising
11.

Journalise the following transactions in the books of Himanshu:


2005
Dec.01

12.

Rs.
Business started with cash

75,000

Dec.07

Purchased goods for cash

10,000

Dec.09

Sold goods to Swati

5,000

Dec.12

Purchased furniture

3,000

Dec.18

Cash received from Swati In full settlement

4,000

Dec.25

Paid rent

1,000

Dec.30

Paid salary

1,500

Enter the following Transactions in the Journal of Mudit :


2006

Rs.

Jan.01

Commenced business with cash

1,75,000

Jan.01

Building

1,00,000

Jan.02

Goods purchased for cash

75,000

Recording of Transactions - I
Jan.03

Sold goods to Ramesh

Jan.04

Paid wages

Jan.06

Sold goods for cash

Jan.10

Paid for trade expenses

Jan.12

Cash received from Ramesh

Jan.14

Goods purchased for Sudhir

Jan.18

Cartage paid

85
30,000
500
10,000
700
29,500

Discount allowed

500
27,000
1,000

Jan.20

Drew cash for personal use

5,000

Jan.22

Goods use for house hold

2,000

Jan.25

Cash paid to Sudhir

26,700

Discount allowed
13.

300

Journalise the following transactions:


2005

Rs.

Dec. 01

Hema started business with cash

1,00,000

Dec. 02

Open a bank account with SBI

30,000

Dec. 04

Purchased goods from Ashu

20,000

Dec.06

Sold goods to Rahul for cash

15,000

Dec.10

Bought goods from Tara for cash

40,000

Dec.13

Sold goods to Suman

20,000

Dec.16

Received cheque from Suman

19,500

Discount allowed
Dec.20

14.

Cheque given to Ashu on account

500
10,000

Dec.22

Rent paid by cheque

2,000

Dec.23

Deposited into bank

16,000
10,000

Dec.25

Machine purchased from Parigya

Dec.26

Trade expenses

Dec.28

Cheque issued to Parigya

Dec.29

Paid telephone expenses by cheque

1,200

Dec.31

Paid salary

4,500

2,000
10,000

Jouranlise the following transactions in the books of Harpreet Bros.:


(a) Rs.1,000 due from Rohit are now a bad debts.
(b) Goods worth Rs.2,000 were used by the proprietor.
(c) Charge depreciation @ 10% p.a for two month on machine costing
Rs.30,000.
(d) Provide interest on capital of Rs. 1,50,000 at 6% p.a. for 9 months.

86

Accountancy
(e) Rahul become insolvent, who owed is Rs. 2,000 a final dividend of
60 paise in a rupee is received from his estate.
15.

Prepare Journal from the transactions given below :


(a) Cash paid for installation of machine

Rs. 500

(b) Goods given as charity

Rs. 2,000

(c) Interest charge on capital @7% p.a. when total


capital were

Rs. 70,000

(d) Received Rs.1,200 of a bad debts written-off last year.


(e) Goods destroyed by fire

Rs. 2,000

(f) Rent outstanding

Rs. 1,000

(g) Interest on drawings

Rs. 900

(h) Sudhir Kumar who owed me Rs. 3,000 has failed to pay the amount.
He pays me a compensation of 45 paise in a rupee.
(i) Commission received in advance

Rs. 7,000

Posting
16.

Journalise the following transactions, post to the ledger:


2005

Rs.

Nov. 01

Business started with (i) Cash

Nov. 03

Purchased goods from Harish

30,000

Nov. 05

Sold goods for cash

12,000

(ii) Goods

50,000

Nov. 08

Purchase furniture for cash

Nov. 10

Cash paid to Harish on account

15,000

Nov.
Nov.
Nov.
Nov.
Nov.
Nov.
Nov.
Nov.
Nov.

Paid sundry expenses


Cash sales
Deposited into bank
Drew cash for personal use
Cash paid to Harish in full settlement of account
Good sold to Nitesh
Cartage paid
Rent paid
Received cash from Nitesh
Discount allowed
Salary paid

200
15,000
5,000
1,000
14,700
7,000
200
1,500
6,800
200
3,000

13
15
18
20
22
25
26
27
29

Nov. 30
17.

1,50,000

Journalise the following transactions is the journal of M/s Goel


Brothers and post them to the ledger.
2006
Jan. 01

Started business with cash

5,000

Rs.
1,65,000

Recording of Transactions - I

18

Jan.
Jan.
Jan.
Jan.
Jan.
Jan.

02
04
05
08
10
15

Jan.
Jan.
Jan.
Jan.
Jan.
Jan.
Jan.
Jan.
Jan.
Jan.
Jan.

16
18
20
22
23
24
26
27
28
29
30

Open bank account in PNB


Goods purchased from Tara
Goods purchased for cash
Goods sold to Naman
Cash paid to tara
Cash received from Naman
Discount allowed
Paid wages
Furniture purchased for office use
withdrawn from bank for personal use
Issued cheque for rent
goods issued for house hold purpose
drawn cash from bank for office use
Commission received
Bank charges
Cheque given for insurance premium
Paid salary
Cash sales

80,000
22,000
30,000
12,000
22,000
11,700
300
200
5,000
4,000
3,000
2,000
6,000
1,000
200
3,000
7,000
10,000

Give journal entries of M/s Mohit traders, Post them to the Ledger
from the following transactions :
August 2005
1.
2.
3.
7.
8.
10.
14.
16.
18.
20.
22.
23.
25.
30.

19.

87

Commenced business with cash


Opened bank account with H.D.F.C.
Purchased furniture
Bought goods for cash from M/s Rupa Traders
Purchased good from M/s Hema Traders
Sold goods for cash
Sold goods on credit to M/s. Gupta Traders
Rent paid
Paid trade expenses
Received cash from Gupta Traders
Goods return to Hema Traders.
Cash paid to Hema Traders
Bought postage stamps
Paid salary to Rishabh

Rs.
1,10,000
50,000
20,000
30,000
42,000
30,000
12,000
4,000
1,000
12,000
2,000
40,000
100
4,000

Journalise the following transaction in the Books of the M/s Bhanu


Traders and Post them into the Ledger.
December, 2005
Rs.
1. Started business with cash
92,000
2. Deposited into bank
60,000

88

Accountancy
4.
6.
8.
10.
14.
17.
19.
21.
22.
26.
28.
29.
30.
31.
20.

40,000
20,000
4,000
20,000
36,000
3,50,000
2,000
3,500
20,000
31,500
2,000
3,000
7,000
3,000

Journalise the following transaction in the Book of M/s Beauti


traders. Also post them in the ledger.
1.
2.
3.
5.
6.
8.
9.
12.
14.
15.
16.
18.
20.
22.
24.
26.
28.
29.
30.

21.

Bought goods on credit from Himani


Purchased goods from cash
Returned goods to Himani
Sold goods for cash
Cheque given to Himani
Goods sold to M/s Goyal Traders.
Drew cash from bank for personal use
Goyal traders returned goods
Cash deposited into bank
Cheque received from Goyal Traders
Goods given as charity
Rent paid
Salary paid
Office machine purchased for cash

Dec. 2005
Started business with cash
Bought office furniture
Paid into bank to open an current account
Purchased a computer and paid by cheque
Bought goods on credit from Ritika
Cash sales
Sold goods to Karishna on credit
Cash paid to Mansi on account
Goods returned to Ritika
Stationery purchased for cash
Paid wages
Goods returned by Karishna
Cheque given to Ritika
Cash received from Karishna on account
Insurance premium paid by cheque
Cheque received from Karishna
Rent paid by cheque
Purchased goods on credit from Meena Traders
Cash sales

Rs.
2,00,000
30,000
1,00,000
2,50,000
60,000
30,000
25,000
30,000
2,000
3,000
1,000
2,000
28,000
15,000
4,000
8,000
3,000
20,000
14,000

Journalise the following transaction in the books of Sanjana and


post them into the ledger :

Recording of Transactions - I
January, 2006
1. Cash in hand
Cash at bank
Stock of goods
Due to Rohan
Due from Tarun
3. Sold goods to Karuna
4. Cash sales
6. Goods sold to Heena
8. Purchased goods from Rupali
10. Goods returned from Karuna
14. Cash received from Karuna
15. Cheque given to Rohan
16. Cash received from Heena
20. Cheque received from Tarun
22. Cheque received from to Heena
25. Cash given to Rupali
26. Paid cartage
27. Paid salary
28. Cash sale
29. Cheque given to Rupali
30. Sanjana took goods for Personal use
31. Paid General expense

89
Rs.
6,000
55,000
40,000
6,000
10,000
15,000
10,000
5,000
30,000
2,000
13,000
6,000
3,000
10.000
2,000
18,000
1,000
8,000
7,000
12,000
4,000
500

Checklist to Test Your Understanding


Test Your Understanding - I
1. (iii), 2 (Capital increases by net profit and fresh capital introduced, decreases
by drawings and net loss), 3 (No), 4 (ii)
Test Your Understanding - II
1. Cash account and capital account, Assets and Liabilities, Assest increase
and capital increase.
2. Purchase account and Remesh account, Expenses and Liabilities, Expenses
and Liabilities increases.
3. Cash account and sales account, Assets and Revenues, Assets and Revenues
increases.
4. Salaries account and cash account, Expense and Assets, Expenses increases
Assets decreases.
5. Furniture account and Cash account, Asset increases Asset decreases.
6. Loan account and Bank, Liability and Asset, Liabilities increases Asset
decreases.

90

Accountancy
7. Sarita account and Sales account, Asset and Revenue, Assets decreases
Revenue decreases.
8. Ramesh account and Cash, liabilities and Assets, Liabilities decreases Assets
increases.
9. Rent account and Cash account, Expense and Assets, Expenses increases
Assets decreases.
Test Your Understanding - III
1(d),

2(d),

3(b),

4(b),

5(d),

6(c),

7(a)

Test your understanding - IV


1. Rent
4. Machine
7. Debtors

2. Debtors
5. Creditors

3. Cash
6. Office stationary

Test Your Understanding - V


1 (iv),

2 (i),

3 (i),

4 (ii),

5 (iii),

6 (iv),

7 (iv),

8 (iv),

9 (iii).

Recording of Transactions-II

LEARNING OBJECTIVES
After studying this
chapter, you will be able
to :
state the need for
special purpose books;
record the transactions
in cash book and post
them in the ledger;
prepare the petty cash
book;
record the transactions
in the special purpose
books;
post the entries in the
special purpose book
and to the ledger;
balance the ledger
accounts.

n chapter 3, you lear nt that all the


business transactions are first recorded in the
journal and then they are posted in the ledger
accounts. A small business may be able to record
all its transactions in one book only, i.e., the journal.
But as the business expands and the number of
transactions becomes large, it may become
cumbersome to jour-nalise each transaction. For
quick, efficient and accurate recording of business
transactions, Journal is sub-divided into special
journals. Many of the business transactions are
repetitive in nature. They can be easily recorded in
special journals, each meant for recording all the
transactions of a similar nature. For example, all
cash transactions may be recorded in one book, all credit
sales transactions in another book and all credit
purchases transactions in yet another book and so on.
These special journals are also called daybooks or
subsidiary books. Transactions that cannot be recorded
in any special journal are recorded in journal called the
Journal Proper. Special journals prove economical and
make division of labour possible in accounting work. In
this chapter we will discuss the following special purpose
books:
Cash Book
Purchases Book
Purchases Return (Return Outwards) Book
Sales Book
Sales Return (Return Inwards) Book
Journal Proper

Recording of Transactions - II

92

4.1 Cash Book


Cash book is a book in which all transactions relating to cash receipts and
cash payments are recorded. It starts with the cash or bank balances at the
beginning of the period. Generally, it is made on monthly basis. This is a very
popular book and is maintained by all organisations, big or small, profit or
not-for-profit. It serves the purpose of both journal as well as the ledger (cash)
account. It is also called the book of original entry. When a cashbook is
maintained, transactions of cash are not recorded in the journal, and no
separate account for cash or bank is required in the ledger.
4.1.1 Single Column Cash Book
The single column cash book records all cash transactions of the business in
a chronological order, i.e., it is a complete record of cash receipts and cash
payments. When all receipts and payments are made in cash by a business
organisation only, the cash book contains only one amount column on each
(debit and credit) side. The format of single column cash book is shown in
figure 4.1.
Cash Book
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

L.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

L.F.

Amount
Rs.

Fig. 4.1 : Format of single column cash book

Recording of entries in the single column cash book and its balancing is
illustrated by an example. Consider the following transactions of M/s Roopa
Traders observe how they are recorded in a single column cash book.
Date

Details

Amount
Rs.

2005
Nov. 01
Nov. 04
Nov. 08
Nov. 13
Nov. 16
Nov. 17
Nov. 20
Nov. 24

Cash in hand
Cash received from Gurmeet
Insurance paid (Annual Instalment)
Purchased furniture
Sold goods for cash
Purchased goods from Mudit in cash
Purchase stationery
Cash paid to Rukmani in full settlement of account

30,000
12,000
6,000
13,800
28,000
17,400
1,100
12,500

Recording of Transactions - II
Nov.
Nov.
Nov.
Nov.

27
30
30
30

93

Sold goods to Kamal for cash


Paid monthly rent
Paid salary
Deposited in bank

18,200
2,500
3,500
8,000

Roopa Traders
Cash Book
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Nov. 01
Nov. 04
Nov. 16
Nov. 27

Balance b/d
Gurmeet
Sales
Sales

Dec.01

Balance b/d

L.F.

Amount
Rs.
30,000
12,000
28,000
18,200

Date

Particulars

2005
Nov. 08
Nov. 13
Nov. 17
Nov. 20
Nov. 24
Nov. 30
Nov. 30
Nov. 30
Nov. 30

Insurance
Furniture
Purchases
Stationery
Rukmani
Rent
Salary
Bank
Balance c/d

88,200

L.F.

Amount
Rs.
6,000
13,800
17,400
1,100
12,500
2,500
3,500
8,000
23,400
88,200

23,400

Posting of the Single Column Cash Book


As evident from figure 4.1, the left side of the cash book shows the receipts of
the cash whereas the right side of the cash book shows all the payments
made in cash. The accounts appearing on then debit side for the cash book
are credited in the respective ledger accounts because cash has been received
in respect of them. Thus, in our example, an entry cash received from Gurmeet
appears on the debit side of the cash book conveys that the cash has been
received from Gurmeet. Therefore, in the ledger, Gurmeets account will be
credited by writing Cash in the particulars column on the credit side. Similarly,
all the account names appearing on the credit side of the cash book are debited
as cash/cheque has been paid in respect of them. Now, notice, how the
transactions in our example are posted to the related ledger accounts:

Recording of Transactions - II

94
Books of Roopa Traders
Gurmeets Account

Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

2005
Nov.04

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
12,000

Sales Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

2005
Nov. 16
Nov. 27

Cash
Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
28,000
18,200

Insurance Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Nov. 08

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Particulars

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

Particulars

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

Particulars

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

6,000
Furniture Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Nov. 13

Particulars

J.F.

Cash

Amount
Rs.

Date

13,800
Purchases Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Nov. 17

Particulars

J.F.

Cash

Amount
Rs.

Date

17,400
Stationery Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Nov. 20

Particulars

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
1,100

Date

Recording of Transactions - II

95
Rukmanis Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Nov.24

Particulars

J.F.

Cash

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

Particulars

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

Particulars

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

Particulars

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

12,500
Rent Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Nov.30

Particulars

J.F.

Cash

Amount
Rs.

Date

2,500
Salary Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Nov. 30

Particulars

J.F.

Cash

Amount
Rs.

Date

3,500
Banks Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Nov.30

Particulars

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

8,000

4.1.2 Double Column Cash Book


In this type of cash book, there are two columns of amount on each side of the
cash book. In fact, now-a-days bank transactions are very large in number. In
many organisations, as far as possible, all receipts and payments are affected
through bank.
A businessman generally opens a current account with a bank. Bank, do
not allow any interest on the balance in current account but charge a small
amount, called incidental charges, for the services rendered.
For depositing cash/cheques in the bank account, a form has to be filled,
which is called a pay-in-slip. (refer figure 4.2) It contains a counterfoil also
which is returned to the customer (depositor) with the signature of the cashier,
as receipt.
The bank issues blank cheque forms, to the account holder for withdrawing
money. (refer figure 4.3) The depositor writes the name of the party to whom
payment is to be made after the words Pay printed on the cheque. Cheque

Recording of Transactions - II

96

Fig. 4.2 : A pay-in-slip

Fig. 4.3 : A cheque

forms have the printed word bearer, which means payment is to be made to
the person whose name has been written after the words pay or the bearer
of the cheques. When the world bearer is struck off by drawing a line, the
cheque becomes an order cheque. It means payment is to be made to the
person whose name is written on the cheque or to his order after proper
identification.
Cheques are generally crossed in practice. The payment of a crossed cheque
cannot be made direct to the party on the counter. It is to be paid only through
a bank. When two parallel lines are drawn across the cheque, it is said to be
crossed. The various types of crossing providing different degrees of safety to
the payment are shown in figure 4.4.

Recording of Transactions - II

97

ly

Ind

ee
Sta

te

Ba

A/

nk

cP

of

ay

go
tN
e
No

ia,

On

ble
tia

.
Co
&

Ne

De

lhi

In case of an A/c payee only crossing, the amount of the cheque can be
deposited only in the account of the person whose name appears on the cheque.
When the name of the bank is written between two parallel lines, it becomes a
special crossing and the payment can be made only to the bank whose name
has been written between the two lines.
Though this is rarely done, a cheque can be transferred by the payee (the
person in whose favour the cheque has been drawn) to another person, if it is
not crossed A/c payee only. A bearer cheque can be passed on by mere delivery.
An order cheque can be transferred by endorsement and delivery. Endorsement
means the writing of instructions to pay the cheque to a particular person
and then singing it on the back of the cheque.

Fig. 4.4 : Types of crossing

When the number of bank transactions is large; it is convenient to have a


separate amount column for bank transactions in the cash book itself instead
of recording them in the journal. This helps in getting information about the
position of the bank account from time to time. Just like cash transactions,
all payments into the bank are recorded on the left side and all withdrawals/
payments through the bank are recorded on the right side. When cash is
deposited in the bank or cash is withdrawn from the bank, both the entries
are recorded in the cash book. This is so because both aspects of the transaction
appear in the cash book itself. When cash is paid into the bank, the amount
deposited is written on the left side in the bank column and at the same time
the same amount is entered on the right side in the cash column. The reverse
entries are recorded when cash is withdrawn from the bank for use in the
office. Against such entries the word C, which stands for contra is written in
the L.F. column indicating that these entries are not to be posted to the ledger
account.

Recording of Transactions - II

98

The bank column is balanced in the same way as the cash column. However,
in the bank column, there can be credit balance also because of overdraft
taken from the bank. Overdraft is a situation when cash withdrawn from the
bank exceeds the amount of deposit. Entries in respect of cheques received
should be made in the bank column of the cash book. When a cheque is
received, it may be deposited into the bank on the same day or it may be
deposited on another day. In case, it is deposited on the same day the amount
is recorded in the bank column of the cash book on the receipts side. If the
cheque is deposited on another day, in that case, on the date of receipt it is
treated as cash received and hence recorded in the cash column on the receipts
side. On the day of deposit to the bank, it is shown in the Bank Column on
receipt (Dr.) side and in the Cash Column on the payment (Cr.) side. This is a
contra entry.
If a cheque received from a customer is dishonoured, the bank will return
the dishonoured cheque and debit the firms account. On receipt of such
cheque or intimation from the bank, the firm will make an entry on the credit
side of the cash book by entering the amount of the dishonoured cheque in
the bank column and the name of the customer in the particulars column.
This entry will restore the position prevailing before the receipt of the cheque
form the customer and its deposit in the bank. Dishonour of a cheque means
return of the cheque unpaid, generally due to insufficient funds in the
customers account with the bank.
If the bank debits the firm on account of interest, commission or other
charges for bank services, the entry will be made on the credit side in bank
column. If the bank credits the firms account, the entry will be made on the
debit side of the cash book in the appropriate column. The format of double
column cash book is shown in figure 4.5.
Cash Book
Dr.
Date Particulars

Cr.
L.F.

Cash
Rs.

Bank Date
Rs.

Particulars

L.F.

Fig. 4.5 : Format of a double column cashbook

Cash
Rs.

Bank
Rs.

Recording of Transactions - II

99

We will now learn how the transactions are recorded in the double column
cash book.
Consider the following example:
The following transactions related to M/s Tools India :
Date

Details

Amount
Rs.

Bank balance
Cash balance
Purchased goods by cheque
Sales of goods for cash
Purchased machinery by cheque
Sold goods and received cheque (deposited same day)
Purchase goods from Mriaula in cash
Purchase stationery by cheque
Cheque given to Rohit
Cash withdrawn from bank
Rent paid by cheque
Paid salary

42,000
15,000
12,000
6,000
5,500
4,500
17,400
1,100
1,500
10,000
2,500
3,500

2005
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.

01
01
04
08
13
16
17
20
24
27
30
30

The double column cash book based upon above business transactions will
prepared as follows :
Cash Book
Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars
2005
Sept.
01
08
16
27

Oct.
01

Balance b/d
Sales
Sales
Bank

Balance b/d

L.F.

Cash
Rs.

15,000
6,000

Bank Date
Rs.

42,000
4,500

C 10,000

31,000

46,500

10,100

13,900

2005
Sept.
04
13
17
20
24
27
30
30
30

Particulars

Purchases
Machine
Purchase
Stationery
Rohit
Cash
Rent
Salary
Balance c/d

L.F.

Cash
Rs.

Bank
Rs.

12,000
5,500
17,400

1,100
1,500
10,000
2,500
3,500
10,100 13,900
31,000 46,500

Recording of Transactions - II

100

Posting of the Double Column Cash Book


When the bank column is maintained in the cash book, the bank account
also is not opened in the ledger. The bank column serves the purpose of the
bank account. Entries marked C (being contra entries as explained earlier)
are ignored while posting from the cash book to the ledger. These entries
represent debit or credit of cash account against the bank account or viceversa. We will now see how the transactions recorded in double column cash
book are posted to the individual accounts.
Purchases Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Sept.04
Sept. 17

Bank
Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

12,000
17,400
Sales Account

Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

2005
Sept. 08
Sept. 16

Cash
Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
6,000
4,500

Machinery Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2005
Sept. 13

Bank

5,500
Stationery Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Sept.20

Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
1,100

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Recording of Transactions - II

101
Rohits Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Sept.24

Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

1,500
Rent Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Sept.30

Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2,500
Salary Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Sept.30

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

3,500

4.1.3 Petty Cash Book


In every organisation, a large number of small payments such as conveyance,
cartage, postage, telegrams and other expenses (collectively recorded under
miscellaneous expenses) are made. These are generally repetitive in nature. If
all these payments are handled by the cashier and are recorded in the main
cash book, the procedure is found to be very cumbersome. The cashier may
be overburdened and the cash book may become very bulky. To avoid this,
large organisations normally appoint one more cashier (petty cashier) and
maintain a separate cash book to record these transactions. Such a cash
book maintained by petty cashier is called petty cash book.
The petty cashier works on the Imprest system. Under this system, a definite
sum, say Rs. 2,000 is given to the petty cashier at the beginning of a certain
period. This amount is called imprest amount. The petty cashier goes on making
all small payments out of this imprest amount and when he has spent the
substantial portion of the imprest amount say Rs.1,780, he gets reimbursement
of the amount spent from the head cashier. Thus, he again has the full imprest
amount in the beginning of the next period. The reimbursement may be made
on a weekly, fortnightly or monthly basis, depending on the frequency of small
payments. (In certain cases, the petty cash system is operated through the

Recording of Transactions - II

102

main cash book itself. In such instances, the petty cash book is not maintained
independently.)
The petty cash book generally has a number of columns for the amount on
the payment side (credit) besides the first other amount column. Each of the
amount columns is allotted for items of specific payments, which are most
common. The last amount column is designated as Miscellaneous followed
by a Remarks column. In the miscellaneous column those payments are
recorded for which a separate column does not exist. In the Remarks the
nature of payment is recorded. At the end of the period, all amount columns
are totaled. The total amount column l shows the total amount spent and to
be reimbursed. On the receipt (debit) side, there is only one amount column.
Columns for the date, voucher number and particulars are common for both
receipts and payments.
Box 1
Advantages of Maintaining Petty Cash Book
1. Saving of Time and efforts of chief cashier: The chief cashier is not required to
deal with petty disbursements. He can concentrate on cash transactions involving
large amount of cash. It saves time and labour and helps chief cashier to discharge
his duties more effectively
2. Effective control over cash disbursements: Cash control becomes easy because of
division of work. The head cashier can control big payments directly and petty
payments by keeping a proper check on the petty cashier. This way the chances
of making frauds and embezzlements become very difficult.
3. Convenient recording: Recording of petty disbursements in the main cash book
makes it bulky and unmanageable. Further, the materiality principle requires
that insignificant details need not be given in the main cashbook. This way the
cash book reveals only material and useful information.
Recording of such small payments becomes easy as the totals of different types
of expenses are posted to ledger. It also saves time and effort of posting individual
items in the ledger. In nutshell it can be stated that preparation of petty cash
book is a cost reduction control measure.

For example, Mr. Mohit, the petty cahier of M/s Samaira Traders received
Rupees 2,000 on May 01, 2005 from the Head Cashier. For the month, details
of petty expenses are listed here under:

Recording of Transactions - II
Date

Details

103
Amount
Rs.

2005
May
02
03
04
05
06
08
08
10
12
13
14
16
19
19
20
22
23
28
29
30

Auto fare
Courier services
Postal stamps
Erasers/Sharpeners/Pencils/Pads
Speed post charges
Taxi fare (Rs.105 + Rs.90)
Refreshments
Auto fare
Registered postal charges
Telegram
Cartage
Computer stationery
Bus fare
STD call charges
Office sanitation including disinfectant (Rs. 36 + Rs. 24)
Refreshment
Photo stating charges
Courier services
Unloading charges
Bus fare

55
40
105
225
98
195
85
60
42
34
25
165
24
87
60
45
47
40
40
15

Posting from the Petty Cash Book


The petty cash book is balanced periodically. The difference between the total
receipts and total payments is the balance with the petty cashier. The balance is
carried to the next period and the petty cashier is paid the amount actually spent.
A petty cash account is opened in the ledger. It is debited with the amount given
to petty cashier. Each expense account is individually debited with the periodic
total as per the respective column by writing petty cash account and the petty
cash account is credited with the total expenditure incurred during the period by
writing sundries as per petty cash book. The petty cash account is balanced. It
reflect the actual cash with the petty cashier.

Balance c/d

Cash received
Auto fare
Courier services
Postal stamps
Erasers/Sharpeners
/Pencils
Speed post charges
Taxi fare (105 + 90)
Refreshments
Auto fare
Registered postal
charges
Telegram
Cartage
Computer stationery
Bus fare
STD call charges
Office sanitation
including disinfectant
(36+24)
Refreshment
Photo stating charges
Courier services
Unloading charges
Bus fare

Particulars

Jun.
513 01
Balance b/d
1,487 01
Cash received

2,000

31

22
23
28
29
30

13
14
16
19
19
20

06
08
08
10
12

Amount Date
Received
Rs.
2005
May
2,000 01
02
03
04
05

Voucher
No.

513
2,000

45
47
40
40
15
1,487

34
25
165
24
87
60

98
195
85
60
42

55
40
105
225

Amount
paid
Rs.

325

40

42

98

40
105

Postage

121

87

34

Telephone
& Telegram

15
349

24

60

195

55

Conveyance

Analysis of Payments

Book of Samaira Traders


Petty Cash Book

The petty cash book for the month will be prepared as follows :

390

165

225

Stationery

302

40

45
47

60

25

85

Misc.

Recording of Transactions - II
104

Recording of Transactions - II

105
Books of Samaira Traders
Journal

Date

2005
May 01

May 31

Particulars

L.F.

Petty cash A/c


To Cash A/c
(Cash paid to petty cashier)
Postage A/c
Telephone & Telegram A/c
Conveyance A/c
Stationary A/c
Miscellaneous expenses A/c
To Petty cash A/c
(Petty expenses posted to petty
cash account)
Petty cash A/c
To Cash A/c
(Cash paid to petty cashier)

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Dr.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

2,000
2,000

Dr.
Dr.
Dr.
Dr.
Dr.

325
121
349
390
302
1,487

Dr.

1,487
1,487

Petty Cash Account


Dr.
Date
2005
May 01

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Cash

2,000

Balance b/d
Cash

2,000
513
1,487

Date
2005
May 31
May 31

Jun. 01
Jun. 01

Particulars

J.F.

Sundries as
per petty cash
book
Balance c/d

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
1,487
513
2,000

Books of Samaria Traders


Postage Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
May 31

Petty cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

325
Telephone and Telegrams Account

Dr.
Date
2005
May 31

Particulars

Petty cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
121

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

Recording of Transactions - II

106
Conveyance Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
May 31

Petty cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

349
Stationery Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
May 31

Petty cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

390
Miscellaneous Expenses Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
May 31

Petty cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

302

4.1.4 Balancing of Cash Book


On the left side, all cash transactions relating to cash receipts (debits) and on
the right side all transactions relating to cash payments (credits) are entered
date-wise. When a cash book is maintained, a separate cash book in the
ledger is not opened. The cash book is balanced in the same way as an account
in the ledger. But it may be noted that in the case of the cash book, there will
always be debit balance because cash payments can never exceed cash receipts
and cash in hand at the beginning of the period.
The source document for cash receipts is generally the duplicate copy of
the receipt issued by the cashier. For payment, any document, invoice, bill,
receipt, etc. on the basis of which payment has been made, will serve as a
source document for recording transactions in the cash book. When payment
has been made, all these documents, popularly known as vouchers, are given
a serial number and filed in a separate file for future reference and verification.
Illustration 1
From the following transactions made by M/s Kuntia Traders, prepare the single column
cashbook.

Recording of Transactions - II
Date

107

Details

Amount
Rs.

Cash in hand
Deposited in bank
Received from Puneet in full settlement of claim
of Rs. 12,000.
Cash paid to Rukmani in full settlement of claim of
Rs.7,000
Sold goods to Sudhir for cash
Paid quarterly insurance premium on policy for
proprietors wife
Purchased office furniture
Purchased stationery
Paid cartage
Paid Kamal, discount allowed by him Rs. 6,800
Received from Gurmeet, discount allowed to him Rs.14,500
Amount withdrawn for house hold use
Electricity bill paid
Goods sold for cash
Bought goods from Kamal on cash basis
Paid telephone charges
Paid postal charges
Paid monthly rent
Paid monthly wages and salary
Bought goods for cash
Sold goods for cash

40,000
16,000
11,700

2005
Sept. 01
Sept. 02
Sept. 04
Sept. 05
Sept. 06
Sept. 06
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.

07
07
07
10
11
12
14
17
21
24
26
28
29
29
30

6,850
14,800
2,740
8,000
1,700
120
200
500
5,000
1,160
23,000
17,000
2,300
520
4,200
8,250
11,000
15,600

Solution
Books of Kuntia Traders
Cash Book
Dr.

Cr.

Date
2005
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.

Particulars

01
04
06
11
17
30

Balance b/d
Puneet
Sales
Gurmeet
Sales
Sales

L.F.

Amount
Rs.
40,000
11,700
14,800
14,500
23,000
15,600

Date
2005
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.

Particulars

02
05
06
07
07
07
10
12
14
21

Bank
Rukmani
Drawings
Office furniture
Stationery
Cartage
Kamal
Drawings
Electric charges
Purchases

L.F.

Amount
Rs.
16,000
6,850
2,740
8,000
1,700
120
6,800
5000
1,160
17,000

Recording of Transactions - II

108
Sept. 24
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.

28
29
29
30
30

Telephone
charges
Postal charges
Rent
Wages & Salary
Purchases
Balance c/d

1,19,600
Oct. 01

Balance b/d

2,300
520
4,200
8,250
11,000
27,960
1,19,600

27,960

Illustration 2
Record the following transactions in double column cash book and balance it.
Date

Details

Amount
Rs.

2005
Aug. 01
Aug. 03
Aug. 08
Aug. 09
Aug.
Aug.
Aug.
Aug.
Aug.

09
10
14
16
20

Aug. 23
Aug.
Aug.
Aug.
Aug.
Aug.

24
25
25
28
31

Aug. 31
Aug. 31
Aug. 31

Cash balance
Bank balance
Paid insurance premium by cheque
Cash sales
Cash discount
Payment for cash purchases
Cash discount
Cash deposited in bank
Telephone bill paid by cheque
Withdrawn from bank for personal use
Withdrawn from bank office use
Received cheque from John in full and final settlement
and deposited the same in the bank
Received cash from Michael
Discount allowed
Stationery purchased for cash
Cartage paid in cash
Cheque received from Kumar
Cheque received from Kumar deposited in Bank
Cheque deposited on Aug. 28 dishonoured and returned
by the bank
Rent paid by cheque
Paid wages to the watchman in cash
Paid cash for postage

15,000
10,000
4,200
22,000
750
21,000
700
15,000
2,300
6,000
14,500
10,700
6,850
150
1,800
350
4,500
4,500

4,000
3,000
220

Recording of Transactions - II

109

Solution
Cash Book
Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars

2005
Aug.
01
08
09
16

Balance b/d
Sales
Cash
Bank

20
23
25

John
Michael
Kumar

28
31

Cash
Balance c/d

L.F.

Cash
Rs.

Bank Date
Rs.

15,000
22,000

2005
Aug.
03
09
09
10

10,000

C
15,000
C 14,500
10,700
6,850
4,500
C

Sept.
01
Balance b/d

4,500
6,000

62,850

40,200

16,980

4,700

14
16
24
25
28
31
31
31
31
31

Particulars

Insurance
Purchases
Bank
Telephone
expenses
Drawings
Cash
Printing and
stationery
Cartage
Bank
Kumar
Rent
Wages
Postage
Balance c/d

L.F.

Cash
Rs.

Bank
Rs.

4,200
C

21,000
15,000
2,300
6,000
14,500

C
1,800

350
4,500
4,500
4,000
3,000
220
16,980

4,700

62,850 40,200

Illustration 3
Prepare bank column cash book from the following tansactions of M/s Laser Zone for the
month of January 2005 and post them to the related ledger accounts :
Date

Details

Jan. 01

Cash in hand
Bank overdraft
Wage paid
Cash sales
Purchased goods by cheque
Purchased furniture for cash
Cash paid to Rohit
Cash sales
Deposited into bank
Bank charged interest on overdraft

Jan.
Jan.
Jan.
Jan.
Jan.
Jan.
Jan.
Jan.

04
05
07
09
11
13
14
16

Amount
Rs.
4,000
3,200
400
7,000
2,000
2,200
2,000
4,500
7,000
200

Recording of Transactions - II
Jan. 20
Jan. 25
Jan.
Jan.
Jan.
Jan.

110

Paid telephone bill by cheque


Sale of goods and received cheque
(deposited same day)
Paid rent
Drew cash for personal use
Paid salary
Interest collected by bank

27
29
30
31

600
3,000
800
500
1,000
1,700

Solution
Books of Laser Zone
Cash Book
Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars
2005
Jan.
01
05
13
14
25
31

L.F.

Balance b/d
Sales
Sales
Cash
Sales
Interest

Cash
Rs.

Bank
Rs.

4,000
7,000
4,500
C

7,000
3,000
1,700

Date
2005
Jan.
01
04
07
09
11
14
16
20
27
29
30
01

Particulars

L.F.

Balance b/d
Wages
Purchase
Furniture
Rohit
Bank
Overdraft
interest
Telephone
Rent
Drawings
Salary
Balance c/d

15,500 11,700
Oct.
01

Balance b/d

1,600

Cash
Rs.

Bank
Rs.

3,200
400
2,000

2,200
2,000
7,000
200
600
800
500
1,000
1,600 5,700
15,500 11,700

5,700
Wages Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Jan.04

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
400

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Recording of Transactions - II

111
Sales Account

Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

2005
Jan. 05
Jan.13
Jan.25

Cash
Cash
Bank

Purchases

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
7,000
4,500
3,000

Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Jan.07

Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2,000
Furniture Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Jan. 09

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2,200
Rohit Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Jan. 11

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2,000
Ovedraft Interest (Paid) Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Jan.16

Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

200
Telephone Expenses Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Jan.20

Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
600

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Recording of Transactions - II

112
Rent Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Jan.27

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Particulars

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

Particulars

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

800
Drawings Account

Dr.
Date

Particulars

2005
Jan.29

J.F.

Cash

Amount
Rs.

Date

500
Salary Account

Dr.
Date

Particulars

2005
Jan.30

J.F.

Cash

Amount
Rs.

Date

1,000
Interest (Received) Account

Dr.
Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

2005
Jan.31

Bank

1,700

Illustration 4
Prepare double column cash book of M/s Advance Technology Pvt. Ltd for the month of
December 2005 from the following transactions :
Date

Details

2005
Dec. 01
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.

02
03
04
05
06
08
10
12

Cash in hand
Cash at bank
Cash paid to petty cashier
Received cheque from Priya
Cash sales
Deposited into bank
Priyas cheque deposited into bank
Purchased furniture by cheque
Paid trade expenses
Cash sales

Amount
Rs.
3,065
6,780
1,000
3,000
2,000
1,200
3,000
6,500
400
9,000

Recording of Transactions - II
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.

13
15
16
17
19
21

Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.
Dec.

22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30

Dec. 31

113

Bank charges
Dividend collected by bank
Paid electric bill by cheque
Cash purchases
Paid for advertising
Goods sold and received a cheque
(deposited same day)
Paid legal charges
Drew from bank for personal use
Paid establishment expenses
Paid for printing of bill book
Paid insurance premium by cheque
Cash sales
Paid salary by cheque
Rent paid
Commission received by cheque
(deposited same day)
Paid for charity by cheque

300
1,200
600
2,000
1,000
6,000
500
2,000
340
850
2,150
7,200
4,000
3,000
2,500
800

Solution
Books of Advance Technology
Cash Book
Dr.
Date Particulars
2005
Dec.
01
03
04
05
06
12
15
21
27
30

Balance b/d
Priya
Sales
Cash
Cash
Sales
Dividend
Sales
Sales
Commission

L.F.

Cash
Rs.

3,065
3,000
2,000
C
C

Bank Date
Rs.

6,780

1,200
3,000
9,000
1,200
6,000
7,200
2,500

2005
Dec.
02
05
06
08
10
13
16
17
19
22
23
24
25
26
28
29

Particulars

L.F.

Petty Cashier
Bank
C
Bank
C
Furniture
Trade expenses
Bank charges
Electric charges
Purchases
Advertisement
Legal charges
Drawings
Establishment
expenses
Printing
Insurance
premium
Salary
Rent

Cash
Rs.

Cr.
Bank
Rs.

1,000
1,200
3,000
6,500
400
300
600
2,000
1,000
500
2,000
340
850
2,150
4,000
3,000

Recording of Transactions - II

114
31
31

2006
Jan.
01
Balance b/d

24,265

20,680

10,975

4,330

Charity
Balance c/d

10,975

800
4,330

24,265 20,680

(ii) Ledger Posting


Petty Cashiers Account
Dr.
Date
2005
Dec.02

Particulars

J.F.

Cash

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

1,000
Priyas Account

Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec. 03

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
3,000

Sales Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec.04
Dec.12
Dec.21
Dec.27

Cash
Cash
Bank
Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
2,000
9,000
6,000
7,200

Furniture Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec.08

Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
6,500

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Recording of Transactions - II

115
Trade Expenses Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec.10

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

400
Bank Charges Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec.13

Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2005
Dec.15

Bank

300
Dividend Account

Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

1,200

Electric Charges Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec.16

Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

600
Purchases Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec. 17

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2,000
Advertisement Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec. 19

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
1,000

Date

Particulars

Recording of Transactions - II

116
Legal Charges Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec. 22

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

500
Drawings Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec. 24

Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2,000
Establishment Expenses Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec. 24

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

340
Printing Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec. 25

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

850

Insurance Premium Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec. 26

Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2,150
Salary Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec. 28

Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
4,000

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Recording of Transactions - II

117
Rent Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec. 29

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

3,000
Commission Received Account

Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Charity

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec. 30

Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
2,500

Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec. 31

Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

800

4.2 Purchases (Journal) Book


All credit purchases of goods are recorded in the purchases journal whereas
cash purchases are recorded in the cash book. Other purchases such as
purchases of office equipment, furniture, building, are recoded in the journal
proper if purchased on credit or in the cash book if purchased for cash. The
source documents for recording entries in the book are invoices or bills received
by the firm from the supplies of the goods. Entries are made with the net
amount of the invoice. Trade discount and other details of the invoice need
not be recorded in this book. The format of the purchases journal is shown in
figure 4.6.
Purchases (Journal) Book
Date

Invoice
No.

Name of Supplier
(Account to be credited)

L.F.

Amount
Rs.

Fig. 4.6 : Format of purchases (journal) book

The monthly total of the purchases book is posted to the debit of purchases
account in the ledger. Individual suppliers accounts may be posted daily.
Consider the following details obtained from M/s Kanika Traders and observe
how the entries are recorded in the purchase journal.

Recording of Transactions - II

118

Date
Details
2005
Aug. 04 Purchased from M/s Neema Electronics (invoice no. 3250): 20 Mini-size T.V.
@ Rs.2,000 per piece, 15 Tape recorders @ Rs. 12,500 per piece. Trade discount
on all items @ 20%.
Aug. 10 Bought from M/s Pawan Electronics (invoice no. 8260): 10 Video cassettes @
Rs. 150 per piece, 20 Tape recorders @ Rs. 1,650 per piece. Trade discout
@ 10% on purchases.
Aug. 18 Purchased from M/s. Northern Electronics (invoice no. 4256): 15 Northern
stereos @ Rs. 4,000 per piece, 20 Northern colour T.V. @ Rs. 14,500 per piece.
Trade discount @ 12.5%.
Aug. 26 Purchased form M/s Neema Electronics (Invoice No. 3294): 10 Mini-size T.V.
@ Rs. 1,000 per piece, 5 Colour T.V. @ Rs. 12,500 per piece. Trade discount
@ 20%.
Aug. 29 Bought from M/s Pawan Electronics: (Invoice No. 8281) 20 Video cassettes @
150 per piece 25 Tape recorders @ Rs. 1,600 per piece. Trade discount @ 10%
on purchases.
Books of Kanika Traders
Purchases (Journal) Book
Date
2005
Aug.04
Aug.10
Aug.18
Aug.26
Aug.29
Aug.31

Invoice
No.
3250
8260
4256
3294
8281

Name of Supplier
(Account to be credited)

L.F.

Neema Electronics
Pawan Electronics
Northern Electronics
Neema Electronics
Pawan Electronics

Amount
Rs.
1,82,000
31,050
3,06,250
54,000
38,700
6,12,000

Posting from the purchases journal is done daily to their respective accounts
with the relevant amounts on the credit side. The total of the purchases journal
is periodically posted to the debit of the purchases account normally on the
monthly basis. However, if the number of transactions is very large, this total
may be done and posted at some other convenient time interval such as daily,
weekly or fortnightly. The posting from the purchases journal to the ledger
from is illustrated as follows:
Books of Kanika Electronics
Neema Electronics
Dr.
Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

2005
Aug.04
Aug. 26

Purchases
Purchases

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
1,82,000
54,000

Recording of Transactions - II

119
Pawan Electronics

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

2005
Aug. 10
Aug. 29

Purchases
Purchases

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
31,050
38,700

Northern Electronics
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

2005
Aug.18

Purchases

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
3,06,250

Purchases Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Aug. 31

Sundries as
per Purchases
Journal

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

6,12,000

4.3 Purchases Return (Journal) Book


In this book, purchases return of goods are recorded. Sometimes goods
purchased are returned to the supplier for various reasons such as the goods
are not of the required quality, or are defective, etc. For every return, a debit
note (in duplicate) is prepared and the original one is sent to the supplier for
making necessary entries in his book. The supplier may also prepare a note,
which is called the credit note. The source document for recording entries in
the purchases return journal is generally a debit note. A debit note will contain
the name of the party (to whom the goods have been returned) details of the
goods returned and the reason for returning the goods. Each debit note is
serially numbered and dated. The format of the purchases return journal is
shown in figure 4.7(a).
Purchases Return (Journal) Book
Date

Debit
Note No.

Name of the Supplier


(Account to be debited)

Fig 4.7(a) : Format of Purchases return (journal)book

L.F.

Amount
Rs.

Recording of Transactions - II

120
Box 2
Debit and Credit Notes

A Debit note is a document evidencing a debit to be raised against a party for reasons
other than sale on credit. On finding that goods supplied are not as per the terms of
the order placed, the defective goods are returned to the supplier of the goods and a
note is prepared to debit the supplier; or when an additional sum is recoverable
from a customer such a note is prepared to debit the customer with the additional
dues. In these two situations the note is called a debit note (refer figure 4.7(b)).
A Credit note is prepared, when a party is to be given a credit for reasons other
than credit purchase. It is a common practice to make it in red ink. When goods are
received back from a customer, a credit note should be sent to him. The suggested
proforma of credit note is shown in figure 4.7(c).

Name of the Firm Issuing the Note

Address of the Firm


Date of Issue .........

No.

DEBIT NOTE
Against : Suppliers Name
Goods returned as per delivery
Amount (Rs)
Challan No.
(Details of goods returned)
(Rupees ...........only)
Signature of the Manager with date
Fig. 4.7(b) : Showing a specimen of debit note
Name of the Firm Issuing the Note

No.

Address of the Firm


Date of Issue .........

CREDIT NOTE
Against : Customers Name
Goods returned by the customer
Amount (Rs)
Challan No.
(Details of goods returned)
(Rupees ...........only)
Signature of the Manager with date
Fig. 4.7(c) : Showing a specimen credit note

Recording of Transactions - II

121

Refer to the purchases (journal) book of Kanika Traders you will notice that
20 mini size T.V.s and 15 tape- recorders were bought from Neema Electronics
for Rs. 1,82,000 However, on delivery 2 mini T.V.s and tape recorders were
found defective and were returned back vide debit note no. 03/2005. In this
case, the purchases return books will be prepared as follows :
Purchases Return (Journal) Book
Date

Debit
Note
No.
03/2005

Name of the Supplier


(Account to be debited)

L.F.

Neema Electronics

Amount
Rs.
13,200
13,200

Posting from the purchases returns journal requires that the suppliers
individual accounts are debited with the amount of returns and the purchases
returns account is credited with the periodical total.
Neema Electronics Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Purchases
Return

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

13,200

Purchases Return Account


Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars
Sundries as
per purchase
returns book

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
13,200

4.4 Sales (Journal) Book


All credit sales of merchandise are recorded in the sales journal. Cash sales
are recorded in the cash book. The format of the sales journal is similar to
that of the purchases journal explained earlier. The source document for
recording entries in the sales journal are sales invoice or bill issued by the
firm to the customers. The date of sale, invoice number, name of the customer
and amount of the invoice are recorded in the sales journal. Other details
about the sales transaction including terms of payment are available in the
invoice. In fact, two or more than two copies of a sales invoice are prepared for

Recording of Transactions - II

122

each sale. The book keeper makes entries in the sales journal from one copy
of the sales invoice. The format of the sales joournal is shown in figure 4.8. In
the sales journal, one additional column may be added to record sales tax
recovered from the customer and to be paid to the government within the
stipulated time. Periodically, at the end of each month the amount column is
total led and posted to the credit of sales account in the ledger. Posting to the
debit side of individual customers accounts may be made daily.
Sales (Journal) Book
Date

Invoice
No.

Name of the Customer


(Account to be debited)

L.F.

Amount
Rs.

Fig. 4.8 : Format of sales (journal) cash book

For example M/s Koina Supplies sold on credit:


(i) Two water purifiers @ Rs. 2,100 each and five buckets @ Rs 130 each to
M/s Raman Traders (Invoice no. 178 dated April 06, 2005).
(ii) Five road side containers @ Rs 4,200 each to M/s Nutan enterprises
(Invoice no 180 dated April 09, 2005) .
(iii) 100 big buckets @ Rs 850 each to M/s Raman traders (Invoice no. 209,
dated April 28, 2005).
The above stated transactions will be entered in a sales journal as follows:
Books of Koina Suppliers
Sales (Journal) Book
Date
2005
April 06
April 09
April 28
April 30

Invoice
No.
178
180
209

Name of the customer


(Account to be debited)
Raman Traders
Nutan Enterprises
Raman Traders

L.F.

Amount
Rs.
4,850
21,000
85,000
1,10,850

Posting from the sales journal are done to the debit of customers accounts
kept in the ledger. Like the purchases journal, individual customers accounts
are generally posted daily, with the amount involved. The sales journal is also
totaled periodically (generally monthly), and this total is credited to sales
account in the ledger. The sales (journal) book illustrated above will be posted
in the related ledger account in the following manner:

Recording of Transactions - II

123
Raman Traders Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Apr. 06
Apr. 28

Sales
Sales

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

4,850
85,000
Nutan Enterprises Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Apr.01

Sales

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

21,000
Sales Account

Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date
2005
Apr. 30

Particulars

J.F.

Sundries as
per sales book

Amount
Rs.
1,10,850

4.5 Sales Return (Journal) Book


This journal is used to record return of goods by customers to them on credit.
On receipt of goods from the customer, a credit note is prepared, like the debit
note referred to earlier. The difference between the credit not and the debit
note is that the former is prepared by the seller and the latter is prepared by
the buyer. Like the debit note, the credit note is also prepared in duplicate
and contains detail relating to the name of the customer, details of the
merchandise received back and the amount. Each credit note is serially
numbered and dated. The source document for recording entries in the sales
return book is generally the credit note. The format of the sales return book is
shown in figure 4.9
Sales Return (Journal) Book
Date

Credit
No.

Name of the customer


(Account to be Credited)

Fig. 4.9 : Format of sales return (journal) book

L.F.

Amount
Rs.

Recording of Transactions - II

124

Refer to the sales (journal) book of Koina Supplier of you will find that two
water purifiers were sold to Raman Traders for Rs 2,100 each, out of which
one purifier was returned back due to the manufacturing defect (credit note
no. 10/2005). In this case, the sales return (Journal) book will be prepared
as follows :
Sales Return (Journal) Book
Date

Credit
Name of the customer
No.
(Account to be Credited)
10/2005 Raman Traders

L.F.

Amount
Rs.
2,100
2,100

Posting to the sales return journal requires that the customers account be
credited with the amount of returns and the sales return account be debited
with the periodical total in the same way as is done in case of posting from the
purchases journal.
Raman Traders Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Sales Return

Amount
Rs.
2,100

Sales Return Account


Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars
Sundries
as per sales
return book

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2,100

Illustration 5
Enter the following transactions of M/s Hi-Life Fashions in purchases and purchases
return book and post them to the ledger accounts for the month of September 2005:
Date

Details

Sept. 01

Purchase of following goods on cr edit from M/s Ratna T raders,


as per Invoice No.714:
25 Shirts @ Rs.300 per shirt
20 Pants @ Rs.700 per pant
Less 10% trade discount
Purchase of following goods on credit from M/s Bombay Fashion House,
as per Invoice No.327 ;

Sept. 08

Recording of Transactions - II

Sept. 10

Sept. 15

Sept. 20

Sept. 24

Sept. 28

125

10 Fancy Trousers @ Rs.500 per trouser


20 Fancy Hat @ Rs. 100 per hat
Less 5% trade discount
Goods returned to M/s Ratana Traders,as per debit note No.102 :
3 shirts @ Rs.300 per shirt
1 Pant @ Rs.700 per pant
Less 10% trade discount
Pur chase of following goods on credit from M/s Zolta Fashions,
as per Invoice No.6781 :
10 Jackets @ Rs.1000 per jacket
5 Plain shirts Rs.200 per shirts
Less 15% trade discount.
Purchase of following goods on cr edit from M/s Bride Palace,
as per Invoice No.1076 :
10 Fancy Lengha @ Rs.2,000 per lengha
Less 5% trade discount.
Goods returned to M/s Bombay Fashion House as per debit note No.103 :
2 Fancy Trousers @ Rs.500 per trouser
4 Fancy Hat @ Rs.100 per hat
Less 5% trade discount.
Goods returned to M/s Bride Palace as per debit note No.105 :
1 Fancy Lengha @ Rs.2,000 per lengha
Less 5% trade discount.

Solution
Books of Hi-life Fashions
Purchases (Journal) Book
Date

Invoice
No.

2005
Sept.01
Sept.08
Sept.15
Sept.20
Sept.30

714
327
6781
1076

Name of the Supplier


(Account to be credited)

L.F.

Ratana Traders
Bombay Fashion House
Zolta Fashions
Bride Palace

Amount
Rs.
19,350
6,650
9,350
19,000
54,350

Purchases Return (Journal) Book


Date
2005
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.
Sept.

Invoice
No.
10
24
28
30

102
103
106

Name of the Supplier


(Account to be debited)
Ratana Traders
Bombay Fashion House
Bride Palace

L.F.

Amount
Rs.
1,440
1,330
1,900
4,670

Recording of Transactions - II

126

(ii) Ledger Posting


Books of M/s Hi-Life Fashions
Ratana Traders Account
Dr.
Date
2005
Sept. 10

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Purchases
return

Amount
Rs.
1,440

Date

Particulars

2005
Sept.01

Purchases

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
19,350

Bombay Fashion House Account


Dr.
Date
2005
Sept. 24

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Purchases
return

Amount
Rs.
1,330

Date

Particulars

2005
Sept. 08

Purchases

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
6,650

Zolta Fashions Account


Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

2005
Sept. 15

Purchases

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
9,350

Bride Palace Account


Dr.
Date
2005
Sept. 28

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Purchases
return

Amount
Rs.
1,900

Date

Sept. 20

Particulars

J.F.

Purchases

Amount
Rs.
19,000

Purchases Account
Dr.
Date
2005
Sept. 30

Cr.
Particulars

Sundries as
per purchases
journal

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
54,350

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Recording of Transactions - II

127
Purchases Return Account

Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date
2005
Sept. 30

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Sundries as
per purchases
return book

4,670

Illustration 6
Enter the following transactions in the Sales and Sales Return book of M/s Vineet Stores:
Date

Details

Dec.01.

Sold goods on credit to M/s Rohit Stores as per invoice no.325 :


30 Kids Books @ Rs. 60 each.
20 Animal Books @ Rs. 50 each
Sold goods on credit to M/s Mera Stores as per invoice no.328 :
100 Greeting Cards @ Rs.12 each.
50 Musical Cards @ Rs. 50 each
Less 5% trade discount.
Sold Goods on credit to M/s Mega Stationers as per invoice no.329 :
50 Writing Pads @ Rs. 20 each.
50 Colour Books @ Rs. 30 each
20 Ink Pads @ 16 each
Goods Returned from M/s Rohit Stores as per credit note no.201:
2 Kids Books @ Rs. 60 each
1 Animal Book @ Rs. 50 each
Sold goods on credit to M/s Abha Traders as per invoice no.355 :
100 Cards Books @ Rs. 10 each.
50 Note Books @ Rs. 35 each
Less 5% trade discount.
Goods returned from M/s Mega Stationers as per credit note no.204:
2 Colour Books @ Rs. 30 each
Sold goods on credit to M/s Bharti Stores as per invoice no.325 :
100 Greeting Cards @ Rs. 20 each.
100 Fancy Envelopes @ Rs. 5 each
Goods returned from M/s Abha Traders as per credit note no.207 :
20 Cards Books @ Rs. 10 each
5 Note Book@ Rs. 35 each
Less 5% trade discount

Dec. 05

Dec. 10

Dec. 15

Dec. 19

Dec. 22
Dec. 26

Dec. 30

Recording of Transactions - II

128

Solution
Books of Veneet Stores
Sales (Journal) Book
Date
2005
Dec.01
Dec.05
Dec.10
Dec.19
Dec.26
Dec. 31

Invoice
No.

Name of the Customer


(Account to be debited)

J.F.

325 Rohit Stores


328 Mera Stores
329 Mega Stationers
335 Abha Traders
340 Bharti Stores

Amount
Rs.
2,800
3,515
2,820
2,375
2,500
14,010

Sales Return (Journal) Book


Date
2005
Dec. 15
Dec. 22
Dec. 30
Dec. 31

Credit
Note No.
201
204
206

Name of the Customer


(Account to be credited)

L.F.

Rohit Stores
Mega Stationers
Abha Traders

Amount
Rs.
170
150
333
653

(ii) Ledger Posting


Rohit Stores Account
Dr.
Date
2005
Dec. 01

Particulars

J.F.

Sales

Amount
Rs.
2800

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec.15

Sales return

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
170

Mera Stores Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec. 05

Sales

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

3,515
Mega Stationers Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec.10

Sales

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
2,820

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec.22

Sales return

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
150

Recording of Transactions - II

129
Abha Traders Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec.19

Sales

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
2,375

Date

Particulars

Dec.30

Sales return

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
333

Bharti Stores Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec.26

Sales

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2,500
Sales Account

Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

Dec. 31

Sundries as
per sales book

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2005
14,010

Sales Return Account


Dr.
Date
2005
Dec.31

Cr.
Particulars
Sundries as
per sales
return book

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
653

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

4.6 Journal Proper


A book maintained to record transactions, which do not find place in special
journals, is known as Journal Proper or Journal Residual.
Following transactions are recorded in this journal:
1. Opening Entry: In order to open new set of books in the beginning of new
accounting year and record therein opening balances of assets, liabilities
and capital, the opening entry is made in the journal.
2. Adjustment Entries: In order to update ledger account on accrual basis,
such entries are made at the end of the accounting period. Such as
Rent outstanding, Prepaid insurance, Depreciation and Commission
received in advance.

Recording of Transactions - II

130

3. Rectification entries: To rectify errors in recording transactions in the


books of original entry and their posting to ledger accounts this journal
is used.
4. Transfer entries: Drawing account is transferred to capital account at
the end of the accounting year. Expenses accounts and revenue accounts
which are not balanced at the time of balancing are opened to record
specific transactions. Accounts relating to operation of business such
as Sales, Purchases, Opening Stock, Income, Gains and Expenses etc
and drawing are closed at the end of the year and their Total/balances
are transferred to Trading and Profit and Loss account by recording the
journal entries. These are also called closing entries.
5. Other entries: In addition to the above mentioned entries in the points
number 1 to 4, recording of the following transaction is done in the
journal proper :
(i) At the time of a dishonour of a cheque the entry for cancellation for
discount received or discount allowed earlier.
(ii) Purchase/sale of items on credit other than goods.
(iii) Goods withdrawn by the owner for personal use.
(iv) Goods distributed as samples for sales promotion.
(v) Endorsement and dishonour of bills of exchange.
(vi) Transaction in respect of consignment and joint venture, etc.
(vii) Loss of goods by fire/theft/spoilage.
Test Your Understanding - I
Select the Correct Answer
(a) When a firm maintains a cash book, it need not maintain ;
(i) Journal Proper
(ii) Purchases (journal) book
(iii) Sales (journal) book
(iv) Bank and cash account in the ledger
(b)

Double column cash book records:


All transactions
Cash and bank transactions
Only cash transactions
Only credit transactions

(i)
(ii)
(iii)
(iv)
(c)

Goods purchased on cash are recorded in the :


(i) Purchases (journal) book
(ii) Sales (journal) book
(iii) Cash book
(iv) Purchases return (journal)book

Recording of Transactions - II
(d)

131

Cash book does not record transaction of :

(i)
(ii)
(iii)
(iv)

Cash nature
Credit nature
Cash and credit nature
None of these

(e)

Total of these transactions is posted in purchase account :


(i) Purchase of furniture
(ii) Cash and credit purchase
(iii) Purchases return
(iv) Purchase of stationery

(f)

The periodic total of sales return journal is posted to :


(i) Sales account
(ii) Goods account
(iii) Purchases return account
(iv) Sales return account

(g)
(i)
(ii)
(iii)
(iv)

Credit balance of bank account in cash book shows :


Overdraft
Cash deposited in our bank
Cash withdrawn from bank
None of these

(h)

The periodic total of purchases return journal is posted to :


(i) Purchase account
(ii) Profit and loss account
(iii) Purchase returns account
(iv) Furniture account

(i)

Balancing of account means :


(i) Total of debit side
(ii) Total of credit side
(iii) Difference in total of debit & credit
(iv) None of these

4.7 Balancing the Accounts


Accounts in the ledger are periodically balanced, generally at the end of the
accounting period, with the object of ascertaining the net position of each amount.
Balancing of an account means that the two sides are totaled and the difference
between them is shown on the side, which is shorter in order to make their
totals equal. The words balance c/d are written against the amount of the
difference between the two sides. The amount of balance is brought (b/d) down
in the next accounting period indicating that it is a continuing account, till
finally settled or closed.
In case the debit side exceeds the credit side, the difference is written on
the credit side, if the credit side exceeds the debit side, the difference between

Recording of Transactions - II

132

the two appears on the debit side and is called debit and credit balance
respectively. The accounts of expenses losses and gains/revenues are not
balanced but are closed by transferring to trading and profit and loss account.
The balancing of the an account is illustrated below with the help of an example
explaining the complete process of recording the transactions, posting to ledger
and balancing there of.
Date
2005
Apr. 01
Apr.02
Apr. 02
Apr.l 03
Apr. 04

Apr.l 04
Apr. 05
Apr. 05
Apr. 06

Apr. 07

Apr. 08

Apr. 10

Apr. 11
Apr. 11
Apr. 12

Details
Commenced business with cash Rs. 1,00,000.
Deposited in bank Rs. 40,000.
Purchased for cash furniture Rs. 6,000;
Land Rs. 42,000.
Paid cheque to M/s Malika & Brothers for purchase of electric wires and
plugs Rs. 17,000.
Bought of M/s Handa Co. vide invoice no. 544:
(i) 28 Immersion Heaters 1,000 Watt of Smg. Ltd. @ Rs. 50, and
(ii) 40 Tube lights @ Rs.35. trade discount @ 12.5%.
Purchased stationery for cash Rs. 2,300.
Loan from M/s Dayal Traders. @ 6% Rs. 25,000 and deposited money in
the bank on the next day.
Paid cartage Rs. 80 and other charges Rs. 20.
Bought of M/s Burari. Ltd. on account vide Invoice No. 125:
(i) 50 Table lamps (Universal) @ Rs. 80 :
(ii) 20 Electric kettles (General) @ Rs. 125.
(iii) 5 Electric iron@ Rs. 300. trade discount 20%.
Sales to M/s Ramneek on account vide invoice no. 871:
(i) 10 Immersion heaters1000 watt @ Rs. 60.
(ii) 5 Table lamps @ Rs. 100:
(iii) 2 Electric irons @ 320.
Sales to M/s Kapadia on credit vide invoice no. 880
(i) 15 Immersion heaters @ 60:
(ii) 15 Tube lights @ Rs. 38.
Return inwards from Ramneek :
(i) 2 Immersion heaters,
(ii) 1 Electric iron.
Paid rent by cheque Rs. 4,000.
Purchased from M/s Rungta. for cash:
(i) 5 Immersion heaters 1000 watt @ Rs. 45.
Returned goods to Burari Ltd. :
(i) 3 Table lamps (Universal)
(ii) 2 Electric kettles
(iii) 1 Electric iron.

Recording of Transactions - II
Apr. 15
Apr. 16
Apr. 18
Apr. 19

Apr. 20
Apr. 21
Apr. 21

Apr. 23
Apr. 23
Apr. 24
Apr. 25
Apr. 25
Apr. 26
Apr. 27

Apr.
Apr.
Apr.
Apr.
Apr.

28
30
30
30
30

133

Purchased on account furniture from quality Furniture Ltd. Rs. 8,000.


Paid for advertisement Rs. 1,200.
Sales to M/s Daman on account vide invoice no. 902:
(i) 10 Electric kettles (General) @ Rs. 130.
Purchased from M/s Kochhar Co. on credit vide invoice no.205:
(i) 25 Electric Mixers @ Rs. 600.
(ii) 40 Electric irons (Special) @ Rs. 540. trade discount 20%.
Sales to M/s Ramneek on account vide bill no.925: 4 Electric Mixers
@ Rs. 600.
Received cheque of Rs.3,700 from M/s Ramneek for full and final settlement
of claim. The cheque deposited in bank after two days.
Purchased from M/s Burari Ltd. on credit vide invoice no.157:
(i) 10 Electric kettles @ Rs. 125
(ii) 20 Electric lamps @ Rs. 80 trade discount @ 20%.
Sales to M/s Nutan on account vide invoice no.958:
(i) 2 Electric Mixers @ Rs. 600.
Cash sales of Electric wires and plugs Rs. 14,500, cash discount allowed
Rs. 200.
Cash purchases from M/s Hitesh:
(i) 5 Electric fans @ Rs. 740.
Paid electricity bill Rs. 1,320.
Made full and final payment to M/s Burari Ltd. by cheque discount allowed
by them Rs. 320.
Purchased stationery on account from M/s Mohit Mart Rs. 3,200.
Sales to M/s Daman on account vide Invoice No. 981:
(i) 15 Table lamps @ Rs. 100
(ii) 10 Immersion heaters 1000 watt @ Rs. 80.
Deposited in bank Rs. 5,000.
Withdrew Rs. 8,000 for personal use.
Paid telephone bill Rs. 2700 by cheque.
Paid insurance Rs. 1,600 by cheque.
Paid to M/s Handa Co. Rs.2,450 by cheque; and Rs. 28,000 to M/s Kochhar
and co. by cheque who allowed Rs. 1,280 as discount.
Purchases (Journal) Book

Date
2005
Apr. 04
Apr. 06
Apr. 19
Apr. 21
Apr. 30

Invoice
No.
544
125
205
157

Name of the Supplier


(Account to be credited)
Handa Co.
Burari Ltd.
Kochhar Co.
Burari Ltd.

L.F.

Amount
Rs.
2,450
6,400
29,280
2,280
40,410

Recording of Transactions - II

134
Sales (Journal) Book

Date
2005
Apr. 07
Apr. 08
Apr. 18
Apr. 20
Apr. 23
Apr. 27

Invoice
No.
871
880
902
925
958
981

Name of the Supplier


(Account to be credited)

L.F.

Ramneek
Kapadia
Daman
Ramneek
Nutan
Daman

Amount
Rs.
1,740
1,470
1,300
2,400
1,200
2,300

Apr. 30

10,410
Purchases Return (Journal) Book

Date

Debit

2005
Apr. 12
Apr. 30

Name of the Supplier


(Account to be debited)

L.F.

Burari Ltd.

Amount

632
632

Sales Return (Journal) Book


Date
Apr. 10
Apr. 30

Credit

Name of the customer


(Account to be credited)

L.F.

Ramneek

Amount
Rs.
440
440

Journal Proper
Date

2005
Apr. 15

Apr. 25

Apr. 26

Apr. 30

Particulars

Furniture A/c
Dr.
To Quality Furniture A/c
(Purchase of furniture on credit)
Burari Ltd A/c
Dr.
To Discount A/c
(Discount received)
Stationery A/c
Dr.
To Mohit Mart A/c
(Purchase of Stationery items on credit)
Kochhar A/c
To Discount A/c
(Discount received)
Total

L.F.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

8,000
8,000
320
320
3,200
3,200
1,280
1,280
12,800

12,800

Recording of Transactions - II

135
Cash Book

Date Particulars L.F.


2005
Apr.
01
02
05
06
21
23

Capital
Cash
6% Loan
Cash
Ramneek
Cash

23
28

Sales
Cash

C
C

Cash
Rs.

Bank Date
Rs.

2005
April
1,00,000
02
40,000 02
25,000
02
25,000 03
3,700
04
3,700 05
14,500
5,000

06
11
11
16
23
24
25
25
28
30
30
30
30
30
30

30
May
01

Balance b/d

1,43,200

73,700

4,655

10,222

Particulars

L.F.

Bank
Furniture
Land
Purchases
Stationery
Miscellaneous
expenses
Bank
Rent
Purchases
Advertisement
Bank
Purchases
Electric
charges
Burari Ltd.
Bank
Drawings
Telephone
charges
Insurance
Handa Co.
Kochhar & Co.
Balance c/d

30

Cash
Rs.

Bank
Rs.

40,000
6,000
42,000
17,000
2,300
100

25,000

225
1,200
3,700
3,700
1,320

4,000

7,728
C

5,000
8,000
2,700
1,600
2,450
28,000
4,655 10,222
1,43,200 73,700

The recorded transactions will be posted in the ledger.


Capital Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Apr.30

Balance c/d

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
1,00,000
1,00,000

Date

Particulars

2005
Apr.01

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
1,00,000
1,00,000

Recording of Transactions - II

136
6% Loan Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Apr. 30

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Balance c/d

Amount
Rs.
25,000
25,000

Date

Particulars

2005
April 05

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
25,000
25,000

Ramneeks Account
Dr.
Date
2005
Apr. 07
Apr. 20

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Sales
Sales

Amount
Rs.
1,740
2,400
4,140

Date

Particulars

2005
April10
April21

Sales return
Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
440
3,700
4,140

Sales Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

2005
Apr. 23
Apr. 30

Cash
Sundries

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
14,500
10,410
24,910

Furniture Account
Dr.
Date
2005
Apr. 02
Apr. 15

Cr.
Particulars

Cash
Quality
Furniture

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
6,000
8,000
14,000

Date
2005
Apr. 30

Particulars

Balance c/d

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
14,000

14,000

Recording of Transactions - II

137
Land Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Apr. 02

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
42,000
42,000

Date
2005
Apr.30

Particulars

J.F.

Balance c/d

Amount
Rs.
42,000
42,000

Purchases Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Apr. 03
Apr. 11
Apr. 24
Apr. 30

Bank
Bank
Cash
Sundries

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Particulars

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

17,000
225
3,700
40,410
61,335
Stationery Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Apr. 04
Apr. 26

Particulars

J.F.

Cash
Mohit mart

Amount
Rs.

Date

2,300
3,200
5,500
Miscellaneous Expenses Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Apr. 05

Particulars

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
100
100

Date

Particulars

Recording of Transactions - II

138
Rent Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Apr. 04

Particulars

J.F.

Bank

Amount
Rs.

Date

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

Particulars

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Particulars

4,000
4,000
Advertisement Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Apr.16

Particulars

J.F.

Cash

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

1,200
1,200
Electric Charges Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Apr. 25

Particulars

J.F.

Cash

Amount
Rs.

Date

1,320
1,320
Drawings Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Apr. 30

Cash

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

8,000
8,000
Telephone Charges Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Apr. 30

Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date
2005

2,700
2,700

Particulars

Recording of Transactions - II

139
Insurance Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Apr. 30

Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

1,600
1,600
Quality Furniture Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Apr. 30

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Balance c/d

Amount
Rs.
8,000
8,000

Date
2005
Apr. 15

Particulars

J.F.

Furniture

Amount
Rs.
8,000
8,000

Mohit Mart Account


Dr.
Date
2005
Apr. 30

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Balance c/d

Amount
Rs.
3,200
3,200

Date
2005
Apr. 26

Particulars

J.F.

Stationery

Amount
Rs.
3,200
3,200

Purchases Return Account


Dr.
Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

2005
Apr. 30

Sundries

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
632
632

Handa Company Account


Dr.
Date
2005
Apr. 30

Particulars

Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
2,450
2,450

Date

Particulars

2005
Apr. 04

Purchases

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
2,450
2,450

Recording of Transactions - II

140
Burari Ltd. Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Apr. 12
Apr. 25

Particulars

J.F.

Purchases
return
Bank
Discount

Amount
Rs.
632
7,728
320
8,680

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

2005
Apr. 06

Purchases

6,400

Apr. 21

Purchases

2,280
8,680

Kochhar Account
Dr.
Date
2005
Apr. 30

Particulars

J.F.

Bank
Discount

Amount
Rs.
28,000
1,280
29,280

Date

Particulars

2005
Apr. 19

Purchases

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
29,280
29,280

Sales Return Account


Dr.
Date
2005
Apr. 30

Particulars

J.F.

Sundries
.

Amount
Rs.
440
440

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Particulars

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

2005
Apr. 30

Kapadia Account
Dr.
Date
2005
Apr. 08

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Sales

Amount
Rs.
1,470
1,470

Date
2005
Apr. 30

Balance c/d

Amount
Rs.
1,470
1,470

Daman Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Apr. 18
Apr. 27

Sales
Sales

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
1,300
2,300
3,600

Date
2005
Apr. 30

Particulars

Balance c/d

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
3,600
3,600

Recording of Transactions - II

141
Nutan Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Apr. 23

Sales

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
1,200
1,200

Date
2005
Apr. 30

Particulars

J.F.

Balance c/d

Amount
Rs.
1,200
1,200

Discount Received Account


Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

2005
Apr. 25
Apr. 30

Burari Ltd
Kochhar

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
320
1,280
1,600

Test Your Understanding - II


1. Fill in the Correct Words :
(a) Cash book is a ......... journal.
(b) In Journal proper, only.........discount is recorded.
(c) Return of goods purchased on credit to the suppliers will be entered in ......
Journal.
(d) Assets sold on credit are entered in .........
(e) Double column cash book records transaction relating to .........and .........
(f) Total of the debit side of cash book is .........than the credit side.
(g) Cash book does not record the .........transactions.
(h) In double column cash book .........transactions are also recorded.
(i) Credit balance shown by a bank column in cash book is .........
(j) The amount paid to the petty cashier at the beginning of a period is known as
.........amount.
(k) In purchase book goods purchased on .........are recorded.
2. State whether the following statements are True or False :
(a) Journal is a book of secondary entry.
(b) One debit account and more than one credit account in a entry is called
compound entry.
(c) Assets sold on credit are entered in sales journal.
(d) Cash and credit purchases are entered in purchasejJournal.
(e) Cash sales are entered in sales journal.
(f) Cash book records transactions relating to receipts and payments.
(g) Ledger is a subsidiary book.
(h) Petty cash book is a book having record of big payments.

Recording of Transactions - II
(i)
(j)

142

Cash received is entered on the debit side of cash book.


Transaction recorded both on debit and credit side of cash book is known as
contra entry.
Balancing of account means total of debit and credit side.
Credit purchase of machine is entered in purchase journal.

(k)
(l)

Key Terms Introduced in the Chapter

Posting

Day books

Cash book

Petty Cash book

Sales return (Journal) Book

Sales (Journal) Book


Balancing of Accounts
Purchase (Journal) book
Purchases return (Journal) Book

Summary with Reference to Learning Objectives


1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.

Journal : Basic book of original entry.


Cash book : A book used to record all cash receipts and payments.
Petty cash book : A book used to record small cash payments.
Purchase journal : A special journal in which only credit purchases are recorded
Sales journal : A special journal in which only credit sales are recorded
Purchases Return Book : A book in which return of merchandise purchased is
recorded.
Sales Return Book : A special book in which returns of merchandise sold on
credit are recorded.
Questions For Practice

Short Answers
1. Briefly state how the cash book is both journal and a ledger.
2. What is the purpose of contra entry?
3. What are special purpose books?
4. What is petty cash book? How it is prepared?
5. Explain the meaning of posting of journal entries?
6. Define the purpose of maintaining subsidiary journal.
7. Write the difference between return Inwards and return ouwards.
8. What do you understand by ledger folio?
9. What is difference between trade discount and cash discount?
10. Write the process of preparing ledger from a journal.
11. What do you understand by Imprest amount in petty cash book?
Long Answers
1.
2.
3.

Explain the need for drawing up the special purpose books.


What is cash book? Explain the types of cash book.
What is contra entry? How can you deal this entry while preparing double
column cash book?

Recording of Transactions - II
4.
5.
6.

143

What is petty cash book? Write the advantages of petty cash book?
Describe the advantages of sub-dividing the Journal.
What do you understand by balancing of account?
Numerical Questions

Simple Cash Book


1.

Enter the following transactions in a simple cash book for December 2005:
Rs.
01
Cash in hand
12,000
05
Cash received from Bhanu
4,000
07
Rent Paid
2,000
10
Purchased goods Murari for cash
6,000
15
Sold goods for cash
9,000
18
Purchase stationery
300
22
Cash paid to Rahul on account
2,000
28
Paid salary
1,000
30
Paid rent
500
(Ans. Cash in hand Rs. 13,200)

2.

Record the following transaction in simple cash book for November 2005:
Rs
01
Cash in hand
12,500
04
Cash paid to Hari
600
07
Purchased goods
800
12
Cash received from Amit
1,960
16
Sold goods for cash
800
20
Paid to Manish
590
25
Paid cartage
100
31
Paid salary
1,000
(Ans. Cash in hand Rs. 12,170)

3.

Enter the following transaction in Simple cash book for December 2005 :
Rs.
01
Cash in hand
7,750
06
Paid to Sonu
45
08
Purchased goods
600
15
Received cash from Parkash
960
20
Cash sales
500
25
Paid to S.Kumar
1,200
30
Paid rent
600
(Ans. Cash in hand Rs. 6,765)

Bank Column Cash Book


4. Record the following transactions in a bank column cash book for December
2005:
Rs.
01
Started business with cash
80,000
04
Deposited in bank
50,000

Recording of Transactions - II
10
15
22
25
30
31
(Ans.
5.

Rs.
Started business with cash
1,20,000
Cash paid into bank
50,000
Purchased goods from Sushmita
20,000
Sold goods to Dinker and received a cheque
20,000
Paid to Sushmita cash
20,000
Cheque received on December 06, 2005 deposited into bank
Sold goods to Rani
12,000
Cartage paid in cash
500
Received cash from Rani
12,000
Commission received
5,000
Drew cash for personal use
2,000
Cash in hand Rs. 64,500 : Cash at bank Rs. 70,000)

Enter the following transactions in double column cash book of M/s Ambica
Traders for November 2005:
01
03
05
10
15
18
20
22
25
30
(Ans.

7.

1,000
8,000
10,000
20,000
2,000
1,000

Prepare a double column cash book with the help of following information
for December 2005 :
01
03
05
06
10
14
18
20
22
27
30
(Ans.

6.

Received cash from Rahul


Bought goods for cash
Bought goods by cheque
Paid to Shyam by cash
Drew from Bank for office use
Rent paid by cheque
Cash in hand Rs. 5,000: cash at bank Rs. 37,000)

144

Commenced business with cash


Opened bank account with ICICI
Purchased goods for cash
Purchased office machine for cash
Sales goods on credit from Rohan and received chaeque
Cash sales
Rohans cheque deposited into bank
Paid cartage by cheque
Cash withdrawn for personal use
Paid rent by cheque
Cash in hand Rs. 11,000, Cash at bank Rs. 35,500)

Rs.
50,000
30,000
10,000
5,000
7,000
8,000
500
2,000
1,000

Prepare double column cash book from the following information for
September 2005:
01
03
05
10
15
20

Cash In hand
Bank overdraft
Paid wages
Cash sales
Cash deposited into bank
Goods purchased and paid by cheque
Paid rent

Rs.
7,500
3,500
200
7,000
4,000
2,000
500

Recording of Transactions - II
25
Drew from bank for personal use
30
Salary paid
(Ans. Cash in hand Rs. 8,800, Bank overdraft Rs. 1,900)
8.

Cash in hand
Bank overdraft
03
Goods purchased for cash
05
Paid wages
10
Cash sales
15
Deposited into bank
22
Sold goods for cheque which was deposited into
bank same day
25
Paid rent by cheque
28
Drew from bank for personal use
31
Bought goods by cheque
(Ans. Cash in hand Rs. 4,100 Cash at bank Rs. 2,500)

Rs.
3,500
2,300
1,200
200
8,000
6,000
2,000
1,200
1,000
1,000

Prepare double column cash book from the following transactions for the
year December 2005:
01

Cash in hand
Cash at bank
03
Purchased goods for cash
05
Received cheque from Jasmeet
08
Sold goods for cash
10
Jasmeets cheque deposited into bank
12
Purchased goods and paid by cheque
15
Paid establishment expenses through bank
18
Cash sales
20
Deposited into bank
24
Paid trade expenses
27
Received commission by cheque
29
Paid Rent
30
Withdrew cash for personal use
31
Salary paid
(Ans. Cash in hand Rs. 8,800 cash at bank Rs. 10,000)
10.

400
1,000

Enter the following transaction in a double column cash book of M/s.Mohit


Traders for January 2005 :
01

9.

145

Rs.
17,500
5,000
3,000
10,000
7,000
20,000
1,000
7,000
10,000
500
6,000
2,000
1,200
6,000

M/s Ruchi trader started their cash book with the following balances on
Dec. 01 2005 : cash in hand Rs.1,354 and balance in bank current account
Rs.7560. He had the following transaction in the month of December, 2005:
03
05
08
12
15
18

Cash sales
Purchased goods, paid by cheque
Cash sales
Paid trade expenses
Sales goods, received cheque(deposited same day)
Purchased motor car paid by cheque

Rs.
2,300
6,000
10,000
700
20,000
15,000

Recording of Transactions - II
20
22
25
28
29
31

Cheque received from Manisha(deposited same day)


Cash Sales
Manishas cheque returned dishonoured
Paid Rent
Paid telephone expenses by cheque
Cash withdrawn for personal use
Prepare bank column cash book
(Ans. Cash in hand Rs. 15,954 cash at bank Rs. 6,060)

146
10,000
7,000
2,000
500
2,000

Petty Cash Book


11.

Prepare petty cash book from the following transactions. The imprest
amount is Rs.2,000.
Rs.
January
01
Paid cartage
50
02
STD charges
40
02
Bus fare
20
03
Postage
30
04
Refreshment for employees
80
06
Courier charges
30
08
Refreshment of customer
50
10
Cartage
35
15
Taxi fare to manager
70
18
Stationery
65
20
Bus fare
10
22
Fax charges
30
25
Telegrams charges
35
27
Postage stamps
200
29
Repair on furniture
105
30
Laundry expenses
115
31
Miscellaneous expenses
100
(Ans. Cash balance Rs. 925)

12.

Record the following transactions during the week ending Dec.30, 2005
with a weekly imprest Rs. 500
24
25
25
26
27
29
(Ans.

Stationery
Bus fare
Cartage
Taxi fare
Wages to casual labour
Postage
Cash balance Rs. 98)

Rs.
100
12
40
80
90
80

Other Subsidiary Books


13.

Enter the following transactions in the Purchase Journal (Book) of


M/s Gupta Traders of July 2005 :

Recording of Transactions - II
01

15

23

25

20

147

Bought from Rahul Traders as per invoice no.20041


40 Registers @ Rs.60 each
80 Gel Pens @ Rs.15 each
50 note books @ Rs.20 each
Trade discount 10%.
Bought from Global Stationers as per invoice no.1132
40 Ink Pads @ Rs.8 each
50 Files @ Rs.10 each
20 Color Books @ Rs. 20 each
Trade Discount 5%
Purchased from Lamba Furniture as per invoice no.3201
2 Chairs @ 600 per chair
1 Table @ 1000 per table
Bought from Mumbai Traders as per invoice no.1111
10 Paper Rim @ Rs.100 per rim
400 drawing Sheets @ Rs.3 each
Packet water colour @ Rs.40 per packet

(Ans: Total of purchases book Rs. 8,299)


14.

Enter the following transactions in sales (journal) book of M/s.Bansal


electronics:
September
01
Sold to Amit Traders as per bill no.4321
20 Pocket Radio @ 70 per Radio
2, T.V. set, B&W.(6) @ 800 Per T.V.
10. Sold to Arun Electronics as per bill no.4351
5 T.V. sets (20) B&W @ Rs.3,000 per T.V.
2 T.V. sets (21) Colour @ Rs. 4,800 per T.V.
22
Sold to Handa Electronics as per bill no.4,399
10 Tape recorders @ Rs. 600 each
5 Walkman @ Rs. 300 each
28
Sold to Harish Trader as per bill no.4430
10 Mixer Juicer Grinder @ Rs. 800 each.
(Ans. Total of sales book Rs. 43,100)

15.

Prepare a purchases return (journal) book from the following transactions


for January 2006.
05
10
17

Returned goods to M/s Kartik Traders


Goods returned to Sahil Pvt. Ltd.
Goods returned to M/s Kohinoor Traders.
for list price Rs.2,000 less 10% trade discount.
28
Return outwards to M/s Handa Traders
(Ans. Total of purchases return book Rs. 6,050)

Rs.
1,200
2,500

550

Recording of Transactions - II
16.

148

Prepare Return Inward Journal(Book) from the following transactions of


M/s Bansal Electronics for November 2005:
04
10
18

M/s Gupta Traders returned the goods


Goods returned from M/s Harish Traders
M/s Rahul Traders returned the goods not as per
specifications
28
Goods returned from Sushil Traders
(Ans : Total of sales return Rs. 4,500)

Rs.
1,500
800
1,200
1,000

Recording, Posting and Balancing


17.

Prepare proper subsidiary books and post them to the ledger from the
following transactions for the month of February 2006:
01
04
06
07
08
10
14
15
17
20
22
24
25
26
28
28
Ans

18.

Rs.
Goods sold to Sachin
5,000
Purchase from Kushal Traders
2,480
Sold goods to Manish Traders
2,100
Sachin returned goods
600
Returns to Kushal Traders
280
Sold to Mukesh
3,300
Purchased from Kunal Traders
5,200
Furniture purchased from Tarun
3,200
Bought of Naresh
4,060
Return to Kunal Traders
200
Return inwards from Mukesh
250
Purchased goods from Kirit & Co. for list price of
5,700
less 10% trade discount
Sold to Shri Chand goods
6600
less 5% trade discount
Sold to Ramesh Brothers
4,000
Return outwards to Kirit and Co.
1,000
less 10% trade discount
Ramesh Brothers returned goods Rs. 500.
: (Total of sales book Rs.20,670, purchases book Rs.16,870,
Purchases return book Rs.1,380, sales return book Rs.1,350).

The following balances of ledger of M/s Marble Traders on April 01, 2006
Rs.
Cash in hand
6,000
Cash at bank
12,000
Bills receivable
7,000
Ramesh (Cr.)
3,000
Stock (Goods)
5,400
Bills payable
2,000
Rahul (Dr.)
9,700
Himanshu (Dr.)
10,000

Recording of Transactions - II

149

Transactions during the month were:


April
01
Goods sold to Manish
02
Purchased goods from Ramesh
03
Received cash from Rahul in full settlement
05
Cash received from Himanshu on account
06
paid to Remesh by cheque
08
Rent paid by cheque
10
Cash received from manish
12
Cash sales
14
Goods returned to Ramesh
15
Cash paid to Ramesh in full settlement
Discount received
18
Goods sold to Kushal
20
Paid trade expenses
21
Drew for personal use
22
Goods return from Kushal
24
Cash received from Kushal
26
Paid for stationery
27
Postage charges
28
Salary Paid
29
Goods purchased from Sheetal Traders
30
Sold goods to Kirit
Goods purchased from Handa Traders
Journlise the above transactions and post them to the ledger.

Rs.
3,000
8,000
9,200
4,000
6,000.
1,200
3,000
6,000
1,000
3,700
300
10,000
200
1,000
1,200
6,000
100
60
2,500
7,000
6000
5,000

Checklist to Test Your Understanding


Test Your Understanding - I
a. (iv)

b. (ii)

c. (iii)

d. (ii)

e. (ii)

f. (iv)

g .(ii)

h. (iii)

i. (iii)

Test Your Understanding - II


1.

(a) subsidiary
(e) cash, bank
(i) overdraft

(b) cash
(f) more
(j) imprest

(c) purchases return


(g) credit
(k) credit

(d) journal proper


(h) bank

2.

(a) False
(e) False
(i) True

(b) True
(f) True
(j) True

(c) False
(g) True
(k) False

(d) False
(h) False
(l) False

Bank Reconciliation Statement

LEARNING OBJECTIVES
After studying this
chapter, you will be able
to :
state the meaning and
need for the preparation
of bank reconciliation
statement;
identify causes of
difference between
bank balance as per
cash book and pass
book;
prepare the bank
reconciliation statement;
ascertain the correct
bank balance as per
cash book;

n chapter 4, you have learnt that


the business organisations keep a record of their
cash and bank transactions in a cash book. The
cash book also serves the purpose of both the cash
account and the bank account and shows the
balance of both at the end of the period.
Once the cash book has been balanced, it is
usual to check its details with the records of the
firms bank transactions as recorded by the bank.
To enable this check, the cashier needs to ensure
that the cash book is completely up to date and a
recent bank statement (or a bank passbook) has
been obtained from the bank. A bank statement
or a bank passbook is a copy of a bank account as
shown by the bank records. This enable the bank
customers to check their funds in the bank
regularly and update their own records of
transactions that have occurred. An illustrative
bank passbook of a current account is shown in
figure 5.1.
The amount of balance shown in the passbook
or the bank statement must tally with the balance
as shown in the cash book. But in practice, these
are usually found to be different. Hence, we have
to ascertain the causes for such difference. It will
be observed that a bank statement/passbook
shows all deposits in the credit column and
withdrawals in the debit column. Thus, if deposits
exceed withdrawals it shows a credit balance and
if withdrawals exceed deposits it will show a debit
balance (overdraft).

Bank Reconciliation Statement

151

5.1 Need for Reconciliation


It is generally experienced that when a comparison is made between the bank
balance as shown in the firms cash book, the two balances do not tally.
Hence, we have to first ascertain the causes of difference thereof and then
reflect them in a statement called Bank Reconciliation Statement to reconcile
(tally) the two balances.
In order to prepare a bank reconciliation statement we need to have a
bank balance as per the cash book and a bank statement as on a particular
day along with details of both the books. If the two balances differ, the entries
in both the books are compared and the items on account of which the
difference has arisen are ascertained with the respective amounts involved so
that the bank reconciliation statement may be prepared. Its format shown in
figure 5.5.
Particulars

Add:

Less:

Amount
Rs.

Balance as per cash book


Cheques issued but not presented
Interest credited by the bank
Cheques deposited but not credited by the bank
Bank charges not recorded in the cash book

.......
.......
.......
.......
.......
.......

Balance as per the passbook

xxxx

Fig. 5.2 : Proforma of bank reconciliation statement

It can also be prepared with two amount columns one showing additions
(+ column) and another showing deductions (-column). For convenience, we
usually adopt this treatment.
Particulars

Balance as per cash book


Cheques issued but not presented `
Interest credited by the bank
Cheque deposited but not credited by the bank
Bank charges not recorded in the cash book

Amount
Rs.
(+)

Amount
Rs.
()

......
......
......

Balance as per the passbook.


Fig. 5.3 : Proforma of bank reconcitiation statement (table form)

......
......
xxxx

DELHI PLA
TO SELF
BY CLG
BY CLG
TO SELF
BY CLG
BY CLG
To SELF
DELHI PLASTIC
ICICI
BY CLG
TO SELF
BY CLG
BY CLG
TO SERVICE CHARGES
TO SELF
TO SELF
BY CLG

04/08/2005
07/08/2005
13/08/2005
13/08/2005
17/08/2005
21/08/2005
26/08/2005
02/09/2005
04/09/2005
08/09/2005
09/09/2005
13/09/2005
15/09/2005
15/09/2005
16/09/2005
21/09/2005
25/09/2005
27/09/2005

35,000.00
10,000.00

20,000.00

30,000.00
10,000.00
6,074.00
9,500,00

120.00
20,000.00
10,000.00

356378

356381
356382
657755
356380

356383
356385

DEBIT
Rs. P.

356376
356377

CHEQUE
No.

16,198.00

5,320.00
18,564.00

3,146.00

25,808.00
32,949.00

10,673,00
9,143.00

Opening
Balance :

CREDIT
Rs. P.

15,782.30
5,782.30
16,455,30
25,598.30
5,598.30
31,406.30
64,355,30
34,355.30
24,355.30
18,281.30
21,427.30
11,927.30
17,247.30
35,811.30
35,691.30
15,691.30
5,691.30
21,889.30

50,782.30

+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+

BALANCE + REMARKS
Rs. P.

DATE : 01/09/2005
OP.ID : GK
PAGE NO. : 1

Fig. 5.1 : Specimen of bank statement (current account)

FOR DHERENDRA NATIONAL BANK


ACCOUNTANT/MANAGER

PARTICULARS

MULTI-MODULE PACKAGE
STATEMENT OF ACCOUNT
FROM 01/09/2005 TO 29/12/2005

DATE

PIN CODE : 110034

ACCOUNT NO. 03355


NAME : DEV PANDIT
KHADWAI, RUNAKUTA, DELHI

DHERENDRA NATIONAL BANK


CONNAUGHT PLACE

Bank Reconciliation Statement


152

Bank Reconciliation Statement

153

Reconciliation of the cash book and the bank passbook balances amounts
to an explanation of differences between them. The differences between the
cash book and the bank passbook is caused by:
timing differences on recording of the transactions.
errors made by the business or by the bank.
5.1.1 Timing Differences
When a business compares the balance of its cash book with the balance
shown by the bank passbook, there is often a difference, which is caused
by the time gap in recording the transactions relating either to payments
or receipts. The factors affecting time gap includes :
5.1.1(a) Cheques issued by the bank but not yet presented for payment
When cheques are issued by the firm to suppliers or creditors of the firm,
these are immediately entered on the credit side of the cash book. However,
the receiving party may not present the cheque to the bank for payment
immediately. The bank will debit the firms account only when these cheques
are actually paid by the bank. Hence, there is a time lag between the issue of
a cheque and its presentation to the bank which may cause the difference
between the two balances.
5.1.1(b) Cheques paid into the bank but not yet collected
When firm receives cheques from its customers (debtors), they are
immediately recorded in the debit side of the cash book. This increases
the bank balance as per the cash book. However, the bank credits the
customer account only when the amount of cheques are actually realised.
The clearing of cheques generally takes few days especially in case of
outstation cheques or when the cheques are paid-in at a bank branch
other than the one at which the account of the firm is maintained. This
leads to a cause of difference between the bank balance shown by the
cash book and the balance shown by the bank passbook.
5.1.1(c) Direct debits made by the bank on behalf of the customer
Sometimes, the bank deducts amount for various services from the account
without the firms knowledge. The firm comes to know about it only when
the bank statement arrives. Examples of such deductions include: cheque
collection charges, incidental charges, interest on overdraft, unpaid cheques
deducted by the bank i.e. stopped or bounced, etc. As a result, the balance
as per passbook will be less than the balance as per cash book.

Bank Reconciliation Statement

154

5.1.1(d) Amounts directly deposited in the bank account


There are instances when debtors(customers) directly deposits money into
firms bank account. But, the firm does not receive the intimation from any
source till it receives the bank statement. In this case, the bank records the
receipts in the firms account at the bank but the same is not recorded in the
firms cash book. As a result, the balance shown in the bank passbook will be
more than the balance shown in the firms cash book.
5.1.1(e) Interest and dividends collected by the bank
When the bank collects interest and dividend on behalf of the customer, then
these are immediately credited to the customers account. But the firm will know
about these transactions and record the same in the cash book only when it
receives a bank statement. Till then the balances as per the cash book and
passbook will differ.
5.1.1(f) Direct payments made by the bank on behalf of the customers
Sometimes the customers give standing instructions to the bank to make
some payment regularly on stated days to the third parties. For example,
telephone bills, insurance premium, rent, taxes, etc. are directly paid by the
bank on behalf of the customer and debited to the account. As a result, the
balance as per the bank passbook would be less than the one shown in the
cash book.
5.1.1(g) Cheques deposited/bills discounted dishonoured
If a cheque deposited by the firm is dishonoured or a bill of exchange drawn
by the business firm is discounted with the bank is dishonoured on the date
of maturity, the same is debited to customers account by the bank. As this
information is not available to the firm immediately, there will be no entry in
the firms cash book regarding the above items. This will be known to the firm
when it receives a statement from the bank. As a result, the balance as per
the passbook would be less than the cash book balance.
5.1.2 Differences Caused by Errors
Sometimes the difference between the two balances may be accounted for by
an error on the part of the bank or an error in the cash book of the business.
This causes difference between the bank balance shown by the cash book
and the balance shown by the bank statement.

Bank Reconciliation Statement

155

5.1.2(a) Errors committed in recording transaction by the firm


Omission or wrong recording of transactions relating to cheques issued, cheques
deposited and wrong totalling, etc. committed by the firm while recording entries
in the cash book cause difference between cash book and passbook balance.
5.1.2(b) Errors committed in recording transactions by the bank
Omission or wrong recording of transactions relating to cheques deposited
and wrong totalling, etc. committed by the bank while posting entries in the
passbook also cause differences between passbook and cash book balance.

Test Your Understanding - I


I.

Read the following transactions and identify the cause of difference on the basis of
time gap or errors made by business firm/bank. Put a sign (9 ) for the correct
cause.

S.No. Transactions

1.
2.

3.
4.
5.

II.

Time Gap

Errors
made by
business/
bank

Cheques issued to customers but not


presented for payment.
Cheque amounting to Rs. 5,000 issued
to M/s. XYZ but recorded as Rs. 500
in the cash book.
Interest credited by the bank but yet
not recorded in the cash book.
Cheque deposited into the bank but
not yet collected by the bank.
Bank charges debited to firms current
account by the bank.
Fill in the blanks :
(i) Passbook is a copy of.............as it appears in the ledger of the bank.
(ii) When money is with drawn from the bank, the bank ............. the account of
the customer.
(iii) Nor mally, the cash book shows a debit balance, passbook shows
.............balance.
(iv) Favourable balance as per the cash book means .............balance in the bank
column of the cash book.

Bank Reconciliation Statement

156

(v) If the cash book balance is taken as starting point the items which make the
cash book balance smaller than the passbook must be .............for the purpose
of reconciliation.
(vi) If the passbook shows a favourable balance and if it is taken as the starting
point for the purpose of bank reconciliation statement then cheques issued
but not presented for payment should be .............to find out cash balance.
(vii) When the cheques are not presented for payment, favourable balance as per
the cash book is .............than that of the passbook.
(viii) When a banker collects the bills and credits the account passbook overdraft
shows .............balance.
(ix) If the overdraft as per the passbook is taken as the starting point, the cheques
issued but not presented are to be .............in the bank reconciliation
statement.
(x) When the passbook balance is taken as the starting point items which makes
the passbook balance .............than the balance in the cash book must be
deducted for the purpose of reconciliation.

5.2 Preparation of Bank Reconciliation Statement


After identifying the causes of difference, the reconciliation may be done in
the following two ways:
(a) Preparation of bank reconciliation statement without adjusting cash book
balance.
(b) Preparation of bank reconciliation statement after adjusting cash book
balance.
It may be noted that in practice, the bank reconciliation statement is
prepared after adjusting the cash book balance, about which you will study
later in the chapter.
5.2.1 Preparation of Bank Reconciliation Statement without adjusting Cash
Book Balance
To prepare bank reconciliation statement, under this approach, the balance
as per cash book or as per passbook is the starting item. The debit balance as
per the cash book means the balance of deposits held at the bank. Such a
balance will be a credit balance as per the passbook. Such a balance exists
when the deposits made by the firm are more than its withdrawals. It indicates
the favourable balance as per cash book or favourable balance as per the
passbook. On the other hand, the credit balance as per the cash book indicates
bank overdraft. In other words, the excess amount withdrawn over the amount
deposited in the bank. It is also known as unfavourable balance as per cash
book or unfavourable balance as per passbook.

Bank Reconciliation Statement

157

We may have four different situations while preparing the bank


reconciliation statement. These are :
1. When debit balance (favourable balance) as per cash book is given and
the balance as per passbook is to be ascertained.
2. When credit balance (favourable balance) as per passbook is given and
the balance as per cash book is to be ascertained.
3. When credit balance as per cash book (unfavourable balance/overdraft
balance) is given and the balance as per passbook is to ascertained.
4. When debit balance as per passbook (unfavourable balance/overdraft
balance) is given and the cash book balance as per is to ascertained.
5.2.1(a) Dealing with favourable balances
The following steps may be initiated to prepare the bank reconciliation
statement:
(i) The date on which the statement is prepared is written at the top, as
part of the heading.
(ii) The first item in the statement is generally the balance as shown by the
cash book. Alternatively, the starting point can also be the balance as
per passbook.
(iii) The cheques deposited but not yet collected are deducted.
(iv) All the cheques issued but not yet presented for payment, amounts
directly deposited in the bank account are added.
(v) All the items of charges such as interest on overdraft, payment by bank
on standing instructions and debited by the bank in the passbook but
not entered in cash book, bills and cheques dishonoured etc. are
deducted.
(vi) All the credits given by the bank such as interest on dividends collected,
etc. and direct deposits in the bank are added.
(vii) Adjustment for errors are made according to the principles of rectification
of errors. (The rectification of errors has been discussed in detail in
chapter 6.)
(viii) Now the net balance shown by the statement should be same as shown
by the passbook.
It may be noted that treatment of all items shall be the reverse of the above
if we adjust passbook balance as the starting point.(see illustration 3)
The following solved illustrations will help you understand dealing with
favourable balance as per cash book and passbook.

Bank Reconciliation Statement

158

Illustration 1
From the following particulars of Mr. Vinod, prepare bank reconciliation statement as on
March 31, 2005.
1. Bank balance as per cash book Rs. 50,000.
2. Cheques issued but not presented for payment Rs. 6,000.
3. The bank had directly collected dividend of Rs. 8,000 and credited to bank account
but was not entered in the cash book.
4. Bank charges of Rs. 400 were not entered in the cash book.
5. A cheques for Rs. 6,000 was deposited but not collected by the bank.
Solution
Bank Reconciliation Statement of Mr. Vinod as on March 31, 2005
Particulars

1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.

Balance as per cash book


Cheques issued but not presented for payment
Dividends collected by the bank
Cheque deposited but not credited by the bank
Bank charges debited by the bank
Balance as per passbook.

+
Rs.

Rs.

50,000
6,000
8,000
6,000
400
57,600
64,000

64,000

Illustration 2
From the following particulars of Anil & Co. prepare a bank reconciliation statement as
on August 31, 2005.
1. Balance as per the cash book Rs. 54,000.
2. Rs. 100 bank incidental charges debited to Anil & Co. account, which is not recorded
in cash book.
3. Cheques for Rs. 5,400 is deposited in the bank but not yet collected by the bank.
4. A cheque for Rs. 20,000 is issued by Anil & Co. not presented for payment.
Solution
Bank Reconciliation Statement of Anil & Co. as on August 31, 2005

1.
2.
3.
4.
5.

Particulars

(+)
Amount
Rs.

()
Amount
Rs.

Balance as per cash book


Cheqeus issued but not presented for payment
Cheques deposited but not credited by the bank
Bank incidental charges debited by the bank
Balance as per passbook

54,000
20,000
-

5,400
100
68,500

74,000

74,000

Bank Reconciliation Statement

159

Illustration 3
The bank passbook of M/s. Boss & Co. showed a balance of Rs. 45,000 on May 31, 2005.
1. Cheques issued before May 31,2005, amounting to Rs. 25,940 had not been
presented for encashment.
2. Two cheques of Rs. 3,900 and Rs. 2,350 were deposited into the bank on May 31
but the bank gave credit for the same in June.
3. There was also a debit in the passbook of Rs. 2,500 in respect of a cheque
dishonoured on 31.5.2005. Prepare a bank reconciliation statement as on
May 31, 2005.
Solution
Bank Reconciliation Statement of Bose & Co as on May 31, 2005
Particulars

(+)
Amount
Rs.
45,000
6,250

3.
4.

Balance as per passbook


Cheques deposited but not collected by the bank
(Rs. 3,900+ Rs. 2,350)
Cheque dishonoured recorded only in passbook
Cheques issued but not presented for payment

5.

Balance as per cash book

1.
2.

()
Amount
Rs.

2,500
25,940
27,810
53,750

53,750

5.2.1(b) Dealing with overdrafts


So far we have dealt with bank reconciliation statement where bank balances
has been positive i.e., there has been money in the bank account. However,
businesses sometimes have overdrafts at the bank. Overdrafts are where the
bank account becomes negative and the businesses in effect have borrowed
from the bank. This is shown in the cash book as a credit balance. In the
bank statement, where the balance is followed by Dr. (or sometimes OD) means
that there is an overdraft and called debit balance as per passbook.
An overdraft is treated as negative figure on a bank reconciliation statement.
The following solved illustration will help you understand the preparation of
bank reconciliation statement when there is an overdraft.
Illustration 4
On March 31, 2005, Rakesh had on overdraft of Rs. 8,000 as shown by his cash book.
Cheques amounting to Rs. 2,000 had been paid in by him but were not collected by the
bank. He issued cheques of Rs. 800 which were not presented to the bank for payment.
There was a debit in his passbook of Rs. 60 for interest and Rs. 100 for bank charges.
Prepare bank reconciliation statement.

Bank Reconciliation Statement

160

Solution
Bank Reconciliation Statement of Rakesh as on April 01, 2005
Particulars

1.
2.
3.
4.
5.

(+)
Amount
Rs.

Overdraft as per cash book


Cheques deposited but not yet collectedcharged by the bank
Bank charges
Cheques issued but not presented for payment
Balance as per bank passbook (overdraft)

800
9,360
10,160

()
Amount
Rs.
8,000
2,000
60
100
10,160

Illustration 5
On March 31, 2005 the bank column of the cash book of Agrawal Traders showed a credit
balance of Rs. 1,18,100 (Overdraft). On examining of the cash book and the bank statement,
it was found that :
1. Cheques received and recorded in the cash book but not sent to the bank of collection
Rs. 12,400.
2. Payment received from a customer directly by the bank Rs. 27,300 but no entry
was made in the cash book.
3. Cheques issued for Rs. 1,75,200 not presented for payment.
Interest of Rs. 8,800 charged by the bank was not entered in the cash book. Prepare
bank reconciliation statement.
Solution
Bank Reconciliation Statement of Agarwal Traders as on March 31, 2005
Particulars

1.
2.

(+)
Amount
Rs.

4.
5.
6.

Overdraft as per cash book


Cheques received and recorded in the cash book but not
sent to the bank for collection
Interest on bank overdraft debited by the bank but not
entered in the cash book
Payment received from the customer directly
27,300
Credited in the bank a/c but not entered in the cash book 1,75,200
Cheques issued but not presented for payment

7.

Balance as per the passbook (favourable balance)

3.

()
Amount
Rs.
1,18,100
12,400
8,800

63,200
2,02,500

2,02,500

Bank Reconciliation Statement

161

Illustration 6
From the following particulars of Asha & Co. prepare a bank reconciliation statement on
December 31, 2005.
Rs.
Overdraft as per passbook
20,000
Interest on overdraft
2,000
Insurance Premium paid by the bank
200
Cheque issued but not presented for payment
6,500
Cheque deposited but not yet cleared
6,000
Wrongly debited by the bank
500
Solution
Bank Reconciliation Statement of Asha & Co as on December 31, 2005
Particulars

1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.

Overdraft as per passbook


Interest on overdraft
Insurance premium paid by the bank
Cheque issued but not presented for payment
Cheques deposited but not yet cleared
Wrongly debited by the bank
Balance as per the cash book (overdraft)

(+)
Amount
Rs.

()
Amount
Rs.
20,000

2,000
200
6,500
6,000
500
17,800
26,500

26,500

Illustration 7
From the following particulars, prepare a bank reconciliation statement as on
March 31, 2001.
(a) Debit balance as per cash book is Rs. 10,000.
(b) A cheque for Rs. 1,000 deposited but not recorded in the cash book.
(c) A cash deposit of Rs. 200 was recorded in the cash book if there is not bank,
column therein.
(d) A cheque issued for Rs. 250 was recorded as Rs. 205 in the cash column.
(e) The debit balance of Rs. 1,500 as on the previous day was brought forward as a
credit balance.
(f) The payment side of the cash book was under cast by Rs. 100.
(g) A cash discount allowed of Rs. 112 was recorded as Rs. 121 in the bank column.
(h) A cheque of Rs. 500 received from a debtor was recorded in the cash book but not
deposited in the bank for collection.
(i) One outgoing cheque of Rs. 300 was recorded twice in the cash book.

Bank Reconciliation Statement

162

Solution
Bank Reconciliation statement as on September 30, 2004

1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6,
7.
8.
9.
10.

Particulars

(+)
Amount
Rs.

Debit balance as per cash book


Error in carrying forward
Cheque recorded twice in cash book
Cheque deposit not record in bank column
Cheque deposit but not recorded
Under casting of payment side
Cheque issued but not entered
A cash discount wrongly recorded in bank column
Cheque recorded but not deposited
Credit balance as per passbook

10,000
3,000
300
200
1,000

14,500

()
Amount
Rs.

100
250
121
500
13,529
14,500

Illustration 8
From the following particulars, prepare the bank reconciliation statement of Shri Krishan
as on March 31, 2005.
(a) Balance as per passbook is Rs. 10,000.
(b) Bank collected a cheque of Rs. 500 on behalf of Shri Krishan but wrongly credited
it to Shri Krishans account.
(c) Bank recorded a cash book deposit of Rs. 1,589 as Rs. 1,598.
(d) Withdrawal column of the passbook under cast by Rs. 100.
(e) The credit balance of Rs. 1,500 as on the pass-book was recorded in the debit
balance.
(f) The payment of a cheque of Rs. 350 was recorded twice in the passbook.
(g) The pass-book showed a credit balance. For a cheque of Rs. 100 deposited by Shri
Kishan.
Solution
Bank Reconciliation Statement as on March 31, 2005

1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.

Particulars

(+)
Amount
Rs.

Credit balance as per passbook


Cheque wrongly credited to another customer account
Error in carrying forward
Cheque recorded twice
Excess credit for cash deposit
Under casting of withdrawal column
Wrong credit
Debit balance as per cash book

10,000
500
3,000
350

()
Amount
Rs.

9
100
1,000
12,741
13,850

13,850

Bank Reconciliation Statement

163

Test Your Understanding - II


Select the Correct Answer:
1. A bank reconciliation statement is prepared by :
(a) Creditors
(b) Bank
(c) Account holder in a bank
(d) Debtors
2. A bank reconciliation statement is prepared with the balance :
(a) Passbook
(b) Cash book
(c) Both passbook and cash book
(d) None of these
3. Passbook is a copy of :
(a) Copy of customer Account
(c) Cash column of cash book

(b) Bank column of cash book


(d) Copy of receipts and payments

4. Unfavourable bank balance means :


(a) Credit balance in passbook
(b) Credit balance in cash book
(c) Debit balance in cash book
(d) None of these
5. Favourable bank balance means :
(a) Credit balance in the cash book
(c) Debit balance in the cash book

(b) Credit balance in passbook


(d) Both b and c

6. A bank reconciliation statement is mainly prepared for :


(a) Reconcile the cash balance of the cash book.
(b) Reconcile the difference between the bank balance shown
by the cash book and bank passbook
(c) Both a and b
(d) None of these

5.2.2 Preparation of Bank Reconciliation Statement with Adjusted


Cash Book
When we look at the various items that normally cause the difference between
the passbook balance and the cash book balance, we find a number of items,
which appear only in the passbook. Why not first record such items in the
cash book to work out the adjusted balance (also known as amended balance)
of the cash book and then prepare the bank reconciliation statement. This
shall reduce the number of items responsible for the difference and have the
correct figure of balance at bank in the balance sheet. In fact, this is exactly
what is done in practice whereby only those items which cause the difference
on account of the time gap in recording appear in bank reconciliation statement.
These are as (i) cheques issued but not yet presented, (ii) cheques deposited
but not yet collected, and (iii) due to an error in the passbook. The step wise
preparation of bank reconciliation statement is shown in figure 5.4.

Bank Reconciliation Statement

164

Illustration 9
The following is the summary of a cash book for December, 2004.
Cash Book (Bank Column)
Receipts
Balance c/d

Rs.
13,221
4,986

Balance b/d
Payments

18,207

Rs.
6,849
11,358
18,207

All receipts are banked and payments are made by cheques. On investigation the
following are observed:
1. Bank charges of Rs. 1,224 entered in the bank statement have not been entered in
cash book.
2. Cheques drawn amounting to Rs. 2,403 have not been presented to the bank for
payment.
3. Cheques received totalling Rs. 6,858 have been entered in the cash book and deposited
in the bank, but have not been credited by the bank until January, 2005.
4. A cheque for Rs. 198 has been entered as a receipt in the cash book instead of as
payment.
5. A cheque for Rs. 225 has been debited by the bank in error.
6. A cheque received for Rs. 720 has been returned by the bank and marked No
funds available, no adjustment had been made in the cash book.
7. All dividends receivable are credited directly to the bank account. During December,
an amount of Rs. 558 was credited by the bank and no entry is made in the cash book.
8. A cheque drawn for Rs. 54 has been incorrectly entered in the cash book as Rs.594.
9. The balance brought forward should have been Rs. 639.
10. The bank statement as on December, 31, 2004 showed an overdraft of Rs. 10,458.
(a) You are required to prepare an amended cash book and
(b) Prepare a bank reconciliation statement as on Dec. 31, 2004.
Solution
Amended Cash Book
(Bank column)
Dr.
Date Particulars

L.F. Amount Date Particulars


Rs.

Dividends received

558

Adj. for cheque drawn for


Rs.54 entered as Rs.594
Adj. of balance brought
forward
Balance c/d

540
450

Balance b/d
Bank charges
Adj. regarding cheque
entered as receipt
Adj. regarding cheque
returned

5,778
7,326

Cr.
L.F. Amount
Rs.
4,986
1,224
396
720

7,326
Balance b/d

5,778

Bank Reconciliation Statement

165

Bank Reconciliation Statement as on Dec. 31, 2004


Rs.
Add:

Overdraft as per bank statement


Cheque issued but not yet presented for payment

Less:

Cheques deposited but not yet credited

Rs.
10,458
2,403
12,861

6,858

Cheque debited in error


Balance as per cash book

225

7,083
5,778

Illustration 10
The bank overdraft of Smith Ltd., on December 31, 2004 as per cash book is Rs.18,000
From the following information, asscertain the adjusted cash balance and prepare bank
reconciliation statement
Rs.
(i) Unpresented cheques
6,000
(ii) Uncleared cheques
3,400
(iii) Bank interest debited in the passbook only
1,000
(iv) Bills collected and credited in the passbook only
1,600
(v) Cheque of Arun traders dishonoured
1,000
(vi) Cheque issued to Kapoor & Co. not yet entered in the
600
of cash book.
Amended Cash Book (Bank Column)
Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars

L.F. Amount Date Particulars


Rs.

Bills collected as per


passbook
Balance c/d

1,600
19,000

L.F. Amount
Rs.

Balance b/d

18,000

Interest
Cheque dishonoured
(Arun Traders)
Kapoor and Co.
(cheque)

20,600

19,000

Bank Reconciliation Statement as on December 31, 2004

Less

1,000
600
20,600

Balance b/d

Add

1,000

Bank overdraft as per cash book


Uncleared cheques
Unpresented cheques
Bank overdraft as per passbook

19,000
3,400
22,400
6,000
16,400

Bank Reconciliation Statement

166

Fig. 5.4 : Showing the step wise preparation of bank reconcilation statement

A Small Project An Activity of Preparation of Bank Reconcilation Statement


Kamlesh works as a cashier for Aqua Products Co. His responsibilities include
maintainance of the firms. The firms cash book for July 2005 which Kamlesh
has just finished entering and balancing for the month is shown in exhibit 1.
Help Kamlesh to prepare the bank reconciliation statement.
Note : the cash column is omitted). A copy of firms bank statement dated July 31, 2005 is
also illustrated in exhibiy 2. The numerical difference between the two is Rs. 261.30.
(Bank statement Rs. 903.00 Cash book Rs. 641.70).
Aqua Products Cash Book
Date

Particulars

2005
July 01
July 03
July 15
July 31

Balance b/d
Kanishk Enterprises
Rampaul and Sons
Sarin Bros

Bank
Rs.
756.209
220.009
330.009
63.00

Date
2005
July 02
July 02
July 02
July 08
July 14
July 14
July 15
July 26
July 31

1,369.20
July 31

Balance b/d

641.70
Exhibit-1

5.4

Particulars

Bank
Rs.

Aditya
004450
Verma & Co. 004451
Gytri & Co. 004452
Mehta Ltd. 004453
Subash & Co.
Kaushik
004454
Kriosk Ltd. 004455
Insurance premium
(SO)
Balance c/d

50.009
130.00
10.009
27.50
89.009
49.009
250.009
122.009
641.70
1,369.20

Bank Reconciliation Statement

167
Bank Statement

Account
Account Number
Ledger No.
Date

Aqual Products Co.


79014456
17
July 31, 2005

Date

Details

Debit
Rs.

2005
July 01
July 04
July 09
July 14
July 16
July 19
July 24
July 26
July 30
July 31
July 31

Balance
Cheques
004450
004452
Subash & Co. (DD)
Cheques
004455
Insurance Premium
004454
Bank charges
Ruchita Limited

Credit
Rs.

220.00 9
50.009
10.009
89.009
330.00 9
250.009
122.009
49.009
12.95
179.75

Balance
Rs.
756.20
976.20
926.20
916.20
827.20
1,157.20
907.20
785.20
736.20
723.25
903.00

Cr.9
Cr.
Cr.
Cr.
Cr.
Cr.
Cr.
Cr.
Cr.
Cr.
Cr.

Exhibit 2
Solution
Step 1 : Tick off the items in both cash book and bank statement (as shown in Exhibit 2).
Step 2 : Updating the cash book from the bank statement.
The unticked items on the bank statement indicate items that have not yet been entered
in Aqua Products Co.s cash book. These are :
(i) Receipt on July 31 by Ruchita Limited amounting to Rs. 179.75
(ii) Bank charges debited by bank on July 31 amounting to Rs. 12.95
These items needs to be entered in the cash book to up date it (refer exhibit 3 The
new entries are shown in darker type).
Aqua Products Cash Book (Extract)
Date

Details

2005
July 31 Balance b/d
July 31 Ruchita Limited

Bank
Rs.
641.70
179.75

Date

Details

2005
July 31
Jul. 31

Bank charges
Balance c/d

821.45
Aug. 01

Balance b/d

808.50
Exhibit 3

Bank
Rs.
12.95
808.50
821.45

Bank Reconciliation Statement

168

Step 3 : Balance the cash book bank columns to produce an updated balance.
As shown in exhibit 3, the balance of the bank column stands at Rs. 808.50. But then
a difference is Rs. 94.50 (i.e. Rs. 903.00 808.50) still exists.
Step 4 : Identify the remaining unticked items from the cash book.
These are
Rs.
1. Receipts on July 31 from Sarin Bros
63.00
2. Payments made on July 02 to Verma & Co.
130.00
(Cheque No. 004457)
3. Payments made on July 08 to Mehta Ltd.
27.50
(Cheque No. 004453)
These above three items will appear in next months bank statement as these are due to
time gap. These are the items which will appear in the bank reconciliation statement.
Aqua Products Co.
Bank Reconciliation Statement as on July 31, 2005

Balance at bank as per cash book


Add Unpresented cheques
Verma and Co.
Mehta and Co.
Less Outstanding lodgement
Balance at bank as per bank statement

Rs.
808.50
130.00
27.50

157.50
966.00
63.00
903.00

Do it Yourself
You are a trainee accountant for Kamraj Limited, a small printing company. One of
your tasks is to enter transactions in the companys cash book, check the entries on
receipt of the bank statement, update the cash book and make any amendments as
necessary. You are then asked to prepare a bank reconciliation statement at the end
of the month.
The companys cash book (showing the bank money columns only) and the bank
statement are shown below.
You are required to :

compare the cash book with the bank statement.

Make the entries necessary to update the cash book.

Calculate the adjusted bank balance as per cash book.

Bank Reconciliation Statement

169
Kamrat Ltd. Cash Book

Date

Particulars

2005
Aug. 01 Balance b/d
Aug.
Aug.
Aug.
Aug.
Aug.
Aug.
Aug.

01
05
08
10
18
27
30

Bank Date
Rs.
1,946

Kapoor & Co.


V. S. Rao
S. K. Alok
E. Norries Ltd.
Samaira Ltd.
Harsh Vardan
IBP Partners

Particulars

Bank
Rs.

2005
Aug. 02 XYZ Insurance

75

249 Aug. 02 Nanda & Co. 200100


206
188 Aug. 04 Daily Ltd.
200101
315
150 Aug. 07 Garage Charges200102
211
440 Aug. 09 M.D. Finance
120
65 Aug. 13 Hill Bros
200103
22
520 Aug. 20 Akshey Ltd.
200104
137
82 Aug. 27 Kalakriti Ltd.
270
Aug. 31 Balance c/d
2,284
3,640

Sep. 01 Balance b/d

3,640

2,284
Exhibit 1

ABC
12, Mall Road, Gurgaon.
Account Kamraj Limited
78300582
Date
August 31, 2004

Date

Particulars

2005
Aug. 01
Aug. 02
Aug. 04
Aug. 04
Aug. 05
Aug. 08
Aug. 09
Aug. 12
Aug. 12
Aug. 20
Aug. 27
Aug. 30
Aug. 31
Aug. 31

Balance
Cheques
XYZ Insurance (DD)
200101
V. S. Rao
Cheques
200102
Cheques
N. P. Finance (SO)
Cheques
Kalakriti Ltd.
Tony Bros
Bank charges
Surya Finance (SO)

STATEMENT
Account No.

Debit

Credit

249
75
315
188
150
211
440
120
65
270
92
55
1,000
Exhibit 2

Balance
Rs.
1,946
2,195
2,120
1,805
1,993
2,143
1,932
2,372
2,252
2,317
2,047
2,139
2,084
1,084

CR
CR
CR
CR
CR
CR
CR
CR
CR
CR
CR
CR
CR
CR

Bank Reconciliation Statement

170

Name of business..........
Bank Reconciliation Statement as at ..........
Balance at bank as per cash book

..........

Add : unpresented cheque(s)

..........

Less : outstanding lodgement(s) not yet entered on bank statement


Balance at bank as per bank statement

..........

Note : show the working clearly and step-wise


Test your Understanding - III
State whether each of the following statements is True or False
1. Passbook is the statement of account of the customer maintained by the bank.
2. A business firm periodically prepares a bank reconciliation statement to reconcile
the bank balance as per the cash book with the passbook as these two show
different balances for various reasons.
3. Cheques issued but not presented for payment will reduce the balance as per
the passbook.
4. Cheques deposited but not collected will result in increasing the balance of the
cash book when compared to passbook.
5. Overdraft as per the passbook is less than the overdraft as per cash book when
there are cheques deposited but not collected by the banker.
6. The debit balance of the bank account as per the cash book should be equal to
the credit balance of the account of the business in the books of the bank.
7. Favourable bank balance as per the cash book will be less than the bank passbook
balance when there are unpresented cheques for payment.
8. Direct collections received by the bank on behalf of the customers would increase
the balance as per the bank passbook when compared to the balance as per the
cash book.
9. When payments made by the bank as per the standing instructions of the
customer, the balance in the passbook will be more when compared to the cash
book.
Key Terms Introduced in the Chapter
1.
2.

Bank Reconciliation Statement


Cash book and Passbook

Bank Reconciliation Statement

171

Summary with Reference to Learning Objectives


1.

2.

3.

Bank Reconciliation Statement : A statement prepared to reconcile the bank


balance as per cash book with the balance as per passbook or bank statement,
by showing the items of difference between the two accounts.
Causes of difference :

timing of recoding the transaction.

error made by business or by the bank.


Correct cash balance: It may happens that some of the receipts or payments
are missing from either of the books and errors, if any, need to be rectified.
This arise the need to look at the entries/errors recorded in both statements
and other information available and compute the correct cash balance before
reconciling the statements.
Questions for Practice

Short Answers
1. State the need for the preparation of bank reconciliation statement?
2. What is a bank overdraft?
3. Briefly explain the statement wrongly debited by the bank with the help of
an example.
4. State the causes of difference occurred due to time lag.
5. Briefly explain the term favourable balance as per cash book
6. Enumerate the steps to ascertain the correct cash book balance.
Long Answers
1. What is a bank reconciliation statement. Why is it prepared?
2. Explain the reasons where the balance shown by the bank passbook does
not agree with the balance as shown by the bank column of the cash book.
3. Explain the process of preparing bank reconciliation statement with
amended cash balance.
Numerical Questions
Favourable balance of cash book and passbook
1. From the following particulars, prepare a, bank reconciliation statement
as at March 31, 2005.
(i) Balance as per cash book Rs. 3,200
(ii) Cheque issued but not presented for payment Rs. 1,800
(iii) Cheque deposited but not collected upto March 31, 2005 Rs. 2000
(iv) Bank charges debited by bank Rs. 150
(Ans: Balance as per passbook Rs. 2,800)
2.

On March 31 2005 the cash book showed a balance of Rs. 3,700 as cash at
bank, but the bank passbook made up to same date showed that cheques
for Rs. 700, Rs. 300 and Rs. 180 respectively had not presented for payment,

Bank Reconciliation Statement

3.

4.

5.

6.

Also, cheque amounting to Rs. 1,200 deposited into the account had not
been credited. Prepare a bank reconciliation statement.
(Ans : Balance as per passbook Rs. 3,680).
The cash book shows a bank balance of Rs. 7,800. On comparing the cash
book with passbook the following discrepancies were noted :
(a) Cheque deposited in bank but not credited Rs. 3,000
(b) Cheque issued but not yet present for payment Rs. 1,500
(c) Insurance premium paid by the bank Rs. 2,000
(d) Bank interest credit by the bank Rs. 400
(e) Bank charges Rs. 100
(d) Directly deposited by a customer Rs. 4,000
(Ans: Balance as per passbook Rs. 8,600).
Bank balance of Rs. 40,000 showed by the cash book of Atul on December
31, 2005. It was found that three cheques of Rs. 2,000, Rs. 5,000 and
Rs. 8,000 deposited during the month of December were not credited in
the passbook till January 02, 2005. Two cheques of Rs. 7,000 and Rs.
8,000 issued on December 28, were not presented for payment till January
03, 2005. In addition to it bank had credited Atul for Rs. 325 as interest
and had debited him with Rs. 50 as bank charges for which there were no
corresponding entries in the cash book.
Prepare a bank reconciliation statement as on December 31, 2004.
(Ans: Balance as per passbook Rs. 40,245).
On comparing the cash book with passbook of Naman it is found that on
March 31, 2005, bank balance of Rs. 40,960 showed by the cash book
differs from the bank balance with regard to the following :
(a) Bank charges Rs 100 on March 31, 2005, are not entered in the cash
book.
(b) On March 21, 2005, a debtor paid Rs. 2,000 into the companys bank
in settlement of his account, but no entry was made in the cash book
of the company in respect of this.
(c) Cheques totaling Rs. 12,980 were issued by the company and duly
recorded in the cash book before March 31, 2005, but had not been
presented at the bank for payment until after that date.
(d) A bill for Rs. 6,900 discounted with the bank is entered in the cash
book with recording the discount charge of Rs. 800.
(e) Rs. 3,520 is entered in the cash book as paid into bank on March 31st,
2005, but not credited by the bank until the following day.
(f) No entry has been made in the cash book to record the dishon or on
March 15, 2005 of a cheque for Rs. 650 received from Bhanu.
Prepare a reconciliation statement as on March 31, 2005.
(Ans: Balance as per passbook Rs. 50,870).
Prepare bank reconciliation statement as on December 31, 2004. On this
day the passbook of Mr. Himanshu showed a balance of Rs. 7,000.
(a) Cheques of Rs. 1,000 directly deposited by a customer.

172

Bank Reconciliation Statement


(b) The bank has credited Mr. Himanshu for Rs. 700 as interest.
(c) Cheques for Rs. 3000 were issued during the month of December but
of these cheques for Rs. 1,000 were not presented during the month of
December.
(Ans: Balance as per cash book Rs. 3,300).
7. From the following particulars prepare a bank reconciliation statement
showing the balance as per cash book on December 31, 2005.
(a) Two cheques of Rs. 2,000 and Rs. 5,000 were paid into bank in October,
2005 but were not credited by the bank in the month of December.
(b) A cheque of Rs. 800 which was received from a customer was entered
in the bank column of the cash book in December 2004 but was omitted
to be banked in December, 2004.
(c) Cheques for Rs. 10,000 were issued into bank in January 2005 but
not credited by the bank on December 31, 2005.
(d) Interest on investment Rs. 1,000 collected by bank appeared in the
passbook.
Balance as per Passbook was Rs. 50,000
(Ans: Balance as per cash book Rs. 47,800)
8. Balance as per passbook of Mr. Kumar is 3,000.
(a) Cheque paid into bank but not yet cleared
Ram Kumar Rs. 1,000
Kishore Kumar Rs. 500
(b) Bank Charges Rs. 300
(c) Cheque issued but not presented
Hameed Rs. 2,000
Kapoor Rs. 500
(d) Interest entered in the passbook but not entered in the cash book Rs. 100
Prepare a bank reconciliation statement.
(Ans: Balance as per cash book Rs. 2,200).
9. The passbook of Mr. Mohit current account showed a credit Balance of
Rs. 20,000 on dated December 31, 2005. Prepare a Bank Reconciliation
Statement with the following information.
(i) A cheque of Rs. 400 drawn on his saving account has been shown on
current account.
(ii) He issued two cheques of Rs. 300 and Rs. 500 on of December 25, but
only the Ist cheque was presented for payment.
(iii) One cheque issued by Mr. Mohit of Rs. 500 on December 25, but it was
not presented for payment whereas it was recorded twice in the cash
book.
(Ans: Balance as per cash book Rs. 18,900).

173

Bank Reconciliation Statement


Unfavourable balance of cash book
10. On Ist January 2005, Rakesh had an overdraft of Rs. 8,000 as showed by
his cash book. Cheques amounting to Rs. 2,000 had been paid in by him
but were not collected by the bank by January 01, 2005. He issued cheques
of Rs. 800 which were not presented to the bank for payment up to that
day. There was a debit in his passbook of Rs. 60 for interest and Rs. 100
for bank charges. Prepare bank reconciliation statement for comparing
both the balance.
(Ans : Overdraft as per passbook Rs. 9,360)
11. Prepare bank reconciliation statement.
(i) Overdraft shown as per cash book on December 31, 2005 Rs. 10,000.
(ii) Bank charges for the above period also debited in the passbook
Rs. 100.
(iii) Interest on overdraft for six months ending December 31, 2005
Rs. 380 debited in the passbook.
(iv) Cheques issued but not incashed prior to December 31, 2005
amounted to Rs. 2,150.
(v) Interest on Investment collected by the bank and credited in the
passbook Rs. 600.
(vi) Cheques paid into bank but not cleared before December, 31 2005
were Rs. 1,100.
(Ans: overdraft as per passbook Rs. 8,830).
12. Kumar find that the bank balance shown by his cash book on December
31, 2005 is Rs. 90,600 (Credit) but the passbook shows a difference due
to the following reason:
A cheque (post dated) for Rs. 1,000 has been debited in the bank column
of the cash book but not presented for payment. Also, a cheque for
Rs. 8,000 drawn in favour of Manohar has not yet been presented for
payment. Cheques totaling Rs. 1,500 deposited in the bank have not yet
been collected and cheque for Rs. 5,000 has been dishonoured.
(Ans: overdraft as per passbook Rs. 1,03,600).
13. On December 31, 2005, the cash book of Mittal Bros. Showed an overdraft
of Rs. 6,920. From the following particulars prepare a Bank Reconciliation
Statement and ascertain the balance as per passbook.
(1) Debited by bank for Rs. 200 on account of Interest on overdraft and
Rs. 50 on account of charges for collecting bills.
(2) Cheques drawn but not encashed before December, 31 2005 for
Rs. 4,000.
(3) The bank has collected interest and has credited Rs. 600 in passbook.
(4) A bill receivable for Rs. 700 previously discounted with the bank
had been dishonoured and debited in the passbook.
(5) Cheques paid into bank but not collected and credited before
December 31, 2005 amounted Rs. 6,000.
(Ans : Overdraft as per passbook Rs. 9,270).

174

Bank Reconciliation Statement


Unfavourable balance of the passbook
14.

Prepare bank reconciliation statement of Shri Bhandari as on December


31, 2005
(i) The Payment of a cheque for Rs. 550 was recorded twice in the
passbook.
(ii) Withdrawal column of the passbook under cast by Rs. 200
(iii) A Cheque of Rs. 200 has been debited in the bank column of the
Cash Book but it was not sent to bank at all.
(iv) A Cheque of Rs. 300 debited to Bank column of the passbook was
not sent to the bank.
(v) Rs. 500 in respect of dishonoured cheque were entered in the
passbook but not in the cash book.
Overdraft as per passbook is Rs. 20,000.
(Ans: Overdraft as per cash book Rs. 20,350).
15. Overdraft shown by the passbook of Mr. Murli is Rs. 20,000. Prepare
bank reconciliation statement on dated December 31, 2005.
(i) Bank charges debited as per passbook Rs. 500.
(ii) Cheques recorded in the cash book but not sent to the bank for
collection Rs. 2,500.
(iii) Received a payment directly from customer Rs. 4,600.
(iv) Cheque issued but not presented for payment Rs. 6,980.
(v) Interest credited by the bank Rs. 100.
(vi) LIC paid by bank Rs. 2,500.
(vii) Cheques deposited with the bank but not collected Rs. 3,500.
(Ans: Overdraft as per cash book Rs. 22,680).
16. Raghav & Co. have two bank accounts. Account No. I and Account No. II.
From the following particulars relating to Account No. I, find out the balance
on that account of December 31, 2005 according to the cash book of
the firm.
(i) Cheques paid into bank prior to December 31, 2005, but not credited
for Rs. 10,000.
(ii) Transfer of funds from account No. II to account no. I recorded by
the bank on December 31, 2005 but entered in the cash book after
that date for Rs. 8,000.
(iii) Cheques issued prior to December 31, 2005 but not presented until
after that date for Rs. 7,429.
(iv) Bank charges debited by bank not entered in the cash book for
Rs. 200.
(v) Interest Debited by the bank not entered in the cash book Rs. 580.
(vi) Overdraft as per Passbook Rs. 18,990.
(Ans: Overdraft as per cash book Rs. 23,639).

175

Bank Reconciliation Statement


17.

Prepare a bank reconciliation statement from the following particulars


and show the balance as per cash book.
(i) Balance as per passbook on December 31, 2005 overdrawn
Rs. 20,000.
(ii) Interest on bank overdraft not entered in the cash book Rs. 2,000.
(iii) Rs. 200 insurance premium paid by bank has not been entered in
the cash book.
(iv) Cheques drawn in the last week of December, 2005, but not cleared
till date for Rs. 3,000 and Rs. 3,500.
(v) Cheques deposited into bank on November, 2005, but yet to be
credited on dated December 31, 2005 Rs. 6,000.
(vii) Wrongly debited by bank Rs. 500.
(Ans: Overdraft as per cash book Rs. 17,800).
18. The passbook of Mr. Randhir showed an overdraft of Rs. 40,950 on March
31, 2005.
Prepare bank reconciliation statement on March 31, 2005.
(i) Out of cheques amounting to Rs. 8,000 drawn by Mr. Randhir on
March 27 a cheque for Rs. 3,000 was encashed on April 03.
(ii) Credited by bank with Rs. 3,800 for interest collected by them, but
the amount is not entered in the cash book.
(iii) Rs. 10,900 paid in by Mr. Randhir in cash and by cheques on March,
31 cheques amounting to Rs. 3,800 were collected on April, 07.
(iv) A Cheque of Rs. 780 credited in the passbook on March 28 being
dishonoured is debited again in the passbook on April 01, 2005. There
was no entry in the cash book about the dishonour of the cheque until
April 15.
(Ans: Overdraft as per cash book Rs. 36,350)

176

Bank Reconciliation Statement

177
Project

1. You are employed by Silk and Carpets as their cashier. Your main
responsibility is to maintain the companys cash book and prepare a bank
reconciliation statement at the end of each month.
The cash book (showing the bank money columns only) is set out below
together with a copy of the bank statement for February 2005.
You are required to :

Reconcile the cash book with the bank statement.


Make the entries necessary to update the cash book..
Start with the balance as per the cash book, list any unpresented cheques
and sub-total on the reconciliation statement.
Enter details of bank lodgements.
Calculate the balance as per the bank statement and check your total against
the bank statement for accuracy.
Silk & Carpets Ltd. Cash Book
Cash Book

Dr.
Date
2005
Feb. 01
Feb. 01
Feb. 04
Feb. 08
Feb. 13
Feb. 20
Feb. 28

Particulars

Bank
Rs.

Balance b/d 1,425


Brown & Co.
157
Brindas
243
Robinson Ltd.
91
Morris
75
Kinki and Co.
420
Howell Ltd.
94

2,505
Feb. 08 Balance b/d

705

Date

Particulars

2005
Feb. 01
Feb. 01
Feb. 03
Feb. 09
Feb. 09
Feb. 10
Feb. 16
Feb. 23
Feb. 27
Feb. 28

Bhargav Bros
Maruti Ltd. 400460
Jackson Ltd. 400461
Spencer Partners 400462
Ivory Computer 400463
Surya Insurance
Shankar Garage 400464
Petty cash 400465
Swaroop & Co. 400466
Balance c/d

Cr.
Bank
Rs.
98
50
540
42
490
300
110
50
120
705
2,505

Bank Reconciliation Statement

178

ROHTAGI BANK
10, Shastri Road, New Delhi.
Account Brooklyn Limited
Date

STATEMENT

Account No. 29842943

February 28, 2005

Date
2004
Feb. 01
Feb. 02
Feb. 04
Feb. 02
Feb. 06
Feb. 10
Feb. 12
Feb. 14
Feb. 14
Feb. 23
Feb. 26
Feb. 26
Feb. 27
Feb. 28

Particulars
Balance
Cheques
Maruti Ltd.
400460
Brindas
Cheques
Surya Insurance (DD)
Morris
400463
Cheques
Rajeshwar
400465
Soumya
Bank charges

Debit

Credit

157
50
98
243
91
300
75
490
420
103
50
220
38

Balance
1,425
1,582
1,532
1,434
1,677
1,768
1,468
1,543
1,053
1,473
1,370
1,320
1,540
1,502

Cr.
Cr.
Cr.
Cr.
Cr.
Cr.
Cr.
Cr.
Cr.
Cr.
Cr.
Cr.
Cr.
Cr.

2. As accounts assistant for Chinnar Limited your main task is to enter


transactions into the companys cash book, check the entries against the
bank statement and prepare a monthly bank reconciliation statement.
The cash book (showing the bank money columns only) and bank statement
for October 2005 are set out below.
You are required to :

Reconcile the cash book with the bank statement.


Make the entries necessary to update the cash book.
Balance the bank columns of the cash book and calculate the revised bank
balance.
Start with the balance as per the cash book, list any unpresented cheques
and sub-total on the reconciliation statement.
Enter details of bank lodgements.
Calculate the balance as per the bank statement and check your total against
the bank statement for accuracy.

Bank Reconciliation Statement

179

Chinnar Limited Cash Book


Cash Book
Date
Oct.
Oct.
Oct.
Oct.
Oct.
Oct.
Oct.
Oct.
Oct.

Particulars
01
04
08
11
11
12
20
25
31

Bank
Rs.

Date

Balance b/d
2,521
Allen Rogers
620
Moore & Kale
27
Howard Limited
48
Barrett & Bryson 106
D Patel
301
Cohen & Co.
58
J McGilvery
209
Balance c/d
604

Oct.
Oct.
Oct.
Oct.
Oct.
Oct.
Oct.
Oct.
Oct.

Particulars
01
04
05
08
13
14
22
25
30

Bank.
Rs.

Sharp & Co Rent


400
I. Oswal 210526
367
Health & Sports 210527
1,108
Evon & Son 210528
320
Khare Garage 210529
32
J. Choudrey 210530
28
Astha Insurance (DD)
139
Soma Computers 210531 1,800
Rastogi
300

4,494

4,494
Nov. 01 Balance b/d

OM BANK
99, Jawahar Marg
Account Chinnar Limited
Date
October 31, 2005
Date

Particulars

2004
Oct. 01
Oct. 01
Oct. 04
Oct. 07
Oct. 11
Oct. 13
Oct. 15
Oct. 18
Oct. 18
Oct. 22
Oct. 27
Oct. 28
Oct. 29
Oct. 29
Oct. 29

Balance
Sharp & Co
Allen Rogers
210526
Cheques
D Patel (BGC)
Cheques
210528
210527
Astha Insurance (DD)
210531
Bharadwajs
Rastogi
Bank Interest
Bank Charges

604

STATEMENT
Account No. 06618432

Debit

Credit

400
620
367
154
301
27
320
1,108
139
1,800
114
300
53
45

Balance
Rs.
2,521 Cr.
2,121 Cr.
2,741 Cr.
2,374 Cr.
2,528 Cr.
2,829 Cr.
2,856 Cr.
2,536 Cr.
1,428 Cr.
1,289 Cr.
511 Dr.
397 Dr.
697 Dr.
750 Dr.
795 Dr.

Bank Reconciliation Statement

180

Checklist to Test Your Understanding


Test Your Understanding - I
(I) 1. Time Gap
4. Time gap
(II) (i) Customer account
(iv) Debit
(vii) loss
(x) Higher

2. Error
5. Time gap
(ii) Debit
(v) Added
(viii) Loss

3. Time gap
(iii) Credit
(vi) Deducted
(ix) Added

4. (a)

5. (c)

6.(b)

4. (T)

5. (F)

6.(T),

Test Your Understanding - II


1. (b)

2. (c)

3. (a)

Test Your Understanding - III


1. (T)

2. (T)

3. (F)

7.(T)

8.(T)

9.(F)

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors

LEARNING OBJECTIVES
After studying this chapter,
you will be able to :
state the meaning of
trial balance;
enumerate the objectives
of preparing trial
balance ;
prepare trial balance;
explain the types of
errors;
state various process
of locating errors ;
identify the errors which
affect the agreement of
trial balance and those
which do not affect the
agreement of trial
balance;
rectify the errors
without preparing
suspense account;
and
rectify the errors with
suspense account.

n the earlier chapters, you have learnt about the


basic principles of accounting that for every debit
there will be an equal credit. It implies that if the
sum of all debits equals the sum of all credits, it is
presumed that the posting to the ledger in terms
of debit and credit amounts is accurate. The trial
balance is a tool for verifying the correctness of
debit and credit amounts. It is an arithmetical
check under the double entry system which verifies
that both aspects of every transaction have been
recorded accurately. This chapter explains the
meaning and process of preparation of trial balance
and the types of errors and their rectification.
6.1 Meaning of Trial Balance
A trial balance is a statement showing the
balances, or total of debits and credits, of all the
accounts in the ledger with a view to verify the
arithmatical accuracy of posting into the ledger
accounts. Trial balance is an important statement
in the accounting process. which shows final
position of all accounts and helps in preparing
the final statements. The task of preparing the
statements is simplified because the accountant
can take the account balances from the trial
balance instead of looking them up in the ledger.

182

Accountancy
Trial Balance of ......as on March 31, 2005
Account T itle

L.F

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

Total
Fig. 6.1 : Showing format of a trial balance

It is normally prepared at the end of an accounting year. However, an


organisation may prepare a trial balance at the end of any chosen period,
which may be monthly, quarterly, half yearly or annually depending upon its
requirements.
In order to prepare a trial balance following steps are taken:

Ascertain the balances of each account in the ledger.

List each account and place its balance in the debit or credit column, as
the case may be. (If an account has a zero balance, it may be included in
the trial balance with zero in the column for its normal balance).

Compute the total of debit balances column.

Compute the total of the credit balances column.

Verify that the sum of the debit balances equal the sum of credit balances.
If they do not tally, it indicate that there are some errors. So one must
check the correctness of the balances of all accounts. It may be noted
that all assets expenses and receivables account shall have debit balances
whereas all liabilities, revenues and payables accounts shall have credit
balances (refer figure 6.2).
6.2 Objectives of Preparing the Trial Balance
The
1.
2.
3.

trial balance is prepared to fulfill the following objectives :


To ascertain the arithmetical accuracy of the ledger accounts.
To help in locating errors.
To help in the preparation of the financial statements.

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors


Account T itle

183
L.F.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Capital
Land and Buildings
Plant and Machinery
Equipment
Furniture and Fixtures
Cash in Hand
Cash at Bank
Debtors
Bills Receivable
Stock of Raw Materials
Work in Progress
Stock of Finished Goods
Prepaid Insurance
Purchases
Carriage Inwards
Carriage Outwards
Sales
Sales Return
Purchases Return
Interest Paid
Commission/Discount Received
Salaries
Long Term Loan
Bills Payable
Creditors
Outstanding Salaries
Outstanding Interest Earned
Advances from Customers
Drawings
Reserve Fund
Provision for Doubtful Debts
Total

Credit
Amount
Rs.
9

9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
9
xxx

xxx

Fig. 6.2 : Illustrative trial balance

6.2.1 To Ascertain the Arithmetical Accuracy of Ledger Accounts


As stated earlier, the purpose of preparing a trial balance is to asceitain whether
all debits and credit are properly recorded in the ledger or not and that all
accounts have been correctly balanced. As a summary of the ledger, it is a list
of the accounts and their balances. When the totals of all the debit balances

184

Accountancy

and credit balances in the trial balance are equal, it is assumed that the
posting and balancing of accounts is arithmetically correct. However, the
tallying of the trial balance is not a conclusive proof of the accuracy of the
accounts. It only ensures that all debits and the corresponding credits have
been properly recorded in the ledger.
6.2.2 To Help in Locating Errors
When a trial balance does not tally (that is, the totals of debit and credit
columns are not equal), we know that at least one error has occured. The
error (or errors) may have occured at one of those stages in the accounting
process: (1) totalling of subsidiary books, (2) posting of journal entries in the
ledger, (3) calculating account balances, (4) carrying account balances to the
trial balance, and (5) totalling the trial balance columns.
It may be noted that the accounting accuracy is not ensured even if the
totals of debit and credit balances are equal because some errors do not affect
equality of debits and credits. For example, the book-keeper may debit a correct
amount in the wrong account while making the journal entry or in posting a
journal entry to the ledger. This error would cause two accounts to have
incorrect balances but the trial balance would tally. Another error is to record
an equal debit and credit of an incorrect amount. This error would give the
two accounts incorrect balances but would not create unequal debits and
credits. As a result, the fact that the trial balance has tallied does not imply
that all entries in the books of original record (journal, cash book, etc.) have
been recorded and posted correctly. However, equal totals do suggest that
several types of errors probably have not occured.
6.2.3 To Help in the Preparation of the Financial Statements
Trial balance is considered as the connecting link between accounting records
and the preparation of financial statements. For preparing a financial
statement, one need not refer to the ledger. In fact, the availability of a tallied
trial balance is the first step in the preparation of financial statements. All
revenue and expense accounts appearing in the trial balance are transferred
to the trading and profit and loss account and all liabilities, capital and assets
accounts are transferred to the balance sheet.
(Preparation of the financial statements is explained in chapters, 9 and 10).

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors

185

6.3 Preparation of Trial Balance


A trial balance can be prepared in the following three ways :
(i) Totals Method
(ii) Balances Method
(iii) Totals-cum-balances Method
6.3.1 Totals method
Under this method, total of each side in the ledger (debit and credit) is ascertained
separately and shown in the trial balance in the respective columns. The total of
debit column of trial balance should agree with the total of credit column in the
trial balance because the accounts are based on double entry system. However,
this method is not widely used in practice, as it does not help in assuming accuracy
of balances of various accounts and and preparation of the fianancial statements.
6.3.2 Balances Method
This is the most widely used method in practice. Under this method trial
balance is prepared by showing the balances of all ledger accounts and then
totalling up the debit and credit columns of the trial balance to assure their
correctness. The account balances are used because the balance summarises
the net effect of all transactions relating to an account and helps in preparing
the financial statements. It may be noted that in trial balance, normally in
place of balances in individual accounts of the debtors, a figure of sundry
debtors is shown, and in place of individual accounts of creditors, a figure of
sundry creditors is shown.
6.3.3 Totals-cum-balances Method
This method is a combination of totals method and balances method. Under
this method four columns for amount are prepared. Two columns for writing
the debit and credit totals of various accounts and two columns for writing
the debit and credit balances of these accounts. However, this method is also
not used in practice because it is time consuming and hardly serves any
additional or special purpose.
Let us now learn how will the trial balance be prepared using each of
these methods with the help of the following example :
Mr. Rawats ledger shows the following accounts for his business. Help
him in preparing the trial balance using : (i) Totals method,
(ii) Balances method, (iii) Totals-cum-Balances method.

186

Accountancy
Rahuls Capital Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2005
Dec. 31

Balance c/d

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
60,000
60,000

Date
2005
Jan. 01
2006
Jan. 01

Particulars

J.F.

Balance b/d
Cash

Amount
Rs.
40,000
20,000
60,000
60,000

Balance b/d

Rohans Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

40,000
20,000

Jan. 01

2005
Dec. 31

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2005
Cash
Balance c/d

60,000

Balance b/d
Purchases

10,000
50,000

2006
Jan. 1

60,000
Balance b/d

20,000

Machinery Account
Dr.
Date
2005
Dec. 31

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

2005
Balance b/d

20,000
Dec. 31

Depreciation
Balance c/d

3,000
17,000
20,000

20,000
2006
Jan. 01

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

Balance b/d

17,000
Rahuls Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Jan. 01

Cr.
Particulars

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2005
Balance b/d
Sales

15,000
60,000
75,000

Balance b/d

20,000

2006
Jan. 01

J.F.

Dec. 31

Cash
Balance c/d

55,000
20,000
75,000

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors

187

Sales Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2005
Rahul
Cash

60,000
10,000
70,000

Cash Account
Dr.
Date
2005
Jan. 01

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

2005
Balanc e b/d
Capital
Rahul
Sales

15,000
20,000
55,000
10,000

Dec. 31

Rohan
Wages
Purchases
Balance c/d

40,000
5,000
12,000
43,000

1,00,000
2006
Jan. 01

Amount
Rs.

Balance b/d

1,00,000

43,000

Wages Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2005
Cash

5,000
5,000
Depreciation Account

Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2005
Machinery

3,000
3,000

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

188

Accountancy
Purchases Account

Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

2005
Rohan
Cash

50,000
12,000
62,000

The trial balance under the three methods is illustrated below:


(i) Trial Balance as at March 31, 2005
(Using Totals Method)
Account
Title

L.F.

Rawats Capital
Rohan
Machinery
Rahul
Sales
Cash
Wages
Depreciation
Purchases

Debit
Total
Rs.
40,000
20,000
75,000
1,00,000
5,000
3,000
62,000
3,05,000

Credit
Total
Rs.
60,000
60,000
3,000
55,000
70,000
57,000

3,05,000

(ii) Trial Balance as at March 31, 2005


(Using Balances Method)
Account T itle

Rawats Capital
Rohans Capital
Machinery
Rahul
Sales
Cash
Wages
Depreciation
Purchases
Total

L.F.

Debit
Balance
Rs.

Credit
Balance
Rs.
60,000
20,000

17,000
20,000
70,000
43,000
5,000
3,000
62,000
1,50,000

1,50,000

Amount
Rs.

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors

189

(iii) Trial Balance as at March 31, 2005


(Using Totals-cum-Balances Method)
Account Title

L.F.

Debit
Total
Rs.

Rawats Capital
Rohan
Machinery
Rahul
Sales
Cash
Wages
Depreciation
Purchases
Total

40,000
20,000
75,000
1,00,000
5,000
3,000
62,000
3,05,000

Credit
Total
Rs.
60,000
60,000
3,000
55,000
70,000
57,000

Debit
Balance
Rs.

Credit
Balance
Rs.
60,000
20,000

17,000
20,000
70,000
43,000
5,000
3,000
62,000
1,50,000

3,05,000

1,50,000

Test Your Understanding - I


Indicate against each amount wheather it is a debit or a credit balance, and prepare
a trial balance as at March 31, 2005 based on the following balances:
Accounts T itle
Capital
Drawings
Machinery
Sales
Purchases
Sales return
Purchases return
Wages
Goodwill
Interest received
Discount allowed
Bank overdraft
Bank loan
Debtors :
Nathu
Roopa
Creditors :
Reena
Ganesh
Cash
Stock on April 01, 2004

Amount
Rs.
1,00,000
16,000
20,000
2,00,000
2,10,000
20,000
30,000
40,000
60,000
15,000
6,000
22,000
90,000
55,000
20,000
35,000
25,000
54,000
16,000

190

Accountancy

6.4. Significance of Agreement of Trial Balance


It is important for an accountant that the trial balance should tally. Normally a
tallied trial balance means that both the debit and the credit entries have been
made correctly for each transaction. However, as stated earlier, the agreement of
trial balance is not an absolute proof of accuracy of accounting records. A tallied
trial balance only proves, to a certain extent, that the posting to the ledger is
arithmetically correct. But it does not guarantee that the entry itself is correct.
There can be errors, which affect the equality of debits and credits, and there can
be errors, which do not affect the equality of debits and credits. Some common
errors include the following:
Error in totalling of the debit and credit balances in the trial balance.
Error in totalling of subsidiary books.
Error in posting of the total of subsidiary books.
Error in showing account balances in wrong column of the tiral balance,
or in the wrong amount.
Omission in showing an account balance in the trial balance.
Error in the calculation of a ledger account balance.
Error while posting a journal entry: a journal entry may not have been
posted properly to the ledger, i.e., posting made either with wrong amount
or on the wrong side of the account or in the wrong account.
Error in recording a transaction in the journal: making a reverse entry,
i.e., account to be debited is credited and amount to be credited is debited,
or an entry with wrong amount.
Error in recording a transaction in subsidiary book with wrong name or wrong
amount.
6.4.1 Classification of Errors
Keeping in view the nature of errors, all the errors can be classified into the
following four categories:
Errors of Commission
Errors of Omission
Errors of Principle
Compensating Errors
6.4.2 Errors of Commission
These are the errors which are committed due to wrong posting of transactions,
wrong totalling or balancing of the accounts, wrong casting of the subsidiary
books, or wrong recording of amount in the books of original entry, etc.
For example: Raj Hans Traders paid Rs. 25,000 to Preetpal Traders (a supplier
of goods). This transaction was correctly recorded in the cashbook. But while

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors

191

posting to the ledger, Preetpals account was debited with Rs. 2,500 only. This
constitutes an error of commission. Such an error by definition is of clerical
nature and most of the errors of commission affect in the trial balance.
6.4.3 Errors of Omission
The errors of omission may be committed at the time of recording the
transaction in the books of original entry or while posting to the ledger. There
can be of two types:
(i) error of complete omission
(ii) error of partial omission
When a transaction is completely omitted from recording in the books of
original record, it is an error of complete omission. For example, credit sales
to Mohan Rs. 10,000, not entered in the sales book. When the recording of
transaction is partly omitted from the books, it is an error of partial omission.
If in the above example, credit sales had been duly recorded in the sales book
but the posting from sales book to Mohans account has not been made, it
would be an error of partial omission.
6.4.4 Errors of Principle
Accounting entries are recorded as per the generally accepted accounting
principles. If any of these principles are violated or ignored, errors resulting
from such violation are known as errors of principle. An error of principle may
occur due to incorrect classification of expenditure or receipt between capital
and revenue. This is very important because it will have an impact on financial
statements. It may lead to under/over stating of income or assets or liabilities,
etc. For example, amount spent on additions to the buildings should be treated
as capital expenditure and must be debited to the asset account. Instead, if
this amount is debited to maintenance and repairs account, it has been treated
as a revenue expense. This is an error of principle. Similarly, if a credit purchase
of machinery is recorded in purchases book instead of journal proper or rent
paid to the landlord is recorded in the cash book as payment to landlord,
these errors of principle. These errors do not affect the trial balance.
6.4.5 Compensating Errors
When two or more errors are committed in such a way that the net effect of
these errors on the debits and credits of accounts is nil, such errors are called
compensating errors. Such errors do not affect the tallying of the trial balance.
For example, if purchases book has been overcast by Rs. 10,000 resulting in
excess debit of Rs. 10,000 in purchases account and sales returns book is
undercast by Rs. 10,000 resulting in short debit to sales returns account is a

192

Accountancy

case of two errors compensating each others effect. One plus is set off by the
other minus, the net effect of these two errors is nil and so they do not affect
the agreement of trial balance.
6.5 Searching of Errors
If the trial balance does not tally, it is a clear indication that at least one error
has occured. The error (or errors) needs to be located and corrected before
preparing the financial statements.
If the trial balance does not tally, the accountant should take the following
steps to detect and locate the errors :
Recast the totals of debit and credit columns of the trial balance.
Compare the account head/title and amount appearing in the trial balance,
with that of the ledger to detect any difference in amount or omission of an
account.
Compare the trial balance of current year with that of the previous year to
check additions and deletions of any accounts and also verify whether
there is a large difference in amount, which is neither expected nor
explained.
Re-do and check the correctness of balances of individual accounts in
the ledger.
Re-check the correctness of the posting in accounts from the books of
original entry.
If the difference between the debit and credit columns is divisible by 2,
there is a possibility that an amount equal to one-half of the difference
may have been posted to the wrong side of another ledger account. For
example, if the total of the debit column of the trial balance exceeds by Rs.
1,500, it is quite possible that a credit item of Rs.750 may have been
wrongly posted in the ledger as a debit item. To locate such errors, the
accountant should scan all the debit entries of an amount of Rs. 750.
The difference may also indicate a complete omission of a posting. For
example, the difference of Rs. 1,500 given above may be due to omissions
of a posting of that amount on the credit side. Thus, the accountant should
verify all the credit items with an amount of Rs. 1,500.
If the difference is a multiple of 9 or divisible by 9, the mistake could be
due to transposition of figures. For example, if a debit amount of Rs. 459
is posted as Rs. 954, the debit total in the trial balance will exceed the
credit side by Rs. 495 (i.e. 954 459 = 495). This difference is divisible by
9. A mistake due to wrong placement of the decimal point may also be
checked by this method. Thus, a difference in trial balance divisible by 9
helps in checking the errors for a transposed mistake.

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors

193

6.6 Rectification of Errors


From the point of view of rectification, the errors may be classified into the
following two categories :
(a) errors which do not affect the trial balance.
(b) errors which affect the trial balance.
This distinction is relevant because the errors which do not affect the trial
balance usually take place in two accounts in such a manner that it can be
easily rectified through a journal entry whereas the errors which affect the
trial balance usually affect one account and a journal entry is not possible for
rectification unless a suspense account has been opened.
6.6.1 Rectification of Errors which do not Affect the Trial Balance
These errors are committed in two or more accounts. Such errors are also
known as two sided errors. They can be rectified by recording a journal entry
giving the correct debit and credit to the concerned accounts.
Examples of such errors are complete omission to record an entry in the
books of original entry; wrong recording of transactions in the book of accounts;
complete omission of posting to the wrong account on the correct side, and
errors of principle.
The rectification process essentially involves:
Cancelling the effect of wrong debit or credit by reversing it; and
Restoring the effect of correct debit or credit.
For this purpose, we need to analyse the error in terms of its effect on the
accounts involved which may be:
(i)
Short debit or credit in an account ; and/or
(ii)
Excess debit or credit in an account.
Therefore, rectification entry can be done by :
(i)
debiting the account with short debit or with excess credit,
(ii)
crediting the account with excess debit or with short credit.
The procedure for rectification for such errors is explained with the help of
following examples :
(a) Credit sales to Mohan Rs. 10,000 were not recorded in the sales book. This is an
error of complete omission. Its affect is that Mohans account has not been debited
and Sales account has not been credited. Accordingly, recording usual entry for
credit sales will rectify the error.
Mohans A/c
To Sales A/c

Dr.

10,000
10,000

194
(b)

Accountancy
Credit sales to Mohan Rs. 10,000 were recorded as Rs. 1,000 in the sales book.
This is an error of commission. The effect of wrong recording is shown below:
Mohans A/c

Dr.

1,000

To Sales A/c

1,000

Correct effect should have been:


Mohans A/c

Dr.

10,000

To Sales A/c

10,000

Now that Mohans account has to be given an additional debit of Rs. 9,000
and sales account has to be credited with additional amount of Rs. 9,000,
rectification entry will be :
Mohans A/c

Dr.

9,000

To Sales A/c

(c)

9,000

Credit sales to Mohan Rs. 10,000 were recorded as Rs. 12,000. This is an error of
commission. The effect of wrong entry made has been :
Mohans A/c

Dr.

12,000

To Sales A/c

12,000

Correct effect should have been :


Mohans A/c

Dr.

10,000

To Sales A/c

10,000

You can see that there is an excess debit of Rs. 2,000 in Mohans account
and excess credit of Rs. 2,000 in sales account.
The, rectification entry will be recorded as follows:
Sales A/c
To Mohans A/c

Dr.

2,000
2,000

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors


(d)

195

Credit sales to Mohan Rs. 10,000 was correctly recorded in the sales book but was
posted to Rams account. This is an error of commission. The effect of wrong posting
has been :
Rams A/c

Dr.

10,000

To Sales A/c

10,000

Correct effect should have been :


Mohans A/c

Dr.

10,000

To Sales A/c

10,000

Notice that there is no error in sales account. But Rams account has been
debited with Rs. 10,000 instead of Mohans account.
Hence rectification entry will be :
Mohans A/c

Dr.

10,000

To Rams A/c
(e)

10,000

Rent paid Rs. 2,000 was wrongly shown as payment to landlord in the
cash book:
The effect of wrong posting has been :
Landlords A/c

Dr.

2,000

To Cash A/c

2,000

Correct effect should have been :


Rent A/c

Dr.

2,000

To Cash A/c

2,000

Landlords account has been wrongly debited instead of Rent account.


Hence, rectification entry will be :
Rent A/c
To Landlords A/c

Dr.

2,000
2,000

196

Accountancy
Test Your Understanding - II

Record the rectification entry for the following transactions:


1. Credit sales to Rajni Rs. 5,000 recorded in Purchases book:
This is an error of ..........................................
State the wrong entry recorded in the book of accounts

Correct effect should have been:

The rectification entry will be:

2. Furniture purchased from M/s Rao Furnishigs for Rs. 8,000 was entered into
the purchases book .
This is the error of ........................................
State the wrong entry recorded in the book of accounts

Correct effect should have been:

The rectification entry will be:

3. Cash sales to Radhika Rs. 15,000 was shown as receipt of commission in the
cash book.
This is the error of ..............................................
State the wrong entry recorded in the book of accounts

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors

197

Correct effect should have been :

The rectificatin entry will be:

4. Cash received from Karim Rs. 6,000 posted to Nadeem.


This is the error of ........................................
State the wrong entry recorded in the book of accounts:

Correct effect should have been:

The rectification entry will be:

6.6.2 Rectification of Errors Affecting Trial Balance


The errors which affect only one account can be rectified by giving an exaplanatory
note in the account affected or by recording a journal entry with the help of the
Suspense Account. Suspense Account is explained later in this chapter. Examples
of such errors are error of casting; error of carrying forward; error of balancing;
error of posting to correct account but with wrong amount; error of posting to
the correct account but on the wrong side; posting to the wrong side with the
wrong amount; omitting to show an account in the trial balance.
An error in the books of original entry, if discovered before it is posted to
the ledger, may be corrected by crossing out the wrong amount by a single
line and writing the correct amount above the crossed amount and initialling
it. An error in an amount posted to the correct ledger account may also be

198

Accountancy

corrected in a similar way, or by making an additional posting for the difference


in amount and giving an explanatory note in the particulars column. But
errors should never be corrected by erasing or overwriting reduces the
authenticity of accounting records and give an impression that something is
being concealed. A better way therefore is by noting the correction on the
appropriate side for neutralising the effect of the error. Take for example a
case where Shyams account was credited short by Rs. 190. This will be rectified
by an additional entry for Rs. 190 on the credit side of his account as follows.
Shyams Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Difference in
amount posted
short on.....

Amount
Rs.
190

Take another example, purchases book was undercast by Rs. 1,000. The effect
of this entry is on purchases account (debit side) where the total of purchases
book is posted
Purchases Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars
Undercasting
purchases
book for the
month of....

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

1,000

Suspese Account
Even if the trial balance does not tally due to the existence of one sided errors,
accountant has to carry forward his accounting process prepare financial
statements. The accountant tallies his trial balance by putting the difference
on shorter side as suspense account.
The process of opening of suspense account can be understood with the help
of the following example :
Consider the sales book of an organisation.

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors

199

Sales Book (Journal)


Date

Invoice
No.

Name of customers
(Accounts to be debited)

L.F.

Ashok traders
Bimal service centre
Chopra enterprises
Diwakar and sons

Amount
Rs.
20,000
10,000
5,000
15,000
50,000

If sales to Diwakar and sons were not posted to his account, ledger will
show the following position :
Ashok Traders Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Sales

Amount
Rs.

Date

20,000
20,000

Particulars

J.F.

Balance c/d

Amount
Rs.
20,000
20,000

Bimal Service Centres Account


Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Sales

Amount
Rs.
10,000

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Balance c/d

10,000

Amount
Rs.
10,000
10,000

Chopra Enterprises Account


Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Sales

Amount
Rs.
5,000
5,000

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
5,000
5,000

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Balance c/d

Sales Account
Cr.
Date

Dr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars
Sundries

50,000

200

Accountancy

The trial balance when prepared on the basis of above balances will not
tally. Its credit column total will amount to Rs. 50,000 and debit column total
to Rs. 35,000. The trial balance would differ with Rs. 15,000. This difference
will be temporarily put to suspense account and trial balance will be made to
agree in the ledger.
In the above case, difference in trial balance has arisen due to one sided
error (omission of posting to Diwakar and sonss account). In a real situation,
there can be many other such one-sided errors which cause a difference in
trial balance and thus result in opening of the suspense account. Till the all
errors affecting agreement of trial balance are not located it is not possible to
rectify them and tally the trial balance in such a situation, is shown in the
Suspense account, make the total of debit and credit columns and proceed
further with the accounting process.
When the errors are located and the specific accounts and amounts involved
are identified, the amounts are transferred from suspense account to the
relevant accounts thereby closing the suspense account. Thus, suspense
account is not placed in any particular category of accounts and is just a
temporary phenomenon.
While rectifying one-sided errors using suspense account, the following steps
are taken:
(i) Identify the account affected due to error.
(ii) Ascertain the amount of excess debit/credit or short debit/credit in the
affected account.
(iii) If the error has resulted in excess debit or short credit in the affected
account, credit the account with the amount of excess debit or short
credit.
(iv) If the error has resulted in excess credit or short debit in the affected
account, debit the account with the amount of excess credit or short
debit.
(v) Complete the journal entry by debiting or crediting the suspense account
as another account affected otherwise.
We will now discuss the process of rectification using suspense account:
(a) Credit sales to Mohan Rs. 10,000 were not posted to his account. This is
an error of partial omission comitted while posting entries of the sales
book.
Wrong effect has been :
Mohans A/c
To Sales A/c

Dr.

Nil
10,000

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors

201

Correct effect should have been :


Mohans A/c
To Sales A/c

Dr.

10,000
10,000

The rectification entry will be :


Mohans A/c
To Suspense A/c
(b)

Dr.

10,000
10,000

Credit sales to Mohan Rs. 10,000 were posted to his account as Rs. 7000. This is
an error of commission. Mohans account has been debited with Rs. 7,000 instead
of Rs. 10,000 resulting in short debit of Rs. 3,000.
The wrong effect has been :
Mohans A/c
To Sales A/c

Dr.

7,000
10,000

Correct effect should have been :


Mohans A/c
To Sales A/c

Dr.

10,000
10,000

Hence, rectification entry will be:


Mohans A/c
To Suspens A/c
(c)

Dr.

3,000
3,000

Credit sales to Mohan Rs. 10,000 were posted to his account as Rs. 12,000.
This is an error of commission. The wrong effect has been :
Mohans A/c
To Sales A/c

Dr.

12,000
10,000

Correct effect should have been


Mohans A/c
To Sales A/c

Dr.

10,000
10,000

The rectification entry will be :


Suspense A/c
To Mohans A/c
(d)

Dr.

2,000
2,000

Purchases book overcast by Rs. 1,000. Errors in casting of subsidiary books


affect only those accounts where totals of the subsidiary books involved are

202

Accountancy
posted. The accounts of individual parties are not af fected. Consider the
following example.
Purchases (Journal) Book
Date

Invoice
No.

Name of suppliers
(Accounts to be credited)

L.F.

Dheru
Chandraprakash
Sachin

Amount
Rs.
8,000
7,000
6,000
21,000

Wrong total
due to overcasting.

22,000

Dherus Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Purchases

Amount
Rs.
8,000

Chandraprakashs Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Purchases

Amount
Rs.
7,000

Sachins Account
Dr.
Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Purchases

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
6,000

Purchases Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars
Sundries

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

22,000

As you can notice that there is no error in accounts of Dheeru, Chanderprakash and
Sachin. Only purchases account has been debited with Rs. 1,000 extra. Hence, rectification
entry will be :

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors

Suspense A/c

203

Dr.

1,000

To Purchases A/c

1,000

6.6.3 Rectification of Errors in the Next Accounting Year


If some errors committed during an accounting year are not located and
rectified before the finalisation of financial statements, suspense account
cannot be closed and its balance will be carried forward to the next accounting
period. When the errors committed in one accounting year are located and
rectified in the next accounting year, profit and loss adjustment account is
debited or credited in place of accounts of expenses/losses and incomes/
gains in order to avoid impact on the income statement of next accounting
period. You will learn about this aspect at an advanced stage of your studies
in accounting.
Box 1
Guiding Principles of Rectification of Errors
1. If error is committed in books of original entry then assume all postings are
done accordingly.
2. If error is at the posting stage then assume that recording in the subsidiary
books has been correctly done.
3. If error is in posting to a wrong account (without mentioning side and amount of
posting) then assume that posting has been done on the right side and with the
right amount.
4. If posting is done to a correct account but with wrong amount (without mentioning
side of posting) then assume that posting has been done on the correct side.
5. If error is posting to a wrong account on the wrong side (without mentioning
amount of posting) then assume that posting has been done with the amount as
per the original recording of the transaction.
6. If error is of posting to a wrong account with wrong amount (without mentioning
the side of posting) then assume that posting has been done on the right side.
7. If posting is done to a correct account on the wrong side (without mentioning
amount of posting) then assume that posting has been done with correct amount
as per original recording.
8. Any error in posting of individual transactions in subsidiaries books relates to
individual account only, the sales account, purchase account, sales return
account or purchases return account are not involved.

204

Accountancy

9. If a transaction is recorded in cash book, then the error in posting relates to the
other affected account, not to cash account/bank account
10. If a transaction is recorded through journal proper, then the phrase transaction
was not posted indicates error in both the accounts involved, unless stated
otherwise.
11. Error in casting of subsidiary books will affect only that account where total of
the particular book is posted leaving the individual personal accounts unaffected.
Test Your Understanding - III
Show the effect through Journal entries :
1. Credit sales to Mohan Rs. 10,000 were posted to his account as Rs. 12,000
This is an error of ..................................
The wrong effect has been :

The correct effect should have been :

The rectification entry will be.

2. Cash paid to Neha Rs. 2,000 was not posted to her account. This is an error of
..................................
The wrong effect has been :

The correct effect should have been :

The rectification entry will be :

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors

205

3. Sales returns from Megha Rs. 1,600 were posted to her account as Rs. 1,000.
This is an error of ..................................
The wrong effect has been :

The correct effect should have been :

The rectification entry will be :

4. Depreciation written off on furniture Rs. 1,500 was not posted to depreciation
account. This is an error of ................
The wrong effect has been :

The correct effect should have been :

The rectification entry :

Illustration 1
Rectify the following errors :
Credit purchases from Raghu Rs. 20,000
(i) were not recorded.
(ii) were recorded as Rs. 10,000.
(iii) were recorded as Rs. 25,000.
(iv) were not posted to his account.
(v) were posted to his account as Rs. 2,000.
(vi) were posted to Reghavs account.
(vii) were posted to the debit of Raghus account.
(viii) were posted to the debit of Raghav.
(ix) were recorded through sales book.

206

Accountancy

Solution
(i)
Purchases A/c
Dr.
20,000
To Raghus A/c
20,000
(Credit purchases from Raghu omitted to be recorded, now corrected)
(ii)
Purchases A/c
Dr.
10,000
To Raghus A/c
10,000
(Credit purchases from Raghu recorded as Rs. 10,000 instead of Rs 20,000,
now corrected)
(iii)
Raghus A/c
Dr.
5,000
To Purchases A/c
5,000
(Credit purchases from Raghu recorded as Rs. 25,000 instead of
Rs. 20,000).
(iv)
Suspense A/c
Dr.
20,000
To Raghus A/c
20,000
(Credit purchases from Raghu not posted to his account now corrected).
(v)
Suspense A/c
Dr.
18,000
To Raghus A/c
18,000
(Credit purchases from Raghu Rs. 20,000 posted to his account as
Rs. 2,000
(vi)
Raghavs A/c
Dr.
20,000
To Raghus A/c
20,000
(Credit purchases from Raghu wrongly credited to Raghav, now corrected)
(vii)
Suspense A/c
Dr.
40,000
To Raghus A/c
40,000
(Credit purchases from Raghu Rs. 20,000 wrongly posted to the debit of
his account, now corrected).

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors

207

(viii)
Suspense A/c
Dr.
40,000
To Raghavs A/c
20,000
To Raghus A/c
20,000
(Credited purchases from Raghu Rs. 20,000 wrongly debited to Raghav,
now corrected).
(ix)
Sales A/c
Dr.
20,000
Purchases A/c
Dr.
20,000
To Raghus A/c
40,000
(Credit purchases from Raghu wrongly recorded through sales book, now
corrected).

Illustration 2
Rectify the following errors :
Cash sales Rs. 16,000
(i) were not posted to sales account.
(ii) were posted as Rs. 6,000 in sales account.
(iii) were posted to commission account.
Solution
(i)
Suspense A/c
Dr.
16,000
To Sales A/c
(Cash sales not posted to sales account now rectified)

16,000

(ii)

Suspense A/c
Dr.
10,000
To Sales A/c
10,000
(Cash sales Rs. 16,000 were posted to sales account as Rs. 6,000, now
rectified)
(iii)
Commission A/c
Dr.
16,000
To Sales A/c
16,000
(Cash sales posted to commission account instead of sales account,
now corrected)

208

Accountancy

Illustration 3
Depreciation written-off as the machinery Rs. 2,000
(i) was not posted
(ii) was not posted to machinery account
(iii) was not posted to depreciation account
Solution
(i)

It was recorded through journal proper. From journal proper posting to all the
accounts are made individually. Hence, no posting was made to depreciation account
and machinery account. Therefore, rectification entry will be :
Depreciation A/c
Dr.
2,000
To Machinery A/c
(Depreciation on machinery not posted, now corrected)

2,000

(ii) In this case posting was not made to machinery account. It is to be assumed that
depreciation account should have been correctly debited. Therefore, rectification
entry shall be :
Suspense A/c
Dr.
2,000
To Machinery A/c
2,000
(Depreciation on machinery not posted to Machinery account, now
corrected).
(iii) In this case depreciation account was not been debited. However, machinery account
must have been correctly credited. Therefore, rectification entry shall be :
Depreciation A/c
Dr.
2,000
To Suspense A/c
2,000
(Depreciation on machinery not posted to Depreciation account, now
corrected).

Illustration 4
Trial balance of Anurag did not agree. It showed an excess credit Rs. 10,000. Anurag put
the difference to suspense account. He located the following errors :
(i) Sales return book over cast by Rs. 1,000.
(ii) Purchases book was undercast by Rs. 600.
(iii) In the sales book total of page no. 4 was carried forward to page 5 as Rs. 1,000
instead of Rs. 1,200 and total of page 8 was carried forward to page 9 as
Rs. 5,600 instead of Rs. 5,000.
(iv) Goods returned to Ram Rs. 1,000 were recorded through sales book.
(v) Credit purchases from M & Co. Rs. 8,000 were recorded through sales book.
(vi) Credit purchases from S & Co. Rs. 5,000 were recorded through sales book.
However, S & Co. were correctly credited.
(vii) Salary paid Rs. 2,000 was debited to employees personal account.

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors

209

Solution
(i)
Suspense A/c
Dr.
1,000
To Sales Return A/c
(Sales returns book overcast by Rs. 1,000, now corrected).

1,000

(ii)
Purchases A/c
Dr.
600
To Suspense A/c
(Purchases book undercast by Rs. 600, now corrected)

600

(iii)
Sales A/c
Dr.
400
To Suspense A/c
(Error in carry forward of sales book, now corrected).

400

Note : Errors in carry forward the total of one page to another during
a period finally affects the total of that book resulting in error of under/overcastting.
In this case, carry forward from page 4 to 5 resulted in undercasting of Rs. 200 and
carry forward from page 8 to page 9 resulted in overcasting of Rs. 600. Overall
overcastting being Rs. 600200 = Rs. 400.
(iv)
Sales A/c
Dr.
1,000
To Return Outwards A/c
1,000
(Return Outwards wrongly recorded through sales book, now rectified).
(v)
Purchases A/c
Dr.
8,000
Sales A/c
Dr.
8,000
To M & Co.s A/c
16,000
(Credit purchases wrongly recorded through sales book, now rectified).
(vi)
Purchases A/c
Dr.
5,000
Sales A/c
Dr.
5,000
To Suspense A/c
10,000
(Credit purchases wrongly recorded through sales book, however suppliers
account correctly credited, now rectified).

210

Accountancy
(vii)
Salary A/c
Dr.
2,000
To Employees personal A/c
2,000
(Salary paid wrongly debited to employees personal account, now
corrected)

Suspense Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars
Difference as per
trial balance
Sales return

J.F.

Amount Date Particulars


Rs.

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

10,000
1,000

Purchases
Sales
Purchases
Sales

11,000

600
400
5,000
5,000
11,000

Illustration 5
Trial balance of Rahul did not agree. Rahul put the difference to suspense account.
Subsequently, he located the following errors :
(i) Wages paid for installation of Machinery Rs. 600 was posted to wages account.
(ii) Repairs to Machinery Rs. 400 debited to Machinery account.
(iii) Repairs paid for the overhauling of second hand machinery purchased Rs. 1,000
was debited to Repairs account.
(iv) Own business material Rs. 8,000 and wages Rs. 2,000 were used for construction
of building. No adjustment was made in the books.
(v) Furniture purchased for Rs. 5,000 was posted to purchase account as Rs. 500.
(vi) Old machinery sold to Karim at its book value of Rs. 2,000 was recorded through
sales book.
(vii) Total of sales returns book Rs. 3,000 was not posted to the ledger.
Rectify the above errors and prepare suspense account to ascertain the original
difference in trial balance.
(i)
Machinery A/c
Dr.
600
To Wages A/c
600
(Wages paid for installation of machinery wrongly debited to wages account,
now rectified)
(ii)
Repairs A/c
Dr.
400
To Machinery A/c
400
(Repairs paid wrongly debited to machinery account now rectified)

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors

211

(iii)
Machinery A/c
Dr.
1,000
To Repairs A/c
1,000
(Repairs for overhauling of second hand machinery purchased, wrongly
debited to repairs account, now rectified).
(iv)
Building A/c
Dr.
10,000
To Purchases A/c
8,000
To Wages A/c
2,000
(Material and wages used for construction of Building, not debited to
building account).
(v)
Furniture A/c
Dr.
5,000
To Purchases A/c
500
To Suspense A/c
4,500
(Furniture purchased for Rs. 5,000 wrongly debited to purchases account
as Rs. 500, now rectified).
(vi)
Sales A/c
Dr.
2,000
To Machinery
2,000
(Sale of machinery wrongly recorded in sales book, now rectified).
(vii)
Sales Return A/c
Dr.
3,000
To Suspense A/c
3,000
(Total of sales returns book not posted to ledger, now rectified).

Suspense Account
Date Particulars
Difference as per
trial balance

J.F.

Amount Date Particulars


Rs.
7,500

Furniture
Sales return

7,500
Hence, original difference in Trial Balance was Rs. 7,500 excess credited.

J.F. Amount
Rs.
4,500
3.000
7,500

212

Accountancy

Illustration 6
Trial balance of Anant Ram did not agree. It showed an excess credit of Rs. 16,000. He
put the difference to suspense account. Subsequently the following errors were located:
(i)

Cash received from Mohit Rs. 4,000 was posted to Mahesh as Rs. 1,000.

(ii) Cheque for Rs. 5,800 received from Arnav in full settlement of his account of Rs.
6,000, was dishonoured. No entry was passed in the books on dishonour of the
cheque.
(iii) Rs. 800 received from Khanna, whose account had previously been written off as
bad, was credited to his account.
(iv) Credit sales to Manav for Rs. 5,000 was recorded through the purchases book as
Rs. 2,000.
(v)

Purchases book undercast by Rs. 1,000.

(vi) Repairs on machinery Rs. 1,600 wrongly debited to Machinery account as Rs. 1,000.
(vii) Goods returned by Nathu Rs. 3,000 were taken into stock. No entry was recorded
in the books.
Solution
(i)
Maheshs A/c
Dr.
1,000
Suspense A/c
Dr.
3,000
To Mohits A/c
4,000
(Cash received from Mohit Rs. 4,000 wrongly posted to Mahesh as
Rs.1,000, now rectified)
(ii)
Arnavs A/c
Dr.
6,000
To Bank A/c
5,800
To Discount Allowed A/c
200
(Cheque received from Arnav for Rs. 5,800 in full settlement of his account
of Rs. 6,000, dishonoured but no entry made in books, now rectified)
(iii)
Khannas A/c
Dr.
800
To Bad debts recovered A/c
800
(Bad debts recovered wrongly credited to Khannas account, now rectified)

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors

213

(iv)
Manavs A/c
Dr.
7,000
To Purchases A/c
2,000
To Sales A/c
5,000
(Credit sales to Manav Rs. 5,000 wrongly recorded through purchases
book as Rs. 2,000, now rectified)
(v)
Purchases A/c
Dr.
To Suspense A/c
(Purchases book undercast by Rs. 1,000)

1,000
1,000

(vi)
Repairs A/c
Dr.
1,600
To Machinery A/c
1,000
To Suspense A/c
600
(Repairs on machinery Rs. 1,600 wrongly debited to machinery account
as Rs. 1,000, now rectified)
(vii)
Sales Return A/c
Dr.
To Nathus A/c
(Sales return from Nathu not recorded)

3,000
3,000

Suspense Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars
Difference as per
trial balance
Mohit

J.F.

Amount Date Particulars


Rs.
16,000
3,000
19,000

Purchases
Repairs
Balance c/d

J.F. Amount
Rs.
1,000
600
17,400
19,000

Note : Even after rectification of errors suspense account is showing a debit balance
of Rs. 17,400. This is due to non-detection of errors affecting trial balance. Balance
of suspense account will be carried forward to the next year and will be eliminated
as and when all the remaining errors affecting trial balance are located.

214

Accountancy

Illustration 7
Trial balance of Kailash did not agree. He put the difference to suspense account. The
following errors were discovered :
(i)

Goods withdrawn by Kailash for personal use Rs. 500 were not recorded in the
books.
(ii) Discount allowed to Ramesh Rs.60 on receiving Rs. 2,040 from him was not recorded
in the books.
(iii) Discount received from Rohan Rs. 50 on paying Rs. 3,250 to him was not posted at all.
(iv) Rs. 700 received from Khalil, a debtor, whose account had earlier been written-off
as bad, were credited to his personal account.
(v) Cash received from Govil, a debtor, Rs. 5,000 was posted to his account as Rs. 500.
(vi) Goods returned to Mahesh Rs. 700 were posted to his account as Rs. 70.
(vii) Bill receivable from Narayan Rs. 1,000 was dishonoured and wrongly debited to
allowances account as Rs. 10,000.
Give journal entries to rectify the above errors and prepare suspense account to ascertain
the amount of difference in trial balance.
Solution.
(i)
Drawings A/c
Dr.
500
To Purchases A/c
500
(Goods withdrawn by proprietor for personal use not recorded, now
rectified).
(ii)
Discount allowed A/c
Dr.
60
To Rameshs A/c
(Discount allowed to Ramesh not recorded, now rectified)

60

(iii)
Rohans A/c
Dr.
50
To Discount received A/c
(Discount received from Rohan not posted , now corrected)

50

(iv)
Khalils A/c
Dr.
700
To Bad debts recovered A/c
700
(Bad debts recovered wrongly credited to debtors personal account, now
corrected)

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors

215

(v)
Suspense A/c
Dr.
4,500
To Govils A/c
4,500
(Cash received from Govil Rs. 5,000 wrongly posted to his account as
Rs. 500)
(vi)
Maheshs A/c
Dr.
630
To Suspense A/c
630
(Goods returned to Mahesh Rs. 700 wrongly posted to his account as
Rs. 70, now corrected)
(vii)
Narayans A/c
Dr.
1,000
Suspense A/c
Dr.
9,000
To Allowances A/c
10,000
(Bill receivables from Narayan Rs. 1,000 wrongly debited to allowances
account as Rs. 10,000).

Suspense Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars
Govil
Allowances

J.F. Amount Date Particulars


Rs.
4,500
Mahesh
9,000
Difference as per
trial balance
13,500

J.F. Amount
Rs.
630
12,870
13,500

Test Your Understanding - IV


Tick the Correct Answer
(1) Agreement of trial balance is affected by:
(a) One sided errors only.
(b) Two sided errors only.
(c) Both a and b.
(d) None of the above.
(2)

Which of the following is not an error of principle:


(a) Purchase of furniture debited to purchases account.
(b) Repairs on the overhauling of second hand machinery purchased debited to
repairs account.

216

(3)

(4)

(5)

(6)

(7)

(8)

(9)

Accountancy
(c) Cash received from Manoj posted to Saroj.
(d) Sale of old car credited to sales account.
Which of the following is not an error of commission:
(a) Overcasting of sales book.
(b) Credit sales to Ramesh Rs. 5,000 credited to his account.
(c) Wrong balancing of machinery account.
(d) Cash sales not recorded in cash book.
Which of following errors will be rectified through suspense account:
(a) Sales return book undercast by Rs. 1,000.
(b) Sales return by Madhu Rs. 1,000 not recorded.
(c) Sales return by Madhu Rs 1,000. recorded as Rs,100.
(d) Sales return by Madhu Rs. 1,000 recorded through purchases returns book
If the trial balance agrees, it implies that:
(a) There is no error in the books.
(b) There may be two sided errors in the book.
(c) There may be one sided error in the books.
(d) There may be both two sided and one sided errors in the books.
If suspense account does not balance off even after rectification of errors it implies
that:
(a) There are some one sided errors only in the books yet to be located.
(b) There are no more errors yet to be located.
(c) There are some two sided errors only yet to be located.
(d) There may be both one sided errors and two sided errors yet to be located.
If wages paid for installation of new machinery is debited to wages Account, it is:
(a) An error of commission.
(b) An error of principle.
(c) A compensating error.
(d) An error of omission.
Trial balance is:
(a) An account.
(b) A statement.
(c) A subsidiary book.
(d) A principal book.
A Trial balance is prepared:
(a) After preparation financial statement.
(b) After recording transactions in subsidiary books.
(c) After posting to ledger is complete.
(d) After posting to ledger is complete and accounts have been balanced,
Key Terms Introduced in the Chapter

Trial Balance
Error of Commission
Error Omission

Compensating Error
Error of Principle
Suspense Account

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors


Summary with Reference to Learning Objectives
1.
2.

3.

4.

5.

6.

7.

Meaning of trial balance : A statement showing the abstract of the balance


(debit/credit) of various accounts in the ledger.
Objectives of trial balance : The main objectives of preparing the trial balance
are : (i) to ascertain the arithmetical accuracy of the ledger accounts; (ii) to
help in locating errors; and (iii) to help in the preparatioon of the final accounts.
Preparation of trial balance by the balance method : In this method, the trial
balance has three columns. The first column is for the head of the account,
the second column for writing the debit balance and the third for the credit
balance of each account in the ledger.
Various types of errors :
(i) Errors of commission : Errors caused due to wrong recording of a
transaction, wrong totalling, wrong casting, wrong balancing, etc.
(ii) Errors of Omission : Errors caused due to omission of recording a
transaction entirely or party in the books of account.
(iii) Errors of Principle : Errors arising due to wrong classificatrion of receipts
and payments between revenue and capital receipts and revenue and
capital expenditure.
(iv) Compensating errors : Two or more errors committed in such a way that
they nullify the effect of each other on the debits and credits.
Rectification of errors : Errors affecting only one account can be rectified by
giving an explanatory note or by passing a journal entry. Errors which affect
two or more accounts are rectified by passing a journal entry.
Meaning and utility of suspense account : An account in which the difference
in the trial balance is put till such time that errors are located and rectified.
It facilitates the preparation of financial statements even when the trial balance
does not tally.
Disposal of suspense account : When all the errors are located and rectified
the suspense account stands disposed off.
Questions for Practice

Short Answers
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.

State the meaning of a trial balance?


Give two examples of errors of principle?
Give two examples of errors of commission?
What are the methods of preparing trial balance?
What are the steps taken by an accountant to locate the errors in the trial
balance?
6. What is a suspense account? Is it necessary that is suspense account will
balance off after rectification of the errors detected by the accountant? If
not, then what happens to the balance still remaining in suspense account?
7. What kinds of errors would cause difference in the trial balance. Also list
examples that would not be revealed by a trial balance?
8. State the limitations of trial balance?

217

218

Accountancy
Long Answers
1. Describe the purpose for the preparation of trial balance.
2. Explain errors of principle and give two examples with measures to rectify
them.
3. Explain the errors of commission and give two examples with measures to
rectify them.
4. What are the different types of errors that are usually committed in recording
business transaction.
5. As an accounts for a company, you are disappointed to learn that the
totals in your new trial balance are not equal. After going through a careful
analysis, you have discovered only one error. Specifically, the balance of
the Office Equipment account has a debit balance of Rs. 15,600 on the
trial balance. However, you have figured out that a correctly recorded credit
purchase of pendrive for Rs 3,500 was posted from the journal to the ledger
with a Rs. 3,500 debit to Office Equipment and another Rs. 3,500 debit to
creditors accounrts. Answer each of the following questions and present
the amount of any misstatement :
(a) Is the balance of the office equipment account overstated, understated,
or correctly stated in the trial balance?
(b) Is the balance of the creditors account overstated, understated, or
correctly stated in the trial balance?
(c) Is the debit column total of the trial balance overstated, understated,
or correclty stated?
(d) Is the credit column total of the trial balance overstated, understated,
or correctly stated?
(e) If the debit column total of the trial balance is Rs. 2,40,000 before
correcting the error, what is the total of credit column.
Numerical Questions
1. Rectify the following errors :
(i) Credit sales to Mohan Rs. 7,000 were not recorded.
(ii) Credit purchases from Rohan Rs. 9,000 were not recorded.
(iii) Goods returned to Rakesh Rs. 4,000 were not recorded.
(iv) Goods returned from Mahesh Rs. 1,000 were not recorded.
2. Rectify the following errors :
(i) Credit sales to Mohan Rs. 7,000 were recorded as Rs.700.
(ii) Credit purchases from Rohan Rs. 9,000 were recorded. as Rs.900.
(iii) Goods returned to Rakesh Rs. 4,000 were recorded as Rs 400.
(iv) Goods returned from Mahesh Rs. 1,000 were recorded as Rs.100.
3. Rectify the following errors :
(i) Credit sales to Mohan Rs. 7,000 were recorded as Rs.7,200.
(ii) Credit purchases from Rohan Rs. 9,000 were recorded as Rs. 9,900.
(iii) Goods returned to Rakesh Rs. 4,000 were recorded as Rs 4,040.
(iv) Goods returned from Mahesh Rs. 1,000 were recorded as Rs.1,600.

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors


4. Rectify the following errors :
(a) Salary paid Rs. 5,000 was debited to employees personal account.
(b) Rent Paid Rs. 4,000 was posted to landlords personal account.
(c) Goods withdrawn by proprietor for personal use Rs. 1,000 were debited
to sundry expenses account.
(d) Cash received from Kohli Rs. 2,000 was posted to Kapurs account.
(e) Cash paid to Babu Rs. 1,500 was posted to Sabus account.
5. Rectify the following errors :
(a) Credit Sales to Mohan Rs. 7,000 were recorded in purchases book.
(b) Credit Purchases from Rohan Rs. 9,00 were recorded in sales book.
(c) Goods returned to Rakesh Rs. 4,000 were recorded in the sales return
book.
(d) Goods returned from Mahesh Rs. 1,000 were recorded in purchases
return book.
(e) Goods returned from Nahesh Rs. 2,000 were recorded in purchases book.
6. Rectify the following errors :
(a) Sales book overcast by Rs. 700.
(b) Purchases book overcast by Rs. 500.
(c) Sales return book overcast by Rs. 300.
(d) Purchase return book overcast by Rs. 200.
7. Rectify the following errors :
(a) Sales book undercast by Rs.300.
(b) Purchases book undercast by Rs.400.
(c) Return Inwards book undercast by Rs.200.
(d) Return outwards book undercast by Rs.100.
8. Rectify the following errors and ascertain the amount of difference in trial
balance by preparing suspense account :
(a) Credit sales to Mohan Rs. 7,000 were not posted.
(b) Credit purchases from Rohan Rs. 9,000 were not posted.
(c) Goods returned to Rakesh Rs. 4,000 were not posted.
(d) Goods returned from Mahesh Rs. 1,000 were not posted.
(e) Cash paid to Ganesh Rs. 3,000 was not posted.
(f) Cash sales Rs. 2,000 were not posted.
(Ans : Difference in trial balance Rs. 2,000 excess credit).
9. Rectify the following errors and ascertain the amount of difference in trial
balance by preparing suspense account :
(a) Credit sales to Mohan Rs. 7,000 were posted as Rs. 9,000.
(b) Credit purchases from Rohan Rs. 9,000 were posted as Rs. 6,000.
(c) Goods returned to Rakesh Rs. 4,000 were posted as Rs. 5,000.
(d) Goods returned from Mahesh Rs. 1,000 were posted as Rs. 3,000.
(e) Cash sales Rs. 2,000 were posted as Rs. 200.
(Ans : Difference in trial balance Rs. 5,800 excess debit.)

219

220

Accountancy
10. Rectify the following errors :
(a) Credit sales to Mohan Rs. 7,000 were posted to Karan.
(b) Credit purchases from Rohan Rs. 9,000 were posted to Gobind.
(c) Goods returned to Rakesh Rs. 4,000 were posted to Naresh.
(d) Goods returned from Mahesh Rs. 1,000 were posted to Manish.
(e) Cash sales Rs. 2,000 were posted to commission account.
11. Rectify the following errors assuming that a suspense account was opened.
Ascertain the difference in trial balance.
(a) Credit sales to Mohan Rs. 7,000 were posted to the credit of his account.
(b) Credit purchases from Rohan Rs. 9,000 were posted to the debit of his
account as Rs. 6,000.
(c) Goods returned to Rakesh Rs. 4,000 were posted to the credit of his
account.
(d) Goods returned from Mahesh Rs. 1,000 were posted to the debit of his
account as Rs. 2,000.
(e) Cash sales Rs. 2,000 were posted to the debit of sales account as Rs. 5,000.
(Ans : Difference in trial balance Rs. 3,000 excess debit).
12. Rectify the following errors assuming that a suspense account was opened.
Ascertain the difference in trial balance.
(a) Credit sales to Mohan Rs. 7,000 were posted to Karan as Rs. 5,000.
(b) Credit purchases from Rohan Rs. 9,000 were posted to the debit of
Gobind as Rs 10,000.
(c) Goods returned to Rakesh Rs. 4,000 were posted to the credit of Naresh
as Rs 3,000.
(d) Goods returned from Mahesh Rs. 1,000 were posted to the debit of
Manish as Rs. 2,000.
(e) Cash sales Rs. 2,000 were posted to commission account as Rs. 200.
(Ans : Difference in trial balance Rs. 14, 800 excess debit).
13. Rectify the following errors assuming that suspense account was opened.
Ascertain the difference in trial balance.
(a) Credit sales to Mohan Rs. 7,000 were recorded in Purchase Book.
However, Mohans account was correctly debited.
(b) Credit purchases from Rohan Rs. 9,000 were recorded in sales book.
However, Rohans account was correctly credited.
(c) Goods returned to Rakesh Rs. 4,000 were recorded in sales return
book. However, Rakeshs account was correctly debited.
(d) Goods returned from Mahesh Rs. 1,000 were recorded through
purchases return book. However, Maheshs account was correctly
credited.
(e) Goods returned to Naresh Rs. 2,000 were recorded through purchases
book. However, Nareshs account was correctly debited.
(Ans : Difference in trial balance Rs. 6,000 excess debit).

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors


14. Rectify the following errors :
(a) Furniture purchased for Rs. 10,000 wrongly debited to purchases
account.
(b) Machinery purchased on credit from Raman for Rs. 20,000 was
recorded through purchases book.
(c) Repairs on machinery Rs. 1,400 debited to machinery account.
(d) Repairs on overhauling of secondhand machinery purchased Rs. 2,000
was debited to Repairs account.
(e) Sale of old machinery at book value of Rs. 3,000 was credited to sales account.
15. Rectify the following errors assuming that suspension account was opened.
Ascertain the difference in trial balance.
(a) Furniture purchased for Rs. 10,000 wrongly debited to purchase
account as Rs. 4,000.
(b) Machinery purchased on credit from Raman for Rs. 20,000 recorded
through Purchases Book as Rs. 6,000.
(c) Repairs on machinery Rs. 1,400 debited to Machinery account as
Rs. 2,400.
(d) Repairs on overhauling of second hand machinery purchased Rs. 2,000
was debited to Repairs account as Rs. 200.
(e) Sale of old machinery at book value Rs. 3,000 was credited to sales
account as Rs. 5,000.
(Ans : Difference in trial balance Rs. 8,800 excess credit).
16. Rectify the following errors :
(a) Depreciation provided on machinery Rs. 4,000 was not posted.
(b) Bad debts written off Rs. 5,000 were not posted.
(c) Discount allowed to a debtor Rs. 100 on receiving cash from him was not
posted.
(d) Discount allowed to a debtor Rs. 100 on receiving cash from him was
not posted to discount account.
(e) Bill receivable for Rs. 2,000 received from a debtor was not posted.
17. Rectify the following errors :
(a) Depreciation provided on machinery Rs. 4,000 was posted as Rs. 400.
(b) Bad debts written off Rs. 5,000 were posted as Rs. 6,000.
(c) Discount allowed to a debtor Rs. 100 on receiving cash from him was
posted as Rs. 60.
(d) Goods withdrawn by proprietor for personal use Rs. 800 were posted
as Rs. 300.
(e) Bill receivable for Rs. 2,000 received from a debtor was posted as
Rs. 3,000.
18. Rectify the following errors assuming that suspense account was opened.
Ascertain the difference in trial balance.
(a) Depreciation provided on machinery Rs. 4,000 was not posted to
Depreciation account.

221

222

Accountancy
(b) Bad debts written-off Rs. 5,000 were not posted to Debtors account.
(c) Discount allowed to a debtor Rs. 100 on receiving cash from him was
not posted to discount allowed account.
(d) Goods withdrawn by proprietor for personal use Rs. 800 were not posted
to Drawings account.
(e) Bill receivable for Rs. 2,000 received from a debtor was not posted to
Bills receivable account.
(Ans : Difference in trial balance Rs. 1,900 excess credit).
19. Trial balance of Anuj did not agree. It showed an excess credit of Rs. 6,000.
He put the difference to suspense account. He discovered the following
errors.
(a) Cash received from Ravish Rs. 8,000 posted to his account as
Rs. 6,000.
(b) Returns inwards book overcast by Rs. 1,000.
(c) Total of sales book Rs. 10,000 was not posted to Sales account.
(d) Credit purchases from Nanak Rs. 7,000 were recorded in sales Book.
However, Nanaks account was correctly credited.
(e) Machinery purchased for Rs. 10,000 was posted to purchases account
as Rs. 5,000. Rectify the errors and prepare suspense account.
(Ans : Total of suspense account Rs. 19,000).
20. Trial balance of Raju showed an excess debit of Rs. 10,000. He put the
difference to suspense account and discovered the following errors :
(a) Depreciation written-off the furniture Rs. 6,000 was not posted to
Furniture account.
(b) Credit sales to Rupam Rs. 10,000 were recorded as Rs. 7,000.
(c) Purchases book undercast by Rs. 2,000.
(d) Cash sales to Rana Rs. 5,000 were not posted.
(e) Old Machinery sold for Rs. 7,000 was credited to sales account.
(f) Discount received Rs. 800 from kanan on playing cash to him was not
posted. Rectify the errors and prepare suspense account.
(Ans : Balance carried forward in suspense account Rs. 1,000 (cr.)).
21. Trial balance of Madan did not agree and he put the difference to
suspense account. He discovered the following errors:
(a) Sales return book overcast by Rs. 800.
(b) Purchases return to Sahu Rs. 2,000 were not posted.
(c) Goods purchased on credit from Narula Rs. 4,000 though taken into
stock, but no entry was passed in the books.
(d) Installation charges on new machinery purchased Rs. 500 were debited
to sundry expenses account as Rs. 50.
(e) Rent paid for residential accommodation of madam (the proprietor)
Rs. 1,400 was debited to Rent account as Rs. 1,000.
Rectify the errors and prepare suspense account to ascertain the
difference in trial balance.
(Ans : Difference in trial balance Rs. 2,050 excess credit).

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors


22. Trial balance of Kohli did not agree and showed an excess debit of Rs.
16,300. He put the difference to a suspense account and discovered the
following errors:
(a) Cash received from Rajat Rs. 5,000 was posted to the debit of Kamal
as Rs. 6,000.
(b) Salaries paid to an employee Rs. 2,000 were debited to his personal
account as Rs. 1200.
(c) Goods withdrawn by proprietor for personal use Rs. 1,000 were credited
to sales account as Rs. 1,600.
(d) Depreciation provided on machinery Rs. 3,000 was posted to Machinery
account as Rs. 300.
(e) Sale of old car for Rs. 10,000 was credited to sales account as
Rs. 6,000. Rectify the errors and prepare suspense account.
(Ans : total of suspense account : Rs. 17,700).
23. Give journal entries to rectify the following errors assuming that suspense
account had been opened.
(a) Goods distributed as free sample Rs. 5,000 were not recorded in the
books.
(b) Goods withdrawn for personal use by the proprietor Rs. 2,000 were
not recorded in the books.
(c) Bill receivable received from a debtor Rs. 6,000 was not posted to his
account.
(d) Total of Returns inwards book Rs. 1,200 was posted to Returns
outwards account.
(e) Discount allowed to Reema Rs. 700 on receiving cash from her was
recorded in the books as Rs. 70.
(Ans : Difference in trial balance Rs. 3,600 excess debit).
24. Trial balance of Khatau did not agree. He put the difference to suspense account
and discovered the following errors :
(a) Credit sales to Manas Rs. 16,000 were recorded in the purchases book
as Rs. 10,000 and posted to the debit of Manas as Rs. 1,000.
(b) Furniture purchased from Noor Rs. 6,000 was recorded through
purchases book as Rs. 5,000 and posted to the debit of Noor Rs. 2,000.
(c) Goods returned to Rai Rs. 3,000 recorded through the Sales book as
Rs. 1,000.
(d) Old machinery sold for Rs. 2,000 to Maneesh recorded through sales
book as Rs. 1,800 and posted to the credit of Manish as Rs. 1,200.
(e) Total of Returns inwards book Rs. 2,800 posted to Purchase account.
Rectify the above errors and prepare suspense account to ascertain
the difference in trial balance.
(Ans : Difference in trial balance Rs. 15,000 excess debit).
25. Trial balance of John did not agree. He put the difference to suspense
account and discovered the following errors :
(a) In the sales book for the month of January total of page 2 was carried
forward to page 3 as Rs. 1,000 instead of Rs. 1200 and total of page 6
was carried forward to page 7 as Rs. 5,600 instead of Rs. 5,000.

223

224

Accountancy
(b) Wages paid for installation of machinery Rs. 500 was posted to wages
account as Rs. 50.
(c) Machinery purchased from R & Co. for Rs. 10,000 on credit was entered
in Purchase Book as Rs. 6,000 and posted there from to R & Co. as
Rs. 1,000.
(d) Credit sales to Mohan Rs. 5,000 were recorded in Purchases Book.
(e) Goods returned to Ram Rs. 1,000 were recorded in Sales Book.
(f) Credit purchases from S & Co. for Rs. 6,000 were recorded in sales
book. However, S & Co. was correctly credited.
(g) Credit purchases from M & Co. Rs. 6,000 were recorded in Sales Book
as Rs. 2,000 and posted there from to the credit of M & Co. as
Rs. 1,000.
(h) Credit sales to Raman Rs. 4,000 posted to the credit of Raghvan as
Rs. 1,000.
(i) Bill receivable for Rs. 1,600 from Noor was dishonoured and posted to
debit of Allowances account.
(j) Cash paid to Mani Rs. 5,000 against our acceptance was debited to
Manu.
(k) Old furniture sold for Rs. 3,000 was posted to Sales account as
Rs. 1,000.
(l) Depreciation provided on furniture Rs. 800 was not posted.
(m) Material Rs. 10,000 and wages Rs. 3,000 were used for construction
of building. No adjustment was made in the books.
Rectify the errors and prepare suspense to ascertain the difference in
trial balance.
(Ans : Difference in trial balance Rs. 13,850 excess credit).
Checklist to Test Your Understanding
Test your understanding - I
Trial Balance Total Rs. 5,17,000
Test your understanding - II
1.

2.

Purchases A/c
To Rajnis A/c

Dr.

Rajnis A/c
To Sales A/c

Dr.

Rajnis A/c
To Sales A/c
To Purchases A/c

Dr.

Purchases A/c
To Raos A/c

Dr.

5,000
5,000
5,000
5,000
10,000
5,000
5,000
8,000
8,000

Trial Balance and Rectification of Errors

3.

4.

225

Furniture A/c
To Purchases A/c

Dr.

Cash A/c
To Commission A/c

Dr.

Cash A/c
To Sales A/c

Dr.

Commission A/c
To Sales A/c

Dr.

Cash A/c
To Nadeems A/c

Dr.

Cash A/c
To Karims A/c

Dr.

8,000
8,000
15,000
15,000
15,000
15,000
15,000
15,000
6, 000
6,000
6,000
6,000

Test Your Understanding - III


1.

2.

Error of Commission
Mohans A/c
To Sales A/c

Dr.

12, 000
12,000

Mohans A/c
To Sales A/c

Dr.

10,000

Suspense A/c
To Mohans A/c

Dr.

10,000
2,000
2,000

Error of Partial omission


xxx A/c

Dr.

2,000

To Cash A/c

2,000

Nehas A/c
To Suspense A/c

Dr.

Nehas A/c
To Suspense A/c

Dr.

2,000
2,000
2,000
2,000

226

Accountancy
3.

4.

Error of Commission
Sales Return A/c
To Meghas A/c

Dr.

Sales Returns A/c


To Meghas A/c

Dr.

Suspense A/c
To Meghas A/c

Dr.

1,600
1,600

1,600
1,600

600
600

Error of Commission
xxx
To Furniture A/c

Dr.

1,500
1,500

Depreciation A/c
To Furniture A/c

Dr.

Depreciation A/c
To Suspense A/c

Dr.

1,500
1,500

1,500
1,500

Test Your Understanding - IV


1. (c)

2. (c)

3. (d)

4. (a)

5. (b)

6. (a)

7. (b)

8. (b)

9. (d)

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves

M
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
After studying this chapter,
you will be able to :
explain the meaning of
depreciation
and
distinguish it from
amortisation
and
depletion;
state the need for
charging depreciation
and identify its causes;
compute depreciation
using straight line and
written down value
methods;
record transactions
relating to depreciation
and disposition of
assets;
explain the meaning
and purpose of creating
provisions and reserves;

atching principle requires that the revenue of


a given period is matched against the expenses
for the same period. This ensures ascertainment of
the correct amount of profit or loss. If some cost is
incurred whose benefits extend for more than one
accounting period then it is not justified to charge
the entire cost as expense in the year in which it is
incurred. Rather such a cost must be spread over
the periods in which it provides benefits.
Depreciation, which is the main subject matter of
the present chapter, deals with such a situation.
Further, it may not always be possible to ascertain
with certainty the amount of some particular
expense. Recall that the principle of conservatism
(prudence) requires that instead of ignoring such
items of expenses, adequate provision must be
made and charged against profits of the current
period. Moreover, a part of profit may be retained
in the business in the form of reserves to provide
for growth, expansion or meeting certain specific
needs of the business in future. This chapter deals
with two distinct topics and hence is being
presented in two different sections. First section
deals with depreciation and second section deals
with provisions and reserves.

distinguish between
reserves and provisions;
explain the nature of
various
types
of
provisions and reserves
including secret reserve.

SECTION I
7.1 Depreciation
Now you are aware that fixed assets are the assets
which are used in business for more than one

228

Accountancy

accounting year. Fixed assets (technically referred to as depreciable assets)


tend to reduce their value once they are put to use. In general, the term
Depreciation means decline in the value of a fixed assets due to use, passage
of time or obsolescence. In other words, if a business enterprise procures a
machine and uses it in production process then the value of machine declines
with its usage. Even if the machine is not used in production process, we can
not expect it to realise the same sales price due to the passage of time or
arrival of a new model (obsolescence). It implies that fixed assets are subject
to decline in value and this decline is technically referred to as depreciation.
As an accounting term, depreciation is that part of the cost of a fixed asset
which has expired on account of its usage and/or lapse of time. Hence,
depreciation is an expired cost or expense, charged against the revenue of a
given accounting period. For example, a machine is purchased for Rs.1,00,000
on April 01, 2005. The useful life of the machine is estimated to be 10 years.
It implies that the machine can be used in the production process for next 10
years till March 31, 2015. You understand that by its very nature, Rs. 1,00,000
is a capital expenditure during the year 2005. However, when income statement
(Profit and Loss account) is prepared, the entire amount of Rs.1,00,000 can
not be charged against the revenue for the year 2005, because of the reason
that the capital expenditure amounting to Rs.1,00,000 is expected to derive
benefits (or revenue) for 10 years and not one year. Therefore, it is logical to
charge only a part of the total cost say Rs.10,000 (one tenth of Rs. 1,00,000)
against the revenue for the year 2005. This part represents, the expired cost
or loss in the value of machine on account of its use or passage of time and is
referred to as Depreciation. The amount of depreciation, being a charge against
profit, is debited to the profit and loss account.
7.1.1 Meaning of Depreciation
Depreciation may be described as a permanent, continuing and gradual
shrinkage in the book value of fixed assets. It is based on the cost of assets
consumed in a business and not on its market value.
According to Institute of Cost and Management Accounting, London (ICMA)
terminology The depreciation is the diminution in intrinsic value of the asset
due to use and/or lapse of time.
Accounting Standard-6 issued by The Institute of Chartered Accountants
of India (ICAI) defines depreciation as a measure of the wearing out, consumption
or other loss of value of depreciable asset arising from use, effluxion of time or
obsolescence through technology and market-change. Depreciation is allocated
so as to charge fair proportion of depreciable amount in each accounting period
during the expected useful life of the asset. Depreciation includes amortisation
of assets whose useful life is pre-determined.

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves

229
Box 1

AS-6 (Revised): Depreciation

Depreciation is a measure of the wearing out, consumption or other loss of


value of depreciable asset arising from use, effluxion of time or obsolescence
through technology and market-change. Depreciation is allocated so as to charge
fair proportion of depreciable amount in each accounting period during the
expected useful life of the asset. Depreciation includes amortisation of assets
whose useful life is pre-determined.
Depreciation has a significant effect in determining and presenting the financial
position and results of operations of an enterprise. Depreciation is charged in
each accounting period by reference to the extent of the depreciable amount.
The subject matter of depreciation, or its base, are depreciable assets which.
are expected to be used during more than one accounting period.
have a limited useful life; and
are held by an enterprise for use in production or supply of goods and services,
for rental to others, or for administrative purposes and not for the purpose of
sale in the ordinary course of business.
The amount of depreciation basically depends upon three factors, i.e. Cost, Useful
life and Net realisable value.
Cost of a fixed asset is the total cost spent in connection with its acquisition,
installation and commissioning as well as for add item or improvement of the
depreciable asset.
Useful life of an asset is the period over which it is expected to be used by the
enterprise.
There are two main methods of calculating depreciation amount.
straight line method
written down value method
Selection of appropriate method depends upon the following factors:
type of the asset
nature of the use of such asset
circumstances prevailing in the business.
The selected depreciation method should be applied consistently from period to
period. Change in depreciation method may be allowed only under specific
circumstances.

Depreciation has a significant effect in determining and presenting the


financial position and results of operations of an enterprise. Depreciation is
charged in each accounting period by reference to the extent of the depreciable
amount. It should be noted that the subject matter of depreciation, or its
base, are depreciable assets which:

are expected to be used during more than one accounting period;

have a limited useful life; and

are held by an enterprise for use in production or supply of goods and


services, for rental to others, or for administrative purposes and not for
the purpose of sale in the ordinary course of business.

230

Accountancy

Examples of depreciable assets are machines, plants, furnitures, buildings,


computers, trucks, vans, equipments, etc. Moreover, depreciation is the
allocation of depreciable amount, which is the historical cost, or other
amount substituted for historical cost less estimated salvage value.
Another point in the allocation of depreciable amount is the expected useful
life of an asset. It has been described as either (i) the period over which a
depreciable asset is expected to the used by the enterprise, or (ii) the number
of production of similar units expected to be obtained from the use of the
asset by the enterprise.
7.1.2 Features of Depreciation
Above mentioned discussion on depreciation highlights the following features
of depreciation:
1. It is decline in the book value of fixed assets.
2. It includes loss of value due to effluxion of time, usage or obsolescence.
For example, a business firm buys a machine for Rs. 1,00,000 on April
01, 2000. In the year 2002, a new version of the machine arrives in the
market. As a result, the machine bought by the business firm becomes
outdated. The resultant decline in the value of old machine is caused by
obsolescence.
3. It is a continuing process.
4. It is an expired cost and hence must be deducted before calculating taxable
profits. For example, if profit before depreciation and tax is Rs. 50,000,
and depreciation is Rs. 10,000; profit before tax will be:
Profit before depreciation & tax
(-) Depreciation
Profit before tax

(Rs.)
50,000
(10,000)
40,000

5. It is a non-cash expense. It does not involve any cash outflow. It is the


process of writing-off the capital expenditure already incurred.

Do it Yourself
Look at your surroundings and identify at least five depreciable assets in your home,
school, hospital, printing press and in a bakery.

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves

231

7.2 Depreciation and other Similar Terms


There are some termslike depletion and amortisation, which are also used
in connection with depreciation. This has been due to the similar treatment
given to them in accounting on the basis of similarity of their outcome, since
they represent the expiry of the usefulness of different assets.
7.2.1 Depletion
The term depletion is used in the context of extraction of natural resources
like mines, quarries, etc. that reduces the availability of the quantity of the
material or asset. For example, if a business enterprise is into mining business
and purchases a coal mine for Rs. 10,00,000. Then the value of coal mine
declines with the extraction of coal out of the mine. This decline in the value of
mine is termed as depletion. The main difference between depletion and
depreciation is that the former is concerned with the exhaution of economic
resources, but the latter relates to the usage of an asset. In spite of this, the
result is erosion in the volume of natural resources and expiry of the service
potential. Therefore, depletion and depreciation are given similar accounting
treatment.
7.2.2 Amortisation
Amortisation refers to writing-off the cost of intangible assets like patents,
copyright, trade marks, franchises, leasehold mines which have entitlements
to use for a specified period of time. The procedure for amortisation or periodic
write-off of a portion of the cost of intangible assets is the same as that for the
depreciation of fixed assets. For example, if a business firm buys a patent for
Rs. 10,00,000 and estimates that its useful life will be 10 years then the
business firm must write-off Rs. 10,00,000 over 10 years. The amount so
written- off is technically referred to as amortisation.
7.3 Causes of Depreciation
These have been very clearly spelt out as part of the definition of depreciation
in the Accounting Standard 6 and are being elaborated here.
7.3.1 Wear and Tear due to Use or Passage of Time
Wear and tear means deterioration, and the consequent diminution in an
assets value, arising from its use in business operations for earning revenue.
It reduces the assets technical capacities to serve the purpose for, which it
has been meant. Another aspect of wear and tear is the physical deterioration.
An asset deteriorates simply with the passage of time, even though they are
not being put to any use. This happens especially when the assets are exposed
to the rigours of nature like weather, winds, rains, etc.

232

Accountancy

7.3.2 Expiration of Legal Rights


Certain categories of assets lose their value after the agreement governing
their use in business comes to an end after the expiry of pre-determined
period. Examples of such assets are patents, copyrights, leases, etc. whose
utility to business is extinguished immediately upon the removal of legal
backing to them.
7.3.3 Obsolescence
Obsolescence is another factor leading to depreciation of fixed assets. In
ordinary language, obsolescence means the fact of being out-of-date.
Obsolescence implies to an existing asset becoming out-of-date on account of
the availability of better type of asset. It arises from such factors as:
Technological changes;
Improvements in production methods;
Change in market demand for the product or service output of the asset;
Legal or other description.
7.3.4 Abnormal Factors
Decline in the usefulness of the asset may be caused by abnormal factors
such as accidents due to fire, earthquake, floods, etc. Accidental loss is
permanent but not continuing or gradual. For example, a car which has been
repaired after an accident will not fetch the same price in the market even if it
has not been used.
Test Your Understanding - I
1. You are looking at the profit and loss account of three business enterprises. You
find the term depletion in first case and amortisation in third case. State the type
of business of two enterprises are into.
2. A pharmaceutical manufacturer has just developed and registered a patent for a
rare medicine. Which term will appear in its profit and loss account regarding the
cost of patent written-off.

7.4 Need for Depreciation


The need for providing depreciation in accounting records arises from
conceptual, legal, and practical business consideration. These considerations
provide depreciation a particular significance as a business expense.
7.4.1 Matching of Costs and Revenue
The rationale of the acquisition of fixed assets in business operations is that
these are used in the earning of revenue. Every asset is bound to undergo

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves

233

some wear and tear, and hence lose value, once it is put to use in business.
Therefore, depreciation is as much the cost as any other expense incurred in
the normal course of business like salary, carriage, postage and stationary,
etc. It is a charge against the revenue of the corresponding period and must
be deducted before arriving at net profit according to Generally Accepted
Accounting Principles.
7.4.2 Consideration of Tax
Depreciation is a deductible cost for tax purposes. However, tax rules for the
calculation of depreciation amount need not necessarily be similar to current
business practices,
7.4.3 True and Fair Financial Position
If depreciation on assets is not provided for, then the assets will be over valued
and the balance sheet will not depict the correct financial position of the
business. Also, this is not permitted either by established accounting practices
or by specific provisions of law.
7.4.4 Compliance with Law
Apart from tax regulations, there are certain specific legislations that indirectly
compel some business organisations like corporate enterprises to provide
depreciation on fixed assets.

Test Your Understanding - II


State whether the following statements are true or false:
1. Depreciation is a non-cash expense.
2. Depreciation is also charged on current assets.
3. Depreciation is decline in the market value of tangible fixed assets.
4. The main cause of depreciation is wear and tear caused by its usage.
5. Depreciation must be charged so as to ascertain true profit or loss of the
business.
6. Depletion term is used in case of intangible assets.
7. Depreciation provides fund for replacement.
8. When market value of an asset is higher than book value, depreciation is not
charged.
9. Depreciation is charged to reduce the value of asset to its market value.
10. If adequate maintenance expenditure is incurred, depreciation need not be
charged.

234

Accountancy

7.5 Factors Affecting the Amount of Depreciation


The determination of depreciation depends on three parameters, viz. cost,
estimated useful life and probable salvage value.
7.5.1 Cost of Asset
Cost (also known as original cost or historical cost) of an asset includes invoice
price and other costs, which are necessary to put the asset in use or working
condition. Besides the purchase price, it includes freight and transportation
cost, transit insurance, installation cost, registration cost, commission paid
on purchase of asset add items such as software, etc. In case of purchase of a
second hand asset it includes initial repair cost to put the asset in workable
condition. According to Accounting Standand-6 of ICAI, cost of a fixed asset is
the total cost spent in connection with its acquisition, installation and
commissioning as well as for addition or improvement of the depreciable asset.
For example, a photocopy machine is purchased for Rs. 50,000 and Rs. 5,000
is spent on its transportation and installation. In this case the original cost of
the machine is Rs. 55,000 (i.e. Rs. 50,000 + Rs.5,000 ) which will be writtenoff as depreciation over the useful life of the machine.
7.5.2 Estimated Net Residual Value
Net Residual value (also known as scrap value or salvage value for accounting
purpose) is the estimated net realisable value (or sale value) of the asset at the
end of its useful life. The net residual value is calculated after deducting the
expenses necessary for the disposal of the asset. For example, a machine is
purchased for Rs. 50,000 and is expected to have a useful life of 10 years. At
the end of 10th year it is expected to have a sale value of Rs. 6,000 but
expenses related to its disposal are estimated at Rs. 1,000. Then its net residual
value shall be Rs. 5,000 (i.e. Rs. 6,000 Rs. 1,000).
7.5.3 Depreciable Cost
Depreciable cost of an asset is equal to its cost (as calculated in point 7.5.1
above) less net residual value (as calculated in point 7.5.2,) Hence, in the
above example, the depreciable cost of machine is Rs. 45,000 (i.e., Rs. 50,000
Rs. 5,000.) It is the depreciable cost, which is distributed and charged as
depreciation expense over the estimated useful life of the asset. In the above
example, Rs. 45,000 shall be charged as depreciation over a period of 10
years. It is important to mention here that total amount of depreciation charged
over the useful life of the asset must be equal to the depreciable cost. If total
amount of depreciation charged is less than the depreciable cost then the

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves

235

capital expenditure is under recovered. It violates the principle of proper


matching of revenue and expense.
7.5.4 Estimated Useful Life
Useful life of an asset is the estimated economic or commercial life of the
asset. Physical life is not important for this purpose because an asset may
still exist physically but may not be capable of commercially viable production.
For example, a machine is purchased and it is estimated that it can be used
in production process for 5 years. After 5 years the machine may still be in
good physical condition but cant be used for production profitably, i.e., if it is
still used the cost of production may be very high. Therefore, the useful life of
the machine is considered as 5 years irrespective of its physical life. Estimation
of useful life of an asset is difficult as it depends upon several factors such as
usage level of asset, maintenance of the asset, technological changes, market
changes, etc. As per Accounting Standard 6 useful life of an asset is normally
the period over which it is expected to be used by the enterprise. Normally,
useful life is shorter than the physical life. The useful life of an asset is expressed
in number of years but it can also be expressed in other units, e.g., number of
units of output (as in case of mines) or number of working hours. Useful life
depends upon the following factors :
Pre-determined by legal or contractual limits, e.g. in case of leasehold
asset, the useful life is the period of lease.
The number of shifts for which asset is to be used.
Repair and maintenance policy of the business organisation.
Technological obsolescence.
Innovation/improvement in production method.
Legal or other restrictions.
7.6 Methods of Calculating Depreciation Amount
The depreciation amount to be charged for during an accounting year depends
up on depreciable amount and the method of allocation. For this, two methods
are mandated by law and enforced by professional accounting practice in
India. These methods are straight line method and written down value method.
Besides these two main methods there are other methods such as annuity
method, depreciation fund method, insurance policy method, sum of years
digit method, double declining method, etc. which may be used for determining
the amount of depreciation. The selection of an appropriate method depends
upon the following :

236

Accountancy

Type of the asset;

Nature of the use of such asset;

Circumstances prevailing in the business;

As per Accounting Standard-6, the selected depreciation method should


be applied consistently from period to period. Change in depreciation method
may be allowed only under specific circumstances.
7.6.1 Straight Line Method
This is the earliest and one of the widely used methods of providing
depreciation. This method is based on the assumption of equal usage of the
asset over its entire useful life. It is called straight line for a reason that if the
amount of depreciation and corresponding time period is plotted on a graph,
it will result in a straight line (figure 7.1).
It is also called fixed installment method because the amount of depreciation
remains constant from year to year over the useful life of the asset. According
to this method, a fixed and an equal amount is charged as depreciation in
every accounting period during the lifetime of an asset. The amount annually
charged as depreciation is such that it reduces the original cost of the asset to
its scrap value, at the end of its useful life. This method is also known as fixed
percentage on original cost method because same percentage of the original
cost (infact depreciable cost) is written off as depreciation from year to year.
The depreciation amount to be provided under this method is computed
by using the following formula:
Depreciation =

Cost of asset Estimated net residential value


Estimated useful life of the asset

Rate of depreciation under straight line method is the percentage of the


total cost of the asset to be charged as deprecation during the useful lifetime
of the asset. Rate of depreciation is calculated as follows:
Rate of Depreciation =

Annual depreciation amount


100
Acquisition cost

Consider the following example, the original cost of the asset is Rs. 2,50,000.
The useful life of the asset is 10 years and net residual value is estimated to
be Rs. 50,000. Now, the amount of depreciation to be charged every year will
be computed as given below:

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves

237

Annual Depreciation Amount


=

Acqusition cost of asset Estimated net residential value


Estimated life of asset

i.e. =

Rs. 2,50,000 Rs. 50,000


= Rs. 20,000
10

Fig. 7.1 : Depreciation amount under straight line method

The rate of depreciation will be calculated as :


(i) Rate of Depreciation =

Annual depreciation amount


100
Acquisition cost

From point (i), the annual depreciation amounts to Rs. 20,000.


Thus, the rate of depreciation will be =

Rs. 20,000
100 = 8%
Rs. 2,50,000

7.6.1.1 Advantages of Straight Line Method


Straight Line method has certain advantages which are stated below:
It is very simple, easy to understand and apply. Simplicity makes it a
popular method in practice;
Asset can be depreciated upto the net scrap value or zero value. Therefore,
this method makes it possible to distribute full depreciable cost over useful
life of the asset;
Every year, same amount is charged as depreciation in profit and loss
account. This makes comparison of profits for different years easy;
This method is suitable for those assets whose useful life can be estimated
accurately and where the use of the asset is consistent from year to year
such as leasehold buildings.

238

Accountancy

7.6.1.2 Limitations of Straight Line Method


Although straight line method is simple and easy to apply it suffers from
certain limitations which are given below.
This method is based on the faulty assumption of same utility of the asset
in different accounting years;
With the passage of time, work efficiency of the asset decreases and repair
and maintenance expense increases. Hence, under this method total
amount charged against profit on account of depreciation and repair taken
together will not be uniform throughout the life of the asset, rather it will
keep on increasing from year to year.
7.6.2 Written Down Value Method
Under this method, depreciation is charged on the book value of the asset.
Since book value keeps on reducing by the annual charge of depreciation, it is
also known as reducing balance method. This method involves the application
of a pre-determined proportion/percentage of the book value of the asset at
the beginning of every accounting period, so as to calculate the amount of
depreciation. The amount of depreciation reduces year after year.
For example, the original cost of the asset is Rs. 2,00,000 and depreciation
is charged @ 10% p.a. at written down value, then the amount of depreciation
will be computed as follows:
10
= Rs. 20,000
100
(ii) Written down value = Rs. 2,00,000 20,000 = Rs.1,80,000
(at the end of the I year)

(i)

Depreciation (I year) = Rs. 20,00,000

10
= Rs. 18,000
100
(iv) Written down value = Rs. 1,80,000 Rs.18,000 = 1,62,000
(at the end of the II year)

(iii) Depreciation (II year) = Rs. 1,80,000

10
= Rs.16,200
100
(vi) Written down value = Rs. 1,62,000 Rs. 16,200 = Rs. 1,45,800
(at the end of III year)

(v) Depreciation (III year) = Rs. 1,62,000

As evident from the example, the amount of depreciation goes on reducing


year after year. For this reason, it is also known reducing installment or
diminishing value method. This method is based upon the assumption that
the benefit accruing to business from assets keeps on diminishing as the
asset becomes old (refer figure 7.2). This is due to the reason that a predetermined percentage is applied to a gradually shrinking balance on the

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves

239

asset account every year. Thus, large amount is recovered depreciation charge
in the earlier years than in later years.

Fig. 7.2 : Depreciation amount using written down value method

Under written down value method, the rate of depreciation is computed by


using the following formula:

s
R = 1 n
100
c

Where,

r = Rate of depreciation
n = Expected useful life
s = Scrap value
c = Cost of an asset

For example, the original cost of a truck is Rs. 9,00,000 and its net salvage
value after 16 years of useful life is Rs. 50,000 then the appropriate rate of
depreciation will be computed as under:

50,000
R = 1 16
100 = (1 0.834) 100 = 16.6%
9,00,000

7.6.2.1 Advantages of Written Down Value Method


Written down value method has the following advantages:

This method is based on a more realistic assumption that the benefits


from asset go on diminishing with the passage of time. Hence, it calls for
proper allocation of cost because higher depreciation is charged in earlier
years when assets utility is more as compared to later years when it
becomes less useful;
It results into almost equal burden on profit or loss account of depreciation
and repair expenses taken together every year;

240

Accountancy

Income Tax Act accept this method for tax purposes;


As a large portion of cost is written-off in earlier years, loss due to
obsolescence gets reduced;
This method is suitable for fixed assets, which lasts for long and which
require increased repair and maintenance expenses with passage of time.
It can also be used where obsolescence rate is high.

7.6.2.2 Limitations of Written Down Value Method


Although this method is based upon a more realistic assumption it suffers
from the following limitations.
As depreciation is calculated at fixed percentage of written down value,
depreciable cost of the asset cannot be fully written-off. The value of the
asset can never be zero;
It is difficult to ascertain a suitable rate of depreciation.
7.7 Straight Line Method and Written Down Method: A Comparative Analysis
Straight line and written down value methods are generally used for calculating
depreciation amount in practice. Following are the points of differences between
these two methods.
7.7.1 Basis of Charging Depreciation
In straight line method, depreciation is charged on the basis of original cost or
(historical cost). Whereas in written down value method, the basis of charging
depreciation is net book value (i.e., original cost less depreciation till date) of
the asset, in the beginning of the year.
7.7.2 Annual Charge of Depreciation
The annual amount of depreciation charged every year remains fixed or
constant under straight line method. Whereas in written down value method
the annual amount of depreciation is highest in the first year and subsequently
declines in later years. The reason for this difference, is the difference in the
basis of charging depreciation under both methods. Under straight line method
depreciation is calculated on original cost while under written down value
method it is calculated on written down value.
7.7.3 Total Charge Against Profit and Loss Account on Account of
Depreciation and Repair Expenses
It is a well-accepted phenomenon that repair and maintenance expenses
increase in later years of the useful life of the asset. Hence, total charge against

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves

241

profit and loss account in respect of depreciation and repair expenses increases
in later years under straight line method. This happens because annual
depreciation charge remains fixed while repair expenses increase. On the other
hand, under written down value method, depreciation charge declines in later
years, therefore total of depreciation and repair charge remains similar or
equal year after year.
7.7.4 Recognition by Income Tax Law
Straight line method is not recognised by Income Tax Law while written down
value method is recognised by the Income Tax Law.
7.7.5 Suitability
Straight line method is suitable for assets in which repair charges are less,
the possibility of obsolescence is less and scrap value depends upon the time
period involved. Such as freehold land and buildings, patents, trade marks,
etc. Written down value method is suitable for assets, which are affected by
technological changes and require more repair expenses with passage of time
such as plant and machinery, vehicles, etc.
Basis of Difference

Straight Line Method

Written Down Value


Method

1.

Basis of charging depreciation

Original cost

2.

Annual depreciation charge

Fixed (Constant) year

3.

Total charge against


profit and loss account in
respect of depreciation
and repairs
Recognition by income
tax law
Suitablity

Unequal year after year.


It increases in later years.

Almost equal every year.

Not recognised

Recognised

It is suitable for assets in


which repair charges are
less, the possibility of
and obsolescence is low
scrap value depends upon
the time period involved.

It is suitable for assets,


which ar e af fected by
technological changes
and require more repair
expenses with passage of
time.

4.
5.

Book Value (i.e. original


cost less depr eciation
char ged
till
date)
Declines year after year

Fig. 7.3 : Comparison of straight line and written down value method

242

Accountancy

Test Your Understanding - III


There are two dentists Dr. Aggarwal and Dr. Mehta in your locality who are
competitors. Both of them have recently bought an equipment for treatment of
patients. Dr. Aggarwal has decided to write-off an equal amount of depreciation
every year while Dr. Mehta wants to write-off a larger amount in earlier years. They
do not know anything about the methods of depreciation. Can you inform them
more about the methods of depreciation they are applying even without knowing
anything about accounting in formal. Who is more wise in your opinion? Give reasons
in support of your answer.

7.8 Methods of Recording Depreciation


In the books of account, there are two types of arrangements for recording
depreciation on fixed assets:
Charging depreciation to asset account or
Creating Provision for depreciation/Accumulated depreciation account.
7.8.1 Charging Depreciation to Asset account
According to this arrangement, depreciation is deducted from the depreciable
cost of the asset ( credited to the asset account) and charged (or debited) to
profit and loss account. Journal entries under this recording method are as
follows:
1. For recording purchase of asset
Asset A/c
Dr.

(only in the year of purchase)


(with the cost of asset including
installation, freight, etc.)

To Bank/Vendor A/c
2. Following two entries are recorded at the end of every year
(a) For deducting depreciation amount from the cost of the asset.
Depreciation A/c
Dr.
(with the amount of depreciation)
To Asset A/c
(b) For charging depreciation to profit and loss account.
Profit & Loss A/c
Dr.
(with the amount of depreciation)
To Depreciation A/c
3. Balance Sheet Treatment
When this method is used, the fixed asset appears at its net book value (i.e. cost
less depreciation charged till date) on the asset side of the balance sheet and not at
its original cost (also known as historical cost).

7.8.2 Creating Provision for Depreciation Account/Accumulated


Depreciation Account
This method is designed to accumulate the depreciation provided on an asset
in a separate account generally called depreciation provision or accumulated

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves

243

depreciation. Such accumulation of depreciation enables that the asset account


need not be disturbed in any way and it continues to be shown at its original
cost over the successive years of its useful life. There are some basic
characteristic of this method of recording depreciation, which are given below:
Asset account continues to appear at its original cost year after year over
its entire life;
Depreciation is accumulated on a separate account instead of being
adjusted into the asset account at the end of each accounting period.
The following journal entries are recorded under this method:
1.

For recording purchase of asset


Asset A/c
To Bank/Vendor A/c

2.

Dr.

(only in the year of purchase)


(with the cost of asset including
installation, expenses etc.)
(cash/credit purchase)

Following two journal entries are recorded at the end of each year:
(a)

For crediting depreciation amount to provision for depreciation account


Depreciation A/c
Dr.
(with the amount of depreciation)
To Provision for depreciation A/c

(b)

For charging depreciation to profit and loss account


Profit & Loss A/c
Dr.
(with the amount of depreciation)
To Depreciation A/c

3.

Balance sheet treatment

In the balance sheet, the fixed asset continues to appear at its original cost on the
asset side. The depreciation charged till that date appears in the provision for depreciation
account, which is shown either on the liabilities side of the balance sheet or by way of
deduction from the original cost of the asset concerned on the asset side of the balance
sheet.
Illustration 1
M/s Singhania and Bros. purchased a plant for Rs. 5,00,000 on April, 01 2002, and
spent Rs. 50,000 for its installation. The salvage value of the plant after its useful life of
10 years is estimated to be Rs. 10,000. Record journal entries for the year 2002-03 and
draw up Plant Account and Depreciation Account for first three years given that the
depreciation is charged using straight line method if :
(i)
(ii)

The books of account close on March 31 every year; and


The firm charges depreciation to the asset account.

244

Accountancy

Solution
Books of Singhania and Bros.
Journal
Date

2002
Apr. 01

Apr. 01

Particulars

L.F.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Plant A/c
Dr.
To Bank A/c
(Purchased plant for Rs. 5,00,000)

5,00,000

Plant A/c
Dr.
To Bank A/c
(Expenses incurred on installation)

50,000

Depreciation A/c
To Plant A/c
(Depreciation charged on asset)

54,000

Credit
Amount
Rs.

5,00,000

50,000

2003
Mar. 31

Mar. 31

Dr.

54,000

Profit and Loss A/c


Dr.
To Depreciation A/c
(Depreciation debited to profit and
loss account)

54,000
54,000

Plant Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2002
Apr. 01

Bank
Bank
(Installation
expenses)

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
5,00,000

Date
2003
Mar. 31

Particulars

Depreciation
Balance c/d

Balance b/d

Balance b/d

4,96,000

4,42,000
4,42,000

2005
Apr. 01

Balance b/d

54,000
4,96,000

5,50,000
2004
Mar. 31

Depreciation
Balance c/d

4,96,000
2004
Apr. 01

Amount
Rs.

50,000

5,50,000
2003
Apr. 01

J.F.

3,88,000

54,000
4,42,000
4,96,000

2005
Mar. 31

Depreciation
Balance c/d

54,000
3,88,000
4,42,000

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves

245

Depreciation Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2003
Mar. 31
2004
Mar. 31
2005
Mar. 31

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Plant

54,000

Plant

54,000

Plant

54,000

Date

Particulars

2003
Mar. 31
2004
Mar. 31
2005
Mar. 31

J.F.

Amounts
Rs.

Profit and Loss

54,000

Profit and Loss

54,000

Profit & Loss

54,000

Workings Notes
(1)

Calculation of original cost


Purchase cost
Add: Installation cost
Original cost
Salvage value
Useful life

(2)

Depreciation amount =

(Rs.)
5,00,000
50,000
5,50,000
10,000
10 years
Rs. 5,50,000 Rs. 10,000
= Rs. 54,000 p.a.
10

Illustration 2
M/s Mehra and Sons acquired a machine for Rs. 1,80,000 on October 01, 2003, and
spent Rs 20,000 for its installation. The firm writes-off depreciation at the rate of 10% on
original cost every year. Record necessary journal entries for the year 2003 and draw up
Machine Account and Depreciation Account for first three years given that:
(i) The book of accounts closes on March 31 every year; and
(ii) The firm charges depreciation to asset account.
Solution
Books of Mehra and Sons
Journal
Date
2003
Oct. 01

Oct. 01

Particulars

L.F.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Machine A/c
Dr.
To Bank A/c
(Purchased machine for Rs.1,80,000)

1,80,000

Machine A/c
Dr.
To Bank A/c
(Expenses incurred on installation)

20,000

Credit
Amount
Rs.

1,80,000

20,000

246
2004
Mar. 31

Mar. 31

2005
Mar. 31

Mar. 31

2006
Mar. 31

Mar. 31

Accountancy

Depreciation A/c
Dr.
To Machine A/c
Depreciation charged on machine)
Profit and Loss A/c
Dr.
To Depreciation A/c
(Depreciation debited to profit and loss
account)

10,000

Depreciation A/c
Dr.
To Machine A/c
(Depreciation charged on machine)

20,000

Profit and Loss A/c


Dr.
To Depreciation A/c
(Depreciation debited to profit and loss
account)

20,000

Depreciation A/c
Dr.
To Machine A/c
(Depreciation charged on machine)

20,000

Profit and Loss A/c


Dr.
To Depreciation A/c
(Depreciation debited to profit and
loss account)

20,000

10,000
10,000
10,000

20,000

20,000

20,000

20,000

Books of M/s Mehra and Sons


Machine Account
Dr.
Date
2003
Oct. 01
Oct. 01

Cr.
Particulars

Bank
Bank
(Installation
expenses)

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
1,80,000
20,000

Date
2004
Mar. 31

Particulars

Depreciation
(for 6 months)
Balance c/d

Balance b/d

Amount
Rs.
10,000
1,90,000

Mar. 31
2,00,000

2004
Apr. 01

J.F.

1,90,000

2,00,000
Mar. 31

Depreciation

20,000
1,70,000

Balance c/d
1,90,000
2005
Apr. 01

Balance b/d

1,70,000
1,70,000

1,90,000
2006
Mar. 31

Depreciation
Balance c/d

20,000
1,50,000
1,70,000

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves

247

Depreciation Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2004
Mar. 31

Machine

10,000
10,000

Mar. 31

Machine

20,000
20,000

2006
Dec. 31

Machine

20,000

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2004
Mar. 31

Profit & Loss

10,000
10,000

Mar. 31

Profit & Loss

20,000
20,000

2006
Dec. 31

Profit & Loss

20,000

2005

20,000

20,000

Working Notes
(1)

Calculation of original cost of the machine


Rs.
Purchase cost
1,80,000
Add Installation cost (20,000)
Original cost

(2)

2,00,000

(3)

Depreciation expense = 10% of Rs. 2,00,000 every year


= Rs. 20,000 p.a.
During the year 2003, depreciation shall be charged only for 6 months, as
acquisition date is October 01, 2003, i.e. the asset is used only for 6 months
during the year 2003-04.

(4)

Depreciation (2003 4) = 20,000

6
= Rs. 10,000
12

Illustration 3
Based on data given in question number 2 record journal entries and prepare Machine
account, Depreciation account and Provision for Depreciation account for the first 3 years
if Provision for depreciation account is maintained by the firm.
Solution
Books of Mehra and Sons
Machine Account
Dr.
Date
2003
Oct. 1
Oct. 1

Particulars

Bank
Bank
(Installation
expenses)

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
1,80,000

Date

Particulars

2004
Mar. 31

Balance c/d

J.F.

Cr.
Amounts
Rs.
2,00,000

20,000
2,00,000

2,00,000

248
2004
Apr. 01

Accountancy

Balance b/d

2,00,000

2005
Mar. 31

Balance c/d

2,00,000

2,00,000

2,00,000

Provision for Depreciation Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2004
Mar. 31

Balance c/d

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
10,000

Date

Particulars

2004
Mar. 31

Depreciation

J.F.

10,000

10,000
2005
Mar. 31

Balance c/d

30,000

10,000
2004
Apr. 01
Mar. 31

Balance b/d
Depreciation

10,000
20,000

30,000
2006
Mar. 31

Amounts
Rs.

30,000
2005

Balance c/d

50,000

Apr. 1

Balance b/d

30,000

2006
Mar. 31

Depreciation

20,000

50,000

50,000

Depreciation Account
Dr.
Date
2004
Mar. 31

Cr.
Particulars

Provision for
Deprection

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
10,000

Date

Particulars

2004
Mar.31

Profit & Loss

10,000
2005
Mar. 31

Provision for
Depreciation

20,000

Provision for
Depreciation

20,000
20,000

Amount
Rs.
10,000
10,000

2005
Mar.31

Profit & Loss

20,000
2006
Mar. 31

J.F.

20,000
20,000

2006
Mar.31

Profit & Loss

20,000
20,000

Illustration 4
M/s. Dalmia Textile Mills purchased machinery on April 01, 2001 for Rs. 2,00,000 on
credit from M/s Ahuja and sons and spent Rs. 10,000 for its installation. Depreciation is

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves

249

provided @10% p.a. on written down value basis. Prepare Machinery Account for the first
three years. Books are closed on March 31, every year.
Solution
Books of Dalmia Textiles mills
Machinery Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date
2001
Apr. 01

Particulars

Bank
Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
2,00,000
10,000

Date
2002
Mar. 31

Particulars

Depreciation
Balance c/d

2,10,000
2002
Apr. 01

Balance b/d

1,89,000

Balance b/d

1,70,100

2004

Balance b/d

1,53,090

Amount
Rs.
21,0001
1,89,000
2,10,000

2003
Mar. 31

Depreciation
Balance c/d

1,89,000
2003
Apr. 01

J.F.

18,9002
1,70,100
1,89,000

2004
Mar. 31

Depreciation
Balance c/d

1,70,100

17,0103
1,53,090
1,70,100

Working Notes
1.

Calculation of the amount of depreciation


Original cost on 01.01.2001
Less: Depreciation for the year 2001
(@10% of 2,10,000)

(Rs.)
2,10,000 (i.e. 2,00,000 + 10,000)

WDV on 31.12.2001/01.01.2002
Less: Depreciation for the year 2002
(@10% of 1,89,000)

1,89,000

WDV on 31.12.2002/01.01.2003
Less: Depreciation for the year 2003
(@10% of 1,70,100)

1,70,100

WDV on 31.12.2003

(21,000)1

(18,900)2

(17,010)3
1,53,090

Illustration 5
M/s Sahani Enterprises acquired a printing machine for Rs. 40,000 on July 01, 2001 and
spent Rs. 5,000 on its transport and installation. Another machine for Rs. 35,000 was
purchased on January 01, 2003. Depreciation is charged at the rate of 20% on written
down value. Prepare Printing Machine account for the years ended on March, 31, 2002,
2003, 2004 and 2005.

250

Accountancy

Solution
Books of Sahani Enterprises
Printing Machine Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date
2001
Jul. 01

Particulars

J.F.

Bank
Bank

Amount
Rs.
40,000
5,000
45,000

2002

Date
2002
Mar. 31

Particulars

Amount
Rs.

Depreciation
Balance c/d

6,7501
38,250
45,000

Depreciation
Balance c/d

9,4002
63,850
73,250

Depreciation
Balance c/d

12,7703
51,080
63,850

2003

Apr. 01
Jan. 01

Balance b/d
Bank

38,250
35,000
73,250

2003
Apr. 01

Balance b/d

63,850

Mar. 31

2004
Mar.31

63,850
2004
Apr. 01

J.F.

Balance b/d

51,080

Working Notes
Orignal cost machine purchased on July 01,2001
() Depreciation till Mar. 31, 2002 (for 9 months @ 20%)
+ Cost of new machine purchased on Jan. 01,2003
() Depreciation for the year 2002-2003
(20% of 38,250 + 20% of Rs. 35,000 for 3 month)
WDV on Mar. 31, 2003
() Depreciation for the year 2003 04 (20% of Rs. 73,850)
WDV on Mar. 31, 2004

(Rs.)
45,000
(6,750)1
38,250
(35,000)
73,250
(9,400)2
63,850
(12,770)3
51,080

Test Your Understanding - IV


Basaria Confectioner bought a cold storage plant on July 01, 2003 for Rs.1,00,000.
Compare the amount of depreciation charged for first three years using:
1. Rate of depreciation @ 10% on original cost basis;
2. Rate of depreciation @ on written down value basis;
3. Also, plot the computed amount of depreciation on a graph.

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves

251

7.9 Disposal of Asset


Disposal of asset can take place either (a) at the end of its useful life or (b)
during its useful life (due to obsolescence or any other abnormal factor).
If it is sold at the end of its useful life, the amount realised on account of the
sale of asset as scrap should be credited to the asset account and the balance
is transferred to profit and loss account. In this regard the following journal
entries are recorded.
1.

2.

For sale of asset as scrap


Bank A/c
To Asset A/c

Dr.

For transfer of balance in asset account


(a) In case of profit
Asset A/c
To Profit and Loss A/c
(b) In case of loss
Profit and Loss A/c
To Asset A/c

Dr.

Dr.

In case, however, the provision for depreciation account has been in use
for recording the depreciation, then before passing the above entries transfer
the balance of the provision for depreciation account to the asset account by
recording the following journal entry:
Provision for depreciation A/c
To Asset A/c

Dr.

For example, R.S. Limited purchased a vehicle for Rs. 4, 00,000. After
4 years its salvage value is estimated at Rs. 40,000. To find out the amount of
depreciation to be charged every year based on straight line basis, and show
as to how the vehicle account would appear for four years assuming it is sold
for Rs. 50,000 at the end when
(a) depreciation is charged to asset account; and
(b) provision for depreciation account is maintained.
Consider the following entries in the book of account of R.S. Limited
(a)

When depreciation is charged to assets account


Books of R.S. Limited
Vehicle Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

I
year

Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
4,00,000
4,00,000

Date

Particulars

End of
the year

Depreciation
Balance c/d

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
90,000
3,10,000
4,00,000

252

Accountancy

II
year

Balance b/d

III
year

Balance b/d

3,10,000

End of
the year

Depreciation
Balance c/d

End of
the year

Depreciation
Balance c/d

90,000
2,20.000

3,10,000

IV
year

2,20,000

3,10,000

2,20,000
1,30,000
10,000

Balance b/d
Profit and
loss (Profit on
sale of vehicle)

90,000
1,30,000
2,20,000
99,000
50,000

Depreciaton
Bank

1,40,000
(b)

1,40,000

When Provision for depreciation account is maintained.


Books of R.S. Limited
Vehicle Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

I
year

Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
4,00,000

Date

Particulars

End of
the year

Balance c/d

J.F.

4,00,000

4,00,000
II
year

Balance b/d

4,00,000

4,00,000
End of
the year

Balance c/d

4,00,000

4,00,000
III
year

Balance b/d

IV
year

Balance b/d
Profit and loss
(Profit on Sale
of Vehicle)

4,00,000

Amount
Rs.

4,00,000
End of
the year

Balance c/d

4,00,000

4,00,000

4,00,000

4,00,000
10,000

Provison for
depreciation
Bank

3,60,000
50,000

4,10,000

4,10,000

Provision for Depreciation


Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

Ist
year

Balance b/d

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
90,000
90,000

Date

Particulars

End of
year

Depreciation

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
90,000
90,000

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves


II
year

Balance b/d

253

1,80,000

End of
the year

Balance c/d
Depreciation

1,80,000
III
year

Balance b/d

2,70,000

IV
year

Machinery

3,60,000

90,000
90,000
1,80,000

End of
the year

Balance c/d
Depreciation

End of
the year

Balance c/d
Provison for
Depreciation

2,70,000

1,80,000
90,000
2,70,000

3,60,000

2,70,000
90,000
3,60,000

7.9.1 Use of Asset Disposal Account


Asset disposal account is designed to provide a complete and clear view of all
the transactions involved in the sale of an asset under one account head. The
concerned variables are the original cost of the asset, depreciation accumulated
on the asset upto date, sale price of the asset, value of the parts of the asset
retained for use, if any and the resultant profit or loss on disposal. The balance
of this amount is transferred to the profit and loss account.
This method is generally used when a part of the asset is sold and
provision for depreciation account exists.
Under this method, a new account titled Asset Disposal Account is opened.
The original cost of the asset being sold is debited to the asset disposal account
and accumulated depreciation amount appearing in provision for depreciation
account relating to that asset till the date of disposal is credited to the asset
disposal account. The net amount realised from the sale of the asset is also
credited to this account. The balance of asset disposal account shows profit
or loss which is transferred to profit and loss account. The advantage of this
method is that it gives a full picture of all the transactions related to asset
disposal at one place. The journal entries required for the preparation of asset
disposal account is as follows:
1.

Asset Disposal A/c


To Asset A/c

Dr. (with the original cost of asset,


being sold)

2.

Provision for Depreciation A/c Dr. (with the accumulated balance in


To Asset Disposal A/c
provision for depreciation account)

3.

Bank A/c
To Asset Disposal A/c

Dr. (with the net sales proceeds)

Asset Disposal Account may ultimately show a debit or credit balance.


The debit balance on the account indicate loss on disposal and would be dealt
with as follows:

254

Accountancy
Profit and Loss A/c
To Asset Disposal A/c

Dr. (with the amount of loss on sale)

The credit balance of the account, profit on disposal and would be closed
by the following journal entry:
Asset Disposal A/c
To Profit and Loss A/c

Dr. (with the amount of profit on sale)

For example, Karan Enterprises has the following balances in its books
as on March 31, 2005
Machinery (gross value):
Provision for depreciation:

Rs. 6,00,000
Rs. 2,50,000

A machine purchased for Rs. 1,00,000 on November 01, 2001, having


accumulated depreciation amounting to Rs. 60,000 was sold on April 1, 2006 for
Rs. 35,000. The Asset Disposal account will be prepared in the following manner:
Books of Karan Enterprises
Machinery Disposal Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2006
Apr. 01

Machinery

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
1,00,000

Date
2006
Apr. 01
Apr. 01
2007
Mar. 31

Particulars

Provision for
depreciation
Bank
Profit & Loss
(Loss on sale)

1,00,000

L.F.

Amount
Rs.
60,000
35,000

5,0001
1,00,000

Machinery Account
Dr.
Date
2005
Mar. 31

Particulars

Balance b/d

Amount
Rs.
6,00,000

Date
2005
Apr. 01

Particulars

Machine
Disposal

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

1,00,000

2006
Mar. 31
6,00,000

6,00,000

Working Notes
(1)

Computation of loss on sale of machinery


Original cost of the asset being sold
Less: accumulated depreciation

Rs.
1,00,000
(60,000)
40,000

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves


(2)

255

Sales value realised


Loss on sale (i.e. Rs. 40,000 Rs. 35,000)

(35,000)
5,0001

Illustration 6
On January 01 2001, Khosla Transport Co. purchased five trucks for Rs. 20,000 each.
Depreciation has been provided at the rate of 10% p.a. using straight line method and
accumulated in provision for depreciation acount. On January 01, 2002, one truck was
sold for Rs. 15,000. On July 01, 2003, another truck (purchased for Rs. 20,000 on Jan
01, 2001) was sold for Rs. 18,000. A new truck costing Rs. 30,000 was purchased on
October 01, 2003. You are required to prepare trucks account, Provision for depreciation
account and Truck disposal account for the years ended on December 2001, 2002 and
2003 assuming that the firm closes its accounts in December every year.
Solution
Book of Khosla Transport Co.
Trucks Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2001
Jan. 01

Bank

1,00,000

(Purchase of
truck)

1,00,000

2002
Jan. 01

J.F

Balance b/d

Amount
Rs.

1,00,000

Date

Particulars

2001
Dec. 31

Balance c/d

J.F

1,00,000
1,00,000

2002
Jan. 01
Dec 31

Truck disposal
Balance c/d

20,000
80,000

1,00,000
2003
Jan. 01
Oct. 01

Balance b/d
Bank
(Purchase of
new truck)

80,000
30,000

Amount
Rs.

1,00,000
2003
Jul. 01
Dec. 31

Truck disposal
Balance c/d

20,000
90,000

1,10,000

1,10,000

Truck Disposal Account


Dr.
Date
2002
Jan. 01

Particulars

Machinery

J.F

Amount
Rs.
20,000

Date
2002
Jan. 01
Jan. 01
Jan. 01

20,000

Particulars

Provision for
Depreciation
Bank (Sale)
Profit & Loss
(Loss on sale)

J.F

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
2,000
15,000
3,0004
20,000

256

Accountancy

2003
Jul. 01
Jul. 01

Machinery
Profit & Loss
(Profit on sale)5

20,000
3,000

2003
Jul. 01

Jul. 01

Provision for
Depreciation
(Rs. 2,000 +
2,000 +1,000)
Bank (Sale)

5,000
18,000

23,000

23,000

Provision for Depreciation Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2001
Dec. 31 Balance c/d

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
10,000

Date

Particulars

2001
Dec. 31

Depreciation

10,000
2002
Jan. 01 Truck Disposal
Dec. 31 Balance c/d

2,000
16,000

5,000
18,750

2002
Jan. 01
Dec. 31

Balance b/d
Depreciation

Balance b/d
Depreciation
(Rs. 6000+
1000+750)

10,000
8,0002

Calculation of amount of depreciation


Year - 2001
10% on Rs. 1,00,000 for one year
Year - 2002
10% on Rs. 80,000 for one year
Year 2003
10% on Rs. 60,000 for 1 year
10% on Rs. 20,000 for six months
10% on Rs. 30,000 for three months
Loss on sale of first truck
Original cost on January 01, 2001
Less depreciation at 10%
Book value on January 1, 2002
Sales price realised on 01.01.2002
Loss on sale of first machine

16,000

7,7503
23,750

Working Notes

2.

10,0001

18,000
2003
Jan. 1
Dec. 31

23,750

1.

Amount
Rs.

10,000

18,000
2003
Jan. 01 Truck Disposal
Dec. 31 Balance c/d

J.F.

Rs.
10,0001
80002
6,000
1,000
7,50
7,7503
20,000
(2,000)
18,000
(15,000)
3,0004

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves


3.

257

Profit on Sale of Second Truck


Original cost on January 01, 2001
Less Depreciation at 10% for year 2001
Depreciation at 10% for 2002
Depreciation @10% for 6 months till July, 2003
Book value on 1.7.2003
Sale price
Profit on sale

20,000
(2,000)
(2,000)
(1,000)
15,000
18,000
3,0005

Illustration 7
On April 01, 2004, following balances appeared in the books of M/s Kanishka Traders:
Furniture account Rs. 50,000, Provision for depreciation on furniture Rs. 22,000. On
October 01, 2004 a part of furniture purchased for Rupees 20,000 on April 01, 2000 was
sold for Rs. 5,000. On the same date a new furniture costing Rs. 25,000 was purchased.
The depreciation was provided @ 10% p.a. on original cost of the asset and no depreciation
was charged on the asset in the year of sale. Prepare furniture account and provision for
depreciation account for the year ending March 31, 2005.
Solution
Books of Kanishka Traders
Furniture Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2004
Apr. 01
Oct. 10

Balance b/d
Bank

J.F.

Amount Date
Rs.
2004
50,000 Oct.01
25,000 Apr. 01

Particulars

J.F

Bank
Provision for
depreciation
Profit and Loss
(Loss on sale)
Balance c/d

Amount
Rs.
5,000
8,000
7,0001

55,000

75,000

75,000

Provision for Depreciation on Furniture Account


Dr.
Date
2004
Oct. 01

2005
Mar. 31

Particulars

Furniture
(Accumulated
depreciation on
furniture sold)
Balance c/d

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Particular

8,000

2004
Apr. 01

Balance b/d

22,000

18,250

2005
Mar. 31

Depreciation
(Rs. 3,000 +
1,250)

4,250
26,250

26,250

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

Date

258

Accountancy

Working Notes
1.

2.

Calculation of amount of depreciation


Calculation of loss on sale
Original cost of furniture on 01.10.2004
Less: Depreciation for 4 year from 01.04.2000 to
31.04.2004 (no depreciation for the year of sale
@10% p.a. on original cost
Value as on 01.10.2004
Sale price
Loss on sale
Depreciation for the year 2004-05
10% of Rs. 30,000 (Rs. 50,000 Rs. 20,000) for full year
10% of Rs. 25,000 for 6 month

Rs.
20,000

8,000
12,000
5,000
7,0001
3,000
1,250
4,250

Illustration 8
Solve illustration 07, if the firm maintains furniture disposal account prepared along
with furniture account and provision for depreciation on furniture account.
Books of Anil Traders
Furniture Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

2004
Apr. 01

Balance b/d

50,000

Oct.01

Bank

25,000

Date
2004
Apr. 01
2005
Mar. 31

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Furniture
disposal

20,000

Balance c/d

55,000
75,000

75,000

Provision for Depreciation on Furniture Account


Dr.
Date
2004
Oct.01
2005
Mar. 31

Cr.
Particulars

Furniture
disposal
Balance c/d

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Date

Particular

8,000

2004
Apr.01

Balance b/d

18,250

2005
Mar.31

Depreciation

26,250

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
22,000

4,250
26,250

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves

259

Furniture Disposal Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2004
Oct.01

Furniture

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
20,000

Date
2004
Oct.01

Particular

J.F.

Provision for
Depreciation
Bank
Profit & Loss
(Loss on sale)

Amount
Rs.

8,000
5,000
7,000
20, 000

20,000
Illustration 9

On Jan 01, 2001 Jain & Sons purchased a second hand plant costing Rs. 2,00,000 and
spent Rs. 10,000 on its overhauling. It also spent Rs. 5,000 on transportation and
installation of the plant. It was decided to provide for depreciation @ of 20% on written
down value. The plant was destroyed by fire on July 31, 2004 and an insurance claim of
Rs. 50,000 was admitted by the insurance company. Prepare plant account, accumulated
depreciation account and plant disposal account assuming that the company closes its
books on December 31, every year.
Solution
Books of Jain & Sons.
Plant Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2001
Jan. 01

Bank

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
2,15,000

Date

Particulars

2001
Dec. 31

Balance c/d

2,15,000
2002
Jan. 01

Balance b/d

2,15,000

Balance b/d

2,15,000

2002
Dec. 31

Balance c/d

Balance b/d

2,15,000
2,15,000

2,15,000

2,15,000
2,15,000

2003
Dec. 31

Balance c/d

2,15,000
2004
Jan. 01

Amount
Rs.

2,15,000

2,15,000
2003
Jan. 01

J.F.

2,15,000
2,15,000

2004
Jul. 31

Plant disposal

2,15,000
2,15,000

260

Accountancy
Accumulated Depreciation Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2001
Dec. 31

Balance c/d

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
43,000

Date

Particulars

2001
Dec. 31

Depreciation

J.F.

43,0001

43,000
2002
Jan. 01

Balance c/d

77,400

43,000
2002
Jan. 01

Balance b/d
Depreciation

43,000
34,4002

77,400
2003
Dec. 31

Balance c/d

1,04,920

77,400
2003
Jan. 01
Dec. 31

Balance b/d
Depreciation

77,400
27,5203
1,04,920

2004
Jan. 01
July 31

Balance b/d
Depreciation

1,04,920
12,8434

1,04,920
2004
Jul. 31

Plant disposal

1,17,763

Amount
Rs.

1,17,763

1,17,763

Plant Disposal Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2004
Jul. 31

Plant

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
2,15,000

Date
2004
Jul. 31

2,15,000

Particulars

Accumulated
depreciation
Insurance Co.
Profit & Loss
(Loss on sale)

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
1,17,763
50,000
47,2375
2,15,000

Working Notes:
1.

Calculation of Depreciation Amount


Original cost on 01.01.2001
(2,00,000 + 10,000+ 5,000)
Depreciation for the year 2001
(@20% of Rs. 2,15,000)

(Rs.)
2,15,000

(43,0001)
1,72,000

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves


Depreciation for the year 2002
(@20% of Rs. 1,72,000)
Depreciation for the year 2003
(@20% of Rs. 1,37,600)
Depreciation till 31.07.04
(@20% of Rs. 1,10,080)
Insurance claim
Loss on disposal

261

(34,4002)
1,37,600
27,5203
1,10,080
(12,8434)
97,237
(50,000)
47,2375

7.10 Effect of any Addition or Extension to the Existing Asset


An existing asset may require some additions or extensions for being suitable
for operations. Such additions/extensions may or may not become an integral
part of the asset. The amount incurred on such additions/extensions is
capitalised and written off as depreciation over the life of the asset. It is
important to mention here that the amount so incurred is in addition to usual
repair and maintenance expenses. AS-6 (Revised) mentions that

Any addition or extension, which becomes an integral part of the existing


asset should be depreciated over the useful life of that asset;

The depreciation on such addition or extension may also be provided


at the rate applied to the existing asset;

Where an addition or extension retains a separate identity and is capable


of being used after the existing asset is disposed off, depreciation, should
be provided independently on the basis of its own useful life.

Illustration 10
M/s Digital Studio bought a machine for Rs. 8,00,000 on April 01, 2000. Depreciation
was provided on straight-line basis at the rate of 20% on original cost. On April 01,2002
a substantial modification was made in the machine to make it more efficient at a cost of
Rs. 80,000. This amount is to be depreciated @ 20% on straight line basis. Routine
maintenance expenses during the year 2003-04 were Rs. 2,000.
Draw up the Machine account, Provision for depreciation account and charge to profit
and loss account in respect of the accounting year ended on March 31,2003.

262

Accountancy

Solution
Books of Digital Studio
Machine Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date
2002
Apr 01

Particulars

J.F.

Balance b/d
Bank

Amount
Rs.
800,000
80,000

Date

Particulars

2003
Mar 31

Balance c/d

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
8,80,000

8,80,000

8,80,000

Provision for Depreciation Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2003
Mar 31

Balance c/d

J.F

Amount
Rs.
4,96,000

4,96,000

Date
2003
April 01
2003
Mar 31

Particulars

J.F

Amount
Rs.

Balance b/d

3,20,0001

Depreciation

1,76,0002
4,96,000

Working Notes
1.
2.

3.

4.

Cost of modification is capitalised but routine repair expenses are treated as


revenue expenditure.
Calculation of balance of provision for depreciation account on 01.04.2002.
Original Cost on 01.04.2000
= Rs. 8,00,000
Depreciation for the years 2000-01 and 2001-02
= Rs 3,20,0001
(@ 20% of Rs. 8,00,000 )
Depreciation for the year 2002-03 is calculated as under:
20% of 8,00,000
= Rs. 1,60,000
20% of Rs. 80,000
= Rs. 16,000
Total Depreciation for 2002-03
= Rs. 1,76,0002
Amount to be charged to profit and loss account
Depreciation
Rs. 1,76,000
Repair and maintenance
Rs. 2,000

Illustration 11
M/s Nishit Printing Press bought a printing machine for Rs. 6,80,000 on April 01, 2001.
Depreciation was provided on straight line basis at the rate of 20% on original cost. On
April 01,2003 a modification was made in the machine to increase its technical reliability,
at a cost of Rs. 70,000. However this modification is not expected to increase the useful
life of the machine. At the same time an important component of the machine was replaced

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves

263

at a cost of Rs. 20,000 due to excessive wear and tear. Routine maintenance expenses
during the year 2003-04 were Rs. 5,000.
Show the Machinery account, Provision for depreciation account and charge to profit and
loss account in respect of the accounting year ended on March 31, 2004.
Solution
Machinery Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2003
Apr.01

J.F.

Balance b/d
Bank
Bank

Amount
Rs.
6,80,000
70,000
20,000

Date

Particulars

2004
Mar. 31

Balance c/d

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
7,70,000

7,70,000

7,70,000

Provision for Depreciation Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2004
Mar.31

Balance c/d

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
4,38,000

Date
2003
Apr.01
2004
Mar.31

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Balance b/d

2,72,0001

Depreciation

1,66,0002

4,38,000

4,38,000

Working Notes
1.

Cost of modification and cost of component replaced are capitalised but routine
repair expenses are revenue expenditure.

2.

Calculation of balance of Provision for depreciation account on 01. 04. 2003.


Original cost on 01.04.2001
= Rs. 6,80,000
Depreciation for the years 2001-02 and 2002-03
2

3.

20

100 6,80,000

Depreciation for the year 2003-04 is calculated as under.


20% of Rs. 6,80,000
1/3 of Rs. 90,000*
Total depreciation for 2003-04

= Rs 2,72,0001

= Rs. 1,36,000
= Rs. 30,000
= Rs. 1,66,0002

264

Accountancy
4.

Amount to be charged to profit and loss account


Rs.

Depreciation
1,66,000
Repair and Maintenance
5,000
Computation of depreciation on addition
=

(Rs. 70,000 + Rs. 20,000) 0


(5 2) years

= Rs.

90,000
3

SECTION II
Provisions and Reserve
7.11 Provisions
There are certain expenses/losses which are related to the current accounting
period but amount of which is not known with certainty because they are not
yet incurred. It is necessary to make provision for such items for ascertaining
true net profit. For example, a trader who sells on credit basis knows that
some of the debtors of the current period would default and would not pay or
would pay only partially. It is necessary to take into account such an expected
loss while calculating true and fair profit/loss according to the principle of
Prudence or Conservatism. Therefore, the trader creates a Provision for Doubtful
Debts to take care of expected loss at the time of realisation from debtors. In
a similar way, Provision for repairs and renewals may also be created to provide
for expected repair and renewal of the fixed assets. Examples of provisions
are :
Provision for depreciation;
Provision for bad and doubtful debts;
Provision for taxation;
Provision for discount on debtors; and
Provision for repairs and renewals.
It must be noted that the amount of provision for expense and loss is a
charge against the revenue of the current period. Creation of provision ensures
proper matching of revenue and expenses and hence the calculation of true
profits. Provisions are created by debiting the profit and loss account. In the
balance sheet, the amount of provision may be shown either:
By way of deduction from the concerned asset on the assets side. For
example, provision for doubtful debts is shown as deduction from the
amount of sundry debtors and provision for depreciation as a deduction
from the concerned fixed assets;

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves

265

On the liabilities side of the balance sheet alongwith current liabilities, for
example provision for taxes and provision for repairs and renewals.

7.11.1 Accounting Treatment for Provisions


The accounting treatment of all types of provisions is almost similar. Therefore,
the accounting treatment is explained here taking up the case of provision for
doubtful debts.
As already stated that when business transaction takes place on credit
basis, debtors account is created and its balance is shown on the asset-side
of the balance sheet. These debtors may be of three types:

Good Debtors are those from where collection of debt is certain.


Bad Debts are those debtors from where collection of money is not
possible and the amount of credit given is a certain loss.
Doubtful Debts are those debtors who may pay but business firm is not
sure about the collection of full amount from them. In fact, as a matter
of business experience, some percentage of such debtors are not likely
to pay, hence treated as doubtful debts. To consider this possible loss
on account of non-payment by some debtors, it is a common practice
(and necessary also) to make a suitable provision for doubtful debts at
the time of ascertaining true profit or loss. The provision for doubtful
debts is usually calculated as a certain percentage of the total amount
due from sundry debtors after deducting/writing-off all known bad
debts. Provision for doubtful debts is also called Provision for bad and
doubtful debts. It is created by debiting the amount of required provision
to the profit and loss account and crediting it to provision for doubtful
debts account.
For creating a provision for doubtful debts the following journal entry
is recorded:
Profit and Loss A/c

Dr.

(with the amount of provision)

To Provision for doubtful debts A/c

This is explained with the help of the following example


Observe an extract of the trial balance from the books of Trehan Traders
on March 31, 2005 is given below:
Date

Account title

Sundry Debtors

L.F.

Debit
Amount
Rs.
68,000

Credit
Amount
Rs.

266

Accountancy

Additional Information
Bad debts proved bad but not recorded amounted to Rs. 8,000
Provision is to be maintained at 10% of debtors.
In order to create the provision for doubtful debts, the following journal
entries will be recorded:
Journal
Date
2005
Mar. 31

Mar. 31

Mar. 31

Particulars

L. F.

Bad debts A/c


To Sundry debtors A/c
(Bad debts written off)

Dr.

Profit & Loss A/c


To Bad debts A/c
(Bad debts debited to profit and
loss account)

Dr.

Amount
Rs.

Amount
Rs.

8,000
8,000

Profit and Loss A/c


Dr.
To Provision for doubtful debts a/c
(For creating provision for doubtful debts)

8,000
8,000

6,0001
6,0001

Working Notes
Provision for doubtful debts @10% of sundry debtors i.e.
(Rs. 68,000 8000) = Rs. 60001

7.12 Reserves
A part of the profit may be set aside and retained in the business to provide
for certain future needs like growth and expansion or to meet future
contingencies such as workmen compensation. Unlike provisions, reserves
are the appropriations of profit to strengthen the financial position of the
business. Reserve is not a charge against profit as it is not meant to cover any
known liability or expected loss in future. However, retention of profits in the
form of reserves reduces the amount of profits available for distribution among
the owners of the business. It is shown under the head Reserves and Surpluses
on the liabilities side of the balance sheet after capital.Examples of reserves
are:
General reserve;
Workmen compensation fund;
Investment fluctuation fund;
Capital reserve;

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves

267

Dividend equalisation reserve;


Reserve for redemption of debenture.

7.12.1 Difference between Reserve and Provision


The points of difference between reserve and provision are explained below:
1. Basic nature : A provision is a charge against profit whereas reserve is an
appropriation of profit. Hence, net profit cannot be calculated unless all
provisions have been debited to profit and loss account, while a reserve is
created after the calculation of net profit.
2. Purpose : Provision is made for a known liability or expense pertaining to
current accounting period, the amount of which is not certain. On the
other hand reserve is created for strengthening the financial position of
the business. Some reserves are also mandatory under the law.
3. Presentation in balance sheet: Provision is shown either (i) by way of
deduction from the item on the asset side for which it is created, or (ii) on
the liabilities side along with current liabilities. On the other hand, reserve
is shown on the liabilities side after capital.
4. Effect on taxable profits : Provision is deducted before calculating taxable
profits. Hence, it reduces taxable profits. A reserve is created from profit
after tax and therefore it has no effect on taxable profit.
5. Element of compulsion : Creation of provision is necessary to ascertain
true and fair profit or loss in compliance with Prudence or Conservatism
concept. It has to be made even if there are no profits. Whereas creation of
a reserve is generally at the discretion of the management. However, in
certain cases law has stipulated for the creation of specific reserves such
as Debenture Redemption Reserve. Reserve cannot be created unless there
are profits.
6. Use for the payment of dividend : Provision cannot be used for distribution
as dividends while general reserve can be used for dividend distribution.
Basis of Difference
1. Basic nature
2. Purpose

3. Effect on taxable
profits.

Provision
Charge against profit.
It is created for a known
liability or expense pertaining
to current accounting period,
the amount of which is not
certain.
It reduces taxable profits.

Reserve
Appropriation of profit.
It is made for strengthening
the financial position of
the business.Some reserves
are also mandatory under law.
It has no effect on taxable
profit.

268

Accountancy

4. Presentations in
Balance sheet

It is shown either (i) by way


It is shown on the liabilities.
of deduction from the item on side after capital amount.
the asset side for which it is
created, or (ii) In the liabilities
side along with current
liabilities.

5. Element of
compulsion

Creation of provision is
necessary to ascertain true
and fair profit or loss in
compliance Prudence or
Conservatism concept.
It must be made even
if there are no profits.

6. Use for the payment It can not be used for


of dividend
dividend distribution.

Generally, creation of a Reserve


is at the discretion of the management. Reserve cannot be
created unless there are profits.
However, in certain cases law
has stipulated for the creation
of specific reserves such as
Debenture Redemption
reserve.
It can be used for divided
distribution.

Fig. 7.4 : Showing comparison between provisions and reserves

7.12.2 Types of Reserves


A reserve is created by retention of profit of the business can be for either a
general or a specific purpose.
1. General reserve : When the purpose for which reserve is created is not
specified, it is called General Reserve . It is also termed as free reserve
because the management can freely utilise it for any purpose. General
reserve strengthens the financial position of the business.
2. Specific reserve : Specific reserve is the reserve, which is created for some
specific purpose and can be utilised only for that purpose. Examples of
specific reserves are given below :
(i) Dividend equalisation reserve: This reserve is created to stabilise or
maintain dividend rate. In the year of high profit, amount is transferred
to Dividend Equalisation reserve. In the year of low profit, this reserve
amount is used to maintain the rate of dividend.
(ii) Workmen compensation fund: It is created to provide for claims of the
workers due to accident, etc.
(iii) Investment fluctuation fund: It is created to make for decline in the
value of investment due to market fluctuations.
(iv) Debenture redemption reserve: It is created to provide funds for
redemption of debentures.
Reserves are also classified as revenue and capital reserves according to
the nature of the profit out of which they are created.

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves

269

(a) Revenue reserves : Revenue reserves are created from revenue profits
which arise out of the normal operating activities of the business and are
otherwise freely available for distribution as dividend. Examples of revenue
reserves are:

General reserve;

Workmen compensation fund;

Investment fluctuation fund;

Dividend equalisation reserve;

Debenture redemption reserve;


(b) Capital reserves: Capital reserves are created out of capital profits which
do not arise from the normal operating activities. Such reserves are not
available for distribution as dividend. These reserves can be used for
writing off capital losses or issue of bonus shares in case of a company.
Examples of capital profits, which are treated as capital reserves, whether
transferred as such or not, are :

Premium on issue of shares or debenture.

Profit on sale of fixed assets.

Profit on redemption of debentures.

Profit on revaluation of fixed asset & liabilities.

Profits prior to incorporation.

Profit on reissue of forfeited shares


7.12.3 Difference between Revenue and Capital Reserve
Revenue reserves and capital reserves are differentiated on the following
grounds:
1. Source of creation : Revenue reserve is created out of revenue profits, which
arise out of the normal operating activities of the business and are
otherwise available for dividend distribution. On the other hand capital
reserve is created primarily out of capital profit, which do not arise from
the normal operating activities of the business and are not available for
distribution as dividend. But revenue profits may also be used for creation
of capital reserves.
2. Purpose : Revenue reserve is created to strengthen the financial position, to
meet unforeseen contingencies or for some specific purposes. Whereas capital
reserve is created for compliance of legal requirements or accounting practices.
3. Usage : A specific revenue reserve can be utilised only for the earmarked
purpose while a general reserve can be utilised for any purpose including
distribution of dividend. Whereas a capital reserve can be utilised for specific
purposes as provided in the law in force, e.g. to write off capital losses or
issue of bonus shares.

270

Accountancy

Basic of Difference

Revenue Reserve

Capital Reserve

1. Source of creation

It is created out of revenue


profits which arise out of
normal operating activities
of the business and are
otherwise available for
dividend distribution.

It is created primarily out of


capital profit which do not arise
out of the nor mal operating
activities of the business and not
available for dividend distribution.
But revenue profits may also be
used for this purpose.

2. Purpose

It is created to strengthen
the financial position, to
meet unforeseen
contingencies or for some
specific purposes.

It is created for compliance of


legal requirements or accounting
practices.

3. Usage

A specific revenue reserve


can be utilised only for the
earmarked purpose while a
general reserve can be
utilised for any purpose
including distribution of
dividend.

It can be utilised for specific


purposes as provided in the law
in force e.g. to write off capital
losses or issue of bonus shares.

Fig. 7.5 : Difference between capital reserve and revenue reserve

7.12.4 Importance of Reserves


A business firm may consider it proper to set up some mechanism to protect
itself from the consequences of unknown expenses and losses, it may be
required to bear in future. It may also regard it as more appropriate in certain
cases to reduce the amount that can be drawn by the proprietors as profit in
order to conserve business resource to meet certain significant demands in
future. An example of such a demand is the much needed expansion in the
scale of business operations. This is presented as the justification for reserves
in business activities and in accounting. The amount so set aside may be
meant for the purpose of :

Meeting a future contingency


Strengthening the general financial position of the business;
Redeeming a long-term liability like debentures, etc.

7.13 Secret Reserve


Secret reserve is a reserve which does not appear in the balance sheet. It may
also help to reduce the disclosed profits and also the tax liability . The secret
reserve can be merged with the profits during the lean periods to show improved

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves

271

profits. Management may resort to creation of secret reserve by charging higher


depreciation than required. It is termed as Secret Reserve, as it is not known
to outside stakeholders. Secret reserve can also be created by way of :
Undervaluation of inventories/stock
Charging capital expenditure to profit and loss account
Making excessive provision for doubtful debts
Showing contingent liabilities as actual liabilities
Creation of secret reserves within reasonable limits is justifiable on grounds
of expediency, prudence and preventing competition from other firms.
Test Your Understanding - V
I State with reasons whether the following statements are True or False ;
(i) Making excessive provision for doubtful debits builds up the secret reserve in
the business.
(ii) Capital reserves are normally created out of free or distributable profits.
(iii) Dividend equalisation reserve is an example of general reserve.
(iv) General reserve can be used only for some specific purposes.
(v) Provision is a charge against profit.
(vi) Reserves are created to meet future expenses or losses the amount of which is
not certain.
(vii) Creation of reserve reduces taxable profits of the business.
II Fill in the correct words :
(i) Depreciation is decline in the value of ...........
(ii) Installation, freight and transport expenses are a part of ...........
(iii) Provision is a ........... against profit.
(iv) Reserve created for maintaining a stable rate of dividend is termed as...........

Key Terms Introduced in the Chapter

Depreciation, Depreciable cost, original cost, useful life;


Depletion, Obsolescence, Amortisation;
Salvage value/Residual value/Scrap value;
Written down value/Reducing balance value/Diminishing value;
Straight Line/Fixed Installment Method;
Asset Disposal Account;
Accumulated Depreciation/Provision for Depreciation Account, Reserve,
Provision, Capital Reserve, Revenue Reserve, General Reserve, Specific
Reserve, Secret Reserve, Provision for Doubtful Debts.
Summary With Reference to Learning Objectives

1.

Meaning of depreciation : Depreciation is decline in the value of a tangible


fixed asset. In accounting, depreciation is the process of allocating depreciable
cost over useful life of a fixed asset.

272

Accountancy
2.

3.

4.

5.

6.

7.

8.

Depreciation and similar terms : Depreciation term is used in the context of


tangible fixed assts. Depletion (in the context of extractive industries), and
amortisation (in the context of intangible assets) are other related terms.
Factors Affecting Depreciation :

Wear and Tear due to use and/or passage of time

Expiration of Legal Rights

Obsolescence
Importance of depreciation :
Depreciation must be charged to ascertain true and fair profit or loss.
Depreciation is a non-cash operating expense.
Methods of charging depreciation : Depreciation amount can be calculated using :
Straight line method, or
Written down value method
Factors affecting the amount of depreciation :
Depreciation amount is determined by
Original cost
Salvage value, and
Useful life of the asset
Provisions and Reserves : A provision is a charge against profit. It is created
for a known current liability the amount of which is uncertain. Reserve on
the other hand, is an appropriation of profit. It is created to strengthen the
financial position of the business.
Types of Reserves : Reserves may be

General reserve and specific reserve;

Revenue reserve and capital reserve.


Secret Reserve : When total depreciation charged is higher than the total
depreciable cost, Secret reserve is created. Secret reserve is not explicitly
shown in the balance sheet.
Questions for Practice

Short Answers
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.

7.
8.
9.
10.

What is Depreciation?
State briefly the need for providing depreciation.
What are the causes of depreciation?
Explain basic factors affecting the amount of depreciation.
Distinguish between straight line method and written down value method
of calculating depreciation.
In case of a long term asset, repair and maintenance expenses are expected
to rise in later years than in earlier year. Which method is suitable for
charging depreciation if the management does not want to increase burden
on profits and loss account on account of depreciation and repair.
What are the effects of depreciation on profit and loss account and balance
sheet?
Distinguish between provision and reserve .
Give four examples each of provision and reserves.
Distinguish between revenue reserve and capital reserve.

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves


11. Give four examples each of revenue reserve and capital reserves.
12. Distinguish between general reserve and specific reserve.
13. Explain the concept of secret reserve.
Long Answers
1. Explain the concept of depreciation. What is the need for charging
depreciation and what are the causes of depreciation?
2. Discuss in detail the straight line method and written down value method
of depreciation. Distinguish between the two and also give situations where
they are useful.
3. Describe in detail two methods of recording depreciation. Also give the
necessary journal entries.
4. Explain determinants of the amount of depreciation.
5. Name and explain different types of reserves in details.
6. What are provisions. How are they created? Give accounting treatment in
case of provision for doubtful Debts.
Numerical Problems
1.

On April 01, 2000, Bajrang Marbles purchased a Machine for Rs. 2,80,000
and spent Rs. 10,000 on its carriage and Rs. 10,000 on its installation. It is
estimated that its working life is 10 years and after 10 years its scrap value
will be Rs. 20,000.
(a) Prepare Machine account and Depreciation account for the first four
years by providing depreciation on straight line method. Accounts are
closed on March 31st every year.
(b) Prepare Machine account, Depreciation account and Provision for
depreciation account (or accumulated depreciation account) for the first
four years by providing depreciation using straight line method accounts
are closed on March 31 every year.
(Ans:[a]
Balance of Machine account on April 1, 2004 Rs.1,28,000.
[b]
Balance of Provision for depreciation account as on 1.04.2004
Rs.72,000.)

2.

On July 01, 2000, Ashok Ltd. Purchased a Machine for Rs. 1,08,000 and
spent Rs. 12,000 on its installation. At the time of purchase it was estimated
that the effective commercial life of the machine will be 12 years and after 12
years its salvage value will be Rs. 12,000.
Prepare machine account and depreciation Account in the books of Ashok
Ltd. For first three years, if depreciation is written off according to straight
line method. The account are closed on December 31st, every year.
(Ans: Balance of Machine account as on 1.01.2003 Rs.97,500).

3.

Reliance Ltd. Purchased a second hand machine for Rs. 56,000 on October
01, 2001 and spent Rs. 28,000 on its overhaul and installation before putting
it to operation. It is expected that the machine can be sold for Rs. 6,000 at
the end of its useful life of 15 years. Moreover an estimated cost of Rs. 1,000
is expected to be incurred to recover the salvage value of Rs. 6,000. Prepare
machine account and Provision for depreciation account for the first three

273

274

Accountancy
years charging depreciation by fixed installment Method. Accounts are closed
on December 31, every year.
(Ans: Balance of provision for depreciation account as on 1.01.04 Rs.18,200).
4.

Berlia Ltd. Purchased a second hand machine for Rs. 56,000 on July 01,
2001 and spent Rs. 24,000 on its repair and installation and Rs. 5,000 for
its carriage. On September 01, 2002, it purchased another machine for
Rs. 2,50,000 and spent Rs. 10,000 on its installation.
(a) Depreciation is provided on machinery @10% p.a on original cost method
annually on December 31. Prepare machinery account and depreciation
account from the year 2001 to 2004.
(b) Prepare machinery account and depreciation account from the year
2001 to 2004, if depreciation is provided on machinery @10% p.a. on
written down value method annually on December 31.
(Ans:[a]
Balance of Machine account as on 1.01.05 Rs.2,54,583.
[b]
Balance of Machine account as on 1.01.05 Rs.2,62,448).

5.

Ganga Ltd. purchased a machinery on January 01, 2001 for Rs. 5,50,000
and spent Rs. 50,000 on its installation. On September 01, 2001 it purchased
another machine for Rs. 3,70,000. On May 01, 2002 it purchased another
machine for Rs. 8,40,000 (including installation expenses).
Depreciation was provided on machinery @10% p.a. on original cost method
annually on December 31. Prepare:
(a) Machinery account and depreciation account for the years 2001, 2002,
2003 and 2004.
(b) If depreciation is accumulated in provision for Depreciation account
then prepare machine account and provision for depreciation account
for the years 2001, 2002, 2003 and 2004.
(Ans:[a] Balance of machine account as on 01.01.05 Rs. 12,22,666.
[b] Balance of provision for dep. account as on 01.01.05 Rs. 5,87,334).
Azad Ltd. purchased furniture on October 01, 2002 for Rs. 4,50,000. On
March 01, 2003 it purchased another furniture for Rs. 3,00,000. On July
01, 2004 it sold off the first furniture purchased in 2002 for Rs. 2,25,000.
Depreciation is provided at 15% p.a. on written down value method each
year. Accounts are closed each year on March 31. Prepare furniture account,
and accumulated depreciation account for the years ended on March 31,2003,
March 31,2004 and March 31,2005. Also give the above two accounts if
furniture disposal account is opened.
(Ans.Loss on sale of furniture Rs.1,14,915,
Balance of provision for depreciation account as on 31.03.05 Rs. 85,959.)

6.

7.

M/s Lokesh Fabrics purchased a Textile Machine on April 01, 2001 for
Rs. 1,00,000. On July 01, 2002 another machine costing Rs. 2,50,000 was
purchased . The machine purchased on April 01, 2001 was sold for Rs.
25,000 on October 01, 2005. The company charges depreciation @15% p.a.
on straight line method. Prepare machinery account and machinery disposal
account for the year ended March 31, 2006.
(Ans. Loss on sale of Machine account Rs.7,500.
Balance of machine account as on 1.04.05 Rs.1,09,375).

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves


8.

The following balances appear in the books of Crystal Ltd, on Jan 01, 2005
Rs.
Machinery account on
15,00,000
Provision for depreciation account
5,50,000
On April 01, 2005 a machinery which was purchased on January 01, 2002
for Rs. 2,00,000 was sold for Rs. 75,000. A new machine was purchased on
July 01, 2005 for Rs. 6,00,000. Depreciation is provided on machinery at
20% p.a. on Straight line method and books are closed on December 31
every year. Prepare the machinery account and provision for depreciation
account for the year ending December 31, 2005.
(Ans. Profit on sale of Machine Rs. 5,000.
Balance of machine account as on 31.03.05 Rs. 19,00,000.
Balance of Provision for depreciation account as on 31.03.05 Rs. 4,80,000).

9.

M/s. Excel Computers has a debit balance of Rs. 50,000 (original cost
Rs. 1,20,000) in computers account on April 01, 2000. On July 01, 2000 it
purchased another computer costing Rs. 2,50,000. One more computer was
purchased on January 01, 2001 for Rs. 30,000. On April 01, 2004 the
computer which has purchased on July 01, 2000 became obselete and was
sold
for
Rs. 20,000. A new version of the IBM computer was purchased on August
01, 2004 for Rs. 80,000. Show Computers account in the books of Excel
Computers for the years ended on March 31, 2001, 2002, 2003 ,2004 and
2005. The computer is depreciated @10 p.a. on straight line method basis.
(Ans: Loss on sale of computer Rs. 1,36,250.
Balance of computers account as on 31.03.05 Rs. 80,583).

10. Carriage Transport Company purchased 5 trucks at the cost of Rs. 2,00,000
each on April 01, 2001. The company writes off depreciation @ 20% p.a. on
original cost and closes its books on December 31, every year. On October 01,
2003, one of the trucks is involved in an accident and is completely destroyed.
Insurance company has agreed to pay Rs. 70,000 in full settlement of the
claim. On the same date the company purchased a second hand truck for Rs.
1,00,000 and spent Rs. 20,000 on its overhauling. Prepare truck account and
provision for depreciation account for the three years ended on December 31,
2003. Also give truck account if truck disposal account is prepared.
(Ans: Loss of settlement of Truck Insurance Rs.30,000.
Balance of Provision for depreciation A/c as on 31.12.03 Rs.4,46,000.
Balance of Trucks account as on 31.12.03 Rs.9,20,000).
11. Saraswati Ltd. purchased a machinery costing Rs. 10,00,000 on January 01,
2001. A new machinery was purchased on 01 May, 2002 for Rs. 15,00,000 and
another on July 01, 2004 for Rs. 12,00,000. A part of the machinery which
originally cost Rs. 2,00,000 in 2001 was sold for Rs. 75,000 on October 31,
2004. Show the machinery account, provision for depreciation account and
machinery disposal account from 2001 to 2005 if depreciation is provided at
10% p.a. on original cost and account are closed on December 31, every year.
(Ans: Loss on sale of Machine Rs.58,333.
Balance of Provision for dep. A/c as on 31.12.05 Rs. 11,30,000.
Balance of Machine A/c as on 31.12.05 Rs.35,00,000).

275

276

Accountancy
12. On July 01, 2001 Ashwani purchased a machine for Rs. 2,00,000 on credit.
Installation expenses Rs. 25,000 are paid by cheque. The estimated life is 5
years and its scrap value after 5 years will be Rs. 20,000. Depreciation is to
be charged on straight line basis. Show the journal entry for the year 2001
and prepare necessary ledger accounts for first three years.
(Ans: Balance of Machine A/c as on 31.12.03 Rs.1,22,500).
13. On October 01, 2000, a Truck was purchased for Rs. 8,00,000 by Laxmi
Transport Ltd. Depreciation was provided at 15% p.a. on the diminishing
balance basis on this truck. On December 31, 2003 this Truck was sold for
Rs. 5,00,000. Accounts are closed on 31st March every year. Prepare a
Truck Account for the four years.
(Ans: Profit on Sale of Truck Rs.55,548).
14. Kapil Ltd. purchased a machinery on July 01, 2001 for Rs. 3,50,000. It
purchased two additional machines, on April 01, 2002 costing Rs. 1,50,000
and on October 01, 2002 costing Rs. 1,00,000. Depreciation is provided
@10% p.a. on straight line basis. On January 01, 2003, first machinery
become useless due to technical changes. This machinery was sold for Rs.
1,00,000. prepare machinery account for 4 years on the basis of calendar
year.
(Ans: Loss on sale of machine Rs. 1,97,500.
Balance of Machine account as on 1.01.05 Rs. 1,86,250).
15. On January 01, 2001, Satkar Transport Ltd, purchased 3 buses for
Rs. 10,00,000 each. On July 01, 2003, one bus was involved in an accident
and was completely destroyed and Rs. 7,00,000 were received from the
Insurance Company in full settlement. Depreciation is writen off @15% p.a.
on diminishing balance method. Prepare bus account from 2001 to 2004.
Books are closed on December 31 every year.
(Ans: Profit on insurance claim Rs. 31,687.
Balance of Bus account as on 1.01.05 Rs. 10,44,013).
16. On October 01, 2001 Juneja Transport Company purchased 2 Trucks for
Rs. 10,00,000 each. On July 01, 2003, One Truck was involved in an accident
and was completely destroyed and Rs. 6,00,000 were received from the
insurance company in full settlement. On December 31, 2003 another truck
was involved in an accident and destroyed partially, which was not insured.
It was sold off for Rs. 1,50,000. On January 31, 2004 company purchased a
fresh truck for Rs. 12,00,000. Depreciation is to be provided at 10% p.a. on
the written down value every year. The books are closed every year on March
31. Give the truck account from 2001 to 2004.
(Ans: Loss on Ist Truck Insurance claim Rs. 1,41,000.
Loss on IInd Truck Rs. 5,53,000.
Balance of Truck account as on 31.03.04 Rs. 11,80,000).
17. A Noida based Construction Company owns 5 cranes and the value of this
asset in its books on April 01, 2001 is Rs. 40,00,000. On October 01, 2001
it sold one of its cranes whose value was Rs. 5,00,000 on April 01, 2001 at
a 10% profit. On the same day it purchased 2 cranes for Rs. 4,50,000 each.

Depreciation, Provisions and Reserves

277

Prepare cranes account. It closes the books on December 31 and provides


for depreciation on 10% written down value.
(Ans: Profit on sale of crane Rs. 47,500.
Balance of Cranes account as on 31.12.01 Rs. 41,15000).
18. Shri Krishan Manufacturing Company purchased 10 machines for Rs. 75,000
each on July 01, 2000. On October 01, 2002, one of the machines got
destroyed by fire and an insurance claim of Rs. 45,000 was admitted by the
company. On the same date another machine is purchased by the company
for Rs. 1,25,000.
The company writes off 15% p.a. depreciation on written down value basis.
The company maintains the calendar year as its financial year. Prepare the
machinery account from 2000 to 2003.
(Ans: Loss on settle of insurance claim Rs. 7,735.
Balance of Machine account as on 31.12.03 Rs. 6,30,393).
19. On January 01, 2000, a Limited Company purchased machinery for
Rs. 20,00,000. Depreciation is provided @15% p.a. on diminishing balance
method. On March 01, 2002, one fourth of machinery was damaged by fire
and Rs. 40,000 were received from the insurance company in full settlement.
On September 01, 2002 another machinery was purchased by the company
for Rs. 15,00,000.
Write up the machinery account from 2002 to 2003. Books are closed on
December 31, every year.
(Ans: Loss on settle of insurance claim Rs. 12,219.
Balance of Machine account as on 01.01.04 Rs 19,94,260).
20. A Plant was purchased on 1st July, 2000 at a cost of Rs. 3,00,000 and
Rs. 50,000 were spent on its installation. The depreciation is written off at
15% p.a. on the straight line method. The plant was sold for Rs. 1,50,000 on
October 01, 2002 and on the same date a new Plant was installed at the cost
of Rs. 4,00,000 including purchasing value. The accounts are closed on
December 31 every year.
Show the machinery account and provision for depreciation account for 3 years.
(Ans: Loss on sale of Plant Rs. 81,875.
Balance of Machine account as on 01.01.03 Rs. 15,000.
Balance of Provision for Depreciation account as on 01.01.03 Rs. 15,000.).
21. An extract of Trial balance from the books of Tahiliani and Sons Enterprises
on December 31 2005 is given below:
Name of the Account
Debit Amount
Credit Amount
Rs.
Rs.
Sundry debtors.
Bad debts
Provision for doubtful debts

50,000
6,000
4,000

Additional Information:

Bad Debts proved bad but not recorded amounted to Rs. 2,000.

Provision is to be maintained at 8% of Debtors.

278

Accountancy
Give necessary accounting entries for writing off the bad debts and creating
the provision for doubtful debts account. Also show the necessary accounts.
(Ans: New provision for Bad debts Rs. 3,840, profit and loss account [Dr.]
Rs. 7,840.)
22. The following information are extract from the Trial Balance of M/s Nisha
traders on 31 December 2005.
Sundry Debtors
80,500
Bad debts
1,000
Provision for bad debts
5,000
Additional Information
Bad Debts
Rs. 500
Provision is to be maintained at 2% of Debtors.
Prepare bad debts accound, Provision for bad debts account and profit and
loss account.
(Ans: New provision Rs. 1,600 Profit and loss account [Cr.] Rs. 1,900).
Checklist to Test Your Understanding
Test Your Understanding - I
1. Fixed assets, exhaustion of natural resources, specific contracted business.
2. Amortisation
Test Your Understanding - II
1. T, 2. F,

3. F.

4. T,

5. T

6. F,

7. T, (viii) F,

8. F,

9. F,

Test Your Understanding - III


Written down value method is more appropriate because this method is suitable
for those assets which are affected by technological changes. Moreover, this method
is recognised by income tax hand.
Test Your Understanding - V
1.

(i)
(v)

2.

(i)
(iii)

T,
T,

(ii)
(vi)

F,
F,

(iii)
(vii)

F,
F,

(iv)

Assets
Charge

(ii)
(iv)

Acquisition cost
Dividend equilisation fund.

F,

Bill of Exchange

G
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
After studying this chapter,
you will be able to :
state the meaning of
bill of exchange and a
promissory note;
distinguish between a
bill of exchange and a
promissory note;
state the advantages
of bill of exchange;
explain the meaning of
different terms involved in
the bill transaction,
record bill of exchange
transactions in journal;
record transactions
relating to dishonour,
retirement and renewal
of bill;
describe the uses of
bill receivable and bill
payable book;
state the meaning and
use of accommodation
bill.

oods can be sold or bought for cash or on


credit. When goods are sold or bought for
cash, payment is received immediately. On the
other hand, when goods are sold/bought on credit
the payment is deferred to a future date. In such a
situation, normally the firm relies on the party to
make payment on the due date. But in some cases,
to avoid any possibility of delay or default, an
instrument of credit is used through which the
buyer assures the seller that the payment shall be
made according to the agreed conditions. In India,
instruments of credit have been in use since time
immemorial and are popularly known as Hundies.
The hundies are written in Indian languages and
have a large variety (refer box1).
Box 1
Hundies and its Types
There are a variety of hundies used in our country.
Let us discuss some of the most common ones.
Shahjog Hundi: This is drawn by one merchant on
another, asking the latter to pay the amount to a
Shah. Shah is a respectable and responsible person,
a man of worth and known in the bazaar. A shah-jog
hundi passes from one hand to another till it reaches
a shah, who, after reasonable enquiries, presents it
to the drawee for acceptance of the payment.
Darshani Hundi: This is hundi payable at sight. It
must be presented for payment within a reasonable
time after its receipt by the holder. It is similar to a
demand bill.

Dev Prakash Sharma/VIII Proof/22/02/2006

280

Accountancy

Muddati Hundi: A muddati or miadi hundi is payable after a specified period of time.
This is similar to a time bill.
There are few other varieties of hundies like Nam-jog hundi, Dhani-jog hundi, Jawabee
hundi, Hokhami hundi, Firman-jog hundi, and so on.

Now a days these instruments of credit are called bills of exchange or


promissory notes. The bill of exchange contains an unconditional order to pay
a certain amount on an agreed date while the promissory note contains an
unconditional promise to pay a certain sum of money on a certain date. In
India these instruments are governed by the Indian Negotiable Instruments
Act 1881.
8.1 Meaning of Bill of Exchange
According to the Negotiable Instruments Act 1881, a bill of exchange is defined
as an instrument in writing containing an unconditional order, signed by the
maker, directing a certain person to pay a certain sum of money only to, or to
the order of a certain person or to the bearer of the instrument. The following
features of a bill of exchange emerge out of this definition.
A bill of exchange must be in writing.
It is an order to make payment.
The order to make payment is unconditional.
The maker of the bill of exchange must sign it.
The payment to be made must be certain.
The date on which payment is made must also be certain.
The bill of exchange must be payable to a certain person.
The amount mentioned in the bill of exchange is payable either on
demand or on the expiry of a fixed period of time.
It must be stamped as per the requirement of law.
A bill of exchange is generally drawn by the creditor upon his debtor. It has to
be accepted by the drawee (debtor) or someone on his behalf. It is just a draft
till its acceptance is made.
For example, Amit sold goods to Rohit on credit for Rs. 10,000 for three months.
To ensure payment on due date Amit draws a bill of exchange upon Rohit for
Rs. 10,000 payable after three months. Before it is accepted by Rohit it will be
called a draft. It will become a bill of exchange only when Rohit writes the word
accepted on it and append his signature thereto communicate his acceptance.

Bill of Exchange

281

8.1.1 Parties to a Bill of Exchange


There are three parties to a bill of exchange:
(1) Drawer is the maker of the bill of exchange. A seller/creditor who is entitled
to receive money from the debtor can draw a bill of exchange upon the
buyer/debtor. The drawer after writing the bill of exchange has to sign it
as maker of the bill of exchange.
(2) Drawee is the person upon whom the bill of exchange is drawn. Drawee is
the purchaser or debtor of the goods upon whom the bill of exchange is
drawn.
(3) Payee is the person to whom the payment is to be made. The drawer of
the bill himself will be the payee if he keeps the bill with him till the date
of its payment. The payee may change in the following situations:
(a) In case the drawer has got the bill discounted, the person who has
discounted the bill will become the payee;
(b) In case the bill is endorsed in favour of a creditor of the drawer, the
creditor will become the payee.
Normally, the drawer and the payee is the same person. Similarly, the drawee
and the acceptor is normally the person. For example, Mamta sold goods worth
Rs.10,000 to Jyoti and drew a bill of exchange upon her for the same amount payable
after three months. Here, Mamta is the drawer of the bill and Jyoti is the drawee. If
the bill is retained by Mamta for three months and the amount of
Rs. 10,000 is received by her on the due date then Mamta will be the payee. If Mamta
gives away this bill to her creditor Ruchi, then Ruchi will be the payee. If Mamta gets
this bill discounted from the bank then the bankers will become the payee.
In the above mentioned bill of exchange, Mamta is the drawer and Jyoti is
the drawee. Since Jyoti has accepted the bill, she is the acceptor. Suppose in
place of Jyoti the bill is accepted by Ashok then Ashok will become the acceptor.
Mamta
New Delhi
Rs.10,000
April 01, 2006
Three months after date pay to me or my order, the sum of Rupees Ten Thousand
only, for value received.
Stamp
Accepted
(signed)
Jyoti
1.4.2006
73-B, Mahipalpur
New Delhi 110 037

(Signed)
Mamta
196, Karol Bagh
New Delhi
To
Jyoti
73-B, Mahipalpur
New Delhi 110 037

Figure 8.1 : Showing specimen of bills of exchange

282

Accountancy
Test Your Understanding - I
Write Ture or False against each statement regarding a bill of exchange:
(i)

A bill of exchange must be accepted by the payee.

(ii)

A bill of exchange is drawn by the creditor.

(iii) A bill of exchange is drawn for all cash transaction.


(iv)

A bill payable on demand is called Time bill;

(v)

The person to whom payment is to be made in a bill or exchange is called


payee.

(vi)

A negotiable instrument does not require the signature of its maker.

(vii) The hundi Payable at sight is called Darshani hundi.


(viii) A negotiable instrument is not freely transferable.
(ix)

Stamping of promissory note is not mandatory.

(x)

The time of payment of a negotiable instrument need not be certain.

8.2 Promissory Note


According to the Negotiable Instruments Act 1881, a promissory note is defined
as an instrument in writing (not being a bank note or a currency note),
containing an unconditional undertaking signed by the maker, to pay a certain
sum of money only to or to the order of a certain person, or to the bearer of the
instrument. However, according to the Reserve Bank of India Act, a promissory
note payable to bearer is illegal. Therefore, a promissory note cannot be made
payable to the bearer.
This definition suggests that when a person gives a promise in writing to
pay a certain sum of money unconditionally to a certain person or according
to his order the document is called is a promissory note.
Following features of a promissory note emerge out of the above definition:
It must be in writing
It must contain an unconditional promise to pay.
The sum payable must be certain.
It must be signed by the maker.
The maker must sign it.
It must be payable to a certain person.
It should be properly stamped.
A promissory note does not require any acceptance because the maker of the
promissory note himself promises to make the payment.

Bill of Exchange

283

Ashok Kumar
Rs. 30,000

New Delhi
01 April, 2006

Three months after date I promise to pay Sh. Harish Chander or order
a sum of Rupees Thirty Thousand only for value received.
Stamp
To
Harish Chander
24, Ansari Road
Darya Ganj
New Delhi 110 002

Ashok Kumar
2, Dariba Kalan
Candani Chowk
Delhi 110 006

Fig. 8.2 : Showing specimen of promissory note

8.2.1 Parties to a Promissory Note


There are two parties to a promissory note.

Maker or Drawer is the person who makes or draws the promissory


note to pay a certain amount as specified in the promissory note. He is
also called the promisor.

Drawee or Payee is the person in whose favour the promissory note is


drawn. He is called the promisee.
Generally, the drawee is also the payee, unless, it is otherwise mentioned in
the promissory note. In the specimen of promissory note(refer figure 8.2),
Ashok Kumar is the drawer or maker who promises to pay Rs.30,000 and
Harish Chander is the drawee or payee to whom payment is to made. If Harish
Chander endorses this promissory note in favour of Rohit then Rohit will
become the payee. Similarly, if Harish Chander gets this promissory note
discounted from the bank then the bank will become the payee.
Box 2
Distinction between a Bill of Exchange and Promissory Note
Both a bill of exchange and a promissory note are instruments of credit and are similar
in many ways. However, there are certain basic differences between the two.
S. No

Basis

Bill of Exchange

Drawer

It is drawn by the creditor

Order or Promise It contains an order to make


and Parties
payment. There can be three
parties to it, viz. the drawer,
the drawee and the payee.

Promissory Note
It is drawn by the debtor
It contains a promise to make
payment. There are only two
parties to it, viz. the drawer
and the payee.

284

Accountancy

Acceptance

It requires acceptance by the


drawee or someone else on his
behalf.

It does not require any


acceptance.

4.

Payee

Drawer and payee can be the


same party.

Drawer cannot be the payee


of it.

5.

Notice

In case of its dishonour due


No notice needs to be givenin
notice of dishonour is to be
case of its dishonour.
given by the holder to the drawer

Fig. 8.3 Distinction between bills of exchange and promissory note

8.3 Advantages of Bill of Exchange


The bills of exchange as instruments of credit are used frequently in business
because of the following advantages:

Framework for relationships: A bill of exchange represents a device, which


provides a framework for enabling the credit transaction between the seller/
creditor and buyer/debtor on an agreed basis.

Certainty of terms and conditions: The creditor knows the time when he
would receive the money so also debtor is fully aware of the date by which
he has to pay the money. This is due to the fact that terms and conditions
of the relationships between debtor and creditor such as amount required
to be paid; date of payment; interest to be paid, if any, place of payment
are clearly mentioned in the bill of exchange.

Convenient means of credit: A bill of exchange enables the buyer to buy the
goods on credit and pay after the period of credit. However, the seller of goods
even after extension of credit can get payment immediately either by
discounting the bill with the bank or by endorsing it in favour of a third party.

Conclusive proof: The bill of exchange is a legal evidence of a credit


transaction implying thereby that during the course of trade buyer has
obtained credit from the seller of the goods, therefore, he is liable to pay to
the seller. In the event of refusal of making the payment, the law requires
the creditor to obtain a certificate from the Notary to make it a conclusive
evidence of the happening.
Easy transferability: A debt can be settled by transferring a bill of
exchange through endorsement and delivery.

Bill of Exchange

285
Test Your Understanding - II

Fill in the blanks with suitable word(s)


(i) The person to whom the amount mentioned in the promissory note is
payable is known as _____________.
(ii) Transfer of a negotiable instrument to another person by signing on it, is
known as _____________.
(iii) In a promissory note, the person who makes the promise to pay is called
as ____________.
(iv) A person who endorses the promissory note in favour of another is known
as____________.

8.4 Maturity of Bill


The term maturity refers the date on which a bill of exchange or a promissory
note becomes due for payment. In arriving at the maturity date three days,
known as days of grace, must be added to the date on which the period of
credit expires instrument is payable. Thus, if a bill dated March 05 is payable
30 days after date it, falls due on April 07, i.e. 33 days after March 05 If it
were payable one month after date, the due date would be April 08, i.e. one
month and 3 days after March 05. However, where the date of maturity is a
public holiday, the instrument will become due on the preceding business
day. In this case if April 08, falls on a public holiday then the April 07 will be
the maturity date. But when an emergent holiday is declared under the
Negotiable Instruments Act 1881, by the Government of India which may
happen to be the date of maturity of a bill of exchange, then the date of
maturity will be the next working day immediately after the holiday. For
example, the Government declared a holiday on April 08 which happened to
be the day on which a bill of exchange drawn by Gupta upon Verma for
Rs.20,000 became due for payment, Since April 08, has been declared a
holiday under the Negotiable Instruments Act, therefore, April 08, will be the
date of maturity for this bill.
8.5 Discounting of Bill
If the holder of the bill needs funds, he can approach the bank for encashment
of the bill before the due date. The bank shall makes the payment of the bill
after deducting some interest (called discount in this case). This process of
encashing the bill with the bank is called discounting the bill. The bank gets
the amount from the drawee on the due date.

286

Accountancy

8.6 Endorsement of Bill


Any holder may transfer a bill unless its transfer is restricted, i.e. the bill has
been negotiated containing words prohibiting its transfer. The bill can be
initially endorsed by the drawer by putting his signatures at the back of the
bill along with the name of the party to whom it is being transferred. The act
of signing and transferring the bill is called endorsement.
8.7 Accounting Treatment
For the person who draws the bill of exchange and gets it back after its due
acceptance, it is a bill receivable. For the person who accepts the bill, same,
it is a bills payable. In case of a promissory note for the maker it is a bills
payable and for the person in whose favour the promissory note is drawn it is
a bills receivable. Bills receivables are assets and Bills payable are liabilities.
Bills and Notes are used interchangeably.
8.7.1 In the Books of Drawer/Promissor
A bill receivable can be treated in the following four ways by its receiver.
1. He can retain it till the date of maturity, and
(a) get it collected on date of maturity directly, or
(b) get it collected through the banker.
2.

He can get the bill discounted from the bank.

3.

He can endorse the bill in favour of his Creditor.

The accounting treatment in the books of receiver under all the four
alternatives is given below under the assumption that the bill is duly honoured
on maturity by the acceptor.
(1) When the bill of exchange is retained by the receiver with him till date of
its maturity:
On receiving the bill
Bills Receivable A/c
To Debtors A/c

Dr.

On maturity of the bill


Cash/Bank A/c
To Bills Receivable A/c

Dr.

However, when the bill of exchange is retained by the receiver with him
and sent to bank for collection a few days before maturity, the following
two entries are recorded:
On sending the bill for collection
Bills Sent for Collection A/c
To Bills Receivable A/c

Dr.

Bill of Exchange

287

On receiving the advice from the bank that the bill has been collected
Bank A/c
Dr.
To Bills Sent for Collection A/c

(2) When the receiver gets the bill discounted from the bank:
On receiving the bill
Bills Receivable A/c
To Debtors A/c
On discounting the bill
Bank A/c
Discount A/c

Dr.

Dr.
Dr.

To Bills Receivable A/c

On Maturity
No entry is recorded because the bill becomes the property of the bank,
therefore, the bank collects the amount of the bill from the acceptor and
no journal entry is recorded in the books of the drawer.
(3) When the bill is endorsed by the receiver in favour of his creditor:
On receiving the bill
Bills Receivable A/c
To Debtors A/c

Dr.

On endorsing the bill


Creditors A/c
To Bills Receivable A/c

Dr.

On Maturity
No entry is recorded because the bill has been transferred in favour of the
creditor, therefore the creditor becomes its owner and will receive the
payment on maturity. Hence, no entry is recorded in the books of drawer
or endorser.
8.7.2 In the Books of Acceptor/Promissor
The following journal entries are recorded in the books of the acceptor or
promisesor under all the four alternatives. It makes no difference whether the
bill is retained discounted, endorsed or pledged.
On accepting the bill
Creditors A/c
To Bills Payable A/c

Dr.

On Maturity of the bill


Bills Payable A/c
To Bank A/c

Dr.

288

Accountancy
Box 3

1. When the drawer retains the bill with him till the date of its maturity and
gets the same collected directly
Transaction
Books of Creditor/Drawer Books of Debtor/
Acceptor
Sale/Purchase of goods
Debtors A/c
Dr.
Purchases A/c Dr.
To Sales A/c
To Creditors A/c
Receiving/Accepting the bill

Bills Receivable A/c Dr.


To Debtors A/c

Creditors A/c Dr.


To Bills Payable A/c

Collection of the bill

Cash/Bank A/c
Dr.
Bills Payable A/c Dr.
To Bills Receivable A/c
To Cash/Bank A/c

2. When the bill is retained by the drawer with him and sent to bank for collection
a few days before maturity
Transaction

Books of Creditor/Drawer

Books of Debtor/
Acceptor

Sale/Purchase of goods

Debtors A/c
To Sales A/c

Purchases A/c Dr.


To Creditors A/c

Receiving /Accepting the bill

Bills Receivable A/c Dr.


To Debtors A/c

Creditors A/c Dr.


To Bills Payable A/c

Sending the bill for collection

Bills sent for


collection A/c
Dr.
To Bill Receivable A/c

No entry

On Receiving from the bank


advice that the bill has been
collected

Dr.

Bank A/c
Dr.
To Bill Sent for
Collection A/c

Bills Payable A/c Dr.


To Bank A/c

3. When the drawer gets the bill discounted from the bank
Transaction

Books of Creditor/Drawer

Books of Debtor/
Acceptor

Sale/Purchase of goods

Debtors A/c
To Sales A/c

Purchases A/c
Dr.
To Creditors A/c

Receiving /Accepting the bill

Bills Receivable A/c Dr.


To Debtors A/c

Discounting the bill

Bank A/c
Dr.
No entry
Discount A/c
Dr.
To Bills Receivable A/c

On maturity of the bill

No entry

Dr.

Creditors A/c
Dr.
To Bills payable A/c

Bills payable A/c Dr.


To Bank A/c

Bill of Exchange

289

4. When the bill is endorsed by the drawer in favour of his creditor


Transaction

Books of Creditor/Drawer

Books of Debtor/
Acceptor

Sale/Purchase of goods

Debtors A/c
To Sales A/c

Purchase A/c
Dr.
To Creditors A/c

Receiving /Accepting the bill

Bills Receivable A/c Dr.


To Debtors A/c

Endorsing the bill

Creditors A/c
Dr.
No entry
To Bills Receivable A/c

On maturity of the bill

No entry

Dr.

Creditors A/c
Dr.
To Bills payable A/c

Bills payable A/c Dr.


To Bank A/c

The journal entries to be recoded in the books of the drawer and the acceptor
under all the four cases have been summarised below.
Illustration 1
Amit sold goods for Rs.20,000 to Sumit on credit on Jan 01, 2006. Amit drew a bill of
exchange upon Sumit for the same amount for three months. Sumit accepted the bill and
returned it to Amit. Sumit met his acceptance on maturity. Record the necessary journal
entries under the following circumstances:
(i)

Amit retained the bill till the date of its maturity and collected directly

(ii)

Amit discounted the bill @ 12% p.a from his bank

(iii) Amit endorsed the bill to his creditor Ankit


(iv)

Amit retained the bill and on March, 31 2006 Amit sent the bill for collection to
its bank. On April 05, 2006 bank advice was received.

Solution
Books of Amit
Journal
(i)

When the bill was retained till its maturity.


Date

Particulars

2006
Jan 01 Sumits A/c
To Sales A/c
(Sold goods to Sumits on credit)
Jan 01 Bills Receivable A/c
To Sumits A/c
(Received Sumits acceptance payable
after three months)

L.F.

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

20,000
20,000

Dr.

20,000
20,000

290

Accountancy

Apr.05 Bank A/c


To Bills Receivable A/c
(Sumit met his acceptance on maturity)
(ii)

Dr.

20,000
20,000

When the bill was discounted from the book.


Journal
Date

Particulars

2006
Jan 01 Sumits A/c
To Sales A/c
(Sold goods to Sumits)

L.F.

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

20,000
20,000

Jan 01 Bills Receivable A/c


Dr.
To Sumits A/c
(Received Sumits acceptance three months)

20,000

Jan 01 Bank A/c


Dr.
Discount A/c
Dr.
To Bills Receivable A/c
(Sumits acceptance discounted with the bank)

19,400
600

20,000

20,000

(iii) When Amit endorsed the bill in favour of his creditor Ankit.
Journal
Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 01 Sumits A/c
To Sales A/c
(Sold goods to Sumits on credit)
Jan. 01 Bills Receivable A/c
To Sumits A/c
(Received Sumits acceptance for
three months)
Jan. 01

L.F.

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

20,000
20,000

Dr.

Ankits A/c
Dr.
To Bills Receivable A/c
(Sumit acceptance endorsed in favour of Ankit)

20,000
20,000

20,000
20,000

Bill of Exchange
(iv)

291

When the bill was sent for collection by Amit to the bank.
Journal
Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 01 Sumits A/c
To Sales A/c
(Sold goods to Sumits on credit)

L.F.

Dr.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

20,000
20,000

Jan. 02 Bills Receivable A/c


To Sumits A/c
(Received Sumits acceptance payable
after three months)

Dr.

Mar. 31 Bills Sent for Collection A/c


To Bills Receivable A/c
(Bills sent for collection)

Dr.

Apr. 05

Debit
Amount
Rs.

20,000
20,000

20,000
20,000

Bank A/c
Dr.
To Bills sent for collection A/c
(Bills sent for collection collected by the bank)

20,000
20,000

The following journal entries will be made in the books of Sumit under all the four
circumstances:
In the books of Sumit
Journal
Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 01 Purchases A/c
To Amits A/c
(Purchases goods from Amit on credit)

L.F.

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

20,000
20,000

Jan. 01 Amits A/c


Dr.
To Bills Payable A/c
(Accepted bill drawn by Amit payable after
three months)

20,000

Apr. 04

20,000

Bills payable A/c


To Bank A/c
(Met acceptance maturity)

Credit
Amount
Rs.

Dr.

20,000

20,000

292

Accountancy

Illustration 2
On March 15, 2006 Ramesh sold goods for Rs. 8,000 to Deepak on credit. Deepak accepted
a bill of exchange drawn upon him by Ramesh payable after three months. On April, 15
Ramesh endorsed the bill in favour of his creditor Poonam in full settlement of her debt of
Rs. 8,250. On May 15, Poonam discounted the bill with her bank @ 12% p.a. On the due
date Deepak met the bill. Record the necessary journal entries in the books of Ramesh,
Deepak, Poonam.
Books of Ramesh
Journal
Date

2006
Mar.15

Mar.15

Apr.15

Particulars

Deepak A/c
To Sales A/c
(Sold goods to Deepak on credit)

L.F.

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

8,000
8,000

Bills Receivable A/c


Dr.
To Deepak A/c
(Received Deepaks acceptance for three months)

8,000

Poonams A/c
To Bills Receivable A/c
To Discount Received A/c
(Bill endorsed in favour of Poonam in full
settlement of her debt of Rs. 8,250)

8,250

8,000

Dr.

8,000
250

Book of Deepak
Journal
Date

2006
Mar.05

Mar.05

Jun.18

Particulars

L.F.

Purchases A/c
To Ramesh A/c
(Sold goods to Deepak on credit)

Dr.

Rameshs A/c
To Bills Payable A/c
(Accepted Rameshs draft payable
after three months)

Dr.

Bills Payable A/c


To Bank A/c
(Met the acceptance in favour of Ramesh
on maturity)

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

8,000
8,000
8,000
8,000

8,000
8,000

Bill of Exchange

293
Books of Poonam
Journal

Date

2006
Mar.15

Mar.15

Particulars

L.F.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Bills Receivable A/c


Dr.
Discount Allowed A/c
Dr.
To Rameshs A/c
(Ramesh endorsed Deepaks acceptance in
our favour for discharge his dept of
Rs. 8,250 in full settlement)

8,000
250

Bank A/c
Discount Allowed A/c
To Bills Receivable A/c
(Biils receivable encashed on maturity)

7,920
80

Dr.
Dr.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

8,250

8,000

8.8 Dishonour of a Bill


A bill is said to have been dishonoured when the drawee fails to make the
payment on the date of maturity. In this situation, liability of the acceptor is
restored. Therefore, the entries made on the receipt of the bill should be
reversed. For example, Anju received bill of exchange duly accepted by Manju,
which was dishonoured. The entries of dishonour will be as follows in the
books of Anju (receiver):
When the bill was kept by Anju with her till maturity
Manjus A/c
Dr.
To Bill Receivables A/c
When the bill had been endorsed by Anju in favour of Sandhya
Manjus A/c
Dr.
To Sandhayas A/c
When the bill was discounted by Anju with his bank
Manjus A/c
Dr.
To Bank A/c
When the bill was sent for collection by Anju
Manjus A/c
Dr.
To Bill Sent for Collection A/c
Illustration 3
On Jan 01,2006 Shieba sold goods to Vishal for Rs. 10,000 and drew upon him a bill of
exchange for 2 months. Vishal accepted the bill and returned it to Shieba. On the date of
maturity the bill was dishonoured by Vishal. Record the necessary entries in all the cases
listed below in the books of Shieba and Vishal:

294

Accountancy
(i) When the bill kept by Shieba till its maturity;
(ii) When the bill is discounted by Shieba for Rs. 200;
(iii) When the bill is endorsed to Lal Chand by Shieba.

Solution
(i)

When the bill was kept by Shieba till its maturity.


Books of Shieba
Journal
Date

2006
Jan.01

(ii)

Particulars

L.F.

Vishals A/c
To Sales A/c
(Sold goods to Vishal)

Dr.

Jan. 01 Bills Receivable A/c


To Vishals A/c
(Received Vishals acceptance)

Dr.

Mar. 04 Vishals A/c


To Bills Receivable A/c
(Vishal dishonoured his acceptance)

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

10,000
10,000
10,000
10,000
10,000
10,000

When the bill was discounted by shieba


Journal
Date

2006
Jan.01

Particulars

L.F.

Vishals A/c
To Sales A/c
(Sold goods to Vishal)

Dr.

Jan. 01 Bills Receivable A/c


To Vishals A/c
(Received Vishals acceptance)

Dr.

Vishals A/c
To Bank A/c
(Discounted bill dishonoured by Vishal)

Credit
Amount
Rs.

10,000
10,000
10,000
10,000

Jan. 01 Bank A/c


Dr.
Discount A/c
Dr.
To Bills Receivable A/c
(Vishals Bill dishonoured his acceptance)
Mar.04

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Dr.

9,800
200
10,000
10,000
10,000

Bill of Exchange
(iii)

295

When the bill was endorsed by Shieba to Lal Chand


Journal
Date

2006
Jan.01

Particulars

L.F.

Vishals A/c
To Sales A/c
(Sold goods to Vishal)

Dr.

Jan. 01 Bills Receivable A/c


To Vishals A/c
(Received Vishals acceptance)

Dr.

Jan. 01 Lal Chand A/c


To Bills Receivable A/c
(Vishals acceptance endorsed
in favour of Lal Chand)

Dr.

Mar.04

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

10,000
10,000

Vishals A/c
To Lal Chand A/c
(Endorsed bill dishonoured by Vishal)

10,000
10,000
10,000
10,000

10,000
10,000

Whereas, in the book of Vishal, the following entries will be recorded


Books of Vishal
Journal
Date

2006
Jan.01

Particulars

Purchases A/c
To Shiebas A/c
(Purchased good from shieba)

Jan. 01 Shiebas A/c


To Bills Payable A/c
(Accepted Shiebas draft)

L.F.

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

10,000
10,000

Dr.

Jan. 04 Bills Payable A/c


Dr.
To Shiebas A/c
(Acceptance in favour of shieba dishonoured)

10,000
10,000
10,000
10,000

8.8.1 Noting Charges


A bill of exchange should be duly presented for payment on the date of its
maturity. The drawee is absolved of his liability if the bill is not duly presented.

296

Accountancy

Proper presentation of the bill means that it should be presented on the date
of maturity to the acceptor during business working hours. To establish beyond
doubt that the bill was dishonoured, despite its due presentation, it may
preferably to be got noted by Notary Public. Noting authenticates the fact of
dishonour. For providing this service, a fees is charged by the Notary Public
which is called Noting Charges.
The following facts are generally noted by the Notary:

Date, fact and reasons of dishonour;

If the bill is not expressly dishonoured, the reasons why he treats it


as dishonoured and;

The amount of noting charges.


The entries recorded for noting charges in the drawers book are as follows:
When Drawer himself pays
Drawees A/c
To Cash A/c

Dr.

Where endorsee pays


Drawees A/c
To Endorsee A/c

Dr.

When the bank pays on discounted bill


Drawees A/c
To Bank A/c

Dr.

When the bank pays in the event of sending the bill for collection to the bank
Drawees A/c
Dr.
To Bank A/c

It may be noticed that whosoever pays the noting charges, ultimately these
have to be borne by the drawee. That is why the drawee is invariably debited
in the drawers books. This is because he is responsible for the dishonour of
the bill and, hence, he has to bear these expenses. For recording the noting
charges in his book the drawee opens Noting Charges Acccount. He debits
the Noting Charges Account and credits the Drawers Account. For example,
Azad sold goods for Rs. 15,000 to Bunty and immediately drew a bill upon
him on Jan. 01, 2006 payable after 3 months. On maturity the bill was
dishonoured and Rs. 50 were paid by the holder of the bill as noting charges.
The journal entries will be recorded in the books of Azad and Bunty as given
below under the following circumstances:
(a) When the bill was kept by Azad till maturity.
(b) When the bill was discounted by Azad with his bank immediately
@ 12% p.a.
(c)

When the bill was endorsed by Azad in favour of his creditor Chitra.

In the books of Azad, entries will be recorded as:

Bill of Exchange
(i)

297

When the bill was retained till its maturity


Books of Azad
Journal
Date

2006
Jan.01

(ii)

Particulars

L.F.

Buntys A/c
To Sales A/c
(Sold goods to Bunty)

Dr.

Jan. 01 Bills Receivable A/c


To Buntys A/c
(Received Buntys acceptance)

Dr.

Apr. 04

Dr.
Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

15,000
15,000

Buntys A/c
To Bills Receivable A/c
To Cash A/c
(Bunty dishonoured his acceptance and
paid Rs. 50 as noting charges)

15,000
15,000
15,050
15,000
50

When the bill was discounted with the bank.


Journal
Date

2006
Jan.01

Particulars

Buntys A/c
To Sales A/c
(Sold goods to Bunty)

L.F.

Dr.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

15,000
15,000

Jan. 01 Bills Receivable A/c


To Buntys A/c
(Received Buntys acceptance payable
after three months)

Dr.

Jan. 01 Bank A/c


Discount A/c
To Bills Receivable A/c
(Buntys acceptance discounted)

Dr.
Dr.

Apr. 04

Debit
Amount
Rs.

15,000
15,000

Buntys A/c
Dr.
To Bank A/c
(Bunty dishonoured his acceptance on maturity
and bank paid noting charges)

14,550
450
15,000
15,050
15,050

298
(iii)

Accountancy
When the bill was endorsed to Chitra
Journal

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 01 Buntys A/c
To Sales A/c
(Sold goods to Bunty)
Jan.01

L.F.

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

15,000
15,000

Bills Receivable A/c


To Buntys A/c
(Received Buntys acceptance)

Dr.

Jan. 01 Chitras A/c


To Bills Receivable A/c
(Buntys acceptance endorsed in favour
of Chitra)

Dr.

Apr. 04

Dr.

Buntys A/c
To Chitras A/c
(Bunty dishonoured his acceptance on
maturity and chitra paid Rs. 50 as
noting charges)

15,000
15,000
15,000
15,000

15,050
15,050

The following journal entries will be made in the books of Bunty in all the three cases.
Book of Bunty
Journal
Date

Particulars

2006
Jan.01

Purchases A/c
To Azads A/c
(Purchase goods from Azad)
Jan. 01 Azads A/c
To Bills Payable A/c
(Accepted Azads draft)
Apr. 04

L.F.

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

15,000
15,000

Dr.

Bills Payable A/c


Dr.
Noting charges A/c
Dr.
To Azads A/c
(Acceptance in favour of Azed dishonoured)

15,000
15,000
15,000
50
15,050

8.9 Renewal of the Bill


Sometimes, the acceptor of the bill foresees that it may be difficult to meet the
obligation of the bill on maturity and may, therefore, approach the drawer
with the request for extension of time for payment. If it is so, the old bill is

Bill of Exchange

299

cancelled and the fresh bill with new terms of payment is drawn and duly
accepted and delivered. This is called renewal of the bill. Since the cancellation
of bill is mutually agreed upon noting of the bill is not required.
The dreawee may have to pay interest to the drawer for the extended
period of credit. The interest is paid in cash or may be included in the amount
of the new bill. Sometimes, a part of the amount due may be paid and the new
bill may be drawn only for the balance. For example, a bill of Rs. 10,000 is
cancelled on a cash payment of Rs. 3,000 and acceptance of a new bill for the
balance of Rs. 7,000 plus interest as agreed between the parties. The journal
entries in the books of the drawer and the drawee will be the same as that of
dishonour of bill. As for the interest invalued, if it is not paid in cash, the
drawer debits the drawees account and credits the interest account, and the
drawee debits the interest and credits the drawers account in his books.
The journal entries recorded in case of renewal for the cancellation of the
old bill, for interest and for the acceptance of the new bill in the books of the
drawer and drawee are given below:
Transaction

Books of Drawer

Books of Drawee

Cancellation of old bill

Drawees A/c
Dr.
To Bills Receivable A/c

Bills Payable A/c Dr.


To Drawers A/c

Interest

Drawees A/c
To Interest A/c

Dr.

Interest A/c
Dr.
To Drawers A/c

New bill

Bill Receivable A/c


To Drawees A/c

Dr.

Drawers A/c
Dr.
To Bills Payable A/c

For example on February 01, 2006 Ravi sold goods to Mohan for Rs.18,000;
Rs. 3,000 were paid by Mohan immediately and for the balance he accepted
three months bill drawn upon him by Ravi. On the date of maturity of the bill
Mohan requested Ravi to cancel the old bill and a new bill upon him for a
period of 2 months. He further agreed to pay interest in cash to Ravi @ 12%
p.a. Ravi agreed to Mohans request and cancelled the old bill and drew a new
bill. The new bill was met on maturity by Mohan. In this case, the following
entries will be recorded in the books of Ravi and Mohan.
Books of Ravi
Journal
Date

Particulars

2006
Feb. 01 Mohans A/c
To Sales A/c
(Sold goods to Mohan)

L.F.

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

18,000
18,000

300

Accountancy

Feb. 01 Cash A/c


Dr.
Bills Receivable A/c
Dr.
To Mohans A/c
(Received Rs. 3,000 in cash from Ravi and
an acceptance for the balance)

3,000
15,000

May 01 Mohans Account


To Bills Receivable A/c
To Interest A/c
(Cancelled old bill on renewal
Rs. 300 as interest)

Dr.

15,300

May 04 Bills Receivable A/c


Cash A/c
To Mohans A/c
(Received new acceptance from Mohan)

Dr.
Dr.

Jul. 07

Dr.

Bank A/c
To Bills Receivable A/c
(Mohan met his new acceptance)

18,000

15,000
300

15,000
300
15,300
15,000
15,000

Book of Mohan
Journal
Date

Particulars

2006
Feb. 01 Purchases A/c
To Ravi A/c
(Purchased goods from Ravi)
Feb.01

L.F.

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.
18,000

18,000

Ravis A/c
Dr.
To Cashs A/c
Bills Payable A/c
(Received cash from Ravi and his acceptance)

18,000

May 04 Bill Payable A/c


Dr.
Interest A/c
Dr.
To Ravi A/c
(Old bill cancelled on renewal,
Rs. 300 charged as interest)
May 04 Ravis A/c
Dr.
To Bills Payable A/c
To Cash A/c
(Accepted new bill and paid cash for interest)

15,000
300

Jul. 07

15,000

Bill Payable A/c


Dr.
Bank A/c
(Met acceptance of the new bill on maturity)

Credit
Amount
Rs.

3,000
15,000

15,300

15,300
15,000
300

15,000

Bill of Exchange

301

8.10 Retiring of the Bill


There are instances when a bill of exchange is arranged to be retired before
the due date by mutual understanding between the drawer and the drawee.
This happens when the drawee of the bill has funds at his disposal and makes
a request to the drawer or holder to accept the payment of the bill before its
maturity. If the holder agrees to do so, the bill is said to have been retired.
The retiring of a bill draws a curtain on the bill transactions before the
expiry of its normal term. To encourage the retirement of the bill, the holder
allows some discount called Rebate on bills for the period between date of
retirement and maturity. The rebate is calculated at a certain rate of interest.
The accounting treatment on the retirement of a bill is similar to the
accounting treatment when a bill is honoured by the acceptor on the due date
in the ordinary course. The only difference between the two relates to the
granting of rebate. The following journal entries are recorded:
In the books of the holder
On retiring the acceptance and rebate allowed
Cash A/c
Dr.
Rebate on bills A/c
Dr.
To Bills Receivables A/c
In the books of the drawee
Bills Payable A/c
Cash A/c
To Rebate on Bills A/c

Dr.
Dr.

Amit sold goods Rs. 10,000 to Babli on Jan. 01, 2006 and immediately drew
a bill on Babli for three month for the same amount, Babli accepted the bill
and returned it to Amit. On March 04, 2006 Babli retired her acceptance
under rebate of 6% per annum.
In the books of Amit
Journal
Date

Particulars

L.F.

2006
Jan. 01 Bablis A/c
Dr.
To Sales A/c
(Sold goods to Babli)
Jan. 01 Bills Receivable A/c
Dr.
To Bablis A/c
(Received Bablis acceptance for three months)
Mar. 04 Bank A/c
Rebate on bills A/c
To Bills Receivable A/c
(Babli retired her acceptance and rebate
allowed to him)

Dr.
Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

10,000
10,000
10,000
10,000
9,950
50
10,000

302

Accountancy

The recorded entries will be posted to the following ledger acounts


Bablis Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 01

Sales

J. F.

Amount
Rs.
10,000
10,000

Date
2006
Jan 06

Particulars

J.F.

Bills Receivable

Amount
Rs.
10,000
10,000

Bill Receivable Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 01

Sales

J. F.

Amount
Rs.
10,000

Date
2006
Mar 04

Particulars

J.F.

Cash
Rebate on bill

Amount
Rs.
9,950
50
10,000

10,000
Book of Babli
Journal
Date

Particulars

L.F.

2006
Jan. 01 Purchases A/c
To Amit A/c
(Purchased goods from Amit)
Jan.01

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

10,000
10,000

Amits A/c
To Bills Payable A/c
(Accepted Amits draft payable after
three months)

Mar. 04 Bill Payable A/c


To Cash A/c
To Rebate on bills A/c
(Acceptance in favour of Amit retired
and rebate received)

Dr.

10,000
10,000

Dr.

10,000
9,950
50

Amits Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 01

Bills Payable

J. F.

Amount
Rs.
10,000
10,000

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 04

Purchases

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
10,000
10,000

Bill of Exchange

303
Bills Payable Account

Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars

J. F.

Amount
Rs.

2006
Jan. 01 Cash
Rebate on bills

9950
50

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 01

Amit

J.F.

10,000

Amount
Rs.
10,000
10,000

8.11 Bills Receivable and Bills Payable Books


When large number of bills are drawn and accepted, their recording by means
of journal entry for every transaction relating to the bills become a very
cumbersome and time consuming exercise. It is then advisable to record them
separately in special subsidiary books, the bills receivables in the Bills
Receivable Book and the bills payable in the Bills Payable Book. The reason
for the use of subsidiary books for recording bill transactions is the same as
that in the case of other subsidiary books for cash, purchases, etc. An important
point in connection with bill receivables and bills payable books is that they
only record the transactions relating to drawing and acceptance of bills, all
other transactions do not record the entire range of transactions relating to
the bills, e.g. relating to bills discounted, endorsement, retirement, renewal
etc.; simply have a passing reference in these books and the entries relating
thereto are recorded as usual in the journal. It may be noted that the entry
relating to honouring of bills appear in cash book.
8.11.1 Bills Receivable Book
It has been designed as a summary of information regarding a duly accepted
bill received by a drawer. All the details of the bill-date, acceptors name,
amount, term, place of payment, etc. are entered in the bills receivable book
for presentation and further reference.
The performa of a bills receivable book is given in Figure 8.3:
BillsReceivable Book
No. Date
Date
of Received of
Bill
Bill

From
Whom
received

Drawer

Acceptor

Where Term Due


payable
Date

Ledger Amount Cash


Folio
Book
Folio

Fig. 8.3: Showing Format of Bills Receivable Book

Remarks

304

Accountancy

The bills receivable book, like any other subsidiary book, is totaled periodically.
This total is debited to the Bills Receivable Account whereas the account of
every individual debtor whom the bills received is credited in the ledger. The
Bills Receivable Account is the account of an asset and would always have a
debit balance. This balance on any date would represent the amount of bills
receivable unmatured and on hand.
8.11.2 Bills Payable Book
It is maintained like a bills receivable book. It is meant to record all the details,
relating to the bills accepted by a person or a party, which are retained for
being use in the future, in case of need.
The proforma of a bills payable book is given in Fig.8.4
Bills Payable Book
No. Date To
Drawer
of
of
Whom
Bill Bill given

Payee

Where Term
payable

Due Ledger Amount Date Cash Remarks


date Folio
paid
Book
Folio

Fig. 8.4: Showing specimen Bills Payable Book

The posting from this books are made to the debit of the account of every
creditor to whom acceptance has been given and the periodical total of the
books is credited to the Bills Payable Account in the ledger. The bills payable
account representing the liability of the acceptor in respect of bills accepted
by him, always has a credit balance, if any. The credit balance of this account
on any particular date must be the same as the total amount worth of bills
payable yet to be presented for payment as ascertained from the bills payable
book. For example, consider the following transactions and observe how these
are recorded in bill receivable and bills payable book along with postings in
the ledger accounts.
2006
(i)
Jan. 07
Received from S. Mitra bill duly accepted for Rs. 1,32,500 dated
January 04, payable three months after date.
(ii) Jan. 09
Accepted S. Wardens draft for Rs. 9,70,000 at two months.
(iii) Jan. 13
Pradhan drew on his trader at three months date and the same was accepted for
Rs. 39,000.

Jan.17

Jan.23

Jan.20

04 Jan.22

05 Jan.23

06 Jan.27

Jan.13

Jan.18

Jan.31

02

03

04

2006

Jan.09

01

S.Mitra

A.Robert

S.Parker

Pradhan
-

3 month

Term
payable

3 month

Madras

1 month

2 month

3 month

2 month

Term

Total

Mar.03

Mar.21

Apr.16

Mar.31

2006

Due
Date

97,000

21,000

42,000

39,000

Date
Paid

Rs.

Ledger
Folio

Amount

Total

Mar.23

Feb.26

Apr.20

Mar.24

Feb.17

Apr.17

2006

Due
Date

Rs. 1,99,500

Ledger

2 month

Bangalore1 month

Bombay

Calcutta 2 month

Amritsar 1 month

Bombay

Where

Bills Payable Book

P.Parson

K.Kanga

A.vakil

G.Ghosh

R.Rakesh

S.Mitra

Acceptor

Payee Where
payable

M.Meyers

Self

D.Dhiman

Do

S.Warden -

Drawer

C.Shah

D.Kanga

D.Dhiman

G.Ghosh

Do

Self

From Whom Drawer


of Bill
Whom
received

R.Rakesh

A.Roberts

S.Parkar

Pradhan

S.Warden

To Whom
given

Jan.21

03 Jan.21

Date
of Bill

Jan.14

02 Jan.15

No.
of
Bill

2006

Jan.04

01 Jan.07

Date
Received

No. Date
of
Bill
2006

Bills Receivable Book

Cash Remarks
Book
Folio

2,73,500

35,000

30,000

20,000

31,000

25,500

1,32,500

Amount Cash Re-marks


Rs. Book
Folio

Bill of Exchange
305

306

Accountancy

(iv)

Jan. 14
Drew on R. Rakesh at one month for Rs.25,000 and he accepted the next day.
(v) Jan. 18
Gave acceptance at two months for Rs.42,000 to S. Parkar.
(vi) Jan. 21
Received from G.Ghosh his acceptance for Rs.31,000 at two months.
(vii) Jan. 22
Received from D.Dhiman, A.Vakils acceptance for Rs.20,000 at three months from
Jan. 17.
(viii) Jan. 23
K. Kanga accepted my draft at one month for Rs.30,000.
(ix) Jan. 27
Received from C.Shah bill for Rs. 35,000 dated January 20, accepted by
P. Parson and drawn by M.Meyers., payable two months after date.
(x) Jan. 31
Gave acceptance for Rs. 21,500 at one month to A. Roberts.

Posting of recorded entries are as follow:


S. Mitras Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 01

Sales

J. F.

Amount
Rs.
1,32,500

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 07

Bills Receovable

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
1,32,500

1,32,500

1,32,500

R. Rakeshs Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 14

Sales

J. F.

Amount
Rs.
25,000

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 15

Bill Receivable

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
25,000

25,000

25,000

G. Ghoshs Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 21

Sales

J. F.

Amount
Rs.
31,000
31,000

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 21

Bills Receivable

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
31,000
31,000

Bill of Exchange

307
D. Dhimans Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 17

Sales

J. F.

Amount
Rs.
20,000

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 22

Bills Receivable

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
20,000

20,000

20,000

K. Kangas Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 23

Sales

J. F.

Amount
Rs.
30,000
30,000

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 23

Bills Receivable

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
30,000
30,000

C. Shahs Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 20

Sales

J. F.

Amount
Rs.
35,000

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 27

Bill Receivable

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
35,000

35,000

35,000

Bill Receivables Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 31

Sundries

J. F.

Amount
Rs.
2,73,500

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 31

Balance c/f

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
2,73,500

2,73,500

2,73,500

S. Wardens Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 09

Bills payable

J. F.

Amount
Rs.
97,000
97,000

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 09

Purchases

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
97,000
97,000

308

Accountancy
Pradhans Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 13

Bills payable

J. F.

Amount
Rs.
39,000
39,000

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 13

Purchases

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
39,000
39,000

S. Parkars Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 18

Bills payable

J. F.

Amount
Rs.
42,000
42,000

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 18

Purchases

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
42,000
42,000

A. Roberts Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 31

Bills payable

J. F.

Amount
Rs.
21,500
21,500

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 31

Purchases

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
21,500
21,500

Bill Payables Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 01

Balance c/d

J. F.

Amount
Rs.
1,99,500
1,99,500

Date
2006
Jan. 04

Particulars

Sundries
Receivable

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

1,99,500
1,99,5000

Note: The drawing and acceptance of a bill always pre-supposes some background of sale
or purchase transaction. Therefore, in posting bill transactions from the two books to the
accounts of debtors and creditors, it is supposed that the necessary sales and purchases
entries have been duly recorded.
Illustration 4
On Jan. 15, 2006 Sachin sold goods Rs.30,000 to Narain and drew upon the later a bill
for the same amount payable after 3 months. The bill was accepted by Narain. The bill
was discounted by Sachin from his bank for Rs.29,250 on Jan. 31, 2006. on maturity the
bill was dishonoured. He further agreed to pay Rs.10,500 in cash including Rs. 500 interest
and accept a new bill for two months for the remaining Rs.20,000. the new bill was

Bill of Exchange

309

creditor Kapil for settling a debt of Rs. 20,800. The new bill was endorsed by sachin in
favour of his creditor Kapil for settling a debt of Rs. 20,800. The new bill was duly met by
Narain on maturity.
Record the necessary journal entries in the books of Sachin and Narain.
Solution
Books of Sachin
Journal
Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 15 Narain A/c
To Sales A/c
(Sold goods to Narain)
Jan.15

L.F.

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.
30,000

30,000

Bills Receivable A/c


To Narains A/c
(Received Buntys acceptance)

Dr.

30,000
30,000

Jan. 31 Bank A/c


Dr.
Discount A/c
To Bill receivable A/c
(Narains acceptance discounted with bank)

29,250
750

Apr. 19

30,500

Apr.19

Apr.19

Credit
Amount
Rs.

Narains A/c
To Bank A/c
To Interest A/c
(Narains acceptance cancelled)

Dr.

Bank A/c
Bills Receivavble A/c
To Narain A/c
(Received cash from Narain and a new
acceptance for the balace)

Dr.
Dr.

30,000

30,000
500
10,500
20,000
30,500

Kapil A/c
Dr.
To Bill Receivable A/c
To Discount Receivable A/c
(Narains acceptance endorsed in favour of
kapil and he allowed discount)

20,800
20,000
800

Books of Narain
Journal
Date

Particulars

2006
Jan. 15 Purchases A/c
To Sachin A/c
(Purchased goods from sachin)

L.F.

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

30,000
30,000

310
Jan.15

Jan.19

Apr. 19

Apr.22

Accountancy
Sachin A/c
To Bills Payable A/c
(Accepted Sachins draft)

Dr.

30,000
30,000

Bill Payable A/c


Dr.
Interest A/c
To Sachin A/c
(Cancelled old bill & Sachin charged interest)

30,000
500

Sachins A/c
To Bank A/c
To Bill Payable A/c
(Paid Sachin and accepted a new draft
for the balance)

Dr.

30,500

Bills Receivavble A/c


To Bank A/c
(Met new acceptance on Maturity)

Dr.

30,500

10,500
20,000

20,000
20,000

Illustration 5.
Ashok sold goods Rs.14,000 to Bishan on October 30, 2005 and drew three bills for
Rs.2,000, Rs.4,000 & Rs.8,000 payable after two, three, and four months respectively.
The first bill was kept by Ashok with him till maturity. He endorsed the second bill in
favour of his creditor Chetan. The third bill was discounted on December 03, 2005 at 12%
p.a. The first and second bills were duly met on maturity but the third bill was dishonoured
and the bank paid Rs.50 as noting charges. On March 03, 2006 Bishan paid Rs.4,000
and noting charges in cash and accepted a new bill at two months after date for the
balance plus interest Rs.100. The new bill was met on maturity by Bishan.
You are required to give the journal entries in the books of both Ashok ans Bishan and
prepare Bishans account in Ashoks books and Ashoks account in Bishans books.
Solution
Books of Ashok
Journal
Date

2005
Oct. 30

Oct. 30

Particulars

Bishans A/c
Dr.
To Sales A/c
(sold goods to Bishan on credit)
Bills Receivable A/c
Dr.
To Bishans A/c
(Received three acceptances from Bishan.
First for Rs. 2,000 payable after two months,
second for Rs. 4,000 payable after three months
and the third for Rs. 8,000 payable after
four months)

L.F.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

14,000
14,000
14,000
14,000

Bill of Exchange
Oct. 30

Apr. 03

2006
Apr.02

311

Chetans A/c
To Bills receivable A/c
(Endorsed second bills in favour of
creditor Chetan)

Dr.

Bank A/c
Discount A/c
To Bill receivable A/c
(Third bill discounted at 12% p.a.)

Dr.

4,000
4,000

7,760
240
8,000

Bank A/c
Dr.
Bills receivable A/c
(Bishan met his first acceptance on due date)

2,000

Mar. 03 Bishan A/c


Dr.
To Bank A/c
(Bishan dishonoured his third acceptance
and bank paid Rs.50 as noting charges)

8,050

Mar. 03 Cash A/c


To Bishans A/c
(Cash received from Bishan)

Dr.

4,050

Mar. 03 Bishans A/c


To Interest A/c
(Interest charged from Bishan for the
extended period)

Dr.

2,000

8,050

4,050
100
100

Mar. 03 Bills Receivable A/c


Dr.
To Bishans A/c
(Received new acceptance from Bishan for
two months)

4,100

May 12 Bank A/c


Dr.
To bills Receivable A/c
(Bishan met his new acceptance on maturity)

4,100

4,100

4,100

Bishans Account
Dr.
Date
2005
Oct. 30
2006
Mar. 03
Mar. 09

Particulars

Sales
Bank
Interest

J. F.

Amount
Rs.
14,000
8,050
100
22,150

Date
2005
Oct. 30
2006
Mar. 03
Mar. 03

Particulars

Bills
Cash
Bills Receivable

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
14,000
4,050
4,100
22,150

312

Accountancy
Books of Bishan
Journal

Date

Particulars

2005
Jan. 30 Purchases A/c
To Ashoks A/c
(Purchases goods on credit from Ashok)
Jan.30

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

14,000
14,000

Ashoks A/c
Dr.
To Bills Payable A/c
(Accepted three drafts of Ashok, the first for
Rs. 2,000 payable after 2 months, second for
Rs. 4,000 Payable after 3 months and the third
for Rs. 8,000 Payable after 4 months)

2006
Jan. 02 Bills Payable A/c
To Bank A/c
(Met first acceptance for Rs. 2,000 in
favour of Ashok.)
Feb.02

L.F.

Dr.

14,000
14,000

2,000
2,000

Bill Payabale A/c


To Bank A/c
(Met second acceptance for Rs. 4,000 in
favour of Ashok on maturity)

Dr.

Mar. 03 Bill Payable A/c


Noting charges A/c
To Ashok A/c
(Third acceptance in favour of Ashok
dishonoured and noting charges Rs. 50)

Dr.
Dr.

4,000
4,000

Mar. 09 Ashoks A/c


Dr.
To Cash A/c
(Paid to Ashok Rs. 4,000 plus noting charges)
Mar. 09 Interest A/c
Dr.
To Ashoks A/c
(Interest allowed to Ashok)
Mar. 09 Ashoks A/c
Dr.
To Bills Payable A/c
(New draft of Ashok for two months accepted)
May 12 Bills Payable A/c
Dr.
To Bank A/c
(Met new acceptance for Rs. 4,100 in favour
of Ashok on maturity)

8,050
50
8,050

4,050
4,050
100
100
4,100
4,100
4,100
4,100

Bill of Exchange

313
Ashoks Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date
2005
Oct. 30
2006
Mar. 03
Mar. 09

Particulars

Bills payable
Cash
Bills Payable

J. F.

Amount
Rs.
14,000
4,050
4,100
22,150

Date
2005
Oct. 30
2006
Mar. 03
Mar. 09

Particulars

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Purchases

14,000

Bills Payable
Noting charges
Interest

8,000
50
100
22,150

Illustration 6.
Aashirwad draws on Aakarshak a Bill of exchange for 3 months for Rs.10,000 which
Aakarshak accepts on January 01, 2006. Aashirwad endorses the bill in favour of Aakarti.
Before maturity Aakarshak approaches Aashirwad with the request that the bill be renewed
for a further period of 3 months at 18 per cent per annum interest. Aashirwad pays the
sum to Prateek on the due date and agrees to the proposal of Aakarshak. Record journal
entries in the books of Aashirwad, assuming that the second bill is duly met.
Solution
Book of Ashirwad
Journal
Date

Particulars

L.F.

2006
Jan. 01 Bills Receivable A/c
Dr.
To Aakarshaks A/c
(The Bill of exchange received from Aakarshak)
Jan.01

Apr. 04

Apr. 04

Apr. 04

Aakaratis A/c
Dr.
To Bills payable A/c
(The bill of exchange received from Aakarshak,
endorsed to Aakarati)

Debit
Amount
Rs.
10,000

10,000
10,000
10,000

Aakarshaks A/c
Dr.
To Aakaratis A/c
(Cancellation of the bill of exchange received
from Aakarshak now with Aakarati)

10,000

Aakaratis A/c
To Bank A/c
(Payment of the amount due to Aakarati)

10,000

Dr.

Aakarshaks A/c
Dr.
To Interest A/c
(Interest due from Aakarshak on Rs.10,000
for 3 months at 18% p.a.)

Credit
Amount
Rs.

10,000

10,000
450
450

314

Accountancy

Apr. 04

Bills Receivable A/c


Dr.
To Aakarshaks A/c
(The new bill received from Aakarshak for
the amountdue for him)
July 07 Bank A/c
Dr.
To Bills Receivable A/c
(The amount received from Aakarshak in
respect of the renewed bill)

10,450
10,450

10,450
10,450

Illustration 7.
Ankit owes Nikita a sum of Rs.6,000. On April 01, 2006 Ankit gives a promissory note for
the amount for 3 months to Nikita who gets it discounted with her bankers for Rs.5,760.
on the due date the bill is dishonoured, the bank paid Rs.15 as noting charges. Ankit
then pays Rs.2,000 in cash and accepts a bill of exchange drawn on him for the balance
together with Rs.100 as interest. This bill of exchange is for 2 months and on the due date
the bill is again dishonoured, Nikita paid Rs.15 as noting charges.
Draft the journal entries to be recorded in Nikitas books.
Solution
Books of Nikita
Journal
Date

2005
Apr. 01

Particulars

Bills Receivable A/c


To Ankits A/c
(Ankits promissory note received in
settlement of his account)

L.F.

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

6,000
6,000

Jan. 01 Bank A/c


Dr.
Discount A/c
Dr.
To Bills Payable A/c
(Ankits Promissory note discounted for Rs.5,760)

5,760
240
6,000

July 04 Ankit A/c


Dr.
To Bank A/c
(The promissory note dishonoured by Ankit
the amount of the bill and the noting charges
recoverable from Ankit and payable to bank)

6,015

July 04 Cash A/c


To Ankits A/c
(The amount received from Ankit)

2,000

Dr.

July 04 Ankits A/c


Dr.
To Interest A/c
(Interest due from Ankit for the second bill)

6,015

2,000
100
100

Bill of Exchange

315

July 04 Bills Receivable A/c


To Ankits A/c
(Ankits acceptance for 2 monthsin
settlement of amount due)

Dr.

4,115
4,115

Sept.07 Ankits A/c


Dr.
To Bills Receivable A/c
(The dishonour by Ankit of his acceptance)
Sept.07 Ankits A/c
To Cash A/c
(Payment of noting charges, recoverable
from Ankit)

4,115
4,115

Dr.

15
15

Illustraion 8.
On May 2005 Mohit sends his promissory note of Rs. 6000 for 3 months to Rohit. Rohit
gets it discounted with his bankers at 18 percent per annum on May 04. On the due date
the bill is dishonoured, the bank paying Rs.10 as noting charges. Rohit agrees to accept
Rs.2,130 in cash (including Rs.130 for noting charges and interest) and another promissory
note for Rs.4,000 at 2 months. On the due date, Mohit approaches Rohit again and asks
for renewal of the bill for a further period of 3 months. Rohit agrees to the request, provided
Mohit pays Rs.200 as interest in cash. This last bill is paid on maturity.
Draft journal entries in the books of Mohit and Rohit.
Solution
Books of Mohit
Journal
Date

2005
May 01

Aug.04

Particulars

Rohits A/c
To Bills Payable A/c
(The amount of the promissory note sent
to Rohit)

L.F.

Dr.

Bills Payable A/c


Dr.
Noting charges A/c
Dr.
To Rohits A/c
(The dishonour of the promissory note and
Rs.10 being payable as noting charges to Rohit)

Aug. 04 Interest A/c


Dr.
Rohits A/c
(Interest due to Rohit from part renewal of
the promissory)

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

6,000
6,000

6,000
10
6,010

120
120

316
Aug.04

Oct.07

Oct.07

Oct.07

2001
Jan.09

Accountancy
Rohits A/c
Dr.
To Bills Payable A/c
To Cash A/c
(Payment of Rs. 2,130 in cash and a new
promissory note for Rs. 4,000 sent to Rohit to
settle his account)

6,130

Bill Payable A/c


To Rohits A/c
(Cancellation of the bill due today)

4,000

4,000
2,130

Dr.

4,000

Interest A/c
Dr.
To Rohits A/c
(The amount due as interest ot Rohit on the
renewed bill)

200

Rohits A/c
Dr.
To Cash A/c
To Bills Payable A/c
(The new acceptance and cash sent to Rohit)

4,200

Bills Payable A/c


Dr.
To Cash A/c
(Payment made to meet the bill due this day)

4,000

200

200
4,000

4,000

Book of Rohit
Journal
Date

2005
May 01

May 04

Aug.04

Aug.04

Particulars

L.F.

Debit
Credit
Amount Amount
Rs.
Rs.

Bills Receivable A/c


Dr.
To Mohits A/c
(Mohits promissory note received this day)

6,000

Banks A/c
Dr.
Discount A/c
Dr.
To Bills Receivable A/c
(The discounting of the promissory note by
Mohit at 18% on Rs. 6,000 for 3 months)

5,730
270

Mohits A/c
Dr.
To Bank A/c
(The dishonour of the promissory not by Mohit
Rs. 10 being charged by bank for noting charges)

6,000

Mohits A/c
Dr.
Interest A/c
(The amount agreed to be paid as interest
by Mohit)

6,000

6,000

6,010

120
120

Bill of Exchange
Aug.04

Oct.07

Oct.07

Oct.07

317

Cash A/c
Bills Receivable A/c
To Mohits A/c
(Cash and promissory note received from
Mohit for the amount due from him)

Dr.

Mohits A/c
To Bills Receivable A/c
(Cancellation of the bill due today)

Dr.

Mohits A/c
To Interest A/c
(The amount due from Mohit as interest)

Dr.

Cash A/c
Bills Receivable A/c
To Mohits A/c

Dr.
Dr.

2,130
4,000
6,130

4,000
4,000
200
200

(Cash and promissory not received from Mohit)


2006
Jan. 10 Cash/Bank A/c
Dr.
To Bills Receivable A/c
(Mohit met his acceptance on maturity)

200
4,000
4,200

4,000
4,000

Test Your Understanding - III


Fill in the blanks:
(i)
(ii)
(iii)
(iv)
(v)
(vi)

A bill of exchange is a ___________________________________instrument.


A bill of exchange is drawn by the ________________upon his___________.
A promissory note is drawn by ______________in favour of his__________.
There are ____________________parties to a bill of exchange.
There are ____________________parties to a promissory note.
Drawer and ______________can not be the same parties in case of a bill of
exchange.
(vii) Bill of exchange in India languages is called _____________
(viii) __________days of grace are added in terms of the bill to calculate the date
of its__________.

8.12 Accommodation Bills


Normally, bills of exchange or promissory notes are drawn to finance the
actual transactions in goods, i.e., an acceptance is made to settle a trade debt
owing to the drawer by the drawee in case of a bill of exchange and the bill is
called a trade bill. As it originates from genuine trade transaction it is for
value received and is enforceable. For example, Ankit buys goods from Bishan,
he may postpone the payment by accepting a draft drawn by Bindu upon
him. Bindu can if he wants, get the money immediately by getting Ankits

318

Accountancy

acceptance discounted with his bank. But, apart from financing transaction in
goods, bills of exchange promissory notes may also be used for raising funds
temporarily. Such a bill is called an accommodation bill as it is accepted by the
drawee to accommodate the drawer. Hence, the drawee is called the
accommodating party and the drawer is called the accommodation party.
For example, Raj draws upon Pal a bill for Rs.10,000 on April 01, 2006 for three
months and the latter accepts the same to accommodate Raj. Raj discounts it
with his bank at 6% per annum on the same date. Raj remitted the amount one
day before the maturity of the bill to Pal. Pal met the bill on the date of its maturity.
The journal entries in the books of Raj and Pal will be recorded as follows:
Book of Raj
Journal
Date

Particulars

2006
Apr. 01 Bills Receivable A/c
To Pals A/c
(Received Pals acceptance)

L.F.

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

10,000
10,000

Apr. 01 Bank A/c


Discount A/c
To Bills Receivables A/c
(Discount Pal acceptance)

Dr.
Dr.

Jul. 03 Pals A/c


To Bank A/c
(Remittance to Pal for paying off
accommodation bill)

Dr.

9,850
150
10,000
10,000
10,010

Books of Pal
Journal
Date

Particulars

L.F.

2005
Apr.01 Rajs A/c
Dr.
To Bill Payable A/c
(Acceptance of accommodation bill drawn by Raj)
Jul.03

Jul.03

Bank A/c
To Rajs A/c
(Received Rajs remittance)

Dr.

Bill Payable A/c


To Bank A/c
(Discharge of accommodation)

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

10,000
10,000
10,000
10,000
10,000
10,000

Bill of Exchange

319

Sometimes, the accommodation parties agree to raise the funds through an


accommodation bill for mutual benefits. It can be done in any of the following
two ways:
(a) The drawer and the drawee share the proceeds in an agreed ratio
(b) Each draws a bill and each accepts a bill
In the case (a) the discounting changes are shared by drawer and drewee in the
ratio in which they share the proceeds. But in the case (b) the discount is not
shared as each party retains the entire proceeds of the bill drawn and discounted
by him. On maturity, each party meets his acceptance out of his own resources
if everyone draws and accepts bills of the same denomination and tenure. But
where they share the proceeds of the same bill, the drawer should remit, just
before maturity, the balance due to the drawee, so that the latter could duly
meet his acceptance. Based upon the above discussion, it can be stated that an
accommodation bill helps both the parties to the instrument to temporarily
raise the necessary funds from discounting institutions.
Illustaration 9
Ashu and Mudit were in need of funds. On October 01, 2005 Ashu drew upon a bill for
Rs. 9,000 for 2 months. Mudit accepted the bill and returned to Ashu. Ashu got it
discounted at 5% from Bank same day. Half of the amount were remitted to Mudit. On the
due date Ashu sent the required sum to Mudit, who met the bill. Journalise the transactions
in the books of Ashu and Mudit.
Books of Ashu
Journal
Date

2005
Oct. 01

Oct. 03

Oct. 03

Oct. 01

Particulars

L.F.

Rajs A/c
To Bills Payable A/c
(Mutual accommodation bill receipts
from Mudit)

Dr.

Bank A/c
Discount A/c
To Bill Receivable A/c
(Bill discounted from bank)

Dr.
Dr.

Mudits A/c
To Cash A/c
To Discount A/c
(Half the proceeds remitted to Mudit)

Dr.

Mudits A/c
To Cash A/c
(Half amount of the bill sent to Mudit to
enable him to meet it)

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

9,000
9,000

8,925
75
9,000
4,500
4,462.50
37.50
4,500
4,500

320

Accountancy
Books of Mudit
Journal

Date

2005
Oct. 01

Oct. 01

Particulars

L.F.

Ashus A/c
To Bills Payable A/c
(Mutual Accommodation bill accepted)

Dr.

Cash A/c
Discount A/c
To Ashus A/c
(half amount of Discounted Bill received
from Ashu)

Dr.
Dr.

Debit
Credit
Amount Amount
Rs.
Rs.
9,000
9,000
4,462.50
37.50
4,500

Dec. 04 Cash A/c


Dr.
To Auhus A/c
(Amount retained by Ashu now received from him)

4,500

Dec. 05 Bill Payable A/c


To Bank A/c
(Acceptance honoured)

9,000

4,500

Dr.

9,000

Illustration 10
Rohan and Rohit were both in need to temporary accommodation. On November 01,
2005, Rohan accepted Rohit draft for Rs. 5,000 for 3 months and Rohit accepted Rohan
draft for Rs. 4,000 for 3 months. The both bills were discounted at the respected banks
for Rs 4,800 and Rs. 3,850. Before maturity of the bill Rohit sent Rs. 1,000 to Rohan for
difference in accommodation bill. Rohan and Rohit met his acceptance on the due date.
Records the transaction in the journal of Rohan and Rohit.
Books of Rohan
Journal
Date

Particulars

2005
Nov. 01 Rohits A/c
To Bills Payable A/c
(Rohan accepted bill accommodation)

L.F.

Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

5,000
5,000

Nov. 01 Bill Receivable A/c


To Rohits A/c
(Accommodated bill received)

Dr.

Nov. 01 Bank A/c


Discount A/c
To Bill Receivable A/c
(Bill discounted by bank)

Dr.
Dr.

4,000
4,000
3,850
150
4,000

Bill of Exchange

321

Feb. 04 Cash A/c


To Rohits A/c
(Cash received for meet the bill)

Dr.

Feb. 04 Bill Payable A/c


To Bank A/c
(Bill met on maturity)

Dr.

1,000
1,000
5,000
5,000

Books of Rohit
Journal
Date

Particulars

2005
Nov. 01 Rohans A/c
To Bills Payable A/c
(Rohit accepted bill accommodation)

L.F.

Dr.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

4,000
4,000

Nov. 01 Bill Receivable A/c


To Rohans A/c
(Accommodated bill received)

Dr.

Nov. 01 Bank A/c


Discount A/c
To Bill Receivable A/c
(Bill discounted by bank)

Dr.
Dr.

Feb. 04

Rohans A/c
To cash A/c
(Sent cash to Rohan)

Dr.

Bill Payable A/c


To Bank A/c
(Bill met on due date)

Dr.

Feb. 04

Debit
Amount
Rs.

5,000
5,000
4,800
200
5,000
1,000
1,000
4,000
4,000

Key Terms Introduced in the Chapter

(a) Drawer
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)

Drawee
Payee
Bill Receivable
Bill Payable
Drawing of a Bill
Acceptance of a Bill
Payment of a bill
Summary with Reference to Learning Objectives
1.

Bill of exchange as an Instrument : A bill of exchange is a device by


which the purchaser or debtor in a credit transaction is not required to

322

Accountancy

2.

3.

4.

make immediate payment but satisfies the seller or creditor by accepting


in writing the liability to pay the amount due from him.
Meaning of bill of exchange and promissory note: A bill of exchange is an
acknowledgement of debt given by one person to another, incorporating
all the terms and conditions of payments. A promissory note is an
undertaking in writing given by the debtor to the creditor to pay the
latter a certain sum of money in accordance with the conditions stated
therein.
Difference between a bill and a note.
(a) A bill is prepared by the creditor and accepted by the debtor; a note
is prepared by the debtor.
(b) There are three parties to a bill; there are only two parties to a note.
(c) A bill requires acceptance to acquire financial status; a note in
itself has financial status.
Features and advantages of a bill : A bill is a written unconditional
order; it is signed by the creditor and accepted by the debtor; the amount
of the bill is payable either on demand or at a fixed or 5. Briefly explain
the purpose and benefits of retiring a bill of exchange to the debtor and
the creditor.
Questions for Practice

Short Answers
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.

Name any two types of commonly used negotiable instruments.


Write two points of distinction between bills of exchange and promissory
note.
State any four essential features of bill of exchange.
State the three parties involved in a bill of exchange.
What is meant by maturity of a bill of exchange?
What is meant by dishonour of a bill of exchange?
Name the parties to a promissory note
What is meant by acceptance of a bill of exchange?
What is Noting of a bill of exchange.
What is meant by renewal of a bill of exchange?
Give the performa of a Bills Receivable Book.
Give the performa of a Bills Payable Book.
What is retirement of a bill of exchange?
What is meant by insolvency?
Give the meaning of rebate.
Give the performa of a Bill of Exchange.

Long Answers
1.

A bill of exchange must contain an unconditional promise to pay Do


you agree with a statement?

Bill of Exchange
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.

Briefly explain the effects of dishonour and noting of a bill of exchange.


Explain briefly the procedure of calculating the date of maturity of a bill
of exchange? Give example.
Distinguish between bill of exchange and promissory note.
Briefly explain the purpose and benefits of retiring a bill of exchange to
the debtor and the creditor.
Explain briefly the purpose and advantages of maintaining of a Bills
Receivable Book.
Briefly explain the benefits of maintaining a Bills Payable Book and
state how is its posting is done in the ledger?

Numerical Questions
1.

On Jan 01, 2006 Rao sold goods Rs.10,000 to Reddy. Half of the payment
was made immediately and for the remaining half Rao drew a bill of
exchange upon Reddy payable after 30 days. Reddy accepted the bill
and returned it to Rao. On the due date Rao presented the bill to Reddy
and received the payment.
Journalise the above transactions in the books Rao and prepare of
Raos account in the books of Reddy.

2.

On Jan 01,2006, Shankar purchased goods from Parvati for Rs.8,000


and immediately drew a promissory note in favour of Parvati payable
after 3 months. On the date of maturity of the promissory note, the
Government of India declared holiday under the Negotiable Instrument
Act 1881. Since, Parvati was unaware about the provision of the law
regarding the date of maturity of the bill, she handed over the bill to
her lawyer, who duly presented the bill and received the payment. The
amount of the bill was handed over by the lawyer to Parvati immediately.
Recore the necessary Journal entries in the books of Parvati and
Shankar.

3.

Vishal sold goods for Rs.7,000 to Manju on Jan 05, 2006 and drew
upon her a bill of exchange payable after 2 months. Manju accepted
Vishals draft and handed over the same to Vishal after acceptance.
Vishal immediately discounted the bill with his bank@12% p.a. On the
due date Manju met her acceptance.
Journalise the above transactions in the books of Vishal and Manju.
On Feb 01, 2006, John purchased goods for Rs.15,000 from Jimmi. He
immediately made a payment of Rs.5,000 by cheque and for the balance
accepted the bill of exchange drawn upon him by Jimmi. The bill of
exchange was payable after 40 days. Five days before the maturity of
the bill, Jimmi sent the same to his bank for collection. The bank duly
presented the bill to John on the due date who met the bill. The bank
informed the same to Jimmi.
Prepare Johns account in the books of Jimmi and Jimmi account in
the books of John.

4.

323

324

Accountancy
5.

6.

7.

8.

On Jan 15, 2006, Kartar Sold goods for Rs.30,000 to Bhagwan and
drew upon him three bills of exchanges of Rs.10,000 each payable after
one month, two month, and three months respectively. The first bill
was retained by Kartar till its maturity. The second bill was endorsed
by him in favour of his creditor Ratna and the third bill was discounted
by him immediately @ 6% p.a. All the bills were met by Bhagwan.
Journalise the above transactions in the books of Kartar and Bhagwan.
Also prepare ledger accounts in books of Kartar and Bhagwan.
On Jan. 01, 2006 Arun sold goods for Rs.30,000 to Sunil. 50% of the
payment was made immediately by Sunil on which Arun allowed a cash
discount of 2%. For the balance Sunil drew a promissory note in favour
of Arun payable after 20 days. Since, the date of maturity of bill was a
public holiday, Arun presented the bill on a day, as per the provisions
of Negotiable Instrument Act which was met by Sunil. State the date on
which the bill was presented by Arun for payment and Jounalise the
above transactions in the books of Arun and Sunil.
Darshan sold goods for Rs. 40,000 to Varun on 8.1.2006 and drew
upon him a bill of exchange payable after two months. Varun accepted
the bill and returned the same to Darshan. On the due date the bill was
met by Varun. Record the necessary Journal entries in the books of
Darshan and Varun in the following circumstances.

When the bill was retained by Darshan till the date of its maturity.

When Darshan immediately discounted the bill @ 6% p.a. with


his bank.

When the bill was endorsed immediately by Darshan in favour of


his creditor Suresh.

When three days before its maturity, the bill was sent by Darshan
to his bank for collection.
Bansal Traders allow a trade discount of 10% on the list price of the
goods purchased from them. Mohan traders, who runs a retail shop
made the following purchases from Bansal Traders.
Date
Amount
(Rs.)
Dec. 21, 2005
1,000
Dec. 26, 2005
1,200
Dec. 18, 2005
2,000
Dec. 31, 2005
5,000
For all the purchases Mohan Traders drew promissory note in favour of
Bansal Traders payable after 30 days. The promissory note for the sale
of Dec. 21, 2005 was retained by Bansal Traders with them till the date
of its maturity. The promissory note drawn on 26.12.2005 was
discounted by Bansal Traders from their bank at 12% p.a. The
promissory note drawn on Dec. 28, 2005 was endorsed by Bansal
Traders in favour of their creditor Dream Soaps in full settlement of a
purchase amounting to Rs. 1,900. On 25.1.2006 Bansal Traders sent
the promissory note drawn on Dec. 31, 2005 to their bank for collection.

Bill of Exchange
All the promissory notes were met by Mohan Traders. Record the
necessary journal entries for the above transactions in the books of
Bansal Traders and Mohan Traders and prepare Mohan Traders account
in the books of Bansal Traders and Bansal Traders account in the books
of Mohan Traders.
9.
Narayanan purchased goods for Rs.25,000 from Ravinderan on Feb.
01, 2006. Ravinderan drew upon Narayanan a bill of exchange for the
same amount payable after 30 days. On the due date Narayanan
dishonoured his acceptance.
Pass the necessary journal entries in the books of Ravinderan and
Narayanan in following cases:
When the bill was retained by Ravinderan with him till the date of
its maturity.
When the bill was discounted by Ravinderan immediately with his
bank @ 6% p.a.
When the bill was endorsed to his creditor Ganeshan.
When the bill was sent by Ravinderan to his bank for collection a
few days before it maturity.
10. Ravi sold goods for Rs.40,000 to Sudershan on Feb 13, 2006. He drew
four bills of exchange upon Sudershan. The first bill was for Rs.5,000
payable after one month. The second bill was for Rs.10,000 payable after
40 days; the third bill was for Rs.12,000 payable after three months and
fourth bill was for the balance amount payable after 19 days. Sudershan
accepted all the bills and returned the same to Ravi. Ravi discounted the
first bill with his bank at 6% p.a. He endorsed the second bill to his
creditor Mustaq for the full settlement of a debt of Rs.10,200. The third
bill was kept by Ravi with him till the date of maturity. Five days before
the maturity of the fourth bill, Ravi sent the bill to his bank for collection.
All the four bills were dishounoured by Sudarshan on maturity. Sudershan
settled Ravis claim in cash three days after the dishonour of each bill
along with interest @ 12% p.a. for the terms of the bills.
You are requested to record the necessary journal entries in the books
to Ravi, Sudershan, Mustaq and bank for the above transaction. Also
prepare Sudershans account and Mustaqs account in the books
of Ravi.
11. On Jan 01, 2006 Neha sold goods for Rs.20,000 to Muskan and drew
upon her a bill of exchange payable after two months. One month before
the maturity of the bill Muskan approached Neha to accept the payment
against the bill at a rebate @ 12% p.a. Neha agreed to the request of
Muskan and Muskan retired the bill under the agreed rate of rebate.
Journalise the above transaction in the books of Neha and Muskan.
12. On Jan 15, 2006 Raghu sold goods worth Rs. 35,000 to Devendra and
drew upto the latter three bills of exchanges. The first bill was for
Rs.5,000 payable after one month, the second bill was for Rs.20,000
payable after three months and third bill for balance amount for 4
months. Raghu endorsed the first bill in favour of his creditor Dewan in
full settlement of a debt of Rs.5,200. The second bill was discounted by

325

326

Accountancy

13.

14.

15.

16.

Raghu @ 6 % p.a. and the third bill was retained by Raghu till the date
of maturity. Devendra dishonoured the bill on maturity and the bank
paid Rs. 30 as noting charges. Four days before the maturity of the
third bill Raghu, sent the same for collection to his bank. The third bill
was also dishonored by Devendra and the bank paid Rs.200 as noting
charges. Five days after the dishonour of the bill Devendra paid the
entire amount due to Raghu along with interest Rs.1,000 for this purpose
Devendra obtained a short term loan from his bank.
You are requested to record the necessary journal entries in the books
of Raghu Devendra and Dewan and also prepare Devendras account in
Raghus books and Raghus account in Devendras account.
Viaml purchased goods Rs.25,000 from Kamal on Jan 15, 2006 and
accepted a bill of exchange drawn upon him by Kamal payable after
two months. On the date of the maturity the bill was duly presented for
payment. Vimal dishonoured the bill.
record the necessary journal entries in the books of Kamal and Vimal
when.
The bill was retained by Kamal till the date of its maturity.
The bill was immediately discounted by Kamal with his bank @ 6% p.a.
The bill was endorsed by Kamal in favour of his creditor Sharad.
Five days before its maturity the bill was sent by Kamal to his bank
for collection.
Abdula sold goods to Tahir on Jan 17, 2006 for Rs.18,000. He drew a
bill of exchange for the same amount on Tahir for 45 days. On the same
date Tahir accepted the bill and returned it to Abdulla. On the due
date Abdulla presented the bill to Tahir which was dishonoured. Abdulla
paid Rs.40 as noting charges. Five days after the dishonour of his
acceptance Tahir settled his debt by making a payment of Rs.18,700
including interest and noting charges.
Record the necessary journal entries in the books of Abdulla and Tahir.
Also prepare Tahirs account in the books of Abdulla and Abdullas
account in the books of Tahir.
Asha sold goods worth Rs.19,000 to Nisha on March 02, 2006. Rs.4,000
were paid by Nisha immediately and for the balance she accepted a bill
of exchange drawn upon her by Asha payable after three months. Asha
discounted the bill immediately with her bank. On the due date Nisha
dishonoured the bill and the bank paid Rs.30 as noting charges.
Record the necessary journal entries in the books of Asha and Nisha.
On Feb. 02, 2006, Verma purchased from Sharma goods for Rs.17,500.
Verma paid Rs.2,500 immediately and for the balance gave a promissory
note to Sharma payable after 60 days. Sharma immediately endorsed
the promissory note in favour of his creditor.
Gupta for the full settlement of a debt of Rs.15,400. On the due date of
the bill Gupta presented the bill to Verma which the latter dishonoured
and Gupta paid Rs.5,000 noting charges. On the same date Gupta
informed Sharma about the dishonour of the bill. Sharma settled his

Bill of Exchange
debt to Gupta by cheque for Rs.15,500 which includes noting charges
and interest. Verma settled Sharmas claim by cheque for the same
amount.

17.

18.

19.

20.

Record the necessary journal entries is the books of Sharma, Gupta


and Verma for the above transaction and prepare Vermas and Guptas
accounts in the books of Sharma. Sharmas account in the books of
Verma. And also Sharmas account in the books of Gupta.
Lilly sold goods to Methew on 1.3.2006 for Rs.12,000 and drew upon
Methew a bill of exchange for the same amount payable after two months.
Lilly immediately discounted the bill with her bank at 9% p.a. The
maturity date of the bill was a non business day (holiday), therefore,
Lilly had to present the bill as per the provisions of the Indian
Instruments Act.1881. The bill was dishonoured by Methew and Lilly
paid Rs.45 as noting charges. Methew settled the claim of Lilly five
days after the disonour of the bill by a cheque, whch includes interest
@ 12% for the term of the bill.
Journalise the above transactions in the books of Lilly and Methew
and prepare Mathews account in the books of Lilly and Lillys account
in the books of Mathew.
Kapil purchased goods for Rs.21,000 from Gaurav on 1.2.2006 and
accepted a bill of exchange drawn by Gaurav for the same amount. The
bill was payable after one month. On 25.2.2002 Gaurav sent the bill to
his bank for collection. The bill was duly presented by the bank. Kapil
dishonoured the bill and the bank paid Rs.100 as noting charges.
Record the necessary journal entries for the above transactions in the
books of Kapil and Gourav.
On Feb. 14, 2006 Rashmi sold good Rs.7,500 to Alka. Alka paid Rs.500
in cash and for the bank balance accepted a bill of exchange drawn
upon her by Rashmi payable after two months. On Apr.10, 2006 Alka
approached Rashmi to cancel the bill since she was short of funds. She
further requested Rashmi to accept Rs.2,000 in cash and draw a new
bill for the balance including interest Rs.500. Rashmi accepted Alkas
request and drew a new bill for the amount due payable after 2 months.
The bill was accepted by Alka. The new bill was duly met by Alka on
maturity.
Record the necessary journal entries in the books of Rashmi and Alka
and prepared Alkas account in the books of Rashmis and Rashmis
account in the books of Alkas
Nikhil sold goods for Rs.23,000 to Akhil on Dec. 01, 2005. He drew
upon Akhil a bill of exchange for the same amount payable after 2
months. Akhil accepted the bill and sent it back to Nikhil. Nikhil
discounted the bill immediately with his bank @12 p.a. On the due
date Akhil dishonoured the bill of exchange and the bank paid Rs.100
as noting charges. Akhil requested Nikhil to draw a new bill upon him
with interest @10% p.a. which he agreed. The new bill was payable
after two months. A week before the maturity of the second bill Akhil

327

328

Accountancy
requested Nikhil to cancel the second bill. He further requested to accept
Rs.10,000 in cash immediately and drew a third bill upon him including
interest of Rs.500. Nikhil agreed to Akhils request. The third bill was
payable after one month. Akhil met the third bill on its maturity. record
the necessary journal entries in the books of Nikhil and Akhil and also
prepare Akhils account in the books of Nikhil and Nikhils account in
the books of Akhil.
21. On Jan 01, 2006 Vibha sold goods worth Rs.18,000 to Sudha and drew
upon the latter a bill of exchange for the same amount payable after
two months. Sudha accepted Vibhas draft and returned the same to
Vibha after acceptance. Vibha endorsed the bill immediately in favour
of her creditor Geeta. Five days before the maturity of the bill Sudha
requested Vibha to cancel the bill since she was short of funds. She
further requested to draw a new bill upon her including interest of
Rs.200. Vibha accepted Sudhas request. Vibha took the bill from Geeta
by making the payment to her in cash and cancelled the same. Then
she drew a new bill upon Sudha as agreed. The new bill was payable
after one month. The new bill was duly met by Sudha on maturity.
Record the necessary journal entries in the books of Vibha.
22. Following was the position of debtor and creditor of Gautam as
on 1.1.2006.
Debtors
Creditors
Rs.
Rs.
Babu
5,000
Chanderkala
8,000
Kiran
13,500
Anita
14,000
Anju
5,000
Sheiba
12,000
Manju
6,000
The following transactions took place in the month of Jan 2006:
Jan 2
Drew on Babu at two months after date at full settlement for Rs.4,800.
Babu accepted the bill and returned it on 5.1.2006.
Jan. 04
Babus bill discounted for Rs.4,750.
Jan. 08
Chanderkala sent a promissory note for Rs.8,000 payable three months
after date.
Jan. 10
Promissory note received from Chanderkala discounted for Rs.7,900.
Jan. 12
Accepted Sheiba draft for the amount due payable two months after
date.
Jan. 22

Bill of Exchange

23.

24.

25.

26.

329

Anita sent his promissory note payable after two months.


Jan. 23
Anitas promissory note endorsed in favour of Manju.
Jan. 25
Accepted Anjus draft payable after three months.
Jan. 29
Kiran sent Rs.2,000 in cash and a promissory note for the balance
payable after three months.
Record the above transactions in the proper subsidiary books.
On Jan. 01, 2006 Harsh accepted a months bill for Rs. 10,000 drawn
on him by tanu for latters benefit. Tanu discounted the bill on same
day @ 8% p.a On the due date tanu sent a cheque to Harsh for honour
the bill. Harsh duly honoured his acceptance.
Record the journal entries in the Books of Tanu and Harsh.
Ritesh and Naina were in need of funds temporarily. On August 01
2005 Ritesh drew upon Naina a bill for Rs. 12,000 for 4 months. Naina
Accepted the bill and returned to Ritesh. Ritesh discounted the Bill @
8% p.a. Half amount of the discounted bill remitted to Naina. On due
date, Ritesh sent the required sum to Naina, who met the bill. Journalise
the transaction in the books of both the parties.
On Jan. 01, 2006, bhanu and Naman drew on each other a bill for Rs.
8,000 payable 3 months after the due date for their Mutual benefit. On
January 02 they discounted with their bank each others bill at 5% p.a.
on the due date each met his Owns acceptance. Give journal entry in
the books of Bhanu and Naman.
On Nov. 01, 2005 Sonia drawn a bill on sunny for Rs. 15,000 for 3
months for mutual accommodation. Sunny accepts the bill and return
it to sonia. Sonia discounted the same with his bankers @ 6% p.a. The
proceeds are shared between sonia and sunny in proportion of 2/3rd,
1/3rd respectively. On the due date sonia remits his proportion to sunny
who fails to met the bill and as a result sonia has to meet it. Sunny Give
a fresh acceptance for the amount due to sonia plus interest of Rs. 100
sunny meet his second acceptance on due date. Record the necessary
journal entries in the books of sonia and sunny.
Checklist to test Your Understanding

Test your understanding-I


(i)
(vi)

False
False

(ii)
(vii)

True
True

(iii)
(viii)

False
False

(iv)
(ix)

False
False

(v)
(x)

True
False

Test Your Understanding-II


(i)Promise

(ii) Endorsement

(iii) Promissor

(iv) Endorser

Test Your Understanding-III


(i) Negotiable, (ii) Drawer, Drawee
(v) Two.
(vi) Drawee

(iii) Debtor, Creditor


(vii) Hundi

(iv) Three
(viii) Maturity

330

Accountancy

Financial Statements - I

Y
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
After studying this chapter,
you will be able to :
state the nature of the
financial statements;
identify the various
stakeholders and their
infor mation requirements;
distinguish between
the capital and revenue expenditure and
receipts;
explain the concept of
trading and profit and
loss account and its
preparation;
State the nature of
gross profit, net profit
and operating profit;
describe the concept of
balance sheet and its
preparation;
explain grouping and
marshalling of assets
and liabilities;
prepare profit and loss
account and balance
sheet of a sole proprietory firm; and
make an opening
entry.

ou have learnt that financial accounting is a


well-defined sequential activity which begins
with Journal (Journalising), Ledger (Posting), and
preparation of T rial Balance (Balancing and
Summarisation at the first stage). In the present
chapter, we will take up the next step, namely,
preparation of financial statements, and discuss the
types of information requirements of various
stakeholders, the distinction between capital and
revenue items and its importance and the nature
of financial statements and the preparation thereof.
9.1 Stakeholders and Their
Information Requirements

Recall from chapter I (Financial Accounting Part I)


that the objective of business is to communicate
the meaningful information to various stakeholders
in the business so that they can make informed
decisions. A stakeholder is any person associated
with the business. The stakes of various
stakeholders can be monetary or non-monetary. The
stakes can be active or passive; or can be direct or
indirect. The owner and persons advancing loan to
the business would have monetary stake. The
government, consumer or a researcher will have
non-monetary stake in the business. The
stakeholders are also called users who are normally
classified as internal and external depending upon
whether they are inside the business or outside the
business. All users have different objectives for

332

Accountancy

joining business and consequently different types of information requirements


from it. In nutshell, the various users have diverse financial information
requirements from the business.
For example we have classified the following into the category of internal
and external users specifying their objectives and consequent information
requirements.
Name

Internal/ Objective for participating


External in business
users

Current
owners

Internal

To make investment in the Likes to know extent of profit in the


business and wealth grow. last accounting period, current
position of the assets/liabilities of the
business.

Manager

Internal

For a career. They essentially act as the agent of


owners (their employers).

Accounting information in the form


of financial statements is like their
report card and they are interested
in information about both profits and
financial position.

Government External

Its role is regulatory and


tries to lay down the rules
in the best public interest.

Its concerns are that the rights of all


stakeholders are protected. Since the
gover nment levies taxes on the
business, they are interested in
information about profitability in
particular besides lot of other
information.

Prospective External
owner

He is expecting to make He is interested in information about


investments in the business past profits and financial position as
with a view to make his indicative of likely future performance.
investment and wealth grow.

Bank

Bank is interested in safty


of the principal as well as
the periodic return
(interest).

External

Accounting Information requirements

Bank is interested in adequacy of


profits only as an assurance of the
return of principal and interest back
in time. Bank is equally concerned
about the form in which the assets
are held by the business. When more
assets are held in cash or near cash
for m, the aspect is knnown as
liquidity.

Fig. 9.1 : Analysis of various users of accounting information

Financial Statements - I

333
Box 1

Accounting Process (up to Trial balance) :


1. Identify the transactions, which that are recorded.
2. Record transactions in journal. Only those transactions are recorded which are
measured in money terms. The system followed for recording is called double entry
system whereby two aspects (debit and credit) of every transaction are recorded.
Repeated transactions of same nature are recorded in subsidiary books, also called
special journals. Instead of recording all transactions in journal, they are recorded in
subsidiary books and the journal proper. For example, the business would record all
credit sales in sales book and all credit purchases in purchases book. The other
examples of subsidiary books are return inwards book, return outwards book. An
other important special book is cash book, in which all cash and bank transactions
are recorded. The entries, which are not recorded in any of these books, are recorded
in a residual journal called journal proper.
3. The entries appearing in the above books are posted in the respective accounts in the ledger.
4. The accounts are balanced and listed in a statement called trial balance. If the total
amounts of debit and credit balances agree, accounts are taken as free from
arithmetical errors.
5. The trial balance forms the basis for making the financial statements, i.e. trading
and profit and loss account and balance sheet.

9.2 Distinction between Capital and Revenue


A very important distinction in accounting is between capital and revenue
items. The distinction has important implications for making of the trading
and profit and loss account and balance sheet. The revenue items form part
of the trading and profit and loss account, the capital items help in the
preparation of a balance sheet.
9.2.1 Expenditure
Whenever payment and/or incurrence of an outlay are made for a purpose
other than the settlement of an existing liability, it is called expenditure. The
expenditures are incurred with a viewpoint they would give benefits to the
business. The benefit of an expenditure may extend up to one accounting
year or more than one year. If the benefit of expenditure extends up to one
accounting period, it is termed as revenue expenditure. Normally, they are
incurred for the day-to-day conduct of the business. An example can be
payment of salaries, rent, etc. The salaries paid in the current period will not
benefit the business in the next accounting period, as the workers have put
in their efforts in the current accounting period. They will have to be paid the
salaries in the next accounting period as well if they are made to work. If the
benefit of expenditure extends to more than one accounting period, it is termed

334

Accountancy

as capital expenditure. An example can be payment to acquire furniture for


use in the business. Furniture acquired in the current accounting period will
give benefits for many accounting periods to come. The usual examples of
capital expenditure can be payment to acquire fixed assets and/or to make
additions/extensions in the fixed assets.
Following points of distinction between capital expenditure and revenue
expenditure are worth noting :
(a) Capital expenditure increases earning capacity of business whereas
revenue expenditure is incurred to maintain the earning capacity.
(b) Capital expenditure is incurred to acquire fixed assets for operation of
business whereas revenue expenditure is incurred on day-to-day conduct
of business.
(c) Revenue expenditure is generally recurring expenditure and capital
expenditure is non-recurring by nature.
(d) Capital expenditure benefits more than one accounting year whereas
revenue expenditure normally benefits one accounting year.
(e) Capital expenditure (subject to depreciation) is recorded in balance sheet
whereas revenue expenditure (subject to adjustment for outstanding
and prepaid amount) is transferred to trading and profit and loss account.
Sometimes, it becomes difficult to correctly demarcate the expenditures
into revenue and capital category. In normal usage, the advertising expenditure
is termed as revenue expenditure. However, a heavy expenditure on advertising
on launching a product is likely to give benefit for more than one accounting
period, as people are likely to remember the advertisement for a slightly longer
period. Such revenue expenditures, which are likely to give benefit for more
than one accounting period, are termed as deferred revenue expenditure.
It must be understood that expenditure is a wider term and includes
expenses as well as assets. There is a difference between expenditure and
expense. Expenditure is any outlay made/incurred by the business firm. The
part of the expenditure, which is perceived to have been used or consumed in
the current year, is termed as expense of the current year.
Revenue expenditure is treated as expenses of the current year and is
shown in trading and profit and loss account. Hence, salary paid by the
business firm is treated as an expense of the current year. Capital expenditures
are also ultimately charged to income statement and are spread over to more
than one accounting period. Hence, furniture of Rs. 50,000 if expected to be
used for 5 years will be treated as expense @ Rs. 10,000 per year. The name
given for the expense is depreciation. The treatment of deferred revenue
expenditure is same as of capital expenditure. They are also written-off over
their expected period of benefit.

Financial Statements - I

335

9.2.2 Receipts
The similar treatment is given the receipts of the business. If the receipts
imply an obligation to return the money, these are capital receipts. The example
can be an additional capital brought in by the owner or a loan taken from the
bank. Both receipts are leading to obligations, the first to the owner (called
equity) and the other to the outsiders (called liabilities). Another example on a
capital receipt can be the sale of a fixed asset like old machinery or furniture.
However, if a receipt does not incur an obligation to return the money or is
not in the form of a sale of fixed asset, it is termed as revenue receipt. The
examples of such receipts sales made by the firm and interest on investment
received by the firm.
9.2.3 Importance of Distinction between Capital and Revenue
As stated earlier, the distinction between capital and revenue items has
important implications for the preparation of trading and profit and loss
account and the balance sheet as all items of revenue value are to the shown
in the trading and profit and loss account and the items of capital nature in
the balance sheet. If any item is wrongly classified, i.e. if any item of revenue
nature is treated as capital item or vice-versa, the ascertainment of profit or
loss will be incorrect. For example, the revenues earned during an accounting
period are Rs. 10,00,000 and the expenses shown are Rs. 8,00,000, the profit
shall work out as Rs. 2,00,000. On scrutiny of the details, you find that a
revenue item of Rs. 20,000 (an expenditure on repairs of machinery) has been
treated as capital expenditure (added to the cost of machinery and debited to
machinery account, not to repairs account), and hence, does not form part of
the expenses for the period. It means the actual expenses for the period are
Rs. 8,20,000 and not Rs. 8,00,000. So, the correct profit is Rs. 1,80,000, not
Rs. 2,00,000. In other words, the profit has been over stated. Similarly, if any
capital expenditure is wrongly shown as revenue expenditure (for example,
purchase of furniture shown as purchases), it will result in under statement
of profits, and also an under statement of assets. Thus, the financial statements
will not reflect the true and fair view of the affairs of the business. Hence, it is
necessary to identify the correct nature of each item and treat it accordingly
in the book of accounts. It is also important from taxation point of view because
capital profits are taxed differently from revenue profits.
9.3 Financial Statements
It has been emphasised that various users have diverse informational
requirements. Instead of generating particular information useful for specific
users, the business prepares a set of financial statements, which in general
satisfies the informational needs of the users.

336

Accountancy

The basic objectives of preparing financial statements are :


(a) To present a true and fair view of the financial performance of the
business;
(b) To present a true and fair view of the financial position of the business;
and
For this purpose, the firm usually prepares the following financial statements:
1. Trading and Profit and Loss Account
2. Balance Sheet
Trading and Profit and Loss account, also known as Income statement,
shows the financial performance in the form of profit earned or loss sustained
by the business. Balance Sheet shows financial position in the form of assets,
liabilities and capital. These are prepared on the basis of trial balance and
additional information, if any.
Example 1
Observe the following trial balance of Ankit and signify correctly the various elements of
accounts and you will notice that the debit balances represent either assets or expenses/
losses and the credit balance represent either equity/liabilities or revenue/gains.
[This trial balance of Ankit will be used throughout the chapter to understand the process of
preparation of financial statements]
Trial Balance of Ankit as on March 31, 2005
Account Title

Cash
Capital
Bank
Sales
Wages
Creditors
Salaries
10% Long term loan (raised on April 01, 2004)
Furniture
Commission received
Rent of building
Debtors
Bad debts
Purchases

L.F.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

1,000
12,000
5,000
1,25,000
8,000
15,000
25,000
5,000
15,000
5,000
13,000
15,500
4,500
75,000
1,62,000

1,62,000

Financial Statements - I

337

Analysis of Trial Balance of Ankit as on March 31, 2005


Account Title

Elements

Cash
Capital
Bank
Sales
Wages
Creditors
Salaries
10% Long-term loan
(raised on April 01, 2004)
Furniture
Commission received
Rent of building
Debtors
Bad debts
Purchases

Asset
Equity
Asset
Revenue
Expense
Liability
Expense
Liability
Asset
Revenue
Expense
Asset
Expense
Expense

L.F.

Debit
Amount
Rs.
1,000

Credit
Amount
Rs.
12,000

5,000
1,25,000
8,000
15,000
25,000
5,000
15,000
5,000
13,000
15,500
4,500
75,000
1,62,000

1,62,000

9.4 Trading and Profit and Loss Account


Trading and Profit and Loss account is prepared to determine the profit earned
or loss sustained by the business enterprise during the accounting period. It
is basically a summary of revenues and expenses of the business and calculates
the net figure termed as profit or loss. Profit is revenue less expenses. If
expenses are more than revenues, the figure is termed as loss. Trading and
Profit and Loss account summarises the performance for an accounting period.
It is achieved by transferring the balances of revenues and expenses to the
trading and profit and loss account from the trial balance. Trading and Profit
and Loss account is also an account with Debit and Credit sides. It can be
observed that debit balances (representing expenses) and losses are transferred
to the debit side of the Trading and a Profit and Loss account and credit
balance (representing revenues/gains) are transfered to its credit side.
9.4.1 Relevant Items in Trading and Profit and Loss Account
The different items appearing in the trading and profit and loss account are
explained hereunder:
Items on the debit side
(i) Opening stock : It is the stock of goods in hand at the beginning of the
accounting year. This is the stock of goods which has been carried forward

338

(ii)

(iii)

(iv)

(v)
(vi)

(vii)

(viii)

(ix)
(x)

Accountancy

from the previous year and remains unchanged during the year and
appears in the trial balance. In the trading account it appears on the
debit side because it forms the part of cost of goods sold for the current
accounting year.
Purchases less returns : Goods, which have been bought for resale
appears as purchases on the debit side of the trading account. They
include both cash as well as credit purchases. Goods which are returned
to suppliers are termed as purchases return. It is shown by way of
deduction from purchases and the computed amount is known as Net
purchases.
Wages : Wages refer to renumeration paid to workers who are directly
engaged in factory for loading, unloading and production of goods and
are debited to trading account.
Carriage inwards/Freight inwards: These expenses are the items of
transport expenses, which are incurred on bringing materials/goods
purchased to the place of business. These items are paid in respect of
purchases made during the year and are debited to the trading account.
Fuel/Water/Power/Gas : These items are used in the production process
and hence are part of expenses.
Packaging material and Packing charges : Cost of packaging material
used in the product are direct expenses as it refers to small containers
which form part of goods sold. However, the packing refers to the big
containers that are used for transporting the goods and is regarded as
an indirect expense debited to profit and loss account.
Salaries : These include salaries paid to the administration, godown
and warehouse staff for the services rendered by them for running the
business. If salaries are paid in kind by providing certain facilities (called
perks) to the employees such as rent free accommodation, meals,
uniform, medical facilities should also be regarded as salaries and
debited to the profit and loss account.
Rent paid : These include office and godown rent, municipal rates and
taxes, factory rent, rates and taxes. The amount of rent paid is shown
on the debit side of the profit and loss account.
Interest paid : Interest paid on loans, bank overdraft, renewal of bills of
exchange, etc. is an expense and is debited to profit and loss account.
Commission paid: Commission paid or payable on business transactions
undertaken through the agents is an item of expense and is debited to
profit and loss account.

Financial Statements - I

339

(xi) Repairs : Repairs and small renewals/ replacements relating to plant


and machinery, furniture, fixtures, fittings, etc. for keeping them in
working condition are included under this head. Such expenditure is
debited to profit and loss account.
(xii) Miscellaneous expenses : Though expenses are classified and booked
under different heads, but certain expenses being of small amount
clubbed together and are called miscellaneous expenses. In normal
usage these expenses are called Sundry expenses or Trade expenses.
Items on the credit side
(i) Sales less returns : Sales account in trial balance shows gross total
sales(cash as well as credit) made during the year. It is shown on the
credit side of the trading account. Goods returned by customers are
called return inwards and are shown as deduction from total sales and
the computed amount is known as net sales.
(ii) Other incomes : Besides salaries and other gains and incomes are also
recorded in the profit and loss account. Examples of such incomes are
rent received, dividend received, interest received, discount received,
commission received, etc.
9.4.2 Closing Entries
The preparation of trading and profit and loss account requires that the
balances of accounts of all concerned items are transferred to it for its
compilation.
Opening stock account, Purchases account, Wages account, Carriage
inwards account and direct expenses account are closed by transferring
to the debit side of the trading and profit and loss account.
This is done by recording the following entry :
Trading A/c
Dr.
To Opening stock A/c
To Purchases A/c
To Wages A/c
To Carriage inwards A/c
To All other direct expenses A/c
The purchases returns or return outwards are closed by transferring its
balance to the purchases account. The following entry is recorded for this
purpose :
Purchases return A/c
Dr.
Purchases A/c

340

Accountancy

Similarly, the sales returns or returns inwards account is closed by


transferring its balance to the sales account as :
Sales A/c
Dr.
To Sales return A/c
The sales account is closed by transferring its balance to the credit side of
the trading and profit and loss account by recording the following entry:
Sales A/c
Dr.
To Trading A/c
Items of expenses, losses, etc. are closed by recording the following entries:
Profit and Loss A/c
Dr.
To Expenses (individually) A/c
To Losses (individually) A/c
Items of incomes, gains, etc. are closed by recording the following entry:
Incomes (individually) A/c
Dr.
Gains (individually) A/c
Dr.
To Profit and Loss A/c
The posting for closing the seven accounts of expenses and revenues as they
appear in the trial balance (in our example 1) are given below:
(i) For closing the accounts of expenses
Trading A/c
Dr.
83,000
To Purchases A/c
75,000
To Wages A/c
8,000
(ii) Profit and Loss A/c
Dr.
43,500
To Salaries
25,000
To Rent of building
13,000
To Bad debts
4,500
(i) For closing the accounts of revenues
Sales A/c
Dr.
1,25,000
To Trading A/c
1,25,000
(ii) Commission received A/c
Dr.
5,000
To Profit and Loss A/c
5,000
The posting done in ledger will appear as follows :
Purchases Account
Dr.
Date

Cr.
Particulars
Balance b/d

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
75,000
75,000

Date

Particulars
Trading

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
75,000
75,000

Financial Statements - I

341
Wages Account

Dr.
Date

Particulars

J.F.

Balance b/d

Amount
Rs.
8,000

Date

Particulars

J.F.

Trading

8,000

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
8,000
8,000

Salaries Account
Dr.
Date

Particulars

J.F.

Balance b/d

Amount
Rs.

Date

25,000

Particulars

J.F.

Profit and Loss

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
25,000

25,000

25,000

Rent of Building Account


Dr.
Date

Particulars

J.F.

Balance b/d

Amount
Rs.

Date

13,000

Particulars

J.F.

Profit and Loss

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
13,000

13,000

13,000

Bad Debts Account


Dr.
Date

Particulars

J.F.

Balance b/d

Amount
Rs.

Date

4,500

Particulars

J.F.

Profit and Loss

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
4,500

4,500

4,500

Sales Account
Dr.
Date

Particulars

J.F.

Trading

Amount
Rs.

Date

1,25,000

Particulars

J.F.

Balance b/d

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
1,25,000

1,25,000

1,25,000

Commission Received Account


Dr.
Date

Particulars
Profit and Loss

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
5,000
5,000

Date

Particulars
Balance b/d

J.F.

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
5,000
5,000

342

Accountancy

As the result of the foregoing discussion, we will now learn how the trading
and profit and loss account can be prepared from the trial balance, the format
of which is shown in figure 9.2. However, this list is not exhaustive.
In real sense, there can be many more of other items, which we will be dealing
at the later stage and there you will notice how this format undergoes a change
with respect to each one of them.
Trading and Profit and Loss Account of ABC
for the year ended March 31, 2005
Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses
Opening stock
Purchases
Wages
Carriage inwards/
Freight inwards/cartage
Gross profit c/d1
Gross loss b/d2

Amount
Rs.
.....
.....
.....
.....

Revenues/Gains
Sales

xxx

Rent/rates and taxes


Salaries
Repairs and renewals
Bad debts
Net profit2 (transfered to
capital account)

.....
.....
.....
.....
.....

xxx
Gross loss c/d1
Gross profit b/d
Inerest received

.....
.....
.....
.....

Net loss2

xxx
1,2

Amount
Rs.
.....

xxx

only one item will be shown


Fig. 9.2 : A format trading and profit and loss account

9.4.3 Concept of Gross Profit and Net Profit


The trading and profit and loss can be seen as combination of two accounts,
viz. Trading account and Profit and Loss account. The trading account or the
first part ascertains the gross profit and profit and loss account or the second
part ascertains net profit.
Trading Account
The trading account ascertains the result from basic operational activities of
the business. The basic operational activity involves the manufacturing,
purchasing and selling of goods. It is prepared to ascertain whether the selling

Financial Statements - I

343

of goods and/or rendering of services to customers have proved profitable for


the business or not. Purchases is one of the main constituents of expenses in
business organisation. Besides purchases, the remaining expenses are divided
into two categories, viz. direct expenses and indirect expenses.
Direct expenses means all expenses directly connected with the manufacture,
purchase of goods and bringing them to the point of sale. Direct expenses
include carriage inwards, freight inwards, wages, factory lighting, coal, water
and feul, royalty on production, etc. In our example-1, besides purchases,
four more items of expenses are listed. These are wages, salaries, rent of
building and bad debts. Out of these items, wages is treated as direct expense
while the other three are treated as indirect expenses.
Similarly, sales constitute the main item of revenue for the business. The
excess of sales over purchases and direct expenses is called gross profit. If
the amount of purchases including direct expenses is more than the sales
revenue, the resultant figure is gross loss. The computation of gross profit
can be shown in the form of equation as :
Gross Profit = Sales (Purchases + Direct Expenses)
The gross profit or the gross loss is transferred to profit and loss account.
The indirect expenses are transferred to the debit side of the second part,
viz. profit and loss account. All revenue/gains other than sales are transferred
to the credit side of the profit and loss account. If the total of the credit side of
the profit and loss account is more than the total of the debit side, the difference
is the net profit for the period of which it is being prepared. On the other hand,
if the total of the debit side is more than the total of the credit side, the
difference is the net loss incurred by the business firm. In an equation form,
it is shown as follows :
Net Profit = Gross Profit + Other Incomes Indirect Expenses
Net profit or net loss so computed is transferred to the capital account in
the balance sheet by way of the following entry :
(i) For transfer of net profit
Profit and Loss A/c
Dr.
To Capital A/c
(ii) For transfer of net loss
Capital A/c
Dr.
To Profit and Loss A/c
We are now redrafting the trading and profit and loss account to show gross
profit and net profit of Ankit for the year ended March 31, 2005. The redrafted
trading and profit and loss account will look like as shown is shown in figure 9.3.

344

Accountancy
Trading and Profit and Loss Account of Ankit
for the year ended March 31, 2005

Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses

Amount
Rs.

Purchases
Wages
Gross profit c/d

75,000
8,000
42,000
1,25,000

Salaries
Rent of building
Bad debts
Net Profit (transfered to
capital account)

25,000
13,000
4,500
4,500

Revenues/Gains
Sales

Amount
Rs.
1,25,000

1,25,000
Gross profit b/d
Commission received

42,000
5,000

47,000

47,000

Fig. 9.3 : Showing the computation of gross profit and net profit of Ankit

Gross profit, which represents the basic operational activity of the business
is computed as Rs. 42,000. The gross profit is transferred from trading account
to profit and loss account. Besides gross profit, business has earned an income
of Rs. 5,000 as commission received and has spent Rs. 42,500 (Rs. 25,000 +
Rs.13,000 + Rs.4,500) on expenses/losses including salaries, rent and bad
debts. Therefore, the net profit is calculated as Rs. 4,500.
Illustration 1
Prepare a trading account from the following particulars for the year ended March 31, 2006:
Rs.
Opening stock
37,500
Purchases
1, 05000
Sales
2,70,000
Wages
30,000

Solution
Trading Account
for the year ended March 31, 2006
Dr.
Expenses/Losses
Opening stock
Purchases
Wages
Gross profit

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
37,500
1,05,000
30,000
97,500
2,70,000

Revenues/Gains
Sales

Amount
Rs.
2,70,000

2,70,000

Financial Statements - I

345

Illustration 2
Prepare a trading account of M/s Prime Products from the following particulars pertaining
to the year 2005-06.
Rs.
Opening stock
50,000
Purchases
1,10,000
Return inwards
5,000
Sales
3,00,000
Return outwards
7,000
Factory rent
30,000
Wages
40,000
Solution
Books of Prime Products
Trading Account
for the year ended March 31, 2006
Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses
Opening stock
Purchases
Less : Return
outwards
Factory rent
Wages
Gross profit

1,10,000
(7,000)

Amount
Rs.

Revenues/Gains

50,000

Sales
3,00,000
Less : Return
(5,000)
inwards

1,03,000
30,000
40,000
72,000
2,95,000

Amount
Rs.
2,95,000

2,95,000

Illustration 3.
Prepare a trading account of M/s Anjali from the following information related to 2005-06.
Rs.
Opening stock
60,000
Purchases
3, 00,000
Sales
7, 50,000
Purchases return
18,000
Sales return
30,000
Carriage on purchases
12,000
Carriage on sales
15,000
Factory rent
18,000
Office rent
18,000
Dock and Clearing charges 48,000
Freight and Octroi
6,500
Coal, Gas and Water
10,000

346

Accountancy

Solution
Books of Anjali
Trading Account
for the year ended 2005-06
Dr.
Expenses/Losses
Opening stock
Purchases
3,00,000
Less : Purchases return (18,000)
Carriage on purchases
Factory rent
Dock and Clearing charges
Freight and Octroi
Coal, Gas and Water
Gross profit

Amount
Rs.
60,000

Revenues/Gains

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

Sales
7,50,000
Less : Sales return (30,000) 7,20,000

2,82,000
12,000
18,000
48,000
6,500
10,000
2,83,500
7,20,000

7,20,000

Illustration 4
From the following information, prepare a profit and loss account for the year ending March
31, 2005.
Rs.
Gross profit
60,000
Rent
5,000
Salary
15,000
Commission paid
7,000
Interest paid on loan
5,000
Advertising
4,000
Discount received
3,000
Printing and stationery
2,000
Legal charges
5,000
Bad debts
1,000
Depreciation
2,000
Interest received
4,000
Loss by fire
3,000
Profit and Loss Account
for the year ended March 31, 2005
Dr.
Expenses/Losses
Rent
Salary
Commission
Interest paid on loan
Advertising
Printing and Stationery
Legal charges

Amount
Rs.

Revenues/Gains

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

5,000
15,000
7,000
5,000
4,000
2,000
5,000

Gross profit
Discount received
Interest received

60,000
3,000
4,000

Financial Statements - I

347

Bad debts
Depreciation
Loss by fire
Net profit (transferred to the
capital account)

1,000
2,000
3,000
18,000
67,000

67,000

Test Your Understanding - I


I State True or False :
(i) Gross profit is total revenue.
(ii) In trading and profit and loss account, opening stock appears on the debit side
because it forms the part of the cost of sales for the current accounting year.
(iii) Rent, rates and taxes is an example of direct expenses.
(iv) If the total of the credit side of the profit and loss account is more than the total
of the debit side, the difference is the net profit.
II Match the items given under A with the correct items under B
(i)
(ii)
(iii)
(iv)
(v)

Closing stock is credited to


Accuracy of book of account is tested by
On returning the goods to seller, the buyer sends
The financial position is determined by
On receiving the returned goods from the
buyer, the seller sends

(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)

Trial balance
Trading account
Credit note
Balance sheet
Debit note

9.4.4 Cost of Goods Sold and Closing StockTrading Account Revisited


The trading and profit and loss account prepared in figure 9.3 presents useful
information as to the profitability from the basic operations of the business
enterprise. It is reproduced for further perusal.
Trading Account of Ankit
for the year ended March 31, 2005
Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses

Amount
Rs.

Revenues/Gains

Purchases
Wages
Gross profit

75,000
8,000
42,000

Sales

1,25,000
Fig. 9.4 : An illutrative trading account of Ankit

Amount
Rs.
1,25,000

1,25,000

348

Accountancy

If there is no opening or closing stock, the total of purchases and direct


expenses is taken as Cost of goods sold. In our example, notice that purchases
amount to Rs. 75,000 and wages amounts to Rs. 8,000. Hence, the cost of
goods sold will be computed using the following formula :
Cost of Goods Sold = Purchases + Direct Expenses
= Rs.75, 000 + Rs. 8,000
= Rs. 83,000
As there is no unsold stock,the presumption here is that all the goods
purchased have been sold. But in practice, there is some unsold goods at the
end of the accounting period.
In our example, let us assume that out of the goods purchased amounting
to Rs. 75,000 in the current year, Ankit is able to sell goods costing Rs. 60,000
only. In such a situation, the business will have an unsold stock of goods
costing Rs. 15,000 in hand, also called closing stock. The amount of cost of
goods sold will be computed as per the following equation :
Cost of Goods Sold = Purchases + Direct Expenses Closing Stock
= Rs. 75,000 + Rs. 8,000 Rs. 15,000
As a result, the amount of gross profit will also change with the existence
of closing stock in business from Rs. 42,000 (as computed in figure 9.4) to
Rs. 57,000 ( refer figure 9.5).
Trading Account of Ankit
for the year ended March 31, 2005
Expenses/Losses

Amount
Rs.

Revenues/Gains

Purchases
Wages
Gross profit c/d

75,000
8,000
57,000

Sales
Closing stock

1,40,000
Salaries
Rent of building
Bad debts
Net Profit (transfered to
capital account)

25,000
13,000
4,500
19,500

Amount
Rs.
1,25,000
15,000
1,40,000

Gross profit b/d


Commission received

62,000
Fig. 9.5 : The trading account of Ankit

57,000
5,000

62,000

Financial Statements - I

349

It may be noted that closing stock does not normally form part of trial
balance, and is brought into books with the help of the following journal
entry :
Closing stock A/c
To Trading A/c

Dr.

This entry opens a new account of asset, i.e. closing stock Rs. 15,000
which is transferred to the balance sheet. The closing stock shall be an opening
stock for the next year and shall be sold during the year. In most cases,
therefore, the business shall have opening stock as well as closing stock every
year, and the cost of goods sold should be worked as per the following equation:
Cost of Goods Sold = Opening Stock+Purchases Direct ExpensesClosing Stock
Look at Illustration 5 and see how it has been computed.
Illustration 5
Compute cost of goods sold for the years 2005 with the help of the following information
and prepare trading account
Rs.
Sales
Purchases
Wages
Stock (Apr. 01, 2004)
Stock (March 31, 2005)
Freight inwards

20, 00,000
15, 00,000
1, 00,000
3, 00,000
4,00,000
1,00,000

Solution
Computation of Cost of Goods Sold
Particulars
Opening stock
Add Purchases
Direct expenses :
Freight inwards
Wages

Amount
Rs.
3,00,000
15,00,000

Less Closing stock

1,00,000
1,00,000
20,00,000
(4,00,000)

Cost of goods sold

16,00,000

350

Accountancy
Trading Account
for the year ended March 31, 2005

Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses

Amount
Rs.
3,00,000
15,00,000
1,00,000
1,00,000
4,00,000

Opening stock
Purchases
Freight inwards
Wages
Gross profit

Revenues/Gains
Sales
Closing stock

24,00,000

Amount
Rs.
20,00,000
4,00,000

24,00,000

Illustration 6
From the following balances obtained from the few accounts of Mr. H. Balaram. Prepare the
Trading and Profit and Loss Account.
Rs.
Rs.
Stock on Apr. 01, 2004
8,000
Bad debts
1,200
Purchases for the year
22,000
Rent
1,200
Sales for the year
42,000
Discount allowed
600
Purchase expenses
2,500
Commission paid
1,100
Salaries and wages
3,500
Sales expenses
600
Advertisement
1,000
Repairs
600
Closing stock on March 31, 2005 is Rs. 4,500
Books of H. Balaram
Trading Account
for the year ended March 31, 2005
Dr.
Expenses/Losses
Opening stock
Purchases
Purchase expenses
Gross profit c/d
Salaries and Wages
Rent
Advertisement
Commission
Discount allowed
Bad debts
Sales expenses
Repairs
Net profit
(transferred to capital account)

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
8,000
22,000
2,500
14,000
46,500
3,500
1,200
1,000
1,100
600
1,200
600
600
4,200
14,000

Revenues/Gains
Sales
Closing stock

Amount
Rs.
42,000
4,500

Gross profit b/d

46,500
14,000

14,000

Financial Statements - I

351

9.5 Operating Profit (EBIT)


It is the profit earned through the normal operations and activities of
the business. Operating profit is the excess of operating revenue over
operating expenses. While calculating operating profit, the incomes and
expenses of a purely financial nature are not taken into account. Thus,
operating profit is profit before interest and tax (EBIT). Similarly,
abnormal items such as loss by fire, etc. are also not taken into account.
It is calculated as follows :
Operating profit = Net Profit + Non Operating Expenses Non Operating Incomes
Refer to the trial balance of Ankit in example 1, you will notice that it
depicts an item relating to 10 % interest on long-term loan raised on
April 01, 2004. The amount of interest works out to Rs. 500 (Rs. 5,000
10/100), which has been shown on the debit side of the trading and profit
and loss account (figure 9.6).
Trading and Profit and Loss Account of Ankit
for the year ended March 31, 2005
Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses

Amount
Rs.

Revenues/Gains

Purchases
Wages
Gross profit c/d

75,000
8,000
57,000

Sales
Closing stock

1,40,000
Salaries
Rent of building
Bad debts
Interest
Net Profit (transfered to
capital account)

25,000
13,000
4,500
500
19,000

Amount
Rs.
1,25,000
15,000
1,40,000

Gross profit b/d


Commission received

62,000

57,000
5,000

62,000

Fig. 9.6 : Showing the treatment of interest on profit

The operating profit will be :


Operating profit = Net profit + Non-operating expenses Non-operating incomes
Operating profit = Rs. 19,000 + 500 nil
= Rs. 19,500

352

Accountancy
Test Your Understanding - II

Choose the correct option in the following questions :


1. The financial statements consist of:
(i) Trial balance
(ii) Profit and loss account
(iii) Balance sheet
(iv) (i) & (iii)
(v) (ii) & (iv)
2. Choose the correct chronological order of ascertainment of the following profits from
the profit and loss account :
(i) Operating Profit, Net Profit, Gross Profit
(ii) Operating Profit, Gross Profit, Net Profit
(iii) Gross Profit, Operating Profit, Net Profit
(iv) Gross Profit, Net Profit, Operating Profit
3. While calculating operating profit, the following are not taken into account.
(i) Normal transactions
(ii) Abnormal items
(iii) Expenses of a purely financial nature
(iv) (ii) & (iii)
(v) (i) & (iii)
4. Which of the following is correct :
(i) Operating Profit = Operating profit Non-operating expenses Non-operating
incomes
(ii) Operating profit = Net profit + Non-operating Expenses + Non-operating incomes
(iii) Operating profit = Net profit + Non-operating Expenses Non-operating incomes
(iv) Operating profit = Net profit Non-operating Expenses + Non-operating incomes

Illustration 7
Following balance is extracted from the books of a trader ascertain gross profit, operating
profit and net profit for the year ended March 31, 2005.
Particulars

Amount
Rs.

Sales
Purchases
Opening stock
Sales return
Purchases return
Rent
Stationary and printing
Salaries
Misc. expenses
Travelling expenses
Advertisement

75,250
32,250
7,600
1,250
250
300
250
3,000
200
500
1,800

Financial Statements - I

353

Commission paid
Office expenses
Wages
Profit on sale of investment
Depreciation
Dividend on investment
Loss on sale of old furniture

150
1,600
2,600
500
800
2,500
300

Closing stock (March 31, 2005) valued at Rs. 8,000


Trading and Profit and Loss Account
for the year ended March 31, 2005
Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses
Opening stock
Purchases
Less: Purchases return
Wages
Gross profit c/d

Amount
Rs.
7,600
32,250
(250)

32,000
2,600
39,800

Revenues/Gains
Sales
Less : Sales return
Closing stock

Amount
Rs.
75,250
(1,250)

82,000
Rent
Stationary and printing
Salaries
Misc. expenses
Travelling expenses
Advertisement expenses
Commission paid
Office expenses
Depreciation
Operating profit c/d

300
250
3,000
200
500
1,800
150
1,600
800
31,200

82,000
Gross profit b/d

39,800
Loss on sale of old furniture
Net Profit (transferred to capital
account)

300
33,900
34,200

74,000
8,000

39,800

39,800
Operating profit b/d
Profit on sale of investment
Dividend on investment

31,200
500
2,500
34,200

9.6 Balance Sheet


The balance sheet is a statement prepared for showing the financial position
of the business summarising its assets and liabilities at a given date. The
assets reflect debit balances and liabilities (including capital) reflect credit
balances. It is prepared at the end of the accounting period after the trading

354

Accountancy

and profit and loss account have been prepared. It is called balance sheet
because it is a statement of balances of ledger accounts that have not been
transferred to trading and profit and loss account and are to be carried forward
to the next year with the help of an opening entry made in the journal at the
beginning of the next year.
9.6.1 Preparing Balance Sheet
All the account of assets, liabilities and capital are shown in the balance
sheet. Accounts of capital and liabilities are shown on the left hand
side, known as Liabilities. Assets and other debit balances are shown
on the right hand side, known as Assets. There is no prescribed form of
Balance sheet, for a proprietary and partnership firms. However, Schedule
VI Part I of the Companies Act 1956 prescribes the format and the order
in which the assets and liabilities of a company should be shown. The
normal format in which the balance sheet is prepared is shown in the
figure 9.7.
Balance Sheet of ...........as at March 31, 2005
Liabilities
Capital
.....
Add Profit
.....
Long-term loan
Short-term loan
Sundry creditors
Bills payable
Bank overdraft

Amount
Rs.
.....
.....
.....

Assets
Furniture
Cash
Bank
Goodwill
Sundry debtors
Closing stock
Land and Buildings

xxxx

Amount
Rs.
.....
.....
.....
.....
.....

xxxx

Fig. 9.7 : Format of a balance sheet

Refer to our example -1 you will observe that the trial balance of Ankit
depicts 14 accounts, out of which 7 accounts have been transferred to the
trading and profit and loss account (refer figure 9.3). These are the accounts
of revenues and expenses. The analysis of figure 9.3 shows that the business
has incurred total expenses of Rs. 1, 25,500 and revenues generated are
Rs. 1, 30,000 making a profit of Rs. 4,500. The remaining seven items in the
trial balance reflects the capital, assets and liabilities. We are reproducing the
trial balance (example -1) to show how the accounts of assets and liabilities of
Ankit would be presented in the balance sheet.

Financial Statements - I

355

Trial Balance of Ankit as on March 31, 2005


Account Title

L.F.

Cash
Capital
Bank
Sales
Wages
Creditors
Salaries
10% Long-term loan
(raised on April 01, 2004)
Furniture
Commission received
Rent of building
Debtors
Bad debts
Purchases

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

1,000
12,000
5,000
1,25,000
8,000
15,000
25,000
5,000
15,000
5,000
13,000
15,500
4,500
75,000
1,62,000

1,62,000

Fig. 9.8 : Showing the accounts of assets and liabilities in the trial balance of Ankit
Balance Sheet of Ankit as at March 31, 2005
Liabilities

Amount
Rs.

Capital
12,000
Add Profit
4,500
10 % Long-term loan
Creditors

16,500
5,000
15,000

Assets

Amount
Rs.

Furniture
Cash
Bank
Debtors

15,000
1,000
5,000
15,500

36,500

36,500

Fig. 9.9 : Showing the balance sheet of Ankit

9.6.2 Relevant Items in the Balance Sheet


Items which are generally included in a balance sheet are explained below :
(1) Current Assets: Current assets are those which are either in the form of
cash or a can be converted into cash within a year. The examples of
such assets are cash in hand/bank, bills receivable, stock of raw
materials, semi-finished goods and finished goods, sundry debtors, short
term investments, prepaid expenses, etc.

356

Accountancy

(2) Current Liabilities: Current liabilities are those liabilities which are
expected to be paid within a year and which are usually to be paid out of
current assets. The examples of such liabilities are bank overdraft, bills
payable, sundry creditors, short-term loans, outstanding expenses, etc.
(3) Fixed Assets: Fixed assets are those assets, which are held on a long-term
basis in the business. Such assets are not acquired for the purpose of resale,
e.g. land, building, plant and machinery, furniture and fixtures, etc. Some
times the term Fixed Block or Block Capital is also used for them.
(4) Intangible Assets : These are such assets which cannot be seen or touched.
Goodwill, Patents, Trademarks are some of the examples of intangible assets.
(5) Investments: Investments represent the funds invested in government
securities, shares of a company, etc. They are shown at cost price. If, on
the date of preparation the balance sheet, the market price of investments
is lower than the cost price, a footnote to that effect may be appended to
the balance sheet.
(6) Long-term Liabilities : All liabilities other than the current liabilities are
known as long-term liabilities. Such liabilities are usually payable after
one year of the date of the balance sheet. The important items of long
term liabilities are long-term loans from bank and other financial
institutions.
(7) Capital: It is the excess of assets over liabilities due to outsiders. It
represents the amount originally contributed by the proprietor/ partners
as increased by profits and interest on capital and decreased by losses
drawings and intrest on drawings.
(8) Drawings : Amount withdrawn by the proprietor is termed as drawings
and has the effect of reducing the balance on his capital account.
Therefore, the drawings account is closed by transferring its balance to
his capital account. However it is shown by way of deduction from capital
in the balance sheet.
9.6.3 Marshalling and Grouping of Assets and Liabilities
A major concern of accounting is about preparing and presenting the financial
statement. The information so provided should be decision useful for the users.
Therefore, it becomes necessary that the items appearing in the balance sheet
should be properly grouped and presented in a particular order.
Marshalling of Assets and Liabilities
In a balance sheet, the assets and liabilities are arranged either in the
order of liquidity or permanence. Arrangement of assets and liabilities in a
particular order is known as Marshalling.
In case of permanence, the most permanent asset or liability is put on the
top in the balance sheet and thereafter the assets are arranged in their reducing
level of permanence.

Financial Statements - I

357

In the balance sheet of Ankit you will find that furniture is the most
permanent of all the assets. Out of debtors, bank and cash, debtors will take
maximum time to convert back into cash. Bank is less liquid than cash. Cash
is the most liquid of all the assets. Similarly, on the liabilities side, the capital,
being the most important source of finance will tend to remain in the business
for a longer period than the long-term loan. Creditors being a liquid liability
will be discharged in the near future. The balance sheet of Ankit in the order
of permanence is shown in figure 9.10(a).
Balance Sheet of Ankit as on March 31, 2005 (in order of permanence)
Liabilities

Amount
Rs.

Capital
12,000
Add Profit
4,500
10 % Long-term loan
Creditors

16,500
5,000
15,000

Assets

Amount
Rs.

Furniture
Debtors
Bank
Cash

15,000
15,500
5,000
1,000

36,500

36,500

Fig. 9.10 (a) : Items of balance sheet shown in the order of permanance

In case of liquidity, the order is reversed. The information presented in


this manner would enable the user to have a good idea about the life of the
various accounts. The assets account of the relatively permanent nature would
continue in the business for a longer time whereas the less permanent or
more liquid accounts will change their forms in the near future and are likely
to become cash or cash equivalent.
The balance sheet of Ankit in the order of liquidity is shown in figure 9.10(b)
Balance Sheet of Ankit as at March31,2005
(in order of liquidity)
Liabilities

Amount
Rs.

Assets

Amount
Rs.

Creditors
10 % Long-term loan
Capital
12,000
Add Profit
4,500

15,000
5,000

Cash
Bank
Debtors
Furniture

1,000
5,000
15,500
15,000

16,500
36,500

Fig. 9.10 (b) : Items of balance sheet shown in the order of liquidity

36,500

358

Accountancy

Grouping of Assets and Liabilities


The items appearing in the balance sheet can also be properly grouped. The
term grouping means putting together items of similar nature under a common
heading. For example, the balance of accounts of cash, bank, debtors, etc.
can be grouped and shown under the heading of current assets and the
balances of all fixed assets and long-term investment under the heading of
non-current assets.
Balance Sheet of Ankit as at March 31, 2005
(in order of permanence)
Liabilities

Amount
Rs.

Owners Funds
Capital
12,000
Add Profit
4,500
Non-Current Liabilities
Long-term loan
Current Liabilities
Creditors

16,500
5,000

Assets
Non Current Assets
Furniture
Current Assets
Debtors
Bank
Cash

Amount
Rs.
15,000
15,500
5,000
1,000

15,000
36,500

36,500

Fig. 9.10 (c): Showing assets and liabilities arranged in logical groups

Do it Yourself
Arrange the following items in the order of both permanence
and liquidity. Also group them under logical heads :
Liabilities

Assets

Long-term loans
Bank overdraft
Bills payable
Owners equity
Short-term loans
Sundry creditors

Building
Cash in hand
Cash at bank
Bills receivable
Sundry debtors
Land
Finished goods
Work in progress
Raw material

Financial Statements - I

359

Illustration 8
From the following balances prepare a trading and profit and loss account and balance
sheet for the year ended March 31, 2006
Account Title
Carriage on goods
purchased
Carriage on goods sold
Manufacturing expenses
Advertisement
Excise duty
Factory lighting
Debtors
Creditors
Dock and Clearing charges
Postage and Telegram
Fire Insurance Premium
Patents
Income tax
Office expenses

Amount
Rs.
8,000
3,500
42,000
7,000
6,000
4,400
80,000
61,000
5,200
800
3,600
12,000
24,000
7,200

Account Title
Cash in hand
Bank overdraft
Motor car
Drawings
Audit fees
Plant
Repairs to plant
Stock at the end
Purchases less return
Commission on purchases
Incidental trade expenses
Investment
Interest on investment
Capital
Sales less return
Salest tax paid
Discount allowed
Discount on purchases

Amount
Rs.
2,500
30,000
60,000
8,000
2,700
1,53,900
2,200
76,000
1,60,000
2,000
3,200
30,000
4,500
1,00,000
5,20,000
12,000
2,700
3,400

360

Accountancy
Trading and Profit and Loss Account
for the year ended March 31, 2006

Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses

Amount
Rs.

Purchases less return


1,60,000
Commission on purchases
2,000
Carriage on goods purchasesd
8,000
Manufacturing expenses
42,000
Factory lighting
4,400
Dock and Clearing charges
5,200
Gross profit c/d
2,98,400

Revenues/Gains
Sales less return

5,20,000
Carriage on sales
Advertisement
Excise duty
Postage and telegram
Fire Insurance premium
Office expenses
Audit fees
Repairs to plant
Incidental trading expenses
Sales tax paid
Discount allowed
Net profit
(transferred to capital
account)

3,500
7,000
6,000
800
3,600
7,200
2,700
2,200
3,200
12,000
2,700
2,55,400

Amount
Rs.
5,20,000

5,20,000
Gross profit b/d
Interest on investment
Discount on purchases

3,06,300

2,98,400
4,500
3,400

3,06,300

Balance Sheet as at March 31, 2006


Liabilities

Amount
Rs.

Assets

Bank overdraft
Creditors
Capital
Add Net profit

30,000
61,000

Cash in hand
Debtors
Closing stock
Investment
Motor car
Plant
Patents

Less Drawings
Less Income tax

1,00,000
2,55,400
3,55,400
(8,000)
3,47400
(24,000)

Amount
Rs.
2,500
80,000
76,000
30,000
60,000
1,53,900
12,000

3,23,400
4,14,400

4,14,400

Financial Statements - I

361

Illustration 9
From the following balances prepare trading and profit and loss account and balance sheet
for the year ended March 31, 2006
Account Title

Amount
Rs.

Opening stock
Purchases
Sales
Returns (Dr.)
Returns (Cr.)
Factory rent
Custom duty
Coal, gas & power
Wages and salary
Discount (Dr.)
Commission (Cr.)
Bad debts
Bad debts recovered
Apprenticeship premium
Production expenses
Adminstrative expenses
Carriage

15,310
82,400
256,000
4,000
2,400
18,000
11,500
6,000
36,600
7,500
1,200
5,850
2,000
4,800
2,600
5,000
8,700

Account Title

Amount
Rs.

Capital
Drawings
Sundry debtors
Sundry creditors
Depreciation
Charity
Cash balance
Bank balance
Bank charges
Establishment expenses
Plant
Leasehold building
Sales tax collected
Goodwill
Patents
Trademark
Loan (Cr.)
Interest on loan

2,50,000
48,000
57,000
12,000
4,200
500
4,460
4,000
180
3,600
42,000
1,50,000
2,000
20,000
10,000
5,000
25,000
3,000

The value of closing stock on March 31, 2006 was Rs. 25,400
Solution
Trading and Profit and Loss Account
for the year ended March 31, 2006
Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses
Opening stock
Purchases:
Less Returns :
Factory rent
Custom duty
Coal, gas, power
Wages and salary
Production expenses
Carriage
Gross profit c/d

Amount
Rs.
15,310
82,400
(2,400)

80,000
18,000
11,500
6,000
36,600
2,600
8,700
98,690
2,77,400

Revenues/Gains

Amount
Rs.

Sales:
Less Returns

2,56,000
(4,000) 2,52,000

Closing stock

25,400

2,77,400

362

Accountancy

Discount (Dr.)
Bad debts
Administrative expenses
Depreciation
Charity
Bank charges
Establishment expenses
Interest on loan
Net profit
(transferred to capital account)

7,500
5,850
5,000
4,200
500
180
3,600
3,000
76,860

Gross profit b/d


Commission
Bad debts recovered
Apprenticeship premium

1,06,690

98,690
1,200
2,000
4,800

1,06,690

Balance Sheet as at March 31, 2006


Liabilities

Amount
Rs.

Assets

Sales tax collected


Sundry creditors
Loan
Capital
Add Net profit

2,000
12,000
25,000

Cash balance
Bank balance
Sundry debtors
Closing stock
Leasehold building
Plant
Patents
Goodwill
Trade mark

2,50,000
76,860
3,26,860

Less Drawings

(48,000)

2,78,860
3,17,860

Amount
Rs.
4,460
4,000
57,000
25,400
1,50,000
42,000
10,000
5,000
20,000
3,17,860

9.7 Opening Entry


The balances of various accounts in balance sheet are carried forward from
one accounting period to another accounting period. In fact, the balance sheet
of an accounting period becomes the opening trial balance of the next
accounting period. Next year an opening entry is made which opens these
accounts contained in the balance sheet.
Refer the balance sheet shown in figure 9.10(c). The opening entry with
regard to it will be recorded as follows :
Furniture A/c
Dr.
15,000
Debtors A/c
Dr.
15,500
Banks A/c
Dr.
5,000
Cash A/c
Dr.
1,000
To Capital A/c
16,500
To 10 % Long-term loan A/c
5,000
To Creditors A/c
15,000

Financial Statements - I

363
Key Terms Introduced in the Chapter

Balance sheet
Bills payable
Capital
Capital receipts
Carriage outwards
Closing entries
Current assets
Purchases return
Return inwards
Revenue expenditure
Discount allowed
Cash
Factory expenses
Fixed assets
Gross Profit
Income tax
Interest on drawings
Net profit
Order of performance
Revenue receipt
Sales
Grouping and Marshalling

Bank overdraft
Bills receivable
Capital expenditure
Carriage inwards
Cash at bank
Closing stock
Currents liabilities
Rent
Return outwards
Depreciation
Discount received
Trade expenses
Financial statements
Freight
Gross Loss
Interest on capital
Net loss
Order of liquidity
Revenue expenditure
Salaries
Sales return

Summary with Reference to Learning Objectives


1

Meaning, usefulness and types of financial statements : After the agreement of


the trial balance, a business enterprise proceeds to prepare financial statements.
Financial statements are the statements, which present periodic reports on the
process of business enterprises and the results achieved during a given period.
Financial statements includs trading and profit and loss account, balance sheet
and other statements and explanatory notes, which form part thereof.
Information provided by financial statements is useful to management to plan
and control the business operations. Financial statement are also useful to
creditors, shareholders and employees of the enterprise.
Meaning need and preparation of trading and profit and loss account : The profit
and loss account highlights the profit earned or loss sustained by the business
entity in the course of business operation during a given period.
The need for preparing the trading and profit and loss account is to ascertain
the net result of business operations during a given period. The profit and loss
account shows the items of revenue expenses and losses on the debit side,
while items of gain and gross profit are shown on the credit side. For the
preparation of the trading and profit and loss account, closing entries are
recorded to transfer balances of account of items of expenses and revenues.
Net profit or net loss shown by the profit and loss account is transferred to the
capital account.

364

Accountancy
3

Meaning, characteristic, need and structure of the balance sheet : The balance
sheet is a statement of assets and liabilities of a business enterprise and shows
the financial position at a given date Informations contained in a balance sheet
is true only on that date. The balance sheet is a part of the final account. But it
is not an account, it is only a statement. In a balance sheet the totals of assets
and liabilities are always equal. It portrays the accounting equation.
A balance sheet has to be prepared to know the financial position of the
business, and the nature and values of its assets and liabilities. All the accounts
which have not been closed till the preparation of the profit and loss account
are shown in the balance sheet. Assets and liabilities shown in the balance
sheet are marshalled in order of liquidity or in order of permanence.
Questions for Practice

Short Answers
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.

6.

What are the objectives of preparing financial statements ?


What is the purpose of preparing trading and profit and loss account?
Explain the concept of cost of goods sold?
What is a balance sheet. What are its characteristics?
Distinguish between capital and revenue expenditure and state whether the
following statements are items of capital or revenue expenditure :
(a) Expenditure incurred on repairs and whitewashing at the time of
purchase of an old building in order to make it usable.
(b) Expenditure incurred to provide one more exit in a cinema hall in
compliance with a government order.
(a) Registration fees paid at the time of purchase of a building
(b) Expenditure incurred in the maintenance of a tea garden which will
produce tea after four years.
(c) Depreciation charged on a plant.
(d) The expenditure incurred in erecting a platform on which a machine will
be fixed.
(e) Advertising expenditure, the benefits of which will last for four years.
What is an operating profit?

Long Answars
1.
2.
3.
4.

What are financial statements? What information do they provide.


What are closing entries? Give four examples of closing entries.
Discuss the need of preparing a balance sheet.
What is meant by Grouping and Marshalling of assets and liabilities. Explain
the ways in which a balance sheet may be marshalled.

Numerical Questions
1.

From the following balances taken from the books of Simmi and Vimmi Ltd.
for the year ending March 31, 2003, calculate the gross profit.
(Rs.)
Closing stock
2,50,000
Net sales during the year
40,00,000
Net purchases during the year
15,00,000

Financial Statements - I

2.

3.

4.

5.

365

Opening stock
15,00,000
Direct expenses
80,000
(Ans. Gross profit Rs.11,70,000)
From the following balances extracted from the books of M/s Ahuja and
Nanda. Calculate the amount of :
(a) Cost of goods available for sale
(b) Cost of goods sold during the year
(c) Gross Profit
Rs.
Opening stock
25,000
Credit purchases
7,50,000
Cash purchases
3,00,000
Credit sales
12,00,000
Cash sales
4,00,000
Wages
1,00,000
Salaries
1,40,000
Closing stock
30,000
Sales return
50,000
Purchases return
10,000
(Ans. (a) Rs. 11,65,000 ; (b) Rs.11,35,000 ; (c) Rs.4,15,000
Calculate the amount of gross profit and operating profit on the basis of the
following balances extracted from the books of M/s Rajiv & Sons for the year
ended March 31, 2005.
Rs.
Opening stock
50,000
Net sales
11,00,000
Net purchases
6,00,000
Direct expenses
60,000
Administration expenses
45,000
Selling and distribution expenses
65,000
Loss due to fire
20,000
Closing stock
70,000
(Ans. Gross profit Rs.4,60,000, Operating profit Rs.3,50,000)
Operating profit earned by M/s Arora & Sachdeva in 2005-06 was
Rs.17,00,000. Its non-operating incomes were Rs.1,50,000 and non-operating
expenses were Rs.3,75,000. Calculate the amount of net profit earned by the
firm.
(Ans. Net profit Rs.14,75,000)
The following are the extracts from the trial balance of M/s Bhola & Sons as
on March 31, 2005
Account title
Opening stock
Purchases
Sales

Debit
Rs.
2,00,000
8,10,000

Credit
Rs.

10,10,000
10,10,000

(only relevant items)


Closing Stock as on date was valued at Rs.3,00,000.

10,10,000

366

Accountancy

6.

You are required to record the necessary journal entries and show how the
above items will appear in the trading and profit and loss account and balance
sheet of M/s Bhola & Sons.
Prepare trading and profit and loss account and balance sheet as on
March 31, 2005 :
Account Title

Amount
Rs.

Account Title

Machinery
Sundry debtors
Drawings
Purchases
Wages
Sundry expenses
Rent & taxes
Carriage inwards
Bank
Openings stock

27,000
21,600
2,700
58,500
15,000
600
1,350
450
4,500
6,000

Capital
Bills payable
Sundry creditors
Sales

Amount
Rs.
60,000
2,800
1,400
73,500

Closing stock as on March 31, 2005 Rs.22,400

7.

[Ans. Gross profit Rs.15,950, Net profit Rs.14,000, Total balance sheet
Rs.75,500]
The following trial balance is extracted from the books of M/s Ram on March
31, 2005. You are required to prepare trading and profit and loss account
and the balance sheet as on date :
Account title

Amount
Rs.

Account title

Debtors
Purchases
Coal, gas and water
Factory wages
Salaries
Rent
Discount
Advertisement
Drawings
Loan
Petty cash
Sales return
Machinery
Land and building
Income tax
Furniture

12,000
50,000
6,000
11,000
9,000
4,000
3,000
500
1,000
6,000
500
1,000
5,000
10,000
100
9,900

Apprenticeship premium
Loan
Bank overdraft
Sales
Creditors
Capital

Amount
Rs.
5,000
10,000
1,000
80,000
13,000
20,000

(Ans. Gross profit: Rs. 12,000, Net profit: Rs. 500, Total balance sheet:
Rs. 43,400)

Financial Statements - I
8.

367

The following is the trial balance of Manju Chawla on March 31, 2005. You
are required to prepare trading and profit and loss account and a balance
sheet as on date :
Account title

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Opening stock
Purchases and sales
Returns
Productive wages
Dock and Clearing charges
Donation and charity
Delivery van expenses
Lighting
Sales tax collected
Bad debts
Misc. incomes
Rent from tenants
Royalty
Capital
Drawings
Debtors and Creditors
Cash
Investment
Patents
Land and Machinery

10,000
40,000
200
6,000
4,000
600
6,000
500

Credit
Amount
Rs.
80,000
600

1,000
600
6,000
2,000
4,000
40,000
2,000
6,0000
3,000
6,000
4,000
43,000

7,000

Closing stock Rs. 2,000.


(Ans. Gross Profit: Rs. 18,400, Net profit: Rs. 18,700, Total balance sheet:
Rs. 64,700)
9. The following is the trial balance of Mr. Deepak as on March 31, 2005. You
are required to prepare trading account, profit and loss account and a balance
sheet as on date :
Account title

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Account title

Drawings
Insurance
General expenses
Rent and taxes
Lighting (factory)
Travelling expenses
Cash in hand
Bills receivable

36,000
3,000
29,000
14,400
2,800
7,400
12,600
5,000

Capital
Bills payable
Creditors
Discount recived
Purchases return
Sales

Credit
Amount
Rs.
2,50000
3,600
50,000
10,400
8,000
4,40,000

368

Accountancy
Sundry debtors
Furniture
Plant and Machinery
Opening stock
Purchases
Sales return
Carriage inwards
Carriage outwards
Wages
Salaries

1,04,000
16,000
1,80,000
40,000
1,60,000
6,000
7,200
1,600
84,000
53,000

Closing stock Rs. 35,000.


(Ans. Gross profit: Rs.1,83,000, Net profit : Rs. 85,000, Total balance sheet:
Rs. 3,52,600)
10. Prepare trading and profit and loss account and balance sheet from the
following particulars as on March 31, 2005.
Account T itle

Purchases and Sales


Return inwards and Return outwards
Carriage inwards
Carriage outwards
Fuel and power
Opening stock
Bad debts
Debtors and Creditors
Capital
Investment
Interest on investment
Loan
Repairs
General expenses
Wages and salaries
Land and buildings
Cash in hand
Miscellaneous receipts
Sales tax collected

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

3,52,000
9,600
7,000
3,360
24,800
57,600
9,950
1,31,200

5,60,000
12,000

48,000
3,48,000

32,000
3,200
16,000
2,400
17,000
28,800
2,88,000
32,000
160
8,350

Closing stock Rs. 30,000.


(Ans. Gross profit: Rs. 1,22,200, Net profit : Rs.92,850, Total balance sheet:
Rs.5,13,200)
11. From the following trial balance of Mr. A. Lal, prepare trading, profit and loss
account and balance sheet as on March 31, 2005

Financial Statements - I

369

Account T itle

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Stock as on April 01, 2005


Purchases and Sales
Returns inwards and outwards
Carriage inwards
General expenses
Bad debts
Discount received
Bank over draft
Interest on bank overdraft
Commission received
Insurance and taxes
Scooter expenses
Salaries
Cash in hand
Scooter
Furniture
Building
Debtors and Creditors
Capital

16,000
67,600
4,600
1,400
2,400
600

Credit
Amount
Rs.
1,12,000
3,200

1,400
10,000
600
1,800
4,000
200
8,800
4,000
8,000
5,200
65,000
6,000

16,000
50,000

Closing stock Rs. 15,000.


(Ans. Gross profit : Rs. 40,600, Net profit: Rs. 27,200, Total balance sheet:
Rs. 1,03,200)
12. Prepare trading and profit and loss account and balance sheet of M/s Royal
Traders from the following balances as on March 31, 2005.
Debit balances
Stock
Cash
Bank
Carriage on purchases
Purchases
Drawings
Wages
Machinery
Debtors
Postage
Sundry expenses
Rent
Furniture

Amount
Rs.
20,000
5,000
10,000
1,500
1,90,000
9,000
55,000
1,00,000
27,000
300
1,700
4,500
35,000

Credit balances
Sales
Creditors
Bills payable
Capital

Closing stock Rs.8,000


(Ans. Gross loss Rs. 13,500, Net loss Rs. 20,000,
Rs. 1,85,000)

Amount
Rs.
2,45,000
10,000
4,000
2,00,000

Total balance sheet

370

Accountancy
13. Prepare trading and profit and loss account from the following particulars of
M/s Neema Traders as on March 31, 2005.
Account Title

Buildings
Plant
Carriage inwards
Wages
Purchases
Sales return
Opening stock
Machinery
Insurance
Interest
Bad debts
Postage
Discount
Salaries
Debtors

Debit
Amount
Rs.
23,000
16,930
1,000
3,300
1,64,000
1,820
9,000
2,10,940
1,610
1,100
250
300
1,000
3,000
3,900

Account Title

Sales
Loan
Bills payable
Bank overdraft
Creditors
Capital
Purchases return

Credit
Amount
Rs.
1,80,000
8,000
2,520
4,720
8,000
2,36,000
1,910

Stock on March 31, 2005 Rs.16,000.


(Ans. Gross profit Rs.17,850, Net profit Rs. 10,590, Total of balance
sheet Rs.2,69,830)
14. From the following balances of M/s Nilu Sarees as on March 31, 2005. Prepare
trading and profit and loss account and balance sheet as on date.
Account Title

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Account Title

Credit
Amount
Rs.

Opening stock
Purchases
Carriage inwards
Salaries
Commission
Wages
Rent & taxes
Repairs
Telephone expenses
Legal charges
Sundry expenses
cash in hand
Debtors
Machinery
Investments
Drawings

10,000
78,000
2,500
30,000
10,000
11,000
2,800
5,000
1,400
1,500
2,500
12,000
30,000
60,000
90,000
18,000

Sales
Capital
Interest
Commission
Creditors
Bills payable

2,28,000
70,000
7,000
8,000
28,000
2,370

Financial Statements - I

371

Closing stock as on March 31, 2005 Rs.22,000.


(Ans. Gross profit Rs. 1,56,500, Net profit Rs. 1,10,300, Total balance
sheet Rs.2,14,000)
15. Prepare trading and profit and loss account of M/s Sports Equipments for
the year ended March 31, 2006 and balance sheet as on that date :
Account T itle

Opening stock
Purchases and sales
Sales returns
Capital
Commission
Creditors
Bank overdraft
Cash in hand
Furniture
Debtors
Plants
Carriage on purchases
Wages
Rent
Bad debts
Drawings
Stationery
Travelling expenses
Insurance
Discount
Office expenses

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

50,000
3,50,000
5,000

4,21,000
3,00,000
4,000
1,00,000
28,000

32,000
1,28,000
1,40,000
60,000
12,000
8,000
15,000
7,000
24,000
6,000
2,000
7,000
5,000
2,000

Closing stock as on March 31, 2006 Rs.2,500


(Ans. Gross loss Rs. 1,500, Net loss Rs. 41,500 , Total balance sheet
Rs.3,62,500)
Checklist to Test Your Understanding
1.

Test Your Understanding - I


I (i) T
II (i) b

2.

(ii) T
(ii) a

(iii) F
(iii) e

(iv) T
(iv) c

Test Your Understanding - II


1. (v)

2. (iii)

3. (iii)

4. (iii)

(v) d

372

Accountancy

Financial Statements - II

10

I
LEARNING OBJECTIVES
After studying this chapter,
you will be able to :
describe the need for
adjustments while
preparing the financial
statements;
explain the accounting
treatment of adjustments for outstanding
and prepaid expenses,
accrued and advance
receipts of incomes;
discuss the adjustments to be made
regarding depreciation, bad debts, provision for doubtful debts,
provision for discount
on debtors;
explain the concepts
and adjustment of
managers commission
and interest on capital;
prepare profit and loss
account and balance
sheet with adjustments; and
make vertical presentation of financial
statements.

n chapter 9, you learnt about the preparation of


simple final accounts in the format of trading and
profit and loss account and balance sheet. The
preparation of simple final accounts pre-supposes
the absence of any accounting complexities which
are nor mal to business operations. These
complexities arise due to the fact that the process
of determining income and financial position is
based on the accrual basis of accounting. This
emphasises that while ascertaining the profitability,
the revenues be considered on earned basis and
not on receipt basis, and the expenses be considered
on incurred basis and not on paid basis. Hence,
many items need some adjustment while preparing
the financial statements. In this chapter we shall
discuss all items which require adjustments and
the way these are brought into the books of account
and incorporated in the final accounts.
10.1 Need for Adjustments
According to accrual concept of accounting, the
profit or loss for an accounting year is not based on
the revenues realised in cash and the expenses paid
in cash during that year because there may be some
receipts of incomes and payments of expenses
during the current year which may partially relate
to the previous year or to the next year. Also, there
may be some incomes and expenses relating to the
current year that are still to be brought into books
of account. So, unless such items duly adjusted,
the final accounts will not reflect the true and fair
view of the state of affairs of the business.

Financial Statements - II

373

Let us take an example of an amount of Rs. 1,000 paid on July 01, 2005
towards insurance premium. You understand that any general insurance
premium paid usually covers a period of 12 months. Suppose the accounting
year ends on March 31, 2006, it would mean that one fourth of the insurance
premium is paid on July 01, 2005 relate to the next accounting year 2006-07.
Therefore, while preparing the financial statements for 2005-06, the expense
on insurance premium that should be debited to the profit and loss account
is Rs. 900 (Rs. 1,200 Rs. 300).
Let us take another example. The salaries for the month of March, 2005
were paid on April 07, 2005. This means that the salaries account of 2004-05
does not include the salaries for the month of March 2005. Such unpaid
salaries is termed as salaries outstanding which have to be brought into books
of account and is debited to profit and loss account along with the salaries
already paid for the month of April, 2004 up to Feburary, 2005.
Similarly, adjustments may also become necessary in respect of certain
incomes received in advance or those which have accrued but are still to be
received. Apart from these, there are certain items which are not recorded on
day-to-day basis such as depreciation on fixed assets, interest on capital, etc.
These are adjusted at the time of preparing financial statements. The purpose
of making various adjustments is to ensure that the final accounts reveal the
true profit or loss and the true financial position of the business. The items
which usually need adjustments are :
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.

Closing stock
Outstanding/expenses
Prepaid/Unexpired expenses
Accrued income
Income received in advance
Depreciation
Bad debts
Provision for doubtful debts
Provision for discount on debtors
Managers commission
Interest on capital

It may be noted that when we prepare the financial statements, we are


provided with the trial balance and some other additional information in respect
of the adjustments to be made. All adjustments are reflected in the final
accounts at two places to complete the double entry. Our earlier example in
chapter 9 which represents the trial balance of Ankit is reproduced in
figure 10.1:

374

Accountancy
Trial Balance of Ankit as on March 31, 2005
Account Title

Elements

Cash
Bank
Wages
Salaries
Furniture
Rent of building
Debtors
Bad debts
Purchases
Capital
Equity
Sales
Creditors
Long-term loan (raised on 1.4.2004)
Commission received

Assets
Assets
Expense
Expense
Assets
Expense
Assets
Expense
Expense

L.F.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

1,000
5,000
8,000
25,000
15,000
13,000
15,500
4,500
75,000
12,000

Revenue
Liabilities
Liabilities
Revenue

Total

1,25,000
15,000
5,000
5,000
1,62,000

1,62,000

Additional Information : The stock on March 31, 2005 was Rs. 15,000.
Figure 10.1 : Showing the trial balance of Ankit

We will now study about the items of adjustments and you will observe
how these adjustments are helpful in the preparation of financial statements
in order to reflect the true profit and loss and financial position of the firm.
10.2 Closing Stock
As already discussed in chapter 9, the closing stock represents the cost of
unsold goods lying in the stores at the end of the accounting period. The
adjustment with regard to the closing stock is done by (i) by crediting it to the
trading and profit and loss account, and (ii) by showing it on the asset side of
the balance sheet. The adjustment entry to be recorded in this regard is :
Closing stock A/c
To Trading A/c

Dr.

The closing stock of the year becomes the opening stock of the next year
and is reflected in the trial balance of the next year. The trading and profit

Financial Statements - II

375

and loss account of Ankit for the year ended March 31, 2005 and his balance
sheet as on that date shall appear as follows :
Trading and Profit and Loss Account of Ankit
for the year ended March 31, 2005
Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses

Amount
Rs.

Revenues/Gains

Purchases
Wages
Gross profit c/d

75,000
8,000
57,000

Sales
Closing stock

1,40,000
Salaries
Rent of building
Bad debts
Net profit (transferred to
Ankits capital account)

25,000
13,000
4,500
19,500
62,000

Amount
Rs.
1,25,000
15,000
1,40,000

Gross profit b/d


Commission received

57,000
5,000

62,000

Sometimes the opening and closing stock are adjusted through purchases
account. In that case, the entry recorded is as follows :
Closing stock A/c
Dr.
To Purchases A/c
This entry reduces the amount in the purchases account and is also
known as adjusted purchases which is shown on the debit side of the trading
and profit and loss account. In this context, it may be noted, that the closing
stock will not be shown on the credit side of the trading and profit and loss as
it has been already been adjusted through the purchases account. Not only,
in such a situation, even the opening stock will not be separately reflected in
the trading and profit and loss account, as it is also adjusted in purchases by
recording the following entry:
Purchases A/c
Dr.
To Opening stock A/c
Another important point to be noted in this context is that when the opening
and closing stocks are adjusted through purchases, the trial balance does
not show any opening stock. Instead, the closing stock shall appear in the
trial balance (not as additional information or as an adjustment item) and so
also the adjusted purchases. In such a situation, you should remember that
the adjusted purchases shall be debited to the trading and profit and loss
account.

376

Accountancy

The closing stock shall be shown on the assets side of the balance sheet as
shown below:
Balance Sheet of Ankit as at March 31, 2005
Liabilities
Owners funds
Capital
Add Net profit
Non-Current Liabilities
Long-term loan
Current Liabilities
Creditors

Amount
Rs.
12,000
19,500

31,500
5,000
15,000

Assets

Amount
Rs.

Non-Current Assets
Furniture
Current Assets
Debtors
Bank
Cash
Closing stock

51,500

15,000
15,500
5,000
1,000
15,000
51,500

10.3 Outstanding Expenses


It is quite common for a business enterprise to have some unpaid expenses in
the normal course of business operations at the end of an accounting year.
Such items usually are wages, salaries, interest on loan, etc.
When expenses of an accounting period remain unpaid at the end of an
accounting period, they are termed as outstanding expenses. As they relate
to the earning of revenue during the current accounting year, it is logical that
they should be duly charged against revenue for computation of the correct
amount of profit or loss. The entry to bring such expenses into account is :
Concerned expense A/c
To Outstanding expense A/c

Dr.

The above entry opens a new account called Outstanding Expenses which
is shown on the liabilities side of the balance sheet. The amount of outstanding
expenses is added to the total of expenses under a particular head for the
purpose of preparing trading and profit and loss account.
For example, refer to Ankits trial balance (refer figure 10.1). You will notice
that wages are shown at Rs. 8,000. Let us assume that Ankit owes Rs.500 as
wages relating to the year 2004-05 to one of his employees. In that case, the
correct expense on wages amounts to Rs. 8,500 instead of Rs. 8,000. Ankit
must show Rs. 8,500 as expense on account of wages in the trading and
profit and loss account and recognise a current liability of Rs. 500 towards
the sum owed to his staff. It will be referred to as wages outstanding and it
will be adjusted to wages account by recording the following journal entry:
Wages A/c
Dr.
500
To Wages outstanding A/c
500

Financial Statements - II

377

The amount of outstanding wages will be added to wages account for the
preparation of the trading and profit and loss account as follows :
Trading and Profit and Loss Account of Ankit
for the year ended March 31, 2005
Dr.
Expenses/Losses
Purchases
Wages
Add Outstanding wages
Gross profit c/d

8,000
500

Amount
Rs.

Revenues/Gains

75,000

Sales

8,500
56,500

Closing stock

1,40,000
Salaries
Rent of building
Bad debts
Net profit (transferred to
Ankits capital account)

25,000
13,000
4,500
19,000

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
1,25,000
15,000
1,40,000

Gross profit b/d


Commission received

61,500

56,500
5,000

61,500

Observe carefully the trading and profit and loss account of Ankit. Did
you notice the amount of net profit is reduced to Rs. 19,000 on account of
outstanding wages. The item relating to outstanding wages will be shown in
balance sheet as follows :
Balance Sheet of Ankit as at March 31, 2005
Liabilities
Owners Funds
Capital
Add Profit
Non-Current Liabilities
Long-term loan
Current Liabilities
Creditors
Outstanding wages

Amount
Rs.
12,000
19,000

31,000
5,000
15,000
500
51,500

Assets
Non-Current Assets
Furniture
Current Assets
Debtors
Bank
Cash
Closing stock

Amount
Rs.
15,000
15,500
5,000
1,000
15,000
51,500

10.4 Prepaid Expenses


There are several items of expense which are paid in advance in the normal
course of business operations. At the end of the accounting year, it is found
that the benefits of such expenses have not yet been fully received; a portion

378

Accountancy

of its benefit would be received in the next accounting year. This portion of
expense, is carried forward to the next year and is termed as prepaid expenses.
The necessary adjustment in respect of prepaid expenses is made by recording
the following entry:
Prepaid expense A/c
Dr.
To concerned expense A/c
The effect of the above adjustment entry is that the amount of prepaid
part is deducted from the total of the particular expense, and the new account
of prepaid expense is shown on the liabilities side of the balance sheet. For
example, in Ankits trial balance, let us assume that the amount of salary
paid by him to the employees includes an amount of Rs. 5,000 which was
paid in advance to one of his employees upon his joining the office. This
implies that Ankit has overpaid his staff by Rs. 5,000 on account of his salary.
Hence, correct expense on account of salary during the current period will be
Rs. 20,000 instead of Rs. 25,000. Ankit must show Rs. 20,000 expense on
account of salary in the profit and loss account and recognise a current asset
of Rs. 5,000 as an advance salary to the employee. It will be termed as prepaid
salary account and will be recorded by the following journal entry :
Prepaid salary A/c
Dr.
5,000
To salary A/c
5,000
The account of prepaid salary will be shown in the trading and profit and
loss account as follows:
Trading and Profit and Loss Account of Ankit
for the year ended March 31, 2005
Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses
Purchases
Wages
Add Outstanding wages
Gross profit c/d

8,000
500

Amount
Rs

Revenues/Gains

75,000

Sales
Closing stock

1,25,000
15,000

8,500
56,500
1,40,000

Salaries
25,000
Less Prepaid salary
(5,000)
Rent of building
Bad debts
Net profit (transferred to Ankit
capital account)

Amount
Rs.

1,40,000
Gross profit b/d

20,000
13,000
4,500
24,000
61,500

Commission received

56,500
5,000

61,500

Financial Statements - II

379

Observe how the prepaid salary has resulted in an increase of net profit by
Rs. 5,000 making it as Rs. 24,000 Further, the item relating to prepaid salary
will be shown in the balance sheet on the assets side as follows :
Balance Sheet of Ankit as at March 31,2005
Liabilities
Owners Funds
Capital
Add Profit
Non-Current Liabilities
Long-term loan
Current Liabilities

Amount
Rs.

12,000
24,000

Creditors
Outstanding wages

36,000
5,000

15,000
500

Assets

Amount
Rs.

Non-Current Assets
Furniture
Current Assets
Debtors
Prepaid salary
Bank
Cash
Closing stock

56,500

15,000
15,500
5,000
5,000
1,000
15,000
56,500

10.5 Accrued Income


It may also happen that certain items of income such as interest on loan,
commission, rent, etc. are earned during the current accounting year but
have not been actually received by the end of the same year. Such incomes
are known as accrued income. The adjusting entry for accrued income is :
Accrued income A/c
Dr.
To Concerned income A/c
The amount of accrued income will be added to the related income in the
profit and loss account and the new account of accrued income will appear
on the asset side of the balance sheet.
Let us, for example, assume that Ankit was giving a little help to a fellow
businessman by introducing few parties to him on commission for this service.
In the trial balance of Ankit you will notice an item of commission received
amounting to Rs. 5,000. Assume that the commission amounting to
Rs.1, 500 was still receivable from the fellow businessman. This implies that
income from commission earned during 2004-05 is Rs. 6, 500 (Rs.5, 000 +
Rs. 1,500) Ankit needs to record an adjustment entry to give effect to the
accrued commission as follows :
Accrued Commission A/c
To Commission A/c

Dr.

1,500
1,500

380

Accountancy

The account of accrued income will be recorded in trading and profit and
loss account as follows :
Trading and Profit and Loss Account of Ankit
for the year ended March 31, 2005
Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses

Purchases
Wages
Add Outstanding
Gross profit c/d

8,000
500

Amount
Rs.

Revenues/Gains

75,000

Sales
Closing stock

25,000
(5,000)

Bad debts
Net profit (transferred to
Ankits capital account)

1,25,000
15,000

8,500
56,500
1,40,000

Salaries
Less Prepaid salary
Rent of building

Amount
Rs.

1,40,000
Gross profit b/d

20,000
13,000
4,500
25,500

Commission received 5,000


1,500
Add Accrued
commission

63,000

56,500

6,500

63,000

Observe that the accrued income has resulted in an increase in the net
profit by Rs. 1,500 making it as Rs. 25,500. Further, it will be shown in the
balance sheet of Ankit on the assets side under the head current asset.
Balance Sheet of Ankit as at March 31, 2005
Liabilities
Owners Funds
Capital
Add Profit
Non-Current Liabilities
Long-term loan
Current Liabilities
Creditors
Outstanding wages

Amount
Rs.
12,000
25,500

37,500
5,000
15,000
500
58,000

Assets
Non-Current Assets
Furniture
Current Assets
Debtors
Prepaid salary
Accrued commission
Bank
Cash
Closing stock

Amount
Rs.
15,000
15,500
5,000
1,500
5,000
1,000
15,000
58,000

Financial Statements - II

381

10.6 Income Received in Advance


Sometimes, a certain income is received but the whole amount of it does not
belong to the current period. The portion of the income which belongs to the
next accounting period is termed as income received in advance or an Unearned
Income. Income received in advance is adjusted by recording the following
entry:
Concerned income A/c
Dr.
To Income received in advance A/c
The effect of this entry will be that the balance in the income account will
be equal to the amount of income earned for the current accounting period,
and the new account of income received in advance will be shown as a liability
in the balance sheet.
For example, let us assume Ankit has agreed in March 31, 2005 to sublet
a part of the building to a fellow shopkeeper @ Rs. 1,000 per month. The
person gives him rent in advance for the next three months of April, May and
June. The amount received had been credited to the profit and loss account.
However, this income does not pertain to current year and hence will not be
credited to profit and loss account. It is income received in advance and will
be recognised as a liability amounting to Rs. 3,000. Ankit needs to record an
adjustment entry to give effect to income received in advance by way of following
journal entry:
Rent received A/c
Dr.
To Rent received in advance A/c

3,000
3,000

This will lead a new account of rent received in advance of Rs. 3,000 which
will appear as follows :
Balance Sheet of Ankit as at March 31, 2005
Liabilities
Owners Funds
Capital
12,000
Add Net profit
25,500
Non Current Liabilities
Long-term loan
Current Liabilities
Creditors
Outstanding wages
Rent received in advance

Amount
Rs.

37,500
5,000
15,000
500
3,000
61,000

Assets
Non Current Assets
Furniture
Current Assets
Debtors
Prepaid salary
Accrued commission
Bank
Cash
Closing stock

Amount
Rs.
15,000
15,500
5,000
1,500
5,000
4,000
15,000
61,000

382

Accountancy

10.7 Depreciation
Recall from chapter 7, that depreciation is the decline in the value of assets
on account of wear and tear and passage of time. It is treated as a business
expense and is debited to profit and loss account. This, in effect, amounts to
writing-off a portion of the cost of an asset which has been used in the business
for the purpose of earning profits. The entry for providing depreciation is :
Depreciation A/c
Dr.
To Concerned asset A/c
In the balance sheet, the asset will be shown at cost minus the amount of
depreciation. For example, the trial balance in our example shows that Ankit
has a furniture account with a balance of Rs. 15,000. Let us assume that
furniture is subject to a depreciation of 10% per annum. This implies that
Ankit must recognise that at the end of the year the value attached to furniture
is to be reduced by Rs. 1,500 (Rs. 15,000 10%). Ankit needs to record an
adjustment entry to give effect to depreciation on furniture as follows :
Depreciation A/c
Dr.
1,500
To Furniture A/c
1,500
Depreciation will be shown in the profit and loss account and balance
sheet as follows :
Trading and Profit and Loss Account of Ankit
for the year ended March 31, 2005
Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses
Purchases
Wages
Add Outstanding wages
Gross Profit c/d

8,000
(500)

Amount
Rs.

Revenues/Gains

75,000

Sales
Closing stock

Depreciation-Furniture
Bad debts
Net profit (transferred to
Ankits capital account)

25,000
(5,000)

1,25,000
15,000

8,500
56,500
1,40,000

Salaries
Less Prepaid salary
Rent of building

Amount
Rs.

1,40,000
Gross profit b/d

20,000
13,000
1,500
4,500
24,000
63,000

Commission received 5,000


1,500
Add Accrued
Commission

56,500
6,500

63,000

Notice that the amount of net profit declines with the adjustment of depreciation.
Let us now see how depreciation as an expense will be shown in balance sheet.

Financial Statements - II

383
Balance Sheet of Ankit
as at March 31, 2005

Liabilities
Owners Funds
Capital
12,000
Add Profit
24,000
Non-Current Liabilities
Long-term loan
Current Liabilities
Creditors
Outstanding wages
Rent received in advance

Amount
Rs.

36,000
5,000
15,000
500
3,000

Assets

Amount
Rs.

Non-Current Assets
Furniture
15,000
Less Depreciation (1,500)
Current Assets
Debtors
Prepaid salary
Accrued commission
Bank
Cash
Closing stock

59,500

13,500
15,500
5,000
1,500
5,000
4,000
15,000
59,500

10.8 Bad Debts


Bad debts refer to the amount that the firm has not been able to realise from
its debtors. It is regarded as a loss and is termed as bad debt. The entry for
recording bad debt is:
Bad debts A/c
To Debtors A/c

Dr.

You will notice in Ankits trial balance, that it contains bad debts amounting
to Rs. 4,500. Whereas, the sundry debtors of Ankit are reported as Rs. 15,500.
The existence of bad debts in the trial balance signifies that Ankit has incurred
a loss arising out of bad debts during the year and which has been already
recorded in the books of account.
However, assuming one of his debtors who owed him Rs. 2,500 had become
insolvent, and nothing is receivable from him. But the amount of bad debts
related to the current year is still to be account for. This fact appears as
additional information and is termed as further bad debts. The adjustment
entry to be recorded for the amount will be as follows. For this purpose, Ankit
needs to record an adjustment entry as under :
Bad debts A/c
To Debtors A/c

Dr.

2,500
2,500

This entry will reduce the value of debtors to Rs. 13,000( Rs. 15,500
Rs. 2,500) and increases the amount of bad debts to Rs. 7,000 (Rs. 4,500 +
Rs. 2,500).

384

Accountancy

The treatment of further bad debts in profit and loss account and balance
sheet is shown below :
Trading and Profit and Loss Account of Ankit
for the year ended March 31, 2005
Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses
Purchases
Wages
Add Outstanding wages
Gross profit c/d

Amount
Rs.
75,000
8,000
500

Revenues/Gains
Sales
Closing stock

8,500
56,500
1,40,000

Salaries
Less Prepaid salary
Rent of building

25,000
(5,000)

Depreciation Furniture
Bad Debts
4,500
Add Further bad debts
2,500
Net profit (transferred to
Ankits capital account)

Amount
Rs.
1,25,000
15,000

1,40,000
Gross profit b/d

20,000
13,000

Commission received 5,000


Add Accrued
1,500
commission

56,500

6,500

1,500
7,000
21,500
63,000

63,000

Balance Sheet of Ankit as at March 31, 2005


Liabilities
Owners Funds
Capital
Add Profit
Non-Current Liabilities
Long-term loan

12,000
21,500

Current Liabilities and Provisions


Creditors
Outstanding Wages
Rent received in advance

Amount Assets
Amount
Rs.
Rs.
Non-Current Assets
Furniture
15,000
33,500 Less Depreciation
(1,500) 13,500
Current Assets
5,000 Debtors
15,500
Less Further bad debts (2,500) 13,000
Prepaid salary
5,000
15,000 Accrued commission
1,500
Bank
5,000
500 Cash
4,000
Closing stock
15,000
3,000
57,000
57,000

10.9 Provision for Bad and Doubtful Debts


In the above balance sheet, debtors now appears at Rs. 13,000, which is their
estimated realisable value during next year. It is quite possible that the whole

Financial Statements - II

385

of this amount may not be realised in future. However, it is not possible to


accurately know the amount of such bad debts. Hence, we make a reasonable
estimate of such loss and provide the same. Such provision is called provision
for bad debts and is created by debiting profit and loss account. The following
journal entry is recorded in this context :
Profit and Loss A/c
Dr.
To Provision for doubtful debts A/c
Provision for doubtful debts is also shown as a deduction from the debtors
on the asset side of the balance sheet.
Let us assume, Ankit feels that 5% of his debtors on March 31, 2005 are
likely to default on their payments next year. This implies he expects bad
debts of Rs. 650 (Rs. 13,000 5%). Ankit needs to record the adjustment
entry as :
Profit and loss A/c
Dr.
To Provision for doubtful debts A/c

650
650

This implies that Rs. 650 will reduce the current years profit on account
of doubtful debts. In the balance sheet, it will be shown as a deduction from
sundry debtors.
Trading and Profit and Loss Account of Ankit
for the year ended March 31, 2005
Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses
Purchases
Wages
Add Outstanding
Gross profit c/d

8,000
500

Amount
Rs.

Revenues/Gains

75,000

Sales
Closing stock

1,25,000
15,000

8,500
56,500
1,40,000

Salaries
25,000
Less Prepaid salary
(5,000)
Rent of building
Depreciation Furniture
Bad debts
4,500
Add Further bad debts
2,500
Provision for doubtful debts
Net profit (transferred to Ankits
capital account)

Amount
Rs.

1,40,000
Gross profit b/d

20,000
13,000
1,500

Commission received 5,000


Add Accrued
1,500
commission

56,500

6,500

7,000
650
20,850
63,000

63,000

386

Accountancy
Balance Sheet of Ankit as at March 31, 2005

Liabilities
Owners Funds
Capital
12,000
Add Net profit
20,850
Non-Current Liabilities
Long-term loan

Current Liabilities & Provisions


Creditors
Outstanding wages
Rent received in advance

Amount Assets
Rs.

32,850
5,000

15,000
500
3,000

Non-Current Assets
Furniture
15,000
Less Depreciation
(1,500)
Current Assets
Debtors
15,500
Less Furtherbad debts 2,500
13,000
Less Provision for
650
doubtful debts
Prepaid salary
Accrued commission
Bank
Cash
Closing stock

56,350

Amount
Rs.

13,500

12,350
5,000
1,500
5,000
4,000
15,000
56,350

It may be noted that the provision created for doubtful debts at the end of
a particular year will be carried forward to the next year and it will be used for
meeting the loss due to bad debts incurred during the next year. The provision
for doubtful debts brought forward from the previous year is called the opening
provision or old provision. When such a provision already exists, the loss due
to bad debts during the current year are adjusted against the same and while
making provision for doubtful debts required at the end of the current year is
called new provision. The balance of old provision as given in trial balance
should also be taken into account.
Let us take an example to understand how bad debts and provision for
doubtful debts are recorded. An extract from a trial balance on March 31,
2005 is given below :
Sundry debtors
Bad debts
Provision for doubtful debts

Rs.
32,000
2,000
3,500

Additional Information :
Write-off further bad debts Rs. 1,000 and create a provision for doubtful debts
@ 5% on debtors.

Financial Statements - II

387

In this case, the following journal entries will be recorded :


Date

Debit
L.F. Amount
Rs.

Particulars
(a) Bad debts A/c
To Sundry debtors
(Futher bad debts)

Dr.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

1,000
1,000

(b) Provision for doubtful debts A/c Dr.


To Bad debts A/c
(Bad debts adjusted against the provision)

3,000

Profit and Loss A/c


Dr.
To Provision for doubtful debts A/c
(Amount charges from profit and loss account)

1,050

3,000

1,050

Profit and Loss Account


for the year ended March 31, 2005
Rs.
Provision for doubtful debts:
Bad debts
2,000
Further bad debts
1,000
New provision
1,550
4,550
Less Old provision
3,500

Rs.

1,050

*Only relevant items.


Balance Sheet as at March 31, 2005
Rs.
Sundry debtors
32,000
Less Further
(1,000)
bad debts
31,000
Less Provision
(1,550)
for doubtful debts

29,450

*Only relevant items.


Note : The amount of new provision for doubtful debts has been calculated as follows:
Rs. 31,000 1 5/100 = Rs. 1,550.

10.10 Provision for Discount on Debtors


A business enterprise allows discount to its debtors to encourage prompt
payments. Discount likely to be allowed to customers in an accounting year

388

Accountancy

can be estimated and provided for by creating a provision for discount on


debtors. Provision for discount is made on good debtors which are arrived at
by deducting further bad debts and the provision for doubtful debts. The
following journal entry is recorded to create provision for discount on debtors:
Profit and loss A/c
Dr.
To Provision for discount on debtors A/c
As stated above, the provision for discount on debtors will be created only
on good debtors. It will be calculated on the amount of debtors arrived at after
deducting the doubtful debts, i.e. Rs. 12,350 (Rs. 13,000 Rs. 650).
Ankit needs to record the adjustment entry as :
Profit and loss A/c
Dr.
To Provision for discount on debtors A/c

227
227

This will reduce the current year profit by Rs. 227 on account of probable
discount on prompt payment. In the balance sheet, it will be shown as a
deduction from the debtors account to portray correctly the expected realiable
value of debtors as Rs. 12,123.
Trading and Profit and Loss Account of Ankit
for the year ended March 31, 2005
Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses
Purchases
Wages
Add Outstanding wages
Gross profit c/d

8,000
(500)

Amount
Rs.

Revenues/Gains

75,000

Sales
Closing stock

25,000
(5,000)

DepreciationFurniture
Bad debts
4,500
Add Further bad debts
2,500
Provision for doubtful debts
Provision for discount on debtors
Net profit (transferred to
Ankits capital account)

1,25,000
15,000

8,500
56,500
1,40,000

Salaries
Less Prepaid salary
Rent of building

Amount
Rs.

1,40,000
Gross profit b/d

20,000
13,000
1,500

Commission received 5,000


Add Accrued
1,500
commission

56,500

6,500

7,000
650
227
20,623
63,000

63,000

Financial Statements - II

389

Balance Sheet of Ankit as on March 31, 2005


Liabilities
Owners Funds
Capital
Add Net profit
Non-Current Liabilities
Long-term loan

Amount
Rs.
12,000
20,623

Current Liabilities & Provisions


Creditors
Outstanding wages
Rent received in advance

32,623
5,000

15,000
500

Assets
Non-Current Assets
Furniture
15,000
Less Depreciation
(1,500)
Current Assets
Debtors
15,500
2,500
Less Further
bad debts
13,000
Less Provision
for bad and
650
doubtful debts
12,350
Less Provision
for discount
(227)
on debtors
Prepaid salary
Accrued commission
Bank
Cash
Closing stock

Amount
Rs.

13,500

12,123
5,000
1,500
5,000
4,000
15,000

3,000
56,123

56,123

In the subsequent year, the discount will be transferred to the provision


for discount on debtors account. The account will be treated in the same
manner as the provision for doubtful debts.
10.11 Managers Commission
The manager of the business is sometimes given the commission on the net
profit of the company. The percentage of the commission is applied on the
profit either before charging such commission or after charging such commission.
In the absence of any such information, it is assumed that commission is
allowed as a percentage of the net profit before charging such commission.
Suppose the net profit of a business is Rs. 110 before charging commission.
If the manager is entitled to 10% of the profit before charging such commission,
the commission will be calculated as :
= Rs. 110 10/100
= Rs. 11

390

Accountancy

In case the commission is 10% of the profit after charging such commission,
it will be calculated as :
= Profit before commission Rate of commission/ (100 + commission)
= Rs. 110

10
110

= Rs. 10.

The managers commission will be adjusted in the books of account by


recording the following entry :
Profit and loss A/c
To Managers commission A/c

Dr.

Let us recall our example and assume that Ankits manager is entitled to a
commission @ 10%. Observe the following profit and loss account if it is based
on :
(i) amount of net profit before charging such commission
(ii) amount of profit after charging such commission.
(i) Trading and Profit and Loss Account of Ankit
for the year ended March 31, 2005
Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses
Purchases
Wages
Add Outstanding wages
Gross profit c/d

8,000
500

Amount
Rs.

Revenues/Gains

75,000

Sales
Closing stock

25,000
(5,000)

Depreciation Furniture
Bad debts
4,500
Add Further bad debts
2,500
Provision for doubtful debts
Provision for discount on debtors
Managers commission
Net profit (transferred to
Ankits capital account)

1,25,000
15,000

8,500
56,500
1,40,000

Salaries
Less Prepaid salary
Rent of building

Amount
Rs.

1,40,000
Gross profit

20,000
13,000
1,500

Commission received 5,000


1,500
Add Accrued
commission

56,500

6,500

7,000
650
227
2,062
18,561
63,000

63,000

Financial Statements - II

391

Balance Sheet of Ankit as at March 31, 2005


Amount Assets
Rs.
Owners Funds
Non-Current Assets
Capital
12,000
Furniture
15,000
Add Net profit
18,561
30,561 Less Depreciation
(1,500)
Non-Current Liabilities
Current Assets
Long-term loan
5,000 Debtors
15,500
Less Further bad debts(2,500)
13,000
Less Provision for bad
Current Liabilities and Provisions
and doubtful
(650)
Creditors
15,000
debts
12,350
Less Provision for
discount on debtors
(227)
Outstanding wages
500 Prepaid salary
Rent received in advance
3,000 Accrued commission
Bank
Cash
Managers commission
2,062 Closing stock
outstanding
56,123
Liabilities

Amount
Rs.

13,500

12,123
5,000
1,500
5,000
4,000
15,000
56,123

(ii) Trading and Profit and Loss Account of Ankit


for the year ended March 31, 2005
Dr.
Expenses/Losses
Purchases
Wages
Add Outstanding wages
Gross profit c/d

Amount
Rs.
75,000
8,000
500

Revenues/Gains
Sales
Closing stock

8,500
56,500
1,40,000

Salaries
Less Prepaid salary
Rent of building

25,000
(5,000)

DepreciationFurniture
Bad debts
4,500
Add Further bad debts
2,500
Provision for bad and
doubtful debts
Provision for discount on
debtors
Managers commission
Net profit (transferred to
Ankits capital account)

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
1,25,000
15,000

1,40,000
Gross profit b/d

20,000
13,000
1,500

Commission received 5,000


1,500
Add Accrued
commission

56,500

6,500

7,000
650
227
1,875
18,748
63,000

63,000

392

Accountancy
Balance Sheet of Ankit as at March 31, 2005

Liabilities
Owners Funds
Capital
Add Net profit
Non-Current Liabilities
Long-term loan

Amount
Rs.
12,000
18,748

Current Liabilities and Provisions


Creditors
Outstanding wages
Rent received in advance
Manager commission
outstanding

30,748
5,000

Assets
Non-Current Assets
Furniture
Less Depreciation

Amount
Rs.
15,000
(1,500) 13,500

3,000

Current Assets
Debtors
15,500
Less Further bad debts (2,500)
13,000
Less Provision
for bad & doubtful (650)
debts
12,350
Less Provision for
discount on debtors(227) 12,123
Prepaid salary
5,000
Accrued commission
1,500
Bank
5,000
Cash
4,000

1,875

Closing stock

15,000
500

56,123

15,000
56,123

10.12 Interest on Capital


Sometimes, the proprietor may like to know the profit made by the business
after providing for interest on capital. In such a situation, interest is calculated
at a given rate of interest on capital as at the beginning of the accounting
year. If however, any additional capital is brought during the year, the interest
may also be computed on such amount from the date on which it was brought
into the business. Such interest is treated as expense for the business and
the following journal entry is recorded in the books of account:
Interest on capital A/c
Dr.
To Capital A/c
In the final accounts, it is shown as an expense on the debit side of the
profit and loss account and added to capital in the balance sheet.
Let us assume, Ankit decides to provide 5% interest on his capital. This
shall amount to Rs. 600 for which the following journal entry will be recorded:
Interest on capital A/c
Dr.
600
To Capital A/c
600
This implies that net profit shall be reduced by Rs. 600. As a result, the
reduced amount of profit shall be added to the capital in the balance sheet.

Financial Statements - II

393

But, when interest on capital shall be added to the capital, this effect shall be
neutralised. As shown below :
Rs.
Capital
12,000
Add Profit
17,961
29,961
600
Add Interest on capital
30,561
Test Your Understanding
Tick the correct answer :
1. Rahuls trial balance provide you the following information :
Debtors
Rs. 80,000
Bad debts
Rs. 2,000
Provision for bad debts
Rs. 4,000
It is desired to maintain a provision for bad debts of Rs. 1,000
State the amount to be debited/credited in profit and loss account :
(a) Rs. 5,000 (Debit)
(b) Rs. 3,000 (Debit)
(c) Rs. 1,000 (Credit)
(d) none of these.
2. If the rent of one month is still to be paid the adjustment entry will be :
(a) Debit outstanding rent account and Credit rent account
(b) Debit profit and loss account and Credit rent account
(c) Debit rent account and Credit profit and loss account
(d) Debit rent account and Credit outstanding rent account.
3. If the rent received in advance Rs. 2,000. The adjustment entry will be :
(a) Debit profit and loss account and Credit rent account
(b) Debit rent account Credit rent received in advance account
(c) Debit rent received in advance account and Credit rent account
(d) None of these.
4. If the opening capital is Rs. 50,000 as on April 01, 2005 and additional capital
introduced Rs. 10,000 on January 01, 2006. Interest charge on capital 10% p.a.
The amount of interest on capital shown in profit and loss account as on March 31,
2005 will be :
(a) Rs. 5,250
(b) Rs. 6,000
(c) Rs. 4,000
(d) Rs, 3,000.
5. If the insurance premium paid Rs. 1,000 and pre-paid insurance Rs. 300. The amount
of insurance premium shown in profit and loss account will be :
(a) Rs. 1,300
(b) Rs. 1,000
(c) Rs. 300
(d) Rs. 700.

394

Accountancy
Adjustment

Adjustment Entry

1. Closing stock

Closing stock A/c


To Trading A/c

Dr.

Shown on the credit Shown on the


assets side and profit assets side
and loss account

2. Outstanding
expenses

Expense A/c
To outstanding
expense A/c

Dr.

Added to the
respective expense
on the debit side

3. Prepaid/
Unexpired
expenses

Prepaid expense A/c


To Expenses A/c

Dr.

Deducted from the


Shown on the
respective expense on assets side
the debit side

4. Income earned Accured income A/c


but not received To Income A/c

Dr.

Added to the
respective income
on the credit side

Shown on the
assets side

5. Income received Income A/c


in advance
To Income received
in advence A/c

Dr.

Deducted from the


respective income
on the credit side

Shown on the
liabilities
sides

6. Depreciation

Dr.

Shown on the debit


side

Deducted from
the value of
asset

7. Provision for
Profit and Loss A/c
bad and
To Provision for
doubtful debts doubtful debts

Dr.

Shown on the debit


side

Shown as
deduction
from debtors

8. Provision for
discount on
debtors

Profit and Loss A/c


To Provision for
discount debtors

Dr.

Shown on the debit


side

Shown as
deductoin
form debtors

9. Managers
commission

Dr.

Shown on the debit


side

Shown on the
liabilities side

10. Interest on
capital

Managers
commission A/c
To outstanding
commission A/c
Interest on capital A/c
To capital A/c

Dr.

Shown on the debit


side

Shown as
addition to
capital

11. Further bad


debts

Bad debts A/c


Dr.
To Sundry Debtors A/c

Shown on the debit


side

Deducted from
debtors

Depreciaton A/c
To Assets A/c

Treatment in Trading
and Profit and Loss
Account

Fig. 10.2 : Showing treatment of various types of adjustments

Treatment in
Balance Sheet

Shown on the
liabilities side

Financial Statements - II

395

Illustration 1
From the following balances, prepare the trading and profit and loss account and balance
sheet as on March 31, 2005.
Debit Balances
Drawings
Cash at bank
Bills receivable
Loan and Building
Furniture
Discount allowed
Bank charges
Salaries
Purchases
Stock (opening)
Sales return
Carriage
Rent and Taxes
General expenses
Plant and Machinery
Book debts
Bad debts
Insurance

Amount
Rs.
6,300
13,870
1,860
42,580
5,130
3,960
100
6,420
1,99,080
60,220
1,870
5,170
7,680
3,630
31,640
82,740
1,250
750

Credit Balances
Capital
Discount received
Loans
Purchases return
Sales
Reserve for bad debts
Creditors

4,74,250

Amount
Rs.
1,50,000
2,980
15,000
1,450
2,81,500
4,650
18,670

4,74,250

Adjustments
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.

Closing stock Rs. 70,000


Create a reserve for bad and doubtful debts @ 10% on book debts
Insurance prepaid Rs. 50
Rent outstanding Rs. 150
Interest on loan is due @ 6% p.a.

Solution
Trading and Profit and Loss Account
for the year ended March 31, 2005
Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses
Opening stock
Purchase
Less Purchases return
Carriage
Gross profit c/d

Amount
Rs.
60,220
1,99,080
(1,450)

1,97,630
5,170
86,610
3,49,630

Revenues/Gains

Amount
Rs.

Sales
2,81,500
Less : Sales return (1,870) 2,79,630
Closing stock
70,000

3,49,630

396

Accountancy

Discount allowed
Bank charges
Salaries
Rent and Taxes
7,680
Add Rent outstanding
150
General expenses
Insurance
750
Less Insurance prepaid
(50)
Bad debts
1,250
Add New provision
8,274
for bad debts
9,524
Less Old provision
(4,650)
for bad debts
Interest on loan outstanding
Net profit (transferred to
capital account)

3,960
100
6,420

Gross profit b/d


Discount received

86,610
2,980

7,830
3,630
700

4,874
900
61,176
89,590

89,590

Balance Sheet as at March 31, 2005

Liabilities
Creditors
Loan
Add Interest on loan
outstanding
Rent outstanding
Capital
Add Net profit
Less Drawings

15,000
900

Amount
Rs.

Assets

Amount
Rs.

18,670

Cash at bank

13,870

15,900

Book debts

150
1,50,000
61,176
2,11,176
(6,300)

2,04,876

2,39,596

82,740

Less Reserve
(8,274)
for bad debts
Bills receivable
Land and Building
Furniture
Plant and Machinery
Insurance (prepaid)
Closing stock

74,466
1,860
42,580
5,130
31,640
50
70,000
2,39,596

Financial Statements - II

397

Illustration 2
The following were the balances extracted from the books of Yogita as on March 31, 2005
:
Debit Balances

Amount
Rs.

Credit Balances

Cash in hand
Cash at bank
Purchases
Return inwards
Wages
Fuel and Power
Carriage on sales
Carriage on purchases
Opening stock
Building
Freehold land
Machinery
Salaries
Patents
General expenses
Insurance
Drawings
Sundry debtors

540
2,630
40,675
680
8,480
4,730
3200
2040
5,760
32,000
10,000
20,000
15,000
7,500
3,000
600
5,245
14,500

Sales
Return outwards
Capital
Sundry creditors
Rent

Amount
Rs.
98,780
500
62,000
6,300
9,000

Taking into account the following adjustments prepare trading and profit and loss account
and balance sheet as on March 31, 2005 :
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)

Stock in hand on March 31, 2005,was Rs. 6,800.


Machinery is to be depreciated at the rate of 10% and patents @ 20%.
Salaries for the month of March, 2005 amounting to Rs. 1,500 were outstanding.
Insurance includes a premium of Rs. 170 on a policy expiring on September 30,
2006.
(e) Further bad debts are Rs. 725. Create a provision @ 5% on debtors.

398

Accountancy

(f) Rent receivable Rs. 1,000.


Solution:
Books of Yogita
Trading and Profit and Loss Account
for the year ended March 31, 2005
Dr.
Expenses/Losses
Opening stock
Purchases
Less Return outwards
Wages
Fuel and Power
Carriage on purchases
Gross profit c/d

Amount
Rs.
5,760
40,675
(500)

Salaries
15,000
Add Outstanding salaries 1,500
Carriage
General expenses
Insurance
600
Less Prepaid insurance
(85)
Further bad debts
725
Add Provision for bad debts 689
Depreciation : machinery 2,000
Patent
1,500
Net profit
(transferred to capital account)

40,175
8,480
4,730
2,040
43,715
1,04,900
16,500
3,200
3,000

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

Revenues/Gains

Sales
98,780
Less Return inwards (680)
Closing stock

Gross profit b/d


Rent
Add Accrued rent

98,100
6,800

1,04,900
43,715
9,000
1,000

10,000

515
1,414
3,500
25,586
53,715

53,715

Balance Sheet as at March 31, 2005


Dr.
Liabilities

Amount
Rs.
6,300

Sundry creditors
Salaries outstanding
Capital

1,500
62,000

Add Net profit

25,586
87,586

Less Drawings

(5,245)

82,341

90,141

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
540
2,630

Assets
Cash in hand
Cash in bank
Sundry debtors
Less Further
bad debts
Less Provision
for bad debts
Insurance prepaid
Stock
Rent accrued
Freehold land
Building
Machinery
Less Depreciation
Patents
Less Depreciation

14,500
(725)
13,775
(689)

13,086
85
6,800
1,000
10,000
32,000

20,000
(2,000)
7,500
(1,500)

18,000
6,000
90,141

Financial Statements - II

399

Illustration 3
The following balances were extracted from the books of Shri R. Lal on March 31, 2005
Account Title
Capital
Drawings
Purchases
Sales
Purchases return
Stock on April 01, 2004

Amount
Rs.
1,00,000
17,600
80,000
1,40,370
2,820
11,460

Bad debts
Bad debts reserve
April 01, 2004

1,400
3,240

Rates and Insurance


Discount (Cr.)
Bills receivable
Sales returns
Wages

1,300
190
1,240
4,240
6,280

Buildings

Account Title

Amount
Rs.

Rent (Cr.)
Railway freight on sales
Carriage inwards
Office expenses
Printing and Stationery
Postage and Telegram

2,100
16,940
2,310
1,340
660
820

Sundry debtors
Sundry creditors

62,070
18,920

Cash in bank
Cash in hand
Office furniture
Salaries and Commission
Addition to buildings

12,400
2,210
3,500
9,870
7,000

25,000

Prepare the trading and profit and loss account and a balance sheet as on March 31,
2005 after keeping in view the following adjustments :
(i) Depreciate old building by Rs. 625 and addition to building at 2% and office furniture
at 5%.
(ii) Write-off further bad debts Rs. 570.
(iii) Increase the bad debts reserve to 6% of debtors.
(iv) On March 31, 2005 Rs. 570 are outstanding for salary.
(v) Rent receivable Rs. 200 on March 31, 2005.
(vi) Interest on capital at 5% to be charged.
(vii) Unexpired insurance Rs. 240.
(viii) Stock was valued at Rs. 14,290 on March 31, 2005.

400

Accountancy

Solution
Books of Shri R. Lal
Trading and Profit and Loss Account
for the year ended March 31, 2005
Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses
Opening stock
Purchases
Less Purchase return
Carriage inwards
Wages
Gross profit c/d

Amount
Rs.
11,460
80,000
(2,820)

77,180
2,310
6,280
53,190

Revenues/Gains

Amount
Rs.

Sales
1,40,370
Less Sales Return
(4,240) 1,36,130

Closing stock

14,290

1,50,420
Railway freight on sales
Office expenses
Postage and Telegram
Printing and Stationery
Salary and Commission
9,870
Add Outstanding salary
570
Rates and Insurance
1,300
Less unexpired insurance
(240)
Bad debts
1,400
Add Further bad debts
570
Add New bad debts
3,690
provision
5660
Less Old provision
(3,240)
for bad debts
Interest on capital
Depreciation on building
Depreciation on addition
to building
Depreciation on furniture
Net profit (transferred to
capital account)

16,940
1,340
820
660

1,50,420
Gross profit c/d
Rent
Add Accrued rent
Discount

53,190
2,100
200

2,300
190

10,440
1,060

2,420
5,000
625
140
175
16,060
55,680

55,680

Financial Statements - II

401
Balance Sheet as at March 31, 2005

Liabilities
Sundry creditors
Outstanding salaries
Capital
Add Net profit
Add Interest on capital

Less Drawings

Amount
Rs.
18,920
570
1,00,000
16,060
5,000
1,21,060
(17,600)

1,03,460

Assets
Cash at bank
Cash in hand
Bills receivable

Debtors
62,070
Less Further bad debts (570)
61,500
Less New provision (3,690)
for bad debts
Accrued rent
Unexpired insurance
Building
25,000
Less Depreciation
(625)
Addition to building 7,000
(140)
Less Depreciation
Office furniture
3,500
Less Depreciation
(175)
Closing stock

1,22,950

Amount
Rs.
12,400
2,210
1,240

57,810
200
240
24,375
6,860
3,325
14,290
1,22,950

Illustration 4
Prepare the trading profit and loss account of M/s Mohit Traders as on 31 March
2006 and draw necessary Journal entries and balance sheet as on that date :
Debit Balances
Opening stock
Purchases
Cash in hand
Cash at bank
Return inwards
Wages
Fuel and Power
Carriage inwards
Insurance
Buildings
Plant
Patents
Salaries
Furniture
Drawings
Rent
Debtors

Amount
Rs.
24,000
1,60,000
16,000
32,000
4,000
22,000
18,000
6,000
8,000
1,00,000
80,000
30,000
28,000
12,000
18,000
2,000
80,000
6,40,000

Credit Balances
Sales
Return outwards
Capital
Creditors
Bills payable
Commission received

Amount
Rs.
4,00,000
2,000
1,50,000
64,000
20,000
4,000

6,40,000

402

Accountancy
Adjustments
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)

Rs.
12,000
6,000
2,400

Salaries outstanding
Wages outstanding
Commission is accrued
Depreciation on building 5% and plant 3%
Insurance paid in advance
Closing stock

700
12,000

Solution
Books of Mohit Traders
Journal
Date

Particulars

2005
March 31 Salary A/c
Wages A/c
To Salary outstanding A/c
To Wages outstanding A/c
(Amount of salary and wages outstanding
as on March 31, 2006)

L.F.

Dr.
Dr.

Debit
Amount
Rs.

12,000
6,000
12,000
6,000

March 31 Prepaid Insurance A/c


To Insurance A/c
(Insurance paid in advance]

Dr.

March 31 Commission accrued A/c

Dr.

1,400
1,400
2,400

To Commission A/c
(Commission accrued but not received)

2,400

March 31 Depreciation A/c


Dr.
To Building A/c
To Plant A/c
(Depreciation charged on plant and building)
March 31 Profit and Loss A/c
To Capital A/c
(Profit transferred to capital account)

Credit
Amount
Rs.

Dr.

7,400
5,000
2,400
1,23,700
1,23,700

Financial Statements - II

403
Books of Mohit Traders
Trading and Profit and Loss Account
for the year ended March 31, 2006

Dr.

Cr.

Expenses /Losses

Amount
Rs.

Opening stock
Purchases
1,60,000
Less returns
(2,000)
Wages
22,000
Add Outstanding wages
6,000
Fuel and Power
Carriage inwards
Gross profit c/d

24,000
1,58,000

Revenue/Gains
Sales
Less Returns
Closing stock

Amount
Rs.
4,00,000
(4,000) 3,96,000
12,000

28,000
18,000
6,000
1,74,000
4,08,000

Salary
Add Outstanding salary
Insurances
Less Prepaid
Rent
Depreciation on building

28,000
12,000
8,000
(700)

Plants
Net Profit (transferred to capital
account)

40,000
7,300
2,000
5,000

4,08,000
Gross Profit b/d
1,74,000
Commission received(4,000)
Add Accrued
2,400
6,400
commission

2,400
1,23,700
1,80,400

1,80,400

Balance Sheet as at March 31, 2006


Liabilities
Creditors
Bills payable
Capital
Add Net profit
Less Drawings
Outstanding salaries
Outstanding wages

Amount
Rs.
64,000
20,000
1,50.000
1,23,700
2,73,700
(18,000)

2,55,700
12,000
6,000

3,57,700

Assets
Cash in hand
Cash at bank
Building
Plant
Patents
Debtors
Insurance prepaid
Commission accrued
Furniture
Closing stock

Amount
Rs.
16,000
32,000
95,000
77,600
30,000
80,000
700
2,400
12,000
12,000
3,57,700

404

Accountancy

Illustration 5
The following information has been extracted from the trial balance of M/s Randhir
Transport Corporation.
Debit balances
Opening stock
Rent
Plant and Machinery
Land and Buildings
Power
Purchases
Sales return
Telegram and Postage
Wages
Salary
Insurance
Discount
Repair and Renewals
Legal charges
Trade taxes
Debtors
Investment
Bad debts
Trade expenses
Commission
Travelling expenses
Drawings

Amount
Rs.
40,000
2,000
1,20,000
2,55,000
3,500
75,000
2,500
400
4,500
2,500
3,200
1,000
2,000
700
1,200
75,000
65,000
2,000
4,500
1,250
1,230
20,020
6,82,500

Credit balances
Capital
Creditors
Bills payable
Loan
Discount
Sales
Provision for bad debts
General reserves

Amount
Rs.
2,70,000
50,000
50,000
1,10,000
1,500
1,50,000
1,000
50,000

6,82,500

Adjustments
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.

Closing stock for the year was Rs. 35,500.


Depreciation charged on plant and machinery 5% and land and building 6%.
Interest on drawing @ 6% and Interest on loan @ 5%.
Interest on investments @ 4%.
Further bad debts 2,500 and make provision for bad debts on debtors 5%.
Discount on debtors @ 2%.
Salary outstanding Rs. 200.
Wages outstanding Rs. 100.
Insurance prepaid Rs. 500.

You are required to make trading and profit and loss account and a balance sheet on
March 31, 2005.

Financial Statements - II

405

Solution
Books of Randhir Transport Corporation
Trading and Profit and Loss Account
for the year ended March 31, 2005
Expenses/Losses
Opening stock
Purchases
Wages
Add Outstanding wages
Power
Gross profit c/d

Amount
Rs.
40,000
75,000
4,500
100

Revenue/Gains
Sales
Less Sales return
Closing stock

Amount
Rs.
1,50,000
(2,500)

4,600
3,500
59,900
1,83,000

Rent
Telegram and Postage
Salary
2,500
Add Outstanding salary
200
Insurance
3,200
Less Prepaid
(500)
Discount
Repair and Renewals
Legal charges
Trade taxes
Trade expenses
Outstanding interest on loan
Commission
Travelling expenses
Discount on debtors
Depreciation on Plant and
Machinery
Depreciation on Land and
Building
Bad debts
2,000
Add Further bad debts
2,500
Add New provision
3,553
8,053
Less Old provision
(1,000)
Net Profit (transferred to
capital account)

1,47,500
35,500

2,000
400

2,700

1,83,000
Gross profit b/d
Outstanding interest
on investment
Discount
Interest on drawings

59,900
2,600
1,500
1,200

2,700
1,000
2,000
700
1,200
4,500
5,500
1,250
1,230
1,450
6,000
15,300

7,053
10,217
65,200

65,200

406

Accountancy
Balance Sheet as at March 31, 2005

Liabilities

Amount
Rs.

Assets

Creditors
Bills payable
Loan
1,10,000
Add Outstanding interest 5,500
General reserve
Capital
2,70,000
Add Net Profit
10,217
2,80,217

50,000
50,000

Debtors
Less Further
bad debts
Less Discount

Less Drawings

1,15,500
50,000

(20,020)

2,60,197
Less Interest on drawings 1,200
Outstanding salary
Outstanding wages

2,58,997
200
100

75,000
(2,500)
72,500
(1,450)
71,050
Less New Provision (3,553)
Investment
Outstanding interest
on investment
Insurance pre-paid

Plant and Machinery


Land and Building
Closing stock

5,24,797

Amount
Rs.

67,497
65,000
2,600
500

1,14,000
2,39,700
35,500
5,24,797

Illustration 6
From the following balances of M/s Keshav Bros. You are required to prepare trading and
profit and loss account and a balance sheet of March 31, 2005.
Debit balances
Plant and Machinery
Debtors
Interest
Wages
Salary
Carriage inwards
Carriage outwards
Return inwards
Factory rent
Office rent
Insurance
Furniture
Buildings
Bills receivable
Cash in hand
Cash at bank
Commission
Opening stock
Purchases
Bad debts

Amount
Rs.
1,30,000
50,000
2,000
1,200
2,500
500
700
2,000
1,450
2,300
780
22,500
2,80,000
3,000
22,500
35,000
500
60,000
2,50,000
3,500
8,70,430

Credit balances
Sales
Return outwards
Creditors
Bills payable
Provision for bad debts
Capital
Rent received
Commission received

Amount
Rs.
3,00,000
2,500
2,50,000
70,000
1,550
2,20,000
10,380
16,000

8,70,430

Financial Statements - II

407

Adjustment
(i)
(ii)
(iii)
(iv)

Provision for bad debts @ 5% and further bad debts Rs. 2,000.
Rent received in advance Rs. 6,000.
Prepaid insurance Rs. 200.
Depreciation on furniture @ 5%, plant and machinery @ 6%, building @ 7%.

Solution
Books of Keshav Bros.
Trading and Profit and Loss Account
for the year ended March 31, 2005
Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses
Opening stock
Purchases
Less Returns
Wages
Carriage inwards
Factory rent
Gross profit c/d

2,50,000
(2,500)

Amount
Rs.

Revenue/Gains

60,000

Sales
Less Return
Closing stock

2,47,500
1,200
500
1,450
57,350

Amount
Rs.
3,00,000
(2,000)

3,68,000
Interest
Salary
Carriage outwards
Office Rent
Insurance
780
Less Prepaid insurance
(200)
Depreciation on furniture
Depreciation on Plant and
Machinery
Depreciation on building
Commission
Bad debts
3,500
Add Further bad debts
2,000
Add New provision
2,400
7,900
Less Old provision
(1,550)
Net Profit (transferred to
capital account)

2,000
2,500
700
2,300

2,98,000
70,000

3,68,000
Gross profit b/d
Rent received
10,380
Less Advance rent (6,000)
Commission received

57,350
4,380
16,000

580
1,125
7,800
19,600
500

6,350
34,275
77,730

77,730

408

Accountancy
Balance Sheet as at March 31, 2005

Liabilities
Creditors
Bills payable
Advance rent
Capital
Add Net profit

Amount
Rs.

2,20,000
34,275

Liabilities

Amount
Rs.

2,50,000
70,000
6,000

Cash In hand
Cash at bank
Bills receivable

22,500
35,000
3,000

2,54,275

Prepaid insurance
200
Debtors
50,000
Less Further
(2,000)
bad debts
48,000
Less New provision (2400)
45,600
Plant and Machinery
1,22,200
Furniture
21,375
Buildings
2,60,400
Closing stock
70,000

5,80,275

5,80,275

Illustration 7
The following information have been taken from the trial balance of M/s Fair Brothers Ltd.
You are required to prepare the trading and profit and loss account and a balance sheet as
at March 31, 2006.
Debit Balances
Cash
Wages
Return outwards
Bad debts
Salaries
Octroi
Charity
Machinery
Debtors (Including a
dishonoured bill of Rs.1,600)
Stock
Purchases
Repairs
Interest on loan
Sales tax
Insurance
Rent

Amount
Rs.
20,000
45,050
4,800
4,620
16,000
1,000
250
32,000
60,000

Credit balances
Sales
Loan 12% (1.7.2005)
Discount received
Return (Purchase)
Creditors
Capital

Amount
Rs.
3,61,000
40,000
1,060
390
60,610
75,000

81,600
2,60,590
3,350
1,200
1,600
2,000
4,000
5,38,060

5,38,060

Financial Statements - II

409

Adjustments
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.

Wages include Rs. 4,000 for erection of new machinery on April 01, 2005.
Provide 5% depreciation on furniture.
Salaried unpaid Rs.1,600.
Closing stock Rs. 81,850.
Create a provision at 5% on debtors.
Half the amount of bill is recoverable.
Rent is paid up to July 30, 2006.
Insurance unexpired Rs. 600.
Books of Fair Brothers Ltd.
Trading and Profit and Loss Account
for the year ended March 31, 2006

Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses
Opening stock
Purchases
Less Purchases return
Wages
Less Prepaid wages
including erection of
machines
Octroi
Gross profit c/d

Amount
Rs.
81,600
2,60,590
(390)
45,050
(4,000)

2,60,200

Revenue/Gains
Sales
Less Sales return
Closing stock

3,61,000
(4,800)

3,56,200
81,850

41,050

1,000
54,200
4,38,050

Salaries
Add Outstanding salary

Amount
Rs.

16,000
1,600

Repairs
Bad debts
Add Further bad debts
Add New provision
Interest on loan
Add Outstanding interest
Sales tax
Insurance
Less Prepaid insurance
Charity
Rent
Less Prepaid rent
Depreciation on machinery
Net profit (transferred to
capital account)

17,600

4,38,050
Gross profit b/d
Discount received

54,200
1,060

3,350
4,620
800
2,960
1,200
2,400
2,000
(600)
4,000
1,000

8,380
3,600
1,600
1,400
250
3,000
1,800
14,280
55,260

55,260

410

Accountancy
Balance Sheet as at March 31, 2006

Liabilities
Creditors
Outstanding salaries
Loan
Outstanding interest
Capital
Add Net profit

Amount
Rs.
60,610
1,600
40,000
2,400
75,000
14,280

89,280

Assets
Cash
Debtors
60,000
Less Bad debts
(800)
Less Provision
2,960
Prepaid rent
Unexpired insurance
Machinery
32,000
4,000
Add Erection
Wages
36,000
Less Depreciation
(1,800)
Closing stock

1,93,890

Amount
Rs.
20,000

56,240
1,000
600

34,200
81,850
1,93,890

Illustration 8
From the following balance extracted from the books of of M/s Hariharan Brother, you are
require to prepare the trading and profit and loss account and a balance sheet as on December
31, 2005.
Debit balance
Opening stock
Purchases
Return inwards
Carriage inwards
Carriage outwards
Wages
Salaries
Rent
Freight and Dock
Fire Insurance premium
Bad debts
Discount
Printing and Stationery
Rates and Taxes
Travelling expenses
Trade expenses
Business premises
Furniture
Bills receivable
Debtors
Machine
Loan
Investment
Cash in hand
Cash at bank
Proprietors withdrawals

Amount
Rs.
16,000
40,000
3,000
2,400
5,000
6,600
11,000
2,200
4,800
1,800
4,200
1,000
500
700
300
400
1,10,000
5,000
7,000
40,000
9,000
10,000
6,000
500
7,000
6,000
3,00,400

Credit balance
Capital
Sales
Return outwards
Apprenticeship premium
Bills payable
Creditors

Amount
Rs.
1,00,000
1,60,000
800
3,000
5,000
31,600

3,00,400

Financial Statements - II

411

Adjustments
1. Closing stock Rs. 14,000.
2. Wages outstanding Rs. 600, Salaries Outstanding Rs. 1,000, Rent outstanding Rs. 200.
3. Fire Insurance premium includes Rs. 1,200 paid in July 01, 2005 to run for one year
from July 01, 2005 to June 30, 2006.
4. Apprenticeship Premium is for three years paid in advance on January 01, 2005.
5. Stationery bill for Rs. 60 remain unpaid.
6. Depreciation on Premises @ 5%, furniture @ 10%, Machinery @ 10%.
7. Interest on loan given accrued for one year @ 7%.
8. Interest on investment @ 5% for half year to December 31, 2005 has accrued.
9. Interest on capital to be allowed at 5% for one year.
10. Interest on drawings to be charged to him ascertained for the year Rs. 160.
Solution
Books of Hariharan Bros.
Trading and Profit and Loss Account for the year ended December 31, 2005
Dr.
Expenses/Losses
Opening stock
Purchases
Less purchases return
Wages
Add Outstanding Wages
Carriage inwards
Freight and Dock
Gross profit c/d

Amount
Rs.
16,000
40,000
(800)
6,600
600

Salaries
11,000
Add Outstanding salary
1,000
Carriage outwords
Rates and Taxes
Printing and Stationery
500
Add Outstanding bill
60
Trade expenses
Travelling expenses
Fire insurance
1,800
(600)
Less Prepaid insurance
Bad debts
Rent
2,200
Add Outstanding rent
200
Interest on capital
Depreciation on Premises
Depreciation on furniture
Depreciation on machinery
Discount
Net profit (transferred to
capital account)

39,200

Revenue/Gains

Sales
1,60,000
Less Sales return
(3,000) 1,57,000
Closing stock
14,000

7,200
2,400
4,800
1,01,400
1,71,000
12,000
5,000
700
560
400
300

Cr.
Amount
Rs.

Gross profit b/d


Apprenticeship
3,000
premium
Less Advance premium (2,000)
Accrued interest on loan
Interest on drawings
Accrued interest on
investment

1,71,000
1,01,400

1,000
700
160
150

1,200
4,200
2,400
5,000
5,500
500
900
1,000
63,750
1,03,410

1,03,410

412

Accountancy

Balance Sheet as at December 31, 2005


Amount Assets
Amount
Rs.
Rs.
Capital
1,00,000
Premises
1,10,000
Add Interest on capital
5,000
Less Depreciation
(5,500) 1,04,500
Add Net profit
63,750
1,68,750
Furniture
4,500
Less drawings
(6,000)
1,62,750
Machinery
8,100
Less Interest on drawings (160) 1,62,590
Creditors
31,600 Debtors
40,000
Bills payable
5,000 Bills receivable
7,000
Outstanding wages
600 Cash in hand
500
Outstanding salaries
1,000 Cash at bank
7,000
Outstanding rent
200 Loan
10,000
Outstanding stationery
60 Add accrued interest
700
10,700
Apprenticeship premium (advance)
2,000 Investments
6,000
Add accrued interest
150
6,150
Pre-paid insurance
600
Closing stock
14,000
2,03,050
2,03,050

Liabilities

Illustration 9
The following balances have been extracted from the trial balance of M/s Kolkata Ltd. You
are required to prepare the trading and profit and loss account on dated March 31, 2006.
Also prepare balance sheet on that date.
Debit balances
Opening stock
Furniture
Drawings
Cash in hand
Purchases
Sales return
Establishment expenses
Bad debts
Debtors
Carriage
Bills receivable
Bank deposits
Wages
Trade expenses
Bank charges
General expenses
Salaries
Insurance
Postage and Telegram
Rent, Rates and Taxes
Coal, Gas, Water

Amount
Rs.
6,000
1,200
2,800
3,000
24,000
2,000
4,400
1,000
10,000
1,000
6,000
8,000
1,000
500
400
1,000
2,000
1,500
500
2,000
2,000
80,300

Credit balances
Capital
Sales
Purchases return
Bank overdraft
Bad debts provision
Creditors
Commission
Bills payable
Apprenticeship premium

Amount
Rs.
20,000
41,300
4,000
4,000
400
5,000
100
5,000
500

80,300

Financial Statements - II

413

Adjustments
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.

Outstanding salaries Rs. 100. Rent and taxes Rs. 200, Wages Rs. 100.
Unexpired insurance Rs. 500.
Commission is received in advances Rs. 50.
Interest Rs. 500 is to be received on bank deposits.
Interest on bank overdraft Rs. 750.
Depreciation on furniture @ 10%.
Closing stock Rs. 9,000.
Further bad debts Rs. 200 New provision @ 5% on debtors.
Apprenticeship premium received in advance Rs. 100.
Interest on drawings @ 6%.

Solution
Books of Kolkata Ltd.
Trading and Profit and Loss Account for the year ended as at March 31, 2006
Dr.

Cr.

Expenses /Losses
Opening stock
Purchases
Less purchases return
Wages
Add Outstanding wages
Coal, Gas, Water
Gross profit c/d

Amount
Rs.
6,000
24,000
(4,000)
1,000
100

20,000

Revenue/Gains
Sales
Less sales return
Closing stock

Amount
Rs.
41300
(2,000)

39,300
9,000

1,100
2,000
19,200
48,300

Establishment expenses
Carriage
Trade expenses
Bank charges

4,400
1,000
500
400

General expenses
Salaries
2,000
Add Outstanding salary
100
Insurance
1,500
(500)
Less Prepaid insurance
Postage and Telegram
Rent, rates and Taxes
Interest on bank overdraft
Bad debts
1,000
Add Further bad debts
200
Add New provision
490
1,690
Less Old provision
(400)
Depreciation on furniture
Net profit (transferred to
capital account)

1,000
2,100

48,300
Gross profit b/d
Commission
100
Less Advance commission (50)
Accrued interest on
deposits
Apprenticeship premium 500
Less Advance received 100
Interest on drawings

19,200
50
500

400
168

1,000
500
2,200
750

1,290
120
5,058
20,318

20,318

414

Accountancy
Balance Sheet as at March 31, 2006

Liabilities

Amount
Rs.

Capital
Net profit

2,00,00
5,058
25,058
Less Drawings
(2,800)
22,258
Less Interest on drawings (168)
Creditors
Commission received in advance
Apprenticeship premium

Assets
Insurance prepaid
Bank deposits

22,090
5,000
50
100

Outstanding wages

100

Outstanding salaries
Outstanding rent,
rates, taxes
Bank overdraft
Add Outstanding interest
Bills payable

100
200

8,000

Add outstanding interest 500

8,500

Furniture
Cash in hand
Debtors
Less Further
bad debts
Less Provision for
bad debts
Bills receivable

1,080
3,000

Closing stock
4,000
750

Amount
Rs.
500

10,000
(200)
9,800
(490)

9,310
6,000
9,000

4,750
5,000
37,390

37,390

Illustration 10
Prepare the trading and profit and loss account of M/s Roni Plastic Ltd. from the following
trial balance and a balance sheet as at March 31, 2006.
Debit balances
Drawings
Sundry debtors
Carriage outwards
Establishment expenses
Interest on loan
Cash in hand
Stock
Motor car
Cash at bank
Land and Buildings
Bad debts
Purchases
Sales return
Advertisement
Carriage inward
Rates, taxes, insurance
General expenses
Bills receivable

Amount
Rs.
6,000
38,200
2,808
16,194
400
6,100
11,678
18,000
9,110
24,000
1,250
1,34,916
15,642
4,528
7,858
7,782
8,978
13,764
3,27,208

Credit balances
Creditors
Capital
Loan on mortgage
Bad debts provision
Sales
Purchases return
Discount
Bills payable
Rent received

Amount
Rs.
16,802
60,000
17,000
1,420
2,22,486
2,692
880
5,428
500

3,27,208

Financial Statements - II

415

Adjustments
1. Depreciation on land and building at @ 5% and Motor vehicle at @ 15%.
2. Interest on loan is @ 5% taken on April 01, 2005.
3. Goods costing Rs1,200 were sent to a customer on sale on return basis for Rs. 1,400
on March 30, 2006 and has been recorded in the books as actual sales.
4. Salaries amounting to Rs. 1,400 and Rates amounting to Rs. 800 are due.
5. The bad debts provision is to be brought up to @ 5% on sundry debtors.
6. Closing stock was Rs. 13,700.
7. Goods costing Rs. 1,000 were taken away by the proprietor for his personal use but
not entry has been made in the books of account.
8. Insurance pre-paid Rs. 350.
9. Provide the managers commission at @ 5% on Net profit after charging such commission.
Solution
Books of Ronis Plastic Ltd.
Trading and Profit and Loss Account for the year ended March 31, 2006
Dr.
Cr.
Expenses/Losses
Amount Revenue/Gains
Amount
Rs.
Rs.
Opening stock
11,678 Sales
2,22,486
Purchases
1,34,916
Less Sales
15,642
return
2,06,844
Less Purchases return
2,692
Less Return basis
(1,400) 2,05,444
1,32,224
13,700
Less Goods withdrawn
(1,000) 1,31,224 Closing stock
Carriage inwards
7,858
Gross profit c/d
68,384
2,19,144
2,19,144
Outstanding salaries
1,400 Gross profit b/d
68,384
Carriage outwards
2,808 Discount
880
Establishment expenses
16,194 Rent
500
Bad debts
1,250
Add New provision
1,840
3,090
Less Old provision
(1,420)
1,670
Rates and Taxes
7,782
(350)
Less Prepaid
7,432
Add Outstanding
800
8,232
Advertisement
4,528
Interest on loan
400
Add Outstanding Interest
450
850
General expenses
8,978
Depreciation on :
Land and Building
1,200
Motor car
2,700
3,900
Manager commission
1,010
Net profit (transferred to
20,194
capital account)
69,764
69,764

416

Accountancy
Balance Sheet as at March 31, 2006

Liabilities
Capital
Add Net profit
Less Drawings
Less Goods withdrawn
loan
Add interest
Bills payable
Creditors
Outstanding Salaries
Outstanding Rates Taxes
Manager commission

Amount
Rs.
60,000
20,194
80,194
(6,000)
(74,194)
1,000
17,000
450

73,194

17,450
5,428
16,802
1,400
800
1,010

Assets

Amount
Rs.

Cash in hand

6,100

Cash at bank

9,110

Bills receivable
Debtors
Less sales
return basis
Less New provisions
Land and Building
Less Depreciation
Motor car
Less Depreciation
Prepaid insurance
Closing stock

1,16,084

13,764
38,200
(1,400)
36,800
(1,840)
24,000
(1,200)
18,000
(2,700)

34,960
22,800
15,300
350
13,700
1,16,084

10.13 Methods of Presenting the Financial Statements


The financial statements, i.e. trading and profit and loss account and balance
sheet can be presented in two ways:
(1) Horizontal form
(2) Vertical form
Under horizontal form of presentation, items are shown side by side in the
trading and profit and loss account and also in the balance sheet as we are
doing so far. This format is rather technical in nature and is not easily
comprehensible for many users. Hence, now-a-days, most firms present them
in a simpler and more intelligible form called a narrative style or vertical
presentation. Under vertical presentation, the final accounts are prepared in
a form of statement with different items being shown on below the other in a
purposeful sequence. Under vertical presentation, the trading and profit and
loss account will appear as shown in figure 10.3.

Financial Statements - II

417

Income Statement for the period ended ......


Particulars
Sales (Gross)
Less Returns
Net sales
Cost of goods sold
Opening stock
Purchases
...
Less Returns
...
Carriage Inwards
Wages
Cost of goods available for sale
Less Closing stock
Gross Profit
Operaing Expenses
(a) Selling expenses
Advertising
Discount
Allowances
Bad debts and Provisions
Carriage outwards
Total selling expenses
(b) General and Administration expenses
Salaries
Rent and Rates
Insurance
Depreciation
Postage
Repairs
General expenses
Total operating expenses
Net Income from operations (Operating profit)
Other Income (Non-operating gains)
Interest earned
Commission earned
Profit on sale of fixed assets
Less Deductions (Non-operating expenses)
Interest paid
Loss by fire
Net non-operating gains
Net income (Net profit)

Amount

...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...

Amount
Rs.
...
...

...

...
...

...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...

...
...
...
...
...
...

...
...
...

...

...
...

418

Accountancy

Under the vertical presentation, the Balance Sheet will appear as follows :
Balance Sheet as on ........
Particulars

Amount

Current Assets
Cash in hand
Cash at bank
Bills receivable
Accrued income
Debtors
Stock
Prepaid expenses
Total current assets
Less Current Liabilities
Bank overdraft
Outstanding expenses
Bills payable
Trade creditors
Income received in advance
Total current liabilities
Net working capital
(Current assets and Current liabilities)
Fixed Assets
Furniture and Fixtures
Patents
Plants and Machhinery
Building
Land
Goodwill
Total fixed assets
Total assets (After paying current liabilities)
Capital Employed
Long-term liabilities
Loan
Mortgage
Total long-term liabilities
Net assets (being the difference between
total assets and long-term liabilities)
Capital (Proprietor)
Capital in the begining
Add Capital introduced during the current year
Interest on capital, salary, etc.
Profit for the current year
Less Drawings during the current year
Interest on drawing
Loss for the current year
Total capital of the proprietor at the end of the year

Amount
Rs.

...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...

...
...

...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...
...

Fig. 10.3 : Showing vertical presentation of financial statements

...

Financial Statements - II

419

Illustration 11
From the following balances extracted from the books of M/s Rohit Traders, prepare the
profit and loss account and balance sheet in the vertical form as on March 31, 2006.
Debit Balances
Opening stock
Purchases
Debtors
Discounts
Carriage outwards
Drawings
Insurance
Salaries
Investments
Motor car
Plants
Land and Building
Carriage inwards
Legal charges
Audit fee
Fuel and Power
Wages
Return inwards
Cash at bank
Cash in hand
Interest
Bad debts

Amount
Rs.
11,520
81,000
28,000
2,000
6,000
10,500
1,200
30,000
20,000
15,000
40,000
80,000
4,080
3,200
3,200
9,460
10,960
1,360
5,200
2,000
2,000
1,320
3,68,000

Adjustments
Closing stock Rs. 4,000
Depreciation on Plant and Buildings @ 10%.

Credit Balances

Amount
Rs.

Capital
Return outwards
Creditors
Commission

1,40,000
400
12,600
5,000

Sales
Long-terms loan

1,98,000
12,000

3,68,000

420

Accountancy

Solution
Books of Rohit Traders
Profit and Loss Account
for the year ended March 31, 2006
Particulars
A
Net Sales
Less Sales return
Cost of goods sold
Opening stock
Purchase
Less Purchases return
Carriage Inwards
Fuel and Power
Wages
Cost of goods available for sale
Less Closing stock

Amount
Rs.

Amount
Rs.

1,98,000
[1,360]

1,96,640

11,520
81,000
(400)

Gross Profit

Operating expenses
(a) Administrative Expenses
Insurance
Salaries
Legal charges
Audit fee
Depreciation (Rs. 4,000 + Rs. 8,000)

80,600
4,080
9,460
10,960
1,16,620
(4,000)

1,12,620
84,020

{A-B}

1,200
30,000
3,200
3,200
12,000
49,600

(b)

Selling and Distribution Expenses


Carriage outwards
Discount
Bad debts
Total operating expenses
[a+b]

Net operating profit

Non-operating incomes
Commission earned
Less Interest paid

6,000
2,000
1,320
58,920

[C-D]

Net profit transferred to capital account

25,100
5,000
(2,000)

3,000
28,100

Financial Statements - II

421

Balance sheet of Rohit Traders as at March 31,2006


Particulars

Amount
Rs.

Sources of firms funds


a
Proprietors fund
Opening capital
Add Net profit

1,40,000
28,100
1,68100
(10,500)

Less Drawings
Long -term loan

Amount
Rs.

1,57,600
12,000
1,69,600

Application of Funds
(i) Cash In hand
Cash at bank
Closing stock
Debtors
(ii) Less Creditors
(a) Investments
(b) Fixed assets :
Motor car
Plants
Land and Buildings

2,000
5,200
4,000
28,000

39,200
12,600

15,000
36,000
72,000

26,600
20,000

1,23,000
1,69,600

Key Terms Introduced in the Chapter

Outstanding /Accrued expenses


Accrued Incomes
Depreciation
Provision for doubtful debts
Managers commission
Horizontal form

Prepaid/Unexpired expenses
Income received in advance
Bad Debts
Provision for discount on debtors
Interest on capital
Vertical form

Summary with Reference to Learning Objectives


1

Need for adjustments : For the preparation of financial statements, it is


necessary that all the adjustments arising out of the accrual basis of accounting
are made at the end of the accounting period. Another important consideration
in the preparation of final accounts with adjustments, is the distinction
between capital and revenue items. Entries which are recorded to give effect to
these adjustments are known as adjusting entries.
Outstanding expenses : At the end of the accounting period sometimes a business
enterprises is left with some unpaid expenses due to one reason or another.
Such expenses are termed as outstanding expenses.

422

Accountancy
3.

4.

5.

Prepaid expenses : At the end of the accounting year, it is found that the
benefits of some expenses have not been fully received; a portion of total
benefits would be received in the next accounting year. That portion of the
expense, the benefit of which will be received during the next accounting
period is known as prepaid expenses.
Accrued Income : These are certain items is received by a business enterprise
but the whole amount of it does not belong to the next period. Such portion of
income which belongs to the next accounting period is income received in advance
and is known as unearned income.
Depreciation : Depreciation is the decline in the value of an asset an account of
wear and tear or passage of time or with. It actually amounts to writing off a
portion of the cost of an asset which has been used in the business for the
purpose of earning profits. In the balance sheet, the asset is shown at loss
minus the amount of depreciation.
Provisions for bad and doubtful debts : It is a normal feature of business
operations that some debts prove irrecoverable which means that the amount
to the realised from them becomes had to view of this. An attempt is made to
bring in a certain element of certainty in the amount in respect of bad debts
charged every year against incomes.
Questions for Practice

Short Answers
1.
2.
3.

4.
5.
6.

7.
8.

Why is it necessary to record the adjusting entries in the preparation of final


accounts?
What is meant by closing stock? Show its treatment in final accounts?
State the meaning of:
(a) Outstanding expenses
(b) Prepaid expenses
(c) Income received in advance
(d) Accrued income
Give the Performa of income statement and balance in vertical form.
Why is it necessary to create a provision for doubtful debts at the time of
preparation of final accounts?
What adjusting entries would you record for the following :
(a) Depreciation
(b) Discount on debtors
(c) Interest on capital
(d) Managers commission
What is meant by provision for discount on debtors?
Give the journal entries for the following adjustments :
(a) Outstanding salary Rs. 3,500.
(b) Rent unpaid for one month at Rs. 6,000 per annum.
(c) Insurance prepaid for a quarter at Rs. 16,000 per annum.
(d) Purchase of furniture costing Rs. 7,000 entered in the purchases book.

Financial Statements - II

423

Long Answers
1.
2.

3.

What are adjusting entries? Why are they necessary for preparing final
accounts?
What is meant by provision for doubtful debts? How are the relevant accounts
prepared and what journal entries are recorded in final accounts? How is the
amount for provision for doubtful debts calculated?
Show the treatment of prepaid expenses depreciation, closing stock at the
time of preparation of final accounts when:
(a) When given inside the trial balance?
(b) When given outside the trial balance?

Numerical Questions
1.

Prepare a trading and profit and loss account for the year ending December
31, 2005. from the balances extracted of M/s Rahul Sons. Also prepare a
balance sheet at the end of the year.

Account Title
Stock
Wages
Salary
Purchases
Sales return
Sundry Debtors
Discount allowed
Insurance
Rent Rates and Taxes
Fixtures and fittings
Trade expenses
Bad debts
Drawings
Repair and renewals
Travelling expenses
Postage
Telegram expenses
Legal fees
Bills receivable
Building

Amount
Rs.
50,000
3,000
8,000
1,75,000
3,000
82,000
1,000
3,200
4,300
20,000
1,500
2,000
32,000
1,600
4,200
300
200
500
50,000
1,10,000
5,51,800

Account Title
Sales
Purchases return
Discount received
Provision for bad debts
Capital
Bills payable
Commission received
Rent
Loan

Amount
Rs.
1,80,000
2,000
500
2,500
3,00,000
22,000
4,000
6,000
34,800

5,51,800

Adjustments
1. Commission received in advance Rs.1,000.
2. Rent receivable Rs. 2,000.
3. Salary outstanding Rs. 1,000 and insurance prepaid Rs. 800.

424

Accountancy

2.

4. Further bad debts Rs. 1,000 and provision for bad debts @ 5% on debtors
and discount on debtors @ 2%.
5. Closing stock Rs. 32,000.
6. Depreciation on building @ 6% p.a.
(Ans : Gross loss Rs.17,000 ; Net loss Rs.43,189 ; Total balance sheet
Rs.2,83,611)
Prepare a trading and profit and loss account of M/s Green Club Ltd. for the
year ending December 31, 2005. from the following figures taken from his
trial balance :

Account Title
Opening stock
Purchases
Return inwards
Postage and Telegram
Salary
Wages
Rent and Rates
Packing and Transport
General expense
Insurance
Debtors
Cash in hand
Cash at bank
Machinery
Lighting and Heating
Discount
Bad debts
Investment

Amount
Rs.
35,000
1,25,000
25,000
600
12,300
3,000
1,000
500
400
4,000
50,000
20,000
40,000
20,000
5,000
3,500
3,500
23,100
3,71,900

Account Title
Sales
Purchase return
Creditors
Bills payable
Discount
Provision for bad debts
Interest received
Capital

Amount
Rs.
2,50,000
6,000
10,000
20,000
1,000
4,500
5,400
75,000

3,71,900

Adjustments
1. Depreciation charged on machinery @ 5% p.a.
2. Further bad debts Rs.1,500, discount on debtors @ 5% and make a
provision on debtors @ 6%.
3. Wages prepaid Rs.1,000.
4. Interest on investment @ 5% p.a.
5. Closing stock 10,000.
(Ans. : Gross Profit Rs.79.000 ; Net Profit Rs.52,565 ; Total Balance Sheet
Rs.1,57,565).

Financial Statements - II

425

3 The following balances has been extracted from the trial of M/s Runway
Shine Ltd. Prepare a trading and profit and loss account and a balance sheet
as on December 31, 2005.
Account Title
Purchases
Opening stock
Return inwards
Carriage inwards
Cash in hand
Cash at bank
Wages
Printing and Stationery
Discount
Bad debts
Insurance
Investment
Debtors
Bills receivable
Postage and Telegraph
Commission
Interest
Repair
Lighting Charges
Telephone charges
Carriage outward
Motor car

Amount
Rs.
1,50,000
50,000
2,000
4,500
77,800
60,800
2,400
4,500
400
1,500
2,500
32,000
53,000
20,000
400
200
1,000
440
500
100
400
25,000
4,89,440

Account Title
Sales
Return outwards
Interest received
Discount received
Creditors
Bill payable
Capital

Amount
Rs.
2,50,000
4,500
3,500
400
1,25,000
6,040
1,00,000

4,89,440

Adjustments
1. Further bad debts Rs. 1,000. Discount on debtors Rs. 500 and make a
provision on debtors @ 5%.
2. Interest received on investment @ 5%.
3. Wages and interest outstanding Rs. 100 and Rs. 200 respectely.
4. Depreciation charged on motor car @ 5% p.a.
5. Closing Stock Rs. 32,500.
(Ans. : Gross profit Rs. 78,000 ; Net profit Rs. 66,060, Total balance sheet
Rs. 2,97,400)

426

Accountancy
4.

The following balances have been extracted from the trial of M/s Haryana
Chemical Ltd. You are required to prepare a trading and profit and loss account
and balance sheet as on December 31, 2005 from the given information.

Account Title
Opening stock
Purchases
Sales return
Cash in hand
Cash at bank
Carriage
Free hold land
Patents
General Expenses
Sundry Debtors
Building
Machinery
Insurance
Drawings
Motor vehicle
Bad debts
Light and Water
Trade expenses
Power
Salary and Wages
Loan a 15% (01.09.2005)

Amount
Rs.
50,000
1,25,500
2,000
21,200
12,000
100
3,20,000
1,20,000
2,000
32,500
86,000
34,500
12,400
10,000
10,500
2,000
1,200
2,000
3,900
5,400
3,000
8,56,200

Account Title
Sales
Purchases return
Creditors
Rent
Interest
Bills payable
Capital

Amount
Rs.
3,50,000
2,500
25,000
5,000
2,000
1,71,700
3,00,000

8,56,200

Adjustments
1. Closing stock was valued at the end of the year Rs. 40,000.
2. Salary amounting Rs. 500 and trade expense Rs. 300 are due.
3. Depreciation charged on building and machinery are @ 4% and @ 5%
respectively.
4. Make a provision of @ 5% on sundry debtors.
(Ans. : Gross profit Rs. 2,11,000 ; Net profit Rs.1,85,560 ; Total balance
sheet Rs.6,73,060)

Financial Statements - II
5.

427

From the following information prepare trading and profit and loss account
of M/s Indian sports house for the year ending December 31, 2005.

Account Title
Drawings
Sundry debtors
Bad debts
Trade Expenses
Printing and Stationery
Rent Rates and Taxes
Feright
Return inwards
Opening stock
Purchases
Furniture and Fixture
Plant and Machinery
Bills receivable
Wages
Cash in hand
Discount allowed
Investments
Motor car

Amount
Rs.
20,000
80,000
1,000
2,400
2,000
5,000
4,000
7,000
25,000
1,80,000
20,000
1,00,000
14,000
10,000
6,000
2,000
40,000
51,000
5,69,400

Account Title
Capital
Return outwards
Bank overdraft
Provision for bad debts
Sundry creditors
Bills payable
Sales

Amount
Rs.
2,00,000
2,000
12,000
4,000
60,000
15,400
2,76,000

5,69,400

Adjustments
1. Closing stock was Rs.45,000.
2. Provision for bad debts is to be maintained @ 2% on debtors.
3. Depreciation charged on : furniture and fixture @ 5%, plant and
Machinery @ 6% and motor car @ 10%.
4. A Machine of Rs.30,000 was purchased on July 01, 2005.
5. The manager is entitle to a commission of @ 10% of the net profit after
charging such commission.
(Ans. : Gross profit Rs.1,01,000 ; Net profit Rs.68,909 ; Total balance sheet
Rs. 3,43,200 ; Managers commission Rs.6,891)

428

Accountancy
6.

Prepare the trading and profit and loss account and a balance sheet of M/s
Shine Ltd. from the following particulars.

Account Title
Sundry debtors
Bad debts
Trade expenses
Printing and Stationary
Rent, Rates and Taxes
Freight
Sales return
Motor car
Opening stock
Furniture and Fixture
Purchases
Drawings
Investments
Cash in hand
Cash in bank

Amount
Rs.
1,00,000
3,000
2,500
5,000
3,450
2,250
6,000
25,000
75,550
15,500
75,000
13,560
65,500
36,000
53,000
4,81,310

Account Title
Bills payable
Sundry creditors
Provision for bad debts
Return outwards
Capital
Discount received
Interest received
Sales

Amount
Rs.
85,550
25,000
1,500
4,500
2,50,000
3,500
11,260
1,00,000

4,81,310

Adjustments
1. Closing stock was valued Rs. 35,000.
2. Depreciation charged on furniture and fixture @ 5%.
3. Further bad debts Rs. 1,000. Make a provision for bad debts @ 5% on
sundry debtors.
4. Depreciation charged on motor car @ 10%.
5. Interest on drawing @ 6%.
6. Rent, rates and taxes was outstanding Rs.200.
7. Discount on debtors 2%.
(Ans. : Gross loss Rs,17,050 ; Net loss Rs.27,344 ; Total balance sheet
Rs. 3,19,032).

Financial Statements - II
7.

429

Following balances have been extracted from the trial balance of M/s Keshav
Electronics Ltd. You are required to prepare the trading and profit and loss
account and a balance sheet as on December 31, 2005.

Account Title
Opening stock
Purchases
Drawings
Buildings
Motor van
Freight inwards
Sales return
Trade expense
Heat and Power
Salary and Wages
Legal expense
Postage and Telegram
Bad debts
Cash in hand
Cash at bank
Sundry debtors
Investments
Insurance
Machinery

Amount
Rs.
2,26,000
4,40,000
75,000
1,00,000
30,000
3,400
10,000
3,300
8,000
5,000
3,000
1,000
6,500
79,000
98,000
25,000
40,000
3,500
22,000

Account Title
Sales
Return outwards
Creditors
Bills payable
Interest receivced
Capital

11,78,700

Amount
Rs.
6,80,000
15,000
50,000
63,700
20,000
3,50,000

11,78,700

The following additional information is available :


1. Stock on December 31, 2005 was Rs. 30,000.
2. Depreciation is to be charged on building at 5% and motor van at 10%.
3. Provision for doubtful debts is to be maintained at 5% on Sundry
Debtors.
4. Unexpired insurance was Rs. 600.
5. The Manager is entitled to a commissiion @ 5% on net profit before
charging such commission.

430

Accountancy

8.

(Ans. : Gross profit Rs,37,600 ; Net profit Rs.25,381 ; Total balance sheet
Rs.4,15,350 ; Managers commission Rs.1,269)
From the following balances extracted from the books of Raga Ltd. prepare
a trading and profit and loss account for the year ended December 31, 2005
and a balance sheet as on that date.

Account Title
Drawings
Land and Buildings
Plant and Machinery
Carriage inwards
Wages
Salary
Sales return
Bank charges
Coal, Gas and Water
purchases
Trade Expenses
Stock (Opening)
Cash at bank
Rates and Taxes
Bills receivable
Sundry debtors
Cash in hand

Amount
Rs.
20,000
12,000
40,000
100
500
2,000
200
200
1,200
1,50,000
3,800
76,800
50,000
870
24,500
54,300
30,000
4,66,470

Account Title
Sales
Capital
Discount
Apprentice premium
Bills payable
Purchases return

Amount
Rs.
2,20,000
1,01,110
1,260
5,230
1,28,870
10,000

4,66,470

The additional information is as under :


1. Closing stock was valued at the end of the year Rs, 20,000.
2. Depreciation on plant and machinery charged at 5% and land and
building at 10%.
3. Discount on debtors at 3%.
4. Make a provision at 5% on debtors for bad debts.
5. Salary outstanding was Rs.100 and Wages prepaid was Rs. 40.
6. The manager is entitled a commission of 5% on net profit after charging
such commission.

Financial Statements - II

9.

431

(Ans. : Gross profit Rs,21,240 ; Net profit Rs.12,664 ; Total balance sheet
Rs.2,23,377 ; Managers commission Rs.633)
From the following balances of M/s Jyoti Exports, prepare trading and
profit and loss account for the year ended March 31, 2006 and balance
sheet as on this date.
Account Title

Sundry debtors
Opening stock
Purchases
Carriage inwards
Wages
Office rent
Insurance
Factory rent
Cleaning charges
Salary
Building
Plant and Machinery
Cash in hand
Gas and Water
Octroi
Furniture
Patents

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Account Title

9,600
22,800
34,800
450
1,770
820
1,440
390
940
1,590
24,000
3,600
2,160
240
60
20,540
10,000

Sundry creditors
Sales
Purchases returns
Bills payable
Capital

1,35,200

Credit
Amount
Rs.
2,500
72,670
2,430
15,600
42,000

1,35,200

Closing stock Rs.10,000.


1.
2.
3.
4.

To provision for bad debts is to be maintained at 5 per cent on sundry debtors.


Wages amounting to Rs.500 and salary amounting to Rs. 350 are outstanding.
Factory rent prepaid Rs. 100.
Depreciation charged on Plant and Machinery @ 5% and Building @ 10%.

432

Accountancy
5.

Outstanding insurance Rs.100.

(Ans : Gross profit Rs.23,250 ; Net profit Rs.16,370 ; Total balance Sheet 63,530)
10. The following balances have been extracted from the books of M/s Green
House for the year ended December 31, 2005, prepare trading and profit and
loss account and balance sheet as on this date.
Account T itle

Amount
Rs.

Purchases
Bank balance
Wages
Debtors
Cash in hand
Legal expenses
Building
Machinery
Bills receivable
Office expenses
Opening stock
Gas and fuel
Freight and Carriage
Factory lighting
Office furniture
Patent right

80,000
11,000
34,000
70,300
1,200
4,000
60,000
120,000
7,000
3,000
45,000
2,700
3,500
5,000
5,000
18,800
4,70,500

Account Title
Capital
Bills payable
Sales
Creditors
Return outwards

Amount
Rs.
2,10,000
6,500
2,00,000
50,000
4,000

4,70,500

adjustments :
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)

Machinery is depreciated at 10% and buildings depreciated at 6%.


Interest on capital @ 4%.
Outstanding wages Rs. 50.
Closing stock Rs.50,000.

Financial Statements - II

433

(Ans : Gross profit Rs.83,750 ; Net Profit Rs.52,750 ; Total balance sheet
Rs.3,19,250).
11. From the following balances extracted from the book of M/s Manju Chawla
on March 31, 2005. You are requested to prepare the trading and profit and
loss account and a balance sheet as on this date.
Account Title

Amount
Rs.

Opening stock
Purchases and Sales
Returns
Wages
Dock and cleaning charges
Lighting
Misc. Income
Rent
Capital
Drawings
Debtors and Creditors
Cash
Investment
Patent
Land and Machinery
Donations and Charity
Sales tax collected
Furniture

10,000
40,000
200
6,000
4,000
500

80,000
600

6,000
2,000
40,000
2,000
6,000
3,000
6,000
4,000
43,000
600

7,000

1,000
11,300
1,36,600

Closing stock was Rs.2,000.


(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)

Amount
Rs.

Interest on drawings @ 7% and interest on capital @ 5%.


Land and Machinery is depreciated at 5%.
Interest on investment @ 6%.
Unexpired rent Rs.100.
Charge 5% depreciation on furniture.

1,36,600

434

Accountancy

12.

(Ans. : Gross profit Rs.30,900 ; Net profit Rs.26,185 ; Total balance sheet
Rs.71,185).
The following balances were extracted from the books of M/s Panchsheel
Garments on December 31, 2005.

Account Title

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Account Title

Opening stock
Purchases
Return Inwards
Carriage inwards
General expenses
Insurance
Scooter expenses
Salary
Cash in hand
Scooter
Furniture
Buildings
Debtors
Wages

16,000
67,600
4,600
1,400
2,400
4,000
200
8,800
4,000
8,000
5,200
65,000
6,000
1,200

Sales
Return outwards
Discount
Bank overdraft
Commission
Creditors
Capital

1,94,400

Credit
Amount
Rs.
1,12,000
3,200
1,400
10,000
1,800
16,000
50,000

1,94,400

Prepare the trading and profit and loss account for the year ended December, 31
and a balance sheet as on that date.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)

Unexpired insurance Rs 1,000.


Salary due but not paid Rs. 1800.
Wages outstanding Rs. 200.
Interest on capital 5%.
Scooter is depreciated @ 5%.
Furniture is depreciated Rs.@ 10%.

Financial Statements - II

435

(Ans. : Gross profit Rs.39,200 ; Net profit Rs.22,780 ; Total balance sheet
Rs.98,780}.
13. Prepare the trading and profit and loss account and balance sheet of M/s
Control Device India on December 31, 2006 from the following balance as
on that date.
Account Title

Debit
Amount
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

Drawings and Capital


Purchase and Sales
Salary and Commission
Carriage
Plant and Machinery
Furniture
Opening stock
Insurnace premium
Interest
Bank overdraft
Rent and Taxes
Wages
Returns
Carriage outwards
Debtors and Creditors
General expenses
Octroi
Investment

19,530
45,000
25,470
2,700
27,000
6,750
42,300
2,700

67,500
1,12,500
1,575

7,425
24,660
2,160
11,215
2,385
1,485
36,000
6,975
530
41,400
2,73,600

Closing stock was valued Rs. 20,000.


(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)

Interest on capital @ 10%.


Interest on drawings @ 5%.
Wages outstanding Rs.50.
Outstanding salary Rs.20.
Provide a depreciation @ 5% on plant and machinery.

1,440
58,500

2,73,600

436

Accountancy
(f) Make a 5% provision on debtors.
(Ans. : Gross profit Rs.29,760 ; Net loss Rs.8,973 ; Total balance sheet Rs.1,28,000)
14. The following balances apperead in the trial balance of M/s Kapil Traders
as on March 31, 2006
Sundry debtors
Bad debts
Provision for bad debts

Rs.
30,500
500
2,000

The partners of the firm agreed to records the following adjustments in the
books of the Firm: Further bad debts Rs.300. Maintain provision for bad
debts 10%. Show the following adjustments in the bad debts account,
provision account, debtors account, profit and loss account and balance
sheet.
(Ans ; Dr. Profit and Loss account Rs.1,820)
15. Prepare the bad debts account, provision for account, profit and loss account
and balance sheet from the following information as on December 31, 2005
Debtors
Bad debts
Provision for bad debts

Rs.
80,000
2,000
5,000

Adjustments :
Bad debts Rs.500 Provision on debtors @ 3%.
(Ans : Credit Profit and Loss account Rs.115)

Checklist to Test Your Understanding


1. (c), 2. (d), 3. (b), 4. (a), 5. (d)

Accounts from Incomplete Records

11

LEARNING OBJECTIVES
After studying this
chapter, you will be able
to :
state the meaning and
features of incomplete
records;
calculate profit or loss
using the statement of
affairs method;
distinguish between
balance sheet and
statement of affairs;
prepare trading and
profit and loss account
and balance sheet from
incomplete records;
and
detect the missing
figures/information by
preparing relevant
accounts.

e have so far studied accounting records of


firms, which follow the double entry system of
book keeping. This gives us an impression that all
business units follow this system. However, in practice,
all firms do not maintain accounting records strictly as
per the double entry system. Many small size enterprises
keep incomplete records of their transactions. But, they
also have to ascertain the profit or loss for the year
and the financial position of the firm as at the end of
the year. This chapter deals with the ascertainment of
profit or loss and financial position of the firm that have
not been maintaining records as per double entry bookkeeping or whose records are otherwise incomplete.
11.1 Meaning of Incomplete Records
Accounting records, which are not strictly kept
according to double entry system are known as
incomplete records. Many authors describe it as single
entry system. However, single entry system is a
misnomer because there is no such system of
maintaining accounting records. It is also not a short
cut method as an alternative to double entry system.
It is rather a mechanism of maintaining records
whereby some transactions are recorded with proper
debits and credits while in case of others, either one
sided or no entry is made. Normally, under this system
records of cash and personal accounts of debtors and
creditors are properly maintained, while the
information relating to assets, liabilities, expenses
and revenues is partially recorded. Hence, these are
usually referred as incomplete records.

438

Accountancy

11.1.1 Features of Incomplete Records


In complete records may be due to partial recording of transactions as is the
case with small shopkeepers such as grocers and vendors. In case of large
sized organisations, the accounting records may be rendered to the state of
incompleteness due to natural calamity, theft or fire. The features of incomplete
records are as under :
(a) It is an unsystematic method of recording transactions.
(b) Generally, records for cash transactions and personal accounts are
properly maintained and there is no information regarding revenue and/
or gains, expenses and/or losses, assets and liabilities.
(c) Personal transactions of owners may also be recorded in the cash book.
(d) Different organisations maintain records according to their convenience
and needs, and their accounts are not comparable due to lack of
uniformity.
(e) To ascertain profit or loss or for obtaining any other information,
necessary figures can be collected only from the original vouchers such
as sales invoice or purchase invoice, etc. Thus, dependence on original
vouchers is inevitable.
(f) The profit or loss for the year cannot be ascertained under this system
with high degree of accuracy as only an estimate of the profit earned or
loss incurred can be made. The balance sheet also may not reflect the
complete and true position of assets and liabilities.
11.2 Reasons of Incompleteness and its Limitations
It is observed, that many businessmen keep incomplete records because of
the following reasons :
(a) This system can be adopted by people who do not have the proper
knowledge of accounting principles;
(b) It is an inexpensive mode of maintaining records. Cost involved is low
as specialised accountants are not appointed by the organisations;
(c) Time consumed in maintaining records is less as only a few books are
maintained;
(d) It is a convenient mode of maintaining records as the owner may record
only important transactions according to the need of the business.
However, the mechanism of incomplete records suffers from a number of
limitations. This is due to the basic nature of this mechanism. Broadly
speaking, unless a systematic approach to maintenance of records is followed,
reliable financial statements cannot be prepared.

Accounts from Incomplete Records

439

The limitations of incomplete records are as follows :


(a) As double entry system is not followed, a trial balance cannot be prepared
and accuracy of accounts cannot be ensured.
(b) Correct ascertainment and evaluation of financial result of business
operations can not be made.
(c) Analysis of profitability, liquidity and solvency of the business cannot
be done. This may cause a problem in raising funds from outsiders and
planning future business activities.
(d) The owners face great difficulty in filing an insurance claim with an
insurance company in case of loss of inventory by fire or theft.
(e) It becomes difficult to convince the income tax authorities about the
reliability of the computed income.
11.3 Ascertainment of Profit and Loss
Every business firm wishes to ascertain the results of its operations to assess
its efficiency and success and failures. This gives rise to the need for preparing
the financial statements to disclose:
(a) the profit made or loss sustained by the firm during a given period; and
(b) the amount of assets and liabilities as at the closing date of the
accounting period.
Therefore, the problem faced in this situation is how to use the available
information in the incomplete records to ascertain the profit or loss for the
particular accounting year and to determine the financial position of a entity
as at the end of the year. This can be done in two ways :
1. Preparing the Statement of Affairs as at the beginning and as at the end
of the accounting period, called statement of affairs or net worth method.
2. Preparing Trading and Profit and Loss Account and the Balance Sheet
by putting the accounting records in proper order, called conversion
method.
11.3.1 Preparing Statement of Affairs
Under this method, statements of assets and liabilities as at the beginning and
at the end of the relevant accounting period are prepared to ascertain the amount
of change in the capital during the period. Such a statement is known as
statement of affairs, shows assets on one side and the liabilities on the other just
as in case of a balance sheet. The difference between the totals of the two sides
(balancing figure) is the capital (refer figure 11.1). Though statement of affairs
resembles balance sheet, it is not called a balance sheet because the data is not
wholly based on ledger balances. The amounts of items like fixed assets,
outstanding expenses, bank balances, etc. are ascertained from the relevant
documents and physical count.

440

Accountancy
Statement of Affairs as at

Liabilities

Amount
Rs.

Bills payable
Creditors
Outstanding expenses
Capital (balancing figure)*

Assets
Land and Building
Machinery
Furniture
Stock
Debtors
Cash and Bank
Prepaid expenses
Capital (balancing figure)*

xxx x

Amount
Rs.

xxxx

Note: * where the total of liabilities side is more than total of assets side, capital would be
shown in assets side and it represents debit balance of capital.
Fig. 11.1 : Format of statement of affairs

Once the amount of capital, both at the beginning and at the end is
computed with the help of statement of affairs, a statement of profit and loss
is prepared to ascertain the exact amount of profit or loss made during the
year. The difference between the opening and closing capital represents its
increase or decrease which is to be adjusted for withdrawals made by the
owner or any fresh capital introduced by him during the accounting period in
order to arrive at the amount of profit or loss made during the period.
The statement of profit and loss is prepared as shown in figure 11.2.
Statement of Profit or Loss for the year ended ........
Particulars

Add
Less

Capital as at the end of year (computed from statement of affairs


as at the end of year)
Drawings during the year
Additional capital introduced during the year
Adjusted capital at the end of year

Less

Capital as at the beginning of year (computed from statement of


affairs as at the beginning of year)
Profit or Loss made during the year
Fig. 11.2 : Format of statement of profit or loss

Amount
Rs.
.....
.....
.....
(
)
.....
(.....)
.....

Accounts from Incomplete Records

441

If the net result of above computation is a positive amount, it represents


the profit earned during the year. In case the net result is a negative amount,
it would represent the loss sustained during the year. The same computation
can be done in the form of an equation as follows :
Profit or Loss = Capital at end Capital at beginning + Drawings during the
year Capital introduced during the year.
For example, consider the following information extracted from the records of Ms. Sheetu :
Rs.
Capital at the beginning of year, i.e. April 01,2004
1,20,000
Capital at the end of year, i.e. on March 31,2005
2,00,000
Capital brought in by the proprietor during the year
50,000
Withdrawals by the proprietor during the year
30,000
The profit for the year will be calculated as follows :
The profit earned or loss incurred during a given period will be computed as follows :
Particulars

Add
Less
Less

Capital as on March 31, 2005


Drawings during the year
Additional capital introduced during the year
Adjusted capital at the end, i.e. March 31, 2005
Capital in the beginning, i.e. April 01, 2004
Profit made during the year

Amount
Rs.
2,00,000
30,000
2,30,000
(50,000)
1,80,000
(1,20,000)
60,000

Illustration 1
Mr. Mehta started his readymade garments business on April 1, 2004 with a capital of
Rs. 50,000. He did not maintain his books according to double entry system. During the
year he introduced fresh capital of Rs. 15,000. He withdrew Rs. 10,000 for personal use.
On March 31, 2005, his assets and liabilities were as follows :
Total creditors Rs. 90,000 ; Total debtors Rs. 1,25,600 ; Stock Rs. 24,750 ; Cash at bank
Rs. 24,980.
Calculate profit or loss made by Mr. Mehta during the first year of his business using the
statement of affairs method.
Solution
Books of Mr. Mehta
Statement of Affairs as on March 31, 2005
Liabilities
Creditors
Capital
(balancing figure)

Amount
Rs.
90,000
85,330
1,75,330

Assets
Cash at bank
Debtors
Stock

Amount
Rs.
24,980
1,25,600
24,750
1,75,330

442

Accountancy
Statement of Profit or Loss for the year ended March 31,2005

Add

Particulars

Amount
Rs.

Capital as March 31, 2005


Drawings during the year

85,330
10,000
95,330

Less
Less

Additional capital introduced during the year


Adjusted capital at end of the year, i.e. March 31,2005
Actual capital at the beginning of year, i.e. April 01, 2004
Profit made during the year

(15,000)
80,330
(50,000)
30,330

Illustration 2
Mrs. Vandana runs a small printing fir m. She was maintaining only some records,
which she thought, were sufficient to run the business. On April 01, 2004, available
information from her records indicated that she had the following assets and liabilities:
Printing Press Rs. 5,00,000, Buildings Rs. 2,00,000, Stock Rs. 50,000, Cash at bank
Rs. 65,600, Cash in hand Rs. 7,980, Dues from customers Rs. 20,350, Dues to
creditors Rs. 75,340 and Outstanding wages Rs. 5,000. She withdrew Rs. 8,000 every
month for meeting her personal expenses. She had also introduced Rs. 15,000 during
the year as additional capital. On March 31, 2005 her position was as follows :
Press Rs. 5, 25,000, Buildings Rs. 2,00,000, Stock Rs. 55,000, Cash at bank
Rs. 40,380, Cash in hand Rs. 15,340, Dues from customers Rs. 17,210, Dues to
creditors Rs. 65,680.
Calculate the profit made by Mrs. Vandana during the year using statement of
affairs method.
Solution
Books of Mrs. Vandana
Statement of Affairs as on April 1, 2004
and as on March 31,2005
Liabilities
Creditors
Wages outstanding
Capital
(balancing figure)

Apr. 01, 04
Rs.

Amount
Rs.

75,340
5,000
7,63,590

65,680

7,87,250

8,43,930

8,52,930

Assets
Printing press
Buildings
Debtors
Stock
Cash at bank
Cash in hand

Apr. 01, 04
Rs.

Amount
Rs.

5,00,000 5,25,000
2,00,000 2,00,000
20,350
17,210
50,000
55,000
65,600
40,380
7,980
15,340
8,43,930 8,52,930

Accounts from Incomplete Records

443

Statement of Profit or Loss for the year ended on March 31, 2005
Particulars

Add
Less
Less

Capital as on March 31,2005


Drawings during the year
Additional capital introduced during the year
Adjusted capital at the end of the year (31.3.2005)
Capital as on April 01, 2004
Profit made during the year

Amount
Rs.
7,87,250
96,000
8,83,250
(15,000)
8,68,250
(7,63,590)
1,04,660

11.3.2 Difference between Statement of Affairs and Balance Sheet


Both statement of affairs and balance sheet show the assets and liabilities of a
business entity on a particular date. However, there are some fundamental
differences between the two. A statement of affairs is prepared from incomplete
records where most of the assets are recorded on the basis of estimates as
compared to a balance sheet which is prepared from records maintained on the
basis of double entry book-keeping and all assets and liabilities can be verified
from the ledger accounts. Hence, a balance sheet is more reliable than a statement
of affairs. The objective of preparing a statement of affairs is to ascertain the
amount of capital account as on that date whereas a balance sheet is prepared
to know the financial position of the business at a particular date. In statement
of affairs, an item of assets or liabilities may get omitted and this omission may
remain unknown because the effect of this omission gets adjusted in the capital
account balance and the total of both sides of statement match. However, in case
of a balance sheet the possibility of omission of any item is remote because in
case of an omission, the balance sheet will not agree and the accountant will
trace the missing item from accounting records. These differences have been
shown in a tabular form as under :
Basis of difference Statement of affairs

Balance sheet

Reliability

It is more reliable as it is prepared


from double entry records.
The objective of preparing balance
sheet is to show the true financial
position of an entity on a
particular date.
Omissions of assets or liabilities
can be discovered easily and can
be traced from accounting records.

Objective

Omission

It is less reliable as it is prepared


from incomplete records.
The objective of preparing statement of affairs is to estimate the
balance in capital account on a
particular date.
Omission of assets or liabilities
cannot be discovered easily.

Fig. 11.3 : Showing comparison between statement of affairs and balance sheet

444

Accountancy
Do It Yourself
Identify a small shopkeeper in your locality, ask him about the accounting
records maintained by him. If he is not maintaining the records as per
double entry system, list the reasons thereof and ask him how does he
compute profit or loss.

11.4 Preparing Trading and Profit and Loss Account and


the Balance Sheet
To prepare proper trading and profit and loss account and the balance sheet
one needs complete information regarding expenses, incomes, assets and
liabilities. In case of incomplete records, details of some items like creditors,
cash purchases, debtors, cash sales, other cash payments and such receipts
are easily available, but there are a number of items the details of which will
have to be ascertained in an indirect manner by using the logic of double
entry. The most common items that are missing and have to be worked out as
such are :
Opening capital
Credit purchases
Credit sales
Bills payable accepted
Bills receivable received
Payments to creditors
Payments to debtors
Any other cash/bank related items.
You know that opening capital can be worked out by preparing the
statement of affairs at the beginning of the year. For other items we have
explained as to how available information can be used to ascertain their missing
figures with the help of total debtors and total creditors, total bills receivable
and total bills payable accounts and summary of cash.
11.4.1 Ascertaining Credit Purchases
The credit purchases figure is not usually available from the incomplete records.
It is quite possible that some other information related to creditors may also
be missing. Therefore, by preparing the total creditors account, a proforma of
which is given in figure 11.4, credit purchases or any other missing figure
related to creditors, as the case may be, can be ascertained as the balancing
figure.

Accounts from Incomplete Records

445

Total Creditors Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars

J.F. Amount
Rs.

Cash paid
Bank
(cheques issued)
Bills payable
(bills accepted)
Discount received
Purchases return
Balance c/d

Date Particulars

....
....

Balance b/d
Bank (cheques
dishonoured)
Bills payable
(bills dishonoured)
Credit purchases

....
....
....
....
xxxxxxx

J.F. Amount
Rs.
....
....
....
....

xxxxxxx

Fig. 11.4 : Showing format of creditors account


For example, consider the following transactions relating to M/s Kisan Food Suppliers:
Rs.
Opening balance of creditors
40,000
Closing balance of creditors
50,000
Payment made in cash
85,000
Discount received
2,000
The total creditors account will be prepared as follows :
Books of Kisan
Food Suppliers
Total Creditors Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars
Cash
Discount
Balance c/d

J.F. Amount
Rs.
85,000
2,000

Date Particulars
Balance b/d
Credit purchases
(balancing figure)

J.F. Amount
Rs.
40,000
97,000

50,000
1,37,000

1,37,000

11.4.2 Ascertainment of Credit Sales


The figure of credit sales is also not usually available from incomplete records.
Some other information on related to debtors may also be missing. Therefore, if
the total debtors account is prepared as shown in figure 11.5, credit sales or any
other missing figure, as the case may be, can be traced out as the balancing
figure.

446

Accountancy
Total Debtors Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars

J.F. Amount
Rs.
....

Balance b/d

Bills receivable
(bills dishonoured)
Bank (cheque
dishonoured)
Credit sales
(balancing figure)

Date Particulars

J.F. Amount
Rs.
....

....

Cash
(cash received)
Bank (cheque
received)
Discount allowed

....

Bad debts

....

....

Sales return

....

Bills receivable
(bills received)
Balance c/d

....

....

....
xxx

xxx
Fig. 11.5 : Showing format of debtors account

From the credit sales as ascertained from total debtors account, the sales returns should
be deducted from gross credit sales to get net credit sales. For example, the following
information is obtained from the books of Mohanlal Traders :
Rs.
Debtors on April 01, 2005
50,000
Debtors on March 31, 2005
70,000
Cash received from debtors
60,000
Discount allowed
1,000
Bills receivable
30,000
Bad debts
3,000
The total debtors account will be prepared as follows :
Mohan Lal Traders
Total Debtors Account
Dr.
Date
2005
Apr. 01

Cr
Particulars

Balance b/d
Credit sales
(balancing figure)

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
50,000
1,14,000

1,64,000

Date

Particulars

Cash
Discount
Bills receivable
Bad debts
Balance c/d

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
60,000
1,000
30,000
3,000
70,000
1,64,000

Accounts from Incomplete Records

447

11.4.3 Ascertainment of Bills Receivable and Bills payable


Quite often, while all details relating to bills receivable and bills payable are
available but the figures of the bills received and bills accepted during the
year are not given. In such a situation, total bills receivable account and total
bills payable account can be prepared and the missing figures ascertained as
the balancing figures. The proforma of total bills receivable account and total
bills payable account is shown in figure 11.6 and figure 11.7.
Total Bills Receivable Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars

J.F. Amount
Rs.
....

Balance b/d
Sundry debtors
(bills received)

....

Date Particulars
Bank
(bills honoured)
Sundry debtors
(bills dishonoured)
Balance c/d

xxx

J.F. Amount
Rs.
....
....
....
xxx

Fig. 11.6 : Showing format of bills receivable account


Total Bills Payable Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars
Bank
(bills matured)
Sundry creditors
(bills dishonoured)
Balance c/d

J.F. Amount
Rs.
....
....

Date Particulars
Balance b/d
Sundry creditors
(bills accepted)

....
xxx

J.F. Amount
Rs.
....
....

xxx

Fig. 11.7 : Showing format of bills payable account


For example consider the following data available from the records of M/s S.S. Senapati
Rs.
Opening bills receivable
5,000
Opening bills payable
37,000
Bills receivable dishonoured
2,000
Bills payable dishonoured
66,750
Closing bills payable
52,000
Bills collected during the year
12,000
Closing bills receivable
4,000

448

Accountancy

The bills receivable and bills payable will be prepared as follows :


Total Bills Receivable Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars
Balance b/d
Sundry debtors
(bills received)
(balancing figure)

J.F. Amount
Rs.
5,000
13,000

Date Particulars
Sundry debtors
(bills dishonoured)
Bank
(bills collected)
Balance c/d

18,000

J.F

Amount
Rs.
2,000
12,000

4,000
18,000

Total Bills Payable Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars
Bill dishonoured
Balance c/d

J.F. Amount
Rs.
66,750
52,500

Date Particulars
Balance b/d
Sundry Creditors
(bills accepted)
(balancing figure)

1,19,250

J.F. Amount
Rs.
37,500
81,750

1,19,250

Test Your Understanding - I


Tick the correct answer :
1. Incomplete record mechanism of book keeping is :
(a) Scientific
(b) Unscientific
(c) Unsystematic
(d) both (b) and (c)
2. Opening capital is ascertained by preparing :
(a) Total debtors account
(b) Total creditors account
(c) Cash account
(d) Opening statement of affairs
3. Credit purchase, during the year is ascertained by preparing :
(a) Total creditors account
(b) Total debtors account
(c) Cash account
(d) Opening statement of affairs
4. If opening capital is Rs. 60,000, drawings Rs. 5,000, capital introduced during the
period Rs. 10,000, closing capital Rs. 90,000. The value of profit earned during the
period will be :
(a) Rs. 20,000
(b) Rs. 25,000
(c) Rs. 30,000
(d) Rs. 40,000

Accounts from Incomplete Records

449

11.4.4 Ascertainment of Missing Information through Summary of Cash


Sometimes, the amount paid to creditors or the amount received from debtors
or the opening or closing cash or bank balance may be missing. To ascertain
any missing item of receipt or payment, we may prepare a cash book summary
showing all receipts and payments during the year and the balancing figure is
taken as the amount of missing item.
If however, both amount paid to creditors and that received from debtors
are missing, then any one of these may be obtained first through the total
creditors or total debtors account, as the case may be, and the other missing
information ascertained from the cash book summary in the same way as
stated earlier.
After the missing figures have been traced out, the final accounts may be
prepared straight away or after the preparation of the trial balance. The
components of the trial balance and their sources of information are
summarised below :
1. Closing assets (except stock) and Closing list
liabilities
2. Opening assets (including opening Opening list
stock) and liabilities
3. Purchases
Credit purchases from total creditors account
and cash purchases from summary of cash
4. Sales
Credit sales from total debtors account and cash
sales from summary of cash
5. Opening capital
Opening statement of affairs
6. Expenses and Revenues
As per cash summary of cash plus subsidiary
informatioon
7. Losses and Gains
From all the accounts and scattered information
8. Bills receivable received
Total bills receivable account
9. Bills payable accepted
Total bills payable account
10. Cash/Bank balance
Summary of cash
Fig. 11.7 : Detecting the missing information
Illustration 3
Compute the amount of total purchases and total sales of Mr. Amit from the following
information for the year ending on March 31,2005.
Amount
Rs.
Total debtors as on April 01, 2004
40,000
Total creditors as on April 01, 2004
50,000
Bills receivable as on April 01, 2004
30,000
Bills payable as on April 01, 2004
45,000
Discount received
5,000
Bad debts
2,000
Return inwards
4,000
Discount allowed
3,000

450

Accountancy
Cash sales
Cash purchases
Total debtors as on March 31, 2005
Cash received from debtors
Cash paid to creditors
Cash received against bills receivable
Payment made against bills receivable
Total creditors as on March 31, 2005
Bills payable as on March 31, 2005
Bills receivable as on March 31, 2005

10,000
8,000
80,000
1,00,000
80,000
25,000
40,000
40,000
50,000
35,000

Solution
Total Bills Receivable Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars
Balance b/d
Total debtors
(balancing figure)

J.F. Amount
Rs.
30,000
30,000

Date Particulars
Cash
Balance c/d

J.F. Amount
Rs.
25,000
35,000

60,000

60,000

Total Bills Payable Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars
Cash
Balance c/d

J.F. Amount
Rs.
40,000
50,000

Date Particulars
Balance b/d
Total creditors
(balancing figure)

J.F. Amount
Rs.
45,000
45,000

90,000

90,000

Total Debtors Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars
Balance b/d
Sales
(balancing figure)

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
40,000
1,79,000

Date Particulars
Bad debts
Return inwards
Discount allowed
Cash
Bills receivable
(Transfer from bills
receivable account)
Balance c/d

2,19,000

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
2,000
4,000
3,000
1,00,000
30,000

80,000
2,19,000

Accounts from Incomplete Records

451

Total Creditors Account


Dr.
Date Particulars

J.F. Amount
Rs.

Discount received
Cash

5,000
80,000

Bills payable (transfer


from bills payable
account)
Balance c/d

45,000

Cr.
J.F. Amount
Rs.

Date Particulars
Balance b/d
Purchases (credit)
(balancing figure)

50,000
1,20,0002

40,000
1,70,000

1,70,000

Working Notes
(i) Credit purchases have been computed from total creditors account as Rs. 1,20,0002.
Cash purchases given are Rs. 8,000. Total purchases will be Rs. 1,20,000 + Rs. 8,000
= Rs. 1,28,000.
(ii) Credit sales have been computed from total debtors account as Rs. 1,79,000 and cash
sales are given as Rs. 10,000. Total sales will be Rs. 1,79,000 + Rs. 10,000
= Rs. 1,89,000.
Illustration 4
From the following information supplied by Ms. Sudha, calculate the amount of Net Sales
Rs.
Debtors on April 01, 2005
Debtors on March 31, 2006
Opening balance of bills receivable as on April 01, 2005
Closing balance of bills receivable as on March 03, 2006
Cash received from debtors
Discount allowed
Cash received against bills receivable
Bad debts
Bill receivalbes (dishonoured)
Cash sales
Sales return

65,000
50,000
23,000
29,000
3,02,000
8,000
21,000
14,000
20,000
2,25,000
17,000

Total Bills Receivable Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars

J.F. Amount
Rs.

Opening balance

23,000

Debtors (Bills receivable )


(balancing figure)

47,000
70,000

Date Particulars
Cash (bills honoured)
Bills receivable
dishonoured
Closing balance

J.F. Amount
Rs.
21,000
20,000
29,000
70,000

452

Accountancy
Total Debtors Account

Dr.
Date
2005
Apr. 01

Cr.
Particulars

Opening balance
Bills receivable
(dishonoured)
Sales (balancing
figure)

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
65,000
20,000

Date
2005
Apr. 01

3,53,000

Particulars

Cash received
Discount allowed

J.F.

Amount
Rs.
3,02,000
8,000

Sales return

17,000

Bad debts
Bills receivable
(transferred from
bills receivable
account)
Closing balance

14,000
47,000

4,38,000

50,000
4,38,000

(Working Notes)
With the preparation of total debtors account and total bills receivable account, the net sales
will be computed as follows :
Net Sales = Cash Sales + Credit Sales Sales return
= Rs. 2,25,000 + Rs. 3,53,000 Rs. 1,7000
= Rs. 5,61,000
Illustration 5
Mr. Om Prakash did not keep his books of accounts under double entry system. From the
following information available from his records, prepare profit and loss account for the
year ending on March 31, 2005 and a balance sheet as at that date, depreciating the washing
equipment @ 10%.
Summary of Cash
Dr.

Cr.

Receipts

Amount
Rs.

Payments

Amount
Rs.

Balance b/d
Cash sales
Received from debtors

8,000
40,000
30,000

Cash purchases
Paid to creditors
Sundry expenses
Cartage
Drawings
Balance c/d

14,000
20,000
6,000
2,000
8,000
28,000

78,000

78,000

Accounts from Incomplete Records

453

Other information :
March 31, 2004

Debtors
Creditors
Stock of materials
Washing equipment
Furniture
Discount allowed during the year
Discount received during the year

March 31, 2004


Rs.
9,000
14,400
10,000
40,000
3,000

March 31, 2005


Rs.
12,000
6,800
16,000
40,000
3,000
1,400
1,700

Solution
Books of Om Prakash
Trading and Profit and Loss Account
for the year ended on March 31, 2005
Expenses/losses
Opening stock
Purchases
Cartage
Gross profit c/d

Amount
Rs.
10,000
28,100
2,000
50,300

Revenues/gains
Sales
Closing stock

90,400
Sundry expenses
Discount allowed
Depreciation
Net profit (transfered to
capital account)

6,000
1,400
4,000
40,600

Amount
Rs.
74,400
16,000

90,400
Gross profit b/d
Discount received

52,000

50,300
1,700

52,000

Balance Sheet as at March 31, 2005


Liabilities
Capital
Add Profit
Less Drawings
Creditors

Amount
Rs.
55,600
40,600
96,200
(8,000)

88,200
6,800

95,000

Assets

Amount
Rs.

Washing equipment 40,000


Less Depreciation
(4,000)

36,000

Furniture
Stock of materials
Debtors
Cash

3,000
16,000
12,000
28,000
95,000

454

Accountancy

Working Notes :
Total Debtors Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars

J.F. Amount
Rs.

Balance b/d
Sales (credit)
(balancing figure)

9,000
34,400

Date Particulars

J.F. Amount
Rs.

Cash
Discount allowed

30,000
1,400

Balance c/d

12,000

43,400

43,400

Total Creditors Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars

J.F. Amount
Rs.

Cash
Discount received
Balance c/d

20,000
1,700

Date Particulars
Balance b/d
Purchases (credit)
(balancing figure)

J.F. Amount
Rs.
14,400
14,100

6,800
28,500

28,500

Statement of Affairs as at March 31,2004


Liabilities

Amount
Rs.

Assets

Amount
Rs.

Creditors
Capital
(balancing figure)

14,400
55,600

Washing equipment
Furniture
Stock of material
Debtors
Cash

40,000
3,000
10,000
9,000
8,000

70,000

70,000

Illustration 6
Mrs. Surabhi started business on Jan 01, 2005 with cash of Rs. 50,000, furniture of
Rs. 10,000, goods of 2,000 and machinery worth 20,000. During the year she further
introduced Rs. 20,000 in her business by opening a bank account. From the following
information extracted from her books, you are required to prepare final accounts for the
ended December 31, 2005.

Accounts from Incomplete Records

455

Rs.
Receipt from debtors
57,500
Cash sales
45,000
Cash purchases
25,000
Wages paid
5,000
Salaries to staff
17,500
Trade expanses
6,500
Electricity bill of factory
7,500
Drawings of Surabhi
3,000
Cash paid to creditors
42,000
Discount allowed
1,200
Discount received
3,000
Bad debts written-off
1,300
Cash balance at end of year
20,000
Mrs. Surabhi used goods worth 2,500 for private purposes, which is not recorded in the
books. Charge depreciation on furniture 10% and machinery 20% p.a. on Dec. 31, 2005 her
debtors were worth 70,000 and creditors Rs. 35,000, stock in trade was valued on that date
at Rs. 25,000.
Solution
Books of Mrs. Surabhi
Trading and Profit and Loss Account
for the year ended December 31, 2005
Expenses/Losses

Amount
Rs.

Revenues/Gains

Opening stock
Purchases :
Cash :
Credit :

20,000

Sales

Less Goods used for


private use
Wages
Electricity bill of factory
Gross profit c/d

25,000
80,0002
1,05,000
(2,500)

Credit
Closing stock

45,000
1,30,000 1,75,000
25,000

1,02,500
5,000
7,500
65,000
2,00,000

Salaries
Trade expenses
Discount allowed
Bad debts
Depreciation
Furniture
Machinery
Net profit (transferred
to capital account)

Amount
Rs.

17,500
6,500
1,200
1,300
1,000
4,000

2,00,000
Gross profit b/d
Discount received

65,000
3,000

5,000
36,500
68,000

68,000

456

Accountancy
Balance Sheet of Mrs. Surabhi as at December 31, 2005

Liabilities

Amount
Rs.

Assets

Amount
Rs.

Creditors

35,000

Cash
Bank
Stock
Debtors
Furniture
Less Depreciation
Machinery
Less Depreciation

20,000
13,000
25,000
70,000

Capital
Add Net profit
Add Additional capital

Less Drawings
Cash 36,000
Goods 2,500

1,00,000
36,500
1,36,000
20,000
1,56,500

(38,500)

10,000
(1,000)
20,000
(4,000)

9,000
16,000

1,18,000
1,53,000

1,53,000

Working Notes :
(i) Total Debtors Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars
Balance b/d
Sales (credit)
(balancing figure)

J.F. Amount
Rs.
NIL
1,30,000

Date Particulars

J.F. Amount
Rs.

Cash
Discount allowed

57,500
1,200

Bad debts
Balance c/d

1,300
70,000

1,30,000

1,30,000

(ii) Total Creditors Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars

J.F. Amount
Rs.

Cash
Discount received

42,000
3,000

Balance c/d

35,000
80,000

Date Particulars
Balance b/d
Purchase credit
(balancing figure)

J.F. Amount
Rs.
NIL
80,000

80,000

Accounts from Incomplete Records

457

(iii) Statement of Affair as on Jan. 01, 2005


Liabilities

Capital (balancing figure)

Amount
Rs.
1,00,0003

Assets
Cash
Stock
Furniture
Machinery

1,00,000

Amounts
Rs.
50,000
20,000
10,000
20,000
1,00,000

(iv) Summary of Cash


Dr.

Cr.

Receipts

Amount
Rs.

Payments

Amount
Rs.

Balance b/d
Capital(bank)
Debtors
Sales

50,000
20,000
57,500
45,000

Purchases
Wages
Salaries
Trade expenses
Electric bill
Drawings
Creditors
Balance c/dcash
Closing bank(balancing figure)

25,000
5,000
17,500
6,500
7,500
36,000
42,000
20,000
13,000

1,72,500

1,72,500

Test Your Understanding - II


Write the correct word(s) :
1.
2.
3.
4.

Credit sales can be ascertained as the balancing figure in the..........account.


Excess of ..........over.........represents loss sustained during the period.
To ascertain the profit, closing capital is to be adjusted by deducting ..........and
adding ..........
Incomplete records are generally used by ..........

Illustration 7
Mr. Bahadur does not know how to keep books of account. From his various records, the
following particulars have been made available prepare the final Accounts, after providing
for doubtful debts 5 per cent of debtors outstanding and depreciating the motor car @ 20
per cent.

458

Accountancy
(i) Balance Sheet as on April 1, 2005

Liabilities

Amount
Rs.

Assets

Amount
Rs.

Capital
Bills payable
Creditors

92,500
32,800
84,200

Motor Car
Stock
Debtors
Bills receivable
Cash in hand

71,700
51,500
49,500
24,400
12,400

2,09,500

2,09,500

(ii) Cash Transactions during the year


Particular

Amount
Rs.

Balance b/d
Receipt from debtors
Bills receivable
Sales

12,400
1,15,000
14,200
1,03,000

Particular

Amount
Rs.

Furniture
Wages
Purchases
Drawings
Bills payable
General expenses
Payment to creditors
Balance c/d

30,000
9,400
40,500
24,000
30,700
20,700
80,800
8,500

2,44,600

2,44,600

(iii) Other Information


Particulars

Amount
Rs.

Bills receivable drawn (received)


Discount to customers
Discount from suppliers
Credit purchases
Closing stock
Closing balance of debtor
Closing balance of bills payable

6,300
2,300
700
29,600
41,700
55,000
10,200

Solution
Cash sales and cash purchases are available from cash transactions. Credit purchase is
also given. But credit sale is to be ascertained by the opening debtors account. Though the
credit purchase is available, the closing balance of creditors is not known. That is why the
creditors account also has to be opened. As there are bills payable and bills receivable,
those accounts also have to be opened, otherwise the creditors and debtors accounts will
not be complete.

Accounts from Incomplete Records

459

Books of Mr. Bahadur


Trading and Profit and Loss Account
for the year ended March 31, 2006
Expenses/Losses

Amount
Rs.

Revenues/Gains

Opening stock
purchases
Cash
Credit
Wages
Gross profit c/d

51,500

Sales

40,500
29,600

70,100
9,400
1,42,800

Cash
Credit
Closing stock

Amount
Rs.

1,03,000
1,29,100 2,32,100
41,700

2,73,800
General expenses
Discount allowed
Depreciation on motor car
Reserve for bad debts
Net profit

20,700
2,300
14,340
2,750
1,03,410

2,73,800
Gross profit b/d
Discount received

1,42,800
700

1,43,500

1,43,500

Balance Sheet as March 31, 2006


Liabilities
Capital
Add Net profit
Less Drawings
Creditors
Bills payable

Amount
Rs.
92,500
1,03,410
1,95,910
(24,000)

1,71,910
24,200
10,200

Assets
Motor car
Less depreciation
Furniture
Stock
Debtors
Less Provision
Bills receivable
Cash

Amount
Rs.
71,700
(14,340)

2,06,310

55,000
(2,750)

57,360
30,000
41,700
52,250
16,500
8,500
2,06,310

Working Notes:
(i) Total Bills Receivable Account
Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars
Balance b/d
Debtors
(bills drawn)

J.F. Amount
Rs.
24,400
6,300
30,700

Date Particulars
Cash (receipt)
Balance c/d
(balancing figure)

J.F. Amount
Rs.
14,200
16,500
30,700

460

Accountancy
(ii) Total Debtors Account

Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars

J.F.

Balance b/d
Credit sales
(balancing figure)

Amount Date Particulars


Rs.
49,500
1,29,100

J.F.

Cash (receipt)
Bills (drawn)

Amount
Rs.
1,15,000
6,300

Discount allowed
Balance c/d

2,300
55,000

1,78,600

1,78,600

(iii) Total Bills payable Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars

J.F. Amount
Rs.

Cash (paid)
Balance c/d

30,700
10,200

Date Particulars

J.F. Amount
Rs.

Balance b/d
Creditors
(bills accepted)
(balancing figure)

32,800

8,100

40,900

40,900

(iv) Total Creditors Account


Dr.

Cr.

Date Particulars
Cash
Bills payable
Discount received
Balance c/d
(balancing figure)

J.F.

Amount Date Particulars


Rs.
80,800
8,100
700
24,200

J.F.

Amount
Rs.

Balance b/d
Credit purchases

1,13,800

84,200
29,600

1,13,800

Illustration 8
Dinesh does not keep systematic books of account due to lack of Knowledge about the
double entry system of accounting. He supplies you the following information :
(i) Assets and Liabilities
December 31, 2006

Sundry debtors
Sundry creditors
Cash

Rs.
45,000
24,000
4,500

Rs.
48,600
?
?

Accounts from Incomplete Records

461

Furniture and Fixtures


Stock
Motor Van

15,000
25,000
16,000

?
?
?

(ii) Transaction during the year


Rs.
80,000
1,400
1,800
63,000
1,000
3,000
2,000
6,000
5,000
2,500

Cash received from debtors


Discount allowed to debtors
Bad debts written off
Cash paid to creditors
Discount allowed by creditors
Sales return
Purchases return
Expenses paid
Drawings
Rent paid
(iii) Other Information

Outstanding expenses Rs. 1,200. Charge 10 per cent depreciation on furniture and 5 per
cent on motor van.Dinesh informs that he sells goods at cost plus 40 per cent. A provision
of 5 per cent on debtors is to be created. Prepare his trading and profit and loss account and
balance sheet as on December 31, 2006
Books of Dinesh
Trading and Profit and Loss Account
for the year ending December 31, 2006
Dr.

Cr.

Expenses/Losses
Opening stock
Purchases
Less Returns
Gross profit c/d

69,000
(2,000)

Amount
Rs.

Revenues/Gains

25,000

Sales
Less Returns
Closing stock

67,000
24,800
1,16,800

Discount allowed
Bad debts
Expenses paid
6,000
Add Outstanding expenses 1,200
Rent paid
Depreciation on Furniture 1,500
Motor van
800
Provision for bad debts
Net profit (transferred to capital
account)

1,400
1,800

Amount
Rs.
89,800
(3,000)

86,800
30,000
1,16,800

Gross profit b/d


Discount received

24,800
1,000

7,200
2,500
2,300
2,430
8,170
25,800

25,800

462

Accountancy
Balance Sheet as on December 31, 2006

Liabilities
Outstanding expenses
Creditors
Capital
Less Drawings
Add Net profit

Amount
Rs.
1,200
27,000
81,500
(5,000)
76,500
8,170

84,670

Assets
Cash
Debtors
48,600
Less Provision
(2,430)
Closing stock
Furniture & Fixtures 15,000
Less Depreciation
(1,500)
Motor van
16,000
Less Depreciation
(800)

1,12,870

Amount
Rs.
8,000
46,170
30,000
13,500
15,200
1,12,870

Working Notes :
(i) Total Debtors Account
Dr.
Date Particulars
Balance b/d
Sales

J.F.

Amount Date Particulars


Rs.
45,000
Cash received
89,800
Discount allowed
Bad debts
Sales return
Balance c/d
1,34,800

Cr.
J.F. Amount
Rs.
80,000
1,400
1,800
3,000
48,600
1,34,800

(ii) Total Creditors Account


Dr.
Date Particulars
Cash paid
Discount received
Purchases return
Balance c/d

J.F. Amount
Rs.
63,000
1,000
2,000
27,000
93,000

Date Particulars
Balance b/d
Purchases

Cr.
J.F. Amount
Rs.
24,000
69,000

93,000

(iii) Summary of Cash


Dr.
Receipts
Balance b/d
Debtors

Amount
Rs.
4,500
80,000

84,500

Payments
Creditors
Expenses paid
Drawings
Rent paid
Balance c/d

Cr.
Amount
Rs.
63,000
6,000
5,000
2,500
8,000
84,500

Accounts from Incomplete Records

463

(iv) Statement of Affairs as on December 31, 2005


Liabilities

Amount
Rs.

Assets

Amount
Rs.

Creditors

24,000

Capital in the beginning


(Balancing figure)

81,500

Debtors
Cash
Stock
Furniture and Fixtures

45,000
4,500
25,000
15,000

Motor Van
1,05,500

16,000
1,05,500

(v) Calculation of Closing Stock


Rs.
89,800
(3,000)
86,800
69,000
(2,000)
(67,000)
40%
100
40
140

Total sales
Less Sales return
Net sales
Total purchases
Less Purchases returens
Rate of gross profit on cost
Suppose cost of goods sold is
Then, Gross profit equals to
Sales equals to
Hence, Cost of goods sold will be

Sale = Rs. 86,800 =

100
140

86, 800 = 62, 000

The amount of closing stock will be calculated as :


Net Purchases
Add Closing stock
Cost of goods available for sale
Less Cost of goods sold
Closing stock

67,000
25,000
92,000
(62,000)
30,000

Key Terms Introduced in the Chapter

Incomplete records

Statement of affairs

Summary with Reference to Learning Objectives


1.

2.

Incomplete records : Incomplete records refer to, lack of accounting records


according to the double entry system. Degree of incompleteness may vary from
highly disorganised records to organised, but still not complete.
Difference between statement of affairs and balance sheet : A statement of affairs
is a statement showing various assets and liabilities of a firm on date, with

464

Accountancy

3.

4.

difference between the two sides denoting capital. Since, the records are
incomplete, the values of assets and liabilities are normally estimates based on
information available. They are not the balances taken from properly maintained
ledger like in case of balance sheet. The balance sheet is derived from a set of
books maintained on the basis of double entry system.
Computation of profit and loss from incomplete records : The statement of affairs
is used to compute capital when a firm has a highly disorganised set of incomplete
records. To the difference between the closing and opening capital, any sum
withdrawn from business are added back and any additional capital introduced
during the year are deducted to find out profit and loss made for the period.
Preparation of profit and loss account and balance sheet : When cash summary
of a firm is available along with information about personal accounts of creditors
and customers, an attempt can be made to prepare the profit and loss account
and balance sheet. Missing figures about purchases, sales, debtors and creditors
can be obtained by preparing proforma accounts of debtors, creditors, bills
receivable and bills payable using the logic of double entry system. Once a
profit and loss account and balance sheet are prepared, it will be possible for
the firm to start a complete accounting system for future.
Questions for Practice

Short Answers
1.
2.
3.
4.

State the meaning of incomplete records?


What are the possible reasons for keeping incomplete records?
Distinguish between statement of affairs and balance sheet.
What practical difficulties are encountered by a trader due to incompleteness
of accounting records?

Long Answers
1.
2.
3.

What is meant by a statement of affairs? How can the profit or loss of a


trader be ascertained with the help of a statement of affairs?
Is it possible to prepare the profit and loss account and the balance sheet
from the incomplete book of accounts kept by a trader? Do you agree? Explain.
Explain how the following may be ascertained from incomplete records:
(a) Opening capital and closing capital
(b) Credit sales and credit purchases
(c) Payments to creditors and collection from debtors
(d) Closing balance of cash.

Numerical Questions
Ascertainment of profit or loss by statement of affairs method
1. Following information is given below prepare the statement of profit or loss:
Rs.
Capital at the end of the year
5,00,000
Capital in the beginning of the year
7,50,000

Accounts from Incomplete Records

2.

3.

4.

5.

6.

Drawings made during the period


3,75,000
Additional Capital introduced
50,000
[Ans : Profit : Rs. 75,000].
Manveer started his business on January 01, 2005 with a capital of
Rs. 4,50,000. On December 31, 2005 his position was as under:
Rs.
Cash
99,000
Bills receivable
75,000
Plant
48,000
Land and Building
1,80,000
Furniture
50,000
He owned Rs. 45,000 from his friend Susheel on that date. He withdrew
Rs. 8,000 per month for his household purposes. Ascertain his profit or loss
for this year ended December 31, 2005
[Ans : Profit : Rs.53,000].
From the information given below ascertain the profit for the year :
Rs.
Capital at the beginning of the year
70,000
Additional capital introduced during the year
17,500
Stock
59,500
Sundry debtors
25,900
Business premises
8,600
Machinery
2,100
Sundry creditors
33,400
Drawings made during the year
26,400
[Ans : Profit : Rs.1,600].
From the following information, Calculate Capital at the beginning :
Rs.
Capital at the end of the year
4,00,000
Drawings made during the year
60,000
Fresh Capital introduce during the year
1,00,000
Profit of the current year
80,000
[Ans : Capital at th beginning of the year : Rs.2,60,000].
Following information is given below : calculate the closing capital
Jan. 01, 2005
Dec. 31, 2005
Rs.
Rs.
Creditors
5,000
30,000
Bills payable
10,000

Loan

50,000
Bills receivable
30,000
50,000
Stock
5,000
30,000
Cash
2,000
20,000
[Ans : Closing capital : Rs.20,000].
Calculation of profit or loss and ascertainment of statement of affairs at the
end of the year (Opening Balance is given)
Mrs. Anu started firm with a capital of Rs. 4,00,000 on 1st July 2005. She
borrowed from her friends a sum of Rs. 1,00,000 @ 10% per annum (interest

465

466

Accountancy

7.

8.

9.

paid) for business and brought a further amount to capital Rs. 75,000 on
Dec. 31, 2005, her position was :
Rs.
Cash
30,000
Stock
4,70,000
Debtors
3,50,000
Creditors
3,00,000
He withdrew Rs. 8,000 per month for the year. Calculate profit or loss for the
year and show your working clearly.
[Ans : Profit : Rs.23,000].
Mr. Arnav does not keep proper records of his business he provided following
information, you are required to prepare a statement showing the profit or
loss for the year.
Rs.
Capital at the beginning of the year
15,00,000
Bills receivable
60,000
Cash in hand
80,000
Furniture
9,00,000
Building
10,00,000
Creditors
6,00,000
Stock in trade
2,00,000
Further capital introduced
3,20,000
Drawings made during the period
80,000
[Ans : Loss : Rs. 1,00,000].
Ascertainment of statement of affairs at the beginning and at the end of the
year and calculation of profit or loss.
Mr. Akshat keeps his books on incomplete records following information is
given below :
April 01, 2004
March 31, 2005
Rs.
Rs.
Cash in hand
1,000
1,500
Cash at bank
15,000
10,000
Stock
1,00,000
95,000
Debtors
42,500
70,000
Business premises
75,000
1,35,000
Furniture
9,000
7,500
Creditors
66,000
87,000
Bills payable
44,000
58,000
During the year he withdrew Rs. 45,000 and introduced Rs. 25,000 as further
capital in the business compute the profit or loss of the business.
[Ans : Profit : Rs. 61,500].
Gopal does not keep proper books of account. Following information is given
below:
Jan. 01, 2005
Dec. 31, 2005
Rs.
Rs.
Cash in hand
18,000
12,000
Cash at bank
1,500
2,000

Accounts from Incomplete Records

467

Stock in trade
80,000
90,000
Sundry debtors
36,000
60,000
Sundry creditors
60,000
40,000
Loan
10,000
8,000
Office equipments
25,000
30,000
Land and Buildings
30,000
20,000
Furniture
10,000
10,000
During the year he introduced Rs. 20,000 and withdrew Rs. 12,000 from the
business. Prepare the statement of profit or loss on the basis of given
information
[Ans : Profit : Rs. 53,500].
10. Mr. Muneesh maintains his books of accounts from incomplete records. His
books provide the information :
Jan. 01, 2005
Dec. 31, 2005
Rs.
Rs.
Cash
1,200
1,600
Bills receivable

2,400
Debtors
16,800
27,200
Stock
22,400
24,400
Investment

8,000
Furniture
7,500
8,000
Creditors
14,000
15,200
He withdrew Rs. 300 per month for personal expenses. He sold his investment
of Rs. 16,000 at 2% premium and introduced that amount into business.
[Ans : Profit : Rs. 9,780].
11. Mr. Girdhari Lal does not keep full double entry records. His balance as on
January 01, 2006 is as.
Liabilities

Amount
Rs.

Assets

Amount
Rs.

Sundry creditors
Bills payable
Capital

35,000
15,000
40,000

Cash in hand
Cash at bank
Sundry debtors
Stock
Furniture
Plant

5,000
20,000
18,000
22,000
8,000
17,000

90,000

90,000

His position at the end of the year is :


Rs.
Cash in hand
Stock
Debtors
Furniture

7,000
8,600
23,800
15,000

468

Accountancy
Plant
20,350
Bills payable
20,200
Creditors
15,000
He withdrew Rs. 500 per month out of which to spent Rs. 1,500 for business
purpose. Prepare the statement of profit or loss.
[Ans : Profit : Rs. 4,050].
12. Mr. Ashok does not keep his books properly. Following information is available
from his books.
Jan. 01, 2005
Dec. 31, 2005
Rs.
Rs.
Sundry creditors
45,000
93,000
Loan from wife
66,000
57,000
Sundry debtors
22,500

Land and Building


89,600
90,000
Cash in hand
7,500
8,700
Bank overdraft
25,000

Furniture
1,300
1,300
Stock
34,000
25,000
During the year Mr. Ashok sold his private car for Rs. 50,000 and invested
this amount into the business. He withdrew from the business Rs. 1,500 per
month upto July 31, 2005 and thereafter Rs. 4,500 per month as drawings.
You are required to prepare the statement of profit or loss and statement of
affair as on December 31, 2005.
[Ans : Loss : Rs. 57,900].
13. Krishna Kulkarni has not kept proper books of accounts prepare the
statement of profit or loss for the year ending December 31, 2005 from
the following information:
Jan. 01, 2005
Dec. 31, 2005
(Rs.)
(Rs.)
Cash in hand
10,000
36,000
Debtors
20,000
80,000
Creditors
10,000
46,000
Bills receivable
20,000
24,000
Bills payable
4,000
42,000
Car

80,000
Stock
40,000
30,000
Furniture
8,000
48,000
Investment
40,000
50,000
Bank balance
1,00,000
90,000
The following adjustments were made :
(a) Krishna withdrew cash Rs. 5,000 per month for private use.
(b) Depreciation @ 5% on car and furniture @10% .
(c) Outstanding Rent Rs. 6,000.
(d) Fresh Capital introduced during the year Rs.30,000.
[Ans : Profit : Rs. 1,41,200 ; Statement of affairs with adjusted : Rs. 4,29,200].

Accounts from Incomplete Records


14. M/s Saniya Sports Equipment does not keep proper records. From the
following information find out profit or loss and also prepare balance sheet
for the year ended December 31, 2005
Dec. 31, 2004
Dec. 31, 2005
Rs.
Rs.
Cash in hand
6,000
24,000
Bank overdraft
30,000

Stock
50,000
80,000
Sundry creditors
26,000
40,000
Sundry debtors
60,000
1,40,000
Bills payable
6,000
12,000
Furniture
40,000
60,000
Bills receivable
8,000
28,000
Machinery
50,000
1,00,000
Investment
30,000
80,000
Drawing Rs.10,000 p.m. for personal use, fresh capital introduce during
the year Rs.2,00,000. A bad debts of Rs.2,000 and a provision of 5% is
to be made on debtors. outstanding salary Rs.2,400, prepaid insurance
Rs.700, depreciation charged on furniture and machine @ 10% p.a.
[ Ans : Profit : Rs. 1,71,300 ; Statement of affairs with adjustment :
Rs. 4,87,700].
Ascertainment of Missing Figures
15. From the following information calculate the amount to be paid to creditors:
Rs.
Sundry creditors as on March 31, 2005
1,80,425
Discount received
26,000
Discount allowed
24,000
Return outwards
37,200
Return inward
32,200
Bills accepted
1,99,000
Bills endorsed to creditors
26,000
Creditors as on April 01, 2006
2,09,050
Total purchases
8,97,000
Cash purchases
1,40,000
[Ans : Cash paid to creditors : Rs. 4,40,175].
16. Find out the credit purchases from the following:
Rs.
Balance of creditors April 01, 2004
45,000
Balance of creditors March 31, 2005
36,000
Cash paid to creditors
1,80,000
Cheque issued to creditors
60,000
Cash purchases
75,000
Discount received from creditors
5,400
Discount allowed
5,000
Bills payable given to creditors
12,750
Return outwards
7,500
Bills payable dishonoured
3,000

469

470

Accountancy
Bills receivable endorsed to creditors
Bills receivable endorsed to creditors dishonoured
Return inwards
[Ans : Credit purchases : Rs. 2, 56,350].
17. From the following information calculate total purchases.
Creditors Jan. 01, 2005
Creditors Dec. 31, 2005
Opening balance of Bills payable
Closing balance of Bills payable
Cash paid to creditors
Bills discharged
Cash purchases
Return outwards
[Ans : Total purchases : Rs. 3,30,500].
18. The following information is given

4,500
1,800
3,700

Rs.
30,000
20,000
25,000
35,000
1,51,000
44,500
1,29,000
6,000

Rs.
Opening creditors
60,000
Cash paid to creditors
30,000
Closing creditors
36,000
Returns Inward
13,000
Bill matured
27,000
Bill dishonoured
8,000
Purchases return
12,000
Discount allowed
5,000
Calculate credit purchases during the year
[Ans : Credit purchases : Rs. 37,000].
19. From the following, calculate the amount of bills accepted during the year.
Rs.
Bills payable as on April 01, 2005
1,80,000
Bills payable as on March 31, 2006
2,20,000
Bills payable dishonoured during the year
28,000
Bills payable honoured during the year
50,000
[Ans : Bills accepted : Rs. 1,18,000].
20. Find out the amount of bills matured during the year on the basis of
information given below ;
Rs.
Bills payable dishonoured
37,000
Closing balance of Bills payable
85,000
Opening balance of Bills payable
70,000
Bills payable accepted
90,000
Cheque dishonoured
23,000
[Ans : Bills matured : Rs. 38,000].
21. Prepare the bills payable account from the following and find out missing
figure if any :

Accounts from Incomplete Records

Bills accepted
Discount received
Purchases returns
Return inwards
Cash paid to accounts payable
Bills receivable endorsed to creditor
Bills dishonoured
Bad debts
Balance of accounts payable (closing)
Credit purchases
[Ans : Opening balance of creditors : Rs. 79,000].
22. Calculate the amount of bills receivable during the year.

471
Rs.
1,05,000
17,000
9,000
12,000
50,000
45,000
17,000
14,000
85,000
2,15,000

Rs.
75,000
25,000
1,30,000
15,000
65,000

Opening balance of bills receivable


Bill dishonoured
Bills collected (honoured)
Bills receivable endorsed to creditors
Closing balance of bills receivable
[Ans : Rs. 1,60,000].
23. Calculate the amount of bills receivable dishonoured from the following
information.
Rs.
Opening balance of bills receivable
1,20,000
Bills collected (honoured)
1,85,000
Bills receivable endorsed
22,800
Closing balance of bills receivable
50,700
Bills receivable received
1,50,000
[Ans : Rs. 11,500].
24. From the details given below, find out the credit sales and total sales.
Rs.
Opening debtors
45,000
Closing debtors
56,000
Discount allowed
2,500
Sales returns
8,500
Irrecoverable amount
4,000
Bills receivables received
12,000
Bills receivable dishonoured
3,000
Cheque dishonoured
7,700
Cash sales
80,000
Cash received from debtors
2,30,000
Cheque received from debtors
25,000
[Ans : Total sales : Rs. 3,62,300].
25. From the following information, prepare the bills receivable account and
total debtors account for the year ended December 31, 2005.

472

Accountancy
Rs.
Opening balance of debtors
1,80,000
Opening balance of bills receivable
55,000
Cash sales made during the year
95,000
Credit sales made during the year
14,50,000
Return inwards
78,000
Cash received from debtors
10,25,000
Discount allowed to debtors
55,000
Bills receivable endorsed to creditors
60,000
Cash received (bills matured)
80,500
Irrecoverable amount
10,000
Closing balance of bills receivable on Dec. 31, 2005
75,500
[Ans : Bills received : Rs. 1,61,000 ; Closing balance of debtors : Rs. 3,01,000].
26. Prepare the suitable accounts and find out the missing figure if any.
Rs.
Opening balance of debtors
14,00,000
Opening balance of bills receivable
7,00,000
Closing balance of bills receivable
3,50,000
Cheque dishonoured
27,000
Cash received from debtors
10,75,000
Cheque received and deposited in the bank
8,25,000
Discount allowed
37,500
Irrecoverable amount
17,500
Returns inwards
28,000
Bills receivable received from customers
1,05,000
Bills receivable matured
2,80,000
Bills discounted
65,000
Bills endorsed to creditors
70,000
[Ans : Credit sales : Rs. 5,16,000].
27. From the following information ascertain the opening balance of sundry
debtors and closing balance of sundry creditors.
Rs.
Opening stock
30,000
Closing stock
25,000
Opening creditors
50,000
Closing debtors
75,000
Discount allowed by creditors
1,500
Discount allowed to customers
2,500
Cash paid to creditors
1,35,000
Bills payable accepted during the period
30,000
Bills receivable received during the period
75,000
Cash received from customers
2,20,000
Bills receivable dishonoured
3,500
Purchases
2,95,000

Accounts from Incomplete Records

473

The rate of gross profit is 25% on selling price and out of the total sales
Rs. 85,000 was for cash sales.
(Hint : Total sales = 4,00,000 = 3, 00, 000

28

100

)
75
[Ans : Opening balance of debtors : Rs. 54,000 ; Closing balance of creditors:
Rs. 1,78,500].
Mrs. Bhavana keeps his books by Single Entry System. Youre required to
prepare final accounts of her business for the year ended December 31, 2005.
Her records relating to cash receipts and cash payments for the above period
showed the following particulars :
Summary of Cash

Dr.

Cr.

Receipts
Opening balance of cash
Further capital
Received from debtors

Amount
Rs.
12,000
20,000
1,20,000

Payments
Paid to creditors
Business expenses
Wage paid
Bhavanas drawings
Balance at bank on
Dec. 31,2005
Cash in hand

1,52,000

Amount
Rs.
53,000
12,000
30,000
15,000
35,000
7,000
1,52,000

The following information is also available :

Debtors
Creditors
Stock
Plant
Machinery
Land & Building
Investment

Jan. 01, 2005


Rs.

Dec. 31, 2005


Rs.

55,000
22,000
35,000
10,00,000
50,000
2,50,000
20,000

85,000
29,000
70,000
1,00,000
50,000
2,50,000
20,000

All her sales and purchases were on credit. Provide depreciation on plant
and building by 10% and machinery by 5%, make a provision for bad debts
by 5%.
[Ans : Gross profit ; Rs. 95,000 ; Net profit : Rs. 41,250 ; Total of balance
sheet : Rs. 5, 75,250].

474

Accountancy
Checklist to Test Your Understanding
1.

Test Your Understanding - I


1. (a)

2.

2. (d)

3. (a)

4. (b)

Test Your Understanding - II


1. Total debtors
3. Fresh capital introduced, drawings

2. Opening capital, closing capital


4. Small traders

Applications of Computers in Accounting

12

LEARNING OBJECTIVES
After studying this
chapter, you will be able
to :
state the meaning,
elements and capabilities of computer system;
explain the need for
computers in accounting;
describe the automation of accounting
process;
explain design of
accounting reports
from the accounting
data;
list
the
various
Management Information System (MIS)
reports and their uses;
explain the data
interface between
information systems.

omputer technology and its usage have


registered a significant development during the
last three decades. Historically, computers have
been used effectively in science and technology to
solve the complex computational and logical
problems. They have also been used for carrying
out economic planning and forecasting processes.
Recently, modern day computers have made their
presence felt in business and industry. The most
important impact of computers has been on the
manner in which data is stored and processed
within an organisation. Although manual data
processing for Management Information System
(MIS) has been quite common in the past, modern
MIS would be nearly impossible without the use of
computer systems. In this chapter we shall discuss
the need for the use of computers in accounting,
the nature of accounting information system and
the types of accounting related MIS reports.
12.1 Meaning and Elements of Computer System
A computer is an electronic device, which is capable
of performing a variety of operations as directed by
a set of instructions. This set of instructions is called
a computer programme. A computer system is a
combination of six elements:
12.1.1 Hardware
Hardware of computer consists of physical components
such as keyboard, mouse, monitor and processor. These
are electronic and electromechanical components.

476

Accountancy

12.1.2 Software
A set(s) of programmes, which is used to work with such hardware is called
its software. A coded set of instructions stored in the form of circuits is called
firmware. There are six types of software as follows:
(a) Operating System : An integrated set of specialised programmes that
are meant to manage the resources of a computer and also facilitate its
operation is called operating system. It creates a necessary interface
that is an interactive link, between the user and the computer hardware.
(b) Utility Programmes : These are a set of computer programmes, which are
designed to perform certain supporting operations: such as programme
to format a disk, duplicate a disk, physically reorganise stored data and
programmes.
(c) Application Software : These are user oriented programmes designed
and developed for performing certain specified tasks: such as payroll
accounting, inventory accounting, financial accounting, etc.
(d) Language Processors : These are the software, which check for language
syntax and eventually translate (or interpret) the source programme
(that is a programme written in a computer language) into machine
language (that is the language which the computer understands).
(e) System Software : These are a set of programmes which control such
internal functions as reading data from input devices, transmitting
processed data to output devices and also checking the system to ensure
that its components are functioning properly.
(f) Connectivity Software : These are a set of programmes which create and
control a connection between a computer and a server so that the
computer is able to communicate and share the resources of server
and other connected computers.
12.1.3 People
People interacting with the computers are also called live-ware of the computer
system. They constitute the most important part of the computer system :
System Analysts are the people who design data processing systems.
Programmers are the people who write programmes to implement the data
processing system design.
Operators are the people who participate in operating the computers.
People who respond to the procedures instituted for executing the computer
programmes are also a part of live-ware.
12.1.4 Procedures
The procedure means a series of operations in a certain order or manner to
achieve desired results. There are three types of procedures which constitute

Applications of Computers in Accounting

477

part of computer system: hardware-oriented, software-oriented and internal


procedure. Hardwareoriented procedure provide details about components
and their method of operation. The software-oriented procedure provides a
set of instructions required for using the software of computer system. Internal
procedure is instituted to ensure smooth flow of data to computers by
sequencing the operation of each sub-system of overall computer system.
12.1.5 Data
These are facts and may consist of numbers, text, etc. These are gathered
and entered into a computer system. The computer system in turn stores,
retrieves, classifies, organises and synthesises the data to produce information
according to a pre-determined set of instructions. The data is, therefore,
processed and organised to create information that is relevant and can be
used for decision-making.
12.1.6 Connectivity
It is being acknowledged as a sixth element of the computer system. The
manner in which a particular computer system is connected to others say
through telephone lines, microwave transmission, satellite link, etc. is the
element of connectivity.
12.2 Capabilities of Computer System
A computer system possesses some characteristics, which, in comparison to
human beings, turn out to be its capabilities. These are as follows ;
Speed : It refers to the amount of time computers takes in accomplishing a
task or completes an operation. Computers require far less time than human
beings in performing a task. Normally, human beings take into account a
second or minute as unit of time. But computers have such a fast operating
capability that the relevant unit of time is fraction of a second. Most of the
modern computers are capable of performing a 100 million calculations per
second and that is why the industry has developed Million Instructions per
Second (MIPS) as the criterion to classify different computers according to
speed.
Accuracy : It refers to the degree of exactness with which computations are
made and operations are performed. One might spend years in detecting errors
in computer calculations or updating a wrong record. Most of the errors in
Computer Based Information System(CBIS) occur because of bad programming,
erroneous data and deviation from procedures. These errors are caused by human
beings. Errors attributable to hardware are normally detected and corrected by
the computer system itself. The computers rarely commit errors and perform all
types of complex operations accurately.

478

Accountancy

Reliability : It refers to the ability with which the computers remain functional to
serve the user. Computers systems are well-adapted to performing repetitive
operations. They are immune to tiredness, boredom or fatigue. Therefore, they are
more reliable than human beings. Yet there can be failures of computer system
due to internal and external reasons. Any failure of the computer in a highly
automated industry is unacceptable. Therefore, the companies in such situations
provide for back-up facility to swiftly take over operations without loss of time.
Versatility : It refers to the ability of computers to perform a variety of tasks: simple
as well as complex. Computers are usually versatile unless designed for a specific
application. A general purpose computer is capable of being used in any area of
application: business, industry, scientific, statistical, technological, communications
and so on. A general purpose computer, when installed in an organisation, can
take over the jobs of several specialists because of its versatility. computer system
when installed can take over the jobs of all these specialists because of being highly
versatile. This further ensures fuller utilisation of its capability.
Storage : It refers to the amount of data a computer system can store and
access. The computer systems, besides having instant access to data, have
huge capacity to store such data in a very small physical space. A CD-ROM
with 4.7 of diameter is capable of storing a large number of books, each
containing thousands of pages and yet leave enough space for storing more
such material. A typical mainframe computer system is capable of storing
and providing online billion of characters and thousands of graphic images.
It is clear from the above discussion that computer capabilities outperform
the human capabilities. As a result, a computer, when used properly, will
improve the efficiency of an organisation.
12.3 Limitations of a Computer System
In spite of possessing all the above capabilities, computers suffer from the
following limitations :
Lack of Commonsense : Computer systems as on date do not possess any
common sense because no full-proof algorithm has been designed to
programme common sense. Since computers work according to a stored
programme(s), they simply lack of commonsense.
Zero IQ : Computers are dumb devices with zero Intelligence Quotient (IQ).
They cannot visualise and think what exactly to do under a particular situation,
unless they have been programmed to tackle that situation. Computers must
be directed to perform each and every action, however, minute it may be.
Lack of Decision-making : Decision-making is a complex process involving
information, knowledge, intelligence, wisdom and ability to judge. Computers
cannot take decisions on their own because they do not possess all the
essentials of decision-making. They can be programmed to take such decisions,

Applications of Computers in Accounting

479

which are purely procedure-oriented. If a computer has not been programmed


for a particular decision situation, it will not take decision due to lack of
wisdom and evaluating faculties. Human beings, on the other hand, possess
this great power of decision-making.
12.4 Components of Computer
The functional components of computer system consist of Input Unit, Central
Processing System and Output Unit. The way these components are embedded
in a computer may differ from one architectural design to another, yet all of
them constitute the essential building blocks of a computer system.
Diagrammatically, these components may be presented as follows:

Fig. 12.1 : Block diagram of main components of computer

12.4.1 Input Unit


It controls various input devices which are used for entering data into the
computer system. Keyboard and mouse, for instance, are the most commonly
used input device. Other such devices are magnetic tape, magnetic disk, light
pen, optical scanner, Magnetic Ink Character (MICR) Recognition, Optical
Character Recognition (OCR), bar code reader, smart card reader, etc. Besides,
there are other devices which respond to voice and physical touch. A menu
layout is displayed on a touch sensitive screen. Whenever user touches a menu
item on touch-screen, the computer senses which particular menu item has
been touched and accordingly performs the operation associated with that menu
item. Such touch screens have been installed at major railway stations for
obtaining the online information about arrival and departure of trains.

480

Accountancy

12.4.2 Central Processing Unit (CPU)


This is the main part of computer hardware that actually processes data,
according to the instructions it receives. It controls the flow of data by directing
the data to enter the system, places the data into its memory, retrieves the
same as and when needed and directs the output of data according to a set of
stored instructions. It has three main units as described below :
(a) Arithmetic and Logic Unit (ALU) : It is responsible for performing all the
arithmetic computations such as addition, subtraction, division,
multiplication and exponentiation. In addition to this, it also performs
logical operations involving comparisons among variables and data items.
(b) Memory Unit : In this unit, data is stored before being actually processed.
The data so stored is accessed and processed according to a set of
instructions which are also stored in the memory of the computer well
before such data is transmitted to the memory from input devices.
(c) Control Unit : This unit is entrusted with the responsibility of controlling
and coordinating the activities of all other units of the computer system.
Specifically, it performs the following functions :
Read instructions out of memory unit;
Decode such instructions;
Set up the routing of data, through internal circuitry/wiring, to the
desired place at right time; and
Determine the input device from where to get next instruction after
the instruction in hand has been executed.
12.4.3 Output Unit
After processing the data, the information produced according to a set of
instruction need to be made available to user in a human readable and
understandable form. A computer system, therefore, needs an output device
to communicate such information to the user. Essentially, the output device
is assigned the task of translating the processed data from machine coded
form to a human readable form. The commonly used output devices include:
external devices like monitor also called Visual Display Unit (VDU), printer,
graphic plotter for producing graphs, technical drawings and charts and
internal devices like magnetic storage devices. Recently, a new device being
perfected is the speech synthesiser, which is capable of producing verbal output
that sounds like human speech. Information:
12.5 Evolution of Computerised Accounting
Manual system of accounting has been traditionally the most popular method
of keeping the records of financial transactions of an organisation.

Applications of Computers in Accounting

481

Conventionally, the bookkeeper (or accountant) used to maintain books of


accounts such as cash book, journal and ledger so as to prepare a summary
of transactions and final accounts manually. The technological innovations
led to the development of various machines capable of performing a variety of
accounting functions. For example, the popular billing machine was designed
to typewrite description of the transaction along with names, addresses of
customers. This machine was capable of computing discounts; adding the
net total and posting the requisite data to the relevant accounts. The customers
bill was generated automatically once the operator has entered the necessary
information. These machines combined the features of a typewriter and various
kinds of calculators.
With substantial increase in the number of transactions, the technology
advanced further. With exponential increase in speed, storage and processing
capacity, newer versions of these machines evolved. A computer to which
they were connected operated these machines. The success of a growing
organisation with complexity of transactions tended to depend on resource
optimisation, quick decision-making and control. As a result, the maintenance
of accounting data on a real-time (or spontaneous) basis became almost
essential. Such a system of maintaining accounting records became convenient
with the computerised accounting system.
12.5.1 Information and Decisions
An organisation is a collection of interdependent decision-making units that
exist to pursue organisational objectives. As a system, every organisation
accepts inputs and transforms them into outputs. All organisational systems
pursue certain objectives through a process of resource allocation, which is
accomplished through the process of managerial decision-making. Information
facilitates decisions regarding allocation of resources and thereby assists an
organisation in pursuit of its objectives. Therefore, the information is the
most important organisational resource. Every medium sized to large
organisation has a well-established information system that is meant to
generate the information required for decision-making.
With the increasing use of information systems in organisations,
Transaction Processing Systems (TPS) have started playing a vital role in
supporting business operations. Every transaction processing system has
three components: Input, Processing and Output. Since Information
Technology (IT) follows the GIGO principle (Garbage in-Garbage out), it is
necessary that input to the IT-based information system is accurate, complete
and authorised. This is achieved by automating the input. A large number of
devices are now available to automate the input process for a TPS.

482

Accountancy

12.5.2 Transaction Processing System


Transaction Processing Systems (TPS) are among the earliest computerised
systems catering to the requirements of large business enterprises. The purpose
of a typical TPS is to record, process, validate and store transactions that
occur in the various functional areas of a business for subsequent retrieval
and usage. A transaction could be internal or external. When a department
requisitions material supplies from stores, an internal transaction is said to
have occurred. However, when the purchase department purchases materials
from a supplier, an external transaction takes place. The scope of financial
accounting is confined to external transactions only. TPS involves following
steps in processing a transaction. In order to understand these steps, let us
consider a case wherein a customer withdraws money using the Automated
Teller Machine (ATM) facility, as described below :
Data Entry : The action data must be entered into the system before it is
processed. There are a number of input devices to enter data: Keyboard,
mouse, etc. For example, a bank customer operates an ATM facility to make
a withdrawal. The actions taken by the customer constitute data, which is
processed after validation by the computerised personal banking system.
Data Validation : It ensures the accuracy and reliability of input data by
comparing the same with some predetermined standards or known data.
This validation is performed by error detection and error correction
procedures. The control mechanism, wherein actual input is compared
with the standard, is meant to detect errors while error correction
procedures make suggestions for entering correct data input. The Personal
Identification Number (PIN) of the customer is validated with the known
data. If it is incorrect, a suggestion is made to indicate that the PIN is
invalid. After validating the PIN (which is also a part of processing by TPS),
the amount of withdrawal being made by the customer is also checked to
ensure that it does not exceed a certain limit.
Processing and Revalidation : The processing of data, representing actions
of the ATM user, occurs almost instantaneously in case of the Online
Transaction Processing (OLTP) system provided a valid data representing
actions of the user has been encountered. This is called check input validity.
Revalidation occurs to ensure that the transaction in terms of delivery of
money by ATM has been completed. This is called check output validity.
Storage : Processed actions, as described above, culminate into financial
transaction data, which describe the withdrawal of money by a particular
customer, are stored in transaction database of Computerised personal banking
system. This implies that only valid transactions are stored in the database.
Information : The stored data is processed using the query facility to produce
desired information. A database supported by DBMS is bound to have
standard Structured Query Language (SQL) support.

Applications of Computers in Accounting

483

Reporting : Finally, reports can be prepared on the basis of the required


information content according to decision usefulness of report.
A simple computerised accounting system accepts the complete transaction
data as input; stores such data in computer storage media (say hard disk)
and retrieves the accounting data for processing as and when required for
generating an accounting report, as output. The input-process-output diagram
shown below indicates as to how accounting software translates data into
information. This processing of data is accomplished either through Batch
Processing or Real-time Processing.
Batch Processing applies to large and voluminous data that is accumulated
offline from various units: branches or departments. The entire accumulated
data is processed in one shot to generate the desired reports according to
decision requirement.
Real-Time Processing provides online outcome in the form of information
and reports without time lag between the transaction and its processing. The
accounting reports are generated by query language popularly called Structured
Query Language (SQL). It allows the user to retrieve report relevant information
that is capable of being laid out in pre-designed accounting report.
Accounting software may be structured with such components as provide for
storage and processing of data pertaining to purchase, sales, inventory, payroll
and other financial transactions (refer figure 12.2).
Do It Yourself
Go to a departmental store and an ATM of a Bank and identify the
accounting process there. Observe the Transaction Processing System (TPS).

12.6 Features of Computerised Accounting System


Accounting software is used to implement a computerised accounting system.
The computer accounting system is based on the concept of databases. It
does away with the concept of creating and maintaining journals, ledger, etc.
which are essential while working with manual accounting system. Typicaly
computerised accounting system offers the following features :
Online input and storage of accounting data.
Printout of purchase and sales invoices.
Logical scheme for codification of accounts and transactions. Every account
and transaction is assigned a unique code.
Grouping of accounts is done from the very beginning.
Instant reports for management, for example Aging Statement, Stock
Statement, Trial Balance, Trading and Profit and Loss Account, Balance Sheet,
Stock Valuation, Value Added Tax (VAT), Returns, Payroll Report, etc.

484

Accountancy

Fig. 12.2 : Components of computerised accounting software system

Test Your Understanding


Fill in the correct words :
1. The user oriented programmes designed and developed for performing certain specific
tasks are called as ...........
2. Language syntax is checked by software called as ...........
3. The people who write programmes to implement the data processing system design
are called as ...........
4. ...........is the brain of the computer.
5. ...........and ...........are two of the important requirements of an accounting report.
6. An example of responsibility report is ...........

Applications of Computers in Accounting

485

12.7 Management Information System and Accounting


Information System
In order to remain competitive, organisations depend heavily on Information
Systems. Management Information System (MIS) is used the most common
form of information system. A management information system (MIS) is a
system that provides the information necessary to take decisions and manage
an organisation effectively. MIS is supportive of the institutions long-term
strategic goals and objectives. MIS is viewed and used at many levels by
management: Operational, Tactical and Strategic. Accounting Information
System (AIS) identifies, collects, processes, and communicates economic
information about an entity to a wide variety of users. Such information is
organised in a manner that correct decisions can be based on it.
Every accounting system is essentially a part of the Accounting Information
System (AIS) which, in turn is a part of the broader system, viz. the
organisations Management Information System.
The following diagram shows the relationship of the Accounting System
with the other functional management information systems.

Fig. 12.3 : Relationship of the accounting system with other


functional management information system

The diagram shown above entails the four widely recognised functional
areas of management. An organisation operates in a given environment
surrounded by the suppliers and customers. The informational needs
emerge from the business processes stratified into functional areas where
accounting is one of them. The accounting information system (AIS) receives
and provides information to the various sub-systems of the institutional/
integrated MIS.

486

Accountancy

Accounting Information System (AIS) is a collection of resources (people


and equipment), designed to transform financial and other data into
information. This information is communicated to a wide variety of decisionmakers. Accepting information systems performs this transformation whether
they are essentially manual systems or thoroughly computerised.
Conventionally, MIS was also perceived as day-to-day financial accounting
systems that are used to ensure basic control is maintained over financial
record keeping activities, but now it is widely recognised as a broader concept
and accounting system is a sub component.
The reports generated by the accounting system are disseminated to
the various users internal and external to the organisation. The external
parties include the proprietors, investors, creditors, financiers, government
suppliers and vendors and the society at large. The reports used by these
parties are more of routine nature. However, the internal parties the
employees, managers, etc. use the accounting information for decisionmaking and control.
Do It Yourself
Go to a shoe manufacturing unit/chemical-processing unit. Observe the
production process and the various selling activities. Visualise the need
for a MIS. Identify the various sub components of the MIS.

12.7.1 Designing of Accounting Reports


Data when processed becomes information. When the related information is
summarised to meet a particular need, it is called as a report. The content
and design of the report is expected to vary depending upon the level to which
it is submitted and decision to made on the basis of the report. A report must
be effective and efficient to the user and should substantiate the decisionmaking process. Akin to any report, every accounting report must be able to
fulfil the following criterion :
(a) Relevance
(b) Timeliness
(c) Accuracy
(d) Completeness
(e) Summarisation
The accounting reports generated by the accounting software may be either
routine reports or on the specific requirements of the user. For example, the
ledger is a routine report while a report on supplies of a particular item by a
given party is an on-demand report. However, from a broader perspective, the
accounting related MIS reports may be of following reports :

Applications of Computers in Accounting

487

(a) Summary Reports : Summarises all activities of the organisation and present
in the form of summary report. Profit and Loss account and Balance Sheet.
(b) Demand Reports : This report will be prepared only when the management
requests them, e.g. Bad Debts Report for a given product, Stock Valuation
Report.
(c) Customer/Supplier Reports : According to the specifications of the
management it will be prepared. For example, Top 10 Customers report,
Interest on Customer Account/Invoices, Statement of Account, Customer
Reminder Letters Outstanding/Open Delivery Order, Purchase Analysis,
Vendor Analysis report.
(d) Exception Reports : According to the conditions or exceptions the report
is prepared. For example, Inventory Report in short supplies, Stock Status
Query, Over stocked Status, etc.
(e) Responsibility Reports : The MIS structure specifies the premises of
management responsibilities. For example, the report on Cash Position,
to be submitted by the head of Finance and Accounts department.
The various steps involved in designing accounting reports from accounting
data are as follows :
(1) Definition of objectives : the objectives of the report must be clearly
defined, who are the users of the report and the decision to be taken on
the basis of report.
(2) Structure of the report : the information to be contained therein and the
style of presentation.
(3) Querying with the database : the accounting information queries must
be clearly defined and the methodology to be adopted while interacting
with the database.
(4) Finalising the report.
12.7.2 Data Interface between the Information System
Accounting information system is important component of the organisational
MIS in an organisation. It receives information and provides information to
the other functional MIS. The following examples illustrate the relationship
and data interface between the various sub-components of MIS.
I Accounting Information System, Manufacturing Information System and
Human Resource Information System
Look at figure 12.4. It depicts the relationship between the three information
systems, viz. manufacturing information system, accounting information
system and the human resource information system.

488

Accountancy

The manufacturing department receives the list of workers from the Human
Resource (HR) department. It sends the details of production achieved by the
workers on the basis of which the HR department to the finance and accounts
(F&A) department to pay the wages. The details of the wages paid and statutory
dues are also send by the F & A department to the production department
also to the HR department to monitor the performance of workers. The HR
department communicates to the other departments about the good/bad
performance on the basis decision on various operational matters may be
taken.

Fig. 12.4 : Relationship between AIS, manufacturing information


system and human resource information system

II AIS and Marketing Information System


Consider the business process in the Marketing and Sales department involving
the following activities :
inquiry
contact creation
entry of orders
dispatch of goods
billing to customers
The accounting sub-systems transaction cycle include the processing of
sales orders, credit authorisation, custody of the goods, inventory position,
shipping information, receivables, etc. It also keeps a track of the customer
accounts, e.g. Aging Report, which should be generated by the system.

Applications of Computers in Accounting

489

III AIS and Manufacturing Information System


Similarly, business process in the production department may involve the
following activities :
preparation of plans and schedules
issue of material requisition forms and job cards
issue of inventory
issue of orders for procurement of raw materials
handling of vendors invoices
payments to vendors
The accounting sub-system transaction cycle would therefore include the
processing of purchase orders, advance to suppliers/vendors, inventory status
updation, account payable, etc. All of this information has to share with the
other MIS in the organisation.
Hence, the computerised accounting system as a sub component of the
accounting information system transforms the financial data into meaningful
information and communicates the information to the decision-makers. The
report demanded may be routine or specific ones.
Key Terms Introduced in the Chapter

Operating system
Analysts
Utility programme
Data
Application software

Management information system


Transactions processing system
Accounting information system
Data interface
Report

Summary with Reference to Learning Objectives


1
2

Meaning of a Computer : Computer is an electronic device capable of performing


variety of operations as desired by a set of instructions.
Elements of a Computer System :

Hardware

Software

People

Procedure

Data

Connectivity
Capabilities of Computer :

Speed

Accuracy

Reliability

Versatility

Storage

490

Accountancy
4

Need of Computers in Accounting : The advent of globalisation has resulted in


the rise in business operations. Consequently, every medium and large sized
organisations require well-established information system in order to generate
information required for decision-making and achieving the organisational
objectives. This made information technology to play vital role in supporting
business operations.
MIS and Accounting Information System : A management information system
provides information necessary to take decisions and manage an organisation
effectively. Accounting information system on the other hand identifies, collects,
processes and communicates economic information about an entity to a wide
variety of users.
Accounting Reports : Information supplied to meet a particular need is called
report. An accounting report must fulfil the following conditions :

Relevance

Timeliness

Accuracy

Completeness

Summarisation
Questions for Practice

Short Answers
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.

State the different elements of a computer system.


List the distinctive advantages of a computer system over a manual system.
Draw block diagram showing the main components of a computer.
Give three examples of a transaction processing system.
State the relationship between information and decision.
What is Accounting Information System?
State the various essential features of an accounting report.
Name three components of a Transaction Processing System.
Give example of the relationship between a Human Resource Information
System and MIS.

Long Answers
1.

2.

3.
4.

An organisation is a collection of interdependent decision-making units that


exists to pursue organisational objectives. In the light of this statement,
explain the relationship between information and decisions. Also explain the
role of Transaction Processing System in facilitating the decision-making
process in business organisations.
Explain, using examples, the relationship between the organisational MIS
and the other functional information system in an organisation. Describe
how AIS receives and provides information to other functional MIS.
An accounting report is essential a report which must be able to fulfil certain
basic criteria Explain? List the various types of accounting reports.
Describe the various elements of a computer system and explain the distinctive
features of a computer system and manual system.

Applications of Computers in Accounting


Checklist to Test Your Understanding
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.

Application software
Language processor
Programmer
CPU
Timliness, Relevance
Cash position, Management responsibility

491

492

Accountancy

Computerised Accounting System

13

n chapter 12, you have learnt about the need for


use of computers in accounting the nature and
use of accounting information system. In this
chapter, we shall discuss the nature of computrised
accounting system, its advantages, limitations and
sourcing.
13.1 Concept of Computerised
Accounting System

LEARNING OBJECTIVES
After studying this
chapter, you will be able
to :
define a computerised
accounting system;
distinguish between a
manual and computerised accounting system;
highlight the advantages and limitations of
computerised accounting system; and
state the sourcing of a
computerised accounting system.

A computerised accounting system is an accounting


information system that processes the financial
transactions and events as per Generally Accepted
Accounting Principles (GAAP) to produce reports as
per user requirements. Every accounting system,
manual or computerised, has two aspects. First, it
has to work under a set of well-defined concepts
called accounting principles. Another, that there is
a user -defined framework for maintenance of
records and generation of reports.
In a computerised accounting system, the framework
of storage and processing of data is called operating
environment that consists of hardware as well as software
in which the accounting system, works. The type of the
accounting system used determines the operating
environment. Both hardware and software are
interdependent. The type of software determines the
structure of the hardware. Further, the selection of
hardware is dependent upon various factors such as
the number of users, level of secrecy and the nature of
various activities of functional departments in an
organisation.

Computerised Accounting System

493

Take the case of a club, for example, where the number of transactions
and their variety is relatively small, a Personal Computer with standardised
software may be sufficient. However, for a large business organisation with a
number of geographically scattered factories and offices, more powerful
computer systems supported by sophisticated networks are required to handle
the voluminous data and the complex reporting requirements. In order to
handle such requirements, multi-user operating systems such as UNIX, Linux,
etc. are used.
Modern computerised accounting systems are based on the concept of
database. A database is implemented using a database management system,
which is define by a set of computer programmes (or software) that manage
and organise data effectively and provide access to the stored data by the
application programmes. The accounting database is well-organised with active
interface that uses accounting application programs and reporting system.
Every computerised accounting system has two basic requirements;
Accounting Framework : It consists a set of principles, coding and grouping
structure of accounting.
Operating Procedure : It is a well-defined operating procedure blended
suitably with the operating environment of the organisation.
The use of computers in any database oriented application has four basic
requirements as mentioned below ;
Front-end Interface : It is an interactive link or a dialog between the user
and database-oriented software through which the user communicates to
the back-end database. For example, a transaction relating to purchase
of goods may be dealt with the accounting system through a purchase
voucher, which appears on the computers monitor of data entry operator
and when entered into the system is stored in the database. The same
data may be queried through reporting system say purchase analysis
software programme.

Back-end Database : It is the data storage system that is hidden from the
user and responds to the requirement of the user to the extent the user is
authorised to access.
Data Processing : It is a sequence of actions that are taken to transform
the data into decision useful information.
Reporting System: It is an integrated set of objects that constitute the
report.
The computerised accounting is also one of the database-oriented
applications wherein the transaction data is stored in well-organised database.
The user operates on such database using the required and desired interface
and also takes the desired reports by suitable transformations of stored data
into information. Therefore, the fundamentals of computerised accounting

494

Accountancy

embrace all the basic requirements of any database-oriented application in


computers. Accordingly, the computerised accounting system has the above
four additional requirements.
13.2 Comparison between Manual and Computerised Accounting
Accounting, by definition, is the process of identifying, recording, classifying
and summarising financial transactions to produce the financial reports for
their ultimate analysis. Let us understand these activities in the context of
manual and computerised accounting system.
Identifying : The identification of transactions, based on application of
accounting principles is, common to both manual and computerised
accounting system.
Recording : The recording of financial transactions, in manual accounting
system is through books of original entries while the data content of such
transactions is stored in a well-designed accounting database in
computerised accounting system.
Classification : In a manual accounting system, transactions recorded in
the books of original entry are further classified by posting into ledger
accounts. This results in transaction data duplicity. In computerised
accounting, no such data duplication is made to cause classification of
transactions. In order to produce ledger accounts, the stored transaction
data is processed to appear as classified so that the same is presented in
the form of a report. Different forms of the same transaction data are
made available for being presented in various reports.
Summarising : The transactions are summarised to produce trial balance
in manual accounting system by ascertaining the balances of various
accounts. As a result, preparation of ledger accounts becomes a prerequisite for preparing the trial balance. However, in computerised
accounting, the originally stored transactions data are processed to churn
out the list of balances of various accounts to be finally shown in the trial
balance report. The generation of ledger accounts is not a necessary
condition for producing trial balance in a computerised accounting system.
Adjusting Entries : In a manual accounting system, these entries are made
to adhere to the principle of cost matching revenue. These entries are
recorded to match the expenses of the accounting period with the revenues
generated by them. Some other adjusting entries may be made as part of
errors and rectification. However, in computerised accounting, Journal
vouchers are prepared and stored to follow the principle of cost matching
revenue, but there is nothing like passing adjusting entries for errors and
rectification, except for rectifying an error of principle by having recorded
a wrong voucher such as using payment voucher for a receipt transaction.

Computerised Accounting System

495

Financial Statements : In a manual system of accounting, the preparation


of financial statements pre-supposes the availability of trial balance.
However, in computerised accounting, there is no such requirement. The
generation of financial statements is independent of producing the trial
balance because such statements can be prepared by direct processing of
originally stored transaction data.

Closing the Books : After the preparation of financial reports, the accountants
make preparations for the next accounting period. This is achieved by
posting of closing and reversing journal entries. In computerised accounting,
there is year-end processing to create and store opening balances of accounts
in database.
It may be observed that conceptually, the accounting process is identical
regardless of the technology used.
13.3 Advantages of Computerised Accounting System
Computerised accounting offers several advantages vis-a-vis manual accounting,
these are summarised as follows ;
Speed : Accounting data is processed faster by using a computerised
accounting system than it is achieved through manual efforts. This is because
computers require far less time than human beings in performing a task.
Accuracy : The possibility of error is eliminated in a computerised
accounting system because the primary accounting data is entered once
for all the subsequent usage and processes in preparing the accounting
reports. Normally, accounting errors in a manual accounting system occur
because of repeated posting of same set of original data by several times
while preparing different types of accounting reports.
Reliability : The computer system is well-adapted to performing repetitive
operations. They are immune to tiredness, boredom or fatigue. As a result,
computers are highly reliable compared to human beings. Since computerised
accounting system relies heavily on computers, they are relatively more reliable
than manual accounting systems.
Up-to-Date Information : The accounting records, in a computerised
accounting system are updated automatically as and when accounting
data is entered and stored. Therefore, latest information pertaining to
accounts get reflected when accounting reports are produced and printed.
For example, when accounting data pertaining to a transaction
regarding cash purchase of goods is entered and stored, the cash account,
purchase account and also the final accounts (trading and profit and loss
account) reflect the impact immediately.

496

Accountancy

Real Time User Interface : Most of the automated accounting systems are
inter-linked through a network of computers. This facilitates the availability
of information to various users at the same time on a real time basis (that
is spontaneously).
Automated Document Production : Most of the computerised accounting
systems have standardised, user defined format of accounting reports that
are generated automatically. The accounting reports such as Cash book,
Trial balance, Statement of accounts are obtained just by click of a mouse
in a computerised accounting environment.
Scalability : In a computerised accounting system, the requirement of
additional manpower is confined to data entry operators for storing
additional vouchers. The additional cost of processing additional transactions
is almost negligible. As a result the computerised accounting systems are
highly scalable.
Legibility : The data displayed on computer monitor is legible. This is
because the characters (alphabets, numerals, etc.) are type written using
standard fonts. This helps in avoiding errors caused by untidy written
figures in a manual accounting system.
Efficiency : The computer based accounting systems ensure better use of
resources and time. This brings about efficiency in generating decisions,
useful informations and reports.
Quality Reports : The inbuilt checks and untouchable features of data
handling facilitate hygienic and true accounting reports that are highly
objective and can be relied upon.
MIS Reports : The computerised accounting system facilitates the real time
production of management infor mation reports, which will help
management to monitor and control the business effectively. Debtors
analysis would indicate the possibilities of defaults (or bad debts) and also
concentration of debt and its impact on the balance sheet. For example, if
the company has a policy of restricting the credit sales by a fixed amount
to a given party, the information is available on the computer system
immediately when every voucher is entered through the data entry form.
However, it takes time when it comes to a manual accounting system.
Besides, the results may not be accurate.
Storage and Retrieval : The computerised accounting system allows the
users to store data in a manner that does not require a large amount of
physical space. This is because the accounting data is stored in
hard-disks, CD-ROMs, floppies that occupy a fraction of physical space
compared to books of accounts in the form of ledger, journal and other
accounting registers. Besides, the system permits fast and accurate
retrieval of data and information.

Computerised Accounting System

497

Motivation and Employees Interest : The computer system requires a


specialised training of staff, which makes them feel more valued. This
motivates them to develop interest in the job. However, it may also cause
resistance when we switch over from a manual system to a computer
system.
Test Your Understanding
1.
2.
3.
4.

The framework of storage and processing of data is called as ........


Database is implemented using ........
A sequence of actions taken to transform the data into decision useful
information is called.......
An appropriate accounting software for a small business organisation
having only one user and single office location would be ........

13.4 Limitations of Computerised Accounting System


The main limitations emerge out of the environment in which the computerised
accounting system is made to operate. These limitations are as given below ;
Cost of Training : The sophisticated computerised accounting packages
generally require specialised staff personnel. As a result, a huge training
costs are incurred to understand the use of hardware and software on a
continuous basis because newer types of hardware and software are
acquired to ensure efficient and effective use of computerised accounting
systems.
Staff Opposition : Whenever the accounting system is computerised, there
is a significant degree of resistance from the existing accounting staff,
partly because of the fear that they shall be made redundant and largely
because of the perception that they shall be less important to the
organisation.
Disruption : The accounting processes suffer a significant loss of work
time when an organisation switches over to the computerised accounting
system. This is due to changes in the working environment that requires
accounting staff to adapt to new systems and procedures.
System Failure : The danger of the system crashing due to hardware failures
and the subsequent loss of work is a serious limitation of computerised
accounting system. However, providing for back-up arrangements can
obviate this limitation. Software damage and failure may occur due to
attacks by viruses. This is of particular relevance to accounting systems
that extensively use Internet facility for their online operations. No fullproof solutions are available as of now to tackle the menace of attacks on
software by viruses.

498

Accountancy

Inability to Check Unanticipated Errors : Since the computers lack capability


to judge, they cannot detect unanticipated errors as human beings commit.
This is because the software to detect and check errors is a set of
programmes for known and anticipated errors.
Breaches of Security : Computer related crimes are difficult to detect as
any alteration of data may go unnoticed. The alteration of records in a
manual accounting system is easily detected by first sight. Fraud and
embezzlement are usually committed on a computerised accounting system
by alteration of data or programmes. Hacking of passwords or user rights
may change the accounting records. This is achieved by tapping
telecommunications lines, wire-tapping or decoding of programmes. Also,
the people responsible for tampering of data cannot be located which in a
manual system is relatively easier to detect.
Ill-effects on Health : The extensive use of computers systems may
lead to development of various health problems: bad backs, eyestrain,
muscular pains, etc. This affects adversely the working efficiency of
accounting staff on one hand and increased medical expenditure on
such staff on the other.
Do It Yourself
Visit a commercial organisation where the accounting is performed manually.
Observe the various accounting activities. Now list the advantages, which
would have accrued, had the accounting being performed through
computers.

13.5 Sourcing of Accounting Software


Accounting software is an integral part of the computerised accounting
system. An important factor to be considered before acquiring accounting
software is the accounting expertise of people responsible in organisation
for accounting work. People, not computers, are responsible for accounting.
The need for accounting software arises in two situations : (a) when the
computerised accounting system is implemented to replace the manual
system or (b) when the current computerised system needs to be replaced
with a new one in view of changing needs.

Computerised Accounting System

499
Box 1
Accounting Software

Variety of accounting software is available in the market. The most


popular software used in India are Tally and Ex. The basic features of
all accounting software are same on a global basis. The legal reporting
requirements in a given country and the business needs affect the
software contents. The other popular softwares are Sage, Wings 2000,
Best Books, Cash Manager, and Ace Pays, etc.

13.5.1 Accounting Packages


Every Computerised Accounting System is implemented to perform the
accounting activity (recording and storing of accounting data) and generate
reports as per the requirements of the user. From this perspective.
The accounting packages are classified into the following categories :
(a)
Ready to use
(b)
Customised
(c)
Tailored
Each of these categories offers distinctive features. However, the choice of
the accounting software would depend upon the suitability to the organisation
especially in terms of accounting needs.
13.5.2 Ready-to-Use
Ready-to-Use accounting software is suited to organisations running small/
conventional business where the frequency or volume of accounting
transactions is very low. This is because the cost of installation is generally
low and number of users is limited. Ready-to-use software is relatively easier
to learn and people (accountant) adaptability is very high. This also implies
that level of secrecy is relatively low and the software is prone to data frauds.
The training needs are simple and sometimes the vendor (supplier of software)
offers the training on the software free. However, these software offer little
scope of linking to other information systems.
13.5.3 Customised
Accounting software may be customised to meet the special requirement of
the user. Standardised accounting software available in the market may not
suit or fulfil the user requirements. For example, standardised accounting
software may contain the sales voucher and inventory status as separate
options. However, when the user requires that inventory status to be updated
immediately upon entry of sales voucher and report be printed, the software
needs to be customised.

500

Accountancy

Customised software is suited large and medium businesses and can be


linked to the other information systems. The cost of installation and
maintenance is relatively high because the high cost is to be paid to the vendor
for customisation. The customisation includes modification and addition to
the software contents, provision for the specified number of users and their
authentication, etc. Secrecy of data and software can be better maintained in
customised software. Since the need to train the software users is important,
the training costs are therefore high.
13.5.4 Tailored
The accounting software is generally tailored in large business organisations
with multi users and geographically scattered locations. These software
requires specialised training to the users. The tailored software is designed to
meet the specific requirements of the users and form an important part of the
organisational MIS. The secrecy and authenticity checks are robust in such
softwares and they offer high flexibility in terms of number of users.
To summarise, the following table represents the comparison between the
various categories of accounting software :
Basis

Ready to use

Customised

Tailored

Nature of business

Small, conventional
business
Low

Large, medium
business
Relatively high

Large, typical
business
High

Low

Relatively high

Relatively high

Limited

Unlimited

Restricted

As per
specifications
yes

High
Low

Relatively high
Medium

Specific
High

Cost of installation and


maintenance
Expected Level of secrecy
(Software and Data)
Number of users and
their interface
Linkage to other
information system
Adaptability
Training
requirements

Yes

Do It Yourself
Visit a branch of a commercial bank and a big shopping complex. See the
various activities performed there and analyse the accounting needs. Identify
an appropriate type of accounting package for performing the accounting
activities.

Computerised Accounting System

501

13.6 Generic Considerations before Sourcing an Accounting Software


The following factors are usually taken in considerations before sourcing
an accounting software.
13.6.1 Flexibility
An important consideration before sourcing an accounting software is
flexibility, viz. data entry and the availability and design of various reports
expected from it. Also, it should offer some flexibility between the users of the
software, the switch over between the accountants (users), operating systems
and the hardware. The user should be able to run the software on variety of
platforms and machines, e.g. Windows 98/2000, Linux, etc.
13.6.2 Cost of Installation and Maintenance
The choice of the software obviously requires consideration of organisation ability
to afford the hardware and software. A simple guideline to take such a decision is
the cost benefit analysis of the available options and the financing opportunities
available to the firm. Some times, certain software which appears cheap to buy,
involve heavy maintenance and alteration costs, e.g. cost of addition of modules,
training of staff, updating of versions, data failure/restoring costs. Conversely, the
accounting software which appear initially expensive to buyers, may require least
maintenance and free upgrading and negligible alteration costs.
13.6.3 Size of Organisation
The size of organisation and the volume of business transactions do affect the
software choices. Small organisations, e.g. in non-profit organisations, where
the number of accounting transactions is not so large, may opt for a simple,
single user operated software. While, a large organisation may require
sophisticated software to meet the multi-user requirements, geographically
scattered and connected through complex networks.
13.6.4 Ease of Adaptation and Training needs
Some accounting software is user friendly requiring a simple training to the
users. However, some other complex software packages linked to other
information systems require intensive training on a continuous basis. The
software must be capable of attracting users and, if its requires simple training,
should be able to motivate its potential users.
13.6.5 Utilities/MIS Reports
The MIS reports and the degree to which they are used in the organisation
also determine the acquisition of software. For example, software that requires

502

Accountancy

simply producing the final accounts or cash flow/ratio analysis may be readyto-use software. However, the software, which is expected to produce cost
records needs to be customised as per user requirements.
13.6.6 Expected Level of Secrecy (Software and Data)
Another consideration before buying accounting software is the security
features, which prevent unauthorised personnel from accessing and/or
manipulating data in the accounting system. In tailored software for large
businesses, the user rights may be restricted to purchase vouchers for the
purchase department, sales vouchers to the billing accountants and petty
cash module access with the cashier. The operating system also matters.
Unix environment allows multi-users compared to Windows. In Unix, the user
cannot make the computer system functional unless the user clicks with a
password, which is not a restriction in Windows.
13.6.7 Exporting/Importing Data Facility
The transfer of database to other systems or software is sometimes expected
from the accounting software. Organisations may need to transfer information
directly from the ledger into spreadsheet software such as Lotus or Excel for
more flexible reporting. The software should allow the hygienic, untouched
data transfer.
Accounting software may be required to be linked to MIS software in the
organisation. In some ready to use accounting softwares, the exporting,
importing facility is available but is limited to MS Office modules only, e.g. MS
Word, MS Excel, etc. However, tailored softwares are designed in manner that
they can interact and share information with the various sub components of
the organisational MIS.
13.6.8 Vendors Reputation and Capability
Another important consideration is the reputation and capability of about
the vendor. This depends upon how long has he been the vendor is in business
of software development, whether there are other users of the software and
extent of the availability of support mechanisms outside the premises of the
vendor.
Key Terms Introduced in the Chapter

Computerised Accounting System


Generally Accepted Accounting Principles
Accounting Software

Mannual Accounting System


Operating Environment
Accounting Packages

Computerised Accounting System

503

Summary with Reference to Learning Objectives


1

Computerised Accounting System : A computerised accounting system is an


accounting information system that processes the financial transactions and
events to produce reports as per user requirements. It is based on the concept
of database and has two basic requirements: (a) Accounting framework and
(b) Operating Procedure.
Advantages of Computerised Accounting System :

Speed

Accuracy

Reliability

Up-to-date

Scalability

Legibility

Efficiency

Quality Report

MIS Reports

Real time user interface

Storage and Retrieval

Motivation and Employees interest

Automated document production


Limitations of Computerised Accounting System :

Cost of training

Staff Opposition

Disruption

System failure

Breaches of security

Ill-effects on health

Inability to check
unanticipated errors
Categories of Accounting Packages :

Ready-to-Use

Customised

Tailored
Questions for Practice

Short Answers
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.

6.

State the four basic requirements of a database applications.


Name the various categories of accounting package.
Give examples of two types of operating systems.
List the various advantages of computerised accounting systems.
Give two examples each of the organisations where ready-to-use, customised,
and tailored accounting packages respectively suitable to perform the
accounting activity.
Distinguish between a ready-to-use and tailored accounting software.

Long Answers
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.

Define a computerised accounting system. Distinguish between a manual


and computerised accounting system.
Discuss the advantages of computerised accounting system over the manual
accounting system.
Describe the various types of accounting software along with their advantages
and limitations.
Accounting software is an integral part of the computerised accounting system
Explain. Briefly list the generic considerations before sourcing an accounting software.
Computerised Accounting Systems are best form of accounting system. Do
you agree? Comment.
Checklist to Test Your Understanding

1. Operating environment

2. DBMS

3. Data Processing

4. Ready to use

504

Accountancy

14

Structuring Database for Accounting

LEARNING OBJECTIVES
After studying this chapter,
you will be able to :
identify the resources
of MS ACCESS as
DBMS;
explain basic concepts
of database system;
express accounting
reality in the context of
Entity Relationship
(ER) Model;
transform ER presentation of accounting
reality into database;
developdatabase
design for computerised system using
Relational Data Model;
formulate basic queries
for retrieving accounting data and information.

n the earlier chapters, you have already learnt


that accounting of transactions are documented
with vouchers. Let us consider a few accounting
transaction to understand as to how these vouchers
are used.
On April 01, 05 M/s Kshipra Computers
commences business with initial capital of
Rs.5,00,000, which is deposited into bank. Recall the
journal entry that is recorded using manual
accounting system. This journal entry has data
contents that are filled-up using a simple transaction
voucher, which is prepared by Smith and authorised
by Aditya.

M/s Kshipra Computers


TRANSACTION VOUCHER
Voucher No: 01

Date: Apr. 01, 2005

Debit Account: 642001 Bank Account


Credit Account: 110001 Capital Account
Amount in Rs. : 5,00,000
Narration: Commenced business by depositing initial
capital into bank
Authorised By: Aditya

Prepared By Smith

Fig. 14.1 : A sample transaction voucher to document simple


transactions involving one debit and one credit

Structuring Database for Accounting

505

The same transaction can also be documented using a credit voucher that
is capable of recording multiple credits against one debit, as shown below:
CREDIT VOUCHER
Voucher No: 01

Date: April 01,2005

Debit Account: 642001 Bank Account

M/s Kshipra Computers

Credit Accounts
S.No
1

Code

Name of Account

Amount

Narration

110001

Capital Account

5,00,000

Commenced Business

Total Amount

5,00,000

Authorised By: Aditya

Prepared By Smith

Fig. 14.2 : A sample voucher for multiple credits against one debit

Now consider the following transaction :


On April 03-20005 M/s Kshipra Computers bought goods costing Rs.50,000
from M/s R.S. and Sons, paying Rs.2,000 as cartage to M/s Saini Transports.
This transaction involves multiple debits of accounts with one account being
credited. The debit voucher that is used to document this transaction appears
as follows :
DEBIT VOUCHER
Voucher No: 05

Date: April 03, 2005

Credit Account: 642001 Bank Account

M/s Kshipra Computers

Debit Accounts
S.No

Code

Name of Account

711001

Purchases

2.

711003

Carriage Inwards
Total Amount

Authorised By: Aditya

Amount
50,000
2,000

Narration
Purchases from R.S & Sons
Paid to M/s Saini Transports

52,000
Prepared By Smith

Fig. 14.3 : A sample vouchers for multiple debits against one credit

506

Accountancy

The process of computerised accounting involves identifying, storing and


retrieving the data content of an accounting transaction. This requires a
mechanism to store such data content of vouchers in a manner that allows its
easy and convenient retrieval as and when required. This is achieved by designing
suitable database for accounting. Such a database consists of inter-related data
tables that are structured in a manner that ensures data consistency and
integrity. In this chapter we shall discuss the basic concepts of database system
of accounting.
14.1 Data Processing Cycle
In order to understand the dynamics of database design, let us understand the
data processing cycle in the context of accounting. Data processing involves the
technique of collecting, sorting, relating, interpreting and computing data items
in such a manner as to provide meaningful and useful information for decisionmaking. The necessary steps involved in data processing cycle are data capturing,
inputing, processing and generating information available to the user. Data
processing cycle, when thought of in the context of accounting, requires a series
of steps that have been described below briefly :
(i) Source Documents : The first step is to capture accounting data from
transaction(s) so as to prepare a document, called voucher (as already
stated earlier), that expresses and documents an accounting transaction.
The relevant accounting data is set out in the voucher, the sample of which
is shown in figures 14.1 to 14.3. These documents are so designed as to
permit the recording of accounting data in a systematic manner.
(ii) Input of Data : The accounting data contained in vouchers is to be entered
in a computers storage device. This is achieved by using a pre-designed
Data Entry Form. This data entry form is designed in a manner that it is
similar to physical voucher document. The data entry form is designed
using software and it is made to appear on the computer monitor so that
the data is entered.
(iii) Data Storage : A suitable data storage structure is required to provide for
a blank data record as shown below:
Code

Name

Type

Structuring Database for Accounting

507

The above blank record that is used for storing the input of data pertaining
code of account, name of account and the category type to which it belongs
is shown below as :
Code

Name

Type

11001

Capital Account

711001

Purchases Account

Hypothetically, the category type 4 above refers to Liabilities and the


category type 1 indicates Expenses. The data storage structures (also called
data tables) are created as a part of structuring database for accounting.
(iv) Manipulation of Data : The stored data is manipulated for necessary
transformation to generate final reports. Such transformed data may be
stored separately and subsequently used for generating final reports.
Alternatively, the transformed data can be directly presented in the form
of a report.
(v) Output of Data : The accounting reports such as ledger, trial balance, etc.
are obtained in a pre-designed format by accessing the transformed data.
Now that you have understood the way data content is stored in structured
manner, we shall discuss how the data structures are designed in consonance
with the data content that emerges from accounting transactions.
14.2 Designing Database for Accounting
Both computerised and computer-based AIS require a definite data structure
for storing the accounting data. As already mentioned, the databases are used
for storing accounting data. The process of designing database (for accounting)
begins with a reality (or accounting reality) that is expressed using elements of a
conceptual data model. The process of designing a database for accounting is
best described through a flow chart (Figure : 14.4).
Reality : It refers to some aspect of real world situation, for which database is to
be designed. In the context of accounting, it is accounting reality that is to be
expressed with complete description.
ER Design : This is a formal blue print, with a pictorial presentation, in which
Entity Relationship (ER) Model concepts are used to represent description of
reality.
Relational Data Model : It is representational data model through which ER
design is transformed into inter-related data tables along with the restriction in
the form of rules that are specified to ensure the consistency and integrity of
stored data.

508

Accountancy

Fig. 14.4 : Flow Chart depicting the process of designing a database for accounting

Normalisation : This is process of refining a database design (that consists of


inter-related data tables) through which the possibility of duplicate or redundant
data items is reduced or eliminated.
Refinement : This is the outcome of the process of normalisation as mentioned
above. The final database design is arrived at after the process of normalisation
is completed.
14.3 Entity Relationship (ER) Model
It is a popular conceptual data model, which is mostly used in database-oriented
applications. The major elements of ER Model are entities, attributes, identifiers
and relationships that are used to express a reality for which a database is to be
designed. The model is best depicted with the help of ER symbols, the list and
description of which is shown in figure 14.5. While preparing an ER Diagram,
the following symbols are used to represent different types of entities, attributes,
identifiers and relationships :

Structuring Database for Accounting

509

The elements of ER model that are meant to describe and display the reality are
discussed in the context of an accounting reality given below :
Meaning

Symbols

Entity Type as Rectangular Box

Weak entity Type as double lined Rectangular Box

Relationship Type as diamond shaped Box

Identifying relationship Type as double


lined diamond shaped Box

Attribute names enclosed in ovals and


attached to their entity type by straight lines.

Key attribute names enclosed in ovals and


attached to their entity type by straight lines.

Multi-valued attributes by double ovals.

Derived attributes by dashed line Ovals

Total participation of E2 in R

Cardinality Ratio 1 : N
for E1 : E2 in R

E1

E2

E1

E2

Fig. 14.5 : Symbols used for constructing an ER diagram

510

Accountancy
Accounting Reality Describing the System of Accounting

Using a hypothetical example of accounting system of an organisation, following


statements of reality becomes the starting point of discussion in describing the ER
Model concepts.
Example Reality :
Accounting Transactions of an organisation are documented using a voucher.
Each vouchers is assigned a serial number, which begins with 01 indicating first
vouchers of the accounting period. There is only one simple transaction voucher used
for documenting the transactions (See Figure : 14.1).
Each voucher documents date of transaction, account name along with its account
code for debit as well as credit entry.
Each voucher indicates the amount and narration with respect to accounting
transaction.
Support documents such as bills, receipts, contracts, etc. also may be attached to
an accounting voucher.
Each Voucher is prepared by a particular Employee and authorised by another
employee.
There is an exhaustive list of Accounts with respect to which the transactions are
documented. Each Account carries a unique numeric code with its width equal to six
digits.
Each Account is classified as belonging to one of the Accounts Types: Expenditure,
Income, Assets and Liabilities.
Fig. 14.6 : Example reality on accounting system

14.3.1 Entities
Anything in the real world with independent existence is called entity such as
an object with physical existence (e.g. car, person, house) or conceptual
existence (e.g. a company, job, university course, account, voucher). In the
context of above accounting reality, there exist five entities: Accounts, Vouchers,
Employees, AccountsType and SupportDocuments. The accounting data is
captured through these entities.
14.3.2 Attributes
Attributes are some properties of interest (or characteristics) that further describe
the entity such as height, weight and date of birth in case of a person and code
and name in case of accounts. An entity has a value for each of its attributes,
which is the data stored in the database.
There are several types of attributes of an entity that have been described as
follows :
(i) Composite vs. Simple (or atomic) attributes : The composite attributes
can be divided into smaller sub-parts to represent some more basic

Structuring Database for Accounting

(ii)

(iii)

(iv)

(v)

511

attributes with independent meanings. The simple attributes cannot be


further sub-divided. For example, Name of a person that is normally subdivided into First Name, Middle Name and Last Name is a composite
attribute. Height of a person is a simple attribute as it is devoid of further
sub-division.
Single-valued vs. Multi-valued Attributes : An attribute with a single value
for an entity is single-valued as opposed to those which multiple values.
For example, height of a person is single-valued attribute while
qualifications of that person are a multi-valued attribute.
Stored vs. Derived Attributes : Two or more attributes may be related in
such a way that one or more becomes basic while the other becomes
dependent on that basic attribute. For example, date of birth of a person
is a stored attribute while age of that person is derived attribute.
Null Values : Absence of a data item is represented by a special value
called null value. There are three situation which may require the use of
null values
When a particular attribute does not apply to an entity;
Value of an attribute is unknown, although it exists;
Unknown because it does not exist.
Complex Attributes : The composite and multi-valued attributes may be
nested (or grouped) to constitute complex ones. The parenthesis () are
used for showing grouping of components of composite attributes. The
braces {} are used for showing the multi-valued attributes
In the context of the example on accounting reality, the following attributes
specific to each entity types have been stated below as :
Entity Type

AccountsType
Accounts
Employees
Vouchers
SupportDocuments

List of Attributes
CatId, Category
Code, Name, Type
EmpId, Fname, Minit, Lname, SuperId
Vno, Date, Debit, Credit, Amount, Narration, AuthBy, PrepBy
Sno, dDate, Name

AccountsType is a conceptual entity that is meant to express the various


categories of accounts in accounting system. The CatId is an attribute of
AccountType entity, the value of which is used to identify the category of
accounts.
Accounts is a conceptual entity that is meant to express various accounts,
each one of which belongs to a particular category of accounts in Accounts
Type Entity. Every account is assigned a unique code by which it is

512

Accountancy

identified. The Name attribute specifies the name of account and Type
refers to the type of account (or category of account) as mentioned above.
Employees is a physical entity that is meant to express the various
employees who are in some way connected with the accounting system.
The EmpId (Employee ID) attribute is meant to identify an Employee;
Fname, Minit and Lname are respectively the first, middle and Last names
of an employee; and SuperId refers to EmpId of the immediate boss of an
employee.
Vouchers is an entity that expresses various transactions vouchers. It is
attributes together provide the structure of transaction data.
SupportDocuments is an entity, which expresses various support
documents that may be attached with a particular voucher of a transaction.
Sno attribute of this entity specifies the serial number of support document
attached, dDate specifies the document date and Name specifies the name
of document that is attached with the voucher.
(vi) Entity Types and Entity Sets : An Entity Type is defined as a collection
of entities, which share a common definition in terms of their attributes.
Each entity type is assigned a name for its subsequent identification. The
attributes of entity type are used to describe it in the database. The values
of attributes of an entity belonging to entity type are known as Entity
Instance. For example, (110001 Capital Account 4) is an entity instance
of an account whose code = 110001, Name = Capital Account and Type =
4. An Entity Set is a collection of all entity instances of a particular entity
type. An Entity Type is described by a set of attributes called schema.
The set of entities pertaining to a particular entity type share the same set
of attributes. The collection of entities of a particular entity type is grouped
into entity set, called the extension of the entity type. For example,
Entity Type : Accounts
Intension (or structure) of entity type
Code

Name

Type

Entity Set: Collection of entity instances of an entity type Accounts


Extension (or instances) of entity type
110001
221019
221020

Capital Account
Jain & Co.
Jayram Bros.
Fig. 14.7 : Examples on entity type and entity set

4
4
4

Structuring Database for Accounting

513

(vii) Value Sets of Attributes : Each simple attribute is associated with a value
set, which specifies the set of possible values that may be assigned to a
particular attribute. For example, the value set of voucher date is all those
dates that fall within the dates valid for a given accounting period. Similarly,
if accounting reality states that each code of an account is numeric with
its width equal to six digits, its possible value set shall be 000001 to
999999. The value set as described above is called domain of values.
14.3.3 Identifier (or Key Attributes of an Entity Type)
Almost every entity type has one of its attributes, which contains unique values
for identifying the entity instance. For example, RollNo as attribute of Entity
type students has unique values through which a student instance can be
identified. Similarly, Code is a key attribute of entity type Accounts because its
data values are required to be unique.

Fig. 14.8 : Diagrammatic presentation of an entity


type accounts with code as key attribute

Some times two or more such attribute together (called composite key) may
constitute such distinct values. For example, the student entity type that has
entity instances across several sections of a class in a school shall require a
composite key of attributes (Sections and RollNo). But in any case, it is a
constraint that does not allow any two-entity instances from having the same
value for the key attribute at a point of time. Some entities may have more than
one Key attribute. The entity types, which do not have a key attribute at all are
called weak entities.
14.3.4 Relationships
Relationship among two or more entity types represents an interaction among
their respective entities. Whenever an attribute (say Debit) of one entity type
(say vouchers) refers to another entity type (say Accounts), there exists a
relationship between these entities (Vouchers and Account).

514

Accountancy

For example, vouchers and accounts are related in two ways: vouchers contain
debit account(s) and vouchers contain credit account(s). In ER Model, these
references are represented as explicit relationships rather than attributes.
(i) Types of relationships : Whenever entities from different entity types are
related to one another in a particular manner, they constitute a relationship
type. The relationship prepared by between the two entity types vouchers
and employees associates each voucher with the employee who prepared
it. Similarly, the relationship authorised by between the two entity types
vouchers and employees associates each voucher with the employee who
authorises it. Each relationship instance of prepared by (short named as
PrepBy) associates one voucher entity with one employee entity. In ER
diagrams, relationship types are displayed as diamond shaped boxes,
connected by straight lines to the rectangular boxes, which represent the
participating entity types.

Fig. 14.9 : Diagram showing binary relationship between vouchers and employees

(ii) Degree : The degree of a relationship type is the number of participating


entity types. A relationship type of degree two is called binary and that of
degree three is called ternary. A VOUCHER (entity), Authorised_by
(relationship) and EMPLOYEES (entity) together signify a binary
relationship. A SUPPLIER (entity) SUPPLY (relationship) PARTS (entity) to
PROJECT (entity) signify a ternary relationship because three entities,
namely supplier, parts and projects are participating in supply relationship
in any transaction.

Fig. 14.10 : Diagram showing ternary relationship between suppliers, parts and projects

Structuring Database for Accounting

515

(iii) Role Names : Each entity type that participates in a relationship type plays
a particular role in the relationship. The role name signifies the role that a
participating entity of an entity type plays in each relationship instance.
In PREPARED BY relationship type, EMPLOYEE plays the role of document
creator and voucher plays the role of document created.
(iv) Structural Constraints : The reality may impose certain constraints (or
restrictions) that may limit the possible combinations of entities,
participating in a given relationship set. These are of two types : Cardinality
Ratio and participation.
Cardinality Ratios for binary relationship specifies the number of
relationship instances that an entity can participate in. In PREP_BY
binary relationship type, VOUCHER:EMPLOYEE is of cardinality ratio
N:1 implying thereby that a set of vouchers can be created by a
particular employee. The possible cardinality ratios are one to one
(1:1),one to many(1:N),many to one(N:1), and many to many(N:M).
Participation constraint specifies as to whether the existence of an entity
type depends on its being related to another entity via a relationship
type or not. The two types of such constraints are: total and partial.
Whenever semantics of reality require that every entity of an entity
type must relate to another entity type, such an entity can exist only if
it participates in that specific relationship. Such a participation is called
total participation. For example, the participation of ACCOUNTS in
CLASSIFY relationship is total participation. This is because every
account must refer to at least one of the accounts type or a category of
accounts. This participation is also called existence dependency. Since
every employee is not expected to prepare at least one of the vouchers,
the participation of employee in PREPARED BY relationship is partial,
implying that some of employee entities are related to the voucher
entity via PREPARED BY relationship. In ER diagram, total
participation is displayed as double line connecting the participating
entity type to the relationship, whereas partial participation is
represented by a single line.
14.3.5 Weak Entity Types
Entity Types, which do not have identifier (or key attributes) of their own are,
called weak entity types. Such entity types are identified by being related to
specific entities from another entity type in combination with some of their
attribute values. These other entity types are called identifying or owner entity
type. Accordingly, the relationship type that relates a weak entity type to its
owner is called identifying relationship of the weak entity.

516

Accountancy

A weak entity type always has a total participation constraint (existence


dependency) with respect to its identifying relationship because it cannot be
identified without its owner entity. For example, a voucher may be accompanied
by a set of support documents such as bills, issued by other parties to the
transaction, details of which need be stored. Such SUPPORT DOCUMENT entity
type which is used to keep track of support documents attached to each voucher
via 1:N relationship, is a weak entity. This is because they are identified as distinct
entities only after determining the particular voucher. A weak entity type normally
has a partial key, which is a set of attribute that can uniquely identify weak
entities that are related to the same owner entity. Assuming that two support
documents of a voucher do not have the same document Id, the said Id can be
a good partial key. Otherwise a composite attribute of all the weak entitys
attributes will be the partial key.
Initial Conceptual Design for an Example Reality : Using a hypothetical example of an
accounting system, as already stated above in Fig: 14.6, following initial design based
on ER Model concepts becomes the starting point of illustration.
Conceptual Design : According to the requirements listed in example reality, there exist
five entities: Vouchers, Accounts, Employees, SupportDocuments and AccountsType

An entity type Vouchers with attributes Voucher No, Serial No, Voucher Date, Debit
Account, Credit Account, Amount, Narration, authorised by, prepared by are used
for storing accounting data of a transactions. Debit and amount are multi-valued
attributes for debit vouchers and credit and amount are multi-valued for credit
vouchers. Voucher No and Sno together constitutes the only key attribute of entity
type vouchers. Therefore, it is specified to be unique.
A Conceptual entity type Accounts with attributes Code, Name and Type is used for
keeping and maintaining a record of all accounts. Both Code and Name qualify to
be the key attributes because of being specified as unique.
An Entity Type Employee with attributes Employee ID (EmpId), Name, Address, Phone,
ID of immediate boss (SuperId) is used to maintain records of employees in the
organisation. Name is a composite attribute with its simple attributes as: First
Name (Fname), Middle Initial (Minit) and Last Name (Lname). The EmpId, specified
to be unique, is the key attribute. SuperId indicates the EmpId of the controlling
officer, the immediate boss.
An entity type, Accounts Type with attributes CatId and Category is used to maintain
records of various categories of accounts so that each of the accounts as stored in
accounts entity are able to find their suitable place in financial accounting reports:
profit and loss account and also the balance sheet.
An entity type called Support with attributes Sno. and Name is used to maintain
records of all the support documents, which are annexed to the accounting voucher.

Fig. 14.11 : Details of initial conceptual design based on example reality

Structuring Database for Accounting

517

14.3.6 ER Presentation of Accounting Reality


The example reality shown at Figure: 14.11 can be shown below diagrammatically
by using the ER notations.:

Fig. 14.12 : ER Schema diagram for accounting database

Fig. 14.13 : Diagrammatic presentation of an entity type accounts with code as key attribute

Fig. 14.14 : Diagrammatic presentation of an entity type accounts with code as key attribute

518

Accountancy

Fig. 14.15 : Diagrammatic presentation of an entity type accounts with code as key attribute

Fig.14.16 : Diagrammatic presentation of an entity type accounts with code as key attribute

14.4 Database Technology


It refers to a set of techniques that are used to design a database. These
techniques use certain concepts, which are crucial to the creation of structure
and development of the design. These concepts are: Reality, data, database,
information, DBMS and database system. A brief description of these concepts
is given below:
(a) Reality : It implies some aspect of the real world. It consists of an
organisation, its different components and the environment in which the
organisation exists and operates. Any organisation includes people, facilities
and other resources that are organised to achieve certain goals. Each
organisation operates within an environment. While operating, the
organisation interacts, influences and gets influenced by the environment.
An organisation may be viewed as a system consisting of several components called its
sub-systems. Each of these sub-systems follows certain procedures and continuously
interacts with each other and their external environment to accomplish the goals of
organisation. During the course of their interaction, events take place, which take the
shape of data items. These sub-systems communicate continuously with AIS to provide
data and seek information. A part of AIS is Financial Accounting System, which is designed
for processing accounting transactions. For example,a firm uses a voucher to document
an accounting transaction. The contents of voucher consist of accounting data, which
need be stored in an organised manner.

Structuring Database for Accounting

519

This continuous interaction results in real world transactions. These


transactions are analysed with a view to identify the components called data
items. A data item is the smallest named unit of data in an information system.
In a transaction, the names of accounts (or their accounting codes), date of
transaction, amount, etc. is all data items.
(b) Data : Data are known facts that can be recorded and which have implicit
meaning. Data represent facts concerning people, places, objects, entities,
events or even concepts. Data can be quantitative and qualitative or they can
be financial and non-financial in character. Consider the following transaction :
April 01, 2005 Commenced business with Cash Rs. 5,00,000.
This transaction, before being recorded through a Transaction Voucher, as
shown in figure 14.1, need be split up into its data contents as 01, 01-Apr05, 642001, Bank Account, 110001,Capital Account, Rs.5,00,000. Data are
not useful for decision-making unless they are processed to suit to the
requirements of decision-making situation.
(c) Database : The data, after being collected, has to be stored so that different
people can use them. This requires the creation of a database. A database is
a shared collection of interrelated data tables, files or structures, which are
designed to meet the varied informational needs of an organisation (See
Example database in figure 14.19. It has two important properties (or
characteristics): one it is integrated and second it is shared. Integrated
property implies that distinct data tables have been logically organised. The
purpose is to reduce or eliminate redundancy (or duplicity) and also to
facilitate better data access. The shared property means that all those who
are authorised to use data/information have access to relevant data. Thus,
a database is a collection of related data that represents some aspect of the
real world (called mini-world or Reality). Accordingly, accounting database
is a collection of related accounting data to represent some aspect of an
accounting information system. Database is designed, built and populated
(or loaded) with data for a specific purpose.
(d) Information : refers to data that have been processed and organised in a
form, which is suitable for decision-making. The raw data when processed
in accordance with decision usefulness of a decision-maker becomes
information. In other words, information is a data that have been processed
and refined and then presented in a format that is convenient for decisionmaking or other organisational activities.

520

Accountancy

Fig. 14.17 : The diagram showing the transaction data processing and information levels

However, information may be viewed as data at one level. But when it is


processed keeping in view the requirements of decision situation, it becomes
information at another level. For example, accounting data at transaction level
is processed to produce balances of each account. The balances are summarised
to prepare the trial balance. The amounts given in trial balance constitute data
to produce profit and loss account and balance sheet.
(e) Database management System (DBMS) is a collection of programs that
enables users to create and maintain a database. Formally, it may be defined
as a general-purpose software system that facilitates the processes of defining,
constructing and manipulating (or processing) databases for various
applications. General-purpose software is defined as a set of programs, which
are designed and developed for a community of users and not for any
particular application with respect to a particular user.
14.5 An Illustration of Accounting Database
Consider an example of ACCOUNTING database for maintaining data pertaining
to accounting transactions, support documents, accounts and employees with
which the students of accounting are familiar. Figure 14.18 shows below the
database structure and some sample data for this database, depicting the
following transactions :
Date
2005
Apr. 01
Apr. 01
Apr. 02
Apr. 02
Apr. 03

Transactions

Commenced business with cash


Cash deposited Into bank
Goods purchased and payment made by Cheque No. 765421
Rent for the month of April, 2001 paid by Cheque No. 765423
Goods purchased for cash from R.S. & Sons
Fig. 14.18 : Accounting transactions of an organisation

Amount
Rs.
5,00,000
4,00,000
1,50,000
9,000
50,000

Structuring Database for Accounting

521

Employees
Emp_Id

Fname Minit LName Address

A001
B001
S001
S002

Aditya
Bimal
Smith
Sunil

Vouchers

K
S
K
K

Bharti
Jalan
John
Sinha

vno Debit

Super_Id
A001
A001
B001

amount

vdate

Credit

2005
01 631001 500,000 Apr.01
02
03
04
05

PhoneNo

632001 400,000 Apr. 01


711001 150,000 Apr. 02
712002
9,000 Apr. 02
711001 50,000 Apr. 03

Narration

auth. by prep. by

110001 Commenced business


with cash
631001 Deposited into bank
632001 Purchases from R.S & Sons
632001 Paid rent for April, 2001
631001 Goods purchased from R.S.
& Sons

A001

B001

A001
A001
A001
A001

S001
B001
B001
S001

Support
Vno

Sno

02
03
03
04
05

1
1
2
1
1

Name
Cash deposit receipt
Purchase invoice no:
Dated:
Delivery challan
Rent receipt for the month April, 2005
Purchase invoice no:
Dated:

Accounts

Code
110001
631001
632001
711001
711003
712002
711011

Name
Capital account
Cash account
Bank account
Purchases
Carriage inwards
Rent
Wages

Type
4
3
3
1
1
1
1

Account Type
Cat_Id
1
2
3
4

Category
Expenditure
Income
Assets
Liabilities

Fig. 14.19 : An example of an accounting database that stores simple accounting transactions

522

Accountancy

Employees
Emp_Id

Fname Minit LName Address

A001
B001
S001
S002

Aditya
Bimal
Smith
Sunil

Vouchers

02
03
03

1
1
2

04
05

1
1

05

Bharti
Jalan
John
Sinha

Super_Id
A001
A001
B001

Vno Sno. Debit


01

K
S
K
K

PhoneNo

Amount Vdate

Credit

Narration

2005
631001 5,00,000 Apr. 01 110001 Commenced business
with Cash
632001 4,00,000 Apr. 01 631001 Deposited into bank
711001 1,50,000 Apr. 02 632001 Purchases from R.S & Sons
711003
3,000 Apr. 02 632001 Paid to Nahar
Transports
712002
9,000 Apr. 02 632001 Paid rent for April, 2001
711001
50,000 Apr. 02 631001 Goods purchased from
R.S. & Sons
711003
2,000 Apr. 03 631001 Paid for carriage to
Saini Transports

Accounts
Code
110001
631001
632001
711001
711003
712002
711011

Name
Capital Account
Cash Account
Bank Account
Purchases
Carriage Inwards
Rent
Wages

auth. by

prep. by

A001

B001

A001
A001
A001

S001
B001
B001

A001
A001

B00101
S001

A001

S001

Type
4
3
3
1
1
1
1

Account Type
Cat_Id
1
2
3
4

Category
Expenditure
Income
Assets
Liabilities

Fig. 14.20 : An example of an accounting database to store accounting transactions


according to debit and credit vouchers support table omitted

Structuring Database for Accounting

523

Modified Version of Accounting Database : An attempt to accommodate Debit


and Credit vouchers, as shown in Figure: 14.2 and 14.3, results in adding a
new column Sno to Vouchers table of database, which is shown in modified
database in figure 14.19. This results in data redundancy as shown in figure
14.20.
ER Model, as already discussed above, is a conceptual model, which need
be transformed into a representational data model so that a database design is
formed for being implemented and operated upon by using DBMS. From among
several representational models, Relational Data Model (RDM) is the most popular
and widely used in actual practice. Let us understand some important concepts
of RDM.
14.6 Relational Data Model
The relational data model represents the database as collection of relations, which
resembles a table of values (or data table). Each row of the table, therefore,
represents a collection of related data values and hence typically corresponds to
real world entity or relationship. The table name and column names are used to
help in interpreting the meaning of values in each row. Each row of a table is
called a data record. All values in a column, which belong to a particular domain,
are of same data type
Consider the following table of data items, named as Accounts. The table
has rows and columns. The column arrow points to a column called Name. The
Row arrow points to a data record consisting of (110001, Capital Account and
4) each of which corresponds to Code, Name and Type, which are three different
columns of the table.
Name of Table : Accounts
Code
110001
221019
221020
411001

Name
Capital Account
Jain & Co.
Jayram Bros.
Furniture Account

Type
4
4
4
3

Fig. 14.21 : Example data table of accounts and their attribute values

Formally, a row is called a tuple, a column header is called an attribute and


the table as such is called a relation. The data type describing the types of
values (such as text value, numeric values, date values, currency value, etc.)
that can appear in each column is called a domain. A domain is a set of indivisible
values. Associated with every domain is a data type such as Number,

524

Accountancy

Text, Currency, Date/Time, etc. Each domain must also be named so as to help
in interpreting its values. Besides this, a domain must be given a format and
any additional information to enable correct interpretation of values. For
example, a numeric domain such as distance should have units of measurement:
Miles or Kilometers
(a) Relations : A relation schema is made up of a relation name and a list of its
attributes. Each attribute is the name of role played by some domain in
the relation schema. A relation is given an identity by its name and
description by its schema. The degree of a relation is indicated by the
number of attributes it contains. For example, the degree of a relation schema
accounts is three as shown below :
ACCOUNTS (Code, Name, Type) Relation with attributes
ACCOUNTS is name of the relation which has three attributes;
Code = Identity of Account;
Name = Names of Account;
Type = Category of Account
A Relation represents an entity type. A relation (or relation state) is a set
of tuples wherein each tuple is an ordered list of values corresponding to
attributes of relation. Each of these values must belong to the domains of
their respective attributes. Each tuple in this relation represents a particular
entity. A relation schema may be interpreted as a declaration in the nature of
an assertion. For example, the schema of accounts relation, as shown above,
asserts that every account has a Code, Name and a Type. As a result, each
tuple in accounts relation can be interpreted as a fact or an instance of
assertion. Some relations represent facts about entities while others might
represent facts about relationships.
(b) Values in Tuples : Each value in a tuple is an indivisible value to imply
that it is not divisible into components within the framework of the basic
relational model. This implies that composite and multi-valued attributes
are not allowed. Composite attributes are represented by their simple
components. The multi-valued attributes are represented by separate
relations. A special value called Null is used to represent unknown or not
applicable values of attributes in a tuple. It is also possible to devise different
types of code values for different types of null value situation.
14.7 Relational Databases and Schemas
A relational database schema is a set of relation schemas and a set of integrity
constraints. A relational database state is a set of relation states such that every
relational database state satisfies the integrity constraints specified on relational
database schema.

Structuring Database for Accounting

525

In this context the following points merit a special consideration :


(a) A particular attribute, which stands for the same real word concept, might
appear in more than one relation with same or different name. For example,
in vouchers relation, the account Number is represented as debit and credit
whereas in accounts relation, it is represented as Code (figure 14.19). EmpId
appearing in Employees relation is represented in Vouchers as Auth.By and
Prep.By.
(b) The particular real world concept appearing more than once in a relation
must be represented by different names. For example, in employees relation,
employee is represented as subordinate, by using EmpId and as superior by
using SuperId.
(c) The Integrity constraints, specified on database schema, must hold in
every database state of that schema.
14.8 Constraints and Database Schemas
There are four different constraints, which can be specified on relational
databases. These are: domain constraint; key constraint; entity integrity
constraint; referential integrity constraints.
(a) Domain : The value of each attribute of a relation must be an indivisible
value and drawn out of possible values associated with its domain. The
value of an attribute, therefore, must conform to the data type associated
with the domain.
(b) Key Constraints and NULL Values : Each data record, which corresponds
to a tuple of a relation, in a table must be distinct. That means no two
tuples (or rows) in a relation ( or table) can have the same combination of
values for all their data items. This is because that a relation, as set of
tuples, has to have all its tuples distinct by definition. Every relation has
at least one key by default, which is the combination of all its attributes.
This is called super-key by default. Any such super-key, therefore, specifies
uniqueness constraint. Such a combination, representing super-key, may
have redundant attributes, implying thereby that a more useful concept
is that of a key which has not redundancy. This can be shown
diagrammatically as shown in figure 14.22. Therefore, minimal super-key
(also called Key) is defined as that part of super-key from which any attribute
cannot be removed without sacrificing the uniqueness constraint. The value
of key attribute can be used to identify each tuple in a relation. A key is
determined from the meaning of the attributes. The uniqueness feature of
key must continue to hold when new tuple in a relation is added. Sometimes
a relation may have more than one key in which case each of such keys is
called a candidate key. One such key is termed as primary key of relation.
The choice of which candidate key to be primary is generally subjective

526

Accountancy

and may depend on circumstances of mini-world. For Example: Both


PAN(Permanent Account Number) and EMPID are candidate keys in
EMPLOYEES relation because of being unique. But EMPID should be selected
in an organisation being native to the organisational environment.

Fig. 14.22 : Flow chart to reach a minimal super-key

(c) Entity integrity constraint : States that no primary key value can be null
because it is used to identify individual tuple in a relation. Null value implies
that we cannot identify such tuples or identify these as alike. A failure to
distinguish them means they are duplicates.
(d) Referential integrity constraint : While key and entity constraints are
specified on individual relation, the referential integrity constraint is specified
between two or more relations. This constraint is specified to maintain
consistency among the tuples of such relations. Accordingly, a tuple in one
relation that refers to another relation must refer to an existing tuple in that
other relation. In referencing Accounts Type, Accounts relation uses its
attribute Type, which acts as foreign key to reference the tuples of relation
Accounts Type through its primary key CatId. The value of Type cannot be
null because of total participation of Accounts in classify relationship.
Similarly, consider another example in which the relation Vouchers

Structuring Database for Accounting

527

(Vno, Sno, Vdate, Debit, Amount, Credit, Amount, Prep_by, Auth_by,


Narration) references two other relations as shown in figure 14.19.
First it references, Accounts (Code, Name, Type). In referencing Accounts,
the Vouchers relation uses its attributes Debit and Credit, which act as Foreign
Keys to reference the tuples of relation Accounts through its primary key,
Code. The values of debit and credit cannot be null because of total
participation of vouchers in debit and credit relationship.
Second, it references Employees (EmpId, Fname, Minit, Lname, Address,
PhoneNo, SuperId). While referencing Employees, the Vouchers relation
makes use of its other attributes Prep.By and Auth.By. These attributes act
as foreign keys to reference the tuples of relation Employees through its key
attribute EmpId. The values of PrepBy and AuthBy cannot be null because
of total participation of vouchers in PrepBy and Authby relationships.
The referential integrity constraint stands violated in above example, if
there is a debit or credit code in voucher relation, the tuple for which does
not exist in Accounts relation. Similarly, referential integrity fails, if there
exists a value corresponding to Auth.By or Prep.By attribute of vouchers,
the tuple for which does not exist in employees relation.
14.9 Operations and Constraint Violations
There are two categories of operations on relational model : updates and retrieval
The three basic types of updates are as given below :
(a) Insert : This operation is performed to add a new tuple in a relation. For
example, an attempt to add another record of an account with data values
corresponding to Code, Name and its Type to Accounts relation shall be
made by performing Insert operation. The insert operation is capable of
violating any of the four constraints discussed above.
(b) Delete : This operation is carried out to remove a tuple from a relation. A
particular data record from a table can be removed by performing such a
operation. The delete operation can violate only referential integrity, if tuple
being removed is referenced by foreign key from other tuples in the database.
(c) Modify : The operation aims at causing a change in the values of some
attributes in existing tuples. This is useful in modifying existing values of an
accounting record in a data table. Usually, this operation does not cause
problems provided the modification is directed on neither primary key nor
foreign key.
Whenever applied, these operations must enforce integrity constraints
specified on relational database schema.
Retrieval operation on Relational Data Model does not cause violation
any integrity constraints.

528

Accountancy

14.10 Designing Relational Database Schema


The rules or guidelines required to design the relational database schema attempt
to provide a step-by-step procedure that transforms ER design into Relational
Data model design to constitute the desired database. In the context of ER model
as shown in design figure14.12, the following specific steps are required to cause
its transformation into relational data model :
(i) Create a relation for every strong entity : For each strong entity type
(which has primary key) in ER schema, a separate relation that includes
all the simple attributes of that entity is created. Either choose one of the
key attributes of such an entity as the primary key for this relation, or
choose a set of simple attributes that uniquely identify this entity as the
primary key of the relation so created. For example, employee entity is
strong because it finds its primary key in EmpId which is one of its unique
attribute. Therefore, a separate relation for Employee has been created as
shown below :
Employee (EmpId, Fname, Minit,Lname,Address, PhoneNo, SuperId)
Similarly, separate relations need be created for the following strong entities
whose Primary Key attribute have been underlined.
Accounts (Code, Name, Type)
Vouchers (VNo,vDate, amount, narration)
Accounts Type (CatId, Category)
(ii) Create a separate relation for each weak entity type : Every weak entity
has an owner entity and an identifying relationship through which such
weak entity type is identified. For every weak entity type, a separate relation
is created by including its attributes. The primary key of this new relation
is the combination of its unique attribute(s) for a particular tuple of the
owner relation along with primary key attribute of such owner relation.
Furthermore, the primary key of owner entity is included as foreign key in
such a relation key of owner entity and the partial key of weak entity.
For example, Support Entity, with Vouchers as its owner Entity, does not
have a primary key of its own. It has partial key which is the Sno assigned
to each document. Therefore, the Primary key of Vouchers, Vno along
with Sno is designed as composite key for support entity and the relation
so formed is shown below as :
Support (vNo,Sno, dName,sDate)
(iii) Identify entity types participating in binary 1:N relationship type : Identify
the first relation on n-side of relationship and second on 1-side of such
relationship. The primary key of second relation should be included in
first relation as its foreign key. For Example, An employee can authorize a
number of vouchers. It implies that Vouchers entity participates in Auth.By

Structuring Database for Accounting

529

relationship on n-side while Employees entity participates in same


relationship on 1-side. Therefore, the vouchers relation as already formed
above in step 1, must also include as foreign key the primary key of
Employees, which is EmpId. Similarly, we can deal with Prep.By
relationship in which Employees and Vouchers again participate in binary
1:N relationship. The end result of mapping both these relationships is to
include twice the EmpId, but in different roles. Since a relation cannot
have same name (here EmpId twice to mean AuthBy and PrepBy), we use
their role names as attributes in Vouchers relation as foreign keys to
reference Employees relation.
Accordingly, the modified Vouchers relation appears as given below:
Vouchers (VNo, vDate, Amount, Narration, Auth.By, Prep.By)
Similarly, there exist two relationships between the relations Vouchers
and Accounts. The relation Vouchers as modified above shall further
include as foreign key the primary key of Accounts relation, which is code.
This code is to be included twice. One to represent debit and another to
represent credit relationship. Since a relation cannot have same name (here
Code is being included twice to mean Debit and Credit), we use their role
names as attributes in Vouchers relation as foreign keys to reference
Accounts relation. The modified vouchers relation shall appear as follows:
Vouchers (Vno,Vdate, Debit, Credit, Amount, Narration, AuthBy, Prep.By)
(iv) Identify entity types participating in binary M:N relationship type : For
each binary M:N relationship type, create a new relation to represent such
relationship. This new relation should include as foreign keys, the primary
keys of the relations that represent the participating entity types. For
example, consider the following entities and relationships in the context of
credit voucher shown in figure 14.23, which has one debit with multiple
credit accounts :

Fig. 14.23 : ER Diagram showing relationships between vouchers and accounts in the
context of credit vouchers, with one debit and several credit entries

530

Accountancy

In this case, relationship Credit has cardinality ratio of M:N between Vouchers
and Accounts(many vouchers are related to many accounts), While relationship
Debit has cardinality ratio of N:1 (many vouchers refer to one account). Further
Credit relationship has Sno, amount and narration has its attributes. Accordingly,
we create a new relation as follows :
Credit (vNo, Sno, Code, Amount, Narration)
In above relation credit Code is included as foreign key to represent primary
key of accounts relation, Vno is included as foreign key to represent primary
key of relation vouchers. (Vno,Code) constitute the primary key of this new
relation credit. By analogy, we can arrive at the following relation for Debit
voucher:
Debit (vNo, Sno, Code, Amount, Narration)
Finally, the following relations have been formed to constitute the relational
data model for our example reality.
Employee (EmpId, Fname, Minit,Lname,Address, PhoneNo, SuperId)
Accounts (Code, Name, Type)
Vouchers (VNo,Vdate, debit, credit, amount, narration, AuthBy, PrepBy)
AccountsType (CatType, Category)
Support (VNo,Sno,Dname,Sdate)
If we adopt the additional semantics the vouchers relation shall appear in
two different schemas :
Situation A : The schema given below is compatible with Debit voucher as shown
if figure 14.3.
Vouchers (vNo,vDate, Credit, Auth.By, Prep.By)
Debit (vNo, Sno, Code, Amount, Narration)
Situation B : The schema given below is compatible with Credit voucher as
shown if figure 14.2.
Vouchers (vNo,vDate, debit, AuthBy, PrepBy)
Credit (vNo, Sno, Code, Amount, Narration)
A generalised Schema for the two schemas shall be
Vouchers (vNo,vDate,Vtype, AccCode, vType, AuthBy, PrepBy)
Details ( vno, Sno, Code, Amount, Narration)
Where in another attribute vType has been introduced to indicate whether
this generalised schema applies to Situation A(vType=0) or Situation B(vType=1).
Debit and Credit attribute of vouchers relation have been renamed as AccCode
to mean Debit and Credit, depending on the value of Vtype. Debit and Credit
relations have been generalised into Details because both shared a set of common
attributes.

Structuring Database for Accounting

531

14.11 llustrating the Database Structure for Example Realities


DBMS software is used to implement the data model by creating several tables,
setting their interrelationships and imposing constraints as may be set out in
database design. After, the design is implemented, it must also allow for retrieval
of data and information. This is achieved by querying the database, for which
purpose, SQL statements are put to use. These retrieval requests result in
emergence of new virtual tables that may be formed out of one or more of existing
tables. A clear understanding of these SQL statements is a first step towards
the theoretical foundations for computerised reporting. This is because a report
is an organised set of information, which is extracted on the basis of these retrieval
requests. For a practical understanding of these operations, consider the following
Models, herein referred to as Model-I and Model-II. Each of these models, which
consist of a set of relations (or tables) and the integrity constraints, constitutes
the database design for accounting.
Model-I : This is based on initial conceptual design of example reality shown in
Figure: 14.11

Fig. 14.24 : Schema diagram for the accounting


system relational database schema

Model-II : The set relations given below are based on modified example reality
that uses Credit and Debit vouchers shown in figures 14.2 and 14.3.

532

Accountancy

Fig. 14.25 : Schema diagram for the accounting


system relational database Schema
Illustration No 1
Mr. Philips commenced business with cash and for that purpose opened a bank account
on April, 1 2005. His transactions for the month are as given below :
Date

Transactions

2005
Apr. 01 Commenced business with cash
Apr. 01 Cash deposited Into bank
Apr. 02 Goods purchased and payment made by Cheque No. 765421
Cheque No. 765422 issued to M/s Nahar Transports for carriage
Apr. 02 Rent for the month April, 2001 paid by Cheque No. 765423
Apr. 03 Goods purchased for cash from M/s R.S. & Sons
Paid for carriage to M/s Saini Transports
Apr. 04 Goods sold to Kemp & Co.
Apr. 05 Goods purchased from M/s Jayram Bros.
Apr. 06 Sold goods for cash to M/s Kumbley & Co.
Apr. 08 Paid for adverisement by Cheque No. 765424
to M/s ABN Cables

Amount
Rs .
5,00,000
4,00,000
1,50,000
3,000
9,000
50,000
2,000
1,75,000
2,50,000
45,000
2,500

Structuring Database for Accounting

533

Apr. 09 Received a bill of exchange from Kemp & Co.payable


after 3 months
Apr. 10 Bill of exchange received from Kemp & Co. discounted for
Apr. 12 Goods returned to Jayram Bros. being defective
Apr. 15 Advance cash payment to salesman for marketing tour
Apr. 17 Paid for insurance of godown Cheque No. 765425
Apr. 18 Paid for fuel, power and electricity
Apr. 18 Salary paid in advance to bimal
Apr. 19 Accepted a bill of exchange payable after four months
in favour of Jay Ram Bros.
Apr. 21 Returns from M/s Kumbley & Co., settled by
Cheque No. 765427
Apr. 23 Cash withdrawn by proprietor for household expenses

1,75,000
1,71,500
15,000
10,000
5,500
1,000
10,000
2,35,000
5,000
20,000

Apr. 25 Advance to salesman adjusted for cash after recording


expenses :
Entertainment
Travelling
Boarding and Lodging
Apr. 27 Goods taken from stock for personal use
Apr. 28 Furniture purchase from M/s S.N. Furnitures
by Cheque No. 765428
Apr. 29 A part of existing stock set a side for usage as
office furniture
Apr. 30 Salary for the month paid by Cheques
Cheque No. 765429 to Aditya
Cheque No. 765430 to Bimal ( one-fourth of advance
adjusted)
Cheque No. 765431 to Smith
Cheque No. 765432 to Sunil
Apr. 30 Payment of telephone bill by Cheque No. 765433
Apr. 30 Paid for wages by cash

4,500
2,200
3,500
5,000
45,000
35,000

9,000
5,500
6,000
5,000
1,500
7,000

The database state pertaining to Accounts and Employees table is as given below :
Accounts
Code
110001
221019
221020
222001
411001
411002
412002

Name
Capital Account
Jain & Co.
Jayram Bros.
Bill Payables
Furniture Account
Office Fittings
Plant and Machinery Account

Type
4
4
4
4
3
3
3

534

Accountancy
621001
621002
631001
632001
641001
641002
642001
651001
711001
711002
711003
711004
711011
712001
712002
712003
712004
712005
712006
712007
712008
712009
712010
811001
811002

Kemp & Co. 3


Kumble & Sons
Cash account
Bank account
Salary in advance account
Advance to salesman
Bills receivable
Drawings
Purchases
Purchases returns
Carriage inwards
Fuel, power and electricity
Wages
General expenses
Rent account
Salaries account
Discount account
Adverisement
Entertainment
Travelling
Boarding and Lodging
Communication expenses
Insurance
Sales account
Sales returns

1
3
3
3
3
3
4
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2

Account Type
CatId

Category

1
2
3
4

Expenditure
Income
Assets
Liabilities
Employees

EmpId

Fname

Minit

LName

A001
B001
S001
S002

Aditya
Bimal
Smith
Sunil

K
S
K
K

Bharti
Jalan
John
Sinha

Address

PhoneNo

SuperId

A001
A001
B001

Structuring Database for Accounting

535

Solution
The solution based on Model-I which lends support to Transaction Voucher with one Debit
and one Credit as shown in figure 14.19, shall appear as follows :
Vouchers
vNo Debit

amount
Rs.

vDate

Credit

01 631001

5,00,000

2005
Apr. 01 110001

02 632001
03 711001

4,00,000
1,50,000

Apr. 01 631001
Apr. 02 632001

04 711003

3,000

Apr. 02 632001

05 712002
06 711001

9,000
50,000

Apr. 02 632001
Apr. 03 631001

07 711003

2,000

Apr. 03 631001

08 621001
09 711001
10 631001

1,75,000
2,50,000
45,000

Apr, 04 811001
Apr. 05 221020
Apr. 06 811001

11 712005
12 642001

2,500
1,75,000

Apr. 08 632001
Apr. 09 621001

13 711002

15,000

Apr. 10 221020

14 712004

3,500

Apr. 12 642001

15 641002

10,000

Apr. 12 631001

16 712010
17 711004

5,500
1,000

Apr. 17 632001
Apr. 18 631001

18 641001

10,000

Apr. 18 631001

19 221020

2,35,000

Apr. 19 222001

20 811002

5,000

Apr. 21 632001

21 651001

20,000

Apr. 23 631001

22 712006

4,500

Apr. 25 641002

narration

AuthBy PrepBy

Commenced business
with cash
Deposited into bank
Purchases from
R.S & Sons
Paid to M/s Nahar
Transports
Paid rent for April, 2001
Goods purchased from
R.S. & Sons
Paid for carriage to
M/s Saini Transports
Goods sold
Invoice no. dated :
Goods sold to M/s
Kumbley & Co.
Paid to M/s ABN Cables
Maturity Date :
July 12, 2001
Goods returned
Note No. dated :
Discount on Bill of
exchange from Kemp & Co.
Advance payment to
sales for marketing tour
Insurance of godown
Payment for fuel, power
and electricity
Salary paid in advance
to Bimal
Settlement by accepting
a bill of exchange
Goods returned by M/s
Kumbley & Co.
Withdrawal by proprietor
for household expenses
Expenses during tour :
Support vouchers 1-4

A001

B001

A001
A001

S001
B001

A001

B001

A001
A001

B001
S001

A001

S001

A001
B001
S001

S002
S002
S002

A001
A001

S002
S002

A001

S002

A001

S002

B001

S001

S001
S001

B001
B001

B001

B001

B001

S001

A001

S001

A001

S001

A001

S001

536

Accountancy

23 712007

2,200

Apr. 25 641002

24 712008

3,500

Apr. 25 641002

25 641002

200 Apr. 25 631001

26 651001

5,000

Apr. 27 711001

27 411001

45,000

Apr. 28 632001

28 411001

35,000

Apr. 29 711001

29 712001

9,000

Apr. 30 632001

30 712001

5,500

Apr. 30 632001

31 712001

6,000

Apr. 30 632001

32 712001

5,000

Apr. 30 632001

33 712009
34 711011

1,500
7,000

Apr. 30 632001
Apr. 30 631001

Expenses during tour :


Support vouchers 5-7
Expenses during tour :
Support vouchers 8-11
Final settlement of
Refer to J.V No : 04/21
Goods taken for private
use
Furniture purchased
from S.N. Furniture
Goods purchased for
trading put to office use
Salary to AdityaApr,2001
Salary to Bimal-April,
2001 after adjustment
Salary to SmithApril 2001
Salary to SunilApril, 2001
Telephone bill
Payment of Wages

A001

S001

A001

S001

A001

S001

A001

S002

A001

S002

A001

S002

A001

S001

A001

S001

A001

S001

A001

S001

A001
A001

B001
S001

Shortcomings
The above solution, being based on transaction voucher with one debit and one credit in a
transaction requires multiple vouchers for one real transaction. For example, a transaction
dated April 30, 2005 Salary for the month paid by cheque requires four vouchers 29 to
32. One transaction should be recorded possibly through one voucher only.
Solution
The solution based on Model-II which lends support to Debit Voucher (with Multiple Debits
and one Credit) and Credit voucher (with one Debit and multiple Credits) as shown in
Figure: 14.2 and figure 14.3 shall appear as follows :
Vouchers
Vno

Vdate

Acc_code

Vtype

PrepBy

AuthBy

01
02
03
04
05
06
07

2005
Apr. 01
Apr. 01
Apr. 02
Apr. 02
Apr. 03
Apr. 04
Apr. 05

631001
632001
632001
632001
631001
811001
221020

1
1
0
0
0
0
0

B001
S001
B001
B001
S001
S002
S002

A001
A001
A001
A001
A001
A001
B001

Structuring Database for Accounting


08
09
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28

Apr. 06
Apr. 08
Apr. 09
Apr. 10
Apr. 10
Apr. 12
Apr. 12
Apr. 17
Apr. 18
Apr. 18
Apr. 19
Apr. 21
Apr. 23
Apr. 25
Apr. 25
Apr. 27
Apr. 28
Apr. 29
Apr. 30
Apr. 30
Apr. 30

537

631001
632001
621001
632001
221020
642001
631001
632001
631001
631001
222001
632001
631001
641002
631001
711001
632001
711001
632001
632001
631001

1
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0

S002
S002
S002
S002
S002
S002
S001
B001
B001
B001
S001
S001
S001
S001
S001
S002
S002
S002
S001
B001
S001

S001
A001
A001
A001
A001
A001
B001
S001
S001
B001
B001
A001
A001
A001
A001
A001
A001
A001
A001
A001
A001

Details
Vno

Sno

01
02
03
03
04
05
05
06
07
08
09
10
12
13
14
15
16
17
18

1
1
1
2
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1

Code
110001
631001
711001
711003
712002
711001
711003
621001
711001
811001
712005
642001
711002
712004
641002
712010
711004
641001
221020

Amount
5,00,000
4,00,000
1,50,000
3,000
9,000
50,000
2,000
1,75,000
2,50,000
45,000
2,500
1,75,000
15,000
3,500
10,000
5,500
1,000
10,000
2,35,000

Narration
Commenced business with cash
Deposited into bank
Purchases from R.S & Sons
Paid to M/s Nahar Transports
Paid rent for April, 2001
Goods purchased from R.S. & Sons
Paid for carriage to M/s Saini Transports
Goods sold
Invoice No. dated:
Goods sold to M/s Kumbley & Co.
Paid to M/s ABN cables
Maturity date July 12, 2001
Goods returned Note No. dated.
Discount on bill of exchange from Kemp & Co.
Advance payment to sales for marketing tour
Insurance of godown
Payment for fuel, power and electricity
Salary paid in advance to Bimal
Settlement by accepting a bill of exhange

538
19
20
21
21
21
22
23
24
25
26
26
26
26
27
28

Accountancy
1
1
1
2
3
1
1
1
1
1
2
3
4
1
1

811002
651001
712006
712007
712008
641002
651001
411001
411001
712001
712001
712001
712001
712009
711011

5,000
20,000
4,500
2,200
3,500
200
5,000
45,000
35,000
9,000
5,500
6,000
5,000
1,500
7,000

Goods Returned by M/s Kumbley & Co.


Withdrawal by proprietor for household expenses
Expenses during tour: Support Vouchers 1-4
Expenses during tour: Support Vouchers 5-7
Expenses during tour: Support Vouchers 8-11
Final settlement of Refer to J.V no. 04/21
Goods taken for private use
Furniture purchased from S.N. Furniture
Goods purchased for trading put to office use
Salary to Aditya Apr. 2001
Salary to Bimal Apr. 2001after adjustment
Salary to Smith Apr. 2001
Salary to Sunil Apr. 2001
Telephone bill
Payment of Wages

Test Your Understanding


A.

B.

Indicate against each of the following statements, True or False :


(a) Every relation has at least one super key by default, which is the combination
of all its attributes.
(b) Data transformation is called Information.
(c) Referential integrity constraint arises because of relationships between various
entities.
(d) The complete absence of WHERE clause in SELECT statement implies that
no tuples of a relation shall be selected.
(e) ER model is an example of representational data model.
Fill in the blanks, an appropriate word(s)
(a) A ........... does not have key attributes of its own.
(b) The ........... for binary relationship specifies the number of relationship
instances that an entity can participate in.
(c) Each simple attribute of an entity type is associated with a value set called
........... of values.
(d) When structure of AIS is based on both human and computer resources, it is
called ........... AIS.
(e) An ........... is a collection of all entities of a particular entity type.
(f) A weak entity type always has a ........... constraint with respect to its identifying
relationship.
(g) When a relation has more than one attribute with unique values, each such
attribute is called ............

After appreciating the way accounting data is presented in above database models, let
us understand as to how the queries on such databases are expressed as relational
operations.

Structuring Database for Accounting

539

14.12 Interacting with Databases


One of the major reasons for the success of commercial databases is the SQL
language support they enjoy. This is because SQL became standard for relational
databases. As a result, users have become less concerned about migrating their
database applications from one database to another database. Another advantage
in using standard SQL is that users may write statements in a database
application program that can access data stored in two or more relational DBMS
without having to change the database sub-language (SQL) provided both the
DBMS enjoy the support of a particular SQL standard.
The name SQL stands for Structured Query Language, which was originally
called SEQUEL (Structured English QUEry Language), designed and
implemented at IBM Research as an interface for experimental relational database
system called SYSTEM-R.
Being a comprehensive database language, it has statements for data
definition, query and update. Besides this, it has the capability to define useroriented views of database, specify security and authorisation, define integrity
constraints and various other operations. Many computer-programming
languages can act as good host languages to incorporate the statements of SQL.
In this sense, it can be used as a sub-language in a database-programming
context.
Basic Queries in SQL : Data Query Language (DQL), which is a sub-set of SQL
is widely used to answer most of the basic queries. The basic set of queries
consists of those, for which the SELECT-FROM-WHERE Structure is put to use
as described below :
SELECT : This clause is used to specify the data or information that is desired
to answer the query.
FROM : This clause is used to specify the source of data for answering the
query. It can be a data table, an existing query or both.
WHERE : This clause is meant to specify the conditions that are used to
narrow down the choice of data to extract the information desired in select
clause.
The following queries have been considered using the database design given
in Model-I and Model-II. The solution to queries has been given using MS
ACCESS implementation.
I. Query to retrieve all columns of data records from a table, subject to a
condition : To project all the attribute values of selected tuples, an asterisk
(*) need be specified. This asterisk stands for all the attributes.
(1)

To retrieve all columns of voucher records whose voucher has been authorised
by an employee whose EmpId is equal to A001.

540

Accountancy

Solution
(Model-I and Model-II)
SELECT *
FROM
WHERE

vouchers
AuthBy=A001;

II. Query to retrieve selected columns of data records from a table, subject
to a condition.
(2)

To Retrieve vouchers with Vno, Vdate, AuthBy columns wherein the vouchers
are dated 12/Apr/2005

Solution
(Model-I and Model-II)
SELECT
FROM
WHERE
(3)

Vno, Vdate, AuthBy


vouchers
Vdate = #04/12/2005#;

To retrieve vouchers with Vno, Vdate, Auth_by columns, which are dated 12/
Apr/2005. The columns of records retrieved by the query are to be renamed
as Voucher, Date and Employee

Solution
(Model-I and Model-II)
SELECT
FROM
WHERE

Vno As Voucher, Vdate As Date, Prep_by As Employee


vouchers
Vdate = # 04/12/2005#;

III. Unspecified WHERE Clause : Absence of WHERE clause in SELECT


statement implies that the tuples from a relation are to be selected without
applying any condition. This in turn means that all tuples of a relation
specified in FROM clause qualify for being selected for the result of query.
Consider the following query with reference to Model-I.
(4)

Find out the list of accounts which have been debited

Solution
(Model-I)
SELECT DISTINCT Debit As Code
FROM vouchers;

Structuring Database for Accounting

541

Solution
(Model-II)
SELECT
AccCode As Code
FROM
vouchers
WHERE
vType = 0;
UNION
SELECT
Details.Code
FROM
vouchers, Details
WHERE
vType = 1 AND vouchers.vNo = Details.vNo;
Save above query as DebitAccounts, and thereafter execute another query as
given below to get the final results.
SELECT DISINCT *
FROM
Debit Accounts ;
(5)

Find out the list of accounts which have been credited

Solution
(Model-I)
SELECT DISTINCT Credit As Code
FROM
vouchers ;
Solution
(Model-II)
SELECT
AccCode As Code
FROM
vouchers
WHERE
Vtype = 1;
UNION
SELECT
Details.Code
FROM
vouchers, Details
WHERE
vType = 0 AND vouchers.vNo = Details.vNo;
Save above query as CreditAccounts, and thereafter execute another query as
given below to get the final results.
SELECT DISINCT *
FROM
CreditAccounts;
(6)

Find out the list of accounts which have been debited as well as credited

Solution
(Model-I)
SELECT DISTINCT Debit As Code
FROM
vouchers
WHERE
Debit IN (SELECT Credit As Code
FROM
vouchers);

542

Accountancy

Solution
(Model-II)
SELECT *
FROM
WHERE
FROM
Save above
Model-II
(7)

DebitAccounts
Code IN (SELECT *
CreditAccounts);
solution query as DebitCredit, both for Model-I and

Find out the list of accounts which have been debited but not credited

Solution
(Model-I)
SELECT
FROM
WHERE
FROM

DISTINCT Debit As Code


vouchers
Debit NOT IN (SELECT Code
DebitCredit);

Solution
(Model-II)
SELECT *
FROM
WHERE
FROM
(8)
Find out

DebitAccounts
Code NOT IN (SELECT *
DebitCredit)
the list of accounts which have been credited but not debited

Solution
(Model-I)
SELECT DISTINCT Credit As Code
FROM
vouchers
WHERE
Credit NOT IN (SELECT Code
FROM
DebitCredit);
Solution
(Model-II)
SELECT *
FROM
WHERE
FROM

CreditAccounts
Code NOT IN ( SELECT *
DebitCredit)

IV. Ambiguous Attribute Names and Renaming (Aliasing) : SQL allows the
use of homonyms (that is same name for two or more attributes) as long
as such attributes are in different relations. If the use of a common attribute
with a particular name across the relations prevails, it becomes necessary

Structuring Database for Accounting

543

to qualify the attribute name with relation name in which it exits. This is
achieved by prefixing the relation name to the attribute name and
separating the two by a period symbol dot. In Model-II, the attribute Vno,
referring to voucher number in vouchers relation, also exists in details
relation. Whenever vouchers and details relations are used in a query, the
use of Vno attribute must precede the name of relation or its alias name.
For example,
(9)

Retrieve a list of accounts and the amounts debited because of cash payments.
The Cash Account code begins with 631.

Solution
(Model-I)
SELECT
FROM
WHERE

Narration, Debit As Code, Amount


Vouchers
Credit LIKE 631*;

Solution
(Model-II)
SELECT
Narration,Acc_code AS Code, Amount
FROM
Vouchers AS V, Details AS D
WHERE
tType=1 AND V.vNo=D.vNo
AND
acc_code like 631*
UNION
SELECT
Narration,Code, Amount
FROM
Vouchers AS V, Details AS D
WHERE
tType = 0 AND V.vNo = D.vNo
AND code LIKE 631*;
(10)

To retrieve a detailed list of all accounts, giving their code, Name and category.

Solution
(Model-I and Model-II)
SELECT Code, Name, Category
FROM Accounts, AccountType
WHERE CatId = Type
(11) To retrieve a detailed list of all account, giving their code, Name and category,
which have been debited
Solution
(Model-I)
SELECT
FROM
WHERE

DISTINCT Debit AS Code, Name, Category


Vouchers AS V,Accounts AS A, AccountType
V.Debit = A.Code AND CatId = type

544

Accountancy

Solution
(Model-II by using query solution saved as DebitAccounts in Q.No: 4)
SELECT Code, Name, Category
FROM DebitAccounts AS D, Accounts AS A, Category
WHERE D.Code = A.Code AND Type = CatId
(12)

To retrieve Code, Name and Category of Expense accounts which have been
debited

Solution
(Model-I)
SELECT
FROM
WHERE

Debit AS Code, Name, Category


Vouchers, Accounts, AccountType
Debit = Code AND Type = CatId
AND Category = Expenses

Solution
(Model-II by using query solution saved as Debit Accounts in Q.No: 4)
SELECT
FROM
WHERE
(13)

D.Code, Name, Category


DebitAccounts AS D, Accounts AS A, AccountType
D.Code = A.code AND Type = CatId
AND Category = Expenses

To retrieve Narration and Amount of transactions where Expense head


Carriage Inwards has been debited.

Solution
(Model-I)
SELECT
FROM
WHERE

Narration, Amount
Vouchers, Accounts
Debit = Code
AND Name LIKE Carriage Inw*;

Solution
(Model-II by using query solution saved as DebitAccounts in Q.No: 4)
SELECT
FROM
WHERE

Narration, Amount
Details AS T,DebitAccounts AS D, Accounts AS A
T.Code = D.Code AND D.Code = A.Code
AND Name LIKE Carriage Inw*

V. Sub-string Comparisons and Arithmetic Operators and Ordering and use


of functions : SQL allows comparison on sub-strings (that are some parts
of a character string). This can be achieved by use of LIKE Operator. This
like operator instead of equal to (=) operator can be used when exact value

Structuring Database for Accounting

545

of comparison is not known. Partial strings or sub-strings are specified by


using * and range specification within rectangular brackets. For Example:
(14)

To make a list of accounts pertaining to the assets of the company, given that
each of the assets account code begins with 4, following query need be
executed:

Solution
(Model-I and Model-II)
SELECT
Code, Name
FROM
accounts
WHERE
Code like 4*
(15)

To make a list of employees whose names start from a to k, following query


need be executed :

Solution
(Model-I and Model-II)
SELECT
FROM
WHERE

Fname & & Minit & & Lname As Name of Employee


Employees
Fname like [a-e]*

VI. Another comparison operator used in SQL is BETWEEN ....AND


....operator. This operator facilitates numeric range tests for selection of
tuples. For Example:
(16)

To retrieve vouchers with amount ranging between 5,000 and 10,000, following
query need be formulated.

Solution
(Model-I)
SELECT
FROM
WHERE

Vno, Amount
Vouchers
Amount BETWEEN 5000 AND 10000 ;

Solution
(Model-II)
SELECT
FROM
WHERE.

Vno, Amount
Vouchers AS V, Details AS D
V.vno = D.vno AND Amount BETWEEN 5,000 AND 10,000;

VII. Another feature of SQL permits the use of standard arithmetic operators,
which can be directly applied to numeric values appearing in a query
statement. Consider the following query:

546

Accountancy
(17)

To find various amounts of sales during the month of April, 2005 and the
amounts of such sales if the prices of products are allowed to be raised by
16%.

Solution
(Model-I)
SELECT
FROM
WHERE

Vdate, Credit, Amount, Amount*1.16 AS Expected


Vouchers, Accounts
Credit = Code AND name LIKE Sales Account*

Solution
(Model-II)
SELECT
FROM
WHERE
UNION
SELECT
FROM
WHERE

Vdate, D.code, Amount, Amount*1.16 AS Expected


Vouchers AS V, Details AS D, accounts AS A
V.vNo = D.vNo AND D.code = A.Code AND A.Name LIKE
Sales Account* AND tType = 1
Vdate, V.Acc_code, Amount, Amount*1.16 AS Expected
Vouchers AS V, Details AS D, accounts AS A
V.vno = D.vno AND V.acc_code = A.code AND A.name LIKE
Sales Account* AND Ttype = 0;

VIII. SQL also allows ordering of resultant tuples according to some specified
attribute, which may or may not form part of the resultant relation. Consider
the following example:
(18)

To retrieve list of Accounts in dictionary order of their Names :

Solution
(Model-I and Model-II)
SELECT *
FROM Accounts
ORDER BY Name

IX. SQL queries allow the use of supported functions within the query itself.
List of these functions varies from one implementation to another depending
on the specific RDBMS. Consider the following example :
(19)

To List details of vouchers released during April, 2005.

Solution
(Model-I and Model-II)
SELECT *
FROM vouchers
WHERE Month(vDate) = 4

Structuring Database for Accounting

547

To execute above query, month() function is used which accepts within parenthesis
the data a parameter and returns the numeric value of one month varying from 1
through 12. In this case the relevant value to be compared for the month of April
is 4.

X. Explicit Sets and NULL in SQL : Query results can be retrieved even for
rows in which value of an attribute is missing. This is achieved by using
NULL in Where clause while specifying the condition. If more than one
value is to be compared with an attribute, the value set can be given in
Where clause by specifying IN operator.
(20)

To retrieve Details of Accounts with following Codes: relating to 621001,


632021 and 642002.

Solution
(Model-I and Model-II)
SELECT *
FROM
Accounts
WHERE
Code IN(621001,632001,642002);
(21)

To retrieve name of all employees who do not have supervisors.

Solution
(Model-I and Model-II)
SELECT *
FROM
WHERE

Employees
SuperId = NULL;

XI. Aggregate Functions and Grouping : The concept of aggregate functions


as referred to in relational operations, is implemented by SQL. Five such
functions commonly used for aggregate of data items are: COUNT,SUM,
MAX, MIN and AVG. These functions when applied on a set of numeric
values, return respectively number of rows, the sum , maximum, minimum
and average of these values. The GROUP BY clause is used for providing
the basis of creating collection of data items on which these functions are
to be applied. Consider the following examples.
(22)

To find the sum, minimum and maximum of cash payment during April,
2005. The cash account code begins with 631

Solution
(Model-I)
SELECT
FROM
WHERE
GROUP BY

Debit AS Code, SUM(Amount) AS Total,


MIN(Amount) As Minimum, MAX(Amount) As Maximum
Vouchers
Debit like 631*
Debit

548

Accountancy

Solution
(Model-II)
SELECT
FROM
WHERE
GROUP BY

Code, SUM(Amount) AS Total,


MIN(Amount) As Minimum, MAX(Amount) As Maximum
Vouchers AS V, Details AS D
V.Vno=D.Vno, Ttype=0 and Code Like 631*
D.Code
Key Terms Introduced in the Chapter

Database System

Entity Relationship (ER) Model


Reality Database

Rational Data Model


Accounting Intermedia

Transaction Voucher
Credit Voucher

Debit Voucher
Attributes

Interacting with Database


Designing Database for Accounting
Summary with Reference to Learning Objectives

(1) Database Concepts


Reality : It consists of different components of an organisation such as people,
facilities and other resources.
Data : It represent data concerning people, places, objects entities, events, etc.
and non-financial 14 nature.
Database : It was a shared collection of inter-related data tables, tiles or structures
which are designed to most varied information needs of all organisation.
International : Processed data organisation in a form that is suitable for decisionmaking.
DBMS : A collection of programmes that enable users to create and maintain a
database.
(2) Database System Concepts and Architecture
Data model : Collection of concepts used to describe the structure of a database.
Database Schemes : The description of a database is called its scheme.
Data Base State and Instances : Data in a database at a particular movement is
called database state.
(3) Entity Relationship (ER) Model
An important concept of data model mostly used in data base oriented application.
The major elements of ER model are entities, Attributes, identities and relationship
that are used to express reality for which a data base is to be designed.

Structuring Database for Accounting


(4) Relation Data Model (RDM)
It represent the database at collection of tables comprising different volumes. It
consists of rows and columns. The table name and column name are used to help
in interpreting the meaning of volumes of each row. Each row of table is called a
data record.
Questions for Practice
Short Answers
1.
2.
3.

4.
5.
6.
7.
8.

9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.

State main categories of data models.


How are computers useful in processing the accounting data?
What do you understand by accounting data? Discuss the stages through
which it is finally transformed for being presented as information in financial
statements.
What do you understand by database. How does it differ from DBMS?
What is meant by entity type? How it is different from entity set? Illustrate
by giving suitable example from accounting reality.
What do you understand by relationship type? How is it different from
relationship instance and relationship set?
What do you understand by multi-valued attribute? How is it different from
complex and composite attribute? Illustrate by giving suitable example.
What do you understand by the concept of weak entity used in data
modelling? Explain the relevance of owner entity type, partial key and
identifying relationship in the context of such modelling.
What is a participation role? State the circumstances under which the use
of role names becomes necessary in description of relationship types.
Define foreign key. How is this concept useful in relational data model?
Illustrate with suitable example.
What is meant by NULL value? What are the reasons that lead to their
occurrence in database relations?
Why are duplicate tuples not allowed in a relation?
What do you understand union compatibility of relations? For which
operations such compatibility is required and why?
What is the need for database normalisation?

Long Answers
1.
2.
3.
4.

Discuss the basic concepts of Entity Relationship (ER) Model. Illustrate as


to how an ER model is diagrammed.
What integrity constraints are specified on database schema? Why is each
considered important?
Discuss the different types of update operations in relation to the integrity
constraints which must be satisfied in a relational database model.
Discuss the steps you would take to transform an ER Model into various
relations of Relational Data Model. Give suitable examples.

Project Work
(i)

Consider the following reality in a business enterprise, which is engaged in


trading activity.

549

550

Accountancy

(ii)

It buys and sells a given number of items each of which is uniquely


identifiable. Each unit of item is expressed in numbers or Kilograms.
It procures its supplies from a given number of suppliers who can supply
any number of items at a time. Each transaction is on credit for a
particular period of time expressed in days.
It sells various items to its customers on credit for a definite period of
time expressed in days.
Each purchase is made through a regular invoice, which has its distinct
number for the supplier. It is duly dated, mentions the items being
transacted, their quantities and prices and total amount of invoice.
Design an ER schema for a database application for purchase and sales
accounting and also show as to how it shall be transformed into various
relations of a relational data model.
Following transactions of M/s Soumya Enterprises are given to you for the
period ending March, 31 2002.

March 05
02
08
10
12
16
20
24
28
30

Additional capital brought in cash by proprietor, Rs.5,00,000, out


of which deposited into a bank account Rs.4,50,000
Received Cheque for Rs.56,000 from K & Co. on account
Issued Cheque for Rs.75,000 in favour of Jain & Sons
Payment of rent for the month Rs.15,000
Goods purchased Rs.34,000 by Cash
Goods sold to R & Co Rs.45,000
Purchased furniture for office use Rs.25,000
Paid fire insurance premium by Cheque Rs. 12,000
Paid cash to Jayram Bros. Rs.29,000 in full settlement of their
account standing at Rs.29,500
Payment of salary to staff Rs.20,000

All these transactions have been stored in database tables as shown below
under (Model-I of database design). Data in Accounts table appears as follows:
Accounts
Code

Name

110001
221019
411001
411002
621001
631001
632001
641001
711001
711002
711003
711005
711006
811001

Capital Account
Jain & Sons
Furniture Account
Fixtures & Fittings Account
K & Co
Cash Account
Bank Account
Salary in Advance Account
Cartage Account
Salaries Account
Rent Account
Insurance Premium
Discount Account
Sales Account

Structuring Database for Accounting

551

Show how will these transactions appear as accounting data in following vouchers
table.

Vno
Vdate
Debit
Amount
Credit
Narration
(iii)

:
:
:
:
:
:

Identity of a transaction stored through a voucher.


to date of transaction
to code of account being debited
Amount of transaction
Code of account being credited
Narration of transaction.

M/s Soumya Exports set up a garments export business on March,1 2002.


Their transactions for the month ending March, 31 2002 are given below :

March 01
03
04
11
14
14
16
19
22
25
29
30

Capital brought in cash by proprietor, Rs.5,00,000, out of which


deposited into a bank account Rs.4,50,000
Received Cheque for Rs.86,000 from Kailash Nath & Co. as advance
account
Issued Cheque for Rs.85,000 to Jackson Bros. as advance for
supplies
Payment of rent for the month Rs.18,000
Purchased Computer system for office use Rs.53,000, payment for
which made by Cheque
Goods purchased Rs.1,30,000 , payment made by Cheque.
Goods purchased from Jackson and Bros. for Rs.97,500
Goods sold to Rajeshwar & Sons Rs.45,000
Purchased Furniture for office use Rs.25,000
Paid fire insurance premium by Cheque Rs. 12,000
Paid Cash To Jackson Bros. Rs.12,000 in full settlement of their
outstanding balance of Rs.12,500
Payment of salary to staff Rs.20,000

All these transactions have been stored in database tables as shown below under
(Model-I of database design). Data in Accounts table appears as follows:
Accounts
Code

Name

110001
221019
411001

Capital Account
Jackson Bros.
Furniture Account

552

Accountancy
413001
621001
621002
631001
632001
641001
711001
711002
711003
711005
711006
811001

Office Equipment
Kailash Nath & Co
Rajeshwar & Sons
Cash Account
Bank Account
Salary in Advance Account
Cartage Account
Salaries Account
Rent Account
Insurance Premium
Discount Account
Sales Account

Show how will these transactions appear as accounting data in following accounting
data tables.

Vno
Vdate
Acc_code
Code

(iv)

:
:
:
:

Identity of a transaction stored through a voucher


date of transaction
code of account being debited or credited
Codes of accounts being credited or debited, depending on
value of Vtype( = 0, means codes being debited, 1 means
codes being credited)
Sno
: Serial number of accounts being debited in debit voucher
and those being credited in credit voucher
Vtype
: 0 = means debit voucher, 1 = credit voucher
Amount
: Amount of transaction
Narration : Narration of transaction
Write relational operation expressions and relevant SQL statements for
following queries using Database Design Model-I and Model-II :
(a) Retrieve the voucher details and type of voucher authorised by a
particular employee.
(b) Retrieve every bank payment voucher details, account name, amount.
You are given that bank account code =632001.
(c) Find details of cash vouchers pertaining to an expense account whose
account code = 711003. You ar e given that cash account
code=631001.
(d) Make a list of accounts and amount with respect to which a voucher
has been either prepared or authorised by a particular employee.
(e) Retrieve details of vouchers without support documents.

Structuring Database for Accounting

(iv)

553

(f) List details of documents with at least one support document.


(g) Find all vouchers with total amounts raised during a particular month.
(h) Retrieve all vouchers prepared by an employee whose First name is Smith.
Write relational operation expressions and relevant SQL statements for
following queries using Database Design Model-I and Model-II.
(a) Retrieve all vouchers pertaining to a particular account with amounts
ranging between Rs. 10,000 to Rs. 20,000.
(b) Retrieve details of each voucher whose support document has the same
date as that of the voucher itself.
(c) Retrieve details of voucher authorised by employees who do not have
supervisors.
(d) Find sum of cash payments, maximum payments, minimum payments
and average.
(e) Find sum of cash payment, maximum and minimum amount with
respect to a particular account Code.
(f) Retrieve every bank payment voucher details, account name, amount
pertaining to a particular period ranging from Date1 to Date 2.
(g) Find details of cash vouchers pertaining to a particular expense account.
(h) Make a list of accounts and amount with respect to which a voucher
has been either prepared or authorised by a particular employee.
(i) Find all vouchers with total amounts raised during a particular month.
(j) Retrieve all vouchers prepared by an employee whose last name is Dev.
(k) Retrieve details of each voucher whose support document has the same
date as that of the voucher itself.
Checklist to Test Your Understanding

A.

(a) T

(b) T

(c) T

B. (a) Weak entity


(b) Computer based
(c) Timeware
(d) Liveware
(e) Total participation
(f) Multi-valued
(g) Full functional

(d) F

(e) F

554

Accountancy

Accounting System Using


Database Management System

LEARNING OBJECTIVES
After studying this
chapter, you will be able
to :
identify the resources
of MS ACCESS as
DBMS;
create data tables
described in a database design and set
relationship among
these tables;
explain the ACCESS
basics and procedures
to create forms using
ACCESS;
describe and create
voucher for ms in
consonance with different database designs;
identify infor mation
requirement of reports
for querying databases;
formulate and implement queries for retrieving data and information for presentation
in accounting reports ;
and
implement the process
in ACCESS for generating accounting reports
by using accounting
information queries.

15

n chapter 14, you have lear nt about the


fundamentals of creating a database design in
the context of accounting system. This chapter deals
with the basics of MS Access for implementing the
databases and specifically deals with implementation of accounting databases, the design of which
has been shown, described and discussed in chapter
14 as Model-I and Model-II. The accounting
database design has been discussed below in terms
of its implementation modalities in the context of
MS Access.
15.1 MS Access and its Components

It is one of the popularly used Database Management


System (DBMS) to create, store and manage
database. It is also popularly called ACCESS.
Every component that is created using Access
is an object and several such similar objects
constitute a class. Access is functionally available
with the following seven-object classes. Each of
these object classes is capable of creating their
respective object replicas.
Tables : This object class allows a database
designer to create the data tables with their
respective fieldnames, data types and properties.
Queries : This object class is meant to create the
SQL compatible query statement with or without
the help of Graphic User Interface (GUI) to define
tables, store data and retrieve both data and
information.

Accounting System using DBMS

555

Forms : This object class allows the designer to create an appropriate user
interface to formally interact with the back end database, defined by the
tables and queries.
Reports: This object class is used to create various reports, the source of
information content of which is based on tables, queries or both. Such
reports are designed in Access according to the requirement of end-user.
Pages : This object class is meant to create Data Access Pages, which can
be posted on a Web site of an organisation using Internet or sent via
e-mail to someone of the organisations network.
Macros : In macro programming, the objects using individual instructions
called macro-oriented actions are manipulated. A Macro is a list of macrooriented actions that run as a unit. Access provides for such Macro
programming.

Fig. 15.1 : An example of database window to work in Access

Modules : These are the foundations of any application and allow the
designer to create a set of programming instructions, called functions or
sub-routines that can be used throughout the application.

556

Accountancy

The functions return a value while subroutines do not return any value.
Access provides for creating such modules.
Each of these object classes is contained in the named database file of
Access with MDB extension. Whenever this file is opened, a database window,
as shown on next page, opens with all the above object classes available on
the left hand side. As and when the specific objects are created or designed,
they get listed on right hand side of this window against each of these object
classes.
Box 1
Capabilities of MS Access
Access has certain capabilities, which bring it closer to an ideal Database
Management System. These capabilities are :
Storing the data in an organised manner.
Enforcing data integrity constraints.
Representing complex relationship among data.
Providing for persistent storage of database objects.
Restricting unauthorised access to database.
Allowing fast retrieval of data with or without processing by using SQL.
Flexibility to create multiple user interfaces.
Providing for data sharing and multi-user transaction processing.
Supporting multiple views of data and information.

15.1.1 Access Basics for Creating a Database


When a new database is created from the scratch, there is complete control
over the database objects, their properties and the relationships. In order to
create a new database without the help of database wizard (that is an
automated process in Access), the following steps are required :
(i) Open Access Window to choose blank Access database and click OK
button.
(ii) Access responds by displaying File New Database dialog box, which
prompts the designer to enter a file name and a location for the database.
This must be followed by clicking Create button.
(iii) If the task pane is not open, choose File from menu bar and click at
new to open the task pane to create a new database.
15.1.2 Creating of Tables in Access
The creation of tables in Access requires the following steps and understanding
of the components of table object.

Accounting System using DBMS

557

Click at Tables object of Access, followed by double click at create table by


design view. This results in providing a table window, the upper part of
which has three columns: Field Name, Data Type and Description. It is meant
to define the schema of a table being created. Each of its rows corresponds to
a column of the table being created. Two primary properties of the column of
a table are its field name and data type.
(a) Field name : refers to column name of the table being created. The name of
the column should be a string of contiguous characters. The Field name is
meant to define the name of column to be created, followed by data type of
such column. The designer can optionally provide description of the column
also. Once the data type is defined, the designer can further specify the
properties of each column in the lower part of the Table window.
(b) Data Types : Access supports different data types, the details of which are
as given below :
Text : It is used for a string of characters: words or numbers that are
not to be used in any arithmetic calculations. The maximum length for
a text field is 255 characters. It is the default data type because of
being used most frequently.
Memo : It is used for storing comments and is capable of accommodating
65,536 characters. But a field with this data type is not amenable to
sorting or filtering of data records.
Number : It is meant to store numbers, which could be integers (-32768
to 32767), long integers (2,147,483,648 to 2,147,483,647), bytes
( 0 255), single (to store values with decimal point up to a certain
limit), double (to store values in decimal point with greater magnitude
and more precision) or decimal types.
Date/Time : It is used to store dates, times or a combination of both.
Currency : It is used for storing numbers in terms of Dollars, Rupees or
other Currencies.
AutoNumber : It is a numeric data automatically entered by Access. It
is of particular importance in a situation where none of the fields
individually or a set of fields as a combination in a table is unique.
Yes/No : It is to declare a logical field which may have only one of the two
opposite values alternatively given as: Yes or No, On or Off, True or False.
OLE Object : OLE stands for Object Linking and Embedding. It refers to
an object that could be a photograph, bar code image or another
document created in another software application.
Hyperlink : This data type is meant to store a Universal Resource Locator
(URL) and e-mail addresses.
(c) Properties : Once the data type of a column is specified, Access allows the
designer to define the properties of each column. These properties are of
two types General and Look up.

558

Accountancy

(i) General : In the context of text data type the general properties are :
Field Size : This property, in case of text fields, refers to the maximum
number of characters allowed in the column. The same property, in
case of numbers, refers to the type of numbers being stored as per
requirements.
Format : It is meant to indicate as to how the fields contents are
displayed. There are standard types of formats to choose from.
Decimal places property : It applies to single, double or decimal types
of numbers.
Input mask : Formats for data entry that include placeholders and
punctuations are called input masks. It works only for text and date
type of fields. It is of particular importance when the accounting codes
being used in the system are formatted with hyphens.
Caption : It is a label used for the field in datasheet view and on the
Forms and reports. If the caption property is set to blank, the field
name becomes the default caption and is used to label the field.
Default Value : It is used for specifying a value for new entries of data
records. While entering the data item, the operator can always over
write the default value. The default value should be the most frequently
entered value in the field.
Validation Rule and Text : Validation means checking of data to eliminate
incorrect entries. Validation criteria can be specified for this property.
If the data so entered does not satisfy the validation criteria, the
validation text gets displayed.
Required and Indexed : The Required property must be provided a logical
value Yes or No. When a fields required property is set to Yes, a user
must enter data in the field before saving the record. A value of No
implies that the data entry in the field is optional. In other words, a
null value is also acceptable to the database. Indexing a field results
in speeding up sorting, searching and filtering of records on that field.
Primary key field is always indexed. For a single field primary key,
Access sets the Required property to Yes and the Indexed property to
Yes (No duplicates) because a primary key by definition must have
unique values without null entries.
Allow-Zero Length : This property is available only for text fields. Setting
it to Yes/No determines whether a text string with zero length is a
valid entry or not.
(ii) Look up : The look up feature is used by a field to find its values in another
table, query or from a fixed list of values. A list of valid values can be
displayed using a list box or combo box. Text box is the default display
control of look up. Look up is created in case of a field, which is foreign

Accounting System using DBMS

559

key (many side) into primary key (one side) between the tables that have
one-to-many relationship. Its other display controls are list control and
combo control. When list box or combo box is used as display control in
look up, it is important to specify the row source type (that is table, query
or list of values or field list). The list of values must be separated by comma.
Some additional properties in case of list box or combo box are meant to
specify the bound column whose values are copied to this field as references.
Number of columns to appear in the list box or combo box is determined
by column count property.
The above steps for defining a column need be repeated for every column
to be created for a particular table.
After defining all the columns of the table, the primary key column of
the table can be specified as any of the columns that are expected to
have unique data values. This can be achieved by right clicking at the
field to be specified as primary key followed by primary key item of
right clicked window. If more than one field constitutes a primary key,
select first field (of such composite primary key) by pressing and holding
Ctrl key and clicking other fields (of the composite primary key) one by
one in the same order in which they together constitute the primary
key. This must be followed by right click at selected fields to mark the
selected fields as primary key.
Save the table design by clicking at File item of menu bar followed by
click at Save option. Access responds by providing a generic default
name of table. The table name provided by Access may be accepted by
clicking at OK or changed by re-typing another name at the input
dialog box. This must be followed by clicking OK. The table stands
created and appears as listed to the right of table object.
Every other table, which constitutes part of the database design, may
also be created in the same manner as described above.
The foregoing discussion in this chapter is divided into four sections:
Creating tables and relationships for accounting databases; Vouchers and
forms; information using queries and generating accounting reports.
15.2 Creating Tables and Relationships for Accounting Database
The database designed in of this chapter is to be discussed in the context of
database components as detailed above. This is because the implementation
of each database design is conditioned by its particular table structure and
interrelationships. Such implementation modalities have been discussed in
detail for various types of transaction vouchers already described in the
preceding chapter.

560

Accountancy

15.2.1 Database Design for Simple Transaction Vouchers


According to the design shown in figure 14.24 (Model-1) of preceding chapter,
there are five data tables: Employees, Accounts, Vouchers, Support and
AccountType. For the purpose of implementation, each table is described below
in terms of their storage structure, i.e. column names, data types and properties:
(a) AccountType : This table has two columns: CatId and Category.
CatId : This column of the AccountType table is meant to specify the
identification value of the category of accounts. Since there are limited
number of accounts type and are being expressed as numeric only,
the data type of this field can be safely taken as Number/byte because
the storage space taken by the data type Number/byte is minimum.
This field has been designated as primary key because it has unique
values across a set of category records.
Category : This field is meant to store the string of characters to express
the category of account such as Expenses, Revenues, Assets and
Liabilities. Its data type should be Text with suggested field size set to
15 characters.
(b) Accounts : This table has three columns: Code, Name and Type.
Code : A unique account number or code identifies an account. This
column is meant to store this code. Its data type is chosen as Text
because it is not to be subjected to any calculations. Its field size is
required to have a length of six characters because every account is
designed to have six digits at leaf level. Because of uniqueness in values,
this field is a good primary key field. The Allow Zero Length property
must be set to No. Indexed property of this field must be set to Yes (No
duplicates) to imply that the database creates automatically an internal
index on this field for fast retrieval of data records and No duplicates
indicates that this index is based on unique values of code.
Name : In a system of accounting, every account has a name. This
column is meant to store the name of an account corresponding to the
account code by which it is identified. Its data type is declared as Text
because it is a string of characters not required for any calculations.
Its field size need be set to 30 characters, which is considered to be
long enough to accommodate the name of account.
Type : Every account must belong to one of the accounts type as stored
in AccountType table. This field is a foreign key to reference CatId field
of AccountType table. Its data type and other properties must be the
same as that of CatId field in AccountType table, except that its Index
property can be set to YES (Duplicates OK). This is because Type
value within accounts table cannot be unique as a number of accounts
might belong to a particular AccountType and store a common CatId

Accounting System using DBMS

561

as data value in Type field. The relationship between the CatId column
of AccountType table and type column of Accounts table must also be
defined so as to maintain referential integrity.
(c) Employees : This table stores the data pertaining to employees of the
organisation and is designed to have following columns :
EmpId : Each employee is identified by a unique data value called
EmpId, which in turn gets reflected in employee table as a column to
store for each employee record a unique identification value. The data
type of this column is text with field size equal to 4. Being a column to
store unique values and also because of its capability to identify an
employee record, it is designated as primary key field. Its Required
property is set to Yes and Zero length property is set to No with
Indexed property as Yes (No Duplicates).
Fname : This column refers to the first name of employee and its data
type is declared as Text because it is meant to store string of alphabets.
Its Field size is set to 10 on the assumption that first name of every
employee can be completely accommodated within this field size. The
Required property is set to Yes with Zero Length Property being No
to imply that every employee has a first name and no employee record
can be stored unless the first name is also stored.
Mname : Mname column is meant to store the middle name of an
employee. It data type is declared as text with field width equal to 10.
The Required Property can be set to No and Zero Length property to
Yes to imply that many employees may not have middle name.
Therefore, the storing of value in this field becomes optional.
Lname : Lname column has been included in the table structure to
store the Last name of an employee. The data type of this column is
Text with field size set to 10. The Required Property can be set to No
and Allow Zero Length property to Yes for the reason which applies
to Mname.
PhoneNo : This column is meant to store the Phone number of the
employee and its data type is set to Text with field size equal to 12.
The Required property is set to No with Allow Zero Length property
set to Yes to imply that null values are permitted for this field because
many employees may not have phone numbers.
SuperId : This column in the Employee table structure refers to EmpId
of the supervisor or immediate superior of the employee. Its data type
is set to Text with field width 4, the same as is for EmpId. Its Required
property is set to No with Allow Zero Length property being Yes to
imply that null values are also permitted. This is because the overall
boss of the organisation, although an employee, does not have any

562

Accountancy

boss and therefore a null value in this field is to be allowed to


accommodate the situation.
(d) Vouchers : This table has been designed to store the transaction data as
contained in a voucher. It has nine columns, the details of each are given
below :
Vno : This column is meant to store voucher number, which indicates
the distinct identity of a transaction. Its data type could be number if
numeric digits are assigned to each of the vouchers. However, its data
type is normally taken as text because it is amenable to any type of
numbering, coding or ordering scheme: numeric, alpha-numeric or
formatted reference. Its width may be set to 6 so that first 2 places to
the left refer to numeric month of the date and next 4 places to numeric
digits giving identity to each of the transactions that have occurred
during the month under reference. This column is designed to have
distinct values and therefore can be designated as primary key of the
table. Accordingly, its value cannot be null and therefore its Allow
Zero Length property must be set to No with Required property being
Yes. However, its data type needs be taken as number (with Integer),
when numeric function(s) such as Dmax() is applied to find maximum
values for auto-generating the vouchers.
Debit : This column is meant to store the code corresponding to an
account, which has been debited in recording a transaction. Since it
references the code column, which is the primary key of Accounts
table as described above, it is a foreign key column in Vouchers table.
The data type and properties of this column should be the same as
that of code column of Accounts table, except that its Indexed property
need be set to Yes Duplicates OK). The relationship between the code
column of accounts table and debit column of Vouchers table must
also be defined so as to maintain referential integrity.
Amount : This column is meant to store the amount of transaction and
is common to the accounts being debited and credited. Its data type
can be Number with field size set to double; format set to standard;
decimal places set to 2 and default value set to 0.00. Alternatively, its
data type can be chosen as currency type, in that case its format can
be either accepted as currency or set to standard with decimal places
set to 2.
Vdate : This column of the table stores the date of transaction. Its data
type is set to Date/Time with format set to Medium Date (dd-MMMyy); Default value set to = Now() to imply current date in Real Time
Clock (RTC) of computer system and caption property set to Date.

Accounting System using DBMS

563

Credit : This column is meant to store the code corresponding to the


account being credited in recording a transaction. Like Debit column,
this column too shares the same properties as code column of Accounts
table and must also be dealt with in the same manner as Debit column
described above.
Narration : This column is meant to store the narration. Its data type
can be set to text type with field size set to 100 characters; Required to
No; Allow Zero Length to Yes and Indexed to No. If the narrations are
very large beyond 255 characters, its data type can be set to Memo so
as to accommodate the narrations up to 65,536 characters, almost
equal to 64 pages.
PrepBy : This column is meant to store the identity of an employee who
has prepared the voucher. EmpId as defined and described in schema
of Employees table identifies the employee. The data type of this field
and other properties must be identical to that of EmpId, except that its
Indexed property must be set to No. This column as per design is
expected to refer to EmpId column of Employees table and therefore
must be defined as foreign key. Its relationship with EmpId column of
Employees table must also be specified to ensure referential integrity.
AuthBy : This column is meant to store the identity of the employee
who has authorised the vouchers. This column is similar to PrepBy
column. Therefore, its data type, properties and relationship with EmpId
are the same as those for PrepBy column.
Support : This table is created to store the details of support documents
annexed to a voucher. It is designed to have the following four columns:
vNo : This column is meant to store the voucher number to which
this document is annexed. Its data type should be the same as that
of Vno in Vouchers table because this column refers to Vno column
of Vouchers table to maintain referential integrity. Its value cannot
be null and therefore its Allow Zero Length property must be set
to No with Required Property being Yes. Since there may be more
than one support documents annexed to a voucher, the values
stored in this column cannot be unique and therefore this column
alone cannot be a primary key field.
sNo : This column has been included in the table structure to store
serial numbers 1,2,3 to correspond to the serial number of
documents being annexed. Duplicate values will occur in this field
also because the serial number of documents across the vouchers
shall be the same. However, both the columns: Svno and Sno
together provide a unique value because the documents, for every
voucher are serially numbered and therefore unique. Both the

564

Accountancy

columns together need be declared as Primary key of this table.


dName : This column refers to Document name. Its data type is
Text with field size equal to 30 to mean that within this character
limit the document name can be suitable accommodated.
sDate : This column refers to any date reference given in the support
document. Its data type is Date/Time. Its format can be declared
as Medium Date with Required and Indexed property set to No.

15.2.2 Modified Design for Implementing Compound Vouchers


There are two tables: VouchersMain and VouchersDetails
(a) VouchersMain : This table has been created to store one record for every
transaction. The rows of this table refer to those data items of the vouchers,
which lie outside the voucher grid. It consists of Vno, AccCode, vdate,
PrepBy, AuthBy and Type.
AccCode : This column is meant to store the complementing account
code, which in the context of debit voucher is credit account and in the
context of credit voucher is a debit account. In debit voucher, the debit
accounts are displayed in Debit Accounts Grid and therefore the
complementing account is the account to be credited. Similarly, in
Credit Voucher, the Credit Accounts Grid displays only the accounts,
which are being credited in recording a transaction. Therefore, the
complementing debit account need be stored in this column. This
column is also the foreign key column because it references the primary
key column of Accounts table. Its data type and properties must be
the same as that of Code column of Accounts table, except that its
Indexed property must be set to Yes (Duplicates OK) and the domain
of its data values is confined to the code values stored in Accounts
table.
Type : This column has been created to store a value 0 (for debit voucher)
or 1 (for credit voucher). Its data type therefore is set to Number with
field size set to byte. This column is very important and therefore its
values must be carefully stored and interpreted in preparing accounting
reports. Improper handling of this column may cause the Errors of
Principle in accounting. The data types and properties of Vno,Vdate,
AuthBy and PrepBy continues to be same as have been defined and
discussed in Vouchers table of Simple Vouchers Design. However, Vno
column has acquired an added importance because of being referenced
by Vno column of VouchersDetail table.
(b) VouchersDetail : This table is meant to store those data items of the voucher,
which appear in the grid of debit or credit vouchers. However, the Total

Accounting System using DBMS

565

amount of voucher is not stored because it is derived data. It consists


of Vno, Sno, Code, Amount and Narration as its columns.
Vno : This column is meant to store voucher number of Debit/
Credit record of VouchersMain table to which the Credit/Debit
entries of vouchersDetails table are related. Its data type should
be the same as that of Vno in VouchersMain table because this
column refers to Vno column of vouchersMain table to maintain
referential integrity. Its value cannot be null and therefore its
Allow Zero Length property must be set to No with Required
property being Yes. Since there can be more than one debit/credit
Entry against each of the credit/debit entry of VoucherMain table,
the values stored in this column cannot be unique and therefore
this column alone cannot be a primary key field.
Sno : This column has been included in the table structure to
store serial numbers 1,2,3 to correspond to the serial number of
debit/credit entries being referred to in the grid of an accounting
Voucher: Debit or Credit. Duplicate values will occur in this field
also because the serial numbers of entries across the vouchers
are bound to be the same. However, both the columns: vno and
Sno together provide a unique value because for every voucher
the entries are serially numbered and therefore unique. Both the
columns together need be declared as primary key of this table.
Code : This column is meant to store the account codes, which in
the context of debit voucher are debit accounts and in the context
of credit voucher are credit accounts. This column is also the
foreign key column because it references the primary key column
of Accounts table. Its data type and properties must be the same
as that of Code column of Accounts table, except that its Indexed
property must be set to Yes (Duplicates OK). The domain of its
data values gets confined to the Code values stored in Accounts
table. The data type and properties of amount and narration
column continue to be the same as already described and
discussed for Vouchers table.
15.3 Vouchers Using Forms
The scope of this section includes the basics of Access for creating a
Form in Access; transforming the voucher designs in terms of Access
objects and properties; and also the procedure for creating Forms for
vouchers.

566

Accountancy

15.3.1 Access Basics for Creating Forms


A Form in Access may be designed, developed and used for the following
purposes :
Data Entry: Form is used for entering, editing and displaying data.
Application flow : Form is used for navigating through an application.
Custom Dialog Box : It can be used for providing messages to the user or
getting parameters from the user for executing a parameter-based query.
Printing information: It can be used for providing hard copies of data entry
information.
This is contrary to the belief that Forms in Access can be used only for
data entry. The most common use of a Form in Access is to display and edit
existing data and also for adding new data records.
15.3.2 Tool Box and Form Controls
A tool box is a collection of visual objects (or controls) that are placed (or
embedded) on the Form to provide some meaning or functionality. The Form
is designed by placing several such controls, which have their own functionality
and properties.
15.3.3 Properties of Controls
Every form control is a complete object with its independent set of properties,
which determine the shape, size, behaviour and functionality of the object.
The properties of these objects are divided into three categories: Format, Data
and Others. All these properties may not apply to all the controls. Some
important properties of these objects are as described below :
(a) Format Properties : Some of the important properties are as described as
under:
Format : It determines the manner in which the data in the control is
displayed. This property is inherited from its underlying data source.
It is set and used in three situations : one when the property is not set
for the underlying field; second when the format setting of the underlying
field is to be overridden; third when a control, which is not bound to
any underlying data field, is to be displayed in a particular manner.
Decimal Places : This property specifies the number of decimal places
up to which the control should display a numeric data. It must be
used in conjunction with format property to determine the final
appearance of numeric data.
Caption : The caption property applies to label, command button and
toggle buttons. This property is used to specify what printed matter
will appear on the face of the control. In the context of label control,
the printed matter is made to appear using this caption property.

Accounting System using DBMS

567

Visible : This property specifies whether the control embedded on the


Form should be visible or hidden when the Form is opened. The property
can make a control appear conditionally when required.
Layout Properties (Left, Top, Width, Height) : These properties are used
to set the position and size of the control.
Back Colour and Style: The back colour property specifies background
colour, as opposed to text colour, for the control. This property, when
set to transparent, shows the forms background colour through the
control. The setting is preferred for an Option group.
Special effects: This property provides the three dimensional effect to a
control in its appearance. The options for this property are: Flat, Raised,
Sunken, Etched, Shadowed and Chiseled. Each of these effects give a
different look to the control.
Border Properties(style, colour, and effect): The Border properties are
capable of affecting the style, colour and thickness of the Border of a
control. The Border style options are Transparent, Solid, Dashes, Dots,
etc. The Border colour property specifies the colour of the Border and
it is possible to select from a variety of colours. The Border width
property can be set to one of several point sizes. When the Border style
of a control is set to transparent, its colour and width properties are
ignored.
Fore Colour: This property can be used for assigning a colour of choice
to the text being formatted.
Font Properties (Name, Size, Weight, Italics, Underline): These properties
are meant to control the appearance of text within a control. These are
capable of affecting font, its point size, thickness and also whether the
text is italicised or underlined.
Text Align : The text-align property affects the manner in which data is
aligned within the control. The available options are: General, Left,
Centre, Right and Distribute.
Margins (Top, Left, Right and Bottom) : These properties determine how
far the text appears from top, left, right and bottom of a control. The
margin properties are of particular importance while using Text box
for memo field.
Line Spacing: It is used to determine the spacing between the lines of a
text with multiple lines. This is useful when a text control is used for
displaying and storing data pertaining to Memo fields.
Display When: This property is capable of deciding whether to send the
data of a control to a Printer or to a Screen. For example, the labels
containing instructions can be displayed on the screen but not on the
printer.

568

Accountancy

Scroll Bars: This property is capable of determining whether scroll bars


appear when the data in the control does not fit within its size or not.
The options are none or vertical. This property is normally set to vertical
for text control to interact with data pertaining to Memo field.
(b) Data Properties
Control Source : This property specifies the field from a record source
that is associated with particular control. By default, it is the record
source that underlies the Form being designed.
Input Mask : The input mask property affects the format used for data
entry into the control as opposed to its appearance, which is affected
by Format and Decimal places property. The input mask of the field
underlying the control is automatically inherited by the control.
However, the input mask property of control in the Form is used to
further restrict what data is entered into the field.
Default Value : This property determines the value assigned to the field
while adding a new data record. It is inherited from the underlying
field of record source to which the control is bound. The default value,
when set for control, has an overriding effect over the default value set
at the underlying field level.
Validation (Rule and Text) : The function performed by Validation Rule
and Validation Text for controls is the same as it applies to Fields of
database tables, except that the validation is performed at Form level
in case of control and database level in case of fields. In case of bound
controls, the user cannot enter data into the control, if the validation
rules for control and the underlying field are in conflict.
Enabled and Locked : This property is meant to determine whether
focus is allowed on the control or not. If it is set to No, the control
appears dimmed and mouse action cannot be performed on such
control. This property is useful for calculated controls meant only for
display of data. Locked property determines whether the data in the
control can be modified or not. This property, when set to Yes, deprives
a user the facility to edit data, though the focus becomes available.
The two properties interact with one another resulting in following
behaviour of control :
Locked
Yes
No
Yes
No

Enabled
Yes
Yes
No
No

Effect : The control can


get focus ; its data can be copied but not modified
get focus and its data can be modified
not get focus
not get focus; its data is displayed dimmed

Accounting System using DBMS

569

(c) Other Properties


Name : This property allows the designer to provide a customised name
to a control. The names assigned by the designer should be purpose
oriented so that the design structure of the Form becomes selfdocumenting.
Status Bar Text : This control specifies the text message that is displayed
in the status bar when the control acquires the focus.
Enter Key Behaviour : This property is meant to determine whether the
use of Enter key adds a new line in the current control or results in
moving the cursor to next control. Its setting is useful for Text control
bound to Memo field.
Allow AutoCorrect : This property, when set to Yes, enables the auto
correction feature to correct automatically common spelling errors and
types. It is useful while using Text control for Memo field.
Vertical: This property is meant to determine whether the text in a
control appears horizontally or vertically. The default setting is No to
mean the horizontal. When set to Yes, the text within the control is
rotated at 90 degrees.
Default : This property applies to command button and specifies whether
the control is a default control on the form or not.
Tab Stop : This property indicates whether the Tab key can be used to
enter a control or not. It is desirable to set this property to No for those
controls whose values are rarely changed.
Tab Index : This property is used to set the tab order for the control.
This property helps in setting the tab order manually as opposed to
automatic setting at Form level.
Short cut Menu : This control is capable of attaching a specific menu to
a control and a bar/window gets displayed when the user right-clicks
at the control.
Control Tip Text : This property is meant to enter text that acts as a
tool tip for the control. The tool tip appears automatically when the
mouse pointer is placed over the control and left there for a moment.
Help Context ID : This property indicates the Help topic attached to a
particular control.
15.3.4 Common Controls in MS Access
Access provides for a number of controls and more can be added using the
add-in-manager in Tools of menu bar. There are three types of controls: Bound,
unbound and calculated. Bound controls are used to display and modify data
stored in a data table of database. These controls automatically appear in the
Form specified in its display control property and inherit many of the properties

570

Accountancy

assigned to the field to which such controls are bound. Unbound controls
display information to the user or get data from user that is not going to be
stored in the database. A Calculated control is a special type of control,
which displays the derived results of an expression or query. The expression
may consist of ready-to-use functions that are meant to make computations
by using input values. Some commonly used functions have been discussed
and described in Appendix given at the end of the chapter. Therefore, the data
in calculated control cannot be modified because it is derived data or
information. The value of these controls changes automatically as and when
the data, to which the expression of the control is bound, changes. Some of
the common controls important for designing a Form are discussed below :
(a) Label : This control is used to write dark prints on the Form such as
Transaction Voucher, Voucher No, S.No, Debit, Credit, Amount, Narration,
Authorised By, Prepared By on the left hand side and Choose the Account
to Debited and Choose the account to be Credited on the right hand
side of Access voucher Form design of which is shown in Fig 15.4. The
attached labels are automatically appended to the Form when other
controls such as Text boxes, List boxes, Combo boxes, etc. are added
because every such added control has to be labeled to inform the user as
to what data to enter or edit through the control. The default caption of
the label is the caption of the field that underlies the control to which it is
bound. If the caption property of the field is kept blank, the label caption
uses field name as its caption.
(b) Text Box : This control is included in a Form to provide a blank area for
entering the data with or without default values. Blank space next to
Amount label, for example, is a text box control to receive the value of
amount of voucher. Text box, when bound to a particular field of the table,
retrieves and displays the data stored in field for a particular row and is
capable of modifying and adding data to the table. The unbound text box
is used to get the data from the user for its subsequent use in report for
providing report criteria.
(c) List Box : This control is used for allowing a user to make a limited choice
from a given set of values. The domain of its values is predefined and
therefore limited. List control may be used next to Debit and Credit labels
in a simple transaction voucher, so as to locate the accounts to be debited
or credited.
(d) Combo Box : This control combines the features of a list box and text box
by allowing a user to select an item from a list or enter a value using the
keyboard.
(e) Sub-form : Many Forms are based on more than one table with One-toMany relationship. The records of such tables can be displayed by creating

Accounting System using DBMS

571

form within a form, with tabular presentation of records. The Form within
a Form (also referred to as Main Form) is called SubForm. The Main Form
and SubForm have parent-child relationship. The Control used for creating
such a child Form is called SubForm/SubReport. Data records appearing
in a grid can be stored in database by using SubForm Control. The SubForm
whenever created is listed as an independent object like main form in
Database Window. However, the SubForm Control in main Form has three
properties for creating a link :
Source Object : It contains name of the Form that is being displayed in
SubForm control.
Link Child Fields : These are the fields from the Child form that link the
this form to the Main form. These are also referred to as Foreign key of
related table.
Link Master Fields : These are the fields from the Main Form that link
the Child form to the Main Form. These are also referred to as Primary
key of primary table. Make sure the Control Wizards tool is selected
before adding the SubForm/SubReport control to the Main form.
(f) Option Groups : Control, when applied to Option button, allows the designer
to select a particular option from out of a set of mutually exclusive options.
This option is useful in designing a common Voucher Form for Debit and
Credit Voucher for compound transactions.
(g) Command Button : It is meant to execute a defined action on the Form.
Access provides for six categories of command buttons as described below:
Record Navigation : The record navigation set of command buttons are
meant to facilitate pointer movement on data records. At a point of
time, only one row of a table, called data record, is accessed. To access
other rows, there has to be a pointer for causing record movement.
Record Operation : There are several operations on data records. These
are meant to facilitate such operations as add new record, delete record,
undo record, save record, duplicate and print record.
Form Operation : These operations are meant to be performed on the
entire form as an object. These are Open form, Close form, Print form,
Refresh form data and so on.
Report Operation : These operations are related to the report object.
Once a report is created, further actions, which can be taken on such
report are Mail report, Preview report, Print report and Send report to
file. Access provides separate command buttons for each of these
actions.
Application : There are five command buttons especially designed for
possible operations pertaining to other application programs. Run
application is meant to execute any existing program ; and Quit

572

Accountancy

application is used to stop the execution of a running application; Run


MS Excel command button is used for calling the MS Excel, spread
sheet program which is part of MS Office package. Similarly, a command
button to run MS Word results in calling the text processing program
of MS Office package; Run Note Pad command button when executed
calls the text writing program provided by the Operating SystemWindows.
Miscellaneous : This category include four command buttons: Auto
dialer; Run query, Run macro, Print table. Auto dialer button in a form
when clicked is capable of dialing a telephone number, provided a
modem is attached and configured in the computer system. Run query
command button is meant to execute an existing query. Run macro
command button is used to execute a specified Macro and Print table
command button, when clicked is capable of printing contents of a
specified data table from among available tables in database.
In the example of Access Voucher Form shown in Fig 15.4, four command
buttons have been embedded. First button when clicked adds a Record while
a click action on the second button results in undoing the record. The third
command button is meant to delete a record and the fourth button when
clicked saves the record to back-end database tables while in this case it is
Vouchers table as already described.
(h) Control Wizard : If the selected controls (such as List box, combo box or
SubForm) when added to the Form do not invoke the automated wizard,
the control wizard need be selected by click action before selecting the
control which is to be embedded on the Form for design purposes.
15.3.5 Creation of Form
Access provides for creation of a Form either by Design or Wizard. This can be
achieved by double clicking at the database file. Immediately the Database
Window appears, which is vertically divided into two parts: left and right. The
left side displays a list of database objects such as Tables, Queries, Forms,
Reports, Pages, Macros and Modules. The right hand side of Database Window
shows the various objects created under each of the classes of objects. At the
top of Database Window and just below the title bar, there is a menu bar,
which consists of three named menu items: Open, Design and New, and five
Icons: one to delete an object, second and third to toggle between Large and
Small (default) Icons and fourth and fifth to toggle between list (default) and
details.
Select Forms Object : This can achieved by a click at Forms listed as objectclass. By default, two items appear on the right side of window: Create Form
in design view and Create Form by using wizard.

Accounting System using DBMS

573

Fig. 15.2 : Database window showing the methods to create forms

(a) Create Form by using wizard : The following procedure is followed for using
the wizard to create a data entry Form :
Double click at Create Form by using wizard. Immediately there is a
window titled, Form Wizard which allows the designer to choose the
data table along with the related available fields to choose from. The
designer should choose only those fields, which pertain to the data
content of Form being designed. But it must be ensured that every
essential field (defined as one with Required property set to Yes and
Allow Zero Length property set to No) must be included. In case of
voucher, choose all the fields by clicking at >> button.
Click at Next command button. Form wizard responds by providing
six mutually exclusive choices with respect to layout of the Form. One
of these choices is exercised by clicking at an option button from a
group of six such buttons.

574

Accountancy

Click at Next command button after exercising layout choice. The Form
wizard responds by prompting the user to select from a list control one
out of the ten options to specify the style of presentation of this Form.
Click at Next to move forward. Access responds by asking for the Title
of the Form. The designer can provide a useful title, which explains the
purpose for which the Form is being created. Further, the designer
may specify whether the Form is to be opened for entering data or for
modifying the design.
Finally click at Finish command button to get the initial design of the
Form in run mode, if the option for entering data is exercised. If the
option for modify design is exercised, the design of the Form is available
along with tool box with various controls to facilitate modification of
design.
Modifying Form Design : The Forms created with wizard have limited visual
appeal. However, Forms have a design view, just as table do, and Access
includes many tools for modifying a Forms design. Some of the common
modifications to the Form are listed below :
Changing Properties of controls
Re-sizing and moving controls
Aligning and spacing controls
Converting (or Morphing) controls
Conditional formatting of controls
Re-arranging Tab Order
Adding New controls
Deleting existing controls
Each of these modifications has been briefly discussed after describing
the procedure for creating a Form by Design view.
(b) Create Form by Design view : Under this method, a data entry Form is
created either as a data bound object or as an unbound object. A double
click at Create Form in Design View provides a New Form dialog but the
Form created in this manner is not bound to any back end database.
However, a click at New to open New Form dialog results in creating the
Form, which is bound to database. The use of drop down list in the new
Form dialog box to select a table or query serves as the foundation of the
Form being created. Fields can be easily added to a Form by using the
Field List window, which contains all the fields that are part of the Forms
record source. The record source for the Form is the table or query that
underlies the Form. Make sure that the Field List window is visible. If it is
not, click at the Field List button on the tool bar. Pick up from the field list
every field, which is to be displayed in the Form for entering the data. It is
important to ensure that every essential field must appear in the Form, if

Accounting System using DBMS

575

the Form is being designed to enter records rather than displaying just
part of record contents. Select and drag the field from the field list to a
place on the Form where it is desired to appear. The location selected
becomes the upper left corner of the text box, and the attached label appears
to the left of where the text control is dropped. Further, the following steps
are taken to develop a data entry Form :
(i) Click at New to open the New Form dialog. Two list controls appear
in the dialog box : one provides for various options to create a Form
such as Design view, Form Wizard, Auto Form; etc. and another to
choose the table or query where objects data comes from (also
called record source). From First List control choose Design
view(default) by a click.
(ii) Choose a table as the record source because the entire data is stored
in the table record by record. Click OK after the table is selected.
(iii) Access responds by providing three windows : one for new blank
Form, second for tool box and third for Field list corresponding to
the selected record source. The Form object henceforth shall act as
a container for other controls to be used in designing Form.
(iv) Select and drag a field from the Field list and place it in the blank
Form by drag and drop method. Repeat this process for every field
in succession. Alternatively, all the fields can be selected by clicking
at every field in the field list while Ctrl Key is kept pressed. The
selected fields can be dragged and dropped at the Voucher Form.
(v) Adding a Title : The Form must be suitably titled for its identity,
which should be self-descriptive. To add a title, use tool box by
clicking at the label control. While the pointer is moved back into
the design area, it changes to a large letter A with crosshairs.
Move the pointer into the header area and click where the label is
desired to be placed and then type the text of title. Once the text is
entered, the focus from the label control can be freed by clicking
anywhere in the Form. The label can be reselected by a click, followed
by using the formatting tool bar to format the title. Alternatively
and in addition to the above, more formatting options can be
exercised by right clicking at the label control and clicking at
Properties item of drop down window of right click action.
(vi) Changing the Properties of Forms and Controls : Every Access object:
Form or Controls is described by its properties. These properties,
as already stated above, have been classified into three broad
categories: Format, Data and Others. It is not essential to know
every available property to work well in designing Forms in Access.
But it is always good idea to check up the property values if the
object is not behaving the way it is expected to. To view the properties

576

Accountancy

(vii)

(viii)

for an object or control, right click at the control and select the
properties. Access responds by providing all the properties listed
under category tabs. The property sheet title bar includes names of
objects contained in the Form. Once property sheet is opened for
one object, it is easy to call for the properties of other objects by
selecting the name of object from property sheet title bar. The values
of such properties are changed as desired. The Forms property
sheet can be opened by double-click at Form selector, which is
located at the left most intersection of vertical and horizontal rulers.
The property setting on multiple controls can be changed at the
same time by selecting multiple objects, in which case only those
properties become available for editing which are common to the
selected objects. The multiple objects can be selected by keeping
the Shift Key pressed, followed by clicking at desired objects.
Moving and Resising controls : In order to move a control, first select
it by a click action, then move the pointer to the edge of the selected
control, ensuring that any of the re-sizing handles appearing as
bold dot is not pointed at directly. The pointer turns its shape to a
small hand. At this stage, hold mouse button pressed and drag the
control to its new location. Movement of control beyond the bottom
or right edge of the Form, leads to increasing the Form area
automatically. Access also allows for combining of select and move
step thereby making it easier and more efficient to reposition the
control. A control can be re-sized by dragging the re-sizing handles
at the corners and sides of the object. A change in the size of text
control, however, does not result in changing the size of its
underlying field because the size of the field is specified in tables
design and can be changed only by modifying the properties of the
field in table design.
Aligning and Spacing Controls : Select two or more controls (click at
control to be selected by holding the Shift Key pressed) to be aligned
and choose Format-align or right click and choose Align from the
shortcut menu to open the list of alignment options. Align-Left leads
to aligning the left edges of all the selected controls; Align-Right aligns
the right edges of the control. To adjust controls on the same
horizontal line, Align-Top or Bottom options can be used. Spacing of
controls allows to change (increase or decrease) the relative position
of selected controls by one grid point horizontally or vertically. The
spacing becomes important when the controls are to be spread out
or move closer together for a neater visual layout. Spacing can also
be used for ensuring that the controls are evenly spaced.

Accounting System using DBMS

(ix)

(x)

(xi)

577

Converting (or Morphing) Controls : Initially, when a Form is built, it


is not always possible to choose the best type of controls to display
each field on the Form. One might make a choice for the control
only to find out later that it does not suit to the requirements. This
is particularly important when the initial design of a Form is created
using Form wizard. Access provides for conversion (or morphing) of
such control into the desired ones. One of the most common types
of morphing is from text to List box or combo box. This is achieved
by right click on the text box, followed by choosing Change To and
selecting the type of control to into which text box is to be morphed.
Every control cannot be morphed into every other type of control.
Text box, for instance, can be converted into a label, list box or
combo box. After morphing, a text box to list box, for instance, it is
important to modify the control properties such as row source,
bound column, column count and column width so that the changed
control behaves in a desired manner.
Conditional formatting of text boxes : The conditional formatting is
displayed in a text control when the value of text control meets a
specified criteria or a set of specified criterion. For example, the
colour of Amount entered should turn Red when it exceeds a
certain limit say Rs. 20,000. In order to create conditional format,
right click at text box to be conditionally formatted when in design
mode, followed by conditional formatting item of right click window.
Access responds by providing conditional formatting window which
appears as follows : Conditional formatting window, as shown above,
is divided into two parts: the default setting and condition-1. Since
the formatting is to occur on the basis of a field value, the criteria
list control can be used to select greater than and Rs. 20,000 is
entered in the right most box of condtion-1. There are five icons:
bold, Italics, underline, Back colour and Fore colour for formatting
the data value. As and when the condition is satisfied, the formatting
based on the selected icons applies to the data value. If there are
multiple conditions for formatting, Add button can be clicked to call
for additional formatting conditions. At the most three conditions
can be set up for conditional formatting. Click OK to apply the
conditions and click Delete to remove the conditional format.
Re-arranging the Tab Order : The tab order of the Form (defined as
a sequence of controls to move through when pressing a tab) is
assigned while creating a Form. The tab order goes out of sequence
when the controls in the Form are re-arranged. An inconsistent
tab order leads to an erroneous data entry. To change the tab order,
choose View-Tab order or right click and choose tab order to open

578

Accountancy

Tab Order dialog box. Clicking Auto Order generally rearranges


the fields in the correct order. It is preferable to try this option first.
If the auto order is not correct, the tab order can be set manually
by clicking the row selector for a control and then dragging the
control up or down into position in the Tab Order.

Fig. 15.3 : Conditional formatting window

15.3.6 Procedure for Creating Voucher Forms


On the basis of above discussion, the following procedure can be followed to
create the different types of vouchers :
(a) Simple Transaction Voucher : The transaction data of simple accounting
vouchers is required to be stored in the Vouchers table of a database by
using a data entry Form in Access. The format of such a form is shown in
figure 15.4.

Accounting System using DBMS

579

Fig. 15.4 : Transaction voucher, using database design (model-I)

The above voucher form uses database design (Model-I) at the backend. A
perusal of the this voucher Form reveals that there are two parts: Left and
Right separated by a dark vertical line. Left part is dedicated to the data
entry of transaction data while the right part has two list controls: one
each giving the accounts to be debited and credited. The pre-printed
contents of simple transaction voucher appear to the left of above Form as
bold dark words. The access resource required to display such pre-printed
matter is label control. The data entry spaces against Voucher Number,
Dated, Amount and Narration are Text Controls. The list controls have
been deployed against Debit Account, Credit Account, Prepared By and
Authorised By. The Title of the Voucher Form has been written by using
the Label Control. Four operation buttons called Command Buttons control
the data entry into the voucher Form. On the Right hand side of above
voucher Form, the list controls have been used in expanded Form to choose
debit and credit accounts. The resources used in creation of above voucher

580

Accountancy

Form, therefore, consist of Labels, Texts, List controls and Command


Buttons. Once a blank Form is picked up like a container, it is capable of
containing these controls including command buttons. The following steps
are required for creating the Simple Transaction Voucher as per the Access
design given above.
(i) Once the Database Window is opened and Forms object is selected,
click at New item of menu bar. Access responds by displaying a
New Form window in which design view option among others
appears by default along with a list control to select a table or
query which is to act as underlying data source for the voucher
being designed. In designing Simple voucher Form, it is fairly clear
that the data entered using this voucher Form is to be stored only
in the Vouchers table.
(ii) Choose Vouchers table, which has been designed to include the
transaction data in each row as a stand-alone record and click OK.
(iii) Access responds by displaying a blank Form object in Form window,
along with two other windows: Tool box and Field List of Vouchers
table. Expand this Form towards the right and divide it into two parts
left and right using line controls of tool box say in the ratio of 3:1.
(iv) Keep the Ctrl Key pressed and click at every field in Field List
Vouchers window. The colour of the list of fields turns blue.
(v) Press at the selected fields area and drag all the fields to left side of
blank Form on which data entry contents of voucher are to be
located. It may be noted that every data entry control has been
assigned to its left an attached label control whose caption is the
caption of the fields in Vouchers table.
(vi) Re-position all the controls to their desired location in the left part
of the Form and set the font weight property of each to bold. The
caption property of each label can be modified to match the preprinted layout of the voucher.
(vii) Click at label control in tool box and add it to the centre top of lefthand side of the Form to add the title: Transaction Voucher. Its
font size property need be set to 16 with font weight set to bold. Set
the fore colour to Blue.
(viii) Paste another text box anywhere in the Form and set its Control
Source property as =Val(DMax(Vno,Voucher))+1 and Visible
property to No. Further, Set Default value property of Text Box to
the left of label Voucher No. as =Val(DMax(Vno,Voucher))+1.
This ensures that the text control generates a new value one more
than the preceding value of last voucher number entered in Vouchers
table, as and when a new record is added. As a result, the voucher

Accounting System using DBMS

(ix)

(x)

(xi)

(xii)

581

number is detected in Vouchers table and incremented by one to


auto generate the voucher number sequentially. Further, set the
Enabled property to No so that the auto generated value is not
amenable to any changes by the user.
Set Default value of Text box meant for entering the voucher date
as = Now(). This results in giving current RTC date as the default
date to voucher as and when a new voucher record is added.
Alternatively, click at More Control button in tool box to select
Microsoft Data and Time Picker Control, Version 6. This control
provides a user-friendly and interactive method of selecting a date.
Set the format property of this control to 3-dpt custom and
custom-Format property to dd-MMM-yy by using DT Picker
properties dialog. Control source of this control is set to vdate so
that the selected date is stored directly into this field.
Set the format property of Text box meant for Amount to Standard
with decimal places to 2. This ensures the appearance of amount up
to two decimal places with standard punctuation of numeric values.
Provide for conditional formatting of amount so that its colour
turns red as and when an expense voucher exceeding Rs. 20,000 is
not authorised by an employee whose EmpId =A001. This can be
achieved by a right click at text box for amount to click at conditional
formatting. A conditional formatting dialog appears in which
condition-1 is to be given as Field value greater than Rs. 20,000
interactively. Click Add button to provide condition-2 as Expression
is [AuthBy]<>A001 and [Debit] like 71*. Click colour icon to
select red colour in condition-2. Click OK to close the conditional
formatting dialog.
Control morphing from Text box to List box is to be applied on
four-text control, each one meant to store Debit, Credit, AuthBy
and PrepBy. This can be achieved by right click at each of these
controls one by one and click at Change To item of right click
window. To begin with, select List Box option for text box next to
Label Debit. Height of text box is expanded. Re-size, it to its original
shape and right click to select the property window. Select Data
properties button to provide the Row Source as Account table. Click
at format properties button to set the column count property to 2
and column width property to 0.5". Ensure that the width property
of list control for debit is set to a minimum of 1.75 to accommodate
the code as well as Name of Account in a row of list control. The
process can be repeated for Text boxes next to Credit. Text controls
meant for AuthBy and PrepBy can also be morphed into List Box

582

Accountancy

(xiii)

controls in a similar way, except that the Row Source Property


should be Set to Employees table and Column width be set to .33
only because Empl_Id occupies only four text spaces as opposed to
Account code, which need six spaces. Width property of these list
controls can be suitably adjusted to accommodate both EmpId and
Fname of employees authorising or preparing a voucher.
Paste List Controls for selecting debit and credit Accounts on the
Right Hand Side (RHS) of Voucher Form. Following steps are taken
to accomplish this :
Click at list box control available in tool box and carry the
mouse pointer to the right side of the Form. Its shape will turn
into a cross with icon of list control. Place it at the top of right
part of the Form. Access responds by invoking List Box Wizard,
which provides for three options to choose the look up values.
By default, the wizard provides for choosing look up values from
table or query.
Click at Next button to get the classified list of tables and queries
to choose from. At this stage, choose the Accounts table because
domain of accounts to be debited or credited remains confined
to accounts available in Accounts table only.
Click at Next button to get the available fields of Accounts table:
Code, Name and Type. Select Code and Name by clicking at >
button.
Click at Next to get a list of accounts with key column hidden.
Uncheck the already checked box to display the key column
also in list control.
Click at Next to get an option to select code to store in database.
Clicking at Next provides two options: One to remember the value
for later use and second to store that value in this field. Choose
second option and select the debit field to the right of this option
as the column against which the key value of accounts from list
control is to be stored.
Repeat the above process to provide for a list control for Account
to be Credited.
Once both the List box controls for debit and credit entries have
been pasted, change the caption property of labels attached to
such List boxes and write the text Choose the Account to be
Debited for first list box and Choose the Account to be Credited
for second. Set the Font weight property to bold, the fore colour
to red and green respectively to distinguish between debit and
credit list control and re-size the label control by increasing its
width to accommodate the text to caption of label. Re-size the

Accounting System using DBMS

583

list boxes to adjust their width and height appropriately. This


can be achieved by right clicking at each of the controls to get
the property windows.
(xiv) Click at Command button in Tool Box and carry the mouse pointer to
Area at the bottom of Left most bottom corner of the Voucher Form. Its
shape turns into a cross with command button icon. Paste it by horizontal
and vertical dragging to give suitable width and height. Immediately, the
Command Button wizard is invoked to seek information about category
of operation and the action to be performed using this command button.
Choose Record operation as category with Add New Record as the action.
Click at Next to state whether the caption of the command button is to
be a text value or an icon. A click at next after appropriate selection
results in giving a suitable object name to the command button. Accept
the default value and click at finish. This results in pasting an operational
button on the Form with the capability to add a new record.
(xv) Repeat this action to create various other command buttons to
match the design of Transaction Voucher Form given above.
(b) Compound Transaction Voucher : The transaction data of Debit or Credit
vouchers, which have already been described as compound transaction
vouchers, is required to be stored in VouchersMain and VouchersDetails
tables of database. Its design, when transformed in Access Form layout,
is expected to appear in the following format :
A perusal of the above Access Form for Credit Voucher reveals that
there are four labels: Voucher No, Date, Prepared By and Authorised By in
Dark bold letters. These labels are meant to define the pre-printed content
of the voucher as per design. Next to first two labels: Voucher No. and
Date are text boxes displaying their respective data contents. To the right
of labels Authorised By and Prepared By are List Box controls to get and
display the first name of employees. Text Box displays the Title of the
Voucher Form Credit Voucher as calculated control because the same
voucher design is used for Debit vouchers also. Just below this dynamic
title is the Option group control whereby the user can make a mutually
exclusive choice for Debit or Credit Voucher. The title of Entries Grid and
Text box to the left of a list control are used to select an account to be
debited or credited (the complementing account) against the accounts being
mentioned in the Entries Grid are also calculated text controls. The
calculated text controls acquire the text value to display on the basis of
what is selected in the Option groups. Next to calculated text box control
is a label to print an instruction for refreshing the display in grid. The grid
consists of five columns: S.No, Code, Name of Account, Amount and
Narration. The grid appears in the voucher by using SubForm control.
Besides this, there are five command buttons, each dedicated to Add

584

Accountancy

Record, Undo Record, Delete Record, Save Record and Close. These
command buttons operate on the data entry Form.

Fig. 15.5 : Credit voucher created as a form in access

To create this voucher Form, following steps are taken using design view :
(i) Create a blank form in design view and ensure that its underlying
data source is selected as VouchersMain table and Field List window
along with tool box is also displayed. As already discussed in Section
I of this chapter, the Compound Voucher Form requires another related
data table, VouchersDetail, for storing the data contents of grid.
(ii) Keep the Ctrl key pressed and click at Vno,Vdate, AuthBy and
PrepBy fields in Field List window.
(iii) Press at any of the selected fields area, drag and drop it to blank
Form. It can be observed that all the selected fields are also dragged
and dropped along with this field.
(iv) Re-position all the controls to their desired location in the Form and
set the font weight property of each to bold. The caption property of
each label can be modified to match the pre-printed layout of the voucher.

Accounting System using DBMS

(v)

(vi)
(vii)

(viii)

(ix)

(x)

(xi)

585

Paste Option group control just below the form space meant for dynamic
title. Access responds by prompting the user to enter the label names
for each option. Enter two options by writing Debit and Credit in different
rows. This must be followed by a click at Next button.
Option group wizard responds by prompting the designer to enter
the default option.
Select Debit so that by default, the compound voucher is a Debit
Voucher. Click at Next button. Access responds by prompting the
designer to enter the data values corresponding to each of the option
labels. Enter against Debit and Credit 0 and 1 respectively. Click
Next button.
Access Responds by requiring the user to either opt for Save the
value for Later Use or Save the value in this Field. Choose the
second option for Save the value and select Vno as Type field.
Click at Next button.
Access responds by asking the designer to choose the appropriate
control type. Choose Option buttons, along with any of the styles
given below in wizard dialog. Click Finish button. Access assigns a
default label to the Option group. Select the label by right clicks
and remove it by clicking at Cut.
Click at text control in tool box and add it to the centre top of the
Form to provide a dynamic text for the title: Debit or Credit Voucher.
The attached label control is removed by a right click on this label
followed by a click on Cut. The font size property of Text need be set to
16 with font weight set to bold. Set the fore colour to Blue. Set its
Control Source property as = IIF([Type] = 0,Debit,Credit) & &
Voucher Re-size the width of this text control so that it can
accommodate and display the dynamic title of voucher. By entering the
above formulae in Control Source property, text control for title becomes
dynamic. Whenever, the Type field is assigned 0 value, a text control for
title displays Debit Voucher and when the value of Type is set to 1, the
Credit Voucher is displayed by the this Text control. The title of simple
Transaction Voucher is static. Therefore, a label control has been used
for this purpose. Further, set the Enabled property to No so that the
displayed text is not amendable to any changes by the user. This
applies to other similar controls meant for dynamic texts in this Voucher
Form.
Paste another text box anywhere in the Form and set its Control
Source Property as = Val(DMax(Vno,Voucher)) + 1 and Visible
property to No. Further, Set Default value property of Text box to
the left of label Voucher No. as =Val(DMax(Vno,Voucher))+1.
This ensures that the text control generates a new value one more

586

Accountancy

than the preceding value of the last voucher number entered in


vouchers table as and when a new record is added. As a result, the
voucher number is detected in Voucher table and incremented by
one to auto generate the voucher number sequentially. Set its
Enabled property to No for reasons already explained earlier.
(xii) Set Default value of Text box meant for entering the voucher date
as = Now(). This results in displaying RTC date as the default date
to voucher as and when a new voucher record is added.
(xiii) Paste another text control below, the label Voucher No: to indicate
Debit in case of Credit voucher and Credit in case of Debit Voucher.
Remove its attached label and set its Font size and font weight
property appropriately. However, its Control Source property is set
as = IIF([Type] = 0,Credit,Debit) so that this text box displays
the desired text as stated above. Pick up a List control from tool box
and place it next to this calculated text control to choose the account.
Immediately, the List control wizard gets activated and displayed.
Complete the list control creation process as already discussed while
designing the simple transaction form. Ensure that its Control source
property is assigned the Field name AccCode; Row Source to
Accounts; Column Count set to 2; Bound Column set to 1 and
Column width to 0.5". Re-size the control for proper display.
Creating Grid for Debit/Credit Entries : The grid for entries is created by using
SubForm Control. Following steps are taken to create SubForm to be linked
to Main Voucher Form :
(i) Pick and paste SubForm control for creating a grid to accommodate the
Debit/Credit Entries. SubForm wizard gets activated and displayed.
Choose existing Tables/Queries, followed by click at Next button.
Subform wizard displays a dialog to giving fields classified by their
respective tables. Choose Sno, Code from VouchersDetail table; Name
from Accounts table; again Amount, narration and Vno from
VouchersDetail table. Click Next button.
(ii) Choose Show VoucherDetail for each record in VouchersMain using
Vno and Click Next and provide the name for subform object as
VouchersDetail SubForm Click at Finish. The SubForm stands created
to accommodate the data contents in voucher grid. The attached label
of SubForm is removed to pave the way for creating dynamic title. This
is achieved by adding another text control (remove the attached label
control) at the top of the SubForm in the same manner as applies to the
title of voucher, except that the Control Source property is set to =
IIF([Type] = 0,Debit,Credit) & & Entries. This calculated
control is capable of showing the title of the grid as Debit Entries or
Credit Entries, depending on choice of Option button at run time.

Accounting System using DBMS

587

The Voucher number column in grid can be hidden by merging its right
most vertical line with vertical line separating narration and voucher
number column by drag and drop method.
(iii) Set the format property of Text box meant for Amount to Standard
with decimal places to 2. This ensures the appearance of amount up to
two decimal places with standard punctuation of numeric values.
(iv) Provide conditional formatting of amount so that its colour turns ino red
as and when an expense voucher exceeding Rs. 20,000 is not authorised
by an employee whose EmpId =A001. This is achieved by a right click at
text box for amount to get short-cut window so that conditional formatting
item is selected. A conditional formatting dialog appears in which condition1 is to be given as Field value greater than Rs. 20,000 interactively. Click
Add button to provide condition-2 as Expression is [AuthBy]<>A001 and
[Debit] like 71*. Click colour icon to select Red colour in condition-2.
Click OK to close the conditional formatting dialog.
(v) Text control for entering Code in SubForm can be morphed to List control
in the same manner as already explained for Debit/Credit Account in
simple Transaction Voucher except that the Control source property is
assigned the Field name Code of VouchersDetail Table.
(vi) Control morphing from Text box to List box is also to be applied on text
controls meant to store the data values for AuthBy and PrepBy
respectively. This can be achieved in the manner as already described
in the context of designing a simple Transaction Voucher.
(vii) Paste a label control to the top right of SubForm for displaying the
instruction Press F9 to Refresh Display.
(viii) Command button at the bottom of Debit/Credit Voucher Form can be
added in the same manner as described above in the context of Simple
Transaction Form. An additional Command button with Caption Close
Form can be added by choosing Form Operation as category with Close
Form as the action.
While operating on the above form in run mode, it must be ensured by the
user that the entries in the grid are made only after saving the data contents
of voucher outside the grid. This is because a data record for contents outside
the grid belongs to VouchersMain table. Such record in primary table must
exist before any data record is entered in grid to be finally stored in
VouchersDetail table.
15.4 Information Using Queries
Accounting information that is presented in an accounting report is generated
by creating and executing various queries using DBMS. The basics of creating
such queries in MS Access have been described below along with their usage
in the context of Model-1.

588

Accountancy

15.4.1 Basics of Creating Queries in Access


Recall that one of the great advantages of relational databases is that the
fragmented data is stored in different data tables so that there is no or minimum
redundancy. But a complete view of data stored across various tables is
achieved only by executing queries based on SQL. A query is capable of
displaying records containing fields from across a number of data tables.
15.4.2 Types of Queries
There are several types of queries in Access that are used to generate
information. Such queries are called select queries because they are used to
select records with a given set of fields: actual and computed and also for a
given criteria. There are three important query types that are required for
generating the accounting reports. These queries have been discussed as below:
(a) Simple Query : A select query is a simple query if it does not involve use of
any query function to produce a summary of data. The criteria, if any,
used in such a query is based on some constant value or values, forming
an integral part of the query. For example, a query, to find date and
amount of transactions records in which an account, identified by code =
711001 is debited, is a simple query and is executed, using database
design of Model-I by the following SQL statement :
SELECT vDate, Amount
FROM Vouchers
WHERE Debit = 711001

In the above SQL statement, the SELECT statement is meant to specify


the fields to be selected, FROM clause specifies the source of data and
WHERE clause filters the records matching the condition that Debit field
has code = 711001
(b) Parameter Queries : A parameter query prompts the user to enter
parameters, or criteria through an input box, for selecting a set of records.
A parameter query is useful when there is a need to repeat the same query
with different criteria. The criteria, this means, is not constant as in the
case of the simple query. While extracting the transactions to prepare
ledger accounts, the same set of queries need be executed for different
account codes. Consider the following SQL statement :
PARAMETERS AccountName Text (255)
SELECT Name
FROM Accounts
WHERE Code = AccountNo

Accounting System using DBMS

589

In the above query, the PARAMETERS clause is meant to declare the


variable AccountNo. This SQL statement, when executed, prompts the
user to provide the value of AccountNo.
(c) Summary Queries : A summary query, as opposed to a simple query, is
used to extract aggregate of data items for a group of records rather than
a detailed set of records. This query type is of particular importance in
accounting because the accounting reports are based on summarisation
of transaction data. Consider the following SQL statement :
SELECT Code, Name, Sum(Amount)
From Vouchers INNER JOIN Accounts
ON (Accounts.Code=Vouchers.Debit)
GROUP BY Code, Name

In the above query, the Vouchers table has been joined with Accounts table
on the basis of Code field of Accounts and Debit field of Vouchers. The resultant
record set has been grouped on the basis of Code and name of accounts.
Accordingly, the sum of amount for each group (or set of records) has been
ascertained and displayed. Finding the sum is the process of summarisation.
15.4.3 Adding Computed fields
The computed fields, representing secondary data, do not form part of data
stored in tables because such data items unnecessarily increase the size of
database. The secondary data items can always be generated on the basis of
primary (or stored) data. In order to find values of such secondary data items,
the query is based on computed fields. The computed fields provide up-todate calculated results because they rely upon updated stored data values.
For example, a data table, named Sales, which includes ItemCode, Quantity,
Price, Dated and CustId, is maintained in a database to store sales
transactions. In order to get list of sales transactions along with total sales
relating to CustId=A051', the following simple query is executed by including
Sales as computed field :
SELECT Dated, ItemCode, Quantity*Price AS Sales
FROM Sales WHERE CustId= A051;

In the above query the expression Quantity*Price has been given the name
Sales by using AS clause.
15.4.4 Using Functions in Queries
A function in the Access environment is named and followed by parenthesis
( ). The function receives some inputs as its arguments and returns a value
(also called its output). These functions also form a part of the expression for
a computed field. Some commonly used functions have been described and
discussed in Appendix given at the end of the chapter.

590

Accountancy

15.4.5 Methods of Creating Query


There are three ways in which any of the above queries can be created in
Access. These methods are Wizard, Design and SQL View. A brief description
of each is given below :
(a) Wizard Method : In order to create a query using Wizard, the following
steps are required :
(i) Select Queries from Objects list given in LHS (Left Hand Side) of
Database window.
(ii) Double click at Create Query by Using Wizard given on the RHS
(Right Hand Side). Immediately, there is a window titled Simple Query
Wizard (Shown in figure: 14.6) that prompts the user to select a
field from a table or an existing query that is to be included in the
query being created. Many such fields may be selected according to
the information requirement of the query. The tables (or queries)

Fig. 15.6 : Window to display simple query wizard

Accounting System using DBMS

591

being chosen represent the data source of the query being created.
The fields being selected imply the data items to be displayed by the
query. Use arrow buttons or double click at the list of fields on LHS
of this window to select fields.
(iii) Click at Next after the desired fields have been selected. If the selected
fields include a number or currency field, the designer is prompted
to choose an option button to specify whether the query to be created
is a summary or detail query.
If detail option is chosen, the execution of query results in
displaying records from data source.
If summary option is selected, the user is prompted to indicate
the type of summarisation required: Sum, Average, Minimum
and Maximum with respect to the field of summarisation. Clicking
at check boxes against different types of summarisations specifies
this. Click OK.
(iv) Click at Next and specify the name of the query being created %
Finish to save and execute the query. The results of the query are
displayed in datasheet view.
(b) Design Method : In order to create a query by design method, the following
steps are required :
(i) Select Queries from Objects list given in LHS of database window.
Double click at Create Query by Using Design View given on the
RHS.
(ii) Access responds by displaying a Select Query and Show Tables
Window. The Select query window is vertically divided into two panes:
upper pane and lower pane, as shown in Figure: 15.7. The upper
pane is meant to display data sources (Tables or Existing Queries)
and the lower pane, which also called Query By Example (QBE)
grid, has one column each for field to be included in query being
created. The row of this grid shows field name, table (or query), sort
order, whether the selected field is shown in the query results or not
and also the criteria that have been applied to the field or fields to
restrict the query results. The Show Table Window is meant to add
tables, queries or both to the upper pane of Select Query Window. If
closed, the Show Table Window can be recalled by a right click at
upper pane % show table.

592

Accountancy

Fig. 15.7 : Select query and show tables windows

(iii) Click at View item of Menu bar % Total and then % Table Names.
(iv) Click at field row of first column of QBE grid to select the fields to be
included in the query. The process is repeated for second and
subsequent columns of grid to include more fields in the query. This
process of selection constitutes the data items to be displayed by
SELECT clause of SQL statement.
(v) The name of table or query is displayed, in accordance with selection
of fields. Such tables or queries constitute the data sources shown
after FROM clause of SQL statement. However, the initial selection
of a table/query in the second row of QBE grid restricts the choice
of fields to the selected table/query only.
(vi) Click at row of grid to specify the Group by clause and aggregate
functions so that summary a query is created.

Accounting System using DBMS

593

(vii) Click at row of grid to specify the sort order (Ascending or descending)
on field(s). The selected fields for sort order are shown after ORDER
BY clause of SQL statement in which ascending order is the choice
by default.
(viii) Click at row to check for the selected field to be displayed in the
query result. The field(s) may be selected only for the purpose of
specifying the sort order or criteria.
Click at row of the grid to specify the criteria to limit the records
to be displayed by the query being created. The specified criteria
result in a conditional expression, which is shown after the
WHERE clause of SQL statement.
Click File % Save (or Press Ctrl+S) to save a query. A dialog box
prompts the user to specify the name of the query being created.
By default a generic name appears which can be accepted or
rewritten with a desired name.
(c) SQL View Method : A query may be directly specified in Select Query Pane
by a right click at table pane % SQL view. The upper and lower panes of
selected query window are substituted by a pane to specify the SQL statement
that is written by using keyboard. The desired SQL statement is directly
okeyed in on this pane and saved in the same manner as described for
design method. While forming the SQL statement, the following clauses are
normally used for generating information (or Select) queries :
(i) SELECT : This clause is used to specify the fields to display data or
information. Consider the following SQL statement segment :
SELECT Code, Name, Amount

The fields Code, Name and Amount after SELECT clause indicate
the data items to be displayed by the query statement.
(ii) FROM : This clause is meant to indicate the source of data in terms
of tables or queries or a combination of both. Two tables are joined
by specifying a JOIN clause based on a condition of Join. There can
be three types of Join: Inner, Left and right.
(iii) INNER : This Join clause is meant to display only exactly matching
records between two data sources. Consider the following SQL
statement segment:
FROM Accounts INNER JOIN AccountType
ON ( CatId=Type)

In the above statement, only those records of Accounts and


AccountType table constitute the source of query data, which match
exactly on CatId = Type.

594

Accountancy

(iv) LEFT : With this Join, all the records in the primary table in the
relationship are displayed irrespective whether there are matching
records in the related table or not. Consider the following SQL
statement segment :
FROM Accounts LEFT JOIN AccountType
ON ( CatId=Type)

In the above statement, all records of Accounts along with matching


records of AccountType table constitute the source of query data,
The matching condition is CatId = Type.
(v) RIGHT : With this Join, all the records of related table in the
relationship are displayed irrespective whether there are matching
records in the primary table or not. Consider the following SQL
statement segment
FROM Accounts RIGHT JOIN AccountType
ON ( CatId=Type)

In the above statement, all records of AccountType along with


matching records of Accounts table constitute the source of query
data. The matching condition is CatId=Type.
(iv) WHERE : This clause in SQL statement is used to provide the
condition to restrict the records to be returned by query. The
resultant records of query must satisfy the condition which is
specified after WHERE clause. This is meant to filter records returned
by the query.
(v) ORDER BY : This clause is meant to specify the order in which the
resultant records of query are required to appear. The basis of
ordering is determined by the list of fields specified after the order
by clause. Consider the following SQL statement segment :
ORDER BY Type, Code

The above statement in the context of Accounts table implies that


the resultant record set is ordered by the Type field of Accounts
and within Type, by Code field of Accounts.
(vi) GROUP BY : The group by clause is used in the SQL statement to
enable grouping of records for creating summary query. The fields
after GROUP BY clause constitute the basis of grouping for which
summary results are obtained. Consider the following SQL statement:
SELECT Debit, Sum(Amount)
FROM Vouchers
GROUP BY Debit

Accounting System using DBMS

595

In the above SQL statement, the GROUP BY clause uses Debit


account codes as the basis for computing the sum of amount of
voucher. The total amount, by which every transacted account has
been debited, is given by this SQL statement In this case, sum of
amount is found for each group of records formed using GROUP BY
clause.
15.5 Generating Accounting Reports
An Accounting system without reporting capability is incomplete as reporting
is one of the main purposes for which an accounting system is designed and
operated upon. The output of accounting system takes the form of accounting
reports. Access offers a great flexibility in designing and generating customised
reports.
15.5.1 Accounting Reports
Every report consists of information, which is different from data. Data
processing leads to data transformation and when this processing is in
accordance with decision usefulness, it is called information. Information
generation is the process of compiling, arranging, formatting and presenting
information to the users. A report is prepared with a definite objective. Every
report is collection of related information for a particular need and purpose
and must meet the twin objectives of reporting : one to reduce the level of
uncertainty that is faced by a decision-maker; second to influence the behaviour
(or positive actions) of the decision-maker. Accordingly, accounting information,
generated by processing accounting data is gathered to generate an accounting
report. An accounting report, therefore, is the physical form of accounting
information. Useful accounting information, regardless of its physical form,
must have five characteristics: relevance, timeliness, accuracy, completeness
and summarisation. An accounting report, in order to be useful, must display
information content in such a manner as to give confidence to the user,
influence his behaviour and prompt him to take positive actions. Reports,
which do not meet the above stated objectives, lack or do not have sufficient
information content, have no value. There are two broad classes of accounting
reports: Programmed and Casual (also called Adhoc or Pass through).
(a) Programmed Reports : These reports contain information useful for decisionmaking situations that the users have anticipated to occur. There are two
types of reports within this report type: Scheduled and On demand.
Scheduled Reports : The reports, which are produced according to a
given time frame, are called scheduled reports. The time frame may be
daily, weekly, monthly, quarterly or yearly. Some examples of scheduled

596

Accountancy

reports are: Trial Balance, Ledger, Statement of Cash Transactions


(Cash Book), Statement of Ageing Accounts, Closing Stock Report, Profit
and Loss Account and Balance Sheet, etc.
On Demand Reports : The reports, which are generated only on the
triggering of some event, are called On demand reports. Some examples
of On demand reports are a Customers Statement of Account, Inventory
Re-order Report, Stock in hand Report for a Selected Group of
items, etc.
Casual Reports : There are reports, the need for which is not anticipated,
the information content of which may be useful but casually required.
These are adhoc reports and are generated casually by executing some
simple queries without requiring much of professional assistance. As
opposed to programmed reports, casual reports are generated as and
when required.

15.5.2 Process of Creating Reports


The process of generating accounting reports in Access involves three steps:
designing the report, identifying the accounting information queries, and finally
creating an accounting report by using such queries.
(i) Designing the Report : Every report is expected to meet certain objectives
of reporting for which it is designed and developed. It should not be too
big so as not to be read at all or too small so as to conceal certain vital
information of importance that is expected to facilitate decision-making.
Objective-oriented reporting means designing the report in such a manner
as to meet the pre-conceived objectives in view.
(ii) Identifying Accounting Information Queries : A number of SQL statements
are written in such a manner that each successive SQL relies on the
results of the preceding SQL statement and refines its results by using
fresh data (or information) from existing data tables (or queries).
(iii) Using the Record set of Final SQL : The record set of final SQL that relies upon
preceding SQL statement, is collection of report-oriented information. This
record set need be embedded in the report being produced.
15.5.3 Basics of Designing a Report in Access
A report, in Access, is a static presentation of stored or transformed data in
an organised manner. Access saves the design of the report, which consists of
information structure along with various controls to display information
content and its record source. When a saved report is opened, the information
content is retrieved from the tables and displayed according to the design. As
a result, a saved report design, when opened, displays the information content

Accounting System using DBMS

597

according to the current state of data. There are two types of formats of
presenting information through a report: Columnar and Tabular.
Columnar Report Format : A columnar format displays the caption of each
field on a separate line in a single column down the page. The corresponding
information contents of the fields are shown in another column next to
their respective fields. If the caption property of a field is kept blank, the
name of the field is used as its caption. This implies that there are two
columns in this format: one for displaying the fields and another for showing
the corresponding information content. A record set that consists of nine
fields, when presented in such a format, requires nine lines of report. In
columnar format, the total number of lines to be printed equals the number
of fields multiplied by the number of record sets to be displayed.
Tabular Report Format : A tabular format displays the caption of fields on
the same line so that their respective information contents appear in the
next line. The number of columns in tabular report is exactly equal to the
number of fields to be displayed. It implies that the above mentioned record
set, when presented in tabular format, requires one line for captions of
fields and another line for information content. In tabular format, the
total number of lines to be printed equals the number of record sets to be
displayed plus one for captions of fields to constitute column headings.
15.5.4 Structure of Report in Access
A report in Access is designed using seven sections which taken together
constitutes the structure of report design. It is not necessary that every report
designed in Access must have all the sections that have been described below:
Report Header : Report header appears at the top of the report and may
include title and other relevant information pertaining to the report.
Page Header : Page header appears at the top of every page of the report.
It may include a uniform title to indicate that the page belongs to a
particular report.
Group Header : The group header and footer are available in a report only
if the sort order and grouping levels are also defined on the basis of a field
of data source. This is because Group Header and Footers are properties
of the field that are used for defining the sort order. Depending on grouping
level, the group header appears at the top of each report group. A set of
report pages constitutes a report group. Each group level of report contains
a separate group header.
Details : The details section, which is also called the main body of a report,
contains data from tables or queries that provide the record source to a
report. This section is most important as it consists of the main information
content of a report.

598

Accountancy

Group Footer : The group footer appears at the bottom of each grouping
level and may contain summaries or sub-totals for the grouped data.
Page Footer : The page footer appears at the bottom of each page of the
report and is meant to include page numbers, date and time of report
generation.
Report Footer : The report footer appears once on the last page of the
report to include summaries or totals for all data of the report.

It is not necessary to incorporate each and every section or component of


report structure. Those report structure components, which are not required
in a specific report being designed, are suppressed. To achieve this suppression,
open the View Menu to hide or display the Report Header/Footer, Report
Page Header/Footer. The size of every section or report structure component
is increased or decreased by dragging section bars up or down using a mouse.
15.5.5 Methods of Creating a Report
There are three ways in which a report can be created in Access. A brief
description of each method is given below:
(a) Auto Report: This is the easiest method of creating a report both with
columnar and tabular formats. To begin with formulate, create and save a
query, which is capable of providing a record set as the information source
of report. Alternatively, the information content must be available in a
single table of the database. If the information is generated by relying
upon more than one table, query is the option to be exercise. After the
information source becomes available in the database, the following
procedure is adopted to create Auto Reports.
(i) Select Reports from objects list given in LHS of Database window
and click at New object button of tool bar. Access responds by
displaying the following New Report Window.
(ii) Choose AutoReport: Columnar or AutoReport: Tabular, followed
by selecting the information source query or table.
(iii) Click OK to generate the report. Access responds by creating and
displaying the report in printpreview mode.
(iv) To print the report, click at the print icon on tool bar.
(v) To save the report design as object, close the print preview window,
and provide a suitable name.
Auto Reports are easy and fast to create. But these reports are less
attractive. To prepare more professional report, report wizard is used.

Accounting System using DBMS

599

Fig. 15.8 : New report window to choose methods of report design

(b) Wizard : The Report wizard allows a designer to choose the fields from
multiple tables along with specification for grouping, sorting and formatting
of information content in report. This obviates the limitation of Auto
Reports. In order to create reports by wizard, following steps are required.
(i) After selecting Reports object, double click at Create Report by
Using Wizard. Access responds by displaying Report Wizard window
similar to the one displayed for query wizard (See Fig 14.10).
(ii) Choose the table or query that includes information content of report,
from Tables/Queries drop-down list on LHS.
(iii) Use arrow buttons to select fields to provide the information source
to report. Single right arrow button is used to select one field and
double arrow button to select all fields. Alternatively, double click
at the fields to be selected in the same order in which they are required
to be displayed in the report.
(iv) Another table or query can be chosen to select more fields for a
report to provide a definite relationship between the tables is defined.
Click Next when selection process of data source is complete.

600

Accountancy

(v) Access responds by prompting the designer to add any grouping


level(s) for displaying the information content of the report. The report
is prepared by choosing any repeated data item to constitute a group.
Click Next when the grouping level is added and defined.
(vi) Access responds by requiring the designer to specify the sort order
based on any of the fields contained in the report. The records may
be sorted up to four fields by specifying either ascending or
descending order for each field. After specifying the sort order, click
Next or specify the summary values to calculate. The summary
values are sum, average, minimum and maximum. Once summary
values are specified, click OK, followed by click Next.
(vii) Report wizard responds by requiring the designer to choose the report
layout (stepped, block, outline and align left) and its orientation
(portrait and landscape). Click Next after specifying the layout and
orientation.
(viii) Report wizard prompts the designer to choose a particular style of
report from among six styles: bold, casual, compact, corporate,
formal and soft-gray. After choosing a suitable style for report, click
Next.
(ix) Report wizard prompts the designer to specify the title of report
being designed. Further, the designer is provided with two options:
preview the report or modify its design. After exercising the option,
click Finish.
(x) Access presents the report in preview mode or design mode depending
on which option is chosen in (i) above.
(c) Design View : The design view method offers greatest flexibility to the
designer in designing a report. In this method, the report is designed by
assembling and embedding various components from report tool box. In
order to design a report by using design view, following steps are required:
(i) After selecting Reports object, double click Create report in Design
view. Access responds by providing a blank report object with three
sections: Report/Page header, Detail and Report/Page footer as
shown in Figure : 15.9.
(ii) Right click the mouse at the black spot appearing at the left of
horizontal ruler of above report. Report object responds by displaying
a drop down window.
(iii) Click Properties and select Record Source from Data tab. The record
source turns into a combo control giving a list of various tables and
queries. Choose the appropriate source of information to be presented

Accounting System using DBMS

601

in the report being designed. Access responds by providing a list of


fields of the selected record source. If this list does not appear or it
is closed by mistake, it can be recalled by clicking at the field list
icon appearing before the icon for tool box.

Fig.15.9 : Window displaying design view of report

(iv) Select the required fields from list of fields displayed as discussed in
(c) above, by clicking at each of the fields to be selected while keeping
the Ctrl key pressed. Drag and drop the selected fields to Detail
section.
(v) The label part of each field is moved to Report/Page header and text
part is accordingly aligned below their respective labels column wise.
The caption of each label giving headings can be suitably modified,
if required.
(vii) The vertical ruler controlling the distance between various report
sections can be suitably adjusted to give a better look to the report.

602

Accountancy

The Report/Page footer bar is brought close to the fields laid out in
Detail section so that the gap between records of details section is
minimized.
(viii) Page headers and page footers may also be added by right click at
title bar of report object, followed by click at Page header/footer.
15.5.6 Refining the Report Design
The design of the report created by any of the methods described above may
be improved upon by making the following additions and modifications to the
report. For this purpose, an existing report is opened in design mode.
Adding Dates and Page Numbers : When an existing report is opened in
design mode, the page footer of the report contains two unbound controls:
the current date and current page number of total number of pages.
Both the controls may be customised according to the requirement of the
designer. The date control uses = Now() function to retrieve the current
date from RTC of computer. The format of date may be modified by selecting
General date, Medium date, Short date or Long date from format property
of this control.
Further, when a report is created using design view method, the date and/
or time and also the page numbers may be added to any of its part. The
date and time is added by clicking Insert % date and time from the menu
bar to open the Date and Time dialog box. After selecting and specifying
the desired preferences regarding date and time, click OK to find that a
text control with chosen date and time preferences is added at the top of
active report section. This added text control containing date and time
may be dragged and dropped in any part of the report as per requirement.
Similarly, the page number is added by clicking Insert % page numbers
from the menu bar to open the Page numbers dialogue box. This dialogue
allows the designer to specify the format, position and alignment. The two
formats are: Page N (for example Page 1) and Page N of M ( for example
Page 1 of 10). The position to specify is either Top of Page (header) or
Bottom of Page (footer). Possible alignment, which may be specified are
Centre, left, right, inside and outside.
Adding and Deleting Report Controls : After a report has been designed,
additional report controls may be added or deleted by the same procedure
as applicable to forms. Clicking tool bar icon opens report design tool bar,
which contains a set of useful controls.
(a) After opening the report in design mode, click Field List button on
report design tool bar. This results in opening the field list window.

Accounting System using DBMS

603

(b) Drag the field into an appropriate section of the report. The field appears
with both label and text box control. The label part gives a constant
field heading while the text part provid
.es different values of the field. These two parts are accordingly placed at the
appropriate sections of the report.
(c) A field control may be deleted by selecting the control and pressing the
Delete key.
Conditionally Formatting Report Controls : The conditional formatting of
text boxes and combo boxes in reports can be achieved in the same manner,
as it applies to Forms. The conditional formatting allows the designer to
apply special text formats that depend on the value of field. This facility is
a useful tool to draw the attention of user or reader of report to some
values of particular interest, such as amounts exceeding certain limit or
unexpected balances in some accounts. In order to create a conditional
formatting, following steps are required:
(a) Open the report in design view.
(b) Select a control and click at format on menu bar, followed by conditional
formatting.
(c) Provide the necessary conditions for formatting to occur in the same
manner as already discussed while applying conditional formatting to
design of Forms.
(d) The conditional formatting is removed by re-opening the same dialog
and clicking at delete button.
Grouping Levels and Sorting Order : The purpose of grouping is to organise
the information content of a report into categories. Sorting order is meant
to arrange such information content into numerical or alphabetical order.
With groupings the sorting applies to each individual group. The grouping
and sorting of information, when applied together, make the report more
meaningful and therefore useful to the user of the report. In order to specify
the grouping and sorting order, following procedure is adopted.
(i) Click at Sorting and Grouping icon of Report Design Tool bar (This
icon is located next to icon for tool box). Immediately, Access
responds by displaying the following Sorting and Grouping dialogue
box.
(ii) The LHS of this dialog box provides a list of fields or expressions
that are to be used for grouping and sorting. In the above dialog
box, Type field of Accounts has been chosen as the basis of grouping
the information content of trial balance. The group header and footer
property is set to Yes to indicate that there is separate header and
footer for each group of accounts in trial balance.

604

Accountancy

Fig. 15.10 : Window displaying sorting and grouping dialogue box

15.5.7 Saving and Exporting a Report


After a report is designed, it may be generated to preview its final shape. Both
the design and a generated report are saved for future use and reference. The
generated report may also be exported for use by others, as described below:
(a) Saving and Exporting Report Object in Access : The design of a report is
saved in Access as report object by assigning a particular name. The report
object, when opened in access by click action generates the desired report
as per design specification. The design may also be exported to another
database file of Access. This is achieved by clicking File % Export and
then selecting and existing database into which the report design is to be
exported. Access responds by providing a dialog box to give the name by
which the exported report is saved in a selected database.

Accounting System using DBMS

605

(b) Saving as Snapshot : After a report is created, it may be saved in such a


manner so as to be viewed by others without the help of Access. This
becomes possible by saving the report as a snapshot file. As a result, a
high quality picture image of each page of report is created with Adobe
Acrobat software. Other users of the report can then view the report and
print any of its pages without being able to modify its contents. It must be
ensured that this feature of saving a report as snapshot is also installed
while installing the MS Office 2000 package. In order to create a report
Snapshot, following steps are required :
Select and generate a report in Database Window.
Click File % Export from menu bar. An Export Report dialog box
appears.
Choose the folder from combo box next to Save in; provide a file name;
select snapshot from list control next to Save as type and click at
Save button. While saving the report ensure that the auto start check
box is enabled.
The generated report is saved as a snapshot and can be supplied to
others for printing and viewing without the help of the Access database
environment.
(c) Exporting to Excel : A generated report may be exported to Excel, which is
a spreadsheet package. This software package is a part of MS Office product
and is generally installed while installing MS Access. A report is exported
to Excel by following the same steps as have been listed above while saving
a report as snapshot, except that before clicking save button in (c) above,
one has to select Microsoft Excel 2000/2002 from list control next to Save
as type.
(d) Exporting to MS Word : A report generated using Access can also be exported
to MS word, which is a text processing package. This package is also
installed while installing MS Access, as a part of MS Office. In order to
export a report to MS Word, the following steps are required :
(i) Select and generate a report in Database Window.
(ii) If print preview tool bar is absent in Access window, Click View %
Tool bars % Print preview from menu bar of Access. Access
responds by providing print preview tool bar for reports.
(iii) Click at right corner of icon for Official Links. There are three options
in the list: Merge It with MS Word, Publish It with MS Word and
Analyse It with MS Excel.
(iv) Click Publish it with MS Word, which is also the default option.
(v) The generated report is exported to MS Word package and can be
dealt with like any other document created using MS Word.

606

Accountancy

(e) Printing a Report : A generated report may also be printed by taking the
following steps provided a printer attached to the computer is installed.
(i) Choose File from menu bar % Print
(ii) Access responds by providing a print window, which allows the
user to select a printer, the number of copies to be printed and also
the range of pages to be printed.
(iii) Properties button is clicked to define print quality under set-up tab
and orientation under paper tab. Two-sided printing may also be
obtained if the printer supports this feature.
(f) E-Mailing a Report : A report generated by Access may also be sent using
E-Mail facility, provided the computer system has Internet facility and is
connected to the Mail Server of the Internet Service Provider (ISP). In order
to send a report using E-mail facility, following steps are required :
(i) Select and generate a report in Database Window
(ii) Click at File % Send-To % Mail recipient from Menu bar of Access.
A Send dialog box appears with various options for choosing the
Format: Microsoft Excel, HTML, Snapshot format, Rich Text format,
etc.
(iii) Choose an appropriate format and click OK. Access responds by
providing an E-Mail composition window.
(iv) Fill up the details regarding E-mail address of recipient and others
to whom copy of report is to be sent; provide a subject to E-mail
and click at Send button. The report gets dispatched to the mailbox
of the recipient of E-mail.
Test Your Understanding
Fill in the blanks
(a) Reports, the need for which is not anticipated is called ........................reports.
(b) ................query does not involve use of any query function to produce a summary
of data.
(c) ................ query prompts the user to enter criteria for selecting a set of records.
(d) ................clause is used to specify the fields to display data or information.
(e) .................. is meant to include page number, data and time of report.
(f) The purpose of ................. is to organise the information of report into categories
whereas ............ arranges information into numerical or alphabetical order.
(g) When saved as ......................., the contents of reports can not be modified by the
user.

Accounting System using DBMS

607

15.5.8 Designing Accounting Reports using Access


Financial Accounting Reports such as Cash book, Bank book, Ledger Accounts
and Trial Balance may be generated in Access by adhering to report generation
process. The exact process in the context of each of these reports is described
below :
Trial Balance
The Trial Balance is one of the accounting reports, which provides the net
amount by which each account, during a given period of time, has been debited
or credited. The format of a typical trial balance is as given below :
Trial Balance
Account Title

L.F.

Debit
Amout
Rs.

Credit
Amount
Rs.

Total

Fig. 15.11 : Format of trial balance

To produce a trial balance, it is necessary to retrieve a set of processed


data records each of which provides information on Code (or Account Number),
Name of Account (or Particulars), Debit balance and Credit balance with
reference to a each account. In order to find net balance corresponding to
every account along with its identity, following steps are taken :
(i) To find the total amount by which every account has been debited;
(ii) To find the total amount by which every account has been Credited;
(iii) To find a collective record set of accounts with their debit and credit
totals;
(iv) To find the net amount with which every account has been debited or
credited; and
(vi) To find the record set which consists of Account code, name of Account,
Debit and Credit Amount.
Above steps to produce trial balance are transformed into a series of SQL
statements, which vary according to the database design. The details of the
above procedure along with the relevant SQL statements need be explained in
the context of the three Models as given below :
Model-I : The following series of SQL statements retrieve a record set for
producing trial balance when database design for Model-I is used.

608

Accountancy

(a) To find the total amount by which the accounts have been debited : In order
to ascertain the total amount by which every transacted account has been
debited, the SELECT clause need to have two fields: one code to identify
the transacted account and another to generate the total by which such
account has been debited. This is achieved by using Debit field of Vouchers
table and finding the sum of amount corresponding to each of the
transacted accounts. The FROM clause relies upon Vouchers table to get
the data source. The GROUP BY clause specifies the field on the basis of
which grouping of record set is formed. This grouping is necessary in SQL
when aggregate query is used to generate summary information. The
summing of amount is obtained by using aggregate function, Sum( ). This
function, as already explained, uses a field with data type Number, as an
input argument and returns its sum as output. Accordingly, the following
SQL statement is formed :
SELECT Debit AS Code, Sum(amount) AS Total
FROM vouchers
GROUP BY debit;

In the above SQL statement, the GROUP BY clause retrieves the rows of
vouchers table accounts-wise because the debit field refers to account code.
As a result, the Sum( ) computes the sum of amount of a particular debit
account and reports against Debit account of SELECT clause. This SQL
statement is saved as Query 01for its subsequent use. The total of debit amount
in this query is given by Total field with positive amounts.
(b) To find the total amount by which the accounts have been credited : In order
to ascertain the total amount by which every transacted account has been
credited, a query similar to that in (a) need be formed, except that the
Debit field in SELECT and GROUP BY clause is substituted by Credit
field. The sum of amount generated by sum(Amount) is multiplied by -1
so that the final amount assigned to Total field is always negative. This is
because the amount of credit must be a negative amount if amount of
debit is taken as positive. The purpose of using negative values is to
differentiate between debit and credit totals for each account and also to
facilitate the simple arithmetic summation for obtaining the net amount.
Accordingly, the following SQL statement is formed :
SELECT Credit AS Code, Sum(Amount)*(-1) AS Total
FROM vouchers
GROUP BY Credit;

This SQL statement is saved as Query 02 to be used as source by next


query.

Accounting System using DBMS

609

(c) To generate a collective record set of accounts with their debit and credit
totals : Every transacted account that has been debited (or credited) only
appears once in this collective record set. However, those transacted
accounts that have been debited as well as credited appear twice in this
record set: once with a positive amount and thereafter with a negative
amount. This collective record set is generated by executing a UNION query
between Query 01 and Query 02.
SELECT*
FROM Query 01
UNION SELECT*
FROM Query 02 ;

This SQL statement is saved as Query 03 for further processing of its


resultant record set.
(d) To generate the net amount with which an account has been debited or
credited : Once the records of account codes with debit and/or credit
totals have been collected, the next logical step is to find out the net amount
by which such accounts have been either debited or credited. This is
accomplished by forming another aggregate query in which FROM clause
uses Query 03 as the data source. The sum of Total for each Code of data
source, provided by Query 03, results in computing net amount for every
account. Accordingly, the following SQL statement is formed to generate a
list of account codes with their respective balances: positive or negative.
SELECT Code, Sum(Total) AS Net
FROM Query 03
GROUP BY Code;

A positive net amount implies a debit and negative amount means a credit
balance corresponding to an account code. This is because in Query 02, the
total of credit amount has been made to appear as negative. This query is
saved as Query 04 for its subsequent use in generating record set for trial
balance.
(e) To find that record set which consists of account code, name of account,
debit amount and credit amount : Every row of a trial balance report consists
of Account Code, Name of Account, Debit Amount and Credit Amount.
The Debit Amount and Credit Amount are mutually exclusive. Such rows
are obtained by generating a record set based on the following SQL
statement.
SELECT a.Code, b.name AS [Name of Account], IIF
(a.Net>0,a.Net,null) AS Debit,
IIF (a.Net<0,abs(a.Net) ,null) AS Credit
FROM Query 04 AS a, Accounts AS b
WHERE a.code = b.code ;

610

Accountancy

In the above SQL statement, the results of Query 04 and data stored in
Accounts table has been used. The SELECT clause of this SQL statement has
two computed fields as explained below :
IIF(a.Net>0,a.Net,null) AS Debit: According to IIF( ) function, if the net
amount exceeds zero, it is displayed as Debit, otherwise nothing appears
in Debit field.
IIF(a.Net<0,abs(a.Net) ,null) AS Credit: According to IIF( ) function, if the
net amount is less than zero (implying negative), it is displayed as Credit,
otherwise nothing appears in Credit field.
Besides, the other two fields: Code and Name, of SELECT clause are
retrieved from Query 04 and Accounts table respectively. This SQL statement
is saved as Query 05 for providing the necessary information content for Trial
Balance Report.
Model-II : The following series of SQL statements retrieve the record set for
producing trial balance when database design for Model-II is used. In addition
to this, the accounts have been categorised within the trial balance according
to the Account Type: Expenses, Revenues, Assets and Liabilities.
(a) To find the total amount by which the accounts have been debited : The
transacted accounts in design of Model-II have been stored in AccCode of
VouchersMain and Code of VouchersDetail. The following SQL statement
is formed to generate the relevant information from VouchersDetails.
SELECT Code, Sum(amount) AS Total
FROM vouchersMain INNER JOIN vouchersDetails ON
VouchersMain.Vno = VouchersDetails.Vno
WHERE Type = 0
GROUP BY Code ;

Similarly, the following SQL statement is formed to generate the required


information from VouchersMain table.
SELECT AccCode As Code, sum(amount) AS Total
FROM vouchersMain INNER JOIN vouchersDetails ON
VouchersMain.Vno = VouchersDetails.Vno
WHERE Type = 1
GROUP BY AccCode ;

Both the SQL statements are meant to extract similar sets of records, but
from two different sources. Therefore, the resultant record set of these SQL
statements have been horizontally merged using UNION clause as shown below:
SELECT Code, sum(amount) AS Total
FROM vouchersMain INNER JOIN vouchersDetails ON
VouchersMain.Vno = VouchersDetails.Vno
WHERE Type = 0
GROUP BY Code

Accounting System using DBMS

611

UNION ALL
SELECT AccCode As Code, sum(amount) AS Total
FROM vouchersMain INNER JOIN vouchersDetails ON
VouchersMain.Vno = VouchersDetails.Vno
WHERE Type = 1
GROUP BY AcCode ;

The above SQL statement is saved as Query101for its subsequent use.


The total of debit amount in this query represents the Total with positive
amounts.
(b) To find the total amount by which the accounts have been credited : In
order to ascertain the total amount by which every transacted account
has been credited, a query similar to that in (a) need be formed. This is
achieved by substituting Debit field in SELECT and GROUP BY clause by
Credit field and the sum of amount generated by sum(Amount) is multiplied
by-1 so that the final amount assigned to Total field is always negative.
Accordingly, the following SQL statement is formed :
SELECT Code, sum(amount)*-1 AS Total
FROM vouchersMain INNER JOIN vouchersDetails ON
VouchersMain.Vno=VouchersDetails.Vno
WHERE Type=1 GROUP BY Code, Amount
UNION
SELECT AccCode As Code, sum(amount)*-1 AS Total
FROM vouchersMain INNER JOIN vouchersDetails ON
VouchersMain.Vno=VouchersDetails.Vno
WHERE Type=0 GROUP BY AccCode, Amount;

In the above SQL statement, the sum of amount has been multiplied by -1 to
ensure that the amount of credit is always negative just as amount of debit is
taken as positive. This query is saved as Query102 for its subsequent use.
(c) To find a collective record set of accounts with their debit and credit totals:
A collective record set is generated by forming a union query between
Query101 and Query102 to ensure that the debit and credit amount with
respect to each account becomes available for generating the net amount.
Accordingly, the following SQL statement is formed.
SELECT*
FROM Query101
UNION Select*
FROM Query102;

612

Accountancy

The above SQL statement causes horizontal merger of record sets returned
by Query101 and Query102. This SQL Statement is saved as Query103 for its
subsequent use in next query.
(d) To find the net amount with which an account has been debited or credited:
To generate the net amount, an SQL statement similar to Query04 (designed
for query (d) of Model-I) above, is formed as shown below, except that its
source of data is Query103 instead of Query 03.
SELECT Code, Sum(Total) AS Net
FROM Query103
GROUP BY Code;

This query is saved as Query104 for its subsequent use in generating a


record set, giving details of information for trial balance.
(e) To find the record set which consists of Account code, Name of Account,
Debit Amount and Credit Amount : This query, which is meant to provide
relevant information to the trial balance report, is similar to Query 05
(designed and discussed in (e) of Model-I). Accordingly, the following SQL
statement is formed by changing the source of data from Query 05 to
Query105 as shown below :
SELECT a.Code, b.name AS [Name of Account], IIF(a.Net>0,a.Net,null) AS
Debit, IIF(a.Net<0,abs(a.Net) ,null) AS Credit FROM Query104 AS a,
Accounts AS b/
WHERE a.code = b.code;

In above SQL statement, the results of Query104 and data stored in


accounts table has been used. This SQL statement is saved as Query105 for
providing source of information to Trial Balance Report.
Trial Balance with Sorting and Grouping levels : In order to prepare a trial
balance with all the account duly grouped by and sorted within category of
accounts, two additional queries (f) and (g) are required.
(f) To find the record set of accounts with their category and category ID :
Accounts table is related to AccountType table vide Type field. The following
SQL statement, using INNER JOIN clause, is formed to retrieve the relevant
fields for various accounts.
SELECT Accounts.Code, Accounts.Name, Category, CatId FROM Accounts
INNER JOIN AccountType ON
Accounts.Type = Account type.CatId;

This SQL statement is saved as Query 106 for its subsequent use in next
query.
(g) To find the record set consisting of Account Code, Name of Account, Debit
Amount and Credit Amount along with category details : This query, when
compared with (e) above, reveals that two additional fields: Category and

Accounting System using DBMS

613

CatId are required. Accordingly, the SQL statement stored as Query105


is modified by substituting Accounts table with Query106 to form the
following Statement.
SELECT a.Code, b.name AS [Name of Account],
IIF(a.Net>0,a.Net,null) AS Debit, IIF(a.Net<0,abs(a.Net) ,null) AS Credit,
Category, CatId
FROM Query104 AS a, Query106 AS b
WHERE a.code = b.code ;

This SQL statement is saved as Query107 to provide information details


for designing trial balance with grouping and sorting of the accounts.
15.5.9 Procedure in Access for Designing a Simple Trial Balance
The Trial Balance is generated using the Design View method by following
the steps listed below :
(i) Select Reports from objects list provided by LHS of Database Window
and click at New object button of tool bar. Access responds by displaying
the New Report Window as shown in figure 15.8 Choose Design View
from list of methods and Query 05 from combo control meant to provide
data source to the report. Click OK after choosing method and data
source of report.
(ii) Access responds by displaying a blank report design divided horizontally
into three sections: Page Header, Detail and Page Footers. Besides, a
list of available fields of Query 05 is also provided for embedding on to
this blank design of report.
(iii) Alternatively, double click at Create report in design view. Access
respond by displaying a blank report design duly divided into three
sections as stated above. Right Click at the left most corner point of
report design where horizontal and vertical rulers converge. Click at
Properties of report and select Data tab to define the record source as
Query 05. Immediately, there appears as list of available fields of
Query 05 so as to be placed on to blank design of report.
(iv) Right click at any part of the report design and choose Report Page
Header and Footer. Access responds by providing two more sections:
Page Header and Page Footer.
(v) Click at the icon for tool bar and pick up a label control to be placed at
Page Header Section and assign set its caption property to Trial
Balance, Font Size to 16, Font colour to Blue, Text align to Left and
Font weight to Bold.

614

Accountancy

(vi) Select all the fields of Query 05 by clicking at every field while keeping
the Ctrl key pressed. Drag and drop the selected fields on Details section.
It may be noted that each of the dropped fields has two controls: Label
and Text. The former gives caption and the latter provides the data
content.
(vii) Select the label controls of all the four fields by clicking at each while
keeping the Shift Key pressed. Right click at selected label controls
and choose cut. Place the mouse at Page Header section and paste
these controls.
(viii) Re-arrange these label controls to appear as headings of columns for
trial balance as: Code, Name of Account, Debit and Credit. Select all
these label controls and right click to choose properties. Access provides
Properties of these controls. Choose format tab and set the Font weight
Property to Bold; Font Size to 10; Font colour to Blue and Text align to
Centre.
(ix) Align the Text controls in Detail section to appear just below each of the
respective label controls appearing in Page Header section.
(x) Select the Text controls and Debit and Credit field and modify their
properties by setting Decimal Places to Zero and Format to Standard.
(xi) Pick up a label control from tool box by click action and place at Report
Footer section, at the area vertically below the column Name of
Accounts and give the caption Total. Set its Text align property to
Centre, Font weight property to Bold and Font Size to 10.
(xii) Pick up a text control and place it at Report Footer section at the area
vertically below Debit column. Set its Record source property as
expression given below :
= Sum ([Query 05]![Debit])
The expression is written by clicking at (...) to call the expression pane.
The expression [Query 05]![Debit] within Sum( ) function refers to Debit
field of Query 05.
(xiii) Pick up another text control and place it at Report Footer section at the
area vertically below Credit column. Set its Record source property as
expression given below.
=Sum ([Query 05]![Credit])
The expression is written in the manner as it applies to sum of debit
column. The expression [Query 05]![Credit] within Sum( ) function refers
to Credit field of Query 05.
The report design prepared above is saved as Trial Balance by Design. The
Trial Balance report design appears on the RHS of Database Window as object
under Reports.

Accounting System using DBMS

615

15.5.10 Designing of Trial Balance with Sorting and Grouping


To design a trial balance with grouping and sorting of accounts, the following
additional steps are required.
(i) Copy the trial balance design as created above and paste it with different
name say Trial balance with Grouping. Open this copied report design
for modification in design view to incorporate the grouping and sorting
of accounts in trial balance report.

Fig 15.12 : Window displaying sorting and grouping dialog

(ii) Change the data source property of report design by right click at the
top left corner of report design % click at properties % Choose Tab and
set the Record source property as Query107.
(iii) Modify the Record source of Text controls for sum of debit and credit
columns to replace existing expressions by

616

Accountancy

= Sum ([Query107]![Debit]) .......... for Debit


= Sum ([Query107]![Credit]) .......... for Credit
(iv) Right click at report design % click at sorting and grouping. Access
responds by providing a window for sorting and grouping as shown in
figure 15.12
(v) Define the basis of grouping as CatId in field/expression and its sort
order set to ascending. Set the Group Header property to Yes. Access
responds by inserting CatId Header section in report design.
(vi) Click at field list icon and drag and drop category field in CatId Header
section. Set its Font Size property to 10, Fore Colour property to Dark
Green and Font Weight property as Bold.
Save the modifications in the above report design. The trial balance report
is generated by double click at this or the previous object. The generated trial
balance may be saved or exported as desired.
Key Terms Introduced in the Chapter

MS Access
Accounting Report
Compound Vouchers

Database Management System


Transaction Vouchers
Queries

Summary with Reference to Learning Objectives


1.

2.

3.

4.

Accounting Reports : A report displays information that is acquired from data


processing and transformation in an organised manner. Reports tend to reduce
the level of uncertainty associated with decision-makers and also influence their
positive actions. The output of the computerised accounting system are
accounting reports. Financial accounting reports such as Cash book, Bank
book, Ledger, and Trial Balance may be generated in Access by adhering to
report generation process.
Using Access for Producing Reports : In Access, the reports are created by
designing a report, identifying its information requirement, creating the queries
in SQL to generate such information so that the final SQL statement provides
the record set of information to the report design. Different Models of database
design require different sets of SQL statements to produce different types of
reports.
Queries Access : There are several types of queries in Access that may be used
to generate information. Such queries are called select queries because they are
used to select records from the given set of records. There are three ways in
which these queries may be created in Access: Wizard, Design View and SQL
View method.
Designing Reports in Access : A report in Access may be designed in three ways:
Auto Report, Wizard and Design View method. A SQL statement (or query) is
capable of displaying records containing fields from across a number of data
tables. A typical report in Access has the structure that consists of Report header,
Page header, Group header, Details, Group footer, Page footer and Report footer.

Accounting System using DBMS

617
Questions for Practice

Short Answers
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.

State what do you understand by accounting reports.


What do you mean by programmed or casual reports?
With the help of an example, briefly state the meaning of parameter queries.
Briefly state the purpose of functions in SQL environment.
Briefly explain in steps the method of creating a query, using wizard.
List the structure of a good report created in Access.
List the ways to refine the design of a report.
Briefly explain the purpose of grouping and sorting of the data as a means to
refine a report.
9. What do you understand by saving a report as snapshot?
10. State the procedure for creating ledger in MS Access.
Long Answers
1.

Describe and discuss the procedure of creating the receipts side of a cash
book.
2. Discuss the concept of accounting reports? Explain the three steps involved
in creating such reports.
3. Discuss with a set of inter-related data tables, the basics of creating queries
in MS Access?
4. Briefly explain the set of SQL statements to produce the receipts side of a
cash book for Model-I.
5. Describe in steps the design view method to create a query in MS Access?
6. Discuss the SQL view method of creating a query?
7. Describe the ways to refine the design of a report.
8. Explain the data base design for Model-I for producing the receipts the series
of SQL statements for producing the payment side of cash book for Model-II.
9. Describe the series of SQL statements to produce trial balance data base
design for Model-II is used.
10. Using Model-III discuss the series of SQL statements to produce a trial balance
up to a particular date.
Project Work
1.

2.

Payroll Accounting: Using the database design given in Exercise of Chapter-IV,


as Project No: 1, you are required to generate the portion of payroll according
to the specified format under MS Access environment.
Financial Accounting: Write the SQL statements for each of the following
queries separately by using database design of accounting specified as ModelI, II and III in Chapter-IV.
(a) List the transactions details of Accounts, which have been debited during
the period April 01, 2001 to September 30, 2001.
(b) List the transactions details of accounts which have been credited during
the month of August 2001.
(c) Find the total expenses incurred during the period September, 2001.
(d) List all the transacted accounts with the amounts by which they have
been debited and also the amount with which they have been credited.
(e) List the amount of expenses authorised by each of the employees.

618

Accountancy
3.

Inventory Accounting: Using the database design developed in Exercise of


Chapter-IV, for Project No: 2, you are required to generate Statement of closing
stock in the following format by assuming that all goods are sold at a profit
of 25% on purchase price.
Statement of Closing Stock
Particulars

Code

4.

Purchases

Item Name

Qty

Amount

Sales
Qty

Amount

Balance
Qty

Balance

Inventory Accounting: Using the database design developed in Exercise of


Chapter-IV, for Project No: 2, Write the SQL statements for each of the following
queries :
(a) List out the Invoice No, Date and amount of sales made during the
month of October, 2002.
(b) Make a list of Invoice No, Date and amount of Purchases during the
period April 01, 2002 to October 31, 2002.
(c) List items wise the quantity sold during the month of September 2002
(d) Find the Minimum and Maximum rate at which each item of goods has
been purchased during the period April 01, 2002.
(e) Make a list of physical quantity of each item in stock.
Checklist to Test Your Understanding
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)

Casual
Simple
Parameter
SELECT
Design view
Sorting
Snap shot

Accounting System using DBMS

619

APPENDIX

Description of Commonly Used Functions in Access


There are three types of functions that are used to set the Control Source property
of calculated controls and/or to form part of calculated field expression in SQL
statement. A brief description of the commonly used functions is below :
A-1. Domain Aggregate Functions
These functions are used to perform calculations based on values in a field of a
table or query. Criteria to select the set of records in the table or query that is
desired to be used for calculations may also be specified. The criteria, if not
specified, imply that all the records of the table or query specific to the field are
used for computation. All the domain aggregate functions use the same syntax
as is given hereunder :
DFunction (FldName, TblName or QryName, SrchCond)
Wherein DFunction refers to a named domain aggregate function. A brief
description of its input arguments is given below:
FldName : It refers to the name of field that is to be searched in a table or
query, which is specified as an argument.
TblName (or QueryName) : It refers to the name of a table or query that contains
the field specified as second input argument.
SrchCond : It refers to the search condition on the basis of which the relevant
record is searched.
Some of the important domain aggregate functions have been described as
below :
(a) DLookup : This function is meant to look up information that is stored in
a table or query, which is not the underlying source of Access Form or
Report. It is used to set the Control Source property of a calculated control
to display data from other table or query. Consider the following example:
DLookup (Name, Accounts, Code = 110001)
In the above example, this function has been applied to search the name of
account (in Accounts table) whose code is 110001.

(b) DMax and DMin : These functions are used to retrieve respectively the
maximum and minimum values in the specified field. Consider the
following example :
DMin (Amount, Vouchers, Debit = 711001)
Dmax (Amount, Vouchers, Debit = 711001")
In the above examples, the amount of minimum purchase transaction
and maximum purchase transaction is retrieved and reported. It may also
be noted that 711001 is the code of Purchase account in Accounts table
(c) DSum : This function computes and returns the sum of the values in the
specified field or expression. For Example, in a table : Sales that contains

620

Accountancy

ItemCode, Price and Quantity as fields, the total amount of sales may be
computed by using the DSum () function as follows :
DSum (Price*Quantity, Sales)
However, if the total sales is to computed for a particular item coded as
1678, the DSum () function shall be applied as follows :
DSum (Price*Quantity, Sales, ItemCode = 1678)
(d) DFirst and DLast : These functions are used to retrieve respectively the
values in the specified field from first and last physical records.
Consider the following application examples :
DFirst (Name, Accounts)
DLast (Name, Accounts)
In the above examples, the name first and last account that physically
exists in Accounts table is retrieved and reported.
(e) DCount : This function is meant to compute the number of records with
non-null values in the specified field. Consider the following application
example :
DCount (*, Accounts)
In the above example, The number of records in accounts table are counted
and reported by DCount () function.
A-2. SQL Aggregate Functions
The SQL aggregate functions have the functionality similar to that of domain
aggregate function. However, unlike domain aggregate functions, these functions
cannot be called directly into controls used in Forms and Reports of Access.
These functions are used in SQL statements that provide the underlying record
source of Forms and Reports. All these functions, when used require the GROUP
BY clause in SQL statement :
(a) Sum : This function is used to compute and return the sum of a set of values.
For Example, consider the following SQL statement that has been used in
Chapter-V to prepare the underlying information source of Trial Balance
(Model-I.).
SELECT Debit As Code, Sum (Amount) As Total
FROM VOUCHERS
GROUP By Debit ;

In the above SQL statement, Sum () has been used to compute the total amount
by which the transacted accounts have beeen debited.
(b) Min and Max : These functions are used to retrieve respectively the minimum
and maximum of value set with respect to field or query expression. For
Example, the following SQL statement is capable of returning the amount of
minimum and maximum sales transaction in Model-I :
SELECT Min (Amount) As MinSales, Max (Amount) As MaxSales
FROM Vouchers
WHERE Credit = 811001 ;

Accounting System using DBMS

621

It may be noted that the sales account that is coded as 811001 is credited as
and when a sales transaction is recorded.
(c) Count : This function counts the number of records returned by a query. The
number of times a sales transaction has occurred and recorded in books of
accounts can be known by executing the following SQL statement.
SQL statement.
SELECT count (*)
FROM Vouchers
WHERE Credit = 811001

In the above SQL statement, the Credit field stores the account code of sales
when a sales transaction occurs. The WHERE clause restricts the number of
records returned by the above SQL to those in which credit field has the
account code of sales. Accordingly, the count () function returns the count
value of records returned by the above SQL statement.
(d) First and Last : These functions are meant to retrieve the first and last record
of a value set pertaining to a field or query expression.
A-3. Other Functions
(a) IIF : The purpose of this function is to provide a value to the field from a
mutually exclusive set of values. Its syntax is as given below :
IIIF (<Condition>, Value-1, Value-2)
Wherein <Condition> refers to any logical expression in which a comparison
is made by using following comparison operators :
= equal to
<less than
>greater than
<= less than or equal to
>= greater than or equal to
The condition formed by the above comparison operators is evaluated to result
into TRUE or FALSE.
<Value-1> This value is returned by IIF() function to the field, if the condition
turns out to be TRUE
<Value-2> This value is returned by IIF() function to the field, if the condition
turns out to be FALSE
Example : Suppose a field Type is to return the string of characters Debit
when its value is 0 and Credit when its value is 1, IIF() function is used as
shown below :
IIF (Type = 0, Debit, Credit)
(b) Abs : The purpose of this function is to return absolute value, This function
receives a numeric value as its input argument and returns an absolute value.
Consider the following examples on use of Abs ( ) function :
When 84 is given as input argument to Abs( 84), it returns 84
When 84 is given as input argument to Abs(84), it returns 84

622

Accountancy

(c) Val : The purpose of this function is to return the numbers contained in a
string as a numeric value of appropriate type. Its Syntax is Val(string)
The string argument of the above Val( ) function is any valid string expression.
The Val( ) function stops reading the string at the first character that cannot
be recognised as number. For example, Val(12431) returns the value 12431
by converting the enclosed string of numerals into value. However, Val
(12,431) returns the numeric value 12 because comma after 12 in the
enclosed string of characters in Val ( ) function is not recognised as number.

S-ar putea să vă placă și